Ricoh D129, D130 Service Manual. Www.s Manuals.com. Manual
User Manual: Multi-functional printer Ricoh Aficio MP 5002SP - Service manuals and Schematics, Disassembly / Assembly. Free.
Open the PDF directly: View PDF .
Page Count: 1402
Download | |
Open PDF In Browser | View PDF |
D129/D130 SERVICE MANUAL It is the reader's responsibility when discussing the information contained within this document to maintain a level of confidentiality that is in the best interest of Ricoh Americas Corporation and its member companies. NO PART OF THIS DOCUMENT MAY BE REPRODUCED IN ANY FASHION AND DISTRIBUTED WITHOUT THE PRIOR PERMISSION OF RICOH AMERICAS CORPORATION. All product names, domain names or product illustrations, including desktop images, used in this document are trademarks, registered trademarks or the property of their respective companies. They are used throughout this book in an informational or editorial fashion only and for the benefit of such companies. No such use, or the use of any trade name, or web site is intended to convey endorsement or other affiliation with Ricoh products. 2012 RICOH Americas Corporation. All rights reserved. WARNING The Service Manual contains information regarding service techniques, procedures, processes and spare parts of office equipment distributed by Ricoh Americas Corporation. Users of this manual should be either service trained or certified by successfully completing a Ricoh Technical Training Program. Untrained and uncertified users utilizing information contained in this service manual to repair or modify Ricoh equipment risk personal injury, damage to property or loss of warranty protection. Ricoh Americas Corporation LEGEND COMPANY PRODUCT CODE LANIER RICOH SAVIN D129-17 MP 4002 Aficio MP 4002 MP 4002 D129-57 MP 4002SP Aficio MP 4002SP MP 4002SP D130-17 MP 5002 Aficio MP 5002 MP 5002 D130-57 MP 5002SP Aficio MP 5002SP MP 5002SP DOCUMENTATION HISTORY REV. NO. * DATE 01/2012 COMMENTS Original Printing D129/D130 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. PRODUCT INFORMATION ........................................................... 1-1 1.1 SPECIFICATIONS ..................................................................................... 1-1 1.2 MACHINE CONFIGURATION ................................................................... 1-2 1.2.1 COPIER ............................................................................................ 1-2 1.3 GUIDANCE FOR THOSE WHO ARE FAMILIAR WITH PREDECESSOR PRODUCTS ..................................................................................................... 1-5 1.4 OVERVIEW ................................................................................................ 1-6 1.4.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT ................................................................... 1-6 1.4.2 PAPER PATH ................................................................................... 1-8 1.4.3 DRIVE LAYOUT ............................................................................... 1-9 2. INSTALLATION ............................................................................. 2-1 2.1 INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS ............................................................ 2-1 2.1.1 ENVIRONMENT ............................................................................... 2-2 2.1.2 MACHINE LEVEL ............................................................................. 2-2 2.1.3 MINIMUM SPACE REQUIREMENTS ............................................... 2-3 2.1.4 POWER REQUIREMENTS .............................................................. 2-3 2.2 INSTALLATION FLOW CHART ................................................................. 2-4 2.3 MAIN MACHINE INSTALLATION .............................................................. 2-5 2.3.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ...................................................................... 2-5 2.3.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ........................................................ 2-7 Preliminary Procedures ........................................................................ 2-7 PCDU (Photoconductor and Development Unit) ................................ 2-10 Toner Bottle........................................................................................ 2-13 Paper Trays........................................................................................ 2-13 Initialize TD Sensor and Developer .................................................... 2-14 Set Paper Size for Paper Trays.......................................................... 2-14 Electrical Total Counter ...................................................................... 2-14 Exposure Glass Cleaner .................................................................... 2-15 Settings Relevant to the Service Contract .......................................... 2-15 Data Overwrite Security ..................................................................... 2-16 HDD Encryption.................................................................................. 2-17 SM i D129/D130 App 2 Me Setting (SP model only) ..................................................... 2-18 2.3.3 MOVING THE MACHINE ................................................................ 2-19 2.3.4 TRANSPORTING THE MACHINE .................................................. 2-19 2.4 PAPER FEED UNIT INSTALLATION (D580)........................................... 2-20 2.4.1 ACCESSORY CHECK .................................................................... 2-20 2.4.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-20 2.5 2000-SHEET LCT INSTALLATION (D581) .............................................. 2-23 2.5.1 ACCESSORY CHECK .................................................................... 2-23 2.5.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-23 2.6 1200-SHEET LCT INSTALLATION (D631) .............................................. 2-26 2.6.1 COMPONENT CHECK ................................................................... 2-26 2.6.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-27 2.7 ARDF INSTALLATION (D630) ................................................................. 2-29 2.7.1 COMPONENT CHECK ................................................................... 2-29 2.7.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-29 2.8 1-BIN TRAY UNIT INSTALLATION (D632).............................................. 2-33 2.8.1 COMPONENT CHECK ................................................................... 2-33 2.8.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-34 2.9 BRIDGE UNIT INSTALLATION (D634).................................................... 2-36 2.9.1 COMPONENT CHECK ................................................................... 2-36 2.9.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-37 2.10 3000/2000-SHEET (BOOKLET) FINISHER (D636/D637) .................. 2-41 2.10.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ................................................................ 2-41 2.10.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-42 Support Tray Installation .................................................................... 2-45 2.11 PUNCH UNIT INSTALLATION (D570) ............................................... 2-46 2.11.1 COMPONENT CHECK ............................................................... 2-46 2.11.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-47 2.12 PLATEN COVER (D593).................................................................... 2-52 2.13 1000-SHEET FINISHER (D588)......................................................... 2-53 2.13.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ................................................................ 2-53 2.13.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-54 2.14 SIDE TRAY (D635) ............................................................................ 2-57 2.14.1 COMPONENT CHECK ............................................................... 2-57 2.14.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-58 2.15 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY (D633) ........................................................ 2-62 2.15.1 COMPONENT CHECK ............................................................... 2-62 2.15.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-62 D129/D130 ii SM Rev. 04/23/2012 2.16 KEY COUNTER INSTALLATION ....................................................... 2-64 2.16.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-64 2.17 KEY COUNTER INTERFACE UNIT INSTALLATION ........................ 2-66 2.17.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-66 2.18 TRAY HEATER .................................................................................. 2-68 2.18.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-68 2.19 TRAY HEATER (OPTIONAL PAPER FEED UNIT) ............................ 2-70 2.19.1 COMPONENT CHECK ............................................................... 2-70 2.19.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-71 For installing the tray heater in the D580 (Two-tray paper feed unit) . 2-71 For installing the tray heater in the D581 (LCT) ................................. 2-73 2.20 HDD INSTALLATION (D640-11) ........................................................ 2-76 2.20.1 COMPONENT CHECK ............................................................... 2-76 2.20.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-77 After Installing the HDD ...................................................................... 2-78 2.21 COPY DATA SECURITY UNIT (B829) .............................................. 2-79 2.21.1 COMPONENT CHECK ............................................................... 2-79 2.21.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-80 User Tool Setting ............................................................................... 2-81 Check All Connections ....................................................................... 2-82 2.22 BROWSER UNIT TYPE I ................................................................... 2-83 2.22.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-83 2.22.2 UPDATE PROCEDURE ............................................................. 2-85 2.23 CARD READER BRACKET TYPE C3352 (D593) ............................. 2-87 2.23.1 COMPONENT CHECK ............................................................... 2-87 2.23.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .................................................. 2-88 2.34 FAX CONNECTION UNIT TYPE A (D629-31) (REMOTE FAX) ........ 2-94 3. PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE .................................................... 3-1 3.1 PM TABLES ............................................................................................... 3-1 4. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ........................................ 4-1 4.1 GENERAL CAUTIONS .............................................................................. 4-1 4.1.1 LASER UNIT ..................................................................................... 4-1 4.1.2 USED TONER .................................................................................. 4-1 4.2 SPECIAL TOOLS AND LUBRICANTS ...................................................... 4-2 4.2.1 SPECIAL TOOLS ............................................................................. 4-2 4.2.2 LUBRICANTS ................................................................................... 4-2 4.3 EXTERIOR COVERS ................................................................................ 4-3 4.3.1 FRONT DOOR, UPPER AND LOWER INNER COVER ................... 4-3 SM iii D129/D130 Rev. 09/11/2012 Upper Inner Cover ................................................................................ 4-3 Lower Inner Cover ................................................................................ 4-3 4.3.2 LEFT COVER ................................................................................... 4-4 4.3.3 REAR COVER .................................................................................. 4-4 4.3.4 RIGHT REAR COVER ...................................................................... 4-5 4.3.5 FRONT RIGHT COVER.................................................................... 4-6 4.3.6 OPERATION PANEL & LCD ............................................................ 4-6 4.3.7 PAPER EXIT COVER ..................................................................... 4-10 4.3.8 INNER TRAY .................................................................................. 4-11 4.4 SCANNER ............................................................................................... 4-12 4.4.1 EXPOSURE GLASS ....................................................................... 4-12 4.4.2 SCANNER EXTERIOR PANELS AND OPERATION PANEL ......... 4-12 Operation panel .................................................................................. 4-12 Scanner left cover .............................................................................. 4-12 Scanner right cover ............................................................................ 4-13 Scanner front cover ............................................................................ 4-13 Scanner rear cover ............................................................................. 4-13 4.4.3 LENS BLOCK ASSEMBLY ............................................................. 4-14 When reassembling ........................................................................... 4-15 4.4.4 ORIGINAL SIZE SENSOR .............................................................. 4-15 4.4.5 EXPOSURE LAMP ......................................................................... 4-17 Chromaticity rank adjustment ............................................................. 4-18 4.4.6 SCANNER HP SENSOR/PLATEN COVER SENSOR.................... 4-20 Scanner HP Sensor ........................................................................... 4-20 Platen Cover Sensor .......................................................................... 4-21 4.4.7 SCANNER MOTOR ........................................................................ 4-22 4.4.8 SCANNER MOTOR DRIVE BOARD .............................................. 4-24 4.4.9 FRONT SCANNER WIRE............................................................... 4-24 Reassembling the Front Scanner Wire............................................... 4-26 4.4.10 REAR SCANNER WIRE ............................................................. 4-29 Reassembling the Rear Scanner Wire ............................................... 4-30 4.5 LASER UNIT ............................................................................................ 4-31 4.5.1 CAUTION DECAL LOCATIONS ..................................................... 4-31 4.5.2 LASER UNIT ................................................................................... 4-31 4.5.3 POLYGON MIRROR MOTOR ........................................................ 4-33 4.5.4 LASER SYNCHRONIZATION DETECTOR .................................... 4-33 4.5.5 LD UNIT .......................................................................................... 4-34 Laser Beam Pitch Adjustment ............................................................ 4-34 D129/D130 iv SM 4.6 PCDU ....................................................................................................... 4-37 4.6.1 PCDU (PHOTOCONDUCTOR AND DEVELOPMENT UNIT) ........ 4-37 Reinstallation...................................................................................... 4-37 4.6.2 DRUM ............................................................................................. 4-38 Re-installation .................................................................................... 4-39 4.6.3 PICK-OFF PAWLS.......................................................................... 4-40 Pick-off Pawl Position Adjustment ...................................................... 4-40 4.6.4 CHARGE ROLLER AND CLEANING ROLLER .............................. 4-41 4.6.5 DRUM CLEANING BLADE ............................................................. 4-42 Re-installation .................................................................................... 4-42 4.6.6 ID SENSOR .................................................................................... 4-43 4.7 DEVELOPMENT ...................................................................................... 4-44 4.7.1 DEVELOPMENT FILTER ............................................................... 4-44 4.7.2 DEVELOPMENT ROLLER ............................................................. 4-44 Cleaning Procedure............................................................................ 4-45 4.7.3 DEVELOPER .................................................................................. 4-46 4.7.4 TD SENSOR ................................................................................... 4-49 4.8 TRANSFER.............................................................................................. 4-50 4.8.1 TRANSFER BELT UNIT ................................................................. 4-50 4.8.2 TRANSFER BELT........................................................................... 4-51 4.8.3 TONER OVERFLOW SENSOR ...................................................... 4-53 4.8.4 TRANSFER BELT CLEANING BLADE/TONER OVERFLOW SENSOR 4-53 Transfer Belt Cleaning Blade ............................................................. 4-53 Toner Overflow Sensor ...................................................................... 4-54 4.9 PAPER FEED .......................................................................................... 4-55 4.9.1 PAPER FEED UNIT ........................................................................ 4-55 Tray 1 and Tray 2 ............................................................................... 4-55 4.9.2 PICK-UP, FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLERS............................ 4-56 Tray 1 and Tray 2 ............................................................................... 4-56 4.9.3 TRAY LIFT MOTOR........................................................................ 4-57 4.9.4 RELAY, TRAY LIFT, PAPER END AND PAPER FEED SENSORS 4-58 Tray 1 and Tray 2 ............................................................................... 4-58 4.9.5 REGISTRATION SENSOR ............................................................. 4-59 Reinstall the registration sensor ......................................................... 4-60 4.10 FUSING.............................................................................................. 4-61 4.10.1 FUSING UNIT ............................................................................. 4-61 4.10.2 WEB ROLLER UNIT ................................................................... 4-62 SM v D129/D130 4.10.3 BRAKE PAD ............................................................................... 4-62 4.10.4 WEB HOLDER ROLLER AND WEB ROLLERS ......................... 4-63 Installing a new web holder roller ....................................................... 4-65 Installing new web rollers ................................................................... 4-65 4.10.5 PRESSURE ROLLER CLEANING ROLLER .............................. 4-66 4.10.6 THERMOSTATS ......................................................................... 4-67 4.10.7 THERMISTOR ............................................................................ 4-68 4.10.8 HOT ROLLER STRIPPERS........................................................ 4-69 4.10.9 FUSING LAMPS ......................................................................... 4-70 4.10.10 HOT ROLLER AND PRESSURE ROLLER .............................. 4-71 4.11 PAPER EXIT ...................................................................................... 4-72 4.11.1 PAPER EXIT UNIT ..................................................................... 4-72 4.11.2 FUSING EXIT, PAPER OVERFLOW, AND PAPER EXIT SENSORS 4-73 4.11.3 JUNCTION JAM SENSOR ......................................................... 4-73 4.11.4 PAPER EXIT MOTOR ................................................................ 4-74 4.12 DUPLEX ............................................................................................. 4-75 4.12.1 DUPLEX UNIT ............................................................................ 4-75 4.12.2 RIGHT DOOR COVER ............................................................... 4-77 4.12.3 DUPLEX DOOR SENSOR.......................................................... 4-77 4.12.4 DUPLEX ENTRANCE SENSOR ................................................. 4-78 4.12.5 DUPLEX EXIT SENSOR ............................................................ 4-79 4.12.6 DUPLEX/BY-PASS MOTOR....................................................... 4-81 4.12.7 DUPLEX INVERTER MOTOR .................................................... 4-82 4.13 BY-PASS ............................................................................................ 4-84 4.13.1 BY-PASS PAPER SIZE SENSOR/BY-PASS PAPER LENGTH SENSOR .................................................................................................. 4-84 When reinstalling the by-pass paper size sensor ............................... 4-86 4.13.2 BY-PASS PAPER END SENSOR .............................................. 4-87 4.13.3 BY-PASS PICK-UP, FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLER, TORQUE LIMITER ................................................................................................... 4-87 4.13.4 BY-PASS FEED CLUTCH .......................................................... 4-88 4.14 DRIVE AREA ..................................................................................... 4-89 4.14.1 PAPER FEED CLUTCH.............................................................. 4-89 Tray 1 and Tray 2 ............................................................................... 4-89 4.14.2 DEVELOPMENT PADDLE MOTOR ........................................... 4-90 4.14.3 TRANSFER/DEVELOPMENT MOTOR ...................................... 4-90 4.14.4 DRUM MOTOR ........................................................................... 4-91 D129/D130 vi SM 4.14.5 FUSING MOTOR ........................................................................ 4-91 4.14.6 WEB MOTOR ............................................................................. 4-92 4.14.7 PAPER FEED MOTOR ............................................................... 4-92 4.14.8 TRANSFER BELT CONTACT MOTOR ...................................... 4-93 4.14.9 REGISTRATION MOTOR........................................................... 4-93 4.14.10 TONER SUPPLY MOTOR ........................................................ 4-94 4.15 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS .......................................................... 4-95 4.15.1 CONTROLLER UNIT .................................................................. 4-95 4.15.2 HDD UNIT................................................................................... 4-96 Before Replacing the HDD Unit .......................................................... 4-96 Replacement Procedure..................................................................... 4-96 After installing the new HDD unit ........................................................ 4-97 4.15.3 CONTROLLER BOARD ............................................................. 4-98 Before Replacing the Controller Board in the Model without HDD ..... 4-98 Replacement Procedure..................................................................... 4-98 When Installing the New Controller Board........................................ 4-100 4.15.4 AFTER INSTALLING THE CONTROLLER BOARD ................. 4-101 4.15.5 MOTHER BOARD .................................................................... 4-101 4.15.6 BCU .......................................................................................... 4-103 When installing the new BCU ........................................................... 4-104 4.15.7 IPU ............................................................................................ 4-104 4.15.8 IOB ........................................................................................... 4-105 When installing a new IOB ............................................................... 4-105 4.15.9 PSU .......................................................................................... 4-105 4.15.10 HIGH VOLTAGE POWER SUPPLY ....................................... 4-106 4.15.11 FUSING EXHAUST FAN ........................................................ 4-106 When installing the fusing exhaust fan ............................................. 4-106 4.15.12 CONTROLLER FAN ............................................................... 4-107 When installing the controller fan ..................................................... 4-107 4.15.13 NVRAM ON THE BCU BOARD .............................................. 4-108 Replacement procedure for the NVRAM on the BCU Board ............ 4-108 4.16 COPY ADJUSTMENTS: PRINTING/SCANNING ............................. 4-109 4.16.1 OVERVIEW .............................................................................. 4-109 4.16.2 PRINTING................................................................................. 4-109 Registration - Leading Edge/Side-to-Side ........................................ 4-109 Blank Margin .................................................................................... 4-111 Main Scan Magnification .................................................................. 4-112 Parallelogram Image Adjustment ..................................................... 4-112 SM vii D129/D130 4.16.3 SCANNING ............................................................................... 4-114 Registration: Platen Mode ................................................................ 4-114 Magnification .................................................................................... 4-115 4.16.4 ADF .......................................................................................... 4-116 Registration ...................................................................................... 4-116 4.16.5 TOUCH SCREEN CALIBRATION ............................................ 4-117 5. SERVICE TABLES ....................................................................... 5-1 5.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE .................................................................... 5-1 5.1.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE OPERATION ..................................... 5-1 Service Mode Lock/Unlock ................................................................... 5-1 5.1.2 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE TABLES ............................................ 5-2 Service Table Key ................................................................................ 5-2 5.2 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE TABLES ..................................................... 5-3 5.2.1 SP TABLES ...................................................................................... 5-3 5.3 MAIN SP TABLES-1 .................................................................................. 5-4 5.3.1 SP1-XXX: FEED ............................................................................... 5-4 5.4 MAIN SP TABLES-2 ................................................................................ 5-13 5.4.1 SP2-XXX: DRUM ............................................................................ 5-13 5.5 MAIN SP TABLES-3 ................................................................................ 5-18 5.5.1 SP3-XXX: PROCESS ..................................................................... 5-18 5.6 MAIN SP TABLES-4 ................................................................................ 5-19 5.6.1 SP4-XXX: SCANNER ..................................................................... 5-19 5.7 MAIN SP TABLES-5 ................................................................................ 5-41 5.7.1 SP5-XXX: MODE ............................................................................ 5-41 5.8 MAIN SP TABLES-6 .............................................................................. 5-108 5.8.1 SP6-XXX: PERIPHERALS............................................................ 5-108 5.9 MAIN SP TABLES-7 .............................................................................. 5-117 5.9.1 SP7-XXX: DATA LOG................................................................... 5-117 5.10 MAIN SP TABLES-8 ........................................................................ 5-132 5.10.1 SP8-XXX: DATA LOG 2 ........................................................... 5-132 5.11 MAIN SP TABLES-9 ........................................................................ 5-183 5.11.1 INPUT CHECK TABLE ............................................................. 5-183 Copier............................................................................................... 5-183 Table 1: Paper Height Sensor .......................................................... 5-186 Table 2: Paper Size Switch .............................................................. 5-187 Table 3: Paper Size (By-pass Table) ............................................... 5-188 APS Original Size Detection............................................................. 5-189 3000/2000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637) ........................... 5-190 D129/D130 viii SM 1000-Sheet Finisher (D588) ............................................................. 5-193 5.11.2 OUTPUT CHECK TABLE ......................................................... 5-194 Copier............................................................................................... 5-194 1000-Sheet Finisher (D588) ............................................................. 5-199 3000 /2000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637) .......................... 5-200 5.11.3 PRINTER SERVICE TABLES................................................... 5-202 SP1-XXX (Service Mode) ................................................................. 5-202 5.11.4 SCANNER SERVICE TABLES ................................................. 5-210 SP1-xxx (System and Others) .......................................................... 5-210 SP2-XXX (Scanning-image quality) ................................................. 5-211 5.12 UPDATING THE FIRMWARE .......................................................... 5-212 5.12.1 BEFORE YOU BEGIN .............................................................. 5-212 5.12.2 UPDATING FIRMWARE ........................................................... 5-213 Preparation....................................................................................... 5-213 Updating Procedure ......................................................................... 5-213 Error Messages ................................................................................ 5-215 Firmware Update Error ..................................................................... 5-215 Recovery after Power Loss .............................................................. 5-215 5.12.3 HANDLING FIRMWARE UPDATE ERRORS ........................... 5-216 Error Message Table ........................................................................ 5-216 5.13 UPLOADING/DOWNLOADING NVRAM DATA ............................... 5-218 5.13.1 UPLOADING NVRAM DATA (SP5-824) ................................... 5-218 5.13.2 DOWNLOADING NVRAM DATA (SP5-825)............................. 5-219 5.14 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE ............................................................. 5-221 5.14.1 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE AT POWER ON ........................... 5-221 5.14.2 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC TEST FLOW ............................................ 5-222 5.14.3 DETAILED SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE ................................... 5-223 5.14.4 EXECUTING DETAILED SELF-DIAGNOSIS ........................... 5-223 5.15 USING THE DEBUG LOG ............................................................... 5-224 5.15.1 OVERVIEW .............................................................................. 5-224 5.15.2 SWITCHING ON AND SETTING UP SAVE DEBUG LOG ....... 5-224 4-Digit Entries for Keys 1 to 10......................................................... 5-226 Key to Acronyms .............................................................................. 5-227 Retrieving the Debug Log from the HDD .......................................... 5-228 Recording Errors Manually ............................................................... 5-228 6. TROUBLESHOOTING ................................................................. 6-1 6.1 SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS .................................................................. 6-1 6.1.1 SUMMARY ....................................................................................... 6-1 SM ix D129/D130 6.1.2 SC CODE DESCRIPTIONS .............................................................. 6-2 SC Tables: SC1xx ................................................................................ 6-3 SC Tables: SC2xx ................................................................................ 6-6 SC Tables: SC3xx ................................................................................ 6-8 SC Tables: SC4xx .............................................................................. 6-11 SC Tables: SC5xx .............................................................................. 6-12 SC Tables: SC6xx .............................................................................. 6-21 SC Tables: SC7xx .............................................................................. 6-30 SC Tables: SC8xx .............................................................................. 6-42 SC Tables: SC9xx .............................................................................. 6-65 6.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS ................................................. 6-71 6.2.1 SENSORS ...................................................................................... 6-71 6.2.2 SWITCHES ..................................................................................... 6-75 6.3 BLOWN FUSE CONDITIONS .................................................................. 6-76 6.4 FUSES ..................................................................................................... 6-77 D129/D130 x SM Read This First Safety Notices Important Safety Notices Prevention of Physical Injury 1. Before disassembling or assembling parts of the copier and peripherals, make sure that the copier power cord is unplugged. 2. The wall outlet should be near the copier and easily accessible. 3. Note that some components of the copier and the paper tray unit are supplied with electrical voltage even if the main power switch is turned off. 4. If any adjustment or operation check has to be made with exterior covers off or open while the main switch is turned on, keep hands away from electrified or mechanically driven components. 5. If the Start key is pressed before the copier completes the warm-up period (the Start key starts blinking red and green alternatively), keep hands away from the mechanical and the electrical components as the copier starts making copies as soon as the warm-up period is completed. 6. The inside and the metal parts of the fusing unit become extremely hot while the copier is operating. Be careful to avoid touching those components with your bare hands. To prevent a fire or explosion, keep the machine away from flammable liquids, gases, and aerosols. Health Safety Conditions 1. Toner and developer are non-toxic, but if you get either of them in your eyes by accident, it may cause temporary eye discomfort. Immediately wash eyes with plenty of water. If unsuccessful, get medical attention. 2. This machine, which uses a high voltage power source, can generate ozone gas. High ozone density is harmful to human health. Therefore, the machine must be installed in a well-ventilated room. Observance of Electrical Safety Standards 1. This machine and its peripherals must be serviced by a customer service representative who has completed the training course on those models. 2. The NVRAM on the system control board has a lithium battery which can explode if replaced incorrectly. Replace the NVRAM only with an identical one. The manufacturer recommends replacing the entire NVRAM. Do not recharge or burn this battery. Used NVRAM must be handled in accordance with local regulations. Handling Toner Work carefully when removing paper jams or replacing toner bottles or cartridges to avoid spilling toner on clothing or the hands. If toner is inhaled, immediately gargle with large amounts of cold water and move to a well ventilated location. If there are signs of irritation or other problems, seek medical attention. If toner gets on the skin, wash immediately with soap and cold running water. If toner gets into the eyes, flush the eyes with cold running water or eye wash. If there are signs of irritation or other problems, seek medical attention. If toner is swallowed, drink a large amount of cold water to dilute the ingested toner. If there are signs of any problem, seek medical attention. If toner spills on clothing, wash the affected area immediately with soap and cold water. Never use hot water! Hot water can cause toner to set and permanently stain fabric. Always store toner and developer supplies such as toner and developer packages, cartridges, and bottles (including used toner and empty bottles and cartridges) out of the reach of children. Always store fresh toner supplies or empty bottles or cartridges in a cool, dry location that is not exposed to direct sunlight. Do not use the cleaner to suck spilled toner (including used toner). Sucked toner may cause firing or explosion due to electrical contact flickering inside the cleaner. However, it is possible to use the cleaner designed for dust explosion-proof purpose. If toner is spilled over the floor, sweep up spilled toner slowly and clean remainder with wet cloth. Safety and Ecological Notes for Disposal 1. Do not incinerate toner bottles or used toner. Toner dust may ignite suddenly when exposed to an open flame. 2. Dispose of used toner, the maintenance unit which includes developer or the organic photoconductor in accordance with local regulations. (These are non-toxic supplies.) 3. Dispose of replaced parts in accordance with local regulations. 4. When keeping used lithium batteries in order to dispose of them later, do not put more than 100 batteries per sealed box. Storing larger numbers or not sealing them apart may lead to chemical reactions and heat build-up. Laser Safety The Center for Devices and Radiological Health (CDRH) prohibits the repair of laser-based optical units in the field. The optical housing unit can only be repaired in a factory or at a location with the requisite equipment. The laser subsystem is replaceable in the field by a qualified Customer Engineer. The laser chassis is not repairable in the field. Customer engineers are therefore directed to return all chassis and laser subsystems to the factory or service depot when replacement of the optical subsystem is required. Use of controls, or adjustment, or performance of procedures other than those specified in this manual may result in hazardous radiation exposure. Turn off the main switch before attempting any of the procedures in the Laser Optics Housing Unit section. Laser beams can seriously damage your eyes. CAUTION MARKING: Conventions in this Manual Symbols and Abbreviations This manual uses several symbols and abbreviations. The meaning of those symbols and abbreviations are as follows: See or Refer to Clip ring Screw Connector Clamp E-ring SEF Short Edge Feed LEF Long Edge Feed Cautions, Notes, etc. The following headings provide special information: FAILURE TO OBEY WARNING INFORMATION COULD RESULT IN SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH. Obey these guidelines to ensure safe operation and prevent minor injuries. This information provides tips and advice about how to best service the machine. PRODUCT INFORMATION R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New None Specifications Product Information 1. PRODUCT INFORMATION 1.1 SPECIFICATIONS See "Appendices" for the following information: General Specifications Optional Equipment SM 1-1 D129/D130 Machine Configuration 1.2 MACHINE CONFIGURATION 1.2.1 COPIER Key: Symbol: U: Unique option, C: Option also used with other products Item Copier D129/D130 Callout Key D129/D130 [1] - D129/D130 Platen Cover (See Note 1) [2] C D593 ARDF (See Note 1) [3] C D630 2000-sheet LCT [4] C D581 1200-sheet LCT [5] C D631 Two-Tray Paper Feed Unit [6] C D580 1-Bin Tray [7] U D632 1-2 Machine Code SM Machine Configuration Callout Key Bridge Unit [8] C D634 Internal Shift Tray [9] U D633 Side Tray [10] U D635 1000-sheet Finisher (See Note 2) [11] C D588 [12] C D637 [13] C D636 -Punch Unit (See Note 3) - C -Punch Unit (See Note 3) - C -Punch Unit (See Note 3) - C Key Counter Bracket - C A674 HDD (for basic model only) - U D640 Copy Data Security Unit - C B829 Fax Option - U D629 G3 Interface Unit - U D629 SAF Memory - C G578 Handset - C D645 Fax Communication Unit - U D629 Printer/Scanner Unit - U D641 Printer Unit - U D641 Scanner Scanner Upgrade Unit - U D641 - U D641 2000-Sheet Booklet Finisher (See Note 2) 3000-Sheet Finisher (See Note 2) Fax Printer/ PostScript3 Unit SM 1-3 Machine Code Product Information Item D570-00 (2/3-hole) NA D570-01 (2/4-hole) EU D570-02 (4-hole) Scandinavia D129/D130 Machine Configuration Item Callout Key Machine Code IPDS Unit - U D641 Gigabit Ethernet - C G874 IEEE 1284 - C B679 IEEE 802.11a/g, g - C D377 Bluetooth - C D566 Memory Unit 512 MB - C D594 File Format Converter - C D377 Browser Unit - U D640 VM Card - C D640 Netware - U D629 NOTE: 1. The ARDF and platen cover cannot be installed together. 2. The finisher requires the bridge unit and two-tray paper feed unit or 2000-sheet LCT. The 1000-sheet finisher and 2000/3000-sheet (Booklet) finisher cannot be installed together. 3. The punch unit requires the 2000/3000-sheet (Booklet) finisher. D129/D130 1-4 SM 1.3 GUIDANCE FOR THOSE WHO ARE FAMILIAR WITH PREDECESSOR PRODUCTS The D129/D130 series are successor models to the D091/D092 series. If you have experience with the predecessor products, the following information will be of help when you read this manual. Different Points from Predecessor Products D129/D130 D091/D092 Controller Type GW+ Controller GW Controller Operation Panel Tilt Operation Panel Type Stationary Operation Panel Includes USB/SD slot (not all Type functions can be used in Basic models) Scanner Lamp LED Xenon Safety Shut Down Available Not Available Standard (SP model only) Option Function PDF Direct Included in Printer/Scanner. App2Me Standard (SP model only) Standard (SP model only) Included in Printer/Scanner, Included in VM SD Card. Printer SD Card. Users who bought the VM card can download App2Me from the Web Site. Data Overwrite Standard Option Standard Option Security HDD Encryption SM 1-5 D129/D130 Product Information Guidance for Those Who are Familiar with Predecessor Products Overview 1.4 OVERVIEW 1.4.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT 1 Exposure Glass 21 By-pass Feed Roller 2 2nd Mirror 22 By-pass Separation Roller 3 1st Mirror 23 Duplex/by-pass transport roller 4 Exposure Lamp 24 Upper Relay Belt 5 Original Length Sensors 25 Feed Roller 6 Scanner Motor 26 Separation Roller D129/D130 1-6 SM 7 Lens 27 Pick-up Roller 8 SBU 28 Bottom Plate 9 Junction Gate 2 29 Development Unit 10 Duplex Inverter Gate 30 Charge Roller 11 Duplex Entrance Sensor 31 F 12 Duplex Inverter Roller 32 Barrel Toroidal Lens (BTL) 13 Hot Roller 33 Polygonal Mirror Motor 14 Pressure Roller 34 Laser Unit 15 Transfer Belt Cleaning Blade 35 Toner Bottle Holder 16 Duplex Transport Roller 36 Junction Gate 1 17 Transfer Belt 37 Exit Roller 18 OPC Drum 38 Paper Exit Sensor 19 Registration Roller 39 3rd Mirror 20 By-pass Pick-up Roller 40 Scanner HP Sensor SM 1-7 Product Information Overview Mirror D129/D130 Overview 1.4.2 PAPER PATH 1 ARDF 2 Interchange Unit 3 Duplex Unit 4 By-pass Tray 5 Large Capacity Tray (LCT: 1200-sheet) 6 Paper Tray Unit 7 Two-Tray Finisher 8 Bridge Unit 9 1-Bin Tray D129/D130 1-8 SM Overview Product Information 1.4.3 DRIVE LAYOUT 1 Scanner Motor 10 Paper Feed Clutch 1 2 Fusing Motor 11 Feed Motor 3 Web Motor 12 By-pass Paper Feed Clutch 4 Transfer/Development Motor 13 Registration Motor 5 Drum Motor 14 Duplex/By-pass Motor 6 Development Paddle Motor 15 Transfer Belt Contact Motor 7 Tray Lift Motor 1 16 Duplex Inverter Motor 8 Tray Lift Motor 2 17 Paper Exit Motor 9 Paper Feed Clutch 2 SM 1-9 D129/D130 INSTALLATION R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY P a ge Date A d de d /U pd at e d /N ew 83 ~ 93 04/20/2012 Added Browser Unit Type I 94 ~ 102 04/23/2012 Added Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31) Installation Requirements 2. INSTALLATION Never turn off the main power switch when the power LED is lit or flashing. To avoid damaging the hard disk or memory, press the operation power switch to switch the power off, wait for the power LED to go off, and then switch the main power switch off. Install the machine in a safe place for keeping security. Make sure that the operation instructions are kept at a customer's hand. The main power LED lights or flashes while the platen cover or ARDF is open, while the main machine is communicating with a facsimile or the network server, or while the machine is accessing the hard disk or memory for reading or writing data. Rating voltage for peripherals: Make sure to plug the cables into the correct sockets. SM 2-1 D129/D130 Installation 2.1 INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS Installation Requirements 2.1.1 ENVIRONMENT Temperature Range: 10°C to 32°C (50°F to 90°F) Humidity Range: 15% to 80% RH Ambient Illumination: Less than 1,500 lux (do not expose to direct sunlight.) Ventilation: Room air should turn at least 30 m3/hr/person Ambient Dust: Less than 0.10 mg/m3 (2.7 x 10/6 oz/yd3) 1. Avoid areas exposed to sudden temperature changes: 1) Areas directly exposed to cool air from an air conditioner. 2) Areas directly exposed to heat from a heater. 2. Do not place the machine where it will be exposed to corrosive gases. 3. Do not install the machine at any location over 2,000 m (6,500 ft.) above sea level. 4. Place the main machine on a strong and level base. Inclination on any side should be no more than 5 mm (0.2"). 5. Do not place the machine where it may be subjected to strong vibrations. 2.1.2 MACHINE LEVEL Front to back: Within 5 mm (0.2") of level Right to left: Within 5 mm (0.2") of level D129/D130 2-2 SM Installation Requirements 2.1.3 MINIMUM SPACE REQUIREMENTS Installation Place the main machine near the power source, providing clearance as shown: Front [A]: Over 75 cm (29.6") Left [B]: 10 cm (4") Rear [C]: 10 cm (4") Right [D]: 55 cm (21.7") The 75 cm (29.6") recommended for the space at the front is for pulling out the paper tray only. If the operator stands at the front of the main machine, more space is required. 2.1.4 POWER REQUIREMENTS Make sure that the wall outlet is near the main machine and easily accessible. Make sure the plug is firmly inserted in the outlet. 1. Avoid multi-wiring. Be sure to ground the machine. Input voltage level: North America 120 V, 60 Hz: More than 12.5 A Europe/Asia 220 V to 240V, 50 Hz/60 Hz: more than 7 A 2. Permissible voltage fluctuation: 10% to 15% 3. Never set anything on the power cord. SM 2-3 D129/D130 Installation Flow Chart 2.2 INSTALLATION FLOW CHART The following flow chart shows how to install the optional units more efficiently. Bridge Unit: Needed for the finishers. Paper Tray Unit or LCT 2000-sheet: Needed for the LCT 1200-sheet and finishers. D129/D130 2-4 SM Main Machine Installation 2.3 MAIN MACHINE INSTALLATION 2.3.1 ACCESSORY CHECK Description 1 2 Q'ty Decal – Energy Save (-91, -61, -17, -57, -18, -58, -27, -67, -29, -69, -19, -59, -28, -68) Rating plate (-17, -18, -19, -21, -27, -28, -29, -57, -58, -59, -61, -67, -69, -68) 1 1 3 Decal – VERMONT (-91, -17, -57, -18, -58) 1 4 Model Name Decal (-91, -92, 17, -57) 1 5 Decal – WEEE (-27, -67) 1 6 Main SW Decal 1 7 Decal – Eco Label (-21, -61) 1 8 Decal – Rohs (-21, -61) 1 9 Decal – Rohs date(-21, -61) 1 10 Decal – Certificates (-21, -61) 2 11 Decal – LASERCLASS1 (-19, -59, -28, -68, -21, -61) 1 12 Decal – Impoter (-19, -59) 1 13 Decal – SDK (-57, -58, -67, -69, -59, -68, -61) 1 14 Decal – Caution - Copy 1 15 Emblem Cover 1 16 Emblem 1 17 Decal – Brand 1 18 Warranty (-21, -61) 1 SM Installation Check the quantity and condition of the accessories in the box against the following list: 2-5 D129/D130 Main Machine Installation Description Q'ty 19 Quick Reference Guide – Safety (-27, -67) 20 21 Sheet – Communication management – Blank (-27, -67, -19, -59) Decal – Paper Tray (-91, -17, -57, -18, -58, -27, -67, -29, -69, -19, -59, -28, -68, -21, -61) 1 1 1 22 Decal – Caution – Original (-91, -17, -57, -18, -58) 1 23 Sheet – EMC – Traceability (-27, -67) 1 24 Sheet – Name – Tel (-21, -61) 1 25 Stamp (-91, -17, -57, -18, -58, -) 1 26 Exposure Glass Cleaning Cloth 1 27 Cloth Holder 1 28 Ferrite Core 1 29 Sheet – Exposure Glass (-91, -17, -18, -19, -21, -27, -28, -29, -57, -58, -59, -61, -67, -69, -68) 30 Power Supply Cord 31 1 1 CD-ROM: Operation Instruction (-91, -92, -17, -18, -21, -27, -28, -29, -57, -58, -67, -69, -68) 1 32 CD-ROM: Driver (-57, -58, -67, -69, -68) 1 33 CD-ROM: Operation Instruction/Driver (-19, -59, -21, -61) 1 Operation Instruction – Read This First 34 (-91, -92, -17, -18, -19, -21, -27, -29, -57, -58, -59, -61, -67, 1 -69) Operation Instruction – User Guide 35 (-91, -92, -17, -18, -19, -21, -27, -29, -57, -58, -59, -61, -67, 1 -69) 36 Sheet – EULA (-57, -58, -67, -68, -69, -19, -59, -21, -61) 1 37 Sheet – Caution (-57, -58, -67, -68, -69, -68, -61) 1 D129/D130 2-6 SM Main Machine Installation Description Q'ty CD-ROM: Operation Instruction - App 2 Me (-57, -58, -67, -69, -59) Quick Reference Guide - App 2 Me 39 1 1 (-57, -58, -69, -59) 40 Quick Reference Guide – Start Up (-27, -67) 1 41 Sheet – Notes – Manual – CD (-19, -59, -21, -61) 1 Installation 38 2.3.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE Preliminary Procedures Put the machine on the paper feed unit or the LCT first if you will install an optional paper feed unit or the optional LCT at the same time. Then install the machine and other options. Keep the shipping retainers after you install the machine. You may need them in the future if you transport the machine to another location. 1. Remove all the tapes and retainers on the machine. 2. Remove all the tapes and retainers in trays 1 and 2, and then take out the power cord from tray 1 (if applicable). SM 2-7 D129/D130 Main Machine Installation 3. Open the right door [A]. 4. Remove the two stoppers [A] from the fusing unit. 5. Remove the scanner unit stay [A]. D129/D130 2-8 SM Installation Main Machine Installation 6. Open the front door [A], and then remove the jam location sheet [B]. 7. Keep the scanner unit stay [A] inside the front door [B]. 8. Reattach the jam location sheet. 9. Close the front door. SM 2-9 D129/D130 Main Machine Installation 10. Attach the correct brand decal to the machine [A]. 11. Attach the correct emblem and the cover to the front door [B] of the machine, if the emblem is not attached. If you want to change the emblem that has been already attached, remove the panel with a small screwdriver, and then install the correct emblem. 12. Attach the correct paper tray number and size decals to the paper trays [C]. 13. Pull out the feeler [A] for the output tray full detection mechanism. PCDU (Photoconductor and Development Unit) 1. Open the front door. 2. Open the right door [1]. 3. Release the lock lever [2]. 4. Pull out the PCDU [3] and place it on a clean flat surface. 5. Spread a large piece of paper on a flat surface. D129/D130 2-10 SM Main Machine Installation Make sure the area is free of pins, paper clips, staples, etc. to avoid attraction to Installation the magnetic development roller. 6. Remove the opening cap [4], and then install it in the opening [5] of the PCDU. 7. Open the PCDU [6] ( 8. Remove the entrance seal plate [7] ( 9. Remove the development roller unit [8], and set it on the paper. SM x 2). x 2). 2-11 D129/D130 Main Machine Installation 10. Pour the developer [9] into the development unit. The developer lot number is embossed on the end of the developer package. Do not discard the package until you have recorded the lot number. ( p.4-46 "Developer") 1) Pour approximately 1/3 of the developer evenly along the length of the development unit. 2) Rotate the drive gear [10] to work the developer into the unit. 3) Repeat until all the developer is in the development unit. 4) Continue to turn the drive gear until the developer is even with the top of the unit. 11. Put the opening cap [4] back in its original place. 12. Reassemble the PCDU. 13. Re-install the PCDU. D129/D130 2-12 SM Main Machine Installation Installation Toner Bottle 1. Open the front door. 2. Turn the toner bottle holder lever [1] counterclockwise, push down the lever [2], and then pull out the toner bottle holder [3]. 3. Hold the toner bottle [5] horizontally, and shake it 5 or 6 times. 4. Unscrew the bottle cap [4] and set the bottle [5] in the holder. 5. Push the toner bottle holder into the main machine until it locks in place. 6. Turn the toner bottle holder lever [1] clockwise to lock it. 7. Close the front door. Paper Trays 1. Open the 1st paper tray, and then press down on the right side of the lock switch to unlock the side fences. 2. Press in on the sides of the fence release, and slide the side fences to the appropriate mark for the paper size. 3. Pinch the sides of the end fence and move it to the appropriate mark for the paper size, then load the paper. 4. Check the position of the stack. Confirm that there is no gap between the stack and the side fences. If you see a gap, adjust the position of the side fences. 5. Press down the lock to lock the side fences. 6. Repeat this procedure to load paper in the 2nd paper tray. SM 2-13 D129/D130 Main Machine Installation Initialize TD Sensor and Developer 1. Connect the main machine to the power outlet, switch on the main machine, and wait for the fusing unit to warm up. 2. Enter Copy SP Mode. 3. Press SP Direct to highlight "SP Direct", enter 2801, and then press 4. When the message prompts you to enter the lot number of the developer, enter the 7-digit lot number, press . on the touch-panel. Press [Yes], and then press [Execute]. This initializes the TD sensor. It takes 60 to 90 sec. The lot number is printed on the end of the developer package. Recording the lot number could help troubleshoot problems later. If the lot number is unavailable, enter any seven-digit number. 5. Press SP Direct to highlight "SP Direct" and enter 2805, press , and then press "Execute" on the touch-panel. This initializes the developer. 6. Press "Exit" twice to return to the copy window. Set Paper Size for Paper Trays 1. Press User Tools/Counter 2. On the touch panel, press "System Settings". 3. Press the "Tray Paper Settings" tab. 4. Press the button for the tray to change. 5. Change the setting and press the [OK] button. 6. Repeat for each tray installed. 7. Press Exit twice to return to the main display . The 1st, 2nd, 3rd, and 4th paper trays are provided with the paper size switches. The detected paper size by the paper size switches has priority over the UP settings. However, if you change the "Auto Detect" with the UP setting, you can select the paper size. 8. Check the copy quality and machine operation. Electrical Total Counter The electrical total counter no longer requires initialization. The new incrementing counter is set to "0" at the factory. D129/D130 2-14 SM Main Machine Installation Installation Exposure Glass Cleaner 1. Attach the exposure glass cleaner holder [1] to the left side of the machine. 2. Place the exposure glass cleaner [2] inside the holder. The exposure glass cleaner is used to clean the ARDF exposure glass, the glass strip to the left of the large exposure glass. Settings Relevant to the Service Contract Change the necessary settings for the following SP modes if the customer has made a service contract. Item A3/11" x 17" double counting SP No. Function Default Specifies whether the counter is SP5-104-001 doubled for A3/11" x 17" paper. "No": Single (SSP) When you have to change this counting setting, contact your supervisor. 5812-002 programs the service station fax number. The number is Service Tel. SP5-812-001 No. Setting through 004 printed on the counter list when the meter charge mode is selected. This lets the user fax the counter data to the service station. SM 2-15 D129/D130 Main Machine Installation Data Overwrite Security Do the following procedure if a customer wants to use this function. 1. Do SP5-878-1(Option Setup - Data Overwrite Security) and touch [EXECUTE]. 2. Go out of the SP mode, turn off the operation switch, then turn off the main power switch. 3. Turn the machine power on. 4. Press [User Tools] and select System Setting > Administrator Tools > Auto Erase Memory Setting > On 5. Exit from User Tools mode. 6. Check the display and make sure that the overwrite erase icon [A] is displayed. 7. Make a Sample Copy. 8. Check the overwrite erase icon. The icon [B] changes to [C] when job data is stored in the hard disk. The icon goes back to its usual shape [B] after this function has completed a data overwrite operation to the hard disk. 9. Do SP5990-005 (SP print mode - Diagnostic Report). 10. Look at the report: Under "[ROM No./Firmware Version]" check the number and version number listed for "HDD Format Option". Under "[Loading Program]" check the option number and version number listed for "GW_zoffy". These two version numbers should be identical. 11. Exit SP mode. D129/D130 2-16 SM Main Machine Installation HDD Encryption 1. Do SP5-878-2 (Option Setup - Encryption Option) and touch [EXECUTE] 2. Go out of the SP mode, turn off the operation switch, then turn off the main power switch. 3. Turn the machine power on. 4. Push [User Tools] and select System Setting > Administrator Tools > Machine Data Encryption Setting. 5. Press [Encrypt]. 6. Select the data to be carried over to the hard disk and not to be reset To carry all of the data over to the hard disk, select [All data].To carry over only the machine setting data, select [File System Data Only]. To reset all of the data, select [Format All Data]. 7. Press the [Start] Key. The encryption key for backup data is printed. SM 2-17 D129/D130 Installation Do the following procedure if a customer wants to use this function. Main Machine Installation App 2 Me Setting (SP model only) SP models have VM and "App 2 Me" built in. Do the following procedure if a customer wants to use "App 2 Me". 1. Press "User Tools" key on the operation panel. 2. Touch the "Extended Feature Settings" button twice. 3. Touch the "App 2 Me" line in the Startup Setting tab. 4. Touch the "Extended Feature Info" tab on the LCD. 5. Touch the "App 2 Me" line. 6. Set the setting of "Auto Start" to "On". 7. Touch the "Exit" button. 8. Exit the "User Tools" settings. Update Procedure for App 2 Me Provider 1. Push the "User/Tools" key. 2. If an administrator setting is registered for the machine, steps 2 and 3 are required. Otherwise, skip to step 4. 3. Push the "Login/Logout" key. 4. Login with the administrator user name and password. 5. Touch "Extended Feature Settings" twice on the LCD. 6. Touch all the applications. Then, the status will be changed to "Stop". 7. Turn off the machine. And then remove the VM Card. 8. Prepare newer App 2 Me Provider zip file from Firmware Download Center. Unzip the zip file. (The folder name is "337051920".) And then copy the App 2 Me Provider folder in the specified path of VM card. The path is "SD_Card Drive¥ sdk¥dsdk¥dist¥337051920" as shown above. D129/D130 2-18 SM Main Machine Installation 9. Turn the SD card label face to the rear of the machine. Then push it slowly into Slot 2 (Lower Slot) until you hear a click. 10. Turn on the main power switch. 11. Press the "User Tools" key on the operation panel. 12. Touch the "Extended Feature Settings" button twice. Installation 13. Touch the "Extended Feature Info" tab on LCD. 14. Touch the "App2Me" line. 15. Set the setting of the "Auto Start" to "On". 16. Touch the "Exit" button. 17. Exit the "User Tools/Counter" settings. 2.3.3 MOVING THE MACHINE This section shows you how to manually move the machine from one floor to another floor. See the section "Transporting the Machine" if you have to pack the machine and move it a longer distance. 1. Remove all trays from the optional paper feed unit or LCT. 2.3.4 TRANSPORTING THE MACHINE 1. Do SP 4806-001 to move the scanner carriage from the home position. This prevents dust from falling into the machine during transportation. 2. Make sure there is no paper left in the paper trays. Then fix down the bottom plates with a sheet of paper and tape. 3. SM Do one of the following: Attach shipping tape to the covers and doors. Shrink-wrap the machine tightly. 2-19 D129/D130 Paper Feed Unit Installation (D580) 2.4 PAPER FEED UNIT INSTALLATION (D580) 2.4.1 ACCESSORY CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list. No. Description Q'ty 1 Screw (M4x10) 2 2 Screw with Spring Washer (M4x10) 1 3 Securing Bracket 2 2.4.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure. The handles of the main machine for lifting must be inserted inside the machine and locked unless these handles are used for the installation or relocation of the main machine. You need two or more persons to lift the copier. The copier is highly unstable when lifted by one person, and may cause human injury or property damage. D129/D130 2-20 SM Paper Feed Unit Installation (D580) Remove all tape on the paper feed unit. 2. Remove the paper trays and remove all tape and padding. 3. Grasp the handle [A] and grips [B] of the machine. 4. Lift the copier and install it on the paper feed unit [C]. Installation 1. You need two or more persons to lift the copier. Hold the handle and grips of the machine when you lift and move the machine. 5. Remove trays 1 and 2 of the machine. 6. Fasten the spring washer screw [A]. 7. Reinstall all trays. SM 2-21 D129/D130 Paper Feed Unit Installation (D580) 8. Attach the securing brackets [B] ( x 1 each; M4x10). 9. Attach the appropriate paper tray number decal [A] and paper size decal [B] to the line [C] on each tray of the paper feed unit. The paper tray number and size sheet is in the accessory box of the main machine. 10. Lock the caster stoppers for the front two casters under the paper feed unit. 11. Load paper into the paper feed unit. 12. Turn on the main power switch of the machine. 13. Check the paper feed unit operation and copy quality. D129/D130 2-22 SM 2000-sheet LCT Installation (D581) 2.5 2000-SHEET LCT INSTALLATION (D581) 2.5.1 ACCESSORY CHECK No. Description Installation Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list. Q'ty 1 Screw (M4x10) 2 2 Screw with Spring washer (M4x10) 1 3 Securing bracket 2 2.5.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure. The handles of the main machine for lifting must be inserted inside the machine and locked, unless these handles are used for the installation or relocation of the main machine. You need two or more persons to lift the copier. The copier is highly unstable when lifted by one person, and may cause human injury or property damage. 1. SM Remove the strips of tape. 2-23 D129/D130 2000-sheet LCT Installation (D581) 2. Grasp the handle [A] and grips [B] of the machine. 3. Lift the copier and install it on the LCT [C]. You need two or more persons to lift the copier. Hold the handle [A] and grips [B] of the machine when you lift and move the machine. 4. Remove trays 1 and 2 of the machine. 5. Fasten the Spring Washer Screw [A]. 6. Reinstall all trays. 7. Attach the securing brackets [B] ( D129/D130 x 1 each; M4x10). 2-24 SM Installation 2000-sheet LCT Installation (D581) 8. Attach the appropriate paper tray number decal [A] and paper size decal [B] to the line [C] on the tray of the LCT. The paper tray number and size sheet is in the accessory box of the main machine. 9. Lock the caster stoppers for the front two casters under the paper feed unit. 10. Load paper into the LCT. 11. Turn on the main power switch of the machine. 12. Check the LCT operation and copy quality. SM 2-25 D129/D130 1200-sheet LCT Installation (D631) 2.6 1200-SHEET LCT INSTALLATION (D631) 2.6.1 COMPONENT CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list. No. Description Q'ty 1 Front Bracket 1 2 Rear Bracket 1 3 Stud Screw 4 4 Joint Pin 2 5 LCT 1 D129/D130 2-26 SM 1200-sheet LCT Installation (D631) 2.6.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure. The Paper Tray Unit (D580) or LCT 2000-sheet (D581) must be installed before Installation installing this 1200-sheet LCT. 1. Unpack the LCT and remove the tapes. 2. Remove the stand covers [A]. 3. Release the locks [B] of the front and rear caster stands. 4. Remove the caster stands [C]. 5. Remove the paper path cover [A], connector cover [B] and six hole covers [C]. SM 2-27 D129/D130 1200-sheet LCT Installation (D631) 6. Insert the joint pins [A]. 7. Attach the front [B] and rear brackets [C]. ( 8. Pull out the front and rear rails [A], and then hang them on each bracket [B]. 9. Connect the LCT cable [C] to the main machine. x2 each) 10. Slide the LCT [D] into the main machine. 11. Make sure that the front and rear sides of the LCT are closely attached to the main machine. D129/D130 2-28 SM ARDF Installation (D630) 2.7 ARDF INSTALLATION (D630) 2.7.1 COMPONENT CHECK No. Description Installation Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list. Q'ty 1 ARDF 1 2 Attention Decal Sheet – Top Cover 1 3 Stamp 1 4 Knob Screw 2 5 Stud Screw 2 6 Platen Sheet 1 2.7.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. SM Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure. Remove the all tapes and shipping retainers. 2-29 D129/D130 ARDF Installation (D630) 2. Insert the two stud screws [A] on the top of the machine. 3. Mount the ARDF [A] by aligning the screw keyholes [B] of the ARDF support plate over the stud screws. 4. Slide the ARDF toward the front of the machine. 5. Secure the ARDF with the two knob screws [C]. 6. Connect the I/F cable [D] to the machine. D129/D130 2-30 SM Installation ARDF Installation (D630) 7. Remove two screws [A] from the bottom of the ARDF. 8. Remove all tapes on the ARDF. 9. Place the platen sheet [A] on the exposure glass. 10. Align the rear left corner (of the platen sheet) with the corner [B] on the exposure glass. 11. Close the ARDF. 12. Open the ARDF and check that the platen sheet is correctly attached. SM 2-31 D129/D130 ARDF Installation (D630) 13. Open the ARDF cover [A]. 14. Open the feed-in guide plate [B] and feed-out guide plate [C]. 15. Install the stamp [D] into the ARDF. 16. Close two guide plates [C] [B]. 17. Close the ARDF cover [A]. 18. Attach the decal [A] to the top cover as shown. Choose the language you want. 19. Plug in and turn on the main power switch of the machine, and then check the ARDF operation. 20. Make a full size copy. Check that the registrations (side-to-side and leading edge) and image skew are correct. If they are not, adjust the registrations and image skew referring to the "Copy Adjustments" in the section of the "Replacements and Adjustments". D129/D130 2-32 SM 1-Bin Tray Unit Installation (D632) 2.8 1-BIN TRAY UNIT INSTALLATION (D632) 2.8.1 COMPONENT CHECK No. SM Description Installation Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list. Q’ty 1 1 Bin Tray Unit 1 2 End-fence 1 3 Tray Support Bar 1 4 Screws (M3 x 16) 2 5 Screws (M3 x 8) 1 6 Harness Cover 1 7 Tray 1 2-33 D129/D130 1-Bin Tray Unit Installation (D632) 2.8.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure. If the bridge unit (D634) or side tray (D635) has already been installed in the machine, remove it before installing 1-bin tray unit (D632). This will make it easier for you to do the following procedure. 1. Remove all tapes. 2. Open the right door of the machine. 3. Remove the front right cover ( p.4-6). 4. Remove the paper exit cover ( p.4-8). Keep the screw removed in step 4 for step 5. x 1, x 1 [This screw was removed in step 4]). 5. Install the 1 bin tray unit [A] ( 6. Attach the tray support bar [A] to the tray [B] as shown, and then attach the end-fence [C]. D129/D130 2-34 SM Installation 1-Bin Tray Unit Installation (D632) 7. Install the tray [A] with the tray support bar in the machine (M3 x 16: 8. Connect the harness to the connector of the 1-bin tray unit ( 9. Attach the harness cover [A] ( x 2). x 1). x 1; M3 x 8). 10. Reinstall the front right cover on the machine, and then close the right door of the machine. 11. Turn on the main power switch of the machine. 12. Check the 1-bin tray unit operation. SM 2-35 D129/D130 Bridge Unit Installation (D634) 2.9 BRIDGE UNIT INSTALLATION (D634) 2.9.1 COMPONENT CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list. No. Description Q’ty 1 Bridge Unit 1 2 Frame Cover 1 3 Knob Screw 1 4 Long Knob Screw 1 5 Holder Bracket Cover 1 6 Guide 2 D129/D130 2-36 SM Bridge Unit Installation (D634) Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure. If you will install the 1-bin tray (D632) on the machine, install the 1-bin tray first before installing the bridge unit (D634). This makes it easy to do the following procedure. If you will install the finisher unit (D588, D636 or D637) on the machine, install it after installing the bridge unit (D634). 1. Remove all tapes. 2. If the sensor feeler [A] is out, fold it into the machine. 3. Open the right door of the machine. 4. Remove the upper inner tray [A]. 5. Remove the front right cover [B] ( x 1). 6. Remove the connector cover [C] ( x 1). SM 2-37 D129/D130 Installation 2.9.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE Bridge Unit Installation (D634) 7. Attach the two guides [A] to the cutouts [B] in the inner tray. 1) Place the lower hook of the guide in the cutout of the paper exit. 2) Attach the guide as shown until the two side hooks hold the paper exit. 3) Press the guide. 4) Press down the guide as shown. D129/D130 2-38 SM Installation Bridge Unit Installation (D634) 8. Install the bridge unit [A] in the machine. 9. Secure the bridge unit with the long knob screw [A] and knob screw [B]. 10. Attach the frame cover [C]. 11. Reinstall the front right cover on the machine, and then close the right door of the machine. Open the bridge unit cover [D] when installing the front right cover. Otherwise, you cannot reinstall it. 12. Install the optional finisher (refer to the finisher installation procedure). SM 2-39 D129/D130 Bridge Unit Installation (D634) Holder bracket [E] is used in the installation procedure of the finisher (D588, D636 or D637). Do not install it at this time. 13. Pull out the extension tray [A] only if the 1000-sheet finisher (D588) will be installed on the main machine. 14. Turn on the main power switch of the machine. 15. Check the bridge unit operation. D129/D130 2-40 SM 3000/2000-sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637) 2.10 3000/2000-SHEET (BOOKLET) FINISHER (D636/D637) 2.10.1 ACCESSORY CHECK No. SM Description Installation Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list. Q'ty 1 Rear joint bracket 1 2 Front joint bracket 1 3 Ground (earth) plate 1 4 Tapping screws - M4 x14 4 5 Tapping screws - M3 x 8 1 6 Tapping screws - M3 x 6 6 7 Upper output tray 1 8 Support Tray 1 9 Lower output tray (D637 only) 1 10 Cushion (with double-sided tape) 1 11 Small Ground (earth) plate 2 2-41 D129/D130 3000/2000-sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637) 2.10.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure. If this finisher is installed on this machine, the following options must be installed before installing this finisher. Bridge Unit (D634) Paper Feed Unit (D580) or LCIT (D581) 1. Unpack the finisher and remove all tapes and packing materials from the finisher. 2. Open the front door, and then remove all tapes and packing materials from the inside of the finisher. D129/D130 2-42 SM Installation 3000/2000-sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637) 3. Pull out the jogger unit [A], and then remove all tapes and retainers. 4. Attach the cushion [A] to the finisher. Make sure that the cushion is placed within 0 to 1 mm from the edge of the cover. 5. Install the ground plate [B] on the finisher ( 6. Install the small ground plates [C] on the finisher( SM x 2; M3 x 6). 2-43 x 2; M3 x 6 each). D129/D130 3000/2000-sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637) x 2; M4 x 14). 7. Attach the rear joint bracket [A] ( 8. Attach the front joint bracket [B] and the holder bracket [C] ( x 2; M4 x 14). Holder bracket [C] must be placed outside the front joint bracket [B]. This bracket is provided with the Bridge Unit (D634). 9. Pull the lock lever [A] ( x 1). 10. Slowly push the finisher to the left side of the machine, keeping its front door open until the brackets [B] [C] go into their slots. 11. Push the lock lever [A], and then secure it ( x 1). 12. Close the front door of the finisher. 13. Connect the finisher connector [D] to the machine. D129/D130 2-44 SM Installation 3000/2000-sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637) 14. Install the upper output tray [A] ( x 1; M3 x 8). 15. Only for D637, install the lower output tray [B]. 16. Turn on the main power switch of the machine. 17. Check the finisher operation. Support Tray Installation If a stacking problem occurs several times on the upper output tray [A], put the support tray [B] on the tray as shown. SM Keep this tray in the manual pocket if this tray does not need to be installed. 2-45 D129/D130 Punch Unit Installation (D570) 2.11 PUNCH UNIT INSTALLATION (D570) The Punch Unit D570 can be installed in the 3000/2000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher D636/D637. 2.11.1 COMPONENT CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list. No. Description Q'ty 1 Punch-out Waste Unit 1 2 Slide Drive Unit 1 3 Punch Waste Hopper 1 4 Wire harness: short-circuit 1 5 Screws (M3 x 6) 5 6 Side-to-Side Detection Unit 1 7 Punching Unit 1 D129/D130 2-46 SM Punch Unit Installation (D570) 2.11.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure. If the 2000/3000-sheet booklet finisher has been installed, disconnect it and pull it away from Installation the machine. 1. Remove all tapes and shipping retainers. 2. If the finisher is connected to the copier, disconnect the power connector [A] and separate the finisher from the copier. 3. Remove the rear cover [B] ( x 2) and open the front door. At the base of the back cover, be sure to disconnect the tabs that fasten the cover to the frame. 4. SM Remove the guide plate [C] ( x 2). 2-47 D129/D130 Punch Unit Installation (D570) x 2) from the punch unit. 5. Remove the shipping retainer [A] ( 6. Move the punch unit [A] along its rails into the finisher. Make sure that the pin engages correctly at the front and rear. 7. Connect the cables [B] of the finisher to the connectors (CN601 and CN602) on the punch unit board ( x 2, x 1). The cables [B] are coiled and attached to the PCB. D129/D130 2-48 SM Installation Punch Unit Installation (D570) 8. Attach the slide drive unit [A] to the finisher and connect it to the punch unit ( Push in the slide drive unit at 9. when you attach the screw x 2, x 1). . Make sure that the punch unit moves freely and is not blocked by the screws. 10. Put the side-to-side detection unit [A] in the machine. Make sure that the two pins are engaged correctly at the front. 11. Make sure that the side-to-side detection unit moves smoothly on its rails. If it does not, make sure that the rails are aligned with their grooves. 12. Attach the side-to-side detection unit and connect it at the rear ( x 2, x 1, x 1). 13. Pull the short connector out of the connector [B], then connect the cable of the finisher ( x 1). SM 2-49 D129/D130 Punch Unit Installation (D570) This is the 3-pin connector. 14. Connect "Wire harness: short-circuit" [A] to the CN110 connector. 15. At the front, use a pair of wire cutters to remove the part [A] of the cover. 16. Install the punch-waste transport unit [B] in the finisher. 17. Make sure that the punch-waste transport unit moves smoothly on its rails. If it does not, make sure that the rails are aligned with the grooves. 18. Remove the short connector from the connector [C]. D129/D130 2-50 SM Punch Unit Installation (D570) This is the 4-pin connector. 19. Connect the cable to connector [C] and attach the punch-waste transport unit ( x x 1). Installation 1, x 1, 20. Set the hopper [A] in its holder. 21. Reassemble the finisher, and then install it on the main machine. 22. Connect the power cord to the outlet, and then turn the main power switch on. 23. Check the punch unit operation. SM 2-51 D129/D130 Platen Cover (D593) 2.12 PLATEN COVER (D593) 1. Install screws [1] ( 2. Position the platen cover bracket [2] on the heads of the stud screws, and slide the platen x 2) on the top cover as shown. cover [3] to the left. D129/D130 2-52 SM 1000-sheet Finisher (D588) 2.13 1000-SHEET FINISHER (D588) 2.13.1 ACCESSORY CHECK No. SM Description Q'ty For this model 1 Grounding Plate 1 Yes 2 Rear Joint Bracket 1 Not used 3 Front Joint Bracket 1 Yes 4 Rear Joint Bracket 1 Yes 5 Copy Tray 1 Yes 6 Screw - M3 x 8 1 Yes 7 Screw - M4 x 13 4 Yes 8 Knob Screw - M3 x 8 1 Yes 9 Knob Screw - M4 x 10 1 Yes 10 Screw - M4 x 25 3 Not used 11 Staple Position Decal 1 Yes 2-53 Installation Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list. D129/D130 1000-sheet Finisher (D588) 2.13.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure. If this finisher is installed, the Bridge Unit (D634) and Paper Feed Unit (D580) or LCT (D581) must be installed before installing this finisher. 1. Unpack the finisher and remove the tapes. D129/D130 Be sure to keep screw [A]. It will be needed to secure the grounding plate in step 3. 2-54 SM Installation 1000-sheet Finisher (D588) 2. Install the rear joint bracket [A] ( x 2; M4 x 13) and front joint bracket [B] ( x 2; M4 x 13). Holder bracket [C] must be placed outside the front joint bracket [B]. This bracket is provided with the Bridge Unit (D634). 3. SM Install the grounding plate [A] on the finisher ( 2-55 x 2; M3 x 8) D129/D130 1000-sheet Finisher (D588) Use the screw removed in step 1 and the screw from the accessory box. 4. Open the front door [B]. Then pull the locking lever [C]. 5. Align the finisher on the joint brackets, and lock it in place by pushing the locking lever. 6. Secure the locking lever ( 7. Install the copy tray [D] ( 8. Connect the finisher cable [E] to the main machine as shown above. 9. Attach the staple position decal [A] to the ARDF as shown. x 1; knob M3 x 8) and close the front door. x 1; knob M4 x 10). 10. Turn on the main power switch and check the finisher operation. D129/D130 2-56 SM Side Tray (D635) 2.14 SIDE TRAY (D635) 2.14.1 COMPONENT CHECK No. Description Q’ty 1 Side Tray Unit 1 2 Sub Output Tray 1 3 Main Output Tray 1 4 Screw 1 5 Knob Screw 1 6 Frame Cover 1 7 Holder Bracket Cover 1 8 Guide 1 SM Installation Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list. 2-57 D129/D130 Side Tray (D635) 2.14.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE Turn off the main switch of the copier and unplug the power cord before you start the installation procedure. If you will install the 1-bin tray (D632) on the machine, install the 1-bin tray first before installing the side tray (D635). This makes it easier to do the following procedure. 1. Remove all tapes. 2. If the sensor feeler [A] is out, fold it into the machine. 3. Open the right door of the machine. 4. Remove the inner tray [A]. 5. Remove the front right cover [B] ( x 1). 6. Remove the connector cover [C] ( x 1). D129/D130 2-58 SM Installation Side Tray (D635) 7. Attach the two guides [A] to the cutouts [B] in the inner tray. 1) Place the lower hook of the guide in the cutout of the paper exit. 2) Attach the guide as shown until the two side hooks hold the paper exit. 3) Press the guide. 4) Press down the guide as shown. SM 2-59 D129/D130 Side Tray (D635) 8. Attach the main output tray [A] and sub output tray [B] to the side tray unit. 9. Install the side tray unit [A] in the machine. 10. Open the side tray cover [A]. 11. Secure the side tray unit with the knob screw [B]. 12. Attach the frame cover [C]. 13. Reinstall the front right cover on the machine, and then close the right door of the machine. D129/D130 2-60 SM Side Tray (D635) Open the side tray cover [A] when installing the front right cover. Otherwise, you cannot reinstall it. 14. Install the holder bracket [D] ( x 1). 15. Turn on the main power switch of the machine. Installation 16. Check the side tray operation. SM 2-61 D129/D130 Internal Shift Tray (D633) 2.15 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY (D633) 2.15.1 COMPONENT CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list. No. Description Q’ty 1 Shift Tray Unit 1 2 Paper Guide - Small 2 3 Connector Cover 1 2.15.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure. 1. Remove all tapes. 2. Remove the standard tray [A]. D129/D130 2-62 SM Internal Shift Tray (D633) Remove the inner cover [B] ( x 1). 4. Install the small paper guides [A]. 5. Attach the connector cover [A] to the shift tray unit [B]. 6. Install the shift tray unit [B] in the machine. 7. Push down the left edge [C] of the shift tray. 8. Turn on the main power switch of the machine. 9. Check the shift tray unit operation. Installation 3. SM 2-63 D129/D130 Key Counter Installation 2.16 KEY COUNTER INSTALLATION 2.16.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Hold the key counter plate nuts [1] on the inside of the key counter bracket [2] and insert the key counter holder [3]. 2. Secure the key counter holder to the bracket ( 3. Install the key counter cover [4] ( 4. Rear cover [5] ( D129/D130 x 2). x 2). x 5) 2-64 SM Installation Key Counter Installation 5. Cut off the part [6] of the rear cover. 6. Connect the harness to CN211 [7] on the IOB ( 7. Peel off the double-sided tape on the key counter bracket and attach the key counter to the x 3). scanner right cover [8]. 8. SM Reassemble the machine. 2-65 D129/D130 Key Counter Interface Unit Installation 2.17 KEY COUNTER INTERFACE UNIT INSTALLATION 2.17.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Rear cover [1] ( 2. Install the key counter interface board in the location [2] ( 3. Connect the harness to CN3 on the key counter interface board. 4. Connect the other terminal of the harness to CN214 [3] on the IOB ( D129/D130 x 6) 2-66 x 4). x 3). SM Installation Key Counter Interface Unit Installation 5. Cut off the part [4] of the rear cover. 6. Connect the harness from the counter device to CN4 on the key counter interface board and clamp it with three clamps [5]. 7. SM Reassemble the machine. 2-67 D129/D130 Tray Heater 2.18 TRAY HEATER 2.18.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Remove trays 1 and 2 from the machine. 2. Connect the connector [1] of the heater to the connector [2] of the main machine. 3. Install the heater [3] inside the machine ( 4. Remove the connector cover [4] ( D129/D130 x 1). x 1). 2-68 SM Installation Tray Heater 5. Release the heater relay connector [5] ( 6. Connect the heater relay connector to the connector [6] (front side) of the main frame ( x 1). x 1). 7. SM Reassemble the machine. 2-69 D129/D130 Tray Heater (Optional Paper Feed Unit) 2.19 TRAY HEATER (OPTIONAL PAPER FEED UNIT) 2.19.1 COMPONENT CHECK No. Description Q'ty 1 Tray heater 1 2 On-standby decal 1 3 Harness 2 1 4 Harness 1 1 5 Screw M4 x 10 2 - Installation procedure 1 D129/D130 2-70 SM Tray Heater (Optional Paper Feed Unit) 2.19.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure. 1. Pull out the two trays from the optional paper feed unit. 2. Install the tray heater [1] in the optional paper feed unit ( 3. Remove the two securing brackets [2] ( optional paper feed unit ( SM Installation For installing the tray heater in the D580 (Two-tray paper feed unit) x 1). x 1 each), and then the rear cover [3] of the x 2). 2-71 D129/D130 Tray Heater (Optional Paper Feed Unit) 4. Connect the harness [4] to the connector [5] of the tray heater. 5. Route the harness [4] as shown and clamp it with four clamps ( 6. Connect the harness [4] to the connector [6] of the mainframe. 7. Remove the connector cover [7] ( 8. Release the optional heater relay connector [8] ( 9. Connect the optional heater relay connector to the connector [9] (rear side) of the main frame ( D129/D130 x 4). x 1). x 1). x 1). 2-72 SM Tray Heater (Optional Paper Feed Unit) 10. Reassemble the mainframe and optional paper feed unit. For installing the tray heater in the D581 (LCT) Remove the rear cover of the mainframe ( 2. Pull out the LCT drawer. x 6). If the right tray comes out with the left tray, push the right tray into the LCT. 3. Left tray [1] ( 4. Remove the right tray [2] while pressing down the stopper [3]. x 2) When reinstalling the right tray, set the right tray on the guide rail and carefully push the tray in, making sure to keep the tray level. SM 2-73 D129/D130 Installation 1. Tray Heater (Optional Paper Feed Unit) 5. Install the tray heater [4] in the optional LCT ( 6. Remove the two securing brackets [5] ( optional LCT ( x 1). x 1 each), and then the rear cover [6] of the x 2). 7. Connect the harness [7] to the connector [8] of the tray heater. 8. Route the harness [7] as shown and clamp it with four clamps ( D129/D130 2-74 x 4). SM Tray Heater (Optional Paper Feed Unit) 9. Connect the harness [7] to the connector [9] of the mainframe. Installation 10. Reassemble the rear cover of the optional LCT. 11. Remove the connector cover [10] ( x 1). 12. Release the optional heater relay connector [11] ( x 1). 13. Connect the optional heater relay connector to the connector [12] (rear side) of the main frame ( x 1). 14. Reassemble the mainframe and optional LCT. SM 2-75 D129/D130 HDD Installation (D640-11) 2.20 HDD INSTALLATION (D640-11) 2.20.1 COMPONENT CHECK No. Description Q'ty 1 HDD Unit 1 2 Connecting Board Unit 1 3 Screw - M3 x 6 5 4 Harness 1 1 5 Harness 2 1 D129/D130 2-76 SM HDD Installation (D640-11) Installation 2.20.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Remove the controller board unit [A] ( 2. Connect the two harnesses to the HDD unit [A] ( 3. Install the connecting board unit [A] on the HDD unit [B] ( SM x 2). 2-77 x 2). x 2). D129/D130 HDD Installation (D640-11) 4. Connect the two harnesses from the HDD unit to the connecting board [A] ( 5. Install the HDD unit [A] on the controller board unit ( 6. Reinstall the controller board unit in the machine. x 2). x 3). After Installing the HDD 1. Do SP5832-001 to format the hard disk. 2. Do SP5853-001 to copy the preset stamp data from the firmware to the hard disk. 3. Do SP5846-040 to copy the address book to the hard disk from the controller board. 4. Do SP5846-041 to let the user get access to the address book. 5. Turn the main power switch off/on. D129/D130 2-78 SM Copy Data Security Unit (B829) 2.21 COPY DATA SECURITY UNIT (B829) No. SM Description Q’ty For this model 1 Bracket 1 1 Yes 2 ICIB-3 1 Yes 3 Flexible cable: Long 1 Not used 4 Flexible cable: Short 1 Not used 5 Harness with bands 1 Not used 6 Harness 1 Not used 7 Small Bracket 1 Not used 8 Saddle Clamp 1 Not used 9 Screws: M3x6 6 Yes 10 Screws: M3x4 2 Yes 11 Bracket 2 1 Not used 2-79 Installation 2.21.1 COMPONENT CHECK D129/D130 Copy Data Security Unit (B829) 2.21.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure. p.4-4) 1. Rear cover ( 2. Controller unit ( p.4-95) 3. Controller box ( p.4-101 "Mother Board") 4. Attach bracket 1 [A] to the ICIB-3 [B] ( D129/D130 x 2; M3 x 4). 2-80 SM Installation Copy Data Security Unit (B829) 5. Connect the ICIB-3 with bracket 1 [A] to CN 505 on the IPU ( 6. Reassemble the machine. x 2; M3 x 6). User Tool Setting 1. Plug in and turn on the main power switch. 2. Go into the User Tools mode, and select System Settings > Administrator Tools > Data Security for Copying > "On". 3. Exit the User Tools. 4. Check the operation. The machine will issue an SC165 error if the machine is powered on with the ICIB-1 removed and the "Data Security for Copying" feature is set to "ON". When you remove this option from the machine, first set the setting to "OFF" with the user tool before removing this board. If you forget to do this, "Data Security for Copying" feature cannot appear in the user tool settings. And then SC165 will appear every time the machine is switched on, and the machine cannot be used. SM 2-81 D129/D130 Copy Data Security Unit (B829) Check All Connections Make sure that the machine can recognize the option. 1. Plug in the power cord. 2. Turn on the main switch. 3. Enter the printer user mode. Then print the configuration page. User Tools > Printer Features > List Test Print > Configuration Page 4. All installed options are shown sin the "System Reference" column. D129/D130 2-82 SM Browser Unit Type I Rev. 04/20/2012 ⇒ 2.22 BROWSER UNIT TYPE I 2.22.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Turn the main switch ON. 2. Press the “User Tools/Counter” key. 3. On the touch panel, press “System Settings”. 4. Make sure that the “Increase Scanner Memory by Disabling Browser” setting in the General Features tab is OFF. 5. Turn the main switch OFF. 6. Remove the control cover [A] (screws x 2). 7. Insert the Browser Option SD card in the lower slot [A]. 8. Turn the main switch ON. 9. Touch the “User Tools/Counter” key. SM 2-83 D129/D130 Installation Use the following procedure to install the Browser Unit Type I. Browser Unit Type I Rev. 04/20/2012 10. On the touch panel, touch “Extended Feature settings”. 11. Touch “Extended Feature settings” in the Extended Feature Settings Menu. 12. Make sure that “Extended JS” application was automatically installed in the Startup Settings tab. 13. Turn the main switch OFF/ON. 14. Move the application to the SD card that is installed to slot 1. 15. Note: See the Service Manual for details on merging SD Applications. D129/D130 2-84 SM Browser Unit Type I Rev. 04/20/2012 Installation 16. Press the “User Tools/Counter” key. 17. Touch “Edit home”. 18. Touch “Add Icon”. 19. Touch “Browse”. 20. Touch a blank square to set the location for the browser icon. 21. Touch “Exit” to complete the addition of the FAX browser icon. SM 2-85 D129/D130 Browser Unit Type I Rev. 04/20/2012 2.22.2 DO THE FOLLOWING STEPS IF THE CUSTOMER IS USING THE RICOH JAVASCRIPT CONNECTED TO A WEB APPLICATION DEVELOPED BY OPERIUS/RIDP. 1. Turn the main switch ON. 2. Press the “User Tools/Counter” key. 3. On the touch panel, touch “Browser Features”. 4. Touch “JavaScript”. 5. Change the Extended JavaScript setting to “Active”. D129/D130 2-86 SM Browser Unit Type I Rev. 04/20/2012 2.22.3 EXJS FIRMWARE UPDATE PROCEDURE Note: z The firmware configuration of the Browser Unit Type I has been changed to enhance browsing. firmware is equivalent to the existing browser firmware. Therefore, it is possible to update the EXJS firmware using the same procedure as that of SDK application firmware. z Both the Browser firmware and EXJS firmware are automatically installed when the Browser SD card is inserted in the upper slot. Preparation: 1. Download the latest EXJS firmware from the RISSN server. 2. Extract the exe file (XXXX. exe), after which the following two files are generated: XXXX_machine. exe/ XXXX_stock.exe. Note: The file (XXXX_machine) is for updating the EXJS firmware in the field. 3. Extract the file (XXXX_machine), after which the “SDK” folder is created. 4. Copy the “SDK” folder to an SD card. Note: XXXX = part number. Main procedure: 1. SM Remove the control cover [A] (screws x 2). 2-87 D129/D130 Installation z The Browser Unit Type I consists of the Browser firmware and EXJS firmware. The EXJS Browser Unit Type I Rev. 04/20/2012 2. Insert the SD card included for firmware update into the lower slot [A]. 3. Turn the main switch ON. 4. After the Update screen is displayed, select the “Browser”. 5. Touch “Update (#)”. 6. After the "Update Done" message appears on the screen, turn the main power switch OFF. 7. Remove the SD card from the lower slot. Do the following steps if you are updating the Extended JavaScript. 8. Turn the main switch ON. 9. Press the “User Tools/Counter” key. 10. On the touch panel, touch “Extended Feature settings”. 11. Touch “Extended Feature settings” in the Extended Feature Settings Menu. 12. Change the status of “Extended JS” to “Ending” in the Startup Settings tab. 13. Turn the main switch OFF. 14. Insert the SD card containing the Extended JS firmware into the lower slot. 15. Turn the main switch ON. 16. Press the “User Tools/Counter” key. D129/D130 2-88 SM Browser Unit Type I Rev. 04/20/2012 17. On the touch panel, push “Extended Feature settings”. Installation 18. Touch “Extended Feature settings” in the Extended Feature Settings Menu. 19. Touch the “Install” tab. 20. Touch “SD card”, then select “Extended JS” from the list of Extended Features. 21. Select “Machine HDD” as the “Install to” destination, then touch “Next”. 22. Check the Extended Features information on the “Ready to Install” screen, then press “OK”. SM 2-89 D129/D130 Browser Unit Type I Rev. 04/20/2012 23. After “The following extended feature has already been installed. Are you sure you want to overwrite it?” is displayed, press “Yes”. 24. Change the status of Extended JS to “waiting” in the Startup Settings tab. 25. Turn the main switch OFF. 26. Remove the SD card from slot 2 (lower slot). 27. Turn the main switch ON. 28. Press the “User Tools/Counter” key. 29. On the touch panel, touch “Extended Feature settings”. 30. Touch “Extended Feature settings” in the Extended Feature settings Menu. 31. Make sure that the “Extended JS” has been updated to the latest version in the Startup Settings tab. 2.22.4 EXJS FIRMWARE UN-INSTALL PROCEDURE 1. Turn the main switch ON. 2. Press the “User Tools/Counter” key. 3. Login with an administrator user name and password. 4. On the touch panel, touch “Extended Feature settings”. 5. Touch “Extended Feature settings” in the Extended Feature Settings Menu. 6. Touch “Extended Feature settings” in the Extended Feature Settings Menu. D129/D130 2-90 SM Browser Unit Type I Installation Rev. 04/20/2012 7. Touch “Uninstall”. 8. Touch “Browser”, and then touch “Yes” after “Are you sure you want to uninstall the following extended feature?” is displayed. Note: “Uninstalling the extended feature... Please wait” is then displayed on the touch screen. 9. After "Completed" is displayed, turn the main power switch OFF Note: The Browser firmware is un-installed from the machine when the Browser SD card is removed. SM 2-91 D129/D130 Card Reader Bracket Type C3352 (D593) Rev. 04/20/2012 2.23 CARD READER BRACKET TYPE C3352 (D593) 2.23.1 COMPONENT CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list. No Description Q'ty For This Model 1 Screw: M3 x 8 5 Yes 2 Screw: M3 x 14 1 Not used 3 Screw: M4 x 25 1 Not used 4 Tapping Screw: M3 x 10 3 Yes 5 Upper Tray 1 Yes 6 Lower Tray 1 Yes 7 Tray Bracket 1 Yes D129/D130 2-92 SM Card Reader Bracket Type C3352 (D593) Rev. 04/20/2012 Installation 2.23.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Attach the tray bracket [A] to the scanner right cover ( [B] x 2: M3x 8 For this model, use the screw holes marked "1" on the table bracket. 2. Attach the lower tray [A] to the tray bracket ( x 2: M3x8). 3. Attach the upper tray [B] to the tray bracket ( x 1: M3x8). 4. Connect the cable to the designated connector (the connector to use depends on the type of device to be connected). SM 2-93 D129/D130 Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31) Rev. 04/23/2012 ⇒ 2.24 FAX CONNECTION UNIT TYPE A (D629-31) (REMOTE FAX) 2.24.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE This unit allows a machine without the FAX unit installed (“Client-side Machine”) to send and receive faxes via a machine with the FAX unit installed (“Remote Machine”). Requirements: Both the Client-side Machine and Remote Machine must have this unit, the Printer unit, and Scanner unit installed. Up to six machines can be registered as the Client-side Machines. Machines that have the FAX unit installed cannot be used as the Client-side Machine. Only machine can be registered as the Remote Machine. Firmware for this unit: “aics” (software number: D6295750) Remote Fax transmissions are possible on a G3 line. The remote fax function does not support User Code Authentication. Disable the User Code Authentication on the Remote machine. Use this function to check the contents of a file that is stored in memory and not yet sent. Also, use this function to cancel a transmission from the Client-side Machine. Before installing this option: Upgrade the machine firmware to the following versions or newer. Firmware P/N Suffix Ver. System/Copy D1295751 F 2.00.3 Network Support D1295754 D 11.77.2 Network DocBox D1295757 D 2.01 Fax D1295753 D 02.03.00 RemoteFax D1295752 D 02.00.00 Websupport D1295755 D 1.11 WebUapl D1295756 D 1.04 JAVA (Standard) D1295735 C 10.03.01 JAVA (Option) D6405750 G 10.03.01 Scanner D1295759 C 01.11 Printer D1295763 C 1.06 PCL D1295762 C 1.08 FCU D6295570 C 02.00.00 D129/D130 2-94 SM Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31) Rev. 04/23/2012 2.24.2 INSTALLING THE APPLICATION Installation On both the Remote Machine and the Client-side Machines: 1. Remove the SD-card slot cover [A] from the SD card slots (Screw x 1) 2. Insert the SD card (Fax Connection Unit Type A) in SD slot 2 (lower) with its label face [B] towards the front of the machine. Then push it slowly into SD slot 2 (lower) until you hear a click. 3. Plug in, and then turn on the machine. 4. Move the Fax Connection Unit Type A application from the SD card in SD slot 2 (lower) to the SD card in SD slot 1 (upper) with SP5-873-001. 5. Turn off the machine. 6. Remove the SD card from SD slot 2 (lower), and then keep it in a safe place (see “SD Card Appli Move” in the manual for the main frame). 7. Attach the SD-card slot cover, and then turn on the machine (x 1) 8. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see ‘Check All Connections’ in the controller option section of the manual for the main frame) SM 2-95 D129/D130 Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31) Rev. 04/23/2012 2.24.3 REGISTERING THE REMOTE MACHINE Only one machine can be registered as the Remote Machine. On the Client-side Machine(s): 1. Press the [User Tools/Counter] key on the operation panel 2. Press [System Settings > Administrator Tools] to select. 3. Press [Program/Delete Remote Machine] to select. 4. Enter the IP address or host name of the Remote Machine. 5. Press [Set] to set after “connection test”. 6. Press [Exit] to exit from the set-up procedure. 2.24.4 REGISTERING THE CLIENT-SIDE MACHINE(S) Up to six machines can be registered as the Client-side Machines. On the Remote Machine: 1. Press the [User Tools/Counter] key on the operation panel 2. Press [Administrator Tools] to select. 3. Press [Program/Delete 4. Enter the IP address or host name of the Client-side Machines. 5. Press [Set] to set after “connection test”. D129/D130 Remote Machine] to select. 2-96 SM Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31) Rev. 04/23/2012 2.24.5 CONFIGURING THE REMOTE RECEPTION SETTINGS Do the following procedure to enable the Client-side Machine(s) to receive faxes via the Remote Machine. You can forward or route received documents per line or special sender or By performing procedures #1-3 above, the Client-side Machines can send faxes via the Remote Machine. The procedures shown below are necessary to enable the Client-side Machines to receive faxes. On the Remote Machine: 1) If you use "Remote Reception Setting per Line" 1. Press [Facsimile Features] to select. 2. Press [Remote Reception Setting per Line] in [Reception Settings] to select. 3. Enter an IP address or a host name of the client-side machine to connect. 4. Press [Set], and [Exit] to exit from the setting. 2) If you use "Remote Reception per Sender" SM 1. Press [Facsimile Features] to select. 2. Press [Program Special Sender] in [Reception Settings] to select. 3. Select the Special Sender. 2-97 D129/D130 Installation box. Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31) Rev. 04/23/2012 4. Press [Remote Reception Setting per Sender] to select. 5. Press [On] and [Remote Machine] to select. 6. Enter an IP address or a host name of the client-side machine to connect. 7. Press [OK] to exit from the setting. D129/D130 2-98 SM Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31) Rev. 04/23/2012 3) If you use "Remote Reception per Box" Press [Facsimile Features] to select. 2. Press [Box Setting] in [General Settings] to select. 3. Select the box. Installation 1. SM 2-99 D129/D130 Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31) Rev. 04/23/2012 4. Press [Personal Box] to select. 5. Enter a dial-in number. 6. Press [Remote Machine] to select. 7. Enter an IP address or a host name of the client-side machine to connect. 8. Press [OK] to exit from the set-up procedure. D129/D130 2-100 SM Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31) Rev. 04/23/2012 2.24.6 REMOTE FAX ICON ADDITION FOR REMOTE MACHINE This procedure allows the remote fax icon to appear on the home screen of the operation panel. SM 1. Press [User Tools]. 2. Press [Edit Home]. 3. Press [Add Icon]. Installation On both the Remote Machine and the Client-side Machines: 2-101 D129/D130 Fax Connection Unit Type A (D629-31) Rev. 04/23/2012 4. Press [Remote Fax]. 5. Press a [Blank] to set a location for the remote fax icon. 6. Press [Exit] to exit from the set-up procedure. D129/D130 2-102 SM PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New None PM Tables 3. PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE 3.1 PM TABLES See "Appendices" for the following information: PM Tables Preventive Maintenance SM 3-1 D129/D130 REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY P a ge 6 ∼ 13 Date A d de d /U pd at e d /N ew 09/11/2012 Updated Operation Panel including LCD 12/27/2012 NVRAM on the BCU board 108 1/4/2013 NVRAM on the BCU board 116 05/16/2012 108 ~ 117 Touch Screen Calibration General Cautions 4. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 4.1 GENERAL CAUTIONS To avoid damage to the transfer belt, drum, or development unit when it is removed or re-installed, never turn off power switch while electrical components are active. Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before attempting any of the procedures in this section. 4.1.1 LASER UNIT 1. Do not loosen the screws that secure the LD drive board to the laser diode casing. Doing so 2. Do not adjust the variable resistors on the LD unit, as they are adjusted in the factory. 3. The polygon mirror and F-theta lenses are very sensitive to dust. Do not open the optical housing unit. 4. Do not touch the glass surface of the polygon mirror motor unit with bare hands. 5. After replacing the LD unit, do the laser beam pitch adjustment. 4.1.2 USED TONER Dispose of used toner in accordance with local regulations. Never throw toner into an open flame, for toner dust may ignite. SM 4-1 D129/D130 Replacement and Adjustment would throw the LD unit out of adjustment. Special Tools and Lubricants 4.2 SPECIAL TOOLS AND LUBRICANTS 4.2.1 SPECIAL TOOLS Part Number Description Q’ty A0069104 Scanner Positioning Pin (4 pc./set) 1 A2929500 Test Chart – S5S (10 pc./set) 1 A2309003 Adjustment Cam – Laser Unit 1 A2309004 Positioning Pin – Laser Unit 1 B6455010 SD Card 1 G0219350 Loop Back Connector 1 4.2.2 LUBRICANTS Part Number Description Q’ty A2579300 Grease Barrierta S552R 1 52039502 Silicone Grease G-501 1 D129/D130 4-2 SM Exterior Covers 4.3 EXTERIOR COVERS 4.3.1 FRONT DOOR, UPPER AND LOWER INNER COVER Left Cover ( p.4-4) 2. Open and remove the front door [A] (pin x 2). Replacement and Adjustment 1. Upper Inner Cover 1. Open the front door [A]. 2. Upper inner cover [B] ( x 2) Lower Inner Cover 1. Remove the front door [A] (pin x 2) 2. Shield glass cover [C] 3. Shield glass [D] ( 4. Lower inner cover [E] SM x 2) 4-3 D129/D130 Exterior Covers 4.3.2 LEFT COVER 1. Left cover [A] ( x 6) 4.3.3 REAR COVER 1. Rear cover [A] ( D129/D130 x 6) 4-4 SM Exterior Covers 4.3.4 RIGHT REAR COVER Rear cover( 2. Open the right door [A]. 3. Scanner right cover [B] ( 4. Right top cover [C] ( 5. Right rear cover [D] ( SM p.4-4) Replacement and Adjustment 1. x 2) x 1) x 4) 4-5 D129/D130 Exterior Covers Rev. 09/11/2012 4.3.5 FRONT RIGHT COVER 1. Open the right door [A]. 2. Front right cover [A] ( ⇒4.3.6 x 1) OPERATION PANEL 1. Front right cover ( 2. Position the operation panel [A] as shown above. 3. Operation panel connector upper cover [B] ( x 1) D129/D130 p.4-6 "Front Right Cover") 4-6 SM Exterior Covers Rev. 09/11/2012 ⇒ 4. Position the operation panel [A] as shown above. 5. Remove the operation panel connector lower cover [B]. 6. Remove the Scanner Left Cover ( 7. Remove the Scanner Right Cover ( Scanner Panels 4.4.2). 8. Remove the Scanner Front Cover ( Scanner Panels 4.4.2). 9. Remove the Grounding Line [A]. [A] 10. Operation panel [A] ( x 4, x 3) SM 4-7 D129/D130 Replacement and Adjustment Scanner Panels 4.4.2). Exterior Covers Rev. 09/11/2012 ⇒ LCD 1. Remove the operation panel cover ( 4.3.6. 2. Remove the rear cover [A] ( x 6). [A] 3. Remove the rear cover [B] together with the hinge [C] ( x 7). [B] [C] 4. Remove the three cables [D]. [D] D129/D130 4-8 SM Exterior Covers Rev. 09/11/2012 ⇒ Important - There are two types of LCDs that use the same part number (D1291420), labeled Type A and Type B below. They are completely interchangeable (0. - However, the harnesses are connected in slightly different locations on the board. Make sure to connect the harnesses in the correct position, depending on the type of LCD. Harness connectors and screws are circled in red for both types. Part Description Type A Type B number D1291420 LCD:TFT: WVGA: Replacement and Adjustment LED:MV 5. Remove the LCDC [E] ( x 6, x 5). 6. Remove the bracket [F] ( x 9). 7. Remove the LCD. Replacing TYPE A: [E] [F] SM 4-9 D129/D130 Exterior Covers Rev. 09/11/2012 ⇒ Replacing TYPE B: [E] [F] 4.3.7 PAPER EXIT COVER 1. Front right cover ( 2. Paper exit cover [A] ( x 1) D129/D130 p.4-6) 4-10 SM Exterior Covers Rev. 09/11/2012 4.3.8 INNER TRAY Left cover ( 2. Upper inner cover ( 3. Paper exit cover ( 4. Connector cover [A] 5. Inner rear cover [A] 6. Inner tray [A] SM p.4-4) p.4-3 "Front Door, Upper and Lower Inner Cover") p.4-8) Replacement and Adjustment 1. 4-11 D129/D130 Scanner Rev. 09/11/2012 4.4 SCANNER 4.4.1 EXPOSURE GLASS 1. Glass cover [A] ( x 2) 2. ARDF exposure glass [B] 3. Rear scale [C] ( x 3) 4. Exposure glass with left scale [D] Position the white marker [E] at the rear-left corner and the black or blue marker at the front-left corner when you reattach the ARDF exposure glass. 4.4.2 SCANNER EXTERIOR PANELS AND OPERATION PANEL Operation panel 1. Remove the Operation Panel ( 4.3.6) Scanner left cover 1. Scanner left cover [A] ( x 3) D129/D130 4-12 SM Scanner Rev. 09/11/2012 Scanner right cover 1. Scanner right cover [A] ( x 2) Scanner front cover Operation panel ( p.4-7) 2. Scanner front cover [A] ( x 2) Replacement and Adjustment 1. Scanner rear cover 1. SM Scanner rear cover [A] ( x 1) 4-13 D129/D130 Scanner 4.4.3 LENS BLOCK ASSEMBLY 1. Exposure glass ( 2. Scanner right cover ( 3. SBU cover [A] ( 4. Original size sensor bracket ( 5. Lens block assembly [A] ( p.4-10) p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel") x 4) p.4-15 "Original Size Sensor") x 4, Grand screw x 1, x 2) Do not remove the other screws on the lens block unit. D129/D130 4-14 SM Scanner When reassembling Adjust the following SP modes after you replace the lens block assembly: SP4–008 (Sub Scan Mag): ( "Scanning" in "Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning") SP4–010 (Sub Mag Reg.): ( "Scanning" in "Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning") SP4–011 (Main Scan Reg): ( SP4–688 (DF: Density Adjustment): Use this to adjust the density level if the ID of outputs "Scanning" in "Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning") made in the DF and Platen mode is different. 4.4.4 ORIGINAL SIZE SENSOR 1. Exposure glass with left scale ( p.4-10 "Exposure Glass") 2. Scanner right cover ( 3. SBU cover ( 4. Remove the screw [A] on the sensor board bracket. 5. Circuit chip [A] ( p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel") Replacement and Adjustment p.4-14 "Lens Block Assembly") SM x 1, x 1) 4-15 D129/D130 Scanner 6. Original size sensor bracket [A] ( 7. Original size sensors [A] (hooks) D129/D130 x 2) 4-16 SM Scanner 4.4.5 EXPOSURE LAMP Before replacing the scanner lamp, check and note the first three digits in the bar-code on the new scanner lamp ( “Chromaticity rank adjustment” in this section). 1. Operation panel ( p.4-7) 2. Exposure glass ( p.4-10) 3. Scanner front cover ( 4. Move the first scanner carriage [A] to the position shown above. 5. Remove the two screws on the scanner lamp [A]. SM p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel") 4-17 Replacement and Adjustment D129/D130 Scanner 6. Disconnect the connector [A] on the scanner lamp. 7. Pull out the scanner lamp [A]. Chromaticity rank adjustment Each scanner lamp has a specific chromaticity rank. The chromaticity rank is indicated by the bar-code on the new scanner lamp. After replacing the lamp, adjust the chromaticity rank to correspond to the new scanner lamp. 1. Check the first three digits [A] in the bar-code on the new scanner lamp before installing the new lamp. D129/D130 4-18 SM Scanner 2. After installing the new lamp, go to SP4-954-005 and enter the SP setting number referring to the table below. SM 139 3 166 12 140 2 167 11 141 1 168 10 142 6 169 15 143 5 170 14 144 4 171 13 145 9 172 18 146 8 173 17 147 7 174 16 148 12 204 3 149 11 205 2 150 10 206 1 151 15 207 6 152 14 208 5 153 13 209 4 154 18 210 9 155 17 211 8 156 16 212 7 157 3 213 12 158 2 214 11 159 1 215 10 160 6 216 15 4-19 Replacement and Adjustment 1st Three Digits SP Setting (SP4-954-005) 1st Three Digits SP Setting (SP4-954-005) D129/D130 Scanner 1st Three Digits SP Setting (SP4-954-005) 1st Three Digits SP Setting (SP4-954-005) 161 5 217 14 162 4 218 13 163 9 219 18 164 8 220 17 165 7 221 16 4.4.6 SCANNER HP SENSOR/PLATEN COVER SENSOR Scanner HP Sensor 1. Scanner rear cover ( 2. Exposure glass ( 3. Move the 1st scanner carriage [A] to the right side. 4. Remove the mylar [A]. D129/D130 p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel") p.4-10) 4-20 SM Scanner 5. Remove the scanner HP sensor [A] ( x 1, three snaps) Platen Cover Sensor Scanner rear cover ( 2. Platen cover sensor [A] ( p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel") Replacement and Adjustment 1. SM x 1, x 1) 4-21 D129/D130 Scanner 4.4.7 SCANNER MOTOR 1. Scanner rear cover ( 2. Remove the 8 screws of the scanner rear frame [A]. 3. Disconnect the two connectors. D129/D130 p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel") 4-22 SM Scanner 4. Pull over the scanner rear stay [A] and remove it ( 5. Scanner motor bracket [A] ( x 1) 6. Scanner motor [A] ( x 1, spring x 1, belt x 1) x 3). Replacement and Adjustment x 2, x 2, After replacing the scanner motor, do the image adjustments in the following section of the manual ( SM "Scanning" in "Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning"). 4-23 D129/D130 Scanner 4.4.8 SCANNER MOTOR DRIVE BOARD 1. Scanner rear cover ( 2. Scanner rear stay. ( 3. SIO [A] ( x 4, p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel") p.4-22 "Scanner Motor") x All) 4.4.9 FRONT SCANNER WIRE 1. Scanner front cover ( 2. Scanner left cover ( p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel") 3. Scanner left stay [A] ( x 3) 4. Scanner left rail frame [B]. D129/D130 p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel") 4-24 SM Scanner x 5, x 1) Operation panel stay [A] ( 6. Scanner front stay [A] ( 7. To make reassembly easy, slide the 1st scanner carriage to the right. Replacement and Adjustment 5. SM x 5) 4-25 D129/D130 Scanner 8. Front scanner wire clamp [A] 9. Front scanner wire bracket [B] ( x 1) 10. Front scanner wire and scanner drive pulley [C] ( x 1) Reassembling the Front Scanner Wire 1. Position the center ball [A] in the middle of the forked holder. 2. Pass the right end (with the ball) [B] through the square hole. Pass the left end (with the ring) [C] through the notch. 3. Wind the right end counterclockwise (shown from the machine’s front) five times. Wind the left end clockwise twice. The two red marks [D] come together when you have done this. Stick the wire to the pulley with tape. This lets you easily handle the assembly at the time of installation. D129/D130 4-26 SM Scanner Install the drive pulley on the shaft [E]. 5. Do not attach the pulley to the shaft with the screw at this time. Insert the left end into the slit [F]. The end should go via the rear track of the left pulley [G] and the rear track of the movable pulley [H]. 6. Hook the right end onto the front scanner wire bracket [I]. The end should go via the front track of the right pulley [J] and the front track of the movable pulley [K]. SM Do not attach the scanner wire bracket with the screw at this time. 4-27 D129/D130 Replacement and Adjustment 4. Scanner 7. Remove the tape from the drive pulley. 8. Insert a scanner-positioning pin [L] through the 2nd carriage hole [M] and the left holes [N] in the front rail. Insert another scanner positioning pin [O] through the 1st carriage hole [P] and the right holes in the front rail [Q]. 9. Insert two more scanner positioning pins through the holes in the rear rail. 10. Screw the drive pulley to the shaft [R]. 11. Screw the scanner wire bracket to the front rail [S]. 12. Install the scanner wire clamp [T]. 13. Pull out the positioning pins. Make sure the 1st and 2nd carriages move smoothly after you remove the positioning pins. Do steps 8 through 13 again if they do not. After replacing the scanner wire, do the image adjustments in the following section of the manual ( D129/D130 "Scanning" in "Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning"). 4-28 SM Scanner 4.4.10 REAR SCANNER WIRE 1. Scanner front cover ( p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel") 2. Scanner left cover ( 3. Scanner left stay ( 4. Scanner left rail frame ( 5. Scanner rear cover ( 6. Scanner rear stay ( 7. Rear rail frame [A] ( 8. SIO ( 9. To make reassembly easy, slide the first scanner to the center. p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel") p.4-24 "Front Scanner Wire") p.4-24 "Front Scanner Wire") p.4-11 "Scanner Exterior Panels and Operation Panel") Replacement and Adjustment p.4-22 "Scanner Motor") x 5) p.4-24 "Scanner Motor Drive Board") 10. Rear scanner wire clamp [B] 11. Rear scanner wire bracket [C] ( 12. Scanner motor gear [D] ( x 1) x 1) 13. Rear scanner wire and scanner drive pulley [E] ( SM 4-29 x 1) D129/D130 Scanner Reassembling the Rear Scanner Wire 1. Position the center ball [B] in the middle of the forked holder. 2. Pass the end with the ball [A] through the right square hole from the front. 3. Position the center ball [B] in the middle of the notch, as shown by the arrow. 4. Pass the ball end [A] through the drive pulley notch. 5. Wind the end with the ring [C] clockwise (shown from the machine’s front) three times; wind the ball end [A] clockwise (shown from the machine’s front) five times. 6. The two red marks [D] should meet when you have done this. Stick the wire to the pulley with tape, so you can easily handle the pulley and wire during installation. 7. Install the drive pulley on the shaft. 8. Do not screw the pulley onto the shaft yet. Install the wire. The winding of the wire on the three pulleys at the rear of the scanner should be the same as the winding on the three pulleys at the front. This must show as a mirror image. Example: At the front of the machine, the side of the drive pulley with the three windings must face the front of the machine. At the rear of the machine, it must face the rear. 9. Perform steps 8 through 13 in “Reassembling the Front Scanner Wire”. After replacing the scanner wire, do the image adjustments in the following section of the manual ( D129/D130 "Scanning" in "Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning"). 4-30 SM Laser Unit 4.5 LASER UNIT Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before attempting any of the procedures in this section. Laser beams can seriously damage your eyes. 4.5.1 CAUTION DECAL LOCATIONS Two caution decals are located in the laser section as shown below. (See the next page for Replacement and Adjustment removal instructions.) 4.5.2 LASER UNIT 1. Open the front door. 2. Front door [A] (pins x 2) SM 4-31 D129/D130 Laser Unit 3. Upper inner cover [B] ( 4. Glass cap [C] 5. Shield glass [D] 6. Lower inner cover [E] ( 7. Laser unit connectors [E] ( x 2) x 2) x 3, x 1) Do not disconnect the harnesses on the LD board [F] unless the LD unit has to be replaced. This board is precisely adjusted in the factory. 8. Laser unit [G] ( D129/D130 x 2) When sliding out the laser unit, do not hold the LD board. Hold the laser unit. 4-32 SM Laser Unit 4.5.3 POLYGON MIRROR MOTOR Laser unit ( 2. Laser unit cover [A] ( 3. Polygon mirror motor [B] ( 4. After replacing the polygon mirror motor, do the image adjustment ( x 4) x 4, x 1) p.4-108 "Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning"). 4.5.4 LASER SYNCHRONIZATION DETECTOR 1. Laser unit ( 2. Laser synchronization detector [A] ( SM p.4-31) x1, x1) 4-33 D129/D130 Replacement and Adjustment p.4-31) 1. Laser Unit 4.5.5 LD UNIT 1. Laser unit ( 2. Upper spring plate [A] ( x 1) 3. Lower spring plate [B] ( x 1) 4. LD unit [C] ( p.4-31) x 1, x1, spring x 1) To avoid damaging the LD board, hold it securely when disconnecting the connectors. Hold the laser unit casing. 5. After replacing the LD board, do the "Laser Beam Pitch Adjustment" (described in the following section). Keep the lower inner cover removed before doing this adjustment because you need to adjust the adjustor screw [D] on the LD unit with a screwdriver. Laser Beam Pitch Adjustment 1. Install a (new) LD unit [A] with the left side of the LD unit being lower than the right side. (This makes this adjustment easier.) D129/D130 4-34 SM Laser Unit 2. Print the test pattern "Hounds Tooth Check (2-Dot Horizontal)" (No. 16 in SP2109-001). 3. Check if the vertical stripes appear on the second pattern (counted from the leading edge) of the printout. 4. Correct: No vertical stripes appear (see the sample following this procedure.) Wrong: Vertical stripes appear (see the sample following this procedure.) Turn the adjustor screw [B] by 90 degrees clockwise (counterclockwise). If the image of the printout is getting worse, try reverse rotation (clockwise counterclockwise) 5. Print the test pattern and check it out. 6. Try steps 2 to 4 again until you get an image with no vertical stripes. 7. Reassemble the machine after completing this adjustment. Replacement and Adjustment Correct: No vertical stripes appear SM 4-35 D129/D130 Laser Unit Incorrect: Vertical stripes appear D129/D130 4-36 SM PCDU 4.6 PCDU 4.6.1 PCDU (PHOTOCONDUCTOR AND DEVELOPMENT UNIT) Open the front door. 2. Open the right door [A]. 3. Release the lock lever [B]. 4. Pull out the PCDU [C] and place it on a clean flat surface. 5. Spread a large piece of paper on a flat surface. Replacement and Adjustment 1. Make sure the area is free of pins, paper clips, staples, etc. to avoid attraction to the magnetic development roller. Reinstallation Open the right cover before you install the PCDU in the machine. SM 4-37 D129/D130 PCDU 4.6.2 DRUM 1. Remove the PCDU ( 2. Toner cap [A] 3. Insert cap [A] into the opening of the PCDU [B]. 4. Make sure that the cap is inserted completely into the opening. Open the PCDU [C] ( D129/D130 p.4-37) x 2). 4-38 SM PCDU 5. Bracket [D] ( x 1) 6. Pull the drum [E] towards the front (the left side in the illustration) while releasing the charge roller [F] using the release levers . Never touch the drum surface with bare hands. Replacement and Adjustment [G], and then remove the drum Re-installation 1. Replace the drum and close the PCDU ( 2. Put the opening cap [A in the previous procedure] back in its original place. 3. After replacing the drum, do these SPs: SM x 2). SP 2001: Charge Bias Setting – make sure that this is at the default setting SP 3001-2: P Sensor Initial Setting (P sensor = ID Sensor) SP 2805: Process Setting SP 2810-1: Grayscale Setting 4-39 D129/D130 PCDU 4.6.3 PICK-OFF PAWLS 1. Drum ( p.4-38) 2. Pawl assembly [A] 3. Pick-off pawl [B] (spring x 1, spur x 1) Pick-off Pawl Position Adjustment If the pick-off pawl has marked the drum with a line, the pick-off pawl position can be adjusted using either method: Changing the spur position Changing the pick-off pawl assembly position D129/D130 4-40 SM PCDU 4.6.4 CHARGE ROLLER AND CLEANING ROLLER 1. Drum ( p.4-38) 2. Push the charge roller holder [A] toward the front of the drum ( x 2) and remove the 3. Charge roller [C]. Disengage the charge roller on the right side to remove it. Try to avoid touching the charge roller. 4. Cleaning roller [D] 5. Disengage the cleaning roller on the left to remove it. After replacing the charge roller and cleaning roller, check the value of SP2001-001. If it is not at the standard value (1500), set SP2001-001 to "1500". If this is not done, the carrier will be attracted to the drum because the charge roller voltage will be too high. SM 4-41 D129/D130 Replacement and Adjustment spring [B]. PCDU 4.6.5 DRUM CLEANING BLADE 1. Drum ( p.4-38) 2. Charge roller and cleaning roller ( 3. Remove drum cleaning blade [A] ( p.4-41) x 2) Re-installation Put toner on the edge of cleaning blade and the mylar at the back side of cleaning blade before re-installing this blade. D129/D130 4-42 SM PCDU 4.6.6 ID SENSOR 1. PCDU ( 2. Fusing unit ( 3. ID sensor bracket [A] ( 4. ID sensor [B] ( SM p.4-37) x 2, Replacement and Adjustment p.4-61) x 1) x 1) Do SP3-001-002 to initialize the ID sensor after replacing. 4-43 D129/D130 Development 4.7 DEVELOPMENT 4.7.1 DEVELOPMENT FILTER 1. PCDU ( p.4-37) 2. Open the PCDU. ( 3. Upper development cover [A] ( 4. Development filter [B] p.4-38 "Drum") x2) 4.7.2 DEVELOPMENT ROLLER 1. PCDU ( 2. Open the PCDU. ( 3. Upper development cover ( 4. Development roller [A] D129/D130 p.4-37) p.4-38 "Drum") p.4-44 "Development Filter") Work carefully to avoid scratching or nicking the development roller. 4-44 SM Development Cleaning Procedure PCDU ( p.4-37) 2. Remove the two screws [A] and open the PCDU as shown above. 3. Remove the upper development cover [A] ( 4. Fold up a sheet of copy paper [A] to fit the width of the uncovered area of the development Replacement and Adjustment 1. x 2). roller, as shown below. 5. SM Slide the paper [A] along the length of the roller to clean the toner off the surface. 4-45 D129/D130 Development 6. Rotate the development roller [A] in the direction of the arrow until the section you cleaned is no longer visible. 7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 until you have cleaned the entire surface of the roller. 8. Reassemble the PCDU and install the PCDU into the machine. 4.7.3 DEVELOPER 1. PCDU ( 2. Open the PCDU. ( 3. Development roller ( 4. Joint bracket [A] ( 5. Development unit [B] D129/D130 p.4-37) p.4-38 "Drum") p.4-44) x 2, x 1) 4-46 SM Development 6. Tip out the old developer [C]. 7. Turn drive gear [D] to ensure that no developer remains in the unit or on the developer roller. Dispose of the used developer in accordance with local regulations. Work carefully to avoid scratching or nicking the development roller. Clean the development roller with a dry cloth. 9. Pour approximately 1/3 of the developer [E] evenly along the length of the development Replacement and Adjustment 8. unit. 10. Rotate the drive gear [F] to work the developer into the unit. 11. Repeat steps 8 and 9 until all toner is in the unit and level with the edges. 12. Re-install the development roller. Make sure that the seals at the both sides of the development roller are set inside the case after you re-install the development roller. SM 4-47 D129/D130 Development 13. Place a piece of paper [G] over the toner entrance hole. This prevents used toner falling from the drum into the development unit during the TD sensor initial setting and interfering with the Vref setting (toner density reference voltage) 14. Secure the drum [H] to the development unit, to close the PCDU ( x 2). 15. Install the PCDU in the machine and close the front and right doors. 16. Turn on the main power switch, and wait for the machine to warm up. 17. Do SP2801 to initialize the TD sensor and enter the developer lot number. 18. After performing the TD sensor initial setting, remove the sheet of paper from the PCDU. D129/D130 4-48 SM Development 4.7.4 TD SENSOR PCDU ( 2. Empty all developer from the development unit. ( 3. Seal 4. TD sensor [A] ( p.4-37) p.4-46 "Developer") x1) The TD sensor is attached to the casing with double-sided tape [B]. Pry it off with the flat head of a screwdriver. Use fresh double-sided tape to re-attach the sensor. 5. Pour new developer into the development unit and perform the TD sensor initial setting using SP2-801. When performing the TD sensor initial setting, cover the toner entrance hole with a piece of paper. SM 4-49 D129/D130 Replacement and Adjustment 1. Transfer 4.8 TRANSFER 4.8.1 TRANSFER BELT UNIT To avoid exposing the drum to strong light, cover it with paper if the right cover will be open for a long period. 1. Open the right door [A]. 2. Release the lever [B]. 3. Transfer belt unit [C] D129/D130 Avoid touching the transfer belt surface. 4-50 SM Transfer 4.8.2 TRANSFER BELT 1. Transfer belt unit ( p.4-50) 2. Connector [A] ( 3. Remove the springs (front and rear) [B]. 4. Release the hooks (front and rear) [C]. 5. Transfer belt with rollers [D] Replacement and Adjustment x 1) SM 4-51 D129/D130 Transfer 6. Lay the transfer belt with rollers on a flat clean surface, and fold the unit [E] to release the tension on the belt ( 7. x 2). Transfer belt [F] Avoid touching the transfer belt surface. Before installing the new transfer belt, clean all the rollers and shafts with alcohol to prevent the belt from slipping. When reinstalling the transfer belt, make sure that the belt is under the pin [F]. To avoid damaging the transfer belt during installation, manually turn the rollers and make sure that the new transfer belt is not running over the edges of any of the rollers. D129/D130 4-52 SM Transfer 4.8.3 TONER OVERFLOW SENSOR Transfer belt unit ( p.4-50) 2. Toner overflow sensor [A] ( x 1, x 1) 4.8.4 TRANSFER BELT CLEANING BLADE/TONER OVERFLOW SENSOR Transfer Belt Cleaning Blade 1. Transfer belt unit ( 2. Transfer belt ( 3. Transfer belt cleaning blade [A] ( p.4-50) p.4-51) x 2) Avoid touching the edge of the new blade. Check the new blade for dust or damage. SM 4-53 D129/D130 Replacement and Adjustment 1. Transfer Toner Overflow Sensor 1. Transfer belt unit ( 2. Toner overflow sensor [A] ( D129/D130 p.4-50) x 1, x 1) 4-54 SM Paper Feed 4.9 PAPER FEED 4.9.1 PAPER FEED UNIT Tray 1 and Tray 2 1. Right rear cover ( 2. Duplex unit ( 3. Pull out tray 1 and tray 2. 4. Paper guide plate [A] (hook x 2) 5. Harness cover [A] ( SM p.4-5) Replacement and Adjustment p.4-75) x 1) 4-55 D129/D130 Paper Feed 6. Paper feed unit [A] ( x 2, x 1) 4.9.2 PICK-UP, FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLERS Tray 1 and Tray 2 1. Paper feed unit ( p.4-55 "Paper Feed Unit") 2. Roller holder [A] ( x 1) 3. Pick-up roller [B] 4. Feed roller [C] 5. Separation roller [D] and torque limiter [E] ( D129/D130 x 1) 4-56 SM Paper Feed 4.9.3 TRAY LIFT MOTOR Rear cover ( 2. Tray lift motor 1 or 2 [A] ( SM p.4-4) x 2, Replacement and Adjustment 1. x 3) 4-57 D129/D130 Paper Feed 4.9.4 RELAY, TRAY LIFT, PAPER END AND PAPER FEED SENSORS Tray 1 and Tray 2 1. Right rear cover ( 2. Duplex unit ( 3. Paper feed unit ( 4. Tray lift sensor [A] ( 5. Paper end feeler [B] and paper end sensor [C] (hook, 6. Relay sensor bracket [D] ( 7. Relay sensor [E] ( 8. Paper feed sensor bracket [F] ( 9. Paper feed sensor [G] ( D129/D130 p.4-5) p.4-75) p.4-55) x 1) x 1 each) x 1) x 1, hook) x 1) x 1, hook) 4-58 SM Paper Feed 4.9.5 REGISTRATION SENSOR 1. Right rear cover ( 2. Duplex unit ( 3. Paper feed unit for tray 1 ( 4. Paper Trays 1 and 2 5. Paper dust box [A] 6. Open the front door. 7. Pull out the paper dust container [B]. 8. Remove two screws [C]. SM p.4-5) p.4-75) Replacement and Adjustment p.4-55 "Paper Feed Unit") 4-59 D129/D130 Paper Feed 9. This makes the paper guide [D] tilt a little bit. Now you can access the screw [E]. Dust container rail [F] ( 10. Sensor bracket [G] ( [E] x 1) x 1) You can only access the screw on the sensor bracket from the inside (paper tray location) of the machine. 11. Registration sensor [H] ( x 1, hooks) Reinstall the registration sensor It is very difficult to secure the sensor bracket to the frame. First attach the sensor bracket with tape temporarily. D129/D130 4-60 SM Fusing 4.10 FUSING 4.10.1 FUSING UNIT Turn off the main switch and wait until the fusing unit cools down before beginning any of the procedures in this section. The fusing unit can cause serious burns. Turn off the main power switch. 2. Open the right door. 3. Pull up the lock levers [A]. 4. Pull the fusing unit [B] until you hear a click. Replacement and Adjustment 1. The lock levers lock the fusing unit again at this time to prevent the fusing unit from falling down. 5. SM Pull up the lock levers [A] again, and then remove the fusing unit [B]. 4-61 D129/D130 Fusing 4.10.2 WEB ROLLER UNIT 1. Fusing unit ( p.4-61) 2. Web roller unit [A] ( x 2) 4.10.3 BRAKE PAD 1. Web roller unit ( 2. Web left cover [A] ( x 1, stepped screw x 3) 3. Web top frame [B] ( x 2) D129/D130 p.4-62) 4-62 SM Fusing 4. Web left frame [C] ( 5. Brake pad [D] x 2) 1. Web roller unit ( p.4-62) 2. Web left cover ( p.4-62 "Brake Pad") 3. Web top frame ( p.4-62 "Brake Pad") 4. Web left frame ( p.4-62 "Brake Pad") 5. Front gear bracket [A] ( 6. All gears and bushings (rear side) [B] ( SM Replacement and Adjustment 4.10.4 WEB HOLDER ROLLER AND WEB ROLLERS x 2) x 2) 4-63 D129/D130 Fusing x 2) 7. Rear gear bracket [C] ( 8. All gear and bushings (rear side) [D] ( 9. Front bracket [E] ( x 2, spring x 1) x 2) 10. Web holder roller [F] (holder x 2, spring x 2) ) 11. Web take up roller [G] ( 12. Web supply roller [H] ( D129/D130 ) 4-64 SM Fusing Installing a new web holder roller The holder [A] has a one-way clutch. Make sure that the holder [A] is set at the front side. Replacement and Adjustment Installing new web rollers 1. Install the web supply roller [A] first ( ). Make sure that the web sheet is under the pin [B]. 2. Install the web take up roller [C] ( ). Make sure that the printed number [D] is outside the web take up roller. 3. Reinstall the rear gear bracket ( 4. Reinstall the front and rear gears and bushings ( p.4-63 "Web Holder Roller and Web Rollers"). p.4-63 "Web Holder Roller and Web Rollers"). 5. SM Reinstall the rear gear bracket ( p.4-63 "Web Holder Roller and Web Rollers"). 4-65 D129/D130 Fusing 6. Turn the rear gear [E] in the arrow direction to remove the slack in the web sheet. 7. Reinstall the front gear bracket [F] ( 8. Turn the coupling [G] in the arrow direction to remove the slack in the web sheet. 9. Reinstall the web unit. p.4-63 "Web Holder Roller and Web Rollers"). 10. If you install a new cleaning web, reset SP 7806-008 (press "Execute" on the LCD). 4.10.5 PRESSURE ROLLER CLEANING ROLLER 1. Fusing unit ( 2. Fusing exit guide [A] (lock x 2) 3. Fusing front upper cover [B] ( x 3) 4. Fusing rear upper cover [C] ( x 3) 5. Fusing outer guide [D] (front: D129/D130 p.4-61) x 1, rear: stepped screw x 1) 4-66 SM Fusing x 4) 6. Cleaning roller unit [E] ( 7. Pressure roller cleaning roller [F] (spring x 2, holder x 2) 1. Fusing unit ( 2. Web roller unit ( 3. Fusing top cover [A] (front: 4. Thermostat holder [B] ( x 2) 5. Thermostat cover [C] ( x 2) 6. Thermostat [D] (terminal x 2) SM Replacement and Adjustment 4.10.6 THERMOSTATS p.4-61) p.4-62) x 1, rear: stepped screw x 1) 4-67 D129/D130 Fusing 4.10.7 THERMISTOR 1. Fusing unit ( 2. Web roller unit ( 3. Fusing top cover ( 4. Pull the two tabs [A]. 5. Disconnect the two terminals [B]. 6. Sensor stays [C] ( 7. Thermistors [D] ( D129/D130 p.4-61) p.4-62) p.4-67 "Thermostats") x 1 each) x 2, x 1) 4-68 SM Fusing 4.10.8 HOT ROLLER STRIPPERS 1. Fusing unit ( 2. Web roller unit ( 3. Fusing top cover ( 4. Fusing top frame [A] ( p.4-61) p.4-62) Replacement and Adjustment p.4-67 "Thermostats") x 5) The cords on this frame are still connected to the fusing unit at this time. Be careful not to damage the cords when removing the hot roller stripper [B]. 5. SM Hot roller stripper [B] (spring x 1) 4-69 D129/D130 Fusing 4.10.9 FUSING LAMPS 1. Fusing unit ( 2. Web roller unit ( 3. Fusing top cover ( 4. Connector cover [A] ( 5. Fusing top frame with connector [B] ( 6. Fusing front lower cover [C] ( 7. Fusing front frame [D] ( 8. Fusing rear lower cover [E] ( 9. Fusing rear frame [F] ( D129/D130 p.4-61) p.4-62) p.4-67 "Thermostats") x 2) x 9) x 2) x 3) x 2) x 5) 4-70 SM Fusing x 4) 10. Terminal bracket [G] ( 11. Front holder bracket [H] ( 12. Terminal base [I] ( x 1) x 3) 13. Rear holder bracket [J] ( x 1) Replacement and Adjustment 14. Fusing lamp-Center (550W) [K] 15. Fusing lamp-End (750W) [L] 4.10.10 HOT ROLLER AND PRESSURE ROLLER 1. Fusing lamps-Center and End ( 2. Hot roller [A] (snap ring x 2, gear x 2, bushing x 2) 3. Pressure roller [B] ( SM p.4-70 "Fusing Lamps") x 2, bushing x 2) 4-71 D129/D130 Paper Exit 4.11 PAPER EXIT 4.11.1 PAPER EXIT UNIT 1. Fusing unit ( 2. Fusing exhaust fan duct ( 3. Paper exit unit [A] ( D129/D130 p.4-61) x 3, p.4-106 "Fusing Exhaust Fan") x 2) 4-72 SM Paper Exit 1. Paper exit unit ( 2. Sensor bracket [A] ( 3. Paper exit sensor [B] ( 4. Paper overflow sensor [C] ( 5. Sensor bracket [D] ( 6. Fusing exit sensor [E] ( Replacement and Adjustment 4.11.2 FUSING EXIT, PAPER OVERFLOW, AND PAPER EXIT SENSORS p.4-72) x 1) x 1, hooks) x 1, hooks) x 2) x 1, x 1) 4.11.3 JUNCTION JAM SENSOR 1. Paper exit unit ( p.4-72) 2. Paper guide [A] ( x 3) 3. Junction jam sensor [B] ( SM x 1) 4-73 D129/D130 Paper Exit 4.11.4 PAPER EXIT MOTOR 1. Paper exit unit ( 2. Motor cover [A] ( 3. Exit motor [B] ( D129/D130 p.4-72) x 1) x 2, x 2, x 1) 4-74 SM Duplex 4.12 DUPLEX 4.12.1 DUPLEX UNIT Right rear cover ( 2. Open the lower right cover [A] at the duplex unit. 3. Release the tab [B] and remove the lower door (spring x 2). 4. Open the right door. 5. Release the front link [C] ( SM p.4-5) Replacement and Adjustment 1. x 1). 4-75 D129/D130 Duplex 6. Keep the right door fully open. 7. Push up the duplex unit a little bit, while pressing the bracket [D] to lock the spring [E]. Do not let the duplex unit open fully before releasing the wire (step 9). Otherwise, the lock for the spring [E] is released. 8. Wire [F] ( 9. Push the projection [G]. D129/D130 x 1) 4-76 SM Duplex 10. Duplex unit ( x 3, x 1, ground cable x 1) 1. Open the duplex door [A] and by-pass tray. 2. Right door cover [B] ( Replacement and Adjustment 4.12.2 RIGHT DOOR COVER x 4) 4.12.3 DUPLEX DOOR SENSOR 1. Right door cover ( 2. Duplex door sensor [A] ( SM p.4-77) x 1, hook) 4-77 D129/D130 Duplex 4.12.4 DUPLEX ENTRANCE SENSOR 1. Right door cover ( 2. Open the right door. 3. Duplex entrance guide [A] ([B]: 4. Duplex entrance sensor bracket [A] ( 5. Duplex entrance sensor [A] (hooks) D129/D130 p.4-77) x1, [C]: Stepped screw x 2) x 1, 4-78 x 1) SM Duplex 4.12.5 DUPLEX EXIT SENSOR Transfer belt unit ( 2. Right door rear cover [A] ( 3. Remove the shaft [B] ( 4. Transfer belt unit holder [C] ( p.4-50) Replacement and Adjustment 1. x 3) x 1). x 1, x 1) When re-installing the transfer belt unit holder, make sure that the spring [D] correctly hooks onto the frame. SM 4-79 D129/D130 Duplex 5. Guide plate [E] (two hooks) 6. Duplex exit sensor [F] ( D129/D130 x 1, hooks) 4-80 SM Duplex 4.12.6 DUPLEX/BY-PASS MOTOR 1. Rear cover ( 2. Right rear cover ( 3. Frame [A] ( 4. Duplex/By-pass motor bracket [B] ( 5. Duplex/By-pass motor [C] ( SM p.4-4) Replacement and Adjustment p.4-5) x 4) x 2, x 1) x 4, bushing x 8, timing belt x 1) 4-81 D129/D130 Duplex 4.12.7 DUPLEX INVERTER MOTOR 1. Right door cover ( 2. Open the right door. 3. Right door rear cover [A] ( 4. Duplex door [B] 5. Duplex guide plate [C] ( D129/D130 p.4-77) x 3) x 3) 4-82 SM Duplex x 2) Bracket [D] ( 7. Duplex inverter motor [E] ( x 3, x 1) Replacement and Adjustment 6. SM 4-83 D129/D130 By-pass 4.13 BY-PASS 4.13.1 BY-PASS PAPER SIZE SENSOR/BY-PASS PAPER LENGTH SENSOR 1. Open the lower right cover [A]. 2. Disconnect the connector and clamp. 3. Open the by-pass tray [A]. D129/D130 4-84 SM By-pass 4. Move the side fences to the center. 5. By-pass tray cover [A] ( 6. By-pass paper size sensor [A] ( 7. By-pass paper length sensor [B] ( Replacement and Adjustment x 4) SM x 1) x 1) 4-85 D129/D130 By-pass When reinstalling the by-pass paper size sensor 1. Adjust the projection [A] of the left side fence bar (it must be centered). 2. Install the by-pass paper size detection switch so that the hole [B] in this switch faces the projection [C] of the left side fence bar. 3. Reassemble the copier. 4. Plug in and turn on the main power switch. 5. Check this switch operation with SP5803-024 (By-pass: Paper Size Sensor< Input Check). - Display on the LCD - Paper Size Display Paper Size Display A3 SEF 00001110 A5 SEF 00001011 B4 SEF 00001100 B6 SEF 00000011 A4 SEF 00001101 A6 SEF 00000111 B5 SEF 00001001 Smaller A6 SEF 00001111 D129/D130 4-86 SM By-pass 4.13.2 BY-PASS PAPER END SENSOR Right door cover ( p.4-77 "Right Door Cover") 2. By-pass feed unit cover [A] ( 3. By-pass paper end sensor [B] ( x 2). x 1, hooks) 4.13.3 BY-PASS PICK-UP, FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLER, TORQUE LIMITER 1. Right door cover ( 2. By-pass feed unit cover ( 3. By-pass pick-up roller [A] (hook) 4. By-pass feed roller [B] ( 5. By-pass separation roller [C] ( 6. Torque limiter [D] SM p.4-77) p.4-87 "By-pass Paper End Sensor") x 1) x 1) 4-87 D129/D130 Replacement and Adjustment 1. By-pass 4.13.4 BY-PASS FEED CLUTCH 1. Open the right door. 2. Right door rear cover ( 3. Transfer belt unit ( 4. Transfer belt unit holder ( 5. By-pass feed clutch holder [A] ( 6. By-pass feed clutch [B] ( D129/D130 p.4-79 "Duplex Exit Sensor") p.4-50) p.4-79 "Duplex Exit Sensor") x 1, x 2) x 1) 4-88 SM Drive Area 4.14 DRIVE AREA 4.14.1 PAPER FEED CLUTCH Tray 1 and Tray 2 Rear cover ( p.4-4) 2. Clutch bracket [A] ( 3. Paper feed clutch [B] ( Replacement and Adjustment 1. SM x 2, x 1, bushing x 1) x 1) 4-89 D129/D130 Drive Area 4.14.2 DEVELOPMENT PADDLE MOTOR 1. Rear cover ( p.4-4) 2. Development paddle motor [A] ( x 4, x 1) 4.14.3 TRANSFER/DEVELOPMENT MOTOR 1. Rear cover ( 2. Transfer/development motor [A] ( D129/D130 p.4-4) x 4, x 1) 4-90 SM Drive Area 4.14.4 DRUM MOTOR Rear cover ( 2. Drum motor [A] ( p.4-4) x 4, Replacement and Adjustment 1. x 1) 4.14.5 FUSING MOTOR 1. Rear cover ( 2. Fusing motor [A] ( SM p.4-4) x 4, x 1) 4-91 D129/D130 Drive Area 4.14.6 WEB MOTOR 1. Rear cover ( p.4-4) 2. Bracket [A] ( 3. Web motor [B] ( x 1) x 1, x 1) 4.14.7 PAPER FEED MOTOR 1. Rear cover ( 2. Right rear cover ( 3. Paper feed motor [A] ( D129/D130 p.4-4) p.4-5) x 2, x 1) 4-92 SM Drive Area 4.14.8 TRANSFER BELT CONTACT MOTOR 1. Rear cover ( p.4-4) 2. Right rear cover ( 3. Transfer belt contact motor [A] ( p.4-5) x 1) Replacement and Adjustment x 2, 4.14.9 REGISTRATION MOTOR 1. Rear cover ( 2. Right rear cover ( 3. Registration motor bracket [A] ( 4. Registration motor [B] ( SM p.4-4) p.4-5) x 2, x 3, x 1) x 1) 4-93 D129/D130 Drive Area 4.14.10 TONER SUPPLY MOTOR 1. Left cover ( 2. Upper inner cover ( 3. Inner Tray ( 4. Exhaust duct [A] ( 5. Toner supply motor [B] (hooks, D129/D130 p.4-4) p.4-3 "Front Door, Upper and Lower Inner Cover") p.4-9) x 2) x 1) 4-94 SM Electrical Components 4.15 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 1. SM Controller unit [A] ( Replacement and Adjustment 4.15.1 CONTROLLER UNIT x 2) 4-95 D129/D130 Electrical Components 4.15.2 HDD UNIT Before Replacing the HDD Unit Copy the address book data to an SD card from the HDD with SP5846-051 if possible. Replacement Procedure 1. Controller unit ( 2. HDD unit [A] with connecting board [B] ( D129/D130 p.4-95) x 3, 4-96 x 2) SM 3. HDD unit [A] ( x 2, Replacement and Adjustment Electrical Components x 2) After installing the new HDD unit 1. Do SP5832-001 to format the hard disk. 2. Do SP5853-001 to copy the preset stamp data from the firmware to the hard disk. 3. Do SP5846-052 to copy back the address book to the hard disk from the SD card to which you have already copied the address book data if possible. 4. Turn the main power switch off/on. Disposal of HDD Units Never remove an HDD unit from the work site without the consent of the client. If the customer has any concerns about the security of any information on the HDD, the HDD must remain with the customer for disposal or safe keeping. The HDD may contain proprietary or classified (Confidential, Secret) information. Specifically, the HDD contains document server documents and data stored in temporary files created automatically during copy job sorting and jam recovery. Such data is stored on the HDD in a special format so it cannot normally be read but can be recovered with illegal methods. SM 4-97 D129/D130 Electrical Components Reinstallation Explain to the customer that the following information stored on the HDD is lost when the HDD is replaced: document server documents, fixed stamps, document server address book The address book and document server documents (if needed) must be input again. 4.15.3 CONTROLLER BOARD The battery on the control board can explode if replaced incorrectly. Dispose of the old battery in accordance with the instructions. Before Replacing the Controller Board in the Model without HDD When you replace the controller board in a model without a HDD, address book data can be copied from an old controller board to a new controller board using an SD card. Copy the address book data to an SD card from the flash ROM on the controller board with SP5846-051 if possible. Replacement Procedure 1. Controller unit ( 2. HDD unit (if it has been installed.) ( 3. Controller cover [A] ( D129/D130 p.4-95) p.4-96) x 2) 4-98 SM Electrical Components 4. Controller right bracket [A] ( 5. Controller board assembly [A] ( Replacement and Adjustment x 5) SM x 4, connector caps) 4-99 D129/D130 Electrical Components 6. NVRAMs [A] 7. Interface rails [B] (hooks each) 8. DIMM-RAM (If it is installed.) 9. Controller board [C] When Installing the New Controller Board 1. Remove the NVRAMs from the old controller board. 2. Install them on the new controller board after you replace the controller board. 3. Replace the NVRAMs if the NVRAM on the old controller board is defective. Make sure you print out the SMC reports ("SP Mode Data" and "Logging Data") before you replace the NVRAMs. Keep NVRAMs away from any objects that can cause static electricity. Static electricity can damage NVRAM data. Make sure the NVRAMs are correctly installed on the controller board. Make sure that the DIP-switch settings on the old controller board are the same for the new controller board. Do not change the DIP switches on the controller board in the field. D129/D130 4-100 SM Electrical Components 4.15.4 AFTER INSTALLING THE CONTROLLER BOARD 1. For a model without a HDD, do SP5846-052 to copy back the address book to the flash ROM on the controller board from the SD card to which you have already copied the address book data if possible. 2. If the customer is using the data encryption feature, the encryption key must be restored. 3. Turn the main power switch off/on. 4.15.5 MOTHER BOARD 1. Rear cover ( p.4-4) 2. Controller unit ( 3. Exhaust fan duct [A] ( Replacement and Adjustment p.4-95) SM x 2, x 1) 4-101 D129/D130 Electrical Components 4. Controller box [A] ( x 6, 5. Mother board [A] ( x 6) D129/D130 x 4, x 3) 4-102 SM Electrical Components 4.15.6 BCU 1. Controller box ( 2. BCU [A] ( 3. Remove the NVRAM [A] from the old board and install it on the new board. 4. Set the DIP switches on the new BCU board to the same settings as the old board. x 4) Replacement and Adjustment x 4, p.4-101 "Mother Board") Make sure the NVRAM is correctly installed on the BCU. Insert the NVRAM in the NVRAM slot with the "half-moon" pointing [B] to the left side. SM 4-103 D129/D130 Electrical Components When installing the new BCU 1. Remove the NVRAM from the old BCU. 2. Install the NVRAM on the new BCU after you replace the BCU. 3. Reassemble the machine. 4. Turn on the main power switch. 5. "SC995-01" occurs. 6. Enter the serial number with SP5-811-004. 7. Turn the main power switch off and on. Make sure you print out the SMC reports ("SP Mode Data" and "Logging Data") before you replace the NVRAM. Keep NVRAM away from any objects that can cause static electricity. Static electricity can damage NVRAM data. 4.15.7 IPU 1. Controller box ( 2. IPU[[A] ( D129/D130 x 6, p.4-101 "Mother Board") x all) 4-104 SM Electrical Components 4.15.8 IOB Rear cover ( 2. IOB [A] ( p.4-4) x 6, Replacement and Adjustment 1. x all) When installing a new IOB Set the bit switches on the new IOB to the same settings as the old IOB. 4.15.9 PSU 1. Left cover ( 2. PSU [A] ( 3. Two clamps [B] (These clamps will be used for the new PSU.) SM p.4-4) x 4, x all) 4-105 D129/D130 Electrical Components 4.15.10 HIGH VOLTAGE POWER SUPPLY 1. Rear cover ( p.4-4) 2. Right rear cover ( 3. High voltage power supply board [A] ( p.4-5) x 5, x all) 4.15.11 FUSING EXHAUST FAN 1. Rear cover ( p.4-4) 2. Fusing exhaust duct [A] ( 3. Separate the duct (hooks). 4. Fusing exhaust fan [B] x 2, x 1) When installing the fusing exhaust fan Make sure that the fusing fan is installed with its decal facing the right side of the machine. D129/D130 4-106 SM Electrical Components 4.15.12 CONTROLLER FAN 1. Controller box ( p.4-101 "Mother Board") 2. Fan cover [A] ( 3. Controller fan [B] ( x 2) Replacement and Adjustment x 1) When installing the controller fan Make sure that the controller fan is installed with its decal facing upward. SM 4-107 D129/D130 Electrical Components ⇒ Rev. 1/4/2013 4.15.13 NVRAM ON THE BCU BOARD Replacement Procedure for the NVRAM on the BCU Board 1. Turn the main power switch ON. 2. Access SP5990-001 and print out all data lists. 2. Turn the main power switch OFF. 3. Insert the SD card into the lower slot on the controller box. 4. Turn the main power switch ON. 5. Upload the NVRAM data (SP5-824-001) onto the SD card. 6. Turn the main power switch OFF. 7. Remove the old NVRAM from the BCU and attach the new one. Important: Even if SC995 is displayed when you turn on the main switch (after replacing the NVRAM), continue with this procedure. 9. Access SP5807-001 and set the area code. Important: SP5807-001 is a Sales SP mode. Dealers must contact the Hotline for the regional support rep. Direct must contact the Hotline for Sensei rep. - The initial value stored in the NVRAM is “1”. - After the NVRAM is replaced, the display for SP5807-001 changes to Japanese. - Refer to the following area destination code list. Area code Destination 1 JP 2 NA 3 EU 4 TWN 5 AA 6 CHN 7 KOR 10. Access SP5-811-001 and program the machine serial number. 11. Access SP5-811-004 and program the BCU serial number. 12. Turn the main switch off. 13. Download the NVRAM data (SP5-825-001) stored on the SD card in Step 5 onto the machine. 14. Remove the SD card from the lower slot in the controller box. Important: If you cannot upload the NVRAM data (SP5-824-001) or download the NVRAM data (SP5-825-001), do the following: -Enter the data from the SMC report manually (included in the factory sheet). -Reinstall the security options (Data Overwrite Security, HDD Encryption). D129/D130 4-108 SM Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning Rev. 12/27/2012 4.16 COPY ADJUSTMENTS: PRINTING/SCANNING 4.16.1 OVERVIEW Perform these adjustments after replacing any of the following: Scanner Wire Lens Block/SBU Assembly Scanner Drive Motor Polygon Mirror Motor Paper Side Fence Memory All Clear 4.16.2 PRINTING Make sure paper is installed correctly in each paper tray before you start these adjustments. 2. Use the Trimming Area Pattern (SP2-109-1, No. 14) to print the test pattern for the following procedures. Registration - Leading Edge/Side-to-Side 1. Check the leading edge registration [A] for each paper type and paper feed station, and adjust it with following SP modes. SP No. Tray: Plain Specification SP1-001-1 0 ±9.0 mm Tray: Thick 1 SM SP1-001-2 4-109 D129/D130 Replacement and Adjustment 1. Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning Rev. 12/27/2012 SP No. 2. Tray: Thick 2 SP1-001-3 By-pass: Plain SP1-001-4 By-pass: Thick 1 SP1-001-5 By-pass: Thick 2 SP1-001-6 Duplex: Plain SP1-001-7 Duplex: Thick 1 SP1-001-8 Specification Check side-to-side registration [B] for each paper feed station, and adjust with the following SP modes. SP No. By-pass SP1-002-1 Tray 1 SP1-002-2 Tray 2 SP1-002-3 Tray 3 SP1-002-4 Tray 4 SP1-002-5 LCT SP1-002-6 Duplex SP1-002-7 D129/D130 Specification 0 ±4.0 mm 4-110 SM Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning Rev. 12/27/2012 Blank Margin If the leading edge/side-to-side registration cannot be adjusted within specifications, 1. Check the trailing edge [A], right edge [B], leading edge [C] and left edge [D] blank margins, and adjust them with the following SP modes. SP No. Leading Edge Specification SP2-103-1 3.0 mm [0.0 to 9.0 mm] Trailing Edge SP2-103-2 Left SP2-103-3 2.0 mm [0.0 to 9.0 mm] Right Duplex: Trailing Edge: L Size: Plain Duplex: Trailing Edge: M Size: Plain Duplex: Trailing Edge: S Size: Plain SP2-103-4 SP2-103-5 1.0 mm [0.0 to 4.0 mm] SP2-103-6 0.8 mm [0.0 to 4.0 mm] SP2-103-7 0.6 mm [0.0 to 4.0 mm] Duplex: Left: Plain SP2-103-8 Duplex: Right: Plain SP2-103-9 0.3 mm [0.0 to 1.5 mm] SM 4-111 D129/D130 Replacement and Adjustment adjust the leading/left side edge blank margin. Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning Rev. 12/27/2012 SP No. Duplex: Trailing Edge: L Size: Thick Duplex: Trailing Edge: M Size: Thick Duplex: Trailing Edge: S Size: Thick Duplex: Left: Thick SP2-103-10 Specification 0.8 mm [0.0 to 4.0 mm] SP2-103-11 0.6 mm [0.0 to 4.0 mm] SP2-103-12 0.4 mm [0.0 to 4.0 mm] SP2-103-13 0.1 mm [0.0 to 1.5 mm] Duplex: Right: Thick SP2-103-14 L Size: Paper length is 297.1 mm or more. M Size: Paper length is 216.1 to 297 mm S Size: Paper length is 216 mm or less. Main Scan Magnification 1. Use SP2-109-001 no 5 (Grid Pattern) to print a single dot pattern. 2. Check magnification, and then SP2-102 (Magnification Adjustment Main Scan) to adjust magnification if required. Specification: ±2%. Parallelogram Image Adjustment Do the following procedure if a parallelogram prints while adjusting the printing registration or printing margin using a trimming area pattern. The following procedure should be done after adjusting the side-to-side registration for each paper tray station. Use SP2-109-1 No. 14 (Trimming Area) to determine whether a parallelogram image appears. If the parallelogram pattern appears, perform the following procedure. D129/D130 4-112 SM 1. Laser unit [A] 2. Bracket [B] ( 3. Install adjustment cam [C] (P/N: A2309003). 4. Secure positioning pin [D] (P/N A2309004) with the two screws removed with the bracket x2) [B]. Do not tighten the screws at this time. 5. To adjust the position of the laser unit [E] 1) Adjust the laser unit position by turning the adjustment cam. (See the illustration above.) 2) Tighten the adjustment bracket. 3) Print the trimming area pattern to check the image. If the results are not satisfactory, repeat steps 5-1) to 5-3). SM 4-113 D129/D130 Replacement and Adjustment Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning Rev. 12/27/2012 Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning Rev. 12/27/2012 4.16.3 SCANNING Before doing the following scanner adjustments, perform or check the printing registration/side-to-side adjustment and the blank margin adjustment. Use the S5S test chart to perform the following adjustments. Registration: Platen Mode 1. Place the test chart on the exposure glass and make a copy from one of the feed stations. 2. Check the leading edge [A] and side-to-side [B] registration, and adjust them with the following SP modes if necessary. SP No. Specification Leading Edge SP4-010-1 0 ±2.0 mm Side-to-side SP4-011-1 0 ±2.5 mm D129/D130 4-114 SM Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning Rev. 12/27/2012 Magnification Use the S5S test chart to perform the following adjustment. 1. Place the test chart on the exposure glass and make a copy from one of the feed stations. 2. Check the magnification ratio. Use SP4-008 (Scanner Sub Scan Magnification) to adjust if necessary. Specification: ±0.9%. SM 4-115 D129/D130 Replacement and Adjustment Sub Scan Magnification Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning Rev. 12/27/2012 4.16.4 ADF Registration 1. Make a temporary test chart as shown above using A3/DLT paper. 2. Place the temporary test chart on the ADF and make a copy from one of the feed stations. 3. Check the registration, and adjust using the following SP modes if necessary. SP No. Specification Side-to-side: 1st side SP6-006-1 Side-to-side: 2nd side SP6-006-2 Leading Edge SP6-006-3 0.0 mm ±5 mm Leading Edge: 1st side SP6-006-5 0.0 mm ±3 mm Leading Edge: 2nd side SP6-006-6 0.0 mm ±2.5 mm Trailing Erase edge: SP6-006-7 0.0 mm ±10.0 mm 0.0 mm ±3 mm D129/D130 4-116 SM Copy Adjustments: Printing/Scanning Rev. 12/27/2012 4.16.5 TOUCH SCREEN CALIBRATION ⇒ After clearing the memory, replacing the operation panel or NVRAM, or if the touch panel detection function is not working correctly, follow this procedure to calibrate the touch screen. Do not attempt to use items [2] to [7] on the Self-Diagnostic Menu. These items are for 1. Press , "1", "9", "9", "3", and then press 5 times to open the Self-Diagnostics menu. 2. On the touch screen press "Touch Screen Adjust" (or press "1"). 3. Use a pointed (not sharp!) tool to press the upper left mark 4. Press the lower right mark 5. Touch a few spots on the touch panel to confirm that the marker (+) appears exactly where . after it appears. the screen is touched. If the + mark does not appear where the screen is touched, press Cancel and repeat from Step 2. 6. When you are finished, press [#] OK on the screen (or press 7. Touch [#] Exit on the screen to close the Self-Diagnostic menu and save the calibration ). settings. SM 4-117 D129/D130 Replacement and Adjustment design use only. SERVICE TABLES R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New None Service Program Mode 5. SERVICE TABLES 5.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE Never turn off the main power switch when the power LED is lit or flashing. To avoid damaging the hard disk or memory, press the operation switch to switch the power off, wait for the power LED to go off, and then switch the main power switch off. The main power LED lights or flashes while the platen cover or ARDF is open, while the main machine is communicating with a facsimile or the network server, or while the machine is accessing the hard disk or memory for reading or writing data. 5.1.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE OPERATION The service program (SP) mode is used to check electrical data, change modes, and adjust values. Never turn off the main power switch when the power LED is lit or flashing. To avoid damaging the hard disk or memory, press the operation switch to switch the power off, Service Tables wait for the power LED to go off, and then switch the main power switch off. Service Mode Lock/Unlock At locations where the machine contains sensitive data, the customer engineer cannot operate the machine until the Administrator turns the service mode lock off. This function makes sure that work on the machine is always done with the permission of the Administrator. 1. If you cannot go into the SP mode, ask the Administrator to log in with the User Tool and then set "Service Mode Lock" to OFF. After he or she logs in: [User Tools] > System Settings > Administrator Tools > Service Mode Lock > OFF This unlocks the machine and lets you get access to all the SP codes. The service technician can do servicing on the machine and turn the machine off and on. It is not necessary to ask the Administrator to log in again each time the machine is turned on. 2. SM If you must use the printer bit switches, go into the SP mode and set SP5169 to "1". 5-1 D129/D130 Service Program Mode 3. After machine servicing is completed: Change SP5169 from "1" to "0". Turn the machine off and on. Tell the administrator that you completed servicing the machine. The administrator will then set the "Service Mode Lock" to ON. 5.1.2 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE TABLES Please note these general changes in this section: Group 8(Data Log 2) is a new group of counters. Along with the addition of Group 8, many of the Group 7 counters have been removed. Service Table Key Notation What it means Example: [-9 to +9 / 0 / 0.1 mm step]. The setting can be [range / default / step] adjusted in the range ±9, value reset to +3.0 after an NVRAM reset, and the value can be changed in 0.1 mm steps with each key press. * DFU Japan only Value stored in NVRAM. After a RAM reset, this default value (factory setting) is restored. Denotes "Design or Factory Use". Do not change this value. The feature or item is for Japan only. Do not change this value. C2b D129 C2c D130 SSP This denotes a "Special Service Program" mode. D129/D130 5-2 SM Service Program Mode Tables 5.2 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE TABLES 5.2.1 SP TABLES There are the most commonly used SP codes in the "Main SP Tables - 1 to - 9" of "Main Chapters". See "Appendices" for the following information: System SP Tables Printer SP Tables Scanner SP Tables Service Tables SM 5-3 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-1 5.3 MAIN SP TABLES-1 5.3.1 SP1-XXX: FEED Leading Edge Registration 1001* Adjusts the leading edge registration by changing the registration clutch operation timing. 001 Tray: Plain 002 Tray: Thick 1 003 Tray: Thick 2 004 By-pass: Plain [–9 to 9/ 0 / 0.1 mm step] 005 By-pass: Thick 1 006 By-pass: Thick 2 007 Duplex: Plain 008 Duplex: Thick 1 Side-to-Side Registration 1002* Adjusts the side to side registration by changing the laser main scan start position for each mode. 001 By-pass 002 Tray 1 003 Tray 2 004 Tray 3 [–4 to 4/ 0 / 0.1 mm step] 005 Tray 4 006 LCT 007 Duplex D129/D130 5-4 SM Main SP Tables-1 Registration Buckle Adjustment 1003* Adjusts the paper feed motor timing. Paper feed motor timing determines the amount of paper buckle at Registration. (A "+" setting causes more buckling.) 001 Tray 1: Plain 002 Tray 1: Thick 1 003 Tray 1: Thick 2 [-9 to 5 / -4 / 1 mm step] 004 Tray 2, 3, 4: Plain 005 Tray 2, 3, 4: Thick1 006 Tray 2, 3, 4: Thick2 007 By-pass: Plain 008 By-pass: Thick 1 [-9 to 5 / -2 /1 mm step] 010 Duplex: Plain [-9 to 5 / -4 / 1 mm step] 011 Duplex: Thick 1 [-9 to 5 / -3 / 1 mm step] Service Tables 009 By-pass: Thick 2 012 LCT: Plain 013 LCT: Thick1 [-9 to 5 / -4 / 1 mm step] 014 LCT: Thick2 By-pass Paper Size Detection 1007* Controls paper size detection for the by-pass feed table. 001 Detection Timing 002 LG Detection SM [-15 to 15 / 0 / 5 mm step] [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: LTSEF, 1: LG 5-5 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-1 Fusing Temperature Adjustment Allows adjustment of the hot roller temperature at the center and ends of the roller for the quality or thickness of the paper. The hot roller in this machine has two fusing lamps: one heats the center of the roller, the other heats both 1105* ends. Each fusing lamp can be adjusted separately. The "re-load temperature" is the "print ready temperature". When the fusing temperature exceeds this setting, the machine can operate. Do not set up a re-load temperature (Re-load Temp. = Fusing. Temp – SP Value.) that is higher than the SP1-105-2 setting. Roller Center 001 C2b: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg] C2c: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg] Adjusts the fusing temperature at the center of the hot roller. Roller Ends 002 C2b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg] C2c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg] Adjusts the fusing temperature at the ends of the hot roller. Re-load Temp. Minus: Roller Center [0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg] Sets the reload temperature for the center of the hot roller. This setting depends on the target temperature. 003 Reload temp. = Target Temp – This SP Setting Do not set a temperature that is higher than the setting for SP1105 1 (Roller Center: Trays) Re-load Temp. Minus: Roller Ends [0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg] Sets the reload temperature for the ends of the hot roller. This setting depends on the target temperature. 004 Reload temp. = Target Temp – This SP Setting Do not set a temperature that is higher than the setting for SP1105 2 (Roller Ends: Trays) 005 to The following SPs adjust the fusing temperature at the center or ends of the 022 hot roller for each paper type. D129/D130 5-6 SM Main SP Tables-1 005 Roller Center: M-Thick 006 Roller Ends: M-Thick C2b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg] C2c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg] C2b: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg] C2c: [100 to 170 / 160 / 1 deg] 007 Roller Center: Thick 1 [100 to 170 / 130 / 1 deg] 008 Roller Ends: Thick 1 009 Roller Center: Thick 2 [100 to 170 / 150/ 1 deg] 010 Wait Temp: Center Minus 011 Wait Temp: Ends Minus 012 Roller Ends: Thin 013 Roller Center: OHP: Plain C2b: [100 to 170 / 130 / 1 deg] C2c: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg] C2b: [100 to 170 / 135 / 1 deg] C2c: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg] [100 to 170 / 150/ 1 deg] 014 Roller Ends: OHP: Plain [100 to 170 / 155/ 1 deg] 016 Roller Ends: OHP: Thick 017 Roller Center: Special 1 018 Roller Ends: Special 1 019 Roller Center: Special 2 020 Roller Ends: Special 2 021 Roller Center: Special 3 022 Roller Ends: Special 3 SM Service Tables 015 Roller Center: OHP: Thick [100 to 170 / 160/ 1 deg] C2b: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg] C2c: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg] C2b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg] C2c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg] C2b: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg] C2c: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg] C2b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg] C2c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg] C2b: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg] C2c: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg] C2b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg] C2c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg] 5-7 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-1 023 Feed Waiting: Plain 024 Feed Waiting: M-Thick 025 Feed Waiting: Thick 1 Turns the feed waiting mode on or off for each paper type. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0=Off, 1=On The paper waits at the registration roller 026 Feed Waiting: Thick 2 until the fusing temperature reaches the prescribed temperature (adjustable with SP1105-028 to -37). 027 Feed Waiting: Thin If you enable this feature, also set SP 1105-38 to a convenient value for the customer. 028 Feed Wait: Center Minus: Plain 029 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: Plain 030 Feed Wait: Center Minus: M-Thick 031 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: M-Thick Adjusts the offset value for each re-load 032 Feed Wait: Center Minus: Thick 1 temperature to exit the feed waiting 033 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: Thick 1 mode. [0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg] 034 Feed Wait: Center Minus: Thick 2 035 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: Thick 2 036 Feed Wait: Center Minus: Thin 037 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: Thin Sets the maximum feed waiting time. [0 to 30 / 0 / 1 sec] The paper is fed when the time specified 038 Feed Waiting: Maximum Time with this SP has passed even though the fusing temperature has not reached the prescribed temperature. 0: Disabled. D129/D130 5-8 SM Main SP Tables-1 1106 Fusing Temperature Display 001 Roller Center Displays the temperature of the fusing unit. 002 Roller Ends [-20 to 250 / 0 / 1 deg] 003 Machine Inside at Power On Displays the temperature inside the machine. 004 Machine Inside [-20 to 250 / 0 / 1 deg] MotorSpeedAdjust Adjusts the speeds of each motor. Each step decreases or increases motor speed in 0.05% increments Regist: Registration motor, Feed: Feed motor, 1801* Duplex: Duplex/By-pass motor, Inverter: Duplex inverter motor, Exit: Paper exit motor, Bridge: Bridge unit drive motor, OpcMot: Drum motor, TransferMot: Transfer/Development Motor, FusingMot: Fusing motor, Service Tables DevPuddleMot: Development Paddle motor 001 Regist: 90: Thick 2 002 Regist: 154: Thick 1 [-2 to 2 / 0.4 / 0.05 %] 003 Regist: 180: Plain 004 Regist: 230: Plain 005 Feed: 90: Thick 2 [-2 to 2 / -0.4 / 0.05 %] 006 Feed: 154: Thick 1 007 Feed: 180: Plain [-2 to 2 / -1 / 0.05 %] 008 Feed: 230: Plain 009 Duplex_CW: 90: Thick 2 [-4 to 4 / 0.4 / 0.1 %] 010 Duplex_CW: 154: Thick 1 011 Duplex_CW: 180: Plain SM [-4 to 4 / -2.3 / 0.1 %] 5-9 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-1 012 Duplex_CW: 230: Plain 013 Duplex_CCW: 90: Thick 2 [-4 to 4 / 0.4 / 0.1 %] 014 Duplex_CCW: 154: Thick 1 015 Duplex_CCW: 180: Plain [-4 to 4 / -0.2 / 0.1 %] 016 Duplex_CCW: 230: Plain 017 Inverter_CW: 90: Thick 2 018 Inverter_CW: 154: Thick 1 019 Inverter_CW: 180: Plain 020 Inverter_CW: 230: Plain 021 Inverter_CCW: 90: Thick 2 022 Inverter_CCW: 154: Thick 1 023 Inverter_CCW: 180: Plain 024 Inverter_CCW: 230: Plain [-4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %] 025 Exit_CW: 90: Thick 2 026 Exit_CW: 154: Thick 1 027 Exit_CW: 180: Plain 028 Exit_CW: 230: Plain 029 Bridge: 90: Thick 2 030 Bridge: 154: Thick 1 031 Bridge: 180: Plain 032 Bridge: 230: Plain 033 OpcMot:90 034 OpcMot:154 [-4 to 4 / 0 / 0.01 %] 035 OpcMot:180 036 OpcMot:230 D129/D130 5-10 SM Main SP Tables-1 037 TransferMot:90 038 TransferMot:154 039 TransferMot:180 040 TransferMot:230 041 FusingMot:90 042 FusingMot:154 043 FusingMot:180 044 FusingMot:230 045 DevPuddleMot 1902* [-4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %] Cleaning Web Setting Web Consumption [0 to 120 / 0 / 1 %] 001 Displays the consumed amount of the web roll. 002 C2b: [3 to 130 / 8.4 / 0.1 sec] C2c: [3 to 130 / 6.7 / 0.1 sec] Service Tables Web Motor Interval Adjusts the interval for web motor rotation. Web Motor Time [0.3 to 10 / 4.2 / 0.1 sec] 003 Adjusts the rotation time of the web motor. C2b: EU [0 to 100 / 90 / 1 %] Web Near End Setting 004 C2b: ASIA/NA [0 to 100 / 92 / 1 %] C2c: EU [0 to 100 / 90 / 1 %] C2c: ASIA/NA [0 to 100 / 92 / 1 %] Adjusts the threshold for web near end. Web Motor Interval: Thick 1 [3 to 130 / 11.2 / 0.1 sec] 005 Adjusts the interval for web motor rotation (thick 1). Web Motor Interval: Thick 2 [3 to 130 / 16.8 / 0.1 sec] 006 Adjusts the interval for web motor rotation (thick 2). SM 5-11 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-1 Paper Interval Time [0 to 10 / 5 / 1 sec] 007 Adjusts the threshold for paper feeding. When the time between trailing edge detection and leading edge detection is within the value of this setting, the machine determines that the paper is still being fed. Web Motor Setting: Web End [0 to 60 / 27 / 1 sec] 008 Adjusts the motor rotation time after the web end. Web Motor Rotation: Power On [0 to 10 / 0 / 1 times] 009 Adjusts the number of web motor rotations at the re-load state. Web Motor Interval: Pre-idle [0 to 30 / 0 / 1 sec] 010 Adjusts the motor waiting time after the fusing motor idling. Web Motor Rotation: Pre-idle [0 to 10 / 0 / 1 times] 011 Adjusts the number of web motor rotations at the fusing idling state. Tray Lock at Jam [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0= OFF, 1= ON 1950* Not used D129/D130 5-12 SM Main SP Tables-2 5.4 MAIN SP TABLES-2 5.4.1 SP2-XXX: DRUM 2005* Bias Control Bias Correction 1 [0.1 to 1 / 0.85 / 0.05 step] 001 Adjusts the lower threshold value for the charge roller correction. When the value of VSDP/VSG is greater than this value, the charge roller voltage increases by 30 V (e.g., from –500 to –530). Bias Correction 2 [0.1 to 1 / 0.9 / 0.05 step] 002 Adjusts the upper threshold value for the charge roller correction. When the value of VSDP/VSG is greater than this value, the charge roller voltage decreases by 30 V (absolute value). Bias Adjustment 1 [1000 to 2000 / 1500 / 10 vol] 003 Adjusts the lower limit value for charge roller voltage correction. [1000 to 2000 / 2000 / 10 vol] Service Tables Bias Adjustment 2 004 Adjusts the upper limit value for charge roller voltage correction. Bias Adjustment 3 [0 to 100 / 30 / 10 vol] 005 Adjusts the correction voltage adjustment step size. Erase Margin Adjustment Adjusts the erase margin by deleting image data at the margins. 2103* L Size: 297.1 mm or more (length) M Size: 216.1 to 297 mm (length) S Size: 216 mm or less (length) 001 Leading Edge [0 to 9 / 3 / 0.1mm] 002 Trailing Edge 003 Left SM [0 to 9 / 2 / 0.1mm] 5-13 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-2 004 Right 005 Duplex Trail.: L Size: Plain [0 to 4 / 1 / 0.1mm] 006 Duplex Trail.: M Size: Plain [0 to 4 / 0.8 / 0.1mm] 007 Duplex Trail.: S Size: Plain [0 to 4 / 0.6 / 0.1mm] 008 Duplex Left: Plain [0 to 1.5 / 0.3 / 0.1mm] 009 Duplex Right: Plain 010 Duplex Trail.: L Size: Thick [0 to 4 / 0.8 / 0.1mm] 011 Duplex Trail.: M Size: Thick [0 to 4 / 0.6 / 0.1mm] 012 Duplex Trail.: S Size: Thick [0 to 4 / 0.4 / 0.1mm] 013 Duplex Left: Thick [0 to 1.5 / 0.1 / 0.1mm] 014 Duplex Right: Thick LD Power Adjustment 2105* Adjusts the LD power for each mode. Each LD power setting is decided by the process control. 001 LD1: Copy [–50 to 79 / -24 (C2b), 5 (C2c) /1 ] 002 LD2: Copy 003 LD1: Printer/Fax [–50 to 79 / -44 (C2b), -25 (C2c)/1 ] 004 LD2: Printer/Fax 2109 Test Pattern 001 Pattern Selection D129/D130 [0 to 24 / 0 /1 ] Test pattern of the GAVD 5-14 SM Main SP Tables-2 0: None 13: Independent Pattern (4 dot) 1: Vertical Line (1 dot) 14: Trimming Area 2: Vertical Line (2 dot) 15: Hound’s Tooth Check (Vertical) 3: Horizontal Line (1 dot) 16: Hound’s Tooth Check (Horizontal) 4: Horizontal Line (2 dot) 17: Black Band (Horizontal) 5: Grid Vertical Line 18: Black band (Vertical) 6: Grid Horizontal Line 19: Checker Flag Pattern 7: Grid pattern small 20: Grayscale (Vertical Margin) 8: Grid Pattern Large 21: Grayscale (Horizontal Margin) 9: Argyle Pattern Small 22: Two Beam Density Pattern 10: Argyle Pattern Large 23: Full Dot Pattern 11: Independent pattern (1 dot) 24:All white Pattern 12: Independent Pattern (2 dot) [0 to 15 / 15 /1 ] 002 Density Set the density of the test pattern which is output in SP2109-001. This SP is not used for the Grayscale patterns. Adjusts the TD sensor reference voltage (Vref). Change this value after replacing the development unit with another development unit that contains toner. [1 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 ] 2220* 1. Check the value of SP2-220 in both the machine containing the test unit and the machine that you are going to move it to. 2. Install the test development unit, and then input the VREF for this unit into SP2-220. 3. After the test, put back the old development unit, and change SP2-220 back to the original value. SM 5-15 D129/D130 Service Tables Vref Setting Main SP Tables-2 Reverse Interval Drum,Transfer [0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 sheets] Adjusts the threshold for the reverse rotation of the drum and 2221* development/transfer motors. This helps the drum and transfer belt cleaning operations. This reverse rotation will interrupt a multiple printing job. TD Sensor Initial Setting Initialization Performs the TD sensor initial setting and allows the service technician to enter the lot number of the developer. (The lot number is embossed on the edge of the developer package.) This SP mode controls the voltage applied 2801 to the TD sensor to make the TD sensor output about 3.0 V. Press "Execute" to start. After finishing this, the TD sensor output voltage is displayed. Use this mode only after installing the machine, changing the TD sensor, or adding new developer. Toner Overflow Sensor [0 = OFF, 1= ON] 2960* Selects whether or not the toner overflow sensor is activated. Grayscale Limit (SSP) Controls the halftone density level to prevent deterioration of the OPC. The 2972* halftone density is detected by the ID sensor, and the machine adjusts the intensity of the LD beam according to the upper/lower limit setting. Upper Limit [0 to 100 / 58 (C2b), 63 (C2c)/ 1vol ] Defines the upper limit for grayscale. 001 A larger value allows a wider range of halftones at the pale end of the scale. If the image contains pale areas with fuzzy borders surrounded by dark areas, reduce this value to make the borders clearer. Lower Limit [0 to 100 / 52 (C2b), 57 (C2c) / 1vol ] 002 Defines the lower limit for grayscale. A smaller value allows a wider range of halftones at the dark end of the scale. D129/D130 5-16 SM Main SP Tables-2 Grayscale Cycle (SSP) 2973* [0 to 1000 / 100 / 10 sheets ] Set s the halftone operation interval in order to prevent deterioration of the OPC. If the number of copies exceeds this setting, at the end of the job, or if the door is opened and closed, charge correction is executed. 2974* Image Density Adjustment Mode [1 to 5 / 3 / 1 ] 001 Adjusts image density. Changing this setting adjusts development bias and ID sensor output voltage that in turn raises or lowers image density. Charge Counter [0 to 1000000 / 0 / 1 sheets ] Set the number of pages to print after toner and carrier initialization before the charge input is increased to compensate for deterioration over time in 2980* the polarity of the carrier. The strength in the polarity of the carrier in the toner will eventually increase after a specified number of copies can compensate for this effect. SM 5-17 D129/D130 Service Tables decrease and cause lower charge output. Setting the charge output to Main SP Tables-3 5.5 MAIN SP TABLES-3 5.5.1 SP3-XXX: PROCESS 3001 P Sensor Setting Current [0 to 43 / 13 / 0.1 mA ] 001* Allows you to reset the PWM of the ID sensor LED to avoid a service call error after clearing NVRAM or replacing the NVRAM. The PWM data is stored by executing SP-3001-2. Initialization - Performs the ID sensor initial setting. ID sensor output for the bare drum 002 (VSG) is adjusted automatically to 4.0 ±0.2 V. Press "Execute" to start. Perform this setting after replacing or cleaning the ID sensor, replacing the drum, or clearing NVRAM. 3045* Toner End Setting DFU 001 ON/OFF 3902* [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0=Off, 1=On New PCU Detection (Not used) ON/OFF Setting [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: On, 1: Off 001 Turns on or off the new unit detection for the transfer belt unit and fusing unit. D129/D130 5-18 SM Main SP Tables-4 5.6 MAIN SP TABLES-4 5.6.1 SP4-XXX: SCANNER Sub Scan Mag. Adjustment 4008* Adjusts the magnification of the sub scan direction during scanning. Changing this value changes the scanner motor speed. [–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.1% ] L-Edge Regist Adjustment 4010* Adjusts the leading edge registration for scanning. [–2 to 2 / 0 / 0.1 mm ] As you enter a negative value, the image moves toward the leading edge. Scanner Erase Margin: Scale Adjusts scanning margins for the leading and trailing edges (sub scan) and Service Tables right and left edge (main scan). 4012* Do not adjust unless the customer desires a scanner margin greater than the printer margin. These settings are adjusted to erase shadows caused by the gap between the original and the scale of the scanner unit. SM 001 Book: Leading Edge [0 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 mm] 002 Book: Trailing Edge [0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm] 003 Book: Left [0 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 mm] 004 Book: Right [0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm] 005 ADF: Leading Edge [0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm] 007 ADF: Right [0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm] 008 ADF: Left [0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm] 5-19 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-4 Scanner Free Run 4013 Performs a scanner free run with the exposure lamp on or off. 001 Lamp: OFF [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 002 Lamp: ON 0=Off, 1=On 4014 Scan 001 HP Detection Enable Scanner free run with HP sensor check. 002 HP Detection Disable Scanner free run without HP sensor check. Dust Check This function checks the narrow scanning glass of the ADF for dust that can 4020* cause black lines in copies. If dust is detected a system banner message is displayed, but processing does not stop. Dust Detect: On/Off Issues a warning if there is dust on the narrow scanning glass of the ADF when the original size is detected before a job starts. This function can detect dust on the white plate above the scanning glass, as well as dust on the glass. Sensitivity of the level of detection is adjusted with SP4020-2. 001 [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Off. No dust warning. 1: On. Dust warning. This warning does not stop the job. Before switching this setting on, clean the ADF scanning glass and the white plate above the scanning glass. 002 Dust Detect: Lvl D129/D130 5-20 SM Main SP Tables-4 Adjusts the sensitivity for dust detection on the ADF scanning glass. This SP is available only after SP4020-1 is switched on. [0 to 8 / 4 / 1] If you see black streaks in copies when no warning has been issued, raise the setting to increase the level of sensitivity. If warnings are issued when you see not black streaks in copies, lower the setting. Dust that triggers a warning could move be removed from the glass by the originals in the feed path. If the dust is removed by passing originals, this is not detected and the warning remains on. Dust Reject: Lvl 003 Selects the level of the sub scan line correction when using the ARDF. [0 to 4 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF, 1: Weakest, 2: Weak, 3: Strong, 4: Strongest APS Operation Check Displays a code that represents the original size detected by the original sensors. ( "Input Check Table" in "Main SP Tables-9") Service Tables 4301 APS Min. Size Determines whether an original of non-standard size is detected as A5/HLT size by the APS sensor. 4303 0: No original 1: A5 - lengthwise (SEF) 2: A5 - Sideways (LEF) If "0" is selected, "Cannot detect original size" will be displayed. SM 5-21 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-4 8K/16K Detection [0 to 3 / 0 / 1 step] 0: Normal Detection ( the machine detects A4/LT size as A4 or LT, 4305 depending on the paper size setting) 1: A4-sideways LT-Lengthwise 2: LT-sideways A4-Lenghtwise 3: 8K 16K 4308* Scan Size Detection Detection ON/OFF Selects whether the machine detects the original size. 001 [0 to 1 / 1 / 1 step] 0: OFF 1: ON 4309* Scan Size Detect: Setting Original Density Thresh 001 Adjust the density for the scan size detection. [0 to 255 / 18 / 1 step] Detection Time 002 Adjust the detection time for scan size detection. [20 to 100 / 60 / 20 msec] Lamp ON: Delay Time 003 Adjust the timing when to lamp on for the scan size detection. [0 to 200 / 40 / 20 msec] LED PWM Duty 004 Adjust the light value for the scan size detection. [0 to 100 / 60 / 1 %] D129/D130 5-22 SM Main SP Tables-4 Scan Size Detect Value [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 digit] 4310 Displays the scanned data for the original width detection. 001 S1: R 002 S1: G 003 S1: B 004 S2: R 005 S2: G 006 S2: B 007 S3: R 008 S3: G 009 S3: B Each detection point (S1, S2, S3) in SP4310 is as follows. Service Tables SM 5-23 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-4 IPU Test Pattern Selects the IPU test Pattern. [0 to 28 / 0 / 1] 0: Scanned image 15: Gray pattern (1) 1: Gradation main scan A 16: Gray pattern (2) 2: Gradation main scan B 17: Gray pattern (3) 3: Gradation main scan C 18: Shading pattern 4: Gradation main scan D 19: Thin line pattern 5: Gradation sub scan (1) 20: Scanned + Grid pattern Test 6: Grid pattern (1) 21: Scanned + Gray scale Pattern 7: Slant grid pattern 22: Scanned + Color patch 8: Gradation K 23: Scanned + Slant Grid C 9: Gray patch 16 24: Scanned + Slant Grid D 10: Gray patch 16 (1) 25: Gray Scale 18 text 11: Gray patch 16 (2) 26: Gray Scale 18 photo 12: Gray patch 64 27: Gray Scale 256 text 13: Grid pattern (2) 28: Gray Scale 256 photo 4417 14: Color patch K 4429* Select Copy Data Security 001 Copying 002 Scanning 003 Fax Operation D129/D130 Adjusts the density of the embedded message with the copy data security unit. [0 to 3 / 3 / 1 ] 3: Darkest density 5-24 SM Main SP Tables-4 4450 Scan Image Path Selection Black Subtraction ON/OFF [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0=OFF, 1=ON 001 Uses or does not use the black reduction image path. SH ON/OFF [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0=OFF, 1=ON 002 Uses or does not use the shading image path. Printer Vector Correction 4540* This SP corrects the printer coverage of 12 hues (RY, YR, YG, etc. x 4 001-004 RY Phase: Option/R/G/B 005-008 YR Phase: Option/R/G/B 009-012 YG Phase: Option/R/G/B 013-016 GY Phase: Option/R/G/B 017-020 GC Phase: Option/R/G/B 021-024 CG Phase: Option/R/G/B Specifies the printer vector correction value. 025-028 CB Phase: Option/R/G/B [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ] 029-032 BC Phase: Option/R/G/B 033-036 BM Phase: Option/R/G/B 037-040 MB Phase: Option/R/G/B 041-044 MR Phase: Option/R/G/B 045-048 RM Phase: Option/R/G/B SM 5-25 D129/D130 Service Tables Colors [R, G, B, Option]) for a total of 48 parameters. Main SP Tables-4 4600 SBU Version 001 SBU ID Displays the ID of the SBU. 002 GASBU-N ID Displays the ID of the GASBU. 003 VSP5100 ID Displays the ID of the VSP5100. 4602 Scanner Memory Access 001 Scanner Memory Access 4603 Enables the read and write check for the SBU registers. AGC Execution 001 HP Detection Enable Executes the AGC with the scanner detection. 002 HP Detection Disable Executes the AGC with the scanner detection. 4609* Gray Balance Set: R Book Scan [-384 to 255 / -46 / 1 digit] 001 Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the red signal in Book Scan. DF Scan [-384 to 255 / -46 / 1 digit] 002 Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the red signal in DF Scan. 4610* Gray Balance Set: G Book Scan [-384 to 255 / -20 / 1 digit] 001 Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the green signal in Book Scan. DF Scan [-384 to 255 / -20 / 1 digit] 002 Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the green signal in DF Scan. D129/D130 5-26 SM Main SP Tables-4 4611* Gray Balance Set: B Book Scan [-384 to 255 / -28 / 1 digit] 001 Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the blue signal in Book Scan. DF Scan [-384 to 255 / -28 / 1 digit] 002 Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the blue signal in DF Scan. 4623 Black Level Adj. Display Latest: RE Color [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit] 001 Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even red signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Latest: RO Color [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit] 002 Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd red signal in the 4624 Service Tables SBU (color printing speed). RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal Black Level Adj. Display Latest: GE Color 001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit] Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even green signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Latest: GO Color 002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit] Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd green signal in the SBU (color printing speed). SM GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal 5-27 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-4 4625 Black Level Adj. Display Latest: BE Color 001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit] Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Latest: BO Color 002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit] Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed). BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal Analog Gain Adjust 4628 Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red. Only for the color scanner 001 Latest: R Color [0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit] Analog Gain Adjust 4629 Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green. SP4629-003 and -004 are used only for the color scanner model. 001 Latest: G Color [0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit] Analog Gain Adjust 4630 Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue. 001 Latest: B Color D129/D130 [0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit] 5-28 SM Main SP Tables-4 Digital Gain Adjust 4631 Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for RE or RO. 001 Latest: RE Color [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit] 002 Latest RO Color [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit] Digital Gain Adjust 4632 Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for GE or GO. 001 Latest: GE Color [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit] 002 Latest: GO Color [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit] Digital Gain Adjust 4633 001 Latest: BE Color [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit] 002 Latest: BO Color [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit] Service Tables Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for BE or BO. Scan Adjust Error 4645 Displays the error value of the white level or black level adjustment. 001 White level [0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 digit] 002 Black level [0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 digit] Scanner Hard Error Displays the result of the SBU connection check. 4647 [0 to 35535 / 0 / 1 ] Power-ON 0: OK, 1: SBU connection check failure If the SBU connection check fails, SC144-001, -002 or -003 occurs. SM 5-29 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-4 4654* Black Level Adj. Display Latest Correct Value: RE Color 001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even red signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Last Correct Value: RO Color 002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd red signal in the SBU (color printing speed). RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal 4655* Black Level Adj. Display Last Correct Value: GE Color 001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even green signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Last Correct Value: GO Color 002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even green signal in the SBU (color printing speed). GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal 4656* Black Level Adj. Display Last Correct Value: BE Color 001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed). D129/D130 5-30 SM Main SP Tables-4 Last Correct Value: BO Color 002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed). BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal Analog Gain Adjust 4658* Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red. 001 Last Correct Value: R Color [0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit ] Analog Gain Adjust 4659* Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green. SP4659-003 and -004 are used only for the color scanner model. [0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit ] Service Tables 001 Last Correct Value: G Color Analog Gain Adjust 4660* Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue. 001 Last Correct Value: B Color 4661* [0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit ] Digital Gain Adjust Last Correct Value: RE Color 001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even red signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Last Correct Value: RO Color 002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd red signal in the SBU (color printing speed). SM 5-31 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-4 RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal 4662* Digital Gain Adjust Last Correct Value: GE Color 001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even green signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Last Correct Value: GO Color 002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd green signal in the SBU (color printing speed). GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal 4663* Digital Gain Adjust Last Correct Value: BE Color 001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Last Correct Value: BO Color 002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed). BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal D129/D130 5-32 SM Main SP Tables-4 4673 Black Level Adj. Display Factory Setting: RE Color 001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the factory setting value of the 2nd black offset level rough adjustment for the even red signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Factory Setting: RO Color 002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the factory setting values of the 2nd black offset level rough adjustment for the odd red signal in the SBU (color printing speed). 4674 RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal Black Level Adj. Display Factory Setting: GE Color Service Tables 001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the factory setting value of the 2nd black offset level rough adjustment for the even green signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Factory Setting: GO Color 002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the factory setting values of the 2nd black offset level rough adjustment for the odd green signal in the SBU (color printing speed). SM GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal 5-33 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-4 4675 Black Level Adj. Display Factory Setting: BE Color 001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the factory setting value of the 2nd black offset level rough adjustment for the even blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Factory Setting: BO Color 002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the factory setting values of the 2nd black offset level rough adjustment for the odd blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed). BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal Analog Gain Adjust 4677 Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Red. SP4677-003 and -004 are used only for the color scanner model. 001 Factory Setting: R [ 0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit] Analog Gain Adjust 4678 Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Green. SP4678-003 and -004 are used only for the color scanner model. 001 Factory Setting: G [ 0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit] Analog Gain Adjust 4679 Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Blue. 001 Factory Setting: B D129/D130 [ 0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit] 5-34 SM Main SP Tables-4 4680* Digital Gain Adjust Factory Setting: RE Color 001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red. Factory Setting: RO Color 002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for odd Red. 4681* Digital Gain Adjust Factory Setting: GE Color 001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green. Factory Setting: GO Color 002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Service Tables Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for odd Green. 4682* Digital Gain Adjust Factory Setting: BE Color 001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue. Factory Setting: BO Color 002 Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for odd Blue. SM 5-35 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-4 Scan Image Density Adjustment Adjusts the white shading parameter when scanning an image with the ARDF. 4688* Adjusts the density level if the ID of outputs made in the DF and Platen mode is different. [80 to 120 / 98 / 1 % ] White Level Peak Read 4690 Displays the peak level of the white level scanning. 001 RE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] 002 RO White Level Peak Read 4691 Displays the peak level of the white level scanning. 001 GE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] 002 GO White Level Peak Read 4692 Displays the peak level of the white level scanning. 001 BE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] 002 BO Black Level Peak Read 4693 Displays the peak level of the black level scanning. 001 RE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] 002 RO D129/D130 5-36 SM Main SP Tables-4 Black Level Peak Read 4694 Display the peak level of the black level scanning. 001 GE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] 002 GO Black Level Peak Read 4695 Display the peak level of the black level scanning. 001 BE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] 002 BO 4802 DF Shading FreeRun 001 Lamp OFF [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] Executes the scanner free run of the shading movement with exposure lamp on or off. 002 Lamp ON Press "OFF" to stop this free run. Otherwise, the free Service Tables run continues. Moves the exposure lamp a short distance 4804 Home Position and immediately returns it to its home position. Touch [Execute] > "Completed" > [Exit] Carriage Save Moves the exposure lamp a short distance away from the home position and stops. Touch [Execute] > "Completed" > [Exit] 4806 Do SP4804 to return the exposure lamp to its home position. This SP is done before shipping the machine to another location. Cycling the machine power off/on also returns the exposure lamp to its home position. SM 5-37 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-4 SBU Test Pattern Change [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step] 1: Grid pattern 4807 2: Gradation main scan 3: Gradation sub scan 4 to 250: Default (Scanning Image) 4808 Factory Setting Input 002* Execution Flag Man Gamma Adj (DFU) Adjusts the offset data of the printer gamma for black in Photo mode or 4918 Letter mode. Touch [Change] to open the printer gamma screen. Enter the manual gamma adjustment screen. 4954 Read/Restore Std Read New Chart 001 Execute the scanning of the A4 chart. Recall Prev Chart 002 Clear the data of the scanned A4 chart. Read Std Chart 003 Execute the scanning of the A4 standard chart. Set Std Chart 004 Overwrite the standard data. Read/Restore Std [0 to 255 / 0 / 1] 005* Adjusts chromaticity rank. When replacing the scanner lamp, select a number according to the barcode on the new scanner lamp. D129/D130 5-38 SM Main SP Tables-4 4991 IPU Image Pass Selection DFU RGB Frame Memory Selects the image path. Enter the number to be selected using the 10-key pad. [0 to 11 / 2/ 1] 0 Scanner input RGB images 1 Scanner I/F RGB images 2 RGB images done by Shading correction (Shading ON, Black offset ON) 3 Shading data 4 Inner pattern data: Gray scale 5 RGB images done by Line skipping correction 6 RGB images done by Digital AE 7 RGB images done by Vertical line correction 8 RGB image done by Scanner gamma correction 9 RGB image done by Filtering correction 10 RGB images done by Full color ADS 11 RGB image done by Color correction SM 5-39 Service Tables 001 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-4 4993* High Light Correction Selects the Highlight correction level. 001 Sensitivity Selection [0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step] 0: weakest sensitivity 9: strongest sensitivity Selects the Highlight correction level. 002 Range Selection [0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step] 0: weakest skew correction, 9: strongest skew correction 4994* Text/Photo Detect Level Adj. High Compression PDF Selects the definition level between Text and Photo for high compression PDF. 001 [0 to 2 / 1 / 1 ] 0: Text priority 1: Normal 2: Photo priority D129/D130 5-40 SM Main SP Tables-5 5.7 MAIN SP TABLES-5 5.7.1 SP5-XXX: MODE mm/inch Display Selection 0: Europe/Asia (mm) 1: North America (inch) 5024* Selects the unit of measurement. After selection, turn the main power switch off and on. 5047* Paper Display Turns on or off the printed paper display on the LCD. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Not displayed, 1: Displayed Display IP Address 5055* Display or does not display the IP address on the LCD. Service Tables [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF, 1: ON 5056* Coverage Counter Display Display or does not display the coverage counter on the LCD. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Not displayed, 1: Displayed 5061* Toner Remaining Icon Display Change Display or does not display the remaining toner display icon on the LCD. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0: Not display, 1: Display SM 5-41 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 5071 Set Bypass Paper Size Display Turn on or off the paper size confirmation pop-up on the LED. This pop-up prevents mismatching between a paper size selected by the operation 001 panel and an actual paper size on the by-pass tray. [0 or 1 / 0 / -] 0: Off, 1: On 5104* A3/DLT Double Count (SSP) Specifies whether the counter is doubled for A3/DLT. "Yes" counts except from the bypass tray. When "Yes" is selected, A3 and DLT paper are counted twice, that is A4 x2 and LT x2 respectively. 5113* Optional Counter Type Default Optional Counter Type Selects the type of counter: 0: None 1: Key Card (RK3, 4) Japan only 001 2: Key Card Down 3: Pre-paid Card 4: Coin Rack 5: MF Key Card 11: Exp. Key Card (Add) 12: Exp. Key Card (Deduct) External Optional Counter Type Enables the SDK application. This lets you select a number for the external device for user access control. Note: "SDK" refers to software on an SD card. 002 [0 to 3 / 0 / 1] 0: None 1: Expansion Device 1 2: Expansion Device 2 3: Expansion Device 3 D129/D130 5-42 SM Main SP Tables-5 5114* Optional Counter I/F MF Key Card Extension 001 Use this SP and change the setting to "1" only when the "5" (MF Key Card) is selected with SP5113-001. [0: Not installed/ 1: Installed (scanning accounting)] Disable Copying Temporarily denies access to the machine. Japan Only 5118* [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Release for normal operation [Default] 1: Prohibit access to machine Mode Clear Opt. Counter Removal Selects if mode clear is done for an optional counter when an optional 5120* counter is removed. 0: Yes. (Always mode clear) 1: StandBy. (Mode clear before/after a job) Service Tables 2: No. (No mode clear) Counter Up Timing Determines whether the optional key counter counts up at paper feed-in or 5121* at paper exit. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0: Feed, 1: Exit F Size Original Setting Selects F size original setting. 5126* [0 to 2 / 0 / 1 step] 0: 8 1/2 x 13 (Foolscap) 1: 8 1/4 x 13 (Folio) 2: 8 x 13 (F) SM 5-43 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 APS Mode 5127* Selects whether the APS function is enabled or disabled with the contact of a pre-paid card or coin lock. 0: Disable (APS active) [Default], 1: Enable (APS not active) Paper Size Type Selection Selects the paper size (type) for both originals and copy paper. 5131* [0 to 2 / - / 1 step] 0: Japan, 1: North America, 2: Europe After changing the setting, turn the copier off and on. If the paper size of the archive files stored on the HDD is different, abnormal copies could result. Bypass Length Setting Sets up the by-pass tray for long paper. 5150 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Off [Default] 1: On. Sets the tray for feeding paper up to 600 mm long. With this SP selected on, paper jams are not detected in the paper path. App. Switch Method Determines whether the application screen is switched with a hardware 5162* switch or software switch. 0: Soft Key Set 1: Hard Key Set Fax Printing Mode at Optional Counter Off Enables or disables the automatic print out without an accounting device. 5167* This SP is used when the receiving fax is accounted for by an external accounting device. 0: Automatic printing 1: No automatic printing D129/D130 5-44 SM Main SP Tables-5 CE Login If you will change the printer bit switches, you must 'log in' to service mode 5169* with this SP before you go into the printer SP mode. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Off. Printer bit switches cannot be adjusted. 1: On. Printer bit switches can be adjusted. Paper Size Setting 5181* SM 001 Tray 1: 1 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF 002 Tray 1: 2 0: A3, 1: DLT 003 Tray 1: 3 0: B4, 1: LG 004 Tray 1: 4 0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF 005 Tray 2: 1 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF 006 Tray 2: 2 0: A3, 1: DLT 007 Tray 2: 3 0: B4, 1: LG 008 Tray 2: 4 0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF 009 Tray 3: 1 (Tandem) 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF 010 Tray 3: 2 0: A3, 1: DLT 011 Tray 3: 3 0: B4, 1: LG 012 Tray 3: 4 0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF 013 Tray 4: 1 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF 014 Tray 4: 2 0: A3, 1: DLT 015 Tray 4: 3 0: B4, 1: LG 016 Tray 4: 4 0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF 017 LCT [0 to 2 / - / 1 ] 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF, 2: B5 LEF 5-45 Service Tables Adjusts the paper size for each tray. [0 to 1 / - / 1] D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 RK4: Setting (Japan only) Enable or distance the prevention for RK4 (Accounting device) 5186 Disconnection. If the RK4 is disconnected for 10 seconds when this SP is set to "1 (Enable)", the machine automatically jams a sheet of paper and stops. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] Copy Nv Version 5188* Displays the NV version on the controller. External Controller Info. Settings 5193 DFU Limitless SW 5195* DFU Paper Exit After Staple End This SP determines whether a machine can continue to output paper if 5199 staple supply runs cannot continue to operate. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF. Paper cannot exit if no staples are available. 1: ON. Paper can exit with no staples. D129/D130 5-46 SM Main SP Tables-5 5212* Page Numbering Horizontally positions the page numbers 003 Duplex Printout Left/Right printed on both sides during duplexing. Position [–10 to 10/ 0 / 1 mm] 0 is center, minus is left, + is right. Vertically positions the page numbers printed 004 Duplex Printout High/Low on both sides during duplexing. Position [–10 to 10/ 0 / 1 mm] 0 is center, minus is down, + is up. 5302* Set Time Time Difference Sets the time clock for the local time. This setting is done at the factory before delivery. The setting is GMT expressed in minutes. [–1440 to 1440 / - / 1 min.] Service Tables Japan: +540 (Tokyo) 002 NA: -300 (NY) EU: +60 (Paris) CH: +480 (Peking) TW: +480 (Taipei) AS: +480 (Hong Kong) KO: +540 (Korea) SM 5-47 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 5307 Summer Time [0 to 1 / 1 (NA/EU), 0 (ASIA) / 1 /step] Setting 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 001 Enables or disables the summer time mode. Make sure that both SP5-307-3 and -4 are correctly set. Otherwise, this SP is not activated even if this SP is set to "1". Rule Set (Start) Specifies the start setting for the summer time mode. There are 8 digits in this SP. For months 1 to 9, the "0" cannot be input in the first digit, so the eight-digit setting for -2 or -3 becomes a seven-digit setting. 1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12] 3rd digit: The week of the month. [1 to 5] 003 4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 6 = Sunday to Saturday] 5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23] 7th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 9 / 1 hour /step] 8th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 5 / 10 minutes /step] For example: 3500010 The timer is advanced by 1 hour at am 0:00 on the 5th Sunday in March. The digits are counted from the left. Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to "1". Rule Set (End) Specifies the end setting for the summer time mode. There are 8 digits in this SP. 1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12] 004 3rd digit: The week of the month. [0 to 5] 4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 7 = Sunday to Saturday] 5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23] The 7th and 8 digits must be set to "00". The digits are counted from the left. Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to "1". D129/D130 5-48 SM Main SP Tables-5 User Code Count Clear 5404 Clears the counts of the user codes assigned by the key operator to restrict the use of the machine. Press [Execute] to clear. 5413 Lockout Setting Lockout On/Off [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF, 1:ON 001 Turns on or off the account lock for the local address book account. Lockout Threshold [1 to 10 / 5 / 1] 002 Sets the maximum trial times for accessing the address book account. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF (Lockout is not cancelled.) Cancellation On/Off 003 1: ON (Lockout is cancelled if a user ID and password are correctly entered after the lockout function has been executed and a specific time has passed.) Cancellation Time [1 to 9999 / 60 / 1 min] 004 Sets the interval of the retry for accessing the local address book account after the lockout function has been executed. This setting is enabled only if SP5413-3 is set to "1" (ON). SM 5-49 D129/D130 Service Tables Turns on or off the cancellation function of the account lockout. Main SP Tables-5 5414 Access Mitigation Mitigation ON / OFF Permits or does not permit consecutive access to the machine with the 001 same ID and password. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF (Permitted) 1: ON (Not permitted) Mitigation Time 002 Sets the prohibiting time for consecutive access to the machine with the same ID and password. [0 to 60 / 15 / 1 min] 5415* Password Attack Permissible Number [0 to 100 / 30 / 1 times] 001 Sets the threshold number of attempts to attack the system with random passwords to gain illegal access to the system. Detect Time [0 to 10 / 5 / 1 sec] 002 Sets a detection time to count a password attack. 5416* Access Information Access User Max Num [50 to 200 / 200 / 1 ] 001 Sets the number of users for the access exclusion and password attack detection function. Access Password Num [50 to 200 / 200 / 1 ] 002 Sets the number of passwords for the access exclusion and password attack detection function. Monitor interval [1 to 10 / 3 / 1 sec] 003 Sets the interval of watching out for user information and passwords. D129/D130 5-50 SM Main SP Tables-5 5417 Access Attack Access Permissible number [0 to 500 / 100 / 1] 001 Sets a limit on access attempts to prevent password cracking. Access Detect Time [10 to 30 / 10 / 1 sec] 002 Sets a detection time to count password cracking. Productivity Fall Weight [0 to 9 / 3 / 1 sec] 003 Sets the wait time to slow down the speed of certification when an excessive number of access attempts have been detected. Attack Max Num [50 to 200 / 200 / 1] 004 Sets a limit on the number of requests received for certification in order to slow down the certification speed when an excessive number of access attempts have been detected. These settings should be done with the System Administrator. 5420* These functions are enabled only after the user access feature has been enabled. [0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF 001 Copy Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the copy application. [0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF 011 Document Server Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the document server. [0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF 021 Fax Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the fax application. SM 5-51 D129/D130 Service Tables User Authentication Main SP Tables-5 [0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF Determines whether certification is required 031 Scanner before a user can use the scanner application. [0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF 041 Printer Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the printer application. 051 SDK1 [0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF 061 SDK2 Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the SDK application. 071 SDK3 [0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF Determines whether certification is required 081 Browser before a user can use the browser application. Authentication Error Code 5481 These SP codes determine how the authentication failures are displayed. [0 or 1 / 0 / -] 001 System Log Disp 0: OFF [Default], 1: ON Determines whether an error code appears in the system log after a user authentication failure occurs. [0 or 1 / 1 / 1] 0: OFF, 1: ON [Default] 002 Panel Disp Determines whether an error code appears on the operation panel after a user authentication failure occurs. D129/D130 5-52 SM Main SP Tables-5 MF KeyCard (Japan only) Sets up operation of the machine with a keycard. 5490 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Disabled. Cancels operation without a user code. 1: Enabled. Allows operation without a user code. 5501* PM Alarm PM Alarm Level 001 Sets the PM alarm interval. [0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 k copies/step] 0: No PM alarm Original Count Alarm (DFU) 002 Selects whether the PM alarm for the number of scans is enabled or not. If this is "1", the PM alarm function is enabled. Jam Alarm Sets the alarm to sound for the specified jam level (document misfeeds are not included). 5504* [0 to 3 / 3 / 1 step] 0: Zero (Off) 1: Low (2.5K jams) 2: Medium (3K jams) 3: High (6K jams) SM 5-53 D129/D130 Service Tables [0 = No / 1 = Yes] Main SP Tables-5 Error Alarm Sets the number of sheets to clear the error alarm counter. The error alarm counter counts "1" when any SC is detected. However, the error alarm counter decreases by "1" when an SC is not detected during a 5505* set number of copied sheets (for example, default 5000 (C1b) or 10000 (C1c) sheets). The error alarm occurs when the SC error alarm counter reaches "5". [0 to 255 / 45 (C2b), 50 (C1b/C1.5b), 60 (C2c), 100 (C1c/C1.5c) / 100 copies / step] 5508 CC Call 001 Jam Remains 002 Continuous Jams 003 Continuous Door Open Enables/disables initiating a call. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Disable 1: Enable Sets the length of time to determine the 011 Jam Detection: Time Length length of an unattended paper jam. [3 to 30 / 10 / 1 minute] 012 Jam Detection Continuous Count Sets the number of continuous paper jams required to initiate a call. [2 to 10 / 5 / 1 time] Sets the length of time the remains opens 013 Door Open: Time Length to determine when to initiate a call. [3 to 30/ 10 / 1 minute] D129/D130 5-54 SM Main SP Tables-5 SC/Alarm Setting With @Remote in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an SC call when 5515* an SC error occurs. If this SP is switched off, the SC call is not issued when an SC error occurs. 001 SC Call 002 Service Parts Near End Call 003 Service Parts End Call 004 User Call 006 Communication Information Test Call [0 or 1 / 1 / 1] 0: OFF 007 Machine Information Notice 1: ON 008 Alarm Notice 010 Supply Automatic Ordering Call 011 Supply Management Report Call Service Tables 012 Jam/Door Open Call Individual PM Part Alarm Call 5516 With @Remote in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an PM alarm call when one of the SP parts reaches its yield. 001 Disable/Enable Setting (0: Not [0 or 1 / 1 / - ] send, 1: Send) 0: Not send, 1: Send 004 Percent yield for triggering PM alert [1 to 255 / 75 / 1 %/step] SM 5-55 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 Memory Clear 5801 Resets NVRAM data to the default settings. Before executing any of these SP codes, print an SMC Report. 001 All Clear 002 Engine Initializes items 2 to 15 below. Initializes all registration settings for the engine and copy process settings. Initializes default system settings, SCS (System 003 SCS Control Service) settings, operation display coordinates, and ROM update information. 004 IMH Memory Clr Initializes the image file system. (IMH: Image Memory Handler) Initializes the automatic delete time setting for stored 005 MCS documents. (MCS: Memory Control Service) 006 Copier application Initializes all copier application settings. Initializes the fax reset time, job login ID, all TX/RX 007 Fax Application settings, local storage file numbers, and off-hook timer. Initializes the printer defaults, programs registered, 008 Printer Application the printer SP bit switches, and the printer CSS counter. 009 Scanner Application Initializes the defaults for the scanner and all the scanner SP modes. Deletes the Netfile (NFA) management files and 010 Web Service thumbnails, and initializes the Job login ID. Netfiles: Jobs to be printed from the document server using a PC and the DeskTopBinder software D129/D130 5-56 SM Main SP Tables-5 Initializes the system defaults and interface settings (IP addresses also), the SmartDeviceMonitor for 011 NCS Admin settings, WebStatusMonitor settings, and the TELNET settings. (NCS: Network Control Service) 014 Clear DCS Setting 015 Clear UCS Setting 016 MIRS Setting 017 CCS 018 SRM Memory Clr SM Initializes the job login ID, SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin, job history, and local storage file numbers. Initializes the DCS (Delivery Control Service) settings. Initializes the UCS (User Information Control Service) settings. Initializes the MIRS (Machine Information Report Service) settings. Initializes the CCS (Certification and Charge-control Service) settings. Initializes the SRM (System Resource Manager) settings. 019 LCS Initializes the LCS (Log Count Service) settings. 020 Web Uapli Initializes the web user application settings. 021 ECS Initializes ECS (Engine Control Service). 023 AICS Initializes the AICS settings. 5-57 Service Tables 012 R-FAX D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 FreeRun Performs a free run on the copier engine. The correct paper should be loaded in the 1st tray or 2nd tray, but paper is 5802* not fed. The main switch has to be turned off and on after using the free run mode for a test. 001 TRAY1:A4LEF - 002 TRAY2:A3 - 003 TRAY2:A4SEF - Input Check 5803 Displays the signals received from sensors and switches. ( "Input Check Table" in "Main SP Tables-9") Output Check 5804 Turns on the electrical components individually for test purposes. ( "Output Check Table" in "Main SP Tables-9") Anti-Condensation Heater 5805 [0 or 1 / 0 / -] 0:OFF / 1:ON 5810 SC Reset Resets all level A service call conditions, such as 001 Fusing SC Reset fusing errors. To clear the service call, touch "Execute" on the LCD, then turn the main power switch off/on. D129/D130 5-58 SM Main SP Tables-5 MachineSerial 5812* 002 Display Displays the machine serial number. 003 BCU Inputs the serial number. 005 FRAM Displays the FRAM serial number. Service Tel. No. Setting 001 Service 002 Facsimile 003 Supply 004 Operation 5816 Inputs the telephone number of the CE (displayed when a service call condition occurs.) Use this to input the fax number of the CE printed on the Counter Report (UP mode). Inputs the telephone number of the supplier displayed on the user mode screen. Allows the service center contact telephone number to be displayed on the user mode screen. Service Tables 5811 Remote Service I/F Setting Selects the remote service setting. 001 [0 to 2 / 2 / 1 /step] 0: Remote service off 1: CSS remote service on 2: @Remote service on CE Call Performs the CE Call at the start or end of the service. 002 [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Start of the service 1: End of the service NOTE: This SP is activated only when SP 5816-001 is set to “2”. SM 5-59 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 Function Flag Enables or disables the remote service function. 003 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled NOTE: This SP setting is changed to "1" after @Remote registration has been completed. Communication Test Call 004 This SP issues a test call from a GW machine to determine whether it can communicate successfully with the call center after it has been set up for NRS. Successful return will be in the range 0 to 99. Device Information Call 005 This SP issues a call to notify the NRS device information to the call center. Successful return will be in the range 0 to 99. SSL Disable Uses or does not use the RCG certification by SSL when calling the RCG. 007 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Uses the RCG certification 1: Does no use the RCG certification RCG Connect Timeout 008 Specifies the connect timeout interval when calling the RCG. [1 to 90 / 30 / 1 second /step] RCG Write Timeout 009 Specifies the write timeout interval when calling the RCG. [0 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step] RCG Read Timeout 010 Specifies the read timeout interval when calling the RCG. [0 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step] D129/D130 5-60 SM Main SP Tables-5 Port 80 Enable 011 Enables/disables access via port 80 to the SOAP method. [0 or 1 / 0 / – ] 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled @Remote Communication Permission [0 to 2 / 1 / 1 ] 012 0: Not permitted 1: Permitted 2: Partially limited RFU (Remote Firmware Update) Timing Selects the RFU timing. 013 [0 or 1 / 1 / – ] 0: RFU is executed whenever update request is received. 1: RFU is executed only when the machine is in the sleep mode. RCG Error Cause Service Tables [0 or 1 / 0 / – ] 014 0: Normal 1: Fails to reflect the client/server certificate settings by network failure to reboot. Transition to 0 on restarting the machine. RCG–C Registed 021 This SP displays the Embedded RC Gate installation end flag. 0: Installation not completed 1: Installation completed Connect Type (N/M) This SP displays and selects the Embedded RC Gate connection method. 023 [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step 0: Internet connection 1: Dial-up connection SM 5-61 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 Cert. Expire Timing DFU 061 Proximity of the expiration of the certification. Use Proxy 062 This SP setting determines if the proxy server is used when the machine communicates with the service center. Proxy Host This SP sets the address of the proxy server used for communication between Embedded RC Gate-N and the gateway. Use this SP to set up or display the customer proxy server address. The address is necessary to set 063 up Embedded RC Gate-N. The address display is limited to 128 characters. Characters beyond the 128 character are ignored. This address is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report. Proxy Port Number This SP sets the port number of the proxy server used for communication between Embedded RC Gate-N and the gateway. This setting is necessary to 064 set up Embedded RC Gate-N. This port number is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report. Proxy User Name This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification user name. 065 The length of the name is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st character is ignored. This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report. D129/D130 5-62 SM Main SP Tables-5 Proxy Password This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification password. 066 The length of the password is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st character is ignored. This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report. CERT: Up State Displays the status of the certification update. 1 2 3 4 067 11 12 The certification used by Embedded RC Gate is set correctly. The certification request (setAuthKey) for update has been received from the GW URL and certification is presently being updated. The certification update is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the successful update. The certification update failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the failed update. Service Tables 0 The period of the certification has expired and new request for an update is being sent to the GW URL. A rescue update for certification has been issued and a rescue certification setting is in progress for the rescue GW connection. The rescue certification setting is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the certification update request. The notification of the request for certification update has completed 13 successfully, and the system is waiting for the certification update request from the rescue GW URL. 14 15 SM The notification of the certification request has been received from the rescue GW controller, and the certification is being stored. The certification has been stored, and the GW URL is being notified of the successful completion of this event. 5-63 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 16 The storing of the certification has failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the failure of this event. The certification update request has been received from the GW URL, 17 the GW URL was notified of the results of the update after it was completed, but a certification error has been received, and the rescue certification is being recorded. 18 The rescue certification of No. 17 has been recorded, and the GW URL is being notified of the failure of the certification update. CERT: Error Displays a number code that describes the reason for the request for update of the certification. 0 1 068 2 3 Normal. There is no request for certification update in progress. Request for certification update in progress. The current certification has expired. An SSL error notification has been issued. Issued after the certification has expired. Notification of shift from a common authentication to an individual certification. 4 Notification of a common certification without ID2. 5 Notification that no certification was issued. 6 Notification that GW URL does not exist. 069 CERT: Up ID The ID of the request for certification. 083 Firm Up Status Displays the status of the firmware update. This SP setting determines if the operator can confirm the previous version of the firmware before the firmware update execution. If the 085 Firm Up User Check option to confirm the previous version is selected, a notification is sent to the system manager and the firmware update is done with the firmware files from the URL. D129/D130 5-64 SM Main SP Tables-5 Allows the service technician to confirm the size 086 Firmware Size of the firmware data files during the firmware update execution. 087 CERT: Macro Ver. 088 CERT: PAC Ver. Displays the macro version of the @Remote certification. Displays the PAC version of the @Remote certification. Displays ID2 for the @Remote certification. Spaces are displayed as underscores (_). 089 CERT: ID2 Code Asteriskes (*) indicate that no @Remote certification exists. "000000___________" indicates "Common certification". Displays the common name of the @Remote certification subject. CN = the following 17 bytes. 090 CERT: Subject Spaces are displayed as underscores (_). Asterisks (*) indicate that no @Remote certification exists. "000000___________" Service Tables indicates "Common certification". Displays serial number for the @Remote 091 CERT: SerialNo. certification. Asterisks (*) indicate that no @Remote certification exists. Displays the common name of the issuer of the 092 CERT: Issuer @Remote certification. CN = the following 30 bytes. Asteriskes () indicate that no @Remote certification exists. 093 CERT: Valid Start 094 CERT: Valid End Displays the start time of the period for which the current @Remote certification is enabled. Displays the end time of the period for which the current @Remote certification is enabled. Server CN Check 096 Not used SM 5-65 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 GW Host 096 Not used GW URL Path 097 Not used Debug RescueG/WURL Set 099 Not used CERT: Encrypt Level Displays the encryption level for the NRS certificate. 102* [1 or 2 / 1 / – ] 1: Indicates that the certificate encryption level is 512 bits. 2: Indicates that the certificate encryption level is 2048 bits. Selection Country 150 Not used Line Type Automatic Judgment 151 Not used Line Type Judgment Result 152 Not used Selection Dial / Push 153 Not used Outside Line Outgoing Number 154 Not used Dial Up User Name 156 Not used D129/D130 5-66 SM Main SP Tables-5 Dial Up Password 157 Not used Local Phone Number 161 Not used Connection Timing Adjustment Incoming 162 Not used Access Point 163 Not used Line Connecting 164 Not used Modem Serial No. 173 Not used Retransmission Limit Service Tables 174 Not used RCG-C M DebugBitSW 186 Not used FAX TX Priority 187 Not used SM 5-67 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 Manual Polling 200 Executes the manual polling. Regist Status Displays a number that indicates the status of the @Remote service device. 0: Neither the @Remote device nor Embedded RCG Gate is set. 1: The Embedded RCG Gate is being set. Only Box registration is completed. 201 In this status, @Remote device cannot communicate with this device. 2: The Embedded RCG Gate is set. In this status, the @Remote device cannot communicate with this device. 3: The @Remote device is being set. In this status the Embedded RCG Gate cannot be set. 4: The @Remote module has not started. 202 Letter Number 203 Confirm Execute Allows entry of the request number needed for the Embedded RCG Gate. Executes the confirmation request to the @Remote Gateway. 204 Confirm Result Displays a number that indicates the result of the confirmation executed with SP5816-203. 0: Succeeded 1: Confirmation number error 2: Registration in progress 3: Proxy error (proxy enabled) 4: Proxy error (proxy disabled) 5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password) 6: Communication error 7: Certification update error 8: Other error 9: Confirmation executing D129/D130 5-68 SM Main SP Tables-5 Confirm Place 205 Displays the result of the notification sent to the device from the Gateway in answer to the confirmation request. Displayed only when the result is registered at the Gateway. 206 Register Execute Executes "Embedded RCG Registration". Register Result Displays a number that indicates the registration result. 0: Succeeded 2: Registration in progress 3: Proxy error (proxy enabled) 207 4: Proxy error (proxy disabled) 5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password) 6: Communication error 7: Certification update error 8: Other error 9: Registration executing Displays a number that describes the error code that was issued when either SP5816-204 or SP5816-207 was executed. Cause Illegal Modem 208 Parameter Code Meaning -11001 Chat parameter error -11002 Chat execution error -11003 Unexpected error -12002 Operation Error, Incorrect Setting -12003 -12004 SM Inquiry, registration attempted without acquiring device status. Attempted registration without execution of an inquiry and no previous registration. Attempted setting with illegal entries for certification and ID2. 5-69 D129/D130 Service Tables Error Code Main SP Tables-5 @Remote communication is prohibited. -12005 The device has an Embedded RC gate-related problem. A confirmation request was made after -12006 the confirmation had been already completed. The request number used at registration -12007 was different from the one used at confirmation. -12008 -12009 -12010 Update certification failed because mainframe was in use. ID2 mismatch between an individual certification and NVRAM Certification area is not initialized. Attempted dial up overseas without the -2385 correct international prefix for the telephone number. Error Caused by -2387 Not supported at the Service Center Response from GW -2389 Database out of service -2390 Program out of service -2391 Two registrations for same device -2392 Parameter error -2393 RCG device not managed -2394 Device not managed -2395 Box ID for RCG device is illegal -2396 Device ID for RCG device is illegal -2397 Incorrect ID2 format -2398 Incorrect request number format URL D129/D130 5-70 SM Main SP Tables-5 Releases the machine from its Embedded RCG 209 Instl Clear Gate setup. NOTE: Turn off and on the main power switch after this setting has been changed. 250 CommLog Print 5821* Prints the communication log. Remote Service Address Sets the IP address of the RCG (Remote 002 RCG IP Address Communication Gate) destination for call processing at the remote service center. [00000000h to FFFFFFFFh / 00000000h / 1] Sets the port number of the RCG (Remote 003 RCG Port Communication Gate) destination for call processing at the remote service center. [0 to 65535 / 443 / 1] Sets the URL path of the RCG (Remote Communication Gate) destination for call processing at the remote service center. Service Tables 004 RCG URL Path [0 to 16 characters / /RCG/services/ /-] NV-RAM Data Upload 5824 Uploads the NVRAM data to an SD card. Push Execute. Note: When uploading data in this SP mode, the front door must be open. NV-RAM Data Download 5825 Downloads data from an SD card to the NVRAM in the machine. After downloading is completed, remove the card and turn the machine power off and on. SM 5-71 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 5828 Network Setting IPv4 Address (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11) 001 This SP allows you to check and reset the IPv4 address for Ethernet and wireless LAN (802.11): aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd IPv4 Subnet Mask (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11) 002 This SP allows you to check and reset the IPv4 subnet mask for Ethernet and wireless LAN (802.11): aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd IPv4 Default Gateway (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11) 003 This SP allows you to check and reset the IPv4 default gateway used by the network for Ethernet and wireless LAN (802.11): aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd DHCP (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11) This SP code allows you check and change the setting that determines whether the IP address is used with DHCP on an Ethernet or wireless 006 (802.11) LAN network. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Not used (manual setting) 1: Used Active IPv4 Address 021 This SP allows you to check the IPv4 address that was used when the machine started up with DHCP. Active IPv4 Subnet Mask 022 This SP allows you to check the IPv4 subnet mask setting that was used when the machine started up with DHCP. D129/D130 5-72 SM Main SP Tables-5 Active IPv4 Gateway Address 023 This SP allows you to check the IPv4 default gateway setting that was used when the machine started up with DHCP. Enables and disables bi-directional 050 1284 Compatibility (Centro) communication on the parallel connection between the machine and a computer. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1 ] 0:Off, 1: On Disables and enables the ECP feature (1284 052 ECP (Centro) Mode) for data transfer. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Switches the job spooling on and off. 065 Job Spooling [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: No spooling, 1: Spooling enabled This SP determines whether the job interrupted 066 Job Spooling Clear: Start Time This SP operates only when SP5828-065 is set to "1". [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 1: OFF Resumes printing spooled jog. 0: ON Clears spooled job. This SP determines whether job spooling is enabled or disabled for each protocol. This is a Job Spooling (Protocol) 8-bit setting. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: No spooling, 1: Spooling enabled 069 SM 0 LPR 4 BMLinks (Japan Only) 1 FTP (Not Used) 5 DIPRINT 2 IPP 6 Reserved (Not Used) 3 SMB 7 Reserved (Not Used) 5-73 D129/D130 Service Tables at power off is resumed at the next power on. Main SP Tables-5 Disables or enables Telnet operation. If this SP 090 TELNET is disabled, the Telnet port is closed. (0:OFF 1:ON) [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Disable, 1: Enable 091 Web (0:OFF 1:ON) Disables or enables the Web operation. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Disable, 1: Enable This is the IPv6 local address referenced on the Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11) in the format: 145 Active IPv6 Link Local Address "Link-Local address" + "Prefix Length" The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each. These notations can be abbreviated. See "Note: IPV6 Addresses " below this table. 147 149 151 153 155 Active IPv6 Stateless Address 1 Active IPv6 Stateless Address 2 These SPs are the IPv6 stateless addresses (1 to 5) referenced on the Ethernet or wireless LAN Active IPv6 Stateless (802.11b) in the format: Address 3 "Stateless Address" + "Prefix Length" Active IPv6 Stateless Address 4 The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each. Active IPv6 Stateless Address 5 IPv6 Manual Address This SP is the IPv6 manually set address referenced on the Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11) in the format: 156 "Manual Set Address" + "Prefix Length" The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each. These notations can be abbreviated. See "Note: IPV6 Addresses" below this table. D129/D130 5-74 SM Main SP Tables-5 IPv6 Gateway Address This SP is the IPv6 gateway address referenced on the Ethernet or wireless 158 LAN (802.11). The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each. These notations can be abbreviated. See "Note: IPV6 Addresses" below this table. Note: IPV6 Addresses Ethernet and the Wireless LAN (802.11) reference the IPV6 "Link-Local address + Prefix Length". The IPV6 address consists of 128 bits divided into 8 blocks of 16 bits: aaaa:bbbb:cccc:dddd:eeee:ffff:gggg:hhhh: The prefix length is inserted at the 17th byte (Prefix Range: 0x0 to 0x80). The initial setting is 0x40 (64). For example, the data: "2001123456789012abcdef012345678940h" is expressed: "2001:1234:5678:9012:abcd:ef01:2345:6789": prefixlen 64 However, the actual IPV6 address display is abbreviated according to the following rules. Rules for Abbreviating IPV6 Addresses 1. The IPV6 address is expressed in hexadecimal delimited by colons (:) with the following characters: 2. Service Tables 0123456789abcdefABCDEF A colon is inserted as a delimiter every 4th hexadecimal character. fe80:0000:0000:0000:0207:40ff:0000:340e 3. The notations can be abbreviated by eliminating zeros where the MSB and digits following the MSB are zero. The example in "2" above, then, becomes fe80:0:0:0207:40ff:0:340e 4. Sections where only zeros exist can be abbreviated with double colons (::). This abbreviation can be done also where succeeding sections contain only zeros (but this can be done only at one point in the address). The example in "2" and "3" above then becomes: fe80::207:40ff:0:340e (only the first null sets zero digits are abbreviated as "::") -orfe80:0:0:0:207:40ff::340e (only the last null set before "340e" is abbreviated as "::") SM 5-75 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 Enable or disables the automatic setting for IPv6 161 IPv6 Stateless Auto stateless. Setting [0 or 1 / 1 / 1] 1: Enable, 0: Disable Web Item visible Displays or does not display the Web system items. 236 [0 x 0000 to 0 x ffff / 0 x ffff] 0: Not displayed, 1: Displayed bit0: Net RICOH bit1: Consumable Supplier bit2-15: Reserved (all) Web shopping link visible Displays or does not display the link to Net RICOH on the top page and link 237 page of the web system. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Not display, 1:Display Web supplies Link visible Displays or does not display the link to Consumable Supplier on the top 238 page and link page of the web system. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Not display, 1:Display Web Link1 Name 239 This SP confirms or changes the URL1 name on the link page of the web system. The maximum characters for the URL name are 31 characters. Web Link1 URL 240 his SP confirms or changes the link to URL1 on the link page of the web system. The maximum characters for the URL are 127 characters. D129/D130 5-76 SM Main SP Tables-5 Web Link1 visible Displays or does not display the link to URL1 on the top page of the web 241 system. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Not display, 1:Display 242 Web Link2 Name Same as "-239" 243 Web Link2 URL Same as "-240" 244 Web Link2 visible Same as "-241" DHCPv6 DUID Sets DHCPv6 DUID. 249 [0000000000000000000000000000h to FFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFh / 0000000000000000000000000000h / -] 5832 Enter the SP number for the partition to initialize, then press #. When the execution ends, cycle the machine off and on. 001 HDD Formatting (All) 002 HDD Formatting (IMH) 003 HDD Formatting (Thumbnail) 004 HDD Formatting (Job Log) 005 HDD Formatting (Printer Fonts) 006 HDD Formatting (User Info) 007 Mail RX Data 008 Mail TX Data 009 HDD Formatting (Data for Design) SM 5-77 D129/D130 Service Tables HDD Main SP Tables-5 010 HDD Formatting (Log) 011 HDD Formatting (Ridoc I/F) (for Ridoc Desk Top Binder) 5836* Capture Setting Capture Function (0:Off 1:On) With this function disabled, the settings related to the capture feature cannot 001 be initialized, displayed, or selected. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Disable, 1: Enable Panel Setting Determines whether each capture related setting can be selected or 002 updated from the initial system screen. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Disable, 1: Enable The setting for SP5836-001 has priority. [0 to 6 / 0 / 1] 072 Reduction for Copy B&W Text 0:1, 1:1/2, 2:1/3, 3:1/4, 6:2/3 [0 to 6 / 0 / 1] 073 Reduction for Copy B&W Other 0:1, 1:1/2, 2:1/3, 3:1/4, 6:2/3 [0 to 6 / 0 / 1] 075 Reduction for Printer B&W 0 1, 1:1/2, 2:1/3, 3:1/4, 6:2/3 078 Reduction for Printer B&W 1200 1: 1/2, 3: 1/4, 4: 1/6, 5: 1/8 [0 to 3 / 1 / 1] 082 Format for Copy B&W Text 0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR, 2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR D129/D130 5-78 SM Main SP Tables-5 [0 to 3 / 1 / 1] 083 Format Copy B&W Other 0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR, 2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR [0 to 3 / 1 / 1] 085 Format for Printer B&W 0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR, 2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR Default for JPEG [5 to 95 / 50 / 1] Sets the JPEG format default for documents sent to the document 091 management server with the MLB, with JPEG selected as the format. Enabled only when optional File Format Converter (MLB: Media Link Board) is installed. Sets the IP address for the primary capture 101 Primary srv IP address server. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 103 Primary srv port number 104 Primary srv URL path This is basically adjusted by the remote system. This is basically adjusted by the remote Service Tables 102 Primary srv scheme system. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. Sets the IP address for the secondary capture 111 Secondary srv IP address server. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 112 Secondary srv scheme 113 Secondary srv port number 114 Secondary srv URL path SM This is basically adjusted by the remote system. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 5-79 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 120 Default Reso Rate Switch 122 Reso: Copy (Mono) This is basically adjusted by the remote system. [0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step] Selects the resolution for BW copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi This is basically adjusted by the remote 124 Reso: Print (Mono) system. [0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step] Selects the resolution for BW print mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi This is basically adjusted by the remote 126 Reso: Fax (Mono) system. [0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step] Selects the resolution for BW fax mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi This is basically adjusted by the remote 127 Reso: Scan (Color) system. [0 to 255 / 4 / 1/step] Selects the resolution for color scanning mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi This is basically adjusted by the remote 128 Reso: Scan (Mono) system. [0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step] Selects the resolution for BW scanning mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi D129/D130 5-80 SM Main SP Tables-5 141 All Addr Info Switch [0 or 1 / 1 / -] 0: Off, 1: On Turns on or off all the address information transmission for the captured resources. 142 Stand-by Doc Max Number [10 to 9999 / 2000 / 1/step] Selects the maximum number of captured documents to be transmitted to the document server. 5840* IEEE 802.11 Channel MAX Sets the maximum range of the bandwidth for the wireless LAN. This 006 bandwidth setting varies for different countries. [1 to 14 / 11 (NA), 13 (EU), 14 (JPN) / 1] JPN: 1 to 14, NA: 1 to 11, EU: 1 to 13 Sets the minimum range of the bandwidth for operation of the wireless LAN. 007 This bandwidth setting varies for different countries. [1 to 14 / 1 / 1] JPN: 1 to 14, NA: 1 to 11, EU: 1 to 13 Transmission speed [0 x 00 to 0 x FF / 0 x FF to Auto / -] 0 x FF to Auto [Default] 0 x 11 - 55M Fix 0 x 10 - 48M Fix 008 0 x 0F - 36M Fix 0 x 07 - 11M Fix 0 x 05 - 5.5M Fix 0 x 08 - 1M Fix 0 x 0E - 18M Fix 0 x 13 - 0 x FE (reserved) 0 x 0D - 12M Fix 0 x 12 - 72M (reserved) 0 x 0B - 9M Fix 0 x 09 - 22M (reserved) 0 x 0A - 6M Fix SM 5-81 D129/D130 Service Tables Channel MIN Main SP Tables-5 WEP Key Select Selects the WEP key. 011 Bit 1 and 0 00: Key1, 01: Key2 (Reserved), 10: Key3 (Reserved), 11: Key4(Reserved) This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed. RTS/CTS Thresh 013 Adjusts the RTS/CTS threshold for the IEEE802.11 card. [0 to 3000 / 2432 / 1] This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed. Fragment Thresh 042 Adjusts the fragment threshold for the IEEE802.11 card. [256 to 2346 / 2346 / 1] This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed. 11g CTS to Self 043 Determines whether the CTS self function is turned on or off. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Off, 1: On This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed. 11g Slot Time 044 Selects the slot time for IEEE802.11. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: 20 m, 1: 9 m This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed. WPA Debug Lvl 045 Selects the debug level for WPA authentication application. [1 to 3 / 3 / 1] 1: Info, 2: warning, 3: error This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed. D129/D130 5-82 SM Main SP Tables-5 Supply Name Setting 5841* Press the User Tools key. These names appear when the user presses the Inquiry button on the User Tools screen. 001 Toner Name Setting: Black 007 OrgStamp 011 StapleStd1 012 StapleStd2 013 StapleStd3 014 StapleStd4 021 StapleBind1 022 StapleBind2 023 StapleBind3 USB Service Tables 5844 Transfer Rate 001 Sets the speed for USB data transmission. [0 x 01 or 0 x 04 / 0 x 04 /-] 0 x 01 [Full Speed], 0 x 04 [Auto Change] Vendor ID 002 Sets the vendor ID: Initial Setting: 0x05A Ricoh Company [0x0000 to 0xFFFF/1] (DFU) Product ID 003 Sets the product ID. [0x0000 to 0xFFFF/1] (DFU) SM 5-83 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 Device Release No. Sets the device release number of the BCD (binary coded decimal) display. 004 [0000 to 9999 / 100 / 1] (DFU) Enter as a decimal number. NCS converts the number to hexadecimal number recognized as the BCD. 005 Fixed USB Port This SP standardizes for common use the model name and serial number for USB PnP (Plug & Play). It determines whether the driver requires re-installation. [0 to 2 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF 1: Level 1 2: Level 2 006 PnP Model Name This SP sets the model name to be used by the USB PnP when "Function Enable (Level 2) is set so the USB Serial No. can have a common name (SP5844-5). Default: Laser Printer (up to 20 characters allowed). 007 PnP Serial Number This SP sets the serial number to be used by the USB PnP when "Function Enable (Level 2) set so the USB Serial No. can have a common name (SP5844-5). Default: None (up to 12 characters allowed for entry). Make sure that this entry is the same as the serial number in use. At initialization the serial number generated from the model name is used, not the setting of this SP code. D129/D130 At times other than initialization, the value set for this SP code is used. 5-84 SM Main SP Tables-5 100 Notify Unsupport This SP determines whether an alert message appears on the control panel when a USB device (unsupported device) that cannot use an A-connector is connected. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Function enable 1: Function disable An unsupported device is a device that cannot use the functions of the USB device. For example, a USB mouse cannot be used even if it connected. If the PictBridge option is not mounted, even if a digital camera is connected it cannot be used because it is an unsupported device. Delivery Server Setting 5845* These are delivery server settings. FTP Port No. 001 Service Tables [0 to 65535 / 3670 / 1] IP Address (Primary) 002 Use this SP to set the Scan Router Server address. The IP address under the transfer tab can be used with the initial system setting. [Range: 000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255] Delivery Error Display Time Use this setting to set the length of time that the message is shown when a 006 test error occurs during document transfer with the NetFile application and an external device. [0 to 999 / 300 / 1 sec] IP Address (Secondary) Sets the IP address that is given to the computer that is the secondary 008 delivery server for Scan Router. This SP lets you set only the IP address, and does not refer to the DNS setting. [Range: 000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255] SM 5-85 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 Delivery Server Model Lets you change the model of the delivery server that is registered by the I/O device. [0 to 4 / 0 / 1 step] 009 0: Unknown 1: SG1 Provided 2: SG1 Package 3: SG2 Provided 4: SG2 Package Delivery Svr. Capability Changes the functions that the registered I/O device can do. [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 step] Bit7 = 1 Comment information exits Bit6 = 1 Direct specification of mail address possible 010 Bit5 = 1 Mail RX confirmation setting possible Bit4 = 1 Address book automatic update function exists Bit3 = 1 Fax RX delivery function exists Bit2 = 1 Sender password function exists Bit1 = 1 Function to link MK-1 user and Sender exists Bit0 = 1 Sender specification required (if set to 1, Bit6 is set to "0") Delivery Svr.Capability (Ext) 011 These settings are for future use. They will let you increase the number of registered devices (in addition to those registered for SP5845 010). There are eight bits (Bit 0 to Bit 7). All are unused at this time. 013 Server Scheme (Primary) 014 Server port Number (Primary) [1 to 65535 / 80 / 1] 015 Server URL Path (Primary) 016 Server Scheme (Secondary) 017 Server Port Number(Secondary) [1 to 65535 / 80 / 1] 018 Server URL Path (Secondary) D129/D130 5-86 SM Main SP Tables-5 [0 to 1 / 1 / -] Rapid Sending Control 0: Disable, 1: Enable 022 Enables or disables the prevention function for the continuous data sending error. 5846* UCS Setting Machine ID (for Delivery Server) Displays the unique device ID in use by the delivery server directory. The 001 value is only displayed and cannot be changed. This ID is created from the NIC MAC or IEEE 1394 EUI. The ID is displayed as either 6-byle or 8-byte binary. Machine ID Clear (for Delivery Server) Clears the unique ID of the device used as the name in the file transfer 002 directory. Execute this SP if the connection of the device to the delivery server is unstable. After clearing the ID, the ID will be established again automatically by cycling the machine off and on. Service Tables Maximum Entries Changes the maximum number of entries that UCS can handle. 003 [2000 to 20000 / 2000 / 1 step] If a value smaller than the present value is set, the UCS managed data is cleared, and the data (excluding user code information) is displayed. Delivery Server Retry Timer Sets the interval for retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire 006 the delivery server address book. [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 step] 0: No retries SM 5-87 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 Delivery Server Retry Times 007 Sets the number of retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire the delivery server address book. [0 to 255 / 0 / 1step] Delivery Server Maximum Entries 008 Lets you set the maximum number of account entries and information about the users of the delivery server controlled by UCS. [2000 to 20000 / 2000 / 1 step] LDAP Search Timeout 010 Sets the length of the time-out for the search of the LDAP server. [1 to 255 / 60 /1 step] WSD Maximum Entries 020 WSD (Web Services on Devices) is the Microsoft standard for connectivity to web-service enabled devices. [50 to 250 / 250 / 1] Folder Auth Change This SP determines whether the user login information (Login User name and Password) or address (destination setting in the address book for Scan-to-SMB) is used to permit folder access. The machine must be cycled 021 off/on for this setting to take effect if it is changed. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Login User Uses operator login information (initial value of main machine) 1: Destination Uses address authorization information Initial Value of Upper Limit Count 022 [0 to 999999 / 500 / 1] D129/D130 5-88 SM Main SP Tables-5 Addr Book Migration (USB -> HDD) This SP moves the address book data from the SD card or flash ROM on the controller board to the HDD. You must cycle the machine off and on after executing this SP. 1. Turn the machine off. 2. Install the HDD. 3. Turn the machine on. 4. Do SP5846 040. 040 5. Turn the machine off/on. Executing this SP overwrites any address book data already on the HDD with the data from the flash ROM on the controller board. We recommend that you back up all directory information to an SD card with SP5846-051 before you execute this SP. After the address book data is copied to HDD, all the address book data is deleted from the flash ROM. If the operation fails, the data is not erased from the flash ROM. This SP must be executed immediately after installation of an HDD unit in a basic machine that previously had no HDD. The first time the machine is powered on with the new HDD installed, the system automatically takes the address book from the NVRAM and writes it onto the new HDD. However, the new address book on the HDD can be accessed only by the system administrator at this stage. Executing this SP by the service technician immediately after power on grants full address book access to all users. Procedure 1. Turn the machine off. 2. Install the new HDD. 3. Turn the machine on. 4. The address book and its initial data are created on the HDD automatically. However, at this point the address book can be accessed by only the system administrator or key operator. 5. Enter the SP mode and do SP5846 041. After this SP executes successfully, any user can access the address book. SM 5-89 D129/D130 Service Tables 041 Fill Addr Acl Info. Main SP Tables-5 Addr Book Media Displays the slot number where an address book data is in. [0 to 30 / - /1] 043 0: Unconfirmed 1: SD Slot 1 20: HDD 2: SD Slot 2 30: Nothing 4: USB Flash ROM Initialize All Setting & Addr Book 046 Initializes all settings and the address book. Initialize Local Address Book 047 Clears all of the address information from the local address book of a machine managed with UCS. Initialize Delivery Addr Book 048 Push [Execute] to delete all items (this does not include user codes) in the delivery address book that is controlled by UCS. Initialize LDAP Addr Book 049 Push [Execute] to delete all items (this does not include user codes) in the LDAP address book that is controlled by UCS. Initialize All Addr Book 050 Clears everything (including users codes) in the directory information managed by UCS. However, the accounts and passwords of the system administrators are not deleted. Backup All Addr Book 051 Copies all directory information to the SD card. Do this SP before replacing the controller board or HDD. The operation may not succeed if the controller board or HDD is damaged. D129/D130 5-90 SM Main SP Tables-5 Restore All Addr Book 052 Copies back all directory information from the SD card to the flash ROM or HDD. Upload the address book from the old flash ROM or HDD with SP5846-51 before removing it. Do SP5846 52 after installing the new HDD. Clear Backup Info Deletes the address book uploaded from the SD card in the slot 2. Deletes 053 only the files uploaded for that machine. This feature does not work if the card is write-protected. Note: After you do this SP, go out of the SP mode, turn the power off. Do not remove the SD card until the Power LED stops flashing. Search Option This SP uses bit switches to set up the fuzzy search options for the UCS local address book. Bit Meaning 0 Checks both upper/lower case characters 060 2 Service Tables 1 Japan Only 3 SM 4 --- Not Used --- 5 --- Not Used --- 6 --- Not Used --- 7 --- Not Used --- 5-91 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 Complexity Option 1 Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to upper case and sets the length of the password. 062 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1step] This SP does not normally require adjustment. This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a group password policy to control access to the address book. Complexity Option 2 Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to lower case and defines the length of the password. 063 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1step] This SP does not normally require adjustment. This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a group password policy to control access to the address book. Complexity Option 3 Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to numbers and defines the length of the password. 064 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1step] This SP does not normally require adjustment. This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a group password policy to control access to the address book. D129/D130 5-92 SM Main SP Tables-5 Complexity Option 4 Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to symbols and defines the length of the password. 065 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1step] This SP does not normally require adjustment. This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a group password policy to control access to the address book. FTP Auth Port Setting 091 Sets the FTP port to get the delivery server address book that is used in the individual authorization mode. [0 to 65535 / 3671 / 1step] Encryption Start 094 Shows the status of the encryption function of the address book on the LDAP server. Service Tables [0 to 255 / 1 ] No default Rep Resolution Reduction 5847-2 through 5847-6 changes the default settings of image data sent externally by the Net File page reference function. 5847* 5847-21 sets the default for JPEG image quality of image files controlled by NetFile. "NetFile" refers to jobs to be printed from the document server with a PC and the DeskTopBinder software. 002 Rate for Copy B&W Text [0 to 6 / 0 / 1] 003 Rate for Copy B&W Other [0 to 6 / 0 / 1] 0: 1x 1: 1/2x 2: 1/3x 3: 1/4x 005 Rate for Printer B&W [0 to 6 / 0 / 1] 4: 1/5x 5: 1/8x 6: 2/3x1 SM 5-93 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 007 Rate for Printer B&W 1200dpi [0 to 6 / 1 / 1] Network Quality Default for JPEG Sets the default value for the quality of JPEG images sent as NetFile pages. 021 This function is available only with the MLB (Media Link Board) option installed. [5 to 95 / 50 / 1step] Web Service 5848-2 sets the 4-bit switch assignment for the access control setting. 5848* Setting of 0001 has no effect on access and delivery from Scan Router. 5848-100 sets the maximum size of images that can be downloaded. The default is equal to 1 gigabyte. 0000: No access control 002 Acc. Ctrl.: Repository (only Lower 4 Bits) 0001: Denies access to DeskTop Binder. 003 Acc. Ctrl.: Doc. Svr. Print (Lower 4 Bits) 004 Acc. Ctrl.: User Directory (Lower 4 Bits) 007 Acc. Ctrl Comm. Log Fax (Lower 4 Bits) 009 Acc. Ctrl.: Job Control (Lower 4 Bits) Switches access control on and off. 011 Acc. Ctrl: Device Management (Lower 4 Bits) 0000: OFF, 0001: ON 021 Acc. Ctrl: Delivery (Lower 4 Bits) 022 Acc. Ctrl: User Administration (Lower 4 Bits) 099 Repository: Download Image Setting D129/D130 5-94 SM Main SP Tables-5 Specified the max size of 100 Repository: Download Image Max. Size the image data that the machine can download/ [1 to 2048 / 2048 / 1 MB] Setting: Log Type: Job 1 210 No information is available at this time. Setting: Log Type: Job 2 211 No information is available at this time. Setting: Log Type: Access 212 No information is available at this time. Setting: Primary Srv 213 No information is available at this time. Setting: Secondary Srv 214 Service Tables No information is available at this time. Setting: Start Time 215 No information is available at this time. Setting: Interval Time 216 No information is available at this time. Setting: Timing 217 No information is available at this time. SM 5-95 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 Installation Date 5849 Displays or prints the installation date of the machine. 001 Display The "Counter Clear Day" has been changed to "Installation Date" or "Inst. Date". Determines whether the installation date is printed on the printout for the total counter. 002 Switch to Print [0 to 1 / 1 / -] 0: OFF (No Print) 1: ON (Print) When the total number of pages that are made reaches 003 Total Counter this value, the current date becomes the 'official' installation date for this machine. [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1] 5850* Address Book Function Japan Only Replacement of Circuit Classification The machine is sold ready to use with a G3 line. This SP allows you to 003 switch all at once to convert to G4 after you add a G4 line. Conversely, if for some reason the G4 line becomes unusable, you can easily switch back to G3. Bluetooth 5851* Sets the operation mode for the Bluetooth Unit. Press either key. [0: Public] / [1: Private] D129/D130 5-96 SM Main SP Tables-5 Stamp Data Download Push [Execute] to download the fixed stamp data from the machine ROM onto the hard disk. Then these stamps can be used by the system. If this is 5853 not done, the user will not have access to the fixed stamps ("Confidential", "Secret", etc.). You must always execute this SP after replacing the HDD or after formatting the HDD. Always switch the machine off and on after executing this SP. 5856 Remote ROM Update When set to "1" allows reception of firmware data via the local port (IEEE 1284) during a remote ROM update. This setting is reset to zero after the machine is cycled off and on. Allows the technician to upgrade the firmware 002 using a parallel cable [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 step] 0: Not allowed 1: Allowed Save Debug Log Service Tables 5857 On/Off (1:ON 0:OFF) Switches on the debug log feature. The debug log cannot be captured until 001 this feature is switched on. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF, 1: ON Target (2: HDD 3: SD) Selects the destination where the debugging information generated by the 002 event selected by SP5858 will be stored if an error is generated [2 to 3 / 2 / 1] 2: HDD, 3: SD Card SM 5-97 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 Save to HDD 005 Specifies the decimal key number of the log to be written to the hard disk. Save to SD Card 006 Specifies the decimal key number of the log to be written to the SD Card. Copy HDD to SD Card (Latest 4 MB) Takes the most recent 4 MB of the log written to the hard disk and copies 009 them to the SD Card. A unique file name is generated to avoid overwriting existing file names on the SD Card. Up to 4MB can be copied to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can be copied one by one to each SD Card. Copy HDD to SD Card Latest 4 MB Any Key) Takes the log of the specified key from the log on the hard disk and copies it to the SD Card. 010 A unique file name is generated to avoid overwriting existing file names on the SD Card. Up to 4 MB can be copied to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can be copied one by one to each SD Card. This SP does not execute if there is no log on the HDD with no key specified. Erase HDD Debug Data 011 Erases all debug logs on the HDD Erase SD Card Debug Data Erases all debug logs on the SD Card. If the card contains only debugging 012 files generated by an event specified by SP5858, the files are erased when SP5857 010 or 011 is executed. To enable this SP, the machine must be cycled off and on. D129/D130 5-98 SM Main SP Tables-5 Free Space on SD Card 013 Displays the amount of space available on the SD card. Copy SD to SD (Latest 4MB) 014 Copies the last 4MB of the log (written directly to the card from shared memory) onto an SD card. Copy SD to SD (Latest 4MB Any Key) 015 This SP copies the log on an SD card (the file that contains the information written directly from shared memory) to a log specified by key number. Make HDD Debug 016 This SP creates a 32 MB file to store a log on the HDD. Make SD Debug 017 This SP creates a 4 MB file to store a log on an SD card. These SPs select the content of the debugging information to be saved to 5858* the destination selected by SP5857-002. SP5858-003 stores one SC specified by number. 001* Engine SC Error (0:OFF 1:ON) 002* SM Stores SC codes generated by copier engine errors. Controller SC Error (0:OFF Stores SC codes generated by GW 1:ON) controller errors. 003* Any SC Error [0 to 65535 / 0 / 1step] 004* Jam (0:OFF 1:ON) Stores jam errors. 5-99 D129/D130 Service Tables Debug Save When Main SP Tables-5 5859* Debug Save Key No. 001 Key 1 002 Key 2 003 Key 3 004 Key 4 005 Key 5 These SPs allow you to set up to 10 keys for log files for functions that use common memory on the controller board. 006 Key 6 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 007 Key 7 008 Key 8 009 Key 9 010 Key 10 5860* SMTP/POP3/IMAP4 Partial Mail Receive Timeout [1 to 168 / 72 / 1 hour] 020 Sets the amount of time to wait before saving a mail that breaks up during reception. The received mail is discarded if the remaining portion of the mail is not received during this prescribed time. MDN Response RFC2298 Compliance Determines whether RFC2298 compliance is switched on for MDN reply 021 mail. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: No, 1: Yes D129/D130 5-100 SM Main SP Tables-5 SMTP Auth. From Field Replacement Determines whether the FROM item of the mail header is switched to the 022 validated account after the SMTP server is validated. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: No. "From" item not switched. 1: Yes. "From" item switched. SMTP Auth Direct Sending Select the authentication method for SMPT. Bit 0: LOGIN Bit 1: PLAIN 025 Bit 2: CRAM_MD5 Bit 3: DIGEST_MD5 Bit 4 to Bit 7: Not Used This SP is activated only when SMTP authentication is enabled by UP mode. Service Tables S/MIME: MIME Header Setting Selects the MIME header type of an E-mail sent by S/MIME. 026 [0 to 2 / 0 / 1] 0: Microsoft Outlook Express standard 1: Internet Draft standard 2: RFC standard 028 S/MIME: Authentication Check When sending S/MIME mail, specifies whether to check the destination authentication. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Not checked 1: Checked SM 5-101 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 5870 Common Key Info Writing Writes to flash ROM the common proof for validating the 001 Writing device for @Remote specifications. 003 Initialize 004 Initializes the data area of the common proof for validating. Writing: Writes to flash ROM the common proof (2048-bit) for validating 2048bit the device for @Remote specifications. SD Card Appli Move 5873 Allows you to move applications from one SD card another. For more, see "SD Card Appli Move" in the chapter "System Maintenance (Main Chapters). 001 Move Exec Executes the move from one SD card to another. 002 Undo Exec This is an undo function. It cancels the previous execution. 5875 SC Auto Reboot This SP determines whether the machine reboots automatically when an SC error occurs. The reboot does not occur for Type A SC codes. [0 to 1/ 0 / 1] 001 Reboot Setting 0: The machine reboots automatically when the machine issues an SC error and logs the SC error code. If the same SC occurs again, the machine does not reboot. 1: The machine does not reboot when an SC error occurs. 002 Reboot Type D129/D130 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Manual reboot, 1: Automatic reboot 5-102 SM Main SP Tables-5 5878 Option Setup Press [Execute] to initialize the Data Overwrite 001 Data Overwrite Security Security option for the copier. For more, see "DataOverwriteSecurity Unit" in the chapter "Installation". Fixed Phase Block Erasing 5881 Detects the Fixed phrase. 5885* Set WIM Function Allows or disallows the functions of web image monitor. 0: OFF, 1: ON Bit: 0: Forbid all document server access 1: Forbid user mode access 2: Forbid print function Service Tables 020 DocSvr Acc Ctrl 3: Forbid Fax 4: Forbid scan sending 5: Forbid download 6: Forbid delete 7: Forbid guest user DocSvr Format 50 Selects the display type for the document box list. [0 to 2 / 0 / 1] 0: Thumbnail, 1: Icon, 2: Details DocSvr Trans 51 Sets the number of documents to be displayed in the document box list. [5 to 20 / 10 / 1] SM 5-103 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 Set Signature [0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step] 0: Signature for each e-mail 100 1: Signature for all e-mails 2: No signature Selects whether the signature is added to the scanned documents with the WIM when they are transmitted by an e-mail. Set Encryption Determines whether the scanned documents with the WIM are encrypted 101 when they are transmitted by an e-mail. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Not encrypted, 1:Encryption 200 Detect Mem Leak Not used 201 DocSvr Timeout Not used SD Get Counter 5887 This SP determines whether the ROM can be updated. This SP sends a text file to an SD card inserted in SD card Slot 2 (lower slot). The operation stores. The file is stored in a folder created in the root directory of the SD card called SD_COUNTER. The file is saved as a text file (*.txt) 001 prefixed with the number of the machine. 1. Insert the SD card in SD card Slot 2 (lower slot). 2. Select SP5887 then touch [EXECUTE]. Touch [Execute] in the message when you are prompted. D129/D130 5-104 SM Main SP Tables-5 Personal Information Protect Selects the protection level for logs. 5888* [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: No authentication, No protection for logs 1: No authentication, Protected logs (only an administrator can see the logs) SDK Application Counter 5893 Displays the counter name of each SDK application. 1 SDK-1 2 SDK-2 3 SDK-3 4 SDK-4 5 SDK-5 Service Tables 6 SDK-6 Plug & Play Maker/Model Name Selects the brand name and the production name for Windows Plug & Play. 5907 This information is stored in the NVRAM. If the NVRAM is defective, these names should be registered again. After selecting, press the "Original Type" key and "#" key at the same time. When the setting is completed, the beeper sounds five times. 5913* Switchover Permission Time Print Application Timer [3 to 30 / 3 / 1 second step] 002 Sets the length of time to elapse before allowing another application to take control of the display when the application currently controlling the display is not operating because a key has not been pressed. SM 5-105 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-5 Copy Server: Set Function 0: ON, 1: OFF Enable and disable the document server. This is a security measure that 5967* prevents image data from being left in the temporary area of the HDD. After changing this setting, you must switch the main switch off and on to enable the new setting. Cherry Server Selects which version of the Scan Router application program, "Light" or "Full" (Professional) is installed. 5974* [0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: Light 1: Full Device Setting The NIC and USB support features are built into the GW controller. Use this 5985 SP to enable and disable these features. In order to use the NIC and USB functions built into the controller board, these SP codes must be set to "1". [0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Disable, 1: Enable, 2: Function limitation When the "Function limitation" is set, "On board NIC" is limited only for the NRS or LDAP/NT authentication. 001 On Board NIC Other network applications than @Remote or LDAP/NT authentication are not available when this SP is set to "2". Even though you can change the initial settings of those network applications, the settings do not work 002 On Board USB D129/D130 [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] 0: Disable, 1: Enable 5-106 SM Main SP Tables-5 5987* Counter Falsification Prevention This SP detects that a mechanical counter device is removed. If it is detected, SC610 occurs. [0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step] 0: OFF. 1: ON SP Print Mode 5990 Prints out the SMC sheets. 001 All ( Data List) 002 SP (Mode Data List) 003 User Program 004 Logging Data 005 Diagnostic Report 006 Non-Default Service Tables 007 NIB Summary 008 Capture Log 021 Copier User Program 022 Scanner SP 023 Scanner User Program 024 SDK/J Summary 025 SDK/J Application Info 026 Print SP SM 5-107 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-6 5.8 MAIN SP TABLES-6 5.8.1 SP6-XXX: PERIPHERALS ADF Registration Adjust Adjusts the side-to-side and leading edge registration for simplex and 6006* duplex original feeding in ARDF mode. SP6006-5 sets the maximum setting allowed for rear edge erase. 001 Side-to-Side Regist: Front [–3 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step] 002 Side-to-Side Regist: Rear 003 Leading Edge Registration [–5 to 5 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step] 005 Buckle: Duplex Front [–3 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step] 006 Buckle: Duplex Rear [–2.5 to 2.5 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step] 007 Rear Edge Erase [–10 to 10 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step] 6007 ADF Input Check 001 002 003 Original Length 1 (B5 Detection Sensor) Original Length 2 (A4 Detection Sensor) Original Length 3 (LG Detection Sensor) 004 Original Width Sensor 1 0: Paper not detected 1: Paper detected 005 Original Width Sensor 2 006 Original Width Sensor 3 007 Original Width Sensor 4 008 Original Width Sensor 5 D129/D130 5-108 SM Main SP Tables-6 009 Original Set Sensor 010 Separation Sensor 011 Skew Correction Sensor 012 Scan Entrance Sensor 013 Registration Sensor 014 Exit Sensor 016 Lift Up Sensor 017 Inverter Sensor 018 Pick-up Roller HP Sensor 019 Original Set HP Sensor 6008 0: ADF cover closed 1: ADF cover open 0: ADF closed 1: ADF open 0: Paper not detected 1: Paper detected 0: HP (Pick-up roller: Up) 1: Not HP (Pick-up roller: Down) 0: HP (Stopper: UP) 1: Not HP (Stopper: Down) Service Tables 015 Feed Cover Sensor ADF Output Check 001 Pick-up Motor Forward 002 Pick-up Motor Reserve 003 Feed Motor Forward 004 Feed Motor Reserve 005 Relay Motor Forward 007 Inverter Motor Forward 008 Inverter Motor Reserve 011 Inverter Solenoid 012 Stamp SM 5-109 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-6 013 Fan Motor ADF FreeRun Performs an ARDF free run in duplex mode. Press [ON] to start, press [OFF] 6009 to stop. Note: This is a general free run controlled from the copier. 001 Free Run: Simplex Motion 002 Free Run: Duplex Motion 003 Free Run: Stamp Motion ADF Stamp Position Adjust. [–5 to 5 / 0 / 0.1 mm step] 6010* Adjusts the horizontal position of the stamp on the scanned originals. Original Size Detect Setting Specifies the original size for a size detected by the original sensor, since original sensors cannot recognize all sizes. (7) 0000 0000 (0) Different bits are used for detection, depending on the location as shown below. Bit 7 6016* Size Location A4 (L)/LT (L) Japan only 6 11" x 15"/DLT (L) 5 DLT (L)/ 11" x 15" 4 LT (S)/ US Exec (S) 3 LT (L)/ 8" x 10" (L) 2 LG (L)/ F4 (L) 1 A4 (L)/ 16K (L) 0 8K (L)/ DLT (L) NA only EU/AA only D129/D130 5-110 SM Main SP Tables-6 DF Magnification Adj. 6017* [–5 to 5 / 0 / 0.1% step] Adjusts the magnification in the sub-scan direction for ADF mode. Use the key to toggle between + and - before entering the value Skew Correction Moving Setting Turns the original skew correction in the ARDF for all original sizes on or off. 6020* [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0: Off (only for small original sizes) 1: On (for all original sizes) Punch Position: Sub Scan 6128 Adjusts the punching position in the sub scan direction. (For D636/D637) 001 2-Hole: DOM (Japan) 002 3-Hole: NA [-7.5 to 7.5 / 0 / 0.5 mm] Service Tables 003 4-Hole: EU 004 5-Hole: SCAN 005 2-Hole: NA Punch Position: Main Scan 6129 Adjusts the punching position in the main scan direction. (For D636/D637) 001 2-Hole: DOM (Japan) 002 3-Hole: NA 003 4-Hole: EU [-2 to 2 / 0 / 0.4 mm] 004 4-Hole: SCAN 005 2-Hole: NA SM 5-111 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-6 Skew Correction: Buckle Adj. 6130* Adjusts the paper buckle at the punch unit for each paper size. (For D636/D637) 001 A3 SEF 002 B4 SEF 003 A4 SEF 004 A4 LEF 005 B5 SEF 006 B5 LEF [-5 to 5 / 0 / 0.25 mm] 007 DLT SEF 008 LG SEF 009 LT SEF 010 LT LEF 011 12" x 18" 012 Other Skew Correction Control 6131* Selects the skew correction control for each paper size. (For D636/D637) 001 A3 SEF 002 B4 SEF 003 A4 SEF 004 A4 LEF [0 to 1 / 1 / 1 mm] 005 B5 SEF 006 B5 LEF 007 DLT SEF D129/D130 5-112 SM Main SP Tables-6 008 LG SEF 009 LT SEF 010 LT LEF 011 12" x 18" 012 Other Jogger Fence Fine Adj. 6132* This SP adjusts the distance between the jogger fences and the sides of the stack on the finisher stapling tray in the (Booklet) Finisher D636/D637. The adjustment is done perpendicular to the direction of paper feed. 001 A3 SEF 002 B4 SEF 003 A4 SEF 004 A4 LEF Service Tables 005 B5 SEF 006 B5 LEF [-1.5 to 1.5 / 0 / 0.5 mm] 007 DLT SEF 008 LG SEF 009 LT SEF 010 LT LEF 011 12" x 18" 012 Other SM 5-113 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-6 Staple Position Adjustment Adjusts the staple position for each finisher (D636/D637). 6133* + Value: Moves the staple position to the rear side. - Value: Moves the staple position to the front side. [-3.5 to 3.5 / 0 / 0.5 mm] Saddle Stitch Position Adj. 6134* Use this SP to adjust the stapling position of the booklet stapler when paper is stapled and folded in the Booklet Finisher (D637). 001 A3 SEF 002 B4 SEF [-3 to 3 / 0 / 0.2 mm] 003 A4 SEF 004 B5 SEF + Value: Shifts staple position toward the crease. - Value: Shifts staple position away from the crease 005 DLT SEF 006 LG SEF 007 LT SEF 008 12" x 18" 009 Other D129/D130 5-114 SM Main SP Tables-6 Folder Position Adj. 6135* This SP corrects the folding position when paper is stapled and folded in the Booklet Finisher D637. 001 A3 SEF 002 B4 SEF [-3 to 3 / 0 / 0.2 mm] 003 A4 SEF 004 B5 SEF + Value: Shifts staple position toward the crease. - Value: Shifts staple position away from the crease. 005 DLT SEF 006 LG SEF 007 LT SEF 008 12" x 18" 009 Other 6136* Sets the number of times that folding is done in the Booklet Finisher D637. [2 to 30 / 2 / 1 time/step] Entrance Sensor 6139 Display the signals received from sensors and switches of the (booklet) finisher. (D588) ( "Input Check Table" in "Main SP Tables-9") FIN (EUP) INPUT Check 6140 Display the signals received from sensors and switches of the (booklet) finisher. (D636/D637) ( SM "Input Check Table" in "Main SP Tables-9") 5-115 D129/D130 Service Tables Book Fold Repeat Main SP Tables-6 FIN (KIN) OUPUT Check 6144 Display the signals received from sensors and switches of the (booklet) finisher. (D588) ( "Output Check Table" in "Main SP Tables-9") FIN (EUP) OUPUT Check 6145 Display the signals received from sensors and switches of the (booklet) finisher. (D636/D637) ( "Output Check Table" in "Main SP Tables-9") Max. Pre-Stack Sheet [0 to 3 / 3 / 1 sheets step] This SP sets the number of sheets sent to the pre-stack tray. 6149* You may need to adjust this setting or switch it off when feeding thick or slick paper. D129/D130 5-116 SM Main SP Tables-7 5.9 MAIN SP TABLES-7 5.9.1 SP7-XXX: DATA LOG 7401* Total SC Counter SC Counter 001 Displays the total number of service calls that have occurred. This SC counter can be reset by executing SP7807 (SC/Jam Counter Reset). Total SC Counter 002 Displays the cumulative sum of service calls that have occurred. This SC counter cannot be reset by executing SP7807 (SC/Jam Counter Reset). 7403* SC History Service Tables 001 Latest 002 Latest 1 003 Latest 2 004 Latest 3 005 Latest 4 Displays the most recent 10 service calls. 006 Latest 5 007 Latest 6 008 Latest 7 009 Latest 8 010 Latest 9 SM 5-117 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-7 7502* Total Paper Jam Jam Counter 001 Displays the total number of paper jams. Total Jam Counter 002 Displays the cumulative sum of paper jams. 7503* Total Original Jam Original Jam Counter 001 Displays the total number of original jams. Total Original Counter 002 Displays the cumulative sum of original jams. 013 Bank: Transport Sn 1: On Total Jams Location These SPs display the total number of paper jams by location. A "Check-in" 7504* (paper late) error occurs when the paper fails to activate the sensor at the precise time. A "Check-out" ("paper lag") paper jam occurs when the paper remains at the sensor for longer than the prescribed time. 001 At power On 003 Tray 1: On 004 Tray 2: On 005 Tray 3: On 006 Tray 4: On 007 LCT: On 008 Bypass: On 009 Duplex: On D129/D130 5-118 SM Main SP Tables-7 013 Bank: Transport Sn 1: On 011 Vertical Transport 1: On 012 Vertical Transport 2: On 014 Bank: Transport Sn 2: On 017 Registration: On 019 Fusing Exit: On 020 Paper Exit: On 021 Bridge Exit On 022 Bridge Transport: On 024 Junction Gate Sensor: On 025 Duplex Exit: On 026 Duplex Entrance: On (In) 027 Duplex Entrance: On (Out) Service Tables 051 Vertical Transport 1: Off 052 Vertical Transport 2: Off 053 Bank Transport 1: Off 054 Bank Transport 2: Off 057 Registration Sensor: Off 058 LCT Feed Sensor: Off 060 Paper Exit: Off 061 Bridge: Exit: Off 062 Bridge: Transport: Off 064 Junction Gate Sensor: Off 065 Duplex Exit: Off 066 Duplex Entrance: Off (In) SM 5-119 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-7 013 Bank: Transport Sn 1: On 067 Duplex Entrance: Off (Out) 100 Finisher Entrance: KIN 101 Finisher Shift Tray Exit: KIN 102 Finisher Staple: KIN 103 Finisher Exit: KIN 105 Finisher Tray Lift Motor: KIN 106 Finisher Jogger Motor: KIN 107 Finisher Shift Motor: KIN 108 Finisher Staple Motor: KIN 109 Finisher Exit Motor: KIN 191 Finisher Entrance: EUP 192 Finisher Proof Exit: EUP 193 Finisher Shift Tray Exit: EUP 194 Finisher Staple Exit: EUP 195 Finisher Exit: EUP 198 Finisher Folder: EUP 199 Finisher Tray Motor: EUP 200 Finisher Jogger Motor: EUP 201 Finisher Shift Motor: EUP 202 Finisher Staple Moving Motor: EUP 203 Finisher Staple Motor: EUP 204 Finisher Folder Motor: EUP 206 Finisher Punch Motor:EUP D129/D130 5-120 SM Main SP Tables-7 Original Jam Detection Displays the total number of original jams by location. These jams occur 7505 when the original does not activate the sensors. A Check-in ("paper late") error occurs when the paper fails to activate the sensor at the precise time. A Check-out ("paper lag") paper jam occurs when the paper remains at the sensor for longer than the prescribed time. 001 At Power: On 003 Separation Sensor: On 004 Skew Correction Sensor: On 005 Interval Sensor: On 006 Registration Sensor: On 007 Inverter Sensor: On 008 Original Exit Sensor: On 053 Separation Sensor: Off Service Tables 054 Skew Correction Sensor: Off 055 Interval Sensor: Off 056 Registration Sensor: Off 057 Inverter Sensor: Off 058 Original Exit Sensor: Off SM 5-121 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-7 7506* Jam Count by Paper Size 005 A4 LEF 006 A5 LEF 014 B5 LEF 038 LT LEF 044 HLT LEF 132 A3 SEF 133 A4 SEF 134 A5 SEF Displays the total number of copy jams by paper size. 141 B4 SEF 142 B5 SEF 160 DLT SEF 164 LG SEF 166 LT SEF 172 HLT SEF 255 Others D129/D130 5-122 SM Main SP Tables-7 7507* Plotter Jam History 001 Last 002 Latest 1 003 Latest 2 Displays the copy jam history (the most recent 10 jams) Sample Display: CODE:007 004 Latest 3 005 Latest 4 SIZE:05h TOTAL:0000334 DATE: Mon Mar 15 11:44:50 2000 006 Latest 5 where: 007 Latest 6 CODE is the SP7504-*** number (see above. SIZE is the ASAP paper size code in hex. 008 Latest 7 009 Latest 8 TOTAL is the total jam error count (SP7502) DATE is the date the jams occurred. Size Code Size Code Size Code A4 (S) 05 A3 (L) 84 DLT (L) A0 A5 (S) 06 A4 (L) 85 LG (L) A4 B5 (S) 0E A5 (L) 86 LT (L) A6 LT (S) 26 B4 (L) 8D HLT (L) AC HLT (S) 2C B5 (L) 8E Others FF SM 5-123 Service Tables 010 Latest 9 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-7 7508* Original Jam History 001 Last 002 Last 1 003 Last 2 Displays the original jam history (the most recent 10 jams). Sample Display: CODE:007 004 Last 3 005 Last 4 SIZE:05h TOTAL:0000334 DATE: Mon Mar 15 11:44:50 2000 006 Last 5 where: 007 Last 6 CODE is the SP7505*** number (see above. SIZE is the ASAP paper size code in hex. 008 Last 7 009 Last 8 TOTAL is the total jam error count (SP7503) DATE is the date the jams occurred. 010 Last 9 Size Code Size Code Size Code A4 (S) 05 A3 (L) 84 DLT (L) A0 A5 (S) 06 A4 (L) 85 LG (L) A4 B5 (S) 0E A5 (L) 86 LT (L) A6 LT (S) 26 B4 (L) 8D HLT (L) AC HLT (S) 2C B5 (L) 8E Others FF ROM No./Firmware Version 7801 This SP codes display the firmware versions of all ROMs in the system, including the mainframe, the ARDF, and peripheral devices. D129/D130 5-124 SM Main SP Tables-7 PM Counter Display 7803* Displays the PM counter since the last PM. Paper [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 001 Displays the paper counter (pages) Page: PCD [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 002 Displays the PCD (Drum and Development unit) counter (pages) Page: Transfer [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 003 Displays the transfer unit counter (pages). Page: Fuser [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 004 Displays the fusing unit counter (pages). Rotation: PCD [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 005 Displays the PCD rotation counter (distance). Rotation: Transfer [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] Service Tables 006 Displays the transfer unit rotation counter (distance). Rotation: Fuser [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 007 Displays the fuser unit rotation counter (distance). Rotation(%): PCD [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %] 008 Displays the PCD (%) rotation counter (Distance/PM). Rotation(%):Transfer [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %] 009 Displays the transfer unit (%) rotation counter (distance/PM). Rotation(%):Fuser [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %] 010 Displays the fuser unit (%) rotation counter (distance/PM). Rotation(%):Web [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %] 011 Displays the web unit (%) rotation counter (distance/PM). SM 5-125 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-7 PM Counter Reset 7804 Resets the PM counter. Touch [Execute] two times > "Completed" > [Exit] Paper 001 Resets the PM counter of the paper. PCD 002 Resets the PM counter of the PCD (Drum and Development unit except developer). Transfer 003 Resets the PM counter of the transfer unit. Fuser 004 Resets the PM counter of the fuser unit. Web 005 Reset the PM counter of the web unit. All Clear 006 Resets all PM counter SC/Jam Counter Reset 7807 Resets the SC and jam counters. To reset, press Execute on the touch panel. This SP does not reset the jam history counters: SP7507, SP7508. D129/D130 5-126 SM Main SP Tables-7 Self-Diagnose Result Display Execute to open the "Self-Diagnostics Result Display" to view details about 7832 errors. Use the keys in the display on the touch-panel to scroll through all the information. If no errors have occurred, you will see the "No Error" message on the screen. Total Memory Size 7836 Displays the memory capacity of the controller system. DF Glass Dust Check Counts the number of occurrences (0 to 65,535) when dust was detected on 7852* the scanning glass of the ADF or resets the dust detection counter. Counting is done only if SP4-020-1 (Dust Check) is switched on. 001 Dust Detection Counter Dust Detection Clear Counter [0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step] Service Tables 002 [0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step] 7853 Replacement Counter PCD [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ] 001 Displays the replacement counter of the PCD (Drum and Development unit). Transfer [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ] 002 Displays the replacement counter of the transfer unit. Fuser [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ] 003 Displays the replacement counter of the fusing unit. Web [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ] 004 Displays the replacement counter of the cleaning web. SM 5-127 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-7 7906 Prev Counter Page: PCD [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 001 Displays the counter (pages) of the previous PCD Page: Transfer [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 002 Displays the previous counter (pages) of the previous transfer unit. Page: Fuser [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 003 Displays the previous counter (pages) of the previous fusing unit. Rotation: PCD [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 004 Displays the previous counter (rotations) of the previous PCD Rotation: Transfer [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 005 Displays the previous counter (rotations) of the previous transfer unit. Rotation: Fuser [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 006 Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous fusing unit. Rotation(%):PCD [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 mm] 007 Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous PCD Rotation(%):Transfer [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 mm] 008 Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous transfer unit. Rotation(%):Fuser [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 mm] 009 Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous fusing unit. Rotation(%):Web [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %] 010 Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous cleaning web. D129/D130 5-128 SM Main SP Tables-7 7950 Replacement Date PCD 001 Displays the replacement date of the PCD. Transfer 002 Displays the replacement date of the transfer unit. Fuser 003 Displays the replacement date of the fusing unit. Web 004 Displays the replacement date of the web unit. 7951 Remaining Counter PCD(Page) [0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days] 001 Displays the remaining counter (pages) of the PCD. [0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days] Service Tables Transfer(Page) 002 Displays the remaining counter (pages) of the transfer unit. Fuser(Page) [0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days] 003 Displays the remaining counter (pages) of the fusing unit. PCD(Rotation) [0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days] 005 Displays the remaining counter (rotations) of the PCD. Transfer(Rotation) [0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days] 006 Displays the remaining counter (rotations) of the transfer unit. Fuser(Rotation) [0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days] 007 Displays the remaining counter (rotations) of the fusing unit. PCD (%) [0 to 255 / 100 / 1 %] 009 Displays the remaining counter (%) of the PCD. SM 5-129 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-7 Transfer (%) [0 to 255 / 100 / 1 %] 010 Displays the remaining counter (%) of the transfer unit. Fuser (%) [0 to 255 / 100 / 1 %] 011 Displays the remaining counter (%) of the fusing unit. Web (%) [0 to 255 / 100 / 1 %] 013 Displays the remaining counter (%) of the cleaning web. PM Yield Setting 7952 Sets the each yield of the following. PCD(Page) [0 to 99999999/ 160000 / 1 sheet] 001 Sets the PM yield of the PCD (Pages). Transfer(Page) [0 to 9999999 / 160000 / 1 sheet] 002 Sets the PM yield of the transfer unit (Pages). Fuser(Page) [0 to 9999999 / 160000 / 1 sheet] 003 Sets the PM yield of the fusing unit (Pages). PCD(Rotation) 005 C2b: [0 to 999999999 / 71990000 / 1 mm] C2c: [0 to 999999999 / 75500000 / 1 mm] Sets the PM yield of the PCD (Rotations). Transfer(Rotation) 006 C2b: [0 to 999999999 / 62770000 / 1 mm] C2c: [0 to 999999999 / 65420000 / 1 mm] Sets the PM yield of the transfer unit (Rotations). Fuser(Rotation) 007 C2b: [0 to 999999999 / 54880000 / 1 mm] C2b: [0 to 999999999 / 55800000 / 1 mm] Sets the PM yield of the fusing unit (Rotations). Web (%) [0 to 255 / 92 / 1 %] 009 Sets the PM yield (%) of the web unit. D129/D130 5-130 SM Main SP Tables-7 Day Threshold: PCD [1 to 30 / 15 / 1 days] 021 Adjusts the threshold day for the near end for the PCD. Day Threshold: Transfer Unit [1 to 30 / 15 / 1 days] 022 Adjusts the threshold day for the near end for the transfer unit. Day Threshold: Fusing Unit [1 to 30 / 15 / 1 days] 023 Adjusts the threshold day for the near end for the fusing unit. 7953 Operation Env Log T<10 [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1 mm] 001 Displays the PCU rotation distance in the environment: T<10°C 10<=T<=17 [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1 mm] 002 Displays the PCU rotation distance in the environment: 10°C<=T<=17°C 17More (2> "2 or more", 4> "4 or more" AddBook Address Book Apl Application B/W Black & White Bk Black C Cyan ColCr Color Create ColMode Color Mode SM Service Tables Key for Abbreviations 5-133 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-8 Abbreviation What It Means Comb Combine Comp Compression Deliv Delivery DesApl Designated Application. The application (Copy, Fax, Scan, Print) used to store the job on the document server, for example. Dev Counter Development Count, no. of pages developed. Dup, Duplex Duplex, printing on both sides Emul Emulation FC Full Color FIN Post-print processing, i.e. finishing (punching, stapling, etc.) Full Bleed No Margins GenCopy Generation Copy Mode Get Print Counter. For jobs 10 pages or less, this counter does GPC not count up. For jobs larger than 10 pages, this counter counts up by the number that is in excess of 10 (e.g., for an 11-page job, the counter counts up 11-10 =1) IFax ImgEdt Internet Fax Image Edit performed on the original with the copier GUI, e.g. border removal, adding stamps, page numbers, etc. K Black (YMCK) LS Local Storage. Refers to the document server. LSize Large (paper) Size Mag Magnification MC One color (monochrome) D129/D130 5-134 SM Main SP Tables-8 Abbreviation What It Means New Remote Service, which allows a service center to monitor NRS machines remotely. "NRS" is used overseas, "CSS" is used in Japan. Org Original for scanning OrgJam Original Jam Print Job Manager/Desk Top Editor: A pair of utilities that allows Palm 2 print jobs to be distributed evenly among the printers on the network, and allows files to moved around, combined, and converted to different formats. PC Personal Computer Pages. A page is the total scanned surface of the original. PGS Duplex pages count as two pages, and A3 simplex count as two PJob Print Jobs Ppr Paper PrtJam Printer (plotter) Jam PrtPGS Print Pages Service Tables pages if the A3/DLT counter SP is switched ON. Red (Toner Remaining). Applies to the wide format model A2 R only. This machine is under development and currently not available. Rez Resolution SC Service Code (Error SC code displayed) Scn Scan Sim, Simplex Simplex, printing on 1 side. S-to-Email Scan-to-E-mail SMC SM SMC report printed with SP5990. All of the Group 8counters are recorded in the SMC report. 5-135 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-8 Abbreviation What It Means Svr Server TonEnd Toner End TonSave Toner Save TXJob Send, Transmission YMC Yellow, Magenta, Cyan YMCK Yellow, Magenta, Cyan, BlacK All of the Group 8 SPs are reset with SP5 801-1 Memory All Clear. 8001 8002 T:Total Jobs These SPs count the number of times each C:Total Jobs application is used to do a job. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8003 F:Total Jobs Note: The L: counter is the total number of times the 8004 P:Total Jobs other applications are used to send a job to the 8005 S:Total Jobs 8006 L:Total Jobs document server, plus the number of times a file already on the document server is used. These SPs reveal the number of times an application is used, not the number of pages processed. When an application is opened for image input or output, this counts as one job. Interrupted jobs (paper jams, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish. Only jobs executed by the customer are counted. Jobs executed by the customer engineer using the SP modes are not counted. When using secure printing (when a password is required to start the print job), the job is counted at the time when either "Delete Data" or "Specify Output" is specified. A job is counted as a fax job when the job is stored for sending. When a fax is received to fax memory, the F: counter increments but the L: counter does not (the document server is not used). A fax broadcast counts as one job for the F: counter (the fax destinations in the broadcast D129/D130 5-136 SM Main SP Tables-8 are not counted separately). A fax broadcast is counted only after all the faxes have been sent to their destinations. If one transmission generates an error, then the broadcast will not be counted until the transmission has been completed. A printed fax report counts as one job for the F: counter. The F: counter does not distinguish between fax sending or receiving. When a copy job on the document server is printed, SP8022 also increments, and when a print job stored on the document server is printed, SP8024 also increments. When an original is both copied and stored on the document server, the C: and L: counters both increment. When a print job is stored on the document server, only the L: counter increments. When the user presses the Document Server button to store the job on the document server, only the L: counter increments. When the user enters document server mode and prints data stored on the document server, only the L: counter increments. When an image received from Palm 2 is received and stored, the L: counter increments. When the customer prints a report (user code list, for example), the O: counter increments. However, for fax reports and reports executed from the fax application, the F: counter 8011 T:Jobs/LS 8012 C:Jobs/LS 8013 F:Jobs/LS 8014 P:Jobs/LS 8015 S:Jobs/LS 8016 L:Jobs/LS 8017 O:Jobs/LS Service Tables increments. These SPs count the number of jobs stored to the document server by each application, to reveal how local storage is being used for input. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. When a scan job is sent to the document server, the S: counter increments. When you enter document server mode and then scan an original, the L: counter increments. When a print job is sent to the document server, the P: counter increments. When a network application sends data to the document server, the O: counter increments. When an image from Palm 2 is stored on the document server, the O: counter increments. When a fax is sent to the document server, the F: counter increments. SM 5-137 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-8 8021 T:Pjob/LS 8022 C:Pjob/LS These SPs reveal how files printed from the document 8023 F:Pjob/LS 8024 P:Pjob/LS 8025 S:Pjob/LS 8026 L:Pjob/LS 8027 O:Pjob/LS server were stored on the document server originally. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the C: counter increments. When an application like DeskTopBinder merges a copy job that was stored on the document server with a print job that was stored on the document server, the C: and P: counters both increment. When a job already on the document server is printed with another application, the L: counter increments. When a scanner job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the S: counter increments. If the original was scanned from within document server mode, then the L: counter increments. When images stored on the document server by a network application (including Palm 2), are printed with another application, the O: counter increments. When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with a network application (Web Image Monitor, for example), the C: counter increments. When a fax on the document server is printed, the F: counter increments. D129/D130 5-138 SM Main SP Tables-8 8031 T:Pjob/DesApl 8032 C:Pjob/DesApl These SPs reveal what applications were used to 8033 F:Pjob/DesApl 8034 P:Pjob/DesApl 8035 S:Pjob/DesApl 8036 L:Pjob/DesApl 8037 O:Pjob/DesApl output documents from the document server. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of jobs printed from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. When documents already stored on the document server are printed, the count for the application that started the print job is incremented. When the print job is started from a network application (Desk Top Binder, Web Image Monitor, etc.) the L: counter increments. 8041 T:TX Jobs/LS 8042 C:TX Jobs/LS 8043 F:TX Jobs/LS 8044 P:TX Jobs/LS 8045 S:TX Jobs/LS 8046 L:TX Jobs/LS 8047 O:TX Jobs/LS the document server that were later accessed for transmission over the telephone line or over a network (attached to an e-mail, or as a fax image by I-Fax). [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] Note: Jobs merged for sending are counted separately. The L: counter counts the number of jobs scanned from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. When a stored copy job is sent from the document server, the C: counter increments. When images stored on the document server by a network application or Palm2 are sent as an e-mail, the O: counter increments. SM 5-139 D129/D130 Service Tables These SPs count the applications that stored files on Main SP Tables-8 8051 T:TX Jobs/DesApl These SPs count the applications used to send 8052 C:TX Jobs/DesApl 8053 F:TX Jobs/DesApl 8054 P:TX Jobs/DesApl 8055 S:TX Jobs/DesApl 8056 L:TX Jobs/DesApl 8057 O:TX Jobs/DesApl files from the document server over the telephone line or over a network (attached to an e-mail, or as a fax image by I-Fax). Jobs merged for sending are counted separately. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of jobs sent from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. If the send is started from Desk Top Binder or Web Image Monitor, for example, then the O: counter increments. T:FIN Jobs 8061 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs total the finishing methods. The finishing method is specified by the application. C:FIN Jobs 8062 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs total finishing methods for copy jobs only. The finishing method is specified by the application. F:FIN Jobs 8063 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs total finishing methods for fax jobs only. The finishing method is specified by the application. Note: Finishing features for fax jobs are not available at this time. P:FIN Jobs 8064 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs total finishing methods for print jobs only. The finishing method is specified by the application. S:FIN Jobs 8065 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs total finishing methods for scan jobs only. The finishing method is specified by the application. Note: Finishing features for scan jobs are not available at this time. D129/D130 5-140 SM Main SP Tables-8 L:FIN Jobs 8066 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs total finishing methods for jobs output from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. The finishing method is specified from the print window within document server mode. O:FIN Jobs 8067 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs total finishing methods for jobs executed by an external application, over the network. The finishing method is specified by the application. Number of jobs started in Sort mode. When a stored 806x 1 Sort copy job is set for Sort and then stored on the document server, the L: counter increments. (See SP8066 1) 806x 2 Stack Number of jobs started out of Sort mode. 806x 3 Staple Number of jobs started in Staple mode. Number of jobs started in Booklet mode. If the 806x 4 Booklet machine is in staple mode, the Staple counter also 806x 5 Z-Fold Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set for folding (Z-fold). Number of jobs started in Punch mode. When Punch 806x 6 Punch is set for a print job, the P: counter increments. (See SP8064 6.) 806x 7 Other 806x 8 Inside-Fold 806x 9 Three-IN-Fold SM Reserved. Not used Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set for folding (Inside-fold). Letter Fold-in Not Used 806x 10 Three-OUT-Fold Letter Fold-out Not Used 806x 11 Four-Fold Double Parallel Fold Not Used 806x 12 KANNON-Fold Gate Fold Not Used 5-141 D129/D130 Service Tables increments. Main SP Tables-8 806x 13 Perfect-Bind Perfect Binder Not Used 806x 14 Ring-Bind Ring Binder Not Used T:Jobs/PGS 8071 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of jobs broken down by the number of pages in the job, regardless of which application was used. C:Jobs/PGS 8072 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count and calculate the number of copy jobs by size based on the number of pages in the job. F:Jobs/PGS 8073 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count and calculate the number of fax jobs by size based on the number of pages in the job. P:Jobs/PGS 8074 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count and calculate the number of print jobs by size based on the number of pages in the job. S:Jobs/PGS 8075 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count and calculate the number of scan jobs by size based on the number of pages in the job. L:Jobs/PGS [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count and calculate the number of jobs printed from within the 8076 document server mode window at the operation panel, by the number of pages in the job. O:Jobs/PGS [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count and calculate the number of "Other" application jobs 8077 (Web Image Monitor, Palm 2, etc.) by size based on the number of pages in the job. 807x 1 1 Page 807x 8 21 to 50 Pages 807x 2 2 Pages 807x 9 51 to 100 Pages D129/D130 5-142 SM Main SP Tables-8 807x 3 3 Pages 807x 10 101 to 300 Pages 807x 4 4 Pages 807x 11 301 to 500 Pages 807x 5 5 Pages 807x 12 501 to 700 Pages 807x 6 6 to 10 Pages 807x 13 701 to 1000 Pages 807x 7 11 to 20 Pages 807x 14 1001 to Pages For example: When a copy job stored on the document server is printed in document server mode, the appropriate L: counter (SP8076 0xx) increments. Printing a fax report counts as a job and increments the F: counter (SP 8073). Interrupted jobs (paper jam, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish. If a job is paused and re-started, it counts as one job. If the finisher runs out of staples during a print and staple job, then the job is counted at the time the error occurs. For copy jobs (SP 8072) and scan jobs (SP 8075), the total is calculated by multiplying the number of sets of copies by the number of pages scanned. (One duplex page counts as 2.) The first test print and subsequent test prints to adjust settings are added to the number of pages of the copy job (SP 8072). Service Tables When printing the first page of a job from within the document server screen, the page is counted. T:FAX TX Jobs [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent 8111 by fax, either directly or using a file stored on the document server, on a telephone line. Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time. 001 B/W Black TX F:FAX TX Jobs 8113 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by fax directly on a telephone line. Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time. 001 B/W SM Black TX 5-143 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-8 These counters count jobs, not pages. This SP counts fax jobs sent over a telephone line with a fax application, including documents stored on the document server. If the mode is changed during the job, the job will count with the mode set when the job started. If the same document is faxed to both a public fax line and an I-Fax at a destination where both are available, then this counter increments, and the I-Fax counter (812x) also increments. The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent. T:IFAX TX Jobs [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent, 8121 either directly or using a file stored on the document server, as fax images using I-Fax. Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time. 001 B/W Black TX F:IFAX TX Jobs [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent (not 8123 stored on the document server), as fax images using I-Fax. Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time. 001 B/W Black TX These counters count jobs, not pages. The counters for color are provided for future use; the color fax feature is not available at this time. The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent. D129/D130 5-144 SM Main SP Tables-8 T:S-to-Email Jobs 8131 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of jobs scanned and attached to an e-mail, regardless of whether the document server was used or not. 001 B/W Black TX 002 Color Color TX 003 ACS Color TX S:S-to-Email Jobs 8135 These SPs count the number of jobs scanned and attached to an e-mail, 001 B/W Black TX 002 Color Color TX 003 ACS Color TX These counters count jobs, not pages. If the job is stored on the document server, after the job is stored it is determined to be color or black-and-white then counted. If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is waiting to be sent, the job is not counted. If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled. If several jobs are combined for sending to the Scan Router, Scan-to-Email, or Scan-to-PC, or if one job is sent to more than one destination. each send is counted separately. For example, if the same document is sent by Scan-to-Email as well as Scan-to-PC, then it is counted twice (once for Scan-to-Email and once for Scan-to-PC). SM 5-145 D129/D130 Service Tables without storing the original on the document server. Main SP Tables-8 T:Deliv Jobs/Svr 8141 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of jobs scanned and sent to a Scan Router server. 001 B/W Black Deliv 002 Color Color Deliv 003 ACS Color Deliv S:Deliv Jobs/Svr 8145 These SPs count the number of jobs scanned and sent to a Scan Router server. 001 B/W Black Deliv 002 Color Color Deliv 003 ACS Color Deliv These counters count jobs, not pages. The jobs are counted even though the arrival and reception of the jobs at the Scan Router server cannot be confirmed. If even one color image is mixed with black-and-white images, then the job is counted as a "Color" job. If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is waiting to be delivered, the job is not counted. If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled. Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job. D129/D130 5-146 SM Main SP Tables-8 T:Deliv Jobs/PC 8151 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of jobs scanned and sent to a folder on a PC (Scan-to-PC). Note: At the present time, 8151 and 8155 perform identical counts. 001 B/W Black Deliv 002 Color Color Deliv 003 ACS Color Deliv S:Deliv Jobs/PC 8155 These SPs count the total number of jobs scanned and sent with Scan-to-PC. 001 B/W Black Deliv 002 Color Color Deliv 003 ACS Color Deliv These counters count jobs, not pages. If the job is cancelled during scanning, it is not counted. If the job is cancelled while it is waiting to be sent, the job is not counted. If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what Service Tables stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled. SM Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job. 5-147 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-8 8161 T:PCFAX TX Jobs These SPs count the number of PC Fax transmission jobs. A job is counted from when it is registered for sending, not when it is sent. 8163 F:PCFAX TX Jobs [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] Note: At the present time, these counters perform identical counts. This counts fax jobs started from a PC using a PC fax application, and sending the data out to the destination from the PC through the copier. 8171 T:Deliv Jobs/WSD These SPs count the pages scanned by WSD. 8175 S:Deliv Jobs/WSD [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 001 B/W Black Deliv 002 Color Color Deliv 003 ACS Color Deliv 8181 T:Scan to Media Jobs 8185 S:Scan to Media Jobs These SPs count the pages scanned to media by the scanner application. 001 B/W Black Deliv 002 Color Color Deliv 003 ACS Color Deliv D129/D130 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 5-148 SM Main SP Tables-8 8191 T:Total Scan PGS 8192 C:Total Scan PGS 8193 F:Total Scan PGS 8195 S:Total Scan PGS 8196 L:Total Scan PGS These SPs count the pages scanned by each application that uses the scanner to scan images. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] SP 8191 to 8196 count the number of scanned sides of pages, not the number of physical pages. These counters do not count reading user stamp data, or reading color charts to adjust color. Previews done with a scanner driver are not counted. A count is done only after all images of a job have been scanned. Scans made in SP mode are not counted. Examples If 3 B5 pages and 1 A3 page are scanned with the scanner application but not stored, the S: count is 4. Service Tables If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server using the Store File button in the Copy mode window, the C: count is 6 and the L: count is 6. If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied but not stored, the C: count is 6. If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6. 8201 T:LSize Scan PGS [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8203 F Lsize Scan PGS [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] S:LSize Scan PGS [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SP codes count the total number of large pages input with the 8205 scanner for scan jobs only. Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission are not counted. Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.. SM 5-149 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-8 8211 T:Scan PGS/LS 8212 C:Scan PGS/LS 8213 F:Scan PGS/LS 8215 S:Scan PGS/LS 8216 L:Scan PGS/LS These SPs count the number of pages scanned into the document server . [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen Reading user stamp data is not counted. If a job is cancelled, the pages output as far as the cancellation are counted. If the scanner application scans and stores 3 B5 sheets and 1 A4 sheet, the S: count is 4. If pages are copied but not stored on the document server, these counters do not change. If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server, the C: count is 6 and the L: count is 6. If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6. ADF Org Feeds 8221 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of pages fed through the ADF for front and back side scanning. Number of front sides fed for scanning: With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Front side count is the same as the number of pages fed for either 001 Front simplex or duplex scanning. With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Front side count is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex front side scanning. (The front side is determined by which side the user loads face up.) Number of rear sides fed for scanning: With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex 002 Back scanning. With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex rear-side scanning. D129/D130 5-150 SM Main SP Tables-8 When 1 sheet is fed for duplex scanning the Front count is 1 and the Back count is 1. If a jam occurs during the job, recovery processing is not counted to avoid double counting. Also, the pages are not counted if the jam occurs before the first sheet is output. Scan PGS/Mode 8231 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each ADF mode to determine the work load on the ADF. 002 SADF 003 Mixed Size 004 Custom Size 005 Platen 006 Mixed 1side/2side Selectable. Large copy jobs that cannot be loaded in the ADF at one time. Selectable. Feeding pages one by one through the ADF. Selectable. Select "Mixed Sizes" on the operation panel. Selectable. Originals of non-standard size. Book mode. Raising the ADF and placing the original directly on the platen. Selectable. Select "Simplex/Duplex" on the operation Service Tables 001 Large Volume panel. If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode, the count is done for the last selected mode. The user cannot select mixed sizes or non-standard sizes with the fax application so if the original's page sizes are mixed or non-standard, these are not counted. If the user selects "Mixed Sizes" for copying in the platen mode, the Mixed Size count is enabled. In the SADF mode if the user copies 1 page in platen mode and then copies 2 pages with SADF, the Platen count is 1 and the SADF count is 3. T:Scan PGS/Org 8241 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of scanned pages by original type for all jobs, regardless of which application was used. 8242 SM C:Scan PGS/Org [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 5-151 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-8 These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Copy jobs. F:Scan PGS/Org 8243 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Fax jobs. S:Scan PGS/Org 8245 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Scan jobs. L:Scan PGS/Org 8246 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of pages scanned and stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen 8241 8242 8243 8245 8246 824x 1: Text Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 824x 2: Text/Photo Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 824x 3: Photo Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 824x 4: GenCopy, Pale Yes Yes No Yes Yes 824x 5: Map Yes Yes No No Yes 824x 6: Normal/Detail Yes No Yes No No 824x 7: Fine/Super Fine Yes No Yes No No 824x 8: Binary Yes No No Yes No 824x 9: Grayscale Yes No No Yes No 824x 10: Color Yes No No Yes No 824x 11: Other Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode, the count is done for the last selected mode. D129/D130 5-152 SM Main SP Tables-8 8251 T:Scan PGS/ImgEdt 8252 C:Scan PGS/ImgEdt 8255 S:Scan PGS/ImgEdt 8256 L:Scan PGS/ImgEdt These SPs show how many times Image Edit features have been selected at the operation panel for each application. Some examples of these editing features are: Erase> Border Erase> Center Image Repeat Centering Positive/Negative 8257 O:Scan PGS/ImgEdt [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] Note: The count totals the number of times the edit features have been used. A detailed breakdown of exactly which features have been used is not given. The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen. 8281 T:Scan PGS/TWAIN These SPs count the number of pages scanned using a TWAIN driver. These counters reveal how 8285 S:Scan PGS/TWAIN [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] Note: At the present time, these counters perform identical counts. 8291 T:Scan PGS/Stamp 8293 F:Scan PGS/Stamp These SPs count the number of pages stamped with the stamp in the ADF unit. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of pages stored 8295 S:Scan PGS/Stamp from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen SM 5-153 D129/D130 Service Tables the TWAIN driver is used for delivery functions. Main SP Tables-8 T:Scan PGS/Size 8301 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by all applications. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output (printing) page size [SP 8-441]. C:Scan PGS/Size 8302 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Copy application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output (printing) page size [SP 8-442]. F:Scan PGS/Size 8303 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Fax application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP 8-443]. S:Scan PGS/Size 8305 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Scan application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP 8-445]. L:Scan PGS/Size [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned and stored 8306 from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP 8-446]. 830x 1 A3 830x 2 A4 830x 3 A5 830x 4 B4 830x 5 B5 830x 6 DLT D129/D130 5-154 SM Main SP Tables-8 830x 7 LG 830x 8 LT 830x 9 HLT 830x 10 Full Bleed 830x 254 Other (Standard) 830x 255 Other (Custom) T:Scan PGS/Rez 8311 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by applications that can specify resolution settings. S:Scan PGS/Rez 8315 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by applications that can specify resolution settings. 831x 1 1200dpi to 831x 2 600dpito1199dpi 831x 3 400dpito599dpi 831x 4 200dpito399dpi 831x 5 to199dpi Service Tables Note: At the present time, 8311 and 8315 perform identical counts. Copy resolution settings are fixed so they are not counted. The Fax application does not allow finely-adjusted resolution settings so no count is done for the Fax application. SM 5-155 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-8 8381 T:Total PrtPGS These SPs count the number of pages printed by 8382 C:Total PrtPGS 8383 F:Total PrtPGS 8384 P:Total PrtPGS 8385 S:Total PrtPGS 8386 L:Total PrtPGS 8387 O:Total PrtPGS the customer. The counter for the application used for storing the pages increments. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. Pages stored with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen go to the C: counter. When the A3/DLT double count function is switched on with SP5104, 1 A3/DLT page is counted as 2. When several documents are merged for a print job, the number of pages stored are counted for the application that stored them. These counters are used primarily to calculate charges on use of the machine, so the following pages are not counted as printed pages: Blank pages in a duplex printing job. Blank pages inserted as document covers, chapter title sheets, and slip sheets. Reports printed to confirm counts. All reports done in the service mode (service summaries, engine maintenance reports, etc.) Test prints for machine image adjustment. Error notification reports. Partially printed pages as the result of a copier jam. LSize PrtPGS 8391 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count pages printed on paper sizes A3/DLT and larger. Note: In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine. D129/D130 5-156 SM Main SP Tables-8 8401 T:PrtPGS/LS 8402 C:PrtPGS/LS 8403 F:PrtPGS/LS 8404 P:PrtPGS/LS within the document server mode screen at the 8405 S:PrtPGS/LS operation panel. These SPs count the number of pages printed from the document server. The counter for the application used to print the pages is incremented. The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8406 L:PrtPGS/LS Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the L: count. Fax jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the F: count. This SP counts the amount of paper (front/back 8411 Prints/Duplex counted as 1 page) used for duplex printing. Last pages printed only on one side are not counted. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8421 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing. This is the total for all applications. C:PrtPGS/Dup Comb 8422 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by the copier application. F:PrtPGS/Dup Comb 8423 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by the fax application. P:PrtPGS/Dup Comb 8424 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by the printer application. 8425 SM S:PrtPGS/Dup Comb [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 5-157 D129/D130 Service Tables T:PrtPGS/Dup Comb Main SP Tables-8 These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by the scanner application. L:PrtPGS/Dup Comb 8426 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing from within the document server mode window at the operation panel. O:PrtPGS/Dup Comb 8427 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by Other applications 842x 1 Simplex> Duplex 842x 2 Duplex> Duplex 842x 3 Book> Duplex 842x 4 Simplex Combine 842x 5 Duplex Combine 842x 6 2in1 2 pages on 1 side (2-Up) 842x 7 4in1 4 pages on 1 side (4-Up) 842x 8 6in1 6 pages on 1 side (6-Up) 842x 9 8in1 8pages on 1 side (8-Up) 842x 10 9in1 9 pages on 1 side (9-Up) 842x 11 16in1 16 pages on 1 side (16-Up) 842x 12 Booklet 842x 13 Magazine 842x 14 2in1 + Booklet 842x 15 4in1 + Booklet 842x 16 6in1 + Booklet 842x 17 8in1 + Booklet D129/D130 5-158 SM Main SP Tables-8 842x 18 9in1 + Booklet 842x 19 2in1 + Magazine 842x 20 4in1 + Magazine 842x 21 6in1 + Magazine 842x 22 8in1 + Magazine 842x 23 9in1 + Magazine 842x 24 16in1 + Magazine These counts (SP8421 to SP8427) are especially useful for customers who need to improve their compliance with ISO standards for the reduction of paper consumption. Pages that are only partially printed with the n-Up functions are counted as 1 page. Here is a summary of how the counters work for Booklet and Magazine modes: SM Magazine Original Pages Count Original Pages Count 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 3 2 3 2 4 2 4 2 5 3 5 4 6 4 6 4 7 4 7 4 8 4 8 4 5-159 Service Tables Booklet D129/D130 Main SP Tables-8 T:PrtPGS/ImgEdt 8431 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below, regardless of which application was used. C:PrtPGS/ImgEdt 8432 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with the copy application. P:PrtPGS/ImgEdt 8434 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with the print application. L:PrtPGS/ImgEdt 8436 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of pages output from within the document server mode window at the operation panel with the three features below. O:PrtPGS/ImgEdt 8437 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with Other applications. 843x 1 Cover/Slip Sheet 843x 2 Series/Book Total number of covers or slip sheets inserted. The count for a cover printed on both sides counts 2. The number of pages printed in series (one side) or printed as a book with booklet right/left pagination. The number of pages printed where stamps were 843x 3 User Stamp applied, including page numbering and date stamping. T:PrtPGS/Ppr Size 8441 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by all applications. 8442 D129/D130 C:PrtPGS/Ppr Size [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 5-160 SM Main SP Tables-8 These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the copy application. F:PrtPGS/Ppr Size 8443 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the fax application. P:PrtPGS/Ppr Size 8444 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the printer application. S:PrtPGS/Ppr Size 8445 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the scanner application. L:PrtPGS/Ppr Size 8446 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed from within the document server mode window at the operation panel. 8447 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by Other applications. 844x 1 A3 844x 2 A4 844x 3 A5 844x 4 B4 844x 5 B5 844x 6 DLT 844x 7 LG 844x 8 LT 844x 9 HLT 844x 10 Full Bleed SM 5-161 D129/D130 Service Tables O:PrtPGS/Ppr Size Main SP Tables-8 844x 254 Other (Standard) 844x 255 Other (Custom) These counters do not distinguish between LEF and SEF. PrtPGS/Ppr Tray [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8451 These SPs count the number of sheets fed from each paper feed station. 001 Bypass Tray Bypass Tray 002 Tray 1 Copier 003 Tray 2 Copier 004 Tray 3 Paper Tray Unit (Option) 005 Tray 4 Paper Tray Unit (Option) 006 Tray 5 LCT (Option) 007 Tray 6 Currently not used. 008 Tray 7 Currently not used. 009 Tray 8 Currently not used. 010 Tray 9 Currently not used. 011 Tray 10 Currently not used. 012 Tray 11 Currently not used. 013 Tray 12 Currently not used. 014 Tray 13 Currently not used. 015 Tray 14 Currently not used. 016 Tray 15 Currently not used. D129/D130 5-162 SM Main SP Tables-8 T:PrtPGS/Ppr Type [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by all applications. These counters are not the same as the PM counter. The PM counter is 8461 based on feed timing to accurately measure the service life of the feed rollers. However, these counts are based on output timing. Blank sheets (covers, chapter covers, slip sheets) are also counted. During duplex printing, pages printed on both sides count as 1, and a page printed on one side counts as 1. C:PrtPGS/Ppr Type 8462 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the copy application. F:PrtPGS/Ppr Type 8463 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the fax application. 8464 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the printer application. L:PrtPGS/Ppr Type 8466 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed from within the document server mode window at the operation panel. 846x 1 Normal 846x 2 Recycled 846x 3 Special 846x 4 Thick 846x 5 Normal (Back) 846x 6 Thick (Back) 846x 7 OHP SM 5-163 D129/D130 Service Tables P:PrtPGS/Ppr Type Main SP Tables-8 846x 8 Other PrtPGS/Mag [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8471 These SPs count by magnification rate the number of pages printed. 001 to 49% 002 50% to 99% 003 100% 004 101% to 200% 005 201% to Counts are done for magnification adjusted for pages, not only on the operation panel but performed remotely with an external network application capable of performing magnification adjustment as well. Magnification adjustments done with printer drivers with PC applications such as Excel are also counted. Magnification adjustments done for adjustments after they have been stored on the document server are not counted. Magnification adjustments performed automatically during Auto Reduce/Enlarge copying are counted. The magnification rates of blank cover sheets, slip sheets, etc. are automatically assigned a rate of 100%. 8481 T:PrtPGS/TonSave 8484 P:PrtPGS/TonSave These SPs count the number of pages printed with the Toner Save feature switched on. Note: These SPs return the same results as this SP is limited to the Print application. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] D129/D130 5-164 SM Main SP Tables-8 T:PrtPGS/Emul 8511 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages printed. P:PrtPGS/Emul 8514 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages printed. 001 RPCS 002 RPDL 003 PS3 004 R98 005 R16 006 GL/GL2 007 R55 Service Tables 008 RTIFF 009 PDF 010 PCL5e/5c 011 PCL XL 012 IPDL-C 013 BM-Links Japan Only 014 Other 015 IPDS SP8511 and SP8514 return the same results as they are both limited to the Print application. SM Print jobs output to the document server are not counted. 5-165 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-8 T:PrtPGS/FIN 8521 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by all applications. C:PrtPGS/FIN 8522 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Copy application. F:PrtPGS/FIN [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by 8523 the Fax application. Note: Print finishing options for received faxes are currently not available. P:PrtPGS/FIN 8524 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Print application. S:PrtPGS/FIN 8525 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Scanner application. L:PrtPGS/FIN 8526 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed from within the document server mode window at the operation panel. 852x 1 Sort 852x 2 Stack 852x 3 Staple 852x 4 Booklet 852x 5 Z-Fold 852x 6 Punch 852x 7 Other D129/D130 5-166 SM Main SP Tables-8 852x 8 Inside-Fold 852x 9 Three-IN-Fold 852x 10 Three-OUT-Fold 852x 11 Four-Fold 852x 12 KANNON-Fold 852x 13 Perfect-Bind 852x 14 Ring-Bind If stapling is selected for finishing and the stack is too large for stapling, the unstapled pages are still counted. The counts for staple finishing are based on output to the staple tray, so jam recoveries are counted. This SP counts the amount of staples used by the 8531 Staples machine. 8551 T:PrtBooks/FIN 8552 C:PrtBooks/FIN 8554 P:PrtBooks/FIN 8556 L:PrtBooks/FIN Service Tables [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 001 Perfect-Bind Not Used 002 Ring-Bind Not Used 8561 T:A Sheet Of Paper [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8562 C:A Sheet Of Paper [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8563 F:A Sheet Of Paper [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8564 P:A Sheet Of Paper [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] SM 5-167 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-8 8566 L:A Sheet Of Paper [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] O:A Sheet Of Paper [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8567 These SPs count the totals number of duplex pages printed. 001 Total: Over A3/DLT 002 Total: Under A3/DLT 003 Duplex: Over A3/DLT 004 Duplex: Under A3/DLT T: Counter [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total output broken down by color output, regardless of the application used. In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, 8581 these counters are also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine. Note: This SP is expanded for color MFP and color LP machines. For this machine, the count is done for black only. O: Counter [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the totals for A3/DLT paper use, number of duplex pages 8591 printed, and the number of staples used. These totals are for Other (O:) applications only. 001 A3/DLT 002 Duplex D129/D130 5-168 SM Main SP Tables-8 T:Coverage Counter 8601 These SPs count the total coverage for each color and printout pages. 001 B/W [0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1] 011 B/W Printing Pages [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] C:Coverage Counter [0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1] 8602 These SPs count the total coverage for B/W. F:Coverage Counter [0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1] 8603 These SPs count the total coverage for B/W. P:Coverage Counter [0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1] 8604 These SPs count the total coverage for B/W. L:Coverage Counter [0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1] 8606 These SPs count the total coverage for B/W. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] Service Tables SDK Apli Counter 8617 These SPs count the total printout pages for each SDK applicaion. 001 SDK-1 002 SDK-2 003 SDK-3 004 SDK-4 005 SDK-5 006 SDK-6 SM 5-169 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-8 T:FAX TX PGS 8631 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number. 001 B/W Black TX F:FAX TX PGS 8633 [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number. 001 B/W Black TX If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/W or Color. At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8631 and SP8633 are the same. The counts include error pages. If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is done for each destination. Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not. Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each destination. D129/D130 5-170 SM Main SP Tables-8 T:FAX TX PGS 8641 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to as fax images using I-Fax. 001 B/W Black TX F:FAX TX PGS 8643 [0 o 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by Fax as fax images using I-Fax. 001 B/W Black TX If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/W or Color. At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8641 and SP8643 are the same. The counts include error pages. If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not. Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each Service Tables done for each destination. destination. SM 5-171 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-8 T:S-to-Email PGS 8651 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an e-mail for both the Scan and document server applications. 001 B/W 002 Color S:S-to-Email PGS 8655 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an e-mail for the Scan application only. 001 B/W 002 Color The count for B/W and Color pages is done after the document is stored on the HDD. If the job is cancelled before it is stored, the pages are not counted. If Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to 5 addresses, the count is 10 (the pages are sent to the same SMTP server together). If Scan-to-PC is used to send a 10-page document to 5 folders, the count is 50 (the document is sent to each destination of the SMB/FTP server). Due to restrictions on some devices, if Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to a large number of destinations, the count may be divided and counted separately. For example, if a 10-page document is sent to 200 addresses, the count is 10 for the first 100 destinations and the count is also 10 for the second 100 destinations, for a total of 20). D129/D130 5-172 SM Main SP Tables-8 T:Deliv PGS/Svr 8661 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan Router server by both Scan and LS applications. 001 B/W 002 Color S:Deliv PGS/Svr 8665 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan Router server by the Scan application. 001 B/W 002 Color The B/W and Color counts are done after the document is stored on the HDD of the Scan Router server. If the job is canceled before storage on the Scan Router server finishes, the counts are not done. The count is executed even if regardless of confirmation of the arrival at the Scan Router server. T: Deliv PGS/PC 8671 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a folder on a PC (Scan-to-PC) with the Scan and LS applications. 001 B/W 002 Color S: Deliv PGS/PC 8675 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent with Scan-to-PC with the Scan application. 001 B/W 002 Color SM 5-173 D129/D130 Service Tables Main SP Tables-8 8681 T:PCFAX TXPGS These SPs count the number of pages sent by PC Fax. These SPs are provided for the Fax application only, so the counts for SP8681 and SP8683 are the 8683 F:PCFAX TXPGS same. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] This counts pages sent from a PC using a PC fax application, from the PC through the copier to the destination. When sending the same message to more than one place using broadcasting, the pages are only counted once. (For example, a 10-page fax is sent to location A and location B. The counter goes up by 10, not 20.) 8691 T:TX PGS/LS 8692 C:TX PGS/LS 8693 F:TX PGS/LS [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8694 P:TX PGS/LS The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from These SPs count the number of pages sent from the document server. The counter for the application that was used to store the pages is incremented. within the document server mode screen at the 8695 S:TX PGS/LS 8696 L:TX PGS/LS operation panel. Pages stored with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen go to the C: counter. Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the count. If several documents are merged for sending, the number of pages stored are counted for the application that stored them. When several documents are sent by a Fax broadcast, the F: count is done for the number of pages sent to each destination. D129/D130 5-174 SM Main SP Tables-8 TX PGS/Port 8701 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of pages sent by the physical port used to send them. For example, if a 3-page original is sent to 4 destinations via ISDN G4, the count for ISDN (G3, G4) is 12. 001 PSTN-1 002 PSTN-2 003 PSTN-3 004 ISDN (G3,G4) 005 Network T:Scan PGS/Comp 8711 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of compressed pages scanned into the document server, counted by the formats listed below. 001 JPEG/JPEG2000 Service Tables 002 TIFF (Multi/Single) 003 PDF 004 Other 005 PDF/Comp 006 PDF/A S:Scan PGS/Comp 8715 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of compressed pages scanned by the scan application, counted by the formats listed below. 001 JPEG/JPEG2000 002 TIFF (Multi/Single) 003 PDF SM 5-175 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-8 004 Other 005 PDF/Comp 006 PDF/A 8721 T:Deliv PGS/WSD [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] S:Deliv PGS/WSD [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8725 These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each scanner mode. 001 B/W 002 Color 8731 8735 T:Scan PGS/Media [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] S:Scan PGS/Media [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of pages scanned and saved in a meia by each scanner mode. 001 B/W 002 Color RX PGS/Port 8741 [0to9999999/ 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of pages received by the physical port used to receive them. 001 PSTN-1 002 PSTN-2 003 PSTN-3 004 ISDN (G3,G4) 005 Network D129/D130 5-176 SM Main SP Tables-8 Dev Counter [0to9999999/ 0 / 1] These SPs count the frequency of use (number of rotations of the 8771 development rollers) for black and other color toners. Note: For machines that do not support color, the Black toner count is the same as the Total count. Toner_Botol_Info. 8781 This SP displays the number of toner bottles used. The count is done based on the equivalent of 1,000 pages per bottle. This SP displays the percent of space 8791 LS Memory Remain available on the document server for storing documents. [0 to 100 / 0 / 1] Toner Remain [0 to 100 / 0 / 1] Service Tables This SP displays the percent of toner remaining for each color. This SP allows the user to check the toner supply at any time. Note: 8801 This precise method of measuring remaining toner supply (1% steps) is better than other machines in the market that can only measure in increments of 10 (10% steps). This SP is expanded for color MFP and color LP machines. For this machine, the count is done for black only. SM 5-177 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-8 8811 Eco Counter Eco Total [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 001 Displays the number of pages reduced by using the duplex and the combine function. Duplex [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 004 Displays the number of pages reduced by using the duplex function. Combine [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 005 Displays the number of pages reduced by using the combine function. Duplex(%) [0 to 100 / 0 / 1] 008 Displays the utilization ratio of the duplex function. Combine(%) [0 to 100 / 0 / 1] 009 Displays the utilization ratio of the duplex function. Paper Cut(%) [0 to 100 / 0 / 1] 010 Displays the paper reduction ratio. Cvr Cnt:0-10% 8851 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the percentage of dot coverage for black other color toners. 011 0 to 2%: BK 021 3 to 4%: BK 031 5 to 7%: BK 041 8 to 10%: BK D129/D130 5-178 SM Main SP Tables-8 Cvr Cnt:11-20% 8861 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the percentage of dot coverage for black other color toners. 001 BK Black toner Cvr Cnt:21-30% 8871 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the percentage of dot coverage for black other color toners. 001 BK Black toner Cvr Cnt:31%8881 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the percentage of dot coverage for black other color toners. Black toner Page/Toner Bottle Service Tables 001 BK [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8891 These SPs display the amount of the remaining current toner. 001 BK Black toner Page/Toner_Prev1 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8901 These SPs display the amount of the remaining previous toner. 001 BK SM Black toner 5-179 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-8 Page/Toner_Prev2 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8911 These SPs display the amount of the remaining 2nd previous toner. 001 BK Black toner Cvr Cnt/Total [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8921 Displays the total coverage and total printout number for each color. 001 Coverage (%) BK 011 Coverage/P:BK Machine Status [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the amount of time the machine spends in each 8941 operation mode. These SPs are useful for customers who need to investigate machine operation for improvement in their compliance with ISO Standards. Engine operation time. Does not include time while 001 Operation Time controller is saving data to HDD (while engine is not operating). Engine not operating. Includes time while controller 002 Standby Time saves data to HDD. Does not include time spent in Energy Save, Low Power, or Off modes. 003 Energy Save Time Includes time while the machine is performing background printing. Includes time in Energy Save mode with Engine on. 004 Low Power Time Includes time while machine is performing background printing. Includes time while machine is performing 005 Off Mode Time background printing. Does not include time machine remains powered off with the power switches. 006 SC D129/D130 Total down time due to SC errors. 5-180 SM Main SP Tables-8 007 PrtJam 008 OrgJam Total down time due to paper jams during printing. Total down time due to original jams during scanning. 009 Supply PM Unit End Total down time due to supply unit end. AddBook Register 8951 These SPs count the number of events when the machine manages data registration. User Code /User ID User code registrations. 002 Mail Address Mail address registrations. 003 Fax Destination Fax destination registrations. 004 Group 005 Group destination registrations. Transfer Fax relay destination Request registrations for relay TX. 006 F-Code [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] Service Tables 001 F-Code box registrations. Copy application 007 Copy Program registrations with the Program (job settings) feature. Fax application registrations 008 Fax Program with the Program (job [0 to 255 / 0 / 255] settings) feature. Printer application 009 Printer Program registrations with the Program (job settings) feature. SM 5-181 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-8 Scanner application 010 Scanner registrations with the Program Program (job settings) feature. Adomin. Counter List [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8999 Display the total coverage and total printout number for each color. 001 Total 003 Copy: BW 007 Printer: BW 010 Fax Print: BW 012 A3/DLT 013 Duplex 023 Copy: BW (%) 027 Printer: BW (%) 030 Fax Print: BW (%) 101 Transmission Total: Color 102 Transmission Total: BW 103 Fax Transmission 104 Scanner Transmission: Color 105 Scanner Transmission: BW D129/D130 5-182 SM Main SP Tables-9 5.11 MAIN SP TABLES-9 5.11.1 INPUT CHECK TABLE When entering the Input Check mode, 8 digits display the result for a section. Each digit corresponds to a different device as shown in the table. Bit No. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Result 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 Copier Input Check 5803 Reading Description 0 See the table 1 following this table. Service Tables 001 Tray 1: Paper Size Sensor 1 002 Tray 1: Tray Set Sensor Set Not set 003 Tray 1: Paper Lift Sensor Not upper limit Upper limit 004 Tray 1: Paper End Sensor No paper Paper remaining 005 Tray 1: Paper Height Sensor 1 See the table 2 following this table. 006 Tray 1: Paper Height Sensor 2 007 Tray 2: Paper Size Sensor SM See the table 1 following this table. 008 Tray 2: Tray Set Sensor Set Not set 009 Tray 2: Paper Lift Sensor Not upper limit Upper limit 010 Tray 2: Paper End Sensor No paper Paper remaining 5-183 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-9 011 Tray 2: Paper Height Sensor 1 See the table 2 following this table. 012 Tray 2: Paper Height Sensor 2 013 Tray 1: Paper Feed Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 014 Tray 2: Paper Feed Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 015 Tray 3: Paper Feed Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 016 Tray 4: Paper Feed Sensor Paper detected No paper detected No paper detected Paper detected 018 Relay Sensor 1 Paper detected No paper detected 019 Relay Sensor 2 Paper detected No paper detected 020 Relay Sensor 3 No paper detected Paper detected 021 Relay Sensor 4 No paper detected Paper detected 022 Relay Sensor: LCT No paper detected Paper detected Not end Paper end 017 LCT: Paper Feed Sensor 023 By-pass: Paper End Sensor 024 By-pass: Paper Size Sensor See the table 3 following this table. 025 Registration Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 026 Fusing Exit Sensor No paper detected Paper detected 027 Fusing Entrance Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 028 Junction Gate Relay Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 029 Exit Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 030 Paper Overflow Sensor Not full Full 031 Right Cover Open/Close Close Open 032 Duplex Unit Open/Close Open Close 033 Duplex Entrance Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 034 Duplex Exit Sensor Paper detected No paper detected D129/D130 5-184 SM Main SP Tables-9 035 Bank Right Cover Open/Close Close Open 036 Tray Cover Open/Close Close Open Set Not set 038 Bridge/Exit Tray: Exit Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 039 Bridge/Exit Tray: Relay Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 040 Bridge/Exit/Shift: Set Detection Set Not set Close Open Close Open Not HP HP Set (Bit1) Not set (Bit1) Not full Full 037 LCT Set 042 Bridge/Exit Tray: Left Guide Open/Close Bridge/Exit Tray: Right Guide Open/Close 043 Transfer Belt Unit HP Sensor 046 Fusing Unit Set 047 Toner Overflow Sensor 048 Interlock Detection 1 049 Interlock Detection 2 Right or front door is Right or front door is open. Right or front door is Right or front door is open. close. 050 Key Card Set Set Not set 051 Key Counter Set Set Not set Not set set Set Not set Paper detected No paper detected Not end End No paper detected Paper detected Stay at rear Stay at front Paper detected No paper detected 052 Mechanical Counter Set 053 1-Bin Unit Set 054 1-Bin Unit: Paper Set 057 Cleaning Web End 060 Shift Sensor 064 Shift Tray Sensor 065 SM close. Bypass Tray Paper Length Detection 5-185 D129/D130 Service Tables 041 Main SP Tables-9 200 Scanner HP Sensor Not HP HP 201 Platen Cover Sensor Open Close Table 1: Paper Height Sensor 0: Deactivated, 1: Activated (actuator inside sensor) Remaining paper Paper height sensor 1 Paper height sensor 2 Full 0 0 Nearly full 1 0 Near end 1 1 Almost empty 0 1 D129/D130 5-186 SM Main SP Tables-9 Table 2: Paper Size Switch Switch 1 is used for the tray set detection. 0: Pushed, 1: Not pushed North America Switch Location Europe/Asia 4 3 2 0 0 1 0 0 0 11" x 17" SEF*1 A3 SEF*1 (A3 SEF) (11" x 17" SEF) 8.5" x 14" SEF *2 B4 SEF *2 (B4 SEF) (8.5" x 14" SEF) A4 SEF A4 SEF 1 1 0 8.5" x 11" SEF 8.5" x 11" SEF 1 1 1 B5 SEF B5 SEF 0 1 1 11" x 81/2" LEF*3 A4 LEF*3 (A4 LEF) (11" x 81/2" LEF) 1 0 0 10.5" x 7.25" LEF*4 B5 LEF*4 (B5 LEF) (10.5" x 7.25" LEF) 0 1 0 A5 LEF A5 LEF 1 0 1 *1: The machine detects either 11" x 17" SEF or A3 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-002 (Tray 1) or -006 (Tray 2). *2: The machine detects either 8.5" x 14" SEF or B4 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-003 (Tray 1) or -007 (Tray 2). *3: The machine detects either 11" x 81/2" LEF or A4 LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-001 (Tray 1) or -005 (Tray 2). *4: The machine detects either B5 LEF or 10.5" x 7.25" LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-004 (Tray 1) or -008 (Tray 2).. SM 5-187 D129/D130 Service Tables Models Main SP Tables-9 Table 3: Paper Size (By-pass Table) 0: Pushed, 1: Not pushed Models Bit No. North America Europe/Asia 3 2 1 0 11" x 17" SEF*1 A3 SEF*1 (11" x 8.5" LEF) (A4 LEF) 1 1 1 0 11" x 17" SEF*1 A3 SEF*1 (11" x 8.5" LEF) (A4 LEF) 1 1 0 0 8.5" x 11" SEF*1 A4 SEF*1 (8.5" x 11" SEF*2) (A5 LEF) 1 1 0 1 8.5" x 11" SEF*1 A4 SEF*1 (8.5" x 11" SEF*2) (B5 LEF) 1 0 0 1 5.5" x 8.5" SEF A5 SEF 1 0 1 1 5.5" x 8.5" SEF A5 SEF 0 0 1 1 5.5" x 8.5" SEF A6 SEF 0 1 1 1 5.5" x 8.5" SEF A6 SEF 1 1 1 1 *1: When the machine determines that the paper feed direction is "LEF", it considers that the paper size is bracketed size. D129/D130 5-188 SM Main SP Tables-9 APS Original Size Detection Original Size Length Sensor Width Sensor SP4-301 display Metric version Inch version L3 L2 L1 W1 W2 A3 11" x 17" O O O O O 00011111 B4 10" x 14" O O O O X 00011110 8.5" x 14" O O O X X 00011100 A4 LEF 8.5" x 11" X X X O O 00000011 B5 LEF - X X X O X 00000010 A4 SEF 11" x 8.5" X O O X X 00001100 B5 SEF - X X O X X 00000100 X X X X X 00000000 F4 8.5" x 13", 8.25" x 13", or 8" x 13" SP 5126 controls the A5 LEF/ SEF SM 5.5" x 8.5", 8.5" x 5.5" 5-189 D129/D130 Service Tables size that is detected Main SP Tables-9 3000/2000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637) Reading 6140 Bit Description 0 1 001 Entrance Sensor No paper detected Paper detected 002 Proof Exit Sensor No paper detected Paper detected Not Full Full No paper Paper detected*1 detected*1 No paper detected Paper detected Not HP HP No paper detected Paper detected Not HP HP 009 Lower Tray Height Sensor No paper detected Paper detected 010 Upper Tray Height Sensor No paper detected Paper detected 011 Upper Tray Full Sensor Not Full Full 012 Stack Roller HP Sensor Not HP HP 013 Jogger HP Sensor Not HP HP HP Not HP No paper detected Paper detected 016 Corner Stapler HP Sensor Not HP HP 017 Stapler Rotation HP Sensor Not HP HP Not Limit Limit 019 Door Switch Closed Open 020 Corner Stapler Operation Not HP HP 003 Proof Full Detection Sensor 004 Upper Tray Exit Sensor 005 Staple Exit Sensor 006 Shift Roller HP Sensor 007 Shift Exit Sensor 008 Exit Guide Plate HP Sensor 014 Feed Out Belt HP Sensor 015 Stapling Tray Paper Sensor 018 Upper Tray Limit SW D129/D130 5-190 SM Main SP Tables-9 Reading Bit Description 0 1 021 Staple Detection No staple detected Staple detected 022 Staple Dip Detection No staple detected Staple detected 023 Punch Movement HP Sensor Not HP HP 024 Paper Position Slide HP Sensor Not HP HP No paper detected Paper detected 026 Punch Full Sensor Not Full Full 027 Punch HP Sensor Not HP HP 025 Paper Position Sensor 028 Punch DIP SW 1 See *1 029 Punch DIP SW 2 See *1 030 Stack Junction Gate HP Sensor Not HP HP No paper detected Paper detected Not HP HP No paper detected Paper detected 034 Bottom Fence HP Sensor Not HP HP 035 Fold Cam HP Sensor Not HP HP 036 Fold Plate HP Sensor Not HP HP 037 Fold Unit Exit Sensor No paper detected Paper detected No paper Paper detected*2 detected*2 No paper Paper detected*2 detected*2 Not HP HP No staple detected Staple detected 031 Stack Present Sensor 032 Clamp Roller HP Sensor 033 Fold Entrance Sensor 038 Lower Tray Full Sensor: Front 039 Lower Tray Full Sensor: Rear 040 Booklet Stapler 1: Operation (Rotation/Front) 041 Booklet Stapler 1: Staple In (Front) SM 5-191 D129/D130 Service Tables 6140 Main SP Tables-9 Reading 6140 Bit Description 042 043 Booklet Stapler 1: Staple In (Leading Edge/Front) Booklet Stapler 1: Operation (Rotation/Rear) 044 Booklet Stapler 1: Staple In (Rear) 045 Booklet Stapler 1: Staple In (Leading Edge/Rear) 046 Upper Tray Full Sensor: 3000 0 1 No staple detected Staple detected Not HP HP No staple detected Staple detected No staple detected Staple detected Not Full Full *1: Combination of DIP SW 1 and SW 2 DIP SW 1 DIP SW 2 Punch Type 0 0 Japan 1 0 Europe 0 1 North America 1 1 North Europe *2: Please refer to "Lower Tray (D637 Only)" in the Service Manual for the "3000/2000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher ". D129/D130 5-192 SM Main SP Tables-9 1000-Sheet Finisher (D588) Reading Bit Description 0 001 Entrance Sensor 002 003 004 005 Paper detected Shift Exit Sensor No paper detected (Lower Tray Exit Sensor) Staple Entrance Sensor Paper detected (Stapler Tray Entrance Sensor) Staple Moving HP Sensor (Stapler HP Sensor) Jogger HP Sensor (Jogger Fence HP Sensor) 006 Stack Feed-out Belt HP Sensor 007 Staple Tray Paper Sensor 008 Staple Rotation Sensor (Staple Rotation HP Sensor) 013 014 SM Paper Sensor (Stack Height Sensor) Tray Lower Sensor (Lower Tray Lower Limit Sensor) 5-193 No paper detected HP HP Not HP No paper detected Paper detected Not HP HP Staple detected 012 Shift HP Sensor Paper detected Not HP 010 Staple READY Detection (Exit Guide Plate HP Sensor) detected HP Staple detected Exit Guide Plate HP No paper Not HP 009 Staple Sensor 011 1 No staple detected No staple detected Not HP HP Not HP HP No output tray Output tray detected detected Lower limit Not lower limit D129/D130 Service Tables 6139 Main SP Tables-9 Reading 6139 015 Bit Description Proof Full Sensor (Paper Limit Sensor) 0 1 Not full Full 5.11.2 OUTPUT CHECK TABLE Copier 5804 Output Check 001 Exit Motor: 350 002 Exit Motor: 175 003 Exit Motor: 230 Paper exit motor (Mainframe) 004 Exit Motor: 180 005 Exit Motor: 154 006 Exit Motor: 90 007 Feed Motor: 300 008 Feed Motor: 255 009 Feed Motor: 230 Paper feed motor (Mainframe) 010 Feed Motor: 215 011 Feed Motor: 180 012 Feed Motor: 154 013 Feed Motor: 90 014 Bank: Feed Motor: 300 Paper feed motor (Optional paper 015 Bank: Feed Motor: 255 feed unit) 016 Bank: Feed Motor: 230 D129/D130 5-194 SM Main SP Tables-9 5804 Output Check 017 Bank: Feed Motor: 215 018 Bank: Feed Motor: 180 019 Bank: Feed Motor: 154 020 Bank: Feed Motor: 90 021 LCT: Feed Motor: 300 022 LCT: Feed Motor: 255 023 LCT: Feed Motor: 230 Paper feed motor (Optional LCT) 024 LCT: Feed Motor: 215 025 LCT: Feed Motor: 180 026 LCT: Feed Motor: 154 027 LCT: Feed Motor: 90 028 Paper Feed Clutch 1 Paper feed clutch 1/2 (Mainframe) Service Tables 029 Paper Feed Clutch 2 030 Bank: Paper Feed Clutch 3 Paper feed clutch 3/4 (Optional 031 Bank: Paper Feed Clutch 4 paper feed unit) 032 LCT: Paper Feed Clutch Paper feed clutch (Optional LCT) 033 Pick-up Solenoid 1 Pick-up Solenoid 1/2 (Mainframe) 034 Pick-up Solenoid 2 035 Bank: Pick-up Solenoid 3 Pick-up Solenoid 3/4 (Optional 036 Bank: Pick-up Solenoid 4 paper feed unit) 037 LCT: Pick-up Solenoid Pick-up Solenoid (LCT) 038 Tray Lift Motor 1: Up 039 Tray Lift Motor 1: Down - 040 Tray Lift Motor 2: Up SM 5-195 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-9 5804 Output Check 041 Tray Lift Motor 2: Down 042 Paper Tray Lock Solenoid Not used 043 Bank: Paper Tray Lock Solenoid Tray lock solenoid (Optional paper feed unit) 044 Registration Motor: 230 045 Registration Motor: 180 046 Registration Motor: 154 047 Registration Motor: 90 048 Exit: Junction Gate Solenoid Junction gate 1 solenoid 049 Duplex: Inverter Gate Solenoid Not used 050 Duplex Inverter Motor: Fwd: 230 051 Duplex Inverter Motor: Fwd: 180 052 Duplex Inverter Motor: Fwd: 154 053 Duplex Inverter Motor: Fwd: 90 054 Duplex Inverter Motor: Rev: 230 055 Duplex Inverter Motor: Rev: 180 056 Duplex Inverter Motor: Rev: 154 057 Duplex Inverter Motor: Rev: 90 058 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Fwd: 230 059 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Fwd: 180 060 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Fwd: 154 061 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Fwd: 90 062 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Rev: 230 063 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Rev: 180 D129/D130 5-196 SM Main SP Tables-9 5804 Output Check 064 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Rev: 154 065 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Rev: 90 066 By-pass Feed Clutch - 067 By-pass Pick-up Solenoid - 068 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: 230 069 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: 180 Drive motor (Bridge unit) 070 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: 154 071 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: 90 Bridge/Exit Tray: Junction Gate Junction Gate Solenoid (Bridge Solenoid unit) 073 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: Reset - 074 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: Enable - 075 Bridge: Cooling Fan Motor Not used 076 Transfer Belt Contact Motor - Service Tables 072 077 OPC Motor: 230 078 OPC Motor: 180 Drum motor 079 OPC Motor: 154 080 OPC Motor: 90 081 Transfer/Development Motor: 230 082 Transfer/Development Motor: 180 083 Transfer/Development Motor: 154 084 Transfer/Development Motor: 90 085 Fusing Motor: 230 086 Fusing Motor: 180 SM 5-197 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-9 5804 Output Check 087 Fusing Motor: 154 088 Fusing Motor: 90 089 Development Paddle Motor - 090 PTL Control - 091 Fusing Fan Motor: High Fusing exhaust fan motor 092 Fusing Fan Motor: Low 093 Exhaust Fan Motor: High Exhaust fan motor 094 Exhaust Fan Motor: Low 095 Duct Fan Motor Cooling fan motor 096 Exit Fan Motor: High Paper exit cooling fan motor 097 Exit Fan Motor: Low 098 PSU Fan Motor Junction gate 2 solenoid (1-bin 099 1-Bin Junction Gate Solenoid unit) 100 Polygon Motor: 230 101 Polygon Motor: 180 102 Polygon Motor: 154 103 Polygon Motor: 90 104 LD 1 105 LD 2 106 Toner Bottle Motor: Fwd Toner supply motor 107 Quenching Lamp - 108 Charge Bias - 109 Development Bias - D129/D130 5-198 SM Main SP Tables-9 5804 Output Check 110 Transfer Belt Voltage - 111 ID Sensor LED - 115 Cleaning Web Motor Web motor 116 Shift Tray Motor Not used 117 CTL Cooling FAN Controller fan 202 Scanner Lamp - 1000-Sheet Finisher (D588) Output Check 6144 SM Description 001 Upper Relay Motor Upper Transport Motor 002 Lower Relay Motor Lower Transport Motor 003 Exit Motor - 004 Proof Junction Gate SOL Tray Junction Gate Solenoid 005 Lower Tray Lift Motor - 006 Jogger Fence Motor - 007 Stapler Motor - 008 Stapler Hammer - 009 Stapler Junction Gate Solenoid - 010 Positioning Roller Solenoid - 011 Stack Feed-out Motor - 012 Shift Motor - 013 Exit Guide Plate Motor - 5-199 Service Tables Display D129/D130 Main SP Tables-9 3000 /2000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637) Output 6145 Display Description 001 Entrance Motor - 002 Upper Transport Motor - 003 Lower Transport Motor - 004 Upper/Proof Tray Exit Motor - 005 Clamp Roller Retraction Motor - 006 Shift Roller Motor - 007 Exit Guide Plate Motor - 008 Upper Tray Lift Motor - 009 Stacking Sponge Roller Motor - 010 Jogger Fence Motor - 011 Feed Out Belt Motor - 012 Corner Stapler Movement Motor - 013 Corner Stapler Rotation Motor - 014 Corner Stapler - 015 Proof Junction Gate Solenoid - 016 Stapling Tray Junction Gate Solenoid - 017 Stapling Edge Pressure Plate - Solenoid 018 Positioning Roller Solenoid - 019 Booklet Pressure Roller Solenoid - 020 Stack Junction Gate Motor - 021 Fold Unit Bottom Fence Lift Motor - D129/D130 5-200 SM Main SP Tables-9 - 023 Booklet Stapler: Rear - 024 Fold Plate Motor - 025 Fold Roller Motor - 026 Positioning Roller Motor - 027 Punch Drive Motor - 028 Punch Movement Motor - 029 Paper Position Sensor Slide Motor - Service Tables 022 Booklet Stapler: Front SM 5-201 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-9 5.11.3 PRINTER SERVICE TABLES SP1-XXX (Service Mode) 1001 Bit Switch 001 Bit Switch 1 0 1 bit 0 DFU - - bit 1 DFU - - bit 2 DFU - - bit 3 No I/O Timeout 0: Disable 1: Enable Enable: The MFP I/O Timeout setting will have no effect. I/O Timeouts will never occur. bit 4 SD Card Save Mode 0: Disable 1: Enable Enable: Print jobs will be saved to an SD Card in the GW SD slot. bit 5 DFU - - bit 6 DFU - - bit 7 [RPCS,PCL]: Printable area frame border 0: Disable 1: Enable Enable: The machine prints all RPCS and PCL jobs with a border on the edges of the printable area. 1001 Bit Switch 002 Bit Switch 2 0 1 bit 0 DFU - - bit 1 DFU - - bit 2 Applying a collation Type Shift Normal Collate Collate D129/D130 5-202 SM Main SP Tables-9 A collation type (shift or normal) will be applied to all jobs that do not already have a ‘Collate Type’ configured. bit 3 If #5-0 is enabled, this Bit Switch has no effect. [PCL5e/c,PS]: PDL Auto Switching 0: Enable 1: Disable Disable: The MFPs ability to change the PDL processor mid-job. Some host systems submit jobs that contain both PS and PCL5e/c. If Auto PDL switching is disabled, these jobs will not be printed properly. DFU - - bit 5 DFU - - bit 6 DFU - - bit 7 DFU - - 0 1 Bit Switch 003 Bit Switch 3 bit 0 DFU - - bit 1 DFU - - bit 2 [PCL5e/c]: Legacy HP compatibility 0: Disable 1: Enable Service Tables 1001 bit 4 Enable: Uses the same left margin as older HP models such as HP4000/HP8000. In other words, the left margin defined in the job (usually " *r0A") will be changed to " *r1A" SM bit 3 DFU - - bit 4 DFU - - bit 5 DFU - - bit 6 DFU - - bit 7 DFU - - 5-203 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-9 1001 Bit Switch 004 Bit Switch 4 0 1 bit 0 DFU - - bit 1 DFU - - bit 2 DFU - - bit 3 IPDS print-side reversal 0: Disable 1: Enable Enable: Increases printing speed but simplex pages may be printed on the back side of the sheet. bit 4 DFU - - bit 5 DFU - - bit 6 DFU - - bit 7 DFU - - D129/D130 5-204 SM Main SP Tables-9 1001 Bit Switch 005 Bit Switch 5 0 1 Disable Enable Show "Collate Type", "Staple Type" and "Punch Type" buttons on the operation panel. bit 0 If enabled, users will be able to configure a Collate Type, Staple Type, and Punch Type from the operation panel. The available types will depend on the device and configured options. After enabling the function, the settings will appear under: "User Tools > Printer Features > System" bit 1 Multiple copies if a paper size or type mismatch occurs 0: Disable (Single copy) 1: Enable (Multiple copy) If a paper size or type mismatch occurs during the printing of multiple copies, only a single copy is output by default. Using this Bit Switch, the device can be configured to print all copies even if a paper mismatch bit 2 DFU bit 3 [PS] PS Criteria Service Tables occurs. - - Pattern3 Pattern1 Change the number of PS criterion used by the PS interpreter to determine whether a job is PS data or not. Pattern3: includes most PS commands. Pattern1: A small number of PS tags and headers bit 4 Increase max number of the stored jobs to 1000 jobs. Disable Enable (1000) (100) Enable: Changes the maximum number of jobs that can be stored on the HDD via Job Type settings to 1000. The default is 100. bit 5 DFU bit 6 Method for determining the image rotation for the edge to bind on. SM 5-205 - - 0: Disable 1: Enable D129/D130 Main SP Tables-9 If enabled, the image rotation will be performed as they were in the specifications of older models for the binding of pages of mixed orientation jobs. The old models are below: - PCL: Pre-04A models - PS/PDF/RPCS:Pre-05S models bit 7 Letterhead mode printing 0: Disable 1: Enable (Duplex) Routes all pages through the duplex unit. If this is disabled, simplex pages or the last page of an odd-paged duplex job are not routed through the duplex unit. This could result in problems with letterhead/pre-printed pages. Only affects pages specified as Letterhead paper. 1001 Bit Switch 006 Bit Switch 6 DFU 1001 - - 0 1 0: Disable 1: Enable Bit Switch 007 Bit Switch 7 Print path If enabled, simplex pages (in mixed simplex/duplex PS/PCL5 jobs only) bit 0 and the last page of an odd paged duplex job (PS, PCL5, PCL6), are always routed through the duplex unit. Not having to switch paper paths increases the print speed slightly. bit 1 to 7 1001 DFU - - - - Bit Switch 008 Bit Switch 8 DFU D129/D130 5-206 SM Main SP Tables-9 1001 Bit Switch 009 Bit Switch 9 PDL Auto Detection timeout of jobs submitted via USB or Parallel Port (IEEE 1284). 0 1 "Disabled "Enabled (Immediately)" (10 seconds)" bit 0 To be used if PDL auto-detection fails. A failure of PDL autodetection doesn't necessarily mean that the job can't be printed. This bit switch tells the device whether to time-out immediately (default) upon failure or to wait 10 seconds. bit 1 DFU bit 2 Job Cancel - - Disabled (Not cancelled) Enabled (Cancelled) If this bit switch, all jobs will be cancelled after a jam occurs. Note: If this bitsw is enabled, printing under the following conditions might result in problems: - Spool printing (WIM >Configuration > Device Settings > System) bit 3 PCL/PS bypass tray paper rotation (SEF/LEF) 0: Disable 1: Enable This bitsw causes the device to revert to the behavior of previous generations. It only takes effect if "Bypass Tray Setting Priority" = "Driver/Command". Previous spec (bitsw=1): If a standard sized paper mismatch occurred in the bypass tray, the MFP always prompted for SEF paper. If this bitsw=0 (default) then in the event of a standard sized paper mismatch, the MFP will always prompt for paper of the rotation (SEF/LEF) determined by the MFP bypass tray paper setting or by the bypass tray sensor. bit 4 Response to PJL USTATUS when multiple collated copies are printed SM 5-207 0: Disable 1: Enable D129/D130 Service Tables - Job submission via USB or Parallel Port Main SP Tables-9 When enabled, if multiple collated copies are printed, the device no longer responds to PJL USTATUS with the number of pages in the current copy. Instead the device will return the total number of pages for all copies. Bit 5 DFU - to 7 1001 - Bit Switch 010 Bit Switch 10 bit 0 to 4 bit 5 DFU List / Test Print Lock 0 1 - - 0: Disable 1: Enable If enabled, you can lock or unlock the [List/Test Print] items under the Pinter Features menu when the Store and Skip Errored Job Function is on. Bit 6 Optional charge machines - - 0: Disable 1: Enable - - 0 1 0: Disable 1: Enable If enabled, you can use the optional charge machines when the Store and Skip Errored Job Function is on. Bit 7 1001 DFU Bit Switch 011 Bit Switch 11 bit 0 List / Test Print menu When enabled, [Multiple Lists] menu is displayed in [List / Test Print] under the Printer Features menu. bit 1 D129/D130 Interrupt printing 0: Job 5-208 1: Page SM Main SP Tables-9 Selects the interrupt unit for the interrupt printing function. When you select "0," you can interrupt the printing of a job while being processed. When you select "1," you can interrupt the printing of a page while being processed. Bit 2 DFU to 7 1001 - - 0 1 - - Bit Switch 012 Bit Switch 12 bit 0 to 7 1003 DFU [Clear Setting] Initialize Printer System 1003 001 Initializes settings in the "System" menu of the user mode. 1004 Service Tables 1003 003 Delete Program [Print Summary] Print Printer Summary 1004 001 Prints the service summary sheet (a summary of all the controller settings). 1006 [Sample/Locked Print] *CTL 0: Linked, 1: On Enables and disables the document server. When you select "0," the 1006 001 document server is enabled or disabled in accordance with Copy Service Mode SP5-967. When you select "1," the document server is enabled regardless of Copy Service Mode SP5-967. SM 5-209 D129/D130 Main SP Tables-9 5.11.4 SCANNER SERVICE TABLES SP1-xxx (System and Others) [Erase margin (Remote Scan)] 1005 Creates an erase margin for all edges of the scanned image. If the machine has scanned the edge of the original, create a margin. This SP is activated only when the machine uses TWAIN scanning. 1005 1 Range from 0 to 5 mm 1009 [Remote scan disable] *CTL *CTL [0 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step ] [0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: enable, 1: disable 1009 1 Enable or disable remote scan. 1010 [Non Display Clear Light PDF] *CTL [0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: Display, 1: Non display 1010 1 Enable or disable remote scan. D129/D130 5-210 SM Main SP Tables-9 SP2-XXX (Scanning-image quality) [Compression Level (Gray-scale)] 2021 Selects the compression ratio for grayscale processing mode (JPEG) for the three settings that can be selected at the operation panel. 2021 1 Comp1: 5-95 [5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ] 2021 2 Comp2: 5-95 [5 to 95 / 40 / 1 /step ] 2021 3 Comp3: 5-95 *CTL [5 to 95 / 65 / 1 /step ] 2021 4 Comp4: 5-95 [5 to 95 / 80 / 1 /step ] 2021 5 Comp5: 5-95 [5 to 95 / 95 / 1 /step ] [Compression ratio of ClearLight PDF] 2024 Selects the compression ratio for clearlight PDF for the two settings that can be selected at the operation panel. 2024 2 SM Compression Ratio (High [5 to 95 / 25 / 1 /step ] Service Tables 2024 1 Compression Ratio (Normal) *CTL [5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ] comp image) 5-211 D129/D130 Updating the Firmware 5.12 UPDATING THE FIRMWARE To update the firmware for this machine, you must have the new version of the firmware downloaded onto an SD (Secure Digital) Card. The SD Card is inserted into SD Card Slot 2 (Lower Slot) on the controller box. 5.12.1 BEFORE YOU BEGIN An SD card is a precision device. Always observe the following precautions when you handle SD cards: Always switch the machine off before you insert an SD card. Never insert the SD card into the slot with the power on. Do not remove the SD card from the service slot after the power has been switched on. Never switch the machine off while the firmware is downloading from the SD card. Keep SD cards in a safe location where they are not exposed to high temperature, high humidity, or exposure to direct sunlight. Always handle SD cards with care. Do not bend or scratch them. Do not let the SD card get exposed to shock or vibration. Make sure that the write protection of an SD card is unlocked when you download an application to it. If not, downloading fails and a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware upgrade. Keep the following points in mind when you use the firmware update software: "Upload" means to send data from the machine to the SD card. "Download" means to send data from the SD card to the machine. To select an item on the LCD, touch the appropriate button on the soft touch-screen of the LCD, or, press the appropriate number key on the 10-key pad of the operation panel. For example, when "Exit (0)" shows on the screen you can touch the Exit button on the screen, or, press the "0" button on the operation panel of the copier. Make sure that the machine is disconnected from the network to prevent a print job for arriving while the firmware update is in progress before you start the firmware update procedure. D129/D130 5-212 SM Updating the Firmware 5.12.2 UPDATING FIRMWARE Preparation 1. If the SD card is blank, copy the entire "romdata" folder onto the SD card. 2. If the card already contains the "romdata" folder, copy the "D129" folder onto the card. Updating Procedure 1. Turn the main power switch off. 2. Remove the controller cover ( 3. Insert the SD card into SD Card Slot 2 (Lower Slot) [A]. Make sure the label on the SD card Service Tables x 2). faces the rear side of the machine. 4. Slowly push the SD card into the slot so it locks in place. You will hear it click. Make sure the SD card locks in place. SM 5-213 D129/D130 Updating the Firmware To remove the SD, push it in to unlock the spring lock. Then release it so it pops out of the slot. 5. Disconnect the network cable from the copier if the machine is connected to a network. 6. Switch the main power switch on. After about 45 seconds, the initial version update screen appears on the LCD in English. 7. On the screen, touch the button or press the corresponding number key on the operation panel to select the item in the menu that you want to update. ROM/NEW What it means Tells you the number of the module and name of the version ROM: currently installed. The first line is the module number, the second line the version name. Tells you the number of the module and name version on the SD NEW: card. The first line is the module number, the second line the version name. Controller, engine and operation panel firmware cannot be updated at the same time. It is recommended to update firmware modules one by one. 8. Touch "UpDate (#)" (or ) to start the update. While downloading is in progress, the LCD will display "Loading". When downloading has been completed, the panel will display "update done". For operation panel software, the Start key lights red while downloading is in progress, and then lights green again after downloading is completed. 9. The "Update is Done" message appears on the operation panel after completing the updating. The message differs depending on the firmware that has been updated. 10. Switch the copier main power switch off when you see the "Update is Done" message or follow the procedure that is displayed on the operation panel. 11. Press in the SD card to release it. Then remove it from the slot. 12. Switch the copier on for normal operation. D129/D130 5-214 SM Updating the Firmware Error Messages An error message shows in the first line if an error occurs during the download. The error code consists of the letter "E" and a number. The example above shows error "E24" displayed. For details, refer to the Error Message Table. ( "Handling Firmware Update Errors" in this section) Firmware Update Error If a firmware update error occurs, this means the update was cancelled during the update Service Tables because the module selected for update was not on the SD card. Recovery after Power Loss If the ROM update is interrupted as a result of accidental loss of power while the firmware is updating, then the correct operation of the machine cannot be guaranteed after the machine is switched on again. If the ROM update does not complete successfully for any reason, then in order to ensure the correct operation of the machine, the ROM update error will continue to show until the ROM is updated successfully. In this case, insert the card again and switch on the machine to continue the firmware download automatically from the card without the menu display. SM 5-215 D129/D130 Updating the Firmware 5.12.3 HANDLING FIRMWARE UPDATE ERRORS An error message shows in the first line if an error occurs during a download. The error code consists of the letter "E" and a number ("E20", for example). Error Message Table Code Meaning Solution Make sure the SD card is installed correctly, or 20 Cannot map logical address 21 Cannot access memory HDD connection incorrect or replace HDD. Cannot decompress Incorrect ROM data on the SD card, or data is compressed data damaged. Error occurred when ROM Controller program defective. If the second update program started attempt fails, replace controller board. 22 23 24 30 31 32 33 34 SD card access error No HDD available for stamp data download Data incorrect for continuous download Data incorrect after download interrupted Incorrect SD card version use a different SD card. Make sure the SD card is inserted correctly, or use a different SD card. HDD connection incorrect or replace HDD. Insert the SD card with the remaining data required for the download, the re-start the procedure. Execute the recovery procedure for the intended module download, then repeat the installation procedure. Incorrect ROM data on the SD card, or data is corrupted. Module mismatch - Correct SD update data is incorrect. Acquire the correct module is not on the SD data (Japan, Overseas, OEM, etc.) then install card) again. D129/D130 5-216 SM Updating the Firmware 35 36 40 42 43 44 50 SM Meaning Solution Module mismatch – Module SD update data is incorrect. The data on the SD on SD card is not for this card is for another machine. Acquire correct machine update data then install again. Cannot write module – Cause other than E34, E35 Engine module download failed SD update data is incorrect. The data on the SD card is for another machine. Acquire correct update data then install again. Replace the update data for the module on the SD card and try again, or replace the BCU board. Operation panel module Replace the update data for the module on the download failed SD card and try again, or replace the LCDC. Stamp data module Replace the update data for the module on the download failed SD card and try again, or replace the hard disks. Controller module download failed Electronic confirmation check failed Replace the update data for the module on the SD card and tray again, or replace controller board. SD update data is incorrect. The data on the SD card is for another machine. Acquire correct update data then install again. 5-217 D129/D130 Service Tables Code Uploading/Downloading NVRAM Data 5.13 UPLOADING/DOWNLOADING NVRAM DATA The content of the NVRAM can be uploaded to and downloaded from an SD card. 5.13.1 UPLOADING NVRAM DATA (SP5-824) 1. Turn off the main switch. 2. Remove the controller cover [A] ( 3. Insert the SD card into SD card slot 2 (Lower Slot) [A]. 4. Turn on the main switch. 5. Execute SP5-824. 6. Press "1" to start uploading the NVRAM data. D129/D130 x 2). 5-218 SM Uploading/Downloading NVRAM Data 5.13.2 DOWNLOADING NVRAM DATA (SP5-825) The following data are not downloaded from the SD card: Total counter C/O, P/O Counter Duplex, A3/DLT/Over 420 mm, Staple and Scanner application scanning counters (system settings). Engine SP data 1. Turn off the main switch. 2. Remove the controller cover [A] ( 3. Plug the SD card into SD card slot 2 (Lower Slot) [A]. 4. Turn on the main switch. 5. Execute SP5-825. 6. Press "1" to start downloading the NVRAM data. Service Tables x 2). SM 5-219 D129/D130 Uploading/Downloading NVRAM Data Note that the following errors could occur during downloading: If a card is not installed in the card slot and a message tells you that downloading cannot proceed, you cannot execute downloading, even by pressing "1". If the correct card for the NVRAM data is not inserted in the card slot, after you press "1" a message will tell you that downloading cannot proceed because the card is abnormal and the execution will halt. D129/D130 5-220 SM Self-Diagnostic Mode 5.14 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE 5.14.1 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE AT POWER ON As soon as the main machine is powered on, the controller waits for the initial settings of the copy engine to take effect and then starts an independent self-diagnostic test program. The self-diagnostic test follows the path of the flow chart shown below and checks the CPU, memory, HDD, and so on. An SC code is displayed in the touch panel if the self-diagnostic program Service Tables detects any malfunction or abnormal condition. SM 5-221 D129/D130 Self-Diagnostic Mode 5.14.2 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC TEST FLOW D129/D130 5-222 SM Self-Diagnostic Mode 5.14.3 DETAILED SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE In addition to the self-diagnostic test initiated every time the main machine is powered on, you can set the machine in a more detailed diagnostic mode manually in order to test other components or conditions that are not tested during self-diagnosis after power on. The following device is required in order to put the machine in the detailed self-diagnosis mode. No. Name G02119350 Parallel Loopback Connector 5.14.4 EXECUTING DETAILED SELF-DIAGNOSIS Follow this procedure to execute detailed self-diagnosis. 1. Switch off the machine, and connect the parallel loopback device to the Centronics I/F port. 2. Hold down , press and hold down , and then while pressing both keys at the same time, switch on the machine. You will see "Now Loading" on the touch-panel, and then you will see the results of the test. A report is printed every time a detailed self-diagnostic test is executed, whether errors Service Tables were detected or not. SM 5-223 D129/D130 Using the Debug Log 5.15 USING THE DEBUG LOG 5.15.1 OVERVIEW This machine provides a Save Debug Log feature that allows the Customer Engineer to save and retrieve error information for analysis. Every time an error occurs, debug information is recorded in volatile memory but this information is lost when the machine is switched off and on. To capture this debug information, the Save Debug Log feature provides two main features: Switching on the debug feature so error information is saved directly to the HDD for later retrieval. Copying the error information from the HDD to an SD card. When a user is experiencing problems with the machine, follow the procedure below to set up the machine so the error information is saved automatically to the HDD. Then ask the user to reproduce the problem. 5.15.2 SWITCHING ON AND SETTING UP SAVE DEBUG LOG The debug information cannot be saved the until the "Save Debug Log" function has been switched on and a target has been selected. 1. Enter the SP mode. 2. Under "5857 Save Debug Log", press "1". 3. On the control panel keypad, press "1" then press . This switches the Save Debug Log feature on. The default setting is "0" (OFF). This feature must be switched on in order for the debug information to be saved. 4. Next, select the target destination where the debug information will be saved. Under "5857 Save Debug Log", touch "2 Target", enter "2" with the operation panel key to select the hard disk as the target destination, then press D129/D130 . 5-224 SM Using the Debug Log Select "3 SD Card" to save the debug information directly to the SD card if it is inserted in Slot 2 (Lower Slot). 5. Now touch "5858" and specify the events that you want to record in the debug log. SP5858 (Debug Save When) provides the following items for selection. 1 Engine SC Error 2 Controller SC Error 3 Any SC Error 4 Jam Saves data when an engine-related SC code is generated. Saves debug data when a controller-related SC Code is generated. Saves data only for the SC code that you specify by Service Tables entering code number. Saves data for jams. More than one event can be selected. Example 1: To Select Items 1, 2, 4 Touch the appropriate items(s). Press "ON" for each selection. This example shows "Engine SC Error" selected. Example 2: To Specify an SC Code Touch "3 Any SC Error", enter the 3-digit SC code number with the control panel number keys, then press SM . This example shows an entry for SC670. 5-225 D129/D130 Using the Debug Log For details about SC code numbers, please refer to the SC tables in Section "4. Troubleshooting" 6. Next, select the one or more memory modules for reading and recording debug information. Touch "5859". Under "5859" press the appropriate key item for the module that you want to record. Enter the appropriate 4-digit number, then press . Refer to the two tables below for the 4-digit numbers to enter for each key. The example below shows "Key 1" with "2222" entered. The following keys can be set with the corresponding numbers. (The initials in parentheses indicate the names of the modules.) 4-Digit Entries for Keys 1 to 10 Key No. Copy 1 2222 (SCS) 2 2223 (SRM) 3 256 (IMH) 4 1000 (ECS) 5 1025 (MCS) D129/D130 Printer 5-226 Scanner Web SM Using the Debug Log 6 4848(COPY) 4400 (GPS) 5375 (Scan) 5682 (NFA) 7 2224 (BCU) 4500 (PDL) 5682 (NFA) 6600 (WebDB) 3000 (NCS) 3300 (PTS) 2000 (NCS) 6666 (WebSys) 4600 8 (GPS-PM) 9 2000 (NCS) 10 2224 (BCU) 2000 (NCS) The default settings for Keys 1 to 10 are all zero ("0"). Acronym Meaning Acronym Meaning ECS Engine Control Service NFA Net File Application GPS GW Print Service PDL Printer Design Language PTS Print Server System Control Service GSP-PM GW Print Service – Print Module IMH Image Memory Handler SCS MCS Memory Control Service SRM NCS Network Control Service WebDB System Resource Management Web Document Box (Document Server) The machine is now set to record the debugging information automatically on the HDD (the target selected with SP5-857-002) for the events that you selected SP5-858and the memory modules selected with SP5-859. Please keep the following important points in mind when you are doing this setting: Note that the number entries for Keys 1 to 5 are the same for the Copy, Printer, Scanner, and Web memory modules. The initial settings are all zero. These settings remain in effect until you change them. Be sure to check all the settings, especially the settings for Keys 6 to 10. To switch off a key setting, enter a zero for that key. SM 5-227 D129/D130 Service Tables Key to Acronyms Using the Debug Log You can select any number of keys from 1 to 10 (or all) by entering the corresponding 4-digit numbers from the table. You cannot mix settings for the groups (COPY, PRINTER, etc.) for 006to010. For example, if you want to create a PRINTER debug log you must select the settings from the 9 available selections for the "PRINTER" column only. One area of the disk is reserved to store the debug log. The size of this area is limited to 4 MB. Retrieving the Debug Log from the HDD 1. Insert the SD card into Slot 2 (Lower Slot). 2. Enter the SP mode and execute SP5857 009 (Copy HDD to SD Card (Latest 4 MB) to write the debugging data to the SD card. The SD card can hold up to 4MB of data. If the debugging data is larger than 4MB, you can switch to another SD card. 3. Use a card reader to copy the file and send it for analysis to your local Ricoh representative by email, or just send the SD card by mail. Recording Errors Manually Since only SC errors and jams are recorded to the debug log automatically, for any other errors that occur while the customer engineer is not on site, please instruct customers to perform the following immediately after occurrence to save the debug data. Such problems would include a controller or panel freeze. In order to use this feature, the customer engineer must have previously switched on the Save Debug Feature (SP5857-001) and selected the hard disk as the save destination (SP5857-002). 1. When the error occurs, on the operation panel, press 2. On the control panel, enter "01" then hold down (Reset Key). for at least 3 sec. until the machine beeps then release. This saves the debug log to the hard disk for later retrieval with an SD card by the service representatives. 3. Switch the machine off and on to resume operation. The debug information for the error is saved on the hard disk so the service representatives can retrieve it on their next visit by copying it from the HDD to an SD card. D129/D130 5-228 SM TROUBLESHOOTING R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New None Service Call Conditions 6. TROUBLESHOOTING 6.1 SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS 6.1.1 SUMMARY There are 4 levels of service call conditions. Level A Definition Reset Procedure To prevent damage to the machine, the main Enter SP mode, use SP machine cannot be operated until the SC has 5810, touch [Execute], and been reset by a service representative (see the then turn the main power note below). switch off and on. SCs that disable only the features that use the defective item. Although these SCs are not shown B to the user under normal conditions, they are displayed on the operation panel only when the Turn the operation switch or main switch off and on. defective feature is selected. D operated as usual. The SC will not be displayed. Only the SC history is updated. Turning the main switch off then on resets SCs Turn the operation switch off displayed on the operation panel. These are and on. re-displayed if the error occurs again. Also see below. Troubleshooting C The SC history is updated. The machine can be When a Level "D" SC code occurs When a Level D SC occurs, a screen opens on the operation panel to tell the operator: An error occurred The job in progress will be erased The machine will reboot automatically after approximately 30 seconds. The operator can wait until the machine reboots automatically or touch "Reset" on the screen to reset the machine immediately and go back to the copy screen. SM 6-1 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions If the operator does not touch "Reset" The next message tells the operator that the machine will reset automatically and that the previous job was lost and must be started again. After reading the message, the operator touches "Confirm" on the screen. The next screen shows the number and title of the SC code, and stops until the operator turns the machine off and on. If the operator touches "Reset" If the operator touches "Reset" to bypass the 30-second interval for the machine to reboot, the machine reboots immediately and the operation panel displays the copy screen. Do not try to use the operation panel during an automatic reboot. If the Remote Service System is in use, the SC code is sent immediately to the Service Center. 6.1.2 SC CODE DESCRIPTIONS If a problem concerns a circuit board, disconnect and reconnect the connectors and then test the machine. Often a loose or disconnected harness is the cause of the problem. Always do this before you decide to replace the PCB. If a motor lock error occurs, check the mechanical load before you decide to replace the motor or sensors. When a Level "A" or "B" SC occurs while in an SP mode, the machine cannot display the SC number. If this occurs, check the SC number after leaving the SP mode. The machine reboots automatically when the machine issues a Level "D" SC code. This is done for Level "D" SC codes only. Never turn off the main power switch when the power LED is lit or flashing. To avoid damaging the hard disk or memory, press the operation switch to switch the power off, wait for the power LED to go off, and then switch the main power switch off. The main power LED lights or flashes while the platen cover or ARDF is open, while the main machine is communicating with a facsimile or the network server, or while the machine is accessing the hard disk or memory for reading or writing data. D129/D130 6-2 SM Service Call Conditions SC Tables: SC1xx Exposure lamp error -001: Shading at AGC -002: Shading at scanning The standard white level was not detected properly when scanning the white plate 101 D Exposure lamp defective Lamp stabilizer defective Exposure lamp connector defective Standard white plate dirty Scanner mirror or scanner lens out of position or dirty SBU defective BCU defective The peak white level is less than 64/255 digits (8 bits) when scanning the shading plate. (The shading data peak does not reach the specified threshold) Scanner home position error 1 Troubleshooting The scanner home position sensor does not detect the "OFF" condition during initialization or copying. 120 D SIB (B/W), SIB (Color) or scanner drive motor defective Scanner motor defective Harness between SIB and scanner drive motor disconnected Harness between SIB and scanner drive motor power source disconnected SM Scanner HP sensor defective Harness between SIB and HP sensor disconnected Scanner wire, timing belt, pulley, or carriage defective BCU defective 6-3 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions Scanner home position error 2 The scanner home position sensor does not detect the "ON" condition during initialization or copying. 121 D SIB (B/W), SIB (Color) or scanner motor drive board defective Scanner motor defective Harness between SIB and scanner drive motor disconnected Harness between SIB and scanner drive motor power source disconnected Scanner HP sensor defective Harness between SIB and scanner HP sensor disconnected Scanner wire, timing belt, pulley, or carriage defective BCU defective Black level detection error The black level cannot be adjusted within the target value during the zero 141 D clamp. Defective SBU BCU defective White level detection error The white level cannot be adjusted within the target during auto gain control. 142 D D129/D130 Dirty exposure glass or optics section SBU board defective Exposure lamp defective Lamp stabilizer defective BCU defective 6-4 SM Service Call Conditions SBU connection error The SBU connection cannot be detected at power on or recovery from the 144 D energy save mode. Defective SBU Defective harness Defective detection port on the BCU IPU error 161 D The error result of self-diagnostic by the ASIC on the IPU is detected. Defective IPU Defective connection between IPU and SBU IPU PCIE Communication error The link up interrupt did not proceed from the LYRA when the main switch 162 D was turned on or when recovering from the energy saver mode. Defective IPU Defective BCU The copy data security board is not detected when the copy data security function is set "ON" with the initial setting. 165 D A device check error occurs when the copy data security function is set to "ON" with the initial setting. SM Incorrect installation of the copy data security board Defective copy data security board 6-5 D129/D130 Troubleshooting Copy Data Security Unit error Service Call Conditions SC Tables: SC2xx Polygon motor error 1: ON timeout 202 D The polygon mirror motor does not reach the targeted operating speed within 10 sec. after turning on or changing speed Polygon motor error 2: OFF timeout 203 D The polygon mirror motor does not leave the READY status within 3 sec. after the polygon motor switched off. Polygon motor error 3: XSCRDY signal error The SCRDY_N signal remains HIGH for 200 ms while the LD unit is firing. 204 D Polygon motor/driver board harness loose or broken Polygon motor/driver board defective Laser optics unit defective IPU defective Laser synchronizing detection error: start position LD0 The laser synchronizing detection signal for the start position of the LDB is not output for two seconds after LDB unit turns on while the polygon motor is 220 D rotating normally The Copy Data Security Unit card not installed The Copy Data Security Unit card is installed, but it is not the correct type for the machine. Laser synchronizing detection error: start position LD1 The laser synchronizing detection signal for the start position of the LDB is not output for two seconds after LDB unit turns on while the polygon motor is 221 D rotating normally. The Copy Data Security Unit card not installed The Copy Data Security Unit card is installed, but it is not the correct type for the machine. D129/D130 6-6 SM Service Call Conditions FGATE ON error 230 D The FGATE signal does not assert within the prescribed time. (The IPU generates the FGATE signal and sends it to the LD unit when the registration sensor switches on.) FGATE OFF error The FGATE signal does not assert within the prescribed time. (The IPU generates the FGATE signal and sends it to the LD unit when the registration 231 D sensor switches on.) IPU defective IPU, Controller board harness loose or broken Controller board defective. LD error 240 C The IPU detected a problem at the LD unit. Worn-out LD Disconnected or broken harness of the LD. 270 SM D The I2C bus device ID is not identified during initialization. A device-status error occurs during I2C bus communication. The I2C bus communication is not established due to an error other than a buffer shortage. Loose connection Defective IPU Defective LD controller board 6-7 D129/D130 Troubleshooting GAVD communication error Service Call Conditions SC Tables: SC3xx Charge roller bias leak A charge roller bias leak signal was detected. 302 D Charge roller damaged High voltage supply board defective PCDU harness defective or disconnected Charge roller bias correction leak The charge roller bias correction is performed twice even if the maximum 304 D charge roller bias (-2000V) is applied to the roller. ID sensor defective Worn charge roller Charge roller damaged Development roller bias leak The development roller bias leak is detected for 60 ms after the high voltage has been supplied to the development unit. 320 D D129/D130 Development bias leak Broken harness Defective high voltage power supply, voltage supply Defective high voltage supply unit 6-8 SM Service Call Conditions Development paddle motor error The machine detects a lock signal error from the development puddle motor for 2 seconds after the drum motor has turned on. 324 D Overload on the development puddle motor Defective development puddle motor Defective harness Defective IOB ID sensor pattern test error One of the following readings occurred 10 times in the ID sensor output when the ID sensor pattern was checked: 1) Vsp > 2.5V 2) Vsg < 2.5V D 3) Vsp =0V 4) Vsg = 0V ID sensor connector defective Poor ID sensor connector connection I/O board (IOB) defective Poor writing of ID sensor pattern on the drum High voltage supply board defective ID sensor Vsg test error When the ID sensor was checked, the ID sensor output voltage is 5.0V while the LED current value is 0. 351 SM D ID sensor defective or dirty ID sensor connector defective Poor ID sensor connection I/O board (IOB) defective Scanning system defective High voltage supply board defective Defect at the ID sensor pattern writing area of the drum 6-9 D129/D130 Troubleshooting 350 Service Call Conditions Grayscale measurement error When the grayscale control result is the maximum and it does not operate 355 C correctly and these cases are detected 15 times. ID sensor defective or dirty The life of ID sensor or photo conductor Shield glass dirty TD sensor (Vt) error 1 The following condition occurs thirty times consecutively during printing. Vt is 360 D less than 0.5V or 4.8V or more TD sensor disconnected Harness between TD sensor and PCDU defective Defective TD sensor. TD sensor adjustment error Vts is less than 1.8V or 4.8V or more during TD sensor initialization. 372 D Heat seal not removed from a new developer pack TD harness sensor disconnected, loose or defective TD sensor defective Harness between TD sensor and drawer disconnected, defective Drum motor error The machine detects a lock signal error from the drum motor for 2 seconds after the drum motor turned on. 396 D D129/D130 Overload on the motor Defective drum motor Defective harness Defective IOB 6-10 SM Service Call Conditions SC Tables: SC4xx Vsg adjustment error 400 D Vsg is more than 4.2V or 3.8V or less when the machine adjusts Vsg value. Dirty or defective ID sensor Defective ID sensor shutter Transfer belt bias error The feed back bias from the transfer belt is more than 4V for 60 msec while the transfer belt bias is output. 440 D The A/D conversion level is 20 or less for 60 msec. The PWM duty is 24% or more for 60 msec. Power pack broken Defective harness Disconnected connector Transfer/Development motor error The machine detects a lock signal error from the transfer/development motor 441 SM D Overload on the motor Defective transfer/development motor Defective harness Defective IOB 6-11 Troubleshooting for a continuous 20 times after the transfer/development motor turned on. D129/D130 Service Call Conditions Transfer belt contact motor error The transfer belt HP sensor detects incorrect movement of the transfer belt after the transfer belt contact motor has turned on. 442 D Dirty transfer belt HP sensor Defective transfer belt contact motor Disconnected connector of the transfer belt HP sensor or motor Disconnected cable Defective IOB SC Tables: SC5xx 1st tray lift malfunction The tray lift sensor is not activated after the tray lift motor has been on for 10 seconds. If the main power switch is turned on when the paper is already at the feed height, the paper height position is detected again. At this time, the tray lift sensor should de-activate within 1.5 sec after the paper bottom plate starts to drop. If it does not deactivate within 1.5 sec., a message will prompt 501 B the user to reset Tray 1. After two attempts to release the error by re-setting the paper tray, if this does not solve the problem then this SC is displayed. An obstruction (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.) has blocked the motor drive and caused an overload. D129/D130 Tray lift sensor connection loose, disconnected, or damaged Tray lift sensor defective Tray lift motor connection loose, disconnected, or damaged Tray lift motor defective 6-12 SM Service Call Conditions 2nd tray lift malfunction The tray lift sensor is not activated after the tray lift motor has been on for 10 seconds. If the main power switch is turned on when the paper is already at the feed height, the paper height position is detected again. At this time, the tray lift sensor should de-activate within 1.5 sec. after the paper bottom plate starts to drop. If it does not deactivate within 1.5 sec., a message will prompt 502 B the user to reset Tray 2. After two attempts to re-set the paper tray, if this does not solve the problem then this SC is displayed. An obstruction (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.) has blocked the motor drive and caused an overload. 503 B Tray lift sensor connection loose, disconnected, or damaged Tray lift sensor defective Tray lift motor connection loose, disconnected, or damaged Tray lift motor defective 3rd tray lift malfunction (optional paper feed unit or LCT) For the paper feed unit: SC 503-01 occurs if the lift sensor does not turn on within 10 seconds after the tray lift motor has turned on. For the LCT: SC 503-01 occurs if the lift sensor does not turn on or turn off within 8 Troubleshooting seconds after the tray lift motor has turned on to lift or lower the tray. For the paper feed unit: -01 - Defective tray lift motor or connector disconnection Defective lift sensor or connector disconnection For the LCT: SM Defective stack transport clutch or connector disconnection Defective tray motor or connector disconnection Defective end fence home position sensor or connector disconnection Defective upper limit sensor or connector disconnection Defective tray lift motor or connector disconnection 6-13 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions This SC is generated if the following condition occurs 3 consecutive times. For the paper feed unit: When the tray lowers, the tray lift sensor does not go off within 1.5 sec. For the LCT: When the main switch is turned on or when the LCT is set, if the end fence is not in its position (home position sensor ON), the tray lift motor stops. -02 If the upper limit does not go off for 1.5 seconds even the tray lift motor turns on to lower the tray after the upper limit has been detected at - power on. For the paper feed unit: Defective tray lift motor or connector disconnection Defective lift sensor or connector disconnection For the LCT: Defective stack transport clutch or connector disconnection Defective tray motor or connector disconnection Defective end fence home position sensor or connector disconnection 4th tray lift malfunction (optional paper feed unit or LCT) For the two-tray paper feed unit: When the tray lift motor is turned on, the upper limit is not detected within 15 seconds. If this condition occurs three consecutive times, the SC is generated. When the tray lowers, the tray lift sensor does not go off within 1.5 sec. For the LCT: 504 B After the job is finished, if the end fence is not in the home position (home position sensor ON), the tray lift motor stops. When the main switch is turned on or when the paper feed unit is set, if the end fence is not in the home position (home position sensor ON), the tray lift motor stops. If this condition occurs three consecutive times, the SC is generated. If the upper or lower limit is not detected within 8 seconds when the tray lift motor is turned on to lift up or lower the tray. D129/D130 When the tray lowers, the tray lift sensor does not go off within 1.5 sec. 6-14 SM Service Call Conditions For the paper feed unit: Defective tray lift motor or connector disconnection Defective lift sensor or connector disconnection For the LCT: Defective tray lift motor or connector disconnection Defective lift sensor or connector disconnection 5th tray lift malfunction (optional LCT) For the two-tray paper feed unit: If the upper limit of the LCT 1200-sheet is not detected within 8 seconds when the tray lift motor is turned on to lift up the tray. When the tray lowers, the tray lift sensor does not go off within 1.5 sec. For the LCT: 505 B If the upper limit of the LCT 1200-sheet is not detected within 8 seconds when the tray lift motor is turned on to lift up or lower the tray. The tray lift sensor of the LCT 1200-sheet does not go off within 1.5 seconds when the tray lowers. If this condition occurs three consecutive times, the SC is generated. Tray lift motor defective or disconnected Upper limit sensor defective or disconnected The IOB does not receive the lock signal for10 seconds after turning on the 530 SM D fusing exhaust fan. Defective fusing exhaust fan motor or connector disconnection Defective IOB Disconnected harness 6-15 D129/D130 Troubleshooting Fusing exhaust fan motor error Service Call Conditions Exhaust fan motor error The IOB does not receive the lock signal for 10 seconds after turning on the 531 D exhaust fan motor. Defective exhaust fan motor or connector disconnection. Defective IOB Disconnected harness Cooling fan motor error The machine does not detect the fan motor lock signal for 10 seconds after 532 D turning on the cooling fan motor. Defective cooling fan motor or connector disconnection. Disconnected harness Defective IOB Paper exit cooling fan motor error The machine does not detect the fan motor lock signal for 10 seconds after 533 D turning on the paper exit cooling fan motor. Defective paper exit cooling fan motor or connector disconnection. Defective IOB Disconnected harness Fusing motor error The IOB does not receive the lock signal for 2 seconds after turning on the fusing motor. 540 D D129/D130 Motor overload Defective fusing motor or connector disconnection. Defective IOB Disconnected harness 6-16 SM Service Call Conditions Fusing thermistor open (center) 541 A The thermistor (center) detects 0°C or less for 5 sec. Fusing thermistor disconnected Fusing thermistor connector defective Fusing temperature warm-up error(center) This SC is generated if the following condition occurs: 542 A The thermistor (center) does not detect an 8°C increment in the fusing temperature for 1.5 sec. just after the fusing temperature reached 45°C. The temperature of the center thermistor does not reach the target temperature for 28 seconds after the fusing lamps turned on. Thermistor warped or broken Fusing overheat error 1 (software detection) A fusing temperature (at the center) of over 230°C (446°F) is detected for 1 second by the fusing thermistors at the center or at either end of the fusing A roller. Power supply unit defective I/O board (IOB) defective BCU defective TRIAC short on PSU (PSU defective) Troubleshooting 543 Fusing overheat error 1 (hardware detection) A fusing temperature (at the center) over 250°C is detected by the fusing 544 SM A temperature monitor circuit in the BCU board. I/O board (IOB) defective BCU defective 6-17 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions Fusing lamp consecutive full power 1 After warm-up the fusing lamp remains at full power for 15 seconds without 545 A the hot roller rotating. Disconnected or defective thermistors (center) Defective fusing lamp Zero cross error The zero cross signal is detected three times even though the heater relay is off when turning on the main power. The zero cross signal is not detected for 2 seconds even though the heater relay is on after turning on the main power or closing the front 547 D door. The detection error occurs twice or more in the 11 zero cross signal detections. This error is defined when the detected zero cross signal is less than 45. Defective fusing lamp relay Defective fusing lamp relay circuit Unstable power supply Fusing thermistor open (end) 551 A The thermistor (end) detects 0°C or less for 5 sec. Fusing thermistor (end) disconnected Fusing thermistor (end) connector defective Fusing temperature warm-up error (end) This SC is generated if the following condition occurs: 552 A The thermistor (end) does not detect an 8°C increment in the fusing temperature for 1.5 sec. just after the fusing temperature reached 45°C. The temperature of the end thermistor does not reach the target temperature for 31 seconds after the fusing lamps turned on. D129/D130 Thermistor warped or broken 6-18 SM Service Call Conditions Fusing overheat error 1 (software detection) A fusing temperature (at the end) of over 230°C (446°F) is detected for 1 second by the fusing thermistors at the center or at either end of the fusing 553 A roller. Power supply unit defective I/O board (IOB) defective BCU defective TRIAC short on PSU (PSU defective) Fusing overheat error 1 (hardware detection) A fusing temperature (at the end) over 250°C is detected by the fusing 554 A temperature monitor circuit in the BCU board. I/O board (IOB) defective BCU defective Fusing lamp consecutive full power 1 After warm-up, the fusing lamp remains at full power for 40 seconds without A the hot roller rotating. Disconnected or defective thermistors (ends) Defective fusing lamp Troubleshooting 555 Zero cross frequency error When the zero cross signal is 66 or more and it is detected 10 times or more 557 C in 11 detections, the machine determines that input 60 Hz and SC557 occurs. SM Noise (High frequency) 6-19 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions Fusing unit jam The fusing sensor detected a fusing unit paper late jam three times. The paper was late and the fusing exit sensor could not detect the paper three 559 A times. Remove the paper that is stopped in the fusing unit. Check that the fusing unit is clean and has no obstacles in the paper feed path. If the error persists, replace the fusing unit. SC559 does not operate until SP1159 has been set to "1" (ON). This sets the machine to count the number of occurrences of paper late jams in the fusing unit. The default setting is "0" (OFF). SC559 is issued after the third occurrence of a paper late jam in the fusing unit. Once this SC has been issued, the machine cannot be used until the service technician removes the cause of the jam and restores it to normal operation. The jam counter is reset after a sheet of paper successfully passes the fusing exit sensor after the cause of the jam has been removed. D129/D130 6-20 SM Service Call Conditions SC Tables: SC6xx Mechanical counter error: BK This SC is only for NA models. 610 620 D D The machine detects the mechanical counter error when SP5987-001 is set to "1". Disconnected mechanical counter Defective mechanical counter ADF communication error Communication error between machine and ADF Communication error between machine and ADF with ASAP is detected. -01 - Disconnected cable ARDF defective IPU board defective External noise Communication error between IPU and ADF After the ARDF is detected, the break signal occurs or communication -02 - Incorrect installation of ARDF ARDF defective IPU board defective External noise Troubleshooting timeout occurs. Communication timeout error between IOB and finisher or mailbox A break (low) signal is received from the finisher or the mailbox. 621 SM D Disconnected cable Defective IOB Defective main board in the peripherals 6-21 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions Paper feed unit communication error While the IOB communicates with a peripheral, an SC code is displayed if one of following conditions occurs. 622 D The IOB receives the break signal which is generated by the peripheral only just after the main switch is turned on. The IOB receives the break signal which is generated by URAT. Defective main control board of the peripheral Defective BCU or IOB Disconnected peripheral 2nd Paper Bank communication error 623 D This SC is not issued for this machine when a communication error signal between the 1st paper bank and 2nd paper bank is received. Loose connector CSS communication error 630 C A communication error occurred during communication with the CSS. Communication line error MF accounting device error 1 632 B The controller sends data to the accounting device, but the device does not respond. This occurs three times. Loose connection between the controller and the accounting device MF accounting device error 2 633 B After communication is established, the controller receives the brake signal from the accounting device. D129/D130 Loose connection between the controller and the accounting device 6-22 SM Service Call Conditions MF accounting device error 3 The accounting device sends the controller the report that indicates a 634 B backup RAM error has occurred. Defective controller of the MF accounting device Battery error MF accounting device error 4 The accounting device sends the controller the report that indicates the 635 636 B D battery voltage error has occurred. Defective controller of the MF accounting device Battery error IC Card Error External authentication module error This SC is generated if the external authentication is enabled and following -01 D condition occurs: No external authentication module SD card error or external authentication module broken No DESS module -02 D Troubleshooting Version error The version of the external authentication module is not correct. Incorrect module version OSM User Code File Error The correct "usercode" file could not be found in the root folder of the SD -11 D card because the file is not present, or the existing file is corrupted or the wrong type file. Make sure the eccm.mod file is in the root folder of the SD card. Note: Check the eccm.mod file is in the root folder of the SD card. SM 6-23 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions Management area error -99 D The management number of the external authentication module exceeds the maximum limit. 637 D Software error Tracking Information Notice Error Tracking Application Error When the tracking information is lost, this SC is issued. -01 D The machine failed to give notice the tracking information to the tracking SDK application. Tracking information is lost, and the machine cannot count correctly. Tracking Information Notice Error When the tracking information is lost, this SC is issued. -02 D The machine failed to give notice the tracking information to the management server. Tracking information is lost, and the machine cannot count correctly. BCU communication error 641 D D129/D130 The BCU does not respond to the frame transmitted from the controller. Defective controller Detective BCU 6-24 SM Service Call Conditions 650 - Communication error of the remote service modem (Embedded RCG-M) Authentication error The authentication for the Embedded RCG-M fails at a dial up connection. -001 - Incorrect SP settings Disconnected telephone line Disconnected modem board Check and set the correct user name (SP5816-156) and password (SP5816-157). Incorrect modem setting -004 - Dial up fails due to the incorrect modem setting. Same as -001 Check and set the correct AT command (SP5816-160). Communication line error The supplied voltage is not sufficient due to a defective communication line -005 - or defective connection. Same as -001 Consult with the user's local telephone company. The modem board does not work properly even though the setting of the modem board is installed with a dial up connection. -013 - Same as -001 1. Install the modem board. 2. Check and reset the modem board setting with SP5816. 3. Replace the modem board. Modem board error 2 -014 SM - The modem board is installed even though the RCG-N is installed. 1. Uninstall the modem board, if it is installed. 2. Check that the Wireless LAN or Ethernet LAN is working properly. 6-25 D129/D130 Troubleshooting Modem board error 1 Service Call Conditions Incorrect dial up connection -001: Program parameter error 651 C -002: Program execution error An unexpected error occurs when the modem (Embedded RCG-M) tries to call the center with a dial up connection. Caused by a software bug ID2 mismatching ID2 for @Remote certification is mismatching between the controller board and NVRAM. 652 D Used controller board installed Used NVRAM installed An unexpected error occurs when the modem (Embedded RCG-M) tries to call the center with a dial up connection. 1. Install the correct controller board or new controller board. 2. Install the correct NVRAM or new NVRAM. ID2 error ID2 stored in the NVRAM is incorrect. 653 D Used NVRAM installed An unexpected error occurs when the modem (Embedded RCG-M) tries to call the center with a dial up connection. Clear the ID2 in the NVRAM, and then input a correct ID2. D129/D130 6-26 SM Service Call Conditions D EEPROM error [1] Open communication error: ID error [2] Open communication error: Channel error [3] Open communication error: Device error [4] Open communication error: Communication failed error [5] Open communication error: Communication time error [6] - SM - Open communication error: Communication suspended error [7] Open communication error: Buffer full error [8] Close communication error: No error code [9] Close communication error: ID error [10] Close communication error: No error code [11] Data write error: ID error [12] Data write error: Channel error [13] Data write error: Device error [14] Data write error: Communication suspended error [15] Data write error: Communication time over error [16] Data write error: Communication suspended error [17] Data write error: Buffer full error [18] Data write error: No error code [19] Data read error: ID error [20] Data read error: Channel error [21] Data read error: Device error [22] Data read error: Communication failed error [23] Data read error: Communication time over error 6-27 Troubleshooting 669 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions - - [24] Data read error: Communication suspended error [25] Data read error: Buffer full error [26] Data read error: No error code [27] Device detection error: ID error [28] Device detection error: Channel error [29] Device detection error: Device error [30] Device detection error: Communication failed error [31] Device detection error: Communication time over error [32] Device detection error: Communication suspended error [33] Device detection error: Buffer full error [34] Device detection error: No error code Retry of EEPROM communication fails three times after the machine has detected the EEPROM error. Caused by noise Engine startup error The BCU fails to respond with the prescribed time when the machine is turned on. 670 D Connections between BCU and controller board are loose, disconnected, or damaged D129/D130 1. Replace the BCU 2. Replace the controller board 6-28 SM Service Call Conditions Controller-to-operation panel communication error at startup After the machine is powered on, the communication between the controller and the operation panel is not established, or communication with controller is interrupted after a normal startup. After startup reset of the operation panel, the attention code or the attention acknowledge code is not sent from the controller within 30 seconds. 672 After the controller issues a command to check the communication line with the controller at 30-second intervals, the controller fails to respond D twice. Controller stalled Controller board installed incorrectly Controller board defective Operation panel connector loose or defective The controller is not completely shutdown when you turn the main switch off. Check the setting of SP5875-001. If the setting is set to "1 (OFF)", change it to "0 (ON)". Transmission error in controller board D Video transmission error is detected in the controller board. Defective Controller Board Troubleshooting 674 Memory address (PER) command error The BCU does not receive a memory address command from the controller for the prescribed time after the paper has reached the registration sensor. 687 SM D Harness Disconnection at BCU Controller board loose or broken Defective BCU Defective Controller Board 6-29 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions SC Tables: SC7xx 700 D Scanner feeding error 1 Pick-up roller HP error When the pick-up motor turns on counterclockwise, the pick-up roller HP 01 - sensor does not detect the home position of the pick-up roller. Defective pick-up roller HP sensor Defective pick-up motor Defective DF drive board Original stopper HP error When the pick-up motor turns on clockwise, the original stopper HP sensor 02 - does not detect the home position of the original stopper. Defective original stopper HP sensor Defective pick-up motor Defective DF drive board DF fan motor 1 error 12 - DF fan motor lock signal is detected after the original transportation has finished. 701 D Turn the main switch off and on. Scanner feeding error 2 Pick-up motor driver error The error flag of the pick-up motor driver IC is asserted when the jam error is 02 - issued. Pick-up motor driver detected an error. Turn the main switch off and on. D129/D130 6-30 SM Service Call Conditions Paper feed motor error The error flag of the paper feed motor driver IC is asserted when the jam 03 - error is issued. Pick-up motor driver detected an error. Turn the main switch off and on. 720 B 2000/3000-Sheet (booklet) Finisher Error Finisher exit guide plate motor error After moving away from the guide plate position sensor, the exit guide is not detected at the home position within the prescribed time. -24 - The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code. Guide plate motor disconnected, defective Guide plate motor overloaded due to obstruction Guide plate position sensor disconnected, defective Finisher punch motor error The punch HP sensor is not activated within the specified time after the punch motor turned on. SM - The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this SC code. Punch HP sensor disconnected, defective Punch motor disconnected or defective Punch motor overload due to obstruction 6-31 Troubleshooting -25 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions Finisher jogger motor error The jogger fences move out of the home position but the HP sensor output does not change within the specified number of pulses. The 1st failure issues an original jam message, and the 2nd failure issues -30 - this SC code. Jogger HP sensor disconnected, defective Jogger motor disconnected, defective Jogger motor overloaded due to obstruction Finisher main board and jogger motor Stack feed-out motor error The stack feed-out HP sensor does not detect the home position of the stack feed-out belt 3000ms after the stack feed-out belt has moved to its home position. The stack feed-out HP sensor does not turn off 200 ms after the stack feed-out belt has moved from its home position. -41 - The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this SC code. Defective stack feed-out HP sensor Overload on the stack feed-out motor Defective stack feed-out motor Defective main board Disconnected or defective harness Finisher stapler movement motor error Staple movement is not finished within a certain time. The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this SC code. -42 - D129/D130 Motor overload Loose connection of the stapler home position sensor Loose connection of the stapler movement motor Defective stapler home position sensor Defective stapler movement motor 6-32 SM Service Call Conditions Finisher corner stapler rotation motor error The stapler does not return to its home position within the specified time after stapling. -43 - The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this SC code. Defective stapler rotation motor Overload on the stapler rotation motor Defective stapler rotation HP sensor Finisher corner stapler motor error The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this SC code. The stapler motor does not switch off within the prescribed time after operating. -44 - The HP sensor of the staple unit does not detect the home position after the staple unit moves to its home position. The HP sensor of the staple unit detects the home position after the staple unit moves from its home position. Staple jam Motor overload Defective stapler motor Troubleshooting SM 6-33 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions Finisher folder plate motor error The folder plate moves but is not detected at the home position within the specified time. -52 - The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this SC code. Folder plate HP sensor disconnected, defective Folder plate motor disconnected, defective Folder plate motor overloaded due to obstruction. Folding unit bottom fence lift motor The folding unit bottom fence movement is not finished within a certain time. The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this -53 - SC code. Motor harness loose, broken Motor drive obstructed Motor defective Clamp roller retraction motor error The clamp roller movement is not finished within a certain time. The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this -55 - SC code. Motor harness loose, broken Motor drive obstructed Motor defective Stack junction gate motor error The stack junction gate motor moves but the stack junction gate is not detected at its position within a specific time. -57 - D129/D130 The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this SC code. Motor broken Motor connection loose Motor overloaded 6-34 SM Service Call Conditions Booklet stapler motor error 1 The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this SC code. -60 - The front stapler unit saddle-stitch motor does not start operation within the specified time. Motor overload Loose connection of the front stapler motor Defective front stapler motor Booklet staple motor error 2 The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this SC code. -61 - The rear stapler unit saddle-stitch motor does not start operation within the specified time. Motor overload Loose connection of the rear stapler motor Defective rear stapler motor Tray lift motor error The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this SC code. SM - The upper tray paper height sensor does not change its status with the specified time after the tray raises or lowers. Motor overload Loose connection of the tray lift motor Defective tray lift motor 6-35 Troubleshooting -70 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions Finisher Tray 1 shift motor error The shift roller HP sensor of the upper tray does not activate within the prescribed time after the shift tray starts to move toward or away from the home position. -71 - The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code. Shift tray HP sensor of the upper tray disconnected, defective Shift tray motor of the upper tray disconnected, defective Shift tray motor of the upper tray overloaded due to obstruction Shift jogger motor 1 error The side fence does not retract within the prescribed time after the shift jogger motor 1 switches on. -72 - The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code. Shift jogger motor 1 disconnected, defective Shift jogger motor 1 overloaded due to obstruction Shift jogger 1 HP sensor disconnected, defective Shift jogger motor 2 error The side fence does not retract within the prescribed time after the shift jogger motor 2 switches on. -73 - D129/D130 The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code. Shift jogger motor 2 disconnected, defective Shift jogger motor 2 overloaded due to obstruction Shift jogger 2 HP sensor disconnected, defective 6-36 SM Service Call Conditions Shift jogger retraction motor error The side fences do not retract within the prescribed time after the retraction motor switches on. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this -74 - SC code. Shift jogger retraction motor broken Shift jogger retraction motor connection loose Shift jogger retraction motor overloaded Defective shift jogger retraction HP sensor Return roller motor error This occurs during the operation of the lower tray pressure motor -75 - Motor harness disconnected, loose, defective Motor overloaded Home position sensor harness disconnected, loose, defective Home position defective Punch movement motor error The punch unit moves but is not detected at the home position within the specified time. -80 - The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this Motor harness disconnected, loose, defective Defective motor Troubleshooting SC code. Paper position sensor slide motor error The paper position sensor moves but is not detected at the home position within the specified time. -81 - The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this SC code. SM Motor harness disconnected, loose, defective Defective motor 6-37 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions 722 B 1000-Sheet Finisher Error Upper transport motor error The upper transport motor in the finisher is not operating. -10 - Upper transport motor drive is obstructed (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.) The motor harness is loose or broken Upper transport motor defective Lower transport motor error The lower transport motor in the finisher is not operating. -14 - Lower transport motor drive is obstructed (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.) The motor harness is loose or broken Lower transport motor defective Exit motor error The exit motor in the finisher is not operating. -17 - Exit motor drive is obstructed (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.) The motor harness is loose or broken Exit motor defective Finisher exit guide plate motor error The exit guide plate HP sensor did not activate within the prescribed time after the exit guide plate motor turned on. -24 - D129/D130 Finisher exit guide plate motor drive is obstructed (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.) Exit guide plate motor harness loose, broken Exit guide plate HP sensor harness loose, broken Exit guide plate motor defective Exit guide plate HP sensor defective 6-38 SM Service Call Conditions Front fence motor error The jogger fence motor in the finisher is not operating. -30 - Jogger motor drive is obstructed (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.) The motor harness is loose or broken Jogger fence HP sensor dirty, loose, defective Jogger fence motor defective Feed-out belt motor error The feed-out belt did not return to the home position within the prescribed time. -41 - Feed-out belt motor drive is obstructed (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.) Motor harness loose or broken Feed-out belt HP sensor dirty, disconnected, broken Motor defective Stapler movement motor The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this SC code. The stapler HP sensor is not activated within the specified time after the SM - stapler motor turned on. Stapler or motor drive is blocked by obstruction Motor harness loose or broken Stapler HP sensor harness loose, broken Motor defective Stapler HP sensor defective 6-39 Troubleshooting -42 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions Corner stapler motor error The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this SC code. The stapler motor does not switch off within the prescribed time after operating. -44 - The HP sensor of the staple unit does not detect the home position after the staple unit moves to its home position. The HP sensor of the staple unit detects the home position after the staple unit moves from its home position. Staple jam Number of sheets in stack exceeds allowed number of sheets for stapling Stapler motor obstructed Stapler motor defective Tray lift motor error The tray lift motor is not operating. -70 - Motor harness loose, broken Motor drive obstructed Stack height sensor dirty, harness loose, broken Motor defective Stack height sensor defective Shift tray motor error The shift tray motor is not operating. -71 - D129/D130 Shift motor drive is obstructed (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.) Shift motor harness loose, broken Shift tray HP sensor harness loose, broken Shift motor defective Shit tray HP sensor defective 6-40 SM Service Call Conditions Shift motor error The shift motor HP sensor does not detect any change for 1.86 seconds after 770 B the shift motor has turned on at power on or during its operation. Defective shift motor Defective shift motor HP sensor Bridge unit error The machine recognizes the finisher, but does not recognize the bridge unit. 791 D Defective connector Broken harness Incorrect installation Finisher error The machine does not recognize the finisher, but recognizes the bridge unit. B Defective connector Defective harness Incorrect installation Troubleshooting 792 SM 6-41 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions SC Tables: SC8xx Energy save I/O sub-system error 816 D Energy saver sub-system detects an error. Defective controller board Monitor Error This is a file detection and electronic file signature check error when the boot loader attempts to read the self-diagnostic module, system kernel, or root 817 D system files from the OS Flash ROM, or the items on the SD card in the controller slot are false or corrupted. OS Flash ROM data defective; change the controller firmware SD card data defective; use another SD card Watchdog timer error The watchdog timer detect the error even if system processing normally. 818 D D129/D130 System program defective Controller board defective Optional board defective 6-42 SM Service Call Conditions Fatal kernel error Due to a control error, a RAM overflow occurred during system processing. One of the following messages was displayed on the operation panel. 819 C 0x6261 6261 6420 6469 7200 00 -> "bad dir" 0x696e 0x69742064 -> "init died" 0x766d 0x5f706167 -> "vm_pageout: VM is full" 554C UL (USB error) ---- Error in the OS "init died", "vm_pageout: VM is full", "Cache Error" System program defective Controller board defective Optional board defective Replace controller firmware For more details about this SC code error, execute SP5990 to print an SMC report so Troubleshooting you can read the error code. The error code is not displayed on the operation panel. SM 6-43 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions 820 CTL Self-diagnostics error: CPU D [XXXX]: Detailed error code CPU error During the self-diagnostic, the controller CPU detects an error. There are 47 types of error code (0001 to 4005) depending on the cause of the error. The CPU detects an error and displays the specific error code with the program address where the error occurs. [0001] to [06FF] System firmware problem Defective controller 1. Turn the main switch off and on. [0801] to [4005] 2. 3. Reinstall the controller system firmware. Replace the controller. When the problem cannot be fixed with the above procedure, the following information displayed on the screen needs to be fed back to a technical support center. SC code Detailed error code Program address CPU/Memory Error [0701] to [070A] D129/D130 System firmware problem Defective RAM-DIMM Defective controller 1. Reinstall the controller system software. 2. Replace the RAM-DIMM. 3. Replace the controller. 6-44 SM Service Call Conditions 821 D Self-diagnostics error: ASIC [XXXX]: Detailed error code ASIC error [0B00] The write-&-verify check error has occurred in the ASIC. Defective ASIC device Replace the controller board. Self-diagnosis error: ASIC The CPU checks if the ASIC timer works correctly compared with the CPU timer. If the ASIC timer does not function in the specified range, this SC code [0D05] is displayed. System firmware problem Defective RAM-DIMM Defective controller Replace the controller board. Video bridge device (ASIC) error 1 [50A1] The CPU does not detect the video bridge device. Defective I/F between the video bridge device and controller [50A2] The CPU detects the video bridge device, but detects error data from the video bridge device. Defective I/F between the video bridge device and controller For more details about this SC code error, execute SP5990 to print an SMC report so you can read the error code. The error code is not displayed on the operation panel. SM 6-45 D129/D130 Troubleshooting Video bridge device (ASIC) register error 1 Service Call Conditions 822 B Self-diagnostic error: HDD Check performed only when HDD is installed: HDD device busy for over 31 s. After a diagnostic command is set for the HDD, but the device remains busy for over 6 s. [3003] HDD defective HDD harness disconnected, defective Controller board defective No response to the self-diagnostic command from the ASIC to the HDDs. [3004] 823 B HDD defective Self-diagnostic error: NIB [XXXX]: Detailed error code MAC address check sum error [6101] The result of the MAC address check sum does not match the check sum stored in ROM. PHY IC error [6104] The PHY IC on the controller cannot be correctly recognized. PHY IC loop-back error [6105] An error occurred during the loop-back test for the PHY IC on the controller. Self-diagnostic error : NVRAM NVRAM device does not exist, NVRAM device is damaged, or NVRAM socket damaged. 824 D D129/D130 NVRAM defective Controller board defective NVRAM backup battery exhausted NVRAM socket damaged 6-46 SM Service Call Conditions 826 D Self-diagnostic Error: RTC/optional NVRAM The one second counted by the RTC is different from the one second counted by the CPU on the controller. [1501] Defective RTC device The RTC device is not detected. [15FF] 827 D Defective RTC device NVRAM without RTC installed Discharged backup battery Self-diagnostic error: Standard SDRAM DIMM [XXXX]: Detailed error code Verification error Error detected during a write/verify check for the standard RAM (SDRAM [0201] DIMM). Loose connection Defective SDRAM DIMM Defective controller Resident memory error [0202] Defective RAM DIMM Defective SPD ROM on RAM DIMM Defective 12C bus Troubleshooting The SPD values in all RAM DIMM are incorrect or unreadable. Replace the RAM DIMM. SM 6-47 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions 828 Self-diagnostic error: ROM D [XXXX]: Detailed error code Check sum error 1 The boot monitor and OS program stored in the ROM DIMM is checked. If the check sum of the program is incorrect, this SC code is [0101] displayed. 1. 829 D Replace the controller board. Self-diagnostic error: Optional RAM [XXXX]: Detailed error code Verification error Error detected during a write/verify check for the optional RAM (SDRAM DIMM). [0301] Loose connection Defective SDRAM DIMM Defective controller Turn the main switch off and on. Replace the SDRAM DIMM. Replace the controller. Memory structure data error The memory structure data error for the optional RAM (SDRAM DIMM) is detected when the self-diagnostic is executed. [0302] Defective RAM DIMM Defective SPD ROM on RAM DIMM Defective 12C bus Replace the RAM DIMM. D129/D130 6-48 SM Service Call Conditions 833 C Self-diagnostic error 8: Engine I/F ASIC ASIC (Mandolin) for system control could not be detected. After the PCI [0F30] configuration, the device ID for the ASIC could not be checked. [0F31] Replace the IPU. ASIC (Mandolin) for system control could not be detected. After the PCI [0F41] configuration, the device ID for the ASIC could not be checked. Replace the IPU. Could not initialize or read the bus connection. [50B1] Check for loose connections at the mother board. Replace the IPU. Value of the SSCG register is incorrect. [50B2] Check for loose connections at the mother board. Troubleshooting Replace the IPU. SM 6-49 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions 835 C Self-diagnostic error: Centronic device Loopback connector is connected but check results in an error. [1102] IEEE1284 connector error Centronic loopback connector defective Replace the controller board. Loopback connector is connected but check results in an error. [110C] ASIC device error IEEE1284 connector error Centronic loopback connector defective Replace the controller board. Centronic loopback connector is not connected for detailed self-diagnostic test. [1120] Centronic loopback connector not connected correctly Centronic loopback connector defective ASIC device defective Replace the controller board. 838 B Self-diagnostic Error: Clock Generator A verify error occurred when setting data was read from the clock generator via the I2C bus. [2701] Defective clock generator Defective I2C bus Defective I2C port on the CPU Replace the controller board. D129/D130 6-50 SM Service Call Conditions 839 C USB NAND Flash ROM error USB NAND Flash ROM cannot be read. [9001] Defective controller board The ID of the USB NAND Flash ROM cannot be read. [9101] Defective controller board The USB NAND Flash ROM controller is disconnected. [9110] Defective controller board EEPROM error 1: EEPROM access 840 B During the I/O processing, a reading error occurred. The 3rd reading failure causes this SC code. During the I/O processing, a writing error occurred. Defective EEPROM EEPROM error 2: EEPROM read/write error 841 B Mirrored data of the EEPROM is different from the original data in EEPROM. Troubleshooting Data in the EEPROM is overwritten for some reason. Flash ROM verification error Verification error of the flash ROM on the controller board occurs. 842 B This SC is logged at 1st error detection.SC819 is issued at 2nd error detection. SC819 is issued at 2nd error detection. Defective flash ROM (controller board) SM 6-51 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions IEEE 1394 I/F error Driver setting incorrect and cannot be used by the 1394 I/F. 851 B Not supported by this machine NIB (PHY), LINK module defective; change the Interface Board Controller board defective Wireless LAN Error 1 During machine operation, the Wireless LAN device (Bluetooth) is inserted 853 B into the controller board. During machine operation, the Wireless LAN device (Bluetooth) is inserted into the controller board. Wireless LAN Error 2 During machine operation, the Wireless LAN device (Bluetooth) is pulled out 854 B from the controller board. During machine operation, the Wireless LAN device (Bluetooth) is pulled out from the controller board. Wireless LAN error 3 855 B An error is detected on the wireless LAN card (802.11a/g, g). Wireless LAN card defective Wireless LAN card connection incorrect USB I/F Error 857 B The USB driver is not stable and caused an error. Bad USB card connection Replace the controller board D129/D130 6-52 SM Service Call Conditions HDD Encryption unit error 1 858 C A serious error occurs when data is encrypted to update an encryption key with the HDD encryption unit. Encryption key acquisition error: The controller fails to get a new encryption key. -00 Defective controller board Replace the controller board. Encryption key setting for HDD error: The controller fails to copy a new encryption key to the HDD. -01 Defective SATA chip on the controller board Replace the controller board. NVRAM data encryption error 1: An error occurs while the NVRAM data is encrypted. -02 Defective NVRAM on the controller board Replace the NVRAM. NVRAM data encryption error 2: An error occurs before the NVRAM data is encrypted. -30 Defective controller board Troubleshooting Replace the controller board. Other error: -31 - A serious error occurs while the data is encrypted. SM Same as SC991 6-53 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions HDD Encryption unit error 2 859 C A serious error occurs when the HDD data is encrypted to update an encryption key with the HDD encryption unit. HDD check error: The HDD is not correctly installed. -08 - No HDD installed Unformatted HDD The encryption key on the controller is different from the one on the HDD 1. Install the HDD correctly. 2. Initialize the HDD. Power failure during the data encryption: The data encryption (NVRAM and HDD) has not been completed. -09 Power failure during the data encryption Initialize the HDD. Data read/write error: -10 - The DMAC error is detected twice or more. Same as SC863 HDD startup error at main power on 860 B HDD is connected but a driver error is detected. The driver does not respond with the HDD within 30 s. HDD is not initialized Label data is corrupted Defective HDD Initialize the HDD with SP5832-001. D129/D130 6-54 SM Service Call Conditions HDD re-try failure At power on, the HDD is detected. Power supply to the HDD is interrupted after the system has entered the energy save mode, but after the HDD has been awakened from the energy save mode, it does not return to the ready 861 D status within 30 sec. Harness between HDD and controller board disconnected, defective HDD power connector disconnected HDD defective Controller board defective Bad sector number error The number of bad sectors in the HDD (image data area) goes over 101. 862 D Defective HDD Format the HDD with SP5-832-002. Replace the HDD. 863 D HDD data read failure The data written to the HDD cannot be read normally, due to bad sectors generated during operation. Troubleshooting Note: [001] to [017] indicate the type of partition where the error occurred. Enable display of these numbers with SP7902. - SM [001] An area which does not belong to a partition [002] a partition [003] b partition [004] c partition [005] d partition [006] e partition [007] f partition - 6-55 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions - - [008] g partition [009] h partition [010] i partition [011] j partition [012] k partition [013] l partition [014] m partition [015] n partition [016] o partition [017] p partition [018] q partition [019] r partition [020] s partition [021] q partition [022] t partition [023] u partition HDD defective Note: If the bad sectors are generated at the image partition, the bad sector information is written to NVRAM, and the next time the HDD is accessed, these bad sectors will not be accessed for read/write operation. D129/D130 6-56 SM Service Call Conditions 864 D HDD data CRC error During HDD operation, the HDD cannot respond to a CRC error query. Data transfer does not execute normally while data is being written to the HDD. Note: [001] to [017] indicate the type of partition where the error occurred. Enable display of these numbers with SP7902. - SM An area which does not belong to a partition [002] a partition [003] b partition [004] c partition [005] d partition [006] e partition [007] f partition [008] g partition [009] h partition [010] i partition [011] j partition [012] k partition [013] l partition [014] m partition [015] n partition [016] o partition [017] p partition [018] q partition [019] r partition [020] s partition - - Troubleshooting - [001] 6-57 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions [021] q partition [022] t partition [023] u partition 865 D HDD defective HDD access error HDD responded to an error during operation for a condition other than those for SC863, 864. Note: [001] to [017] indicate the type of partition where the error occurred. Enable display of these numbers with SP7902. - - D129/D130 [001] An area which does not belong to a partition [002] a partition [003] b partition [004] c partition [005] d partition [006] e partition [007] f partition [008] g partition [009] h partition [010] i partition [011] j partition [012] k partition [013] l partition [014] m partition [015] n partition [016] o partition 6-58 SM Service Call Conditions - - [017] p partition [018] q partition [019] r partition [020] s partition [021] q partition [022] t partition [023] u partition HDD defective. SD card error 1: Confirmation The machine detects an electronic license error in the application on the SD card in the controller slot immediately after the machine is turned on. The program on the SD card contains electronic confirmation license data. If the 866 B program does not contain this license data, or if the result of the check shows that the license data in the program on the SD card is incorrect, then the checked program cannot execute and this SC code is displayed. Program missing from the SD card Download the correct program for the machine to the SD card 867 D Troubleshooting SD card error 2: SD card removed The SD card in the slot is removed while the machine is on. Insert the SD card, then turn the machine off and on. SM 6-59 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions SD card error 3: SC card access An error occurs while an SD card is used. 868 D SD card not inserted correctly SD card defective Controller board defective Note: If you want to try to reformat the SC card, use SD Formatter Ver 1.1. Address book data error The address book data cannot be read from the HDD, SD card or flash ROM on the controller where it is stored, or the data read from the media is defective. Software defective: Turn the machine off/on. If this is not the solution for the problem, then 870 B replace the controller firmware. HDD defective. More Details Do SP5846-046 (Initialize All Setting & Addr Book) to reset all address book data. Reset the user information with SP5832-006 (HDD Formatting– User Information). Replace the HDDs. HDD mail receive data error 872 The machine detects that the HDD is not operating correctly at power on. The machine detects that the HDD is not operating correctly (can neither B read nor write) while processing incoming email. HDD defective The machine is turned off while the HDD is being accessed. Do SP5832-008 to format the mail RX data on the HDD. D129/D130 6-60 SM Service Call Conditions HDD mail send data error An error is detected on the HDD immediately after the machine has been 873 B turned on, or power has been turned off while the machine has used the HDD. 1. Do SP5832-008 (Format HDD – Mail TX Data) to initialize the HDD. 2. Replace the HDD Delete All error 1: HDD A data error is detected for the HDD/NVRAM after the Delete All option has been used. 874 D Note: The source of this error is the DataOverwriteSecurity Unit running from an SD card. 1. Turn the main switch off/on and try the operation again. 2. Install the DataOverwriteSecurity Unit again. For more, see "Installation". 3. HDD defective Troubleshooting Delete All error 2: Data area An error occurs while the machine deletes data from the HDD. Note: The source of this error is the DataOverwriteSecurity Unit (D362) running from an SD card. 875 D -001 An error occurs in hddchack-i. -002 Failed to delete data from the HDD. -003 Turn the main switch off/on and try the operation again SM 6-61 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions Log Data Error 876 D An error is detected in the handling of the log data at power on or during machine operation. This can be caused by switching the machine off while it is operating. Log Data Error 1 -01 - Damaged log data file in the HDD Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004. Log Data Error 2 -02 - HDD encryption unit not installed 1. Ask the customer's administrator to disable the HDD encryption setting with a user tool. 2. Install the HDD encryption unit. Log Data Error 3 -03 - Invalid log encryption key due to defective NVRAM data 1. Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004. 2. Ask the customer's administrator to disable the HDD encryption setting with a user tool. Log Data Error 4 -04 - Unusual HDD encryption function due to defective NVRAM data Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004. Log Data Error 5 -05 - Installed a NVRAM or HDD which was used in another machine 1. Reinstall the previous NVRAM or HDD. 2. Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004. Log Data Error 99 -99 - Other than the above causes Ask your supervisor. D129/D130 6-62 SM Service Call Conditions HDD DataOverwriteSecurity SD card error The 'all delete' function cannot be executed but the DataOverwriteSecurity Unit is installed and activated. 877 878 B D Defective SD card SD card not installed 1. Replace the NVRAM and then install the new SD card. 2. Check and reinstall the SD card. USB Flash Error TPM system authentication error The system firmware is not authenticated by TPM (security chip). -00 - Incorrect updating for the system firmware Defective flash ROM on the controller board Replace the controller board. USB Flash Error File system in the USB flash device is defective. - Cannot mount partition 3 in the USB flash device. Encryption key does not exist. Cannot find the file for KMMD to be operated. Troubleshooting -01 Replace the controller board. TPM Error An error occurred in TPM or in TPM driver. -02 TPM defective Replace the controller board. SM 6-63 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions TCSD Error An error occurred in TPM or in TPM driver. -03 TPM defective Replace the controller board. File Format Converter (MLB) error 880 B A request to get access to the MLB is not answered within the specified time. MLB defective, replace the MLB Authentication area error 881 D Authentication application error is detected. Error data in an authentication application reaches the management limit. Software performance error If the processing program shows abnormal performance and the program is 899 D D129/D130 abnormally ended, this SC is issued. Controller board defective Software defective 6-64 SM Service Call Conditions SC Tables: SC9xx Electrical total counter error The total counter contains something that is not a number. 900 920 D B NVRAM incorrect type NVRAM defective NVRAM data scrambled Unexpected error from external source Printer error -01 Timeout error during the PM operation -02 Working memory error - -03 Cannot start-up the filtering process -04 Abnormal exit from the filtering process An internal application error was detected and operation cannot continue. - - Software defective; turn the machine off/on, or change the controller firmware Insufficient memory 921 D Printer font error -01 - Resident font is not found -02 - Option font is not found Troubleshooting A necessary font is not found in the SD card. - SM - A necessary font is not found in the SD card. The SD card data is corrupted. 6-65 D129/D130 Service Call Conditions 925 B Net File function error -00 - HDD is defective -01 - NetFile management file is broken The NetFile file management on the HDD cannot be used, or a NetFile management file is corrupted and operation cannot continue. The HDDs are defective and they cannot be debugged or partitioned, so the Scan Router - - functions (delivery of received faxes, document capture, etc.), Web services, and other network functions cannot be used. HDD status codes are displayed below the SC code. Refer to the four procedures below (Recovery from SC 925). Here is a list of HDD status codes: Display Meaning (-1) HDD not connected (-2) HDD not ready (-3) No label (-4) Partition type incorrect (-5) Error returned during label read or check (-6) Error returned during label read or check (-7) "filesystem" repair failed (-8) "filesystem" mount failed (-9) Drive does not answer command (-10) Internal kernel error (-11) Size of drive is too small (-12) Specified partition does not exist D129/D130 6-66 SM Service Call Conditions Display (-13) Meaning Device file does not exist Recovery from SC 925 Procedure 1 If the machine shows SC codes for HDD errors (SC860 to SC865) with SC 925, do the recovery procedures for SC860 to SC865. Procedure 2 If the machine does not show one of the five HDD errors (SC860 to SC865), turn the machine power off and on. If this is not the solution for the problem, then initialize the NetFile partition on the HDD with SP5832-011 (HDD Formatting – Ridoc I/F). NetFiles: Jobs printed from the document server using a PC and DeskTopBinder Before you initialize the NetFile partition on the HDD, tell the customer that: Received faxes on the delivery server will be erased All captured documents will be erased DeskTopBinder/Print Job Manager/Desk Top Editor job history will be erased Documents on the document server, and scanned documents, will not be erased. The first time that the network gets access to the machine, the management information must be configured again (this will use a lot of time). Before you initialize the Netfile partition with SP5832-011, do these steps: 1. Go into the User Tools mode and do "Delivery Settings" to print all received fax documents 2. In the User Tools mode, do Document Management> Batch Delete Transfer Documents. 3. Do SP5832-011, then turn the machine power off and on. Procedure 3 If "Procedure 2" is not the solution for the problem, do SP5832-001 (HDD Formatting – All), then turn the machine power off and on. SP5832-001 erases all document and address book data on the hard disks. Ask the customer before you do this SP code. SM 6-67 D129/D130 Troubleshooting that are scheduled for delivery. Then erase them. Service Call Conditions Procedure 4 If "Procedure 3" is not the solution for the problem, replace the HDD. Software error 1 990 D The software performs an unexpected function and the program cannot continue. Software defective, re-boot Software error 2 991 C The software performs an unexpected function. However, unlike SC990, recovery processing allows the program to continue. Software defective, re-boot In order to get more details about SC990 and SC991: 1) Execute SP7403 or print an SMC Report (SP5990) to read the history of the 10 most recent logged errors. 2) If you press the zero key on the operation panel with the SP selection menu displayed, you will see detailed information about the recently logged SC990 or SC991, including the software file name, line number, and so on. 1) is the recommended method, because another SC could write over the information for the previous SC. Undefined error 992 D Defective software program An error undetectable by any other SC code occurred Application Item Error 994 C The number of executed application items on the operation panel reach the maximum limit for the operation panel structure. D129/D130 Too much executed application items 6-68 SM Service Call Conditions 995 -01 D CPM setting error - Defective BCU NVRAM Replacement error 1. Install the previous NVRAM. 2. Input the serial number with SP5811-003, and turn the main power switch off/on. -02 - Defective NVRAM Defective controller 1. Update the controller firmware. 2. Install a new NVRAM, and turn off and on the main power switch after SC995-002 has occurred. -03 -04 - Incorrect type controller installed Defective controller 1. Replace the controller with the correct type. Incorrect model controller installed. 1. Replace the controller with the correct model. - Software Error 3: Cannot select application function An application does not start after the user pushed the correct key on the B operation panel. Software bug A RAM or DIMM option necessary for the application is not installed or not installed correctly. SM 6-69 D129/D130 Troubleshooting 997 Service Call Conditions Software Error 4: Application cannot start Register processing does not operate for an application within 60 s after the machine power is turned on. No applications start correctly, and all 998 D end abnormally. Software bug A RAM or DIMM option necessary for the application is not installed or not installed correctly. D129/D130 6-70 SM Electrical Component Defects 6.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS 6.2.1 SENSORS Component (Symbol) CN Condition By-pass Paper 236-2 Open Length Sensor (IOB) Shorted Duplex Entrance 217-A8 (IOB) Duplex Cover Duplex Exit Symptom Paper size error Open Jam Z Shorted Jam Z 217-A11 Open "Open Cover" is displayed. (IOB) Shorted “Open cover" cannot be detected. 217-A14 Open Jam Z (IOB) Shorted am Z (Jam 1) The Paper End indicator lights Open even if paper is placed on the by-pass tray. By-pass Paper End 217-B3 (IOB) Shorted light even if there is no paper on the by-pass tray. 217-B9, By-pass Paper Size Open B10,B12,B13 (IOB) Paper size error Shorted CPU cannot detect the toner Open Toner Overflow overflow even the waste toner in 217-B15 the transfer belt unit is full. (IOB) CPU detects the toner overflow Shorted even the waste toner in the transfer belt unit is not full. SM 6-71 D129/D130 Troubleshooting The Paper End indicator does not Electrical Component Defects Component (Symbol) CN Condition Symptom No symptom, but this may cause Paper Feed 1 216-A4 (IOB) Open/Shorted Jam A, and some pieces of paper are remaining at the paper feed unit when tray 1 is opened. Relay 1 Open Jam A Shorted Jam A, B 216-A7 (IOB) The Paper End indicator lights Open Paper End 1 even if paper is placed in the 216-A10 paper tray 1. (IOB) The Paper End indicator does not Shorted light even if there is no paper in the paper tray 1. Tray Lift 1 216-A13 Open/ (IOB) Shorted SC501 is displayed. No symptom, but this may cause Paper Feed 2 216-B4 (IOB) Open/ Jam A and some pieces of paper Shorted are remaining at the paper feed unit when tray 2 is opened. Relay 2 Open Jam A Shorted Jam A, B 216-B7 (IOB) The Paper End indicator lights Open Paper End 2 even if paper is placed in the 216-B10 paper tray 2. (IOB) The Paper End indicator does not Shorted light even if there is no paper in the paper tray 2. D129/D130 6-72 SM Electrical Component Defects (Symbol) Tray Lift 2 Registration Paper Size 1 Paper Size 2 Lower Paper Height 1 Lower Paper Height 2 Upper Paper Height 1 Upper Paper Height 2 Junction Jam Paper Exit Fusing Exit SM CN Condition 216-B13 Open/ (IOB) Shorted Symptom SC502 is displayed. Open Jam A (Jam 8, 17) Shorted Jam A, B (Jam 1) 209-2 (IOB) 209-4, 5, 5, 8 Open/ (IOB) Shorted 209-9, 10, Open/ 11, 13 (IOB) Shorted 210-4 (IOB) 210-7 (IOB) 210-12 (IOB) 210-15 (IOB) Paper size error in tray 1 Paper size error in tray 2 Open/ Shorted Remaining paper volume in tray 2 Open/ on the LCD is wrong. Shorted Open/ Shorted Remaining paper volume in tray 1 Open/ on the LCD is wrong. Shorted 221-A10 Open/ (IOB) Shorted Jam C Open Jam C Shorted Jam C Open Jam C Shorted Jam C Troubleshooting Component 221-B2 (IOB) 221-B5 (IOB) 6-73 D129/D130 Electrical Component Defects Component (Symbol) CN Condition Symptom Paper overflow message is not Open displayed when a paper overflow condition exists. Paper Overflow 221-B8 (IOB) Paper overflow message is Shorted displayed when a paper overflow condition does not exist. The add toner indicator blinks Open TD (Toner Density) even if there is toner in the 213-14 (IOB) development unit. Shorted CPU detects the web end even Open Web End the web is not used up. 208-16 (IOB) Shorted ID (Image Density) SC390 is displayed. CPU cannot detect the web end even the web is used up. Open SC350 is displayed after copying. Shorted SC351 is displayed after copying. 208-11 (IOB) CPU cannot detect paper even a Open sheet of paper remains at the fusing unit. Fusing Entrance 208-8 (IOB) CPU detects paper even a sheet Shorted of paper does not remain at the fusing unit. Scanner Home Position D129/D130 Open SC121 is displayed. Shorted SC120 is displayed. 318-2 (SIO) 6-74 SM Electrical Component Defects Component CN (Symbol) Condition APS and ARE do not function Open Platen Cover properly. 318-5 (SIO) Shorted Original Length 1 Original Length 2 Symptom No symptom. CPU cannot detect the original 313-2 Open/ (SIO) Shorted 313-8 Open/ (SIO) Shorted size properly. APS and ARE do not function correctly. CPU cannot detect the original size properly. APS and ARE do not function correctly. 6.2.2 SWITCHES (Symbol) CN Condition "Open Cover" is displayed even if Open Right Door the right door is closed. 221-B10 (IOB) Shorted Main Power Symptom The LCD goes blank when the right door is opened. 903-1,2 Open The machine does not turn on. (PSU) Shorted The machine does not turn off. Troubleshooting Component "Doors/Covers Open" is displayed Open Interlock even if the front or right door is 913-1,2 closed. (PSU) Shorted SM 6-75 The LCD goes blank when the front or right door is opened. D129/D130 Blown Fuse Conditions 6.3 BLOWN FUSE CONDITIONS Use a correct rating fuse for the fuse replacement. Never use a wrong rating fuse. If do so, the machine may be damaged. Rating Fuse Symptom at power on 115V 210 to 230V Power Supply Board FU21 6.3A / 250V 6.3A / 250V SC 533 (Power to IOB) FU22 6.3A / 250V 6.3A / 250V SC 144-02 (Power to SIO) FU23 10A / 250V 10A / 250V FU24 10A / 250V 10A / 250V FU25 6.3A / 250V 6.3A / 250V "Open Cover" is displayed. (Power to Interlock Switch) "Open Cover" is displayed. (Power to Interlock Switch) Alert LED turns on and operation panel does not turn on. (Power to MB) Stack paper in the optional paper feed unit or FU26 6.3A / 250V 6.3A / 250V LCT is not detected. SC 503 is issued after opening and closing the tray 3 or 4. (Power to optional PFU or LCT) The machine does not detect a finisher. FU27 6.3A / 250V 6.3 A/ 250V FU101 15A / 250V 8A / 250V No response FU102 12A / 250V 4A / 250V No response D129/D130 (Power to optional Finisher) 6-76 SM Fuses 6.4 FUSES Part No. Q'ty FU11 11071229 1 FU21, 22, 25, 26, 27 11071295 5 FU23, 24 11071216 2 FU101 11071252 1 FU102 11071320 1 FU103, 12, 14 11071225 3 Troubleshooting Fuse Address SM 6-77 D129/D130 D129/D130 SERVICE MANUAL APPENDICES D129/D130 APPENDICES TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. APPENDIX: GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS ................................. 1-1 1.1 GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS ................................................................... 1-1 1.1.1 GENERAL ......................................................................................... 1-1 1.1.2 POWER CONSUMPTION ................................................................ 1-4 1.1.3 PRINTER CONTROLLER................................................................. 1-5 1.1.4 SCANNER SPECIFICATIONS ......................................................... 1-7 1.2 OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT........................................................................... 1-8 1.2.1 ARDF (D630) .................................................................................... 1-8 1.2.2 TWO-TRAY PAPER FEED UNIT (D580) .......................................... 1-9 1.2.3 LCT 2000-SHEET (D581) ................................................................. 1-9 1.2.4 LCT 1200-SHEET (D631) ............................................................... 1-10 1.2.5 1-BIN TRAY UNIT (D632) ............................................................... 1-10 1.2.6 SIDE TRAY (D635) ......................................................................... 1-11 1.2.7 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY (D633) .................................................... 1-11 1.2.8 BRIDGE UNIT (D634) ..................................................................... 1-12 1.2.9 1000-SHEET FINISHER (D588) ..................................................... 1-12 Upper Tray ......................................................................................... 1-12 Lower Tray ......................................................................................... 1-13 1.2.10 3000-SHEET FINISHER (D636) .............................................. 1-14 1.2.11 2000-SHEET BOOKLET FINISHER (D637) ............................ 1-16 1.2.12 PUNCH UNIT FOR 2000/3000-SHEET (BOOKLET) FINISHER1-18 2. APPENDIX: PM TABLES .............................................................. 2-1 2.1 PM TABLES ............................................................................................... 2-1 2.1.1 MAINFRAME .................................................................................... 2-1 2.1.2 OPTIONS.......................................................................................... 2-5 ARDF ................................................................................................... 2-6 PFU ...................................................................................................... 2-6 LCT ...................................................................................................... 2-7 SR5020 ................................................................................................ 2-7 2000/3000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher ..................................................... 2-8 SM Appendix i D129/D130 Rev. 11/15/2012 Bridge Unit ........................................................................................... 2-8 1-Bin Tray Unit ..................................................................................... 2-9 3. APPENDIX: SERVICE PROGRAM MODE TABLES ................... 3-1 3.1 SYSTEM SP TABLE-1 ............................................................................... 3-1 3.1.1 SP1-XXX: FEED ............................................................................... 3-1 3.2 SYSTEM SP TABLES-2 .......................................................................... 3-17 3.2.1 SP2-XXX: DRUM ............................................................................ 3-17 3.3 SYSTEM SP TABLE-3 ............................................................................. 3-43 3.3.1 SP3-XXX: PROCESS ..................................................................... 3-43 3.4 SYSTEM SP TABLES-4 .......................................................................... 3-46 3.4.1 SP4-XXX: SCANNER ..................................................................... 3-46 3.5 SYSTEM SP TABLES-5 .......................................................................... 3-79 3.5.1 SP5-XXX: MODE ............................................................................ 3-79 3.6 SYSTEM SP TABLES-6 ........................................................................ 3-165 3.6.1 SP6-XXX: PERIPHERALS............................................................ 3-165 3.7 SYSTEM SP TABLES-7 ........................................................................ 3-176 3.7.1 SP7-XXX: DATA LOG................................................................... 3-176 3.8 SYSTEM SP TABLES-8 ........................................................................ 3-197 3.8.1 SP8-XXX: DATA LOG 2................................................................ 3-197 3.9 INPUT CHECK....................................................................................... 3-251 3.9.1 COPIER ........................................................................................ 3-251 Table 1: Paper Height Sensor .......................................................... 3-254 Table 2: Paper Size Switch .............................................................. 3-255 Table 3: Paper Size (By-pass Table) ............................................... 3-256 APS Original Size Detection............................................................. 3-257 3.9.2 OPTIONS...................................................................................... 3-258 3000/2000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637) ........................... 3-258 1000-Sheet Finisher (D588) ............................................................. 3-261 3.10 OUTPUT CHECK ............................................................................. 3-263 3.10.1 COPIER ................................................................................. 3-263 3.10.2 1000-SHEET FINISHER (D588) ............................................ 3-268 3.10.3 3000 /2000-SHEET (BOOKLET) FINISHER (D636/D637)..... 3-269 3.11 PRINTER SERVICE TABLES .......................................................... 3-271 3.11.1 SP1-XXX (SERVICE MODE) ................................................. 3-271 3.12 SCANNER SERVICE TABLE........................................................... 3-282 3.12.1 SP TABLES ........................................................................... 3-282 3.13 DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF SP5-749 ......................................... 3-284 D129/D130 ii SM Appendix APPENDIX: SPECIFICATIONS R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New None General Specifications Appendix: Specifications 1. APPENDIX: GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS 1.1 GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS 1.1.1 GENERAL Configuration Desktop Copy Process Dry electrostatic transfer system Original Sheet, book, three-dimensional object Original Size Maximum A3/11" x 17" A3/11" x 17" - A5 LEF Paper trays: Non-standard sizes: Width: 182 - 297 mm (7.2" - 11.7") Length: 148 mm - 432 mm (5.8" - 17") 12" x 18"/305 x 457.2 mm, A3/11" x 17" - A6 SEF Copy Paper Size By-pass tray: Non-standard sizes: Width: 90 - 305 mm (3.6" - 12") Length: 148 - 600 mm (5.8" - 23.6") A3/11" x 17" - A6 SEF Duplex: Non-standard sizes: Width: 90 - 297 mm (3.6" - 11.7") Length: 148 - 432 mm (5.8" - 17") Copy Paper Weight SM Appendix Paper trays: 60 - 216 g/m 2 (16 lb. Bond - 80 lb. Cover) By-pass: 52 - 220 g/m 2 (14 lb. Bond - 80 lb. Cover) Duplex: 60 - 169 g/m 2 (16 lb. Bond - 90 lb. Index) 1-1 D129/D130 General Specifications Metric version (%): 400, 200, 141, 122, 115, 7R5E: Reproduction Ratios 93, 82, 75, 71, 65, 50, 25 Inch version (%): 400, 200, 155, 129, 121, 93, 85, 78, 73, 65, 50, 25 Zoom: 25 to 400% in 1% steps D129 40 cpm A4, 81/2" x 11" LEF, 1-to-1 (ADF) D130 50 cpm, A4, 81/2" x 11" LEF, 1-to-1 (ADF) Basic 4.1 s, 1st Tray, A4/81/2" x 11" LEF SP 3.5 s, 1st Tray, A4/81/2" x 11" LEF Basic Less than 14.7s SP Less than 19 s Copying Speed First Copy Time Warm-up Time Continuous Copy 1 to 999 (operation panel entry) Paper Capacity 1,200 sheets (without options) (550 sheets/tray x 2 with 100 sheets in the by-pass tray) Paper Capacity (with options) 4,400 sheets (550 sheets/tray x 2 with 100 sheets in the by-pass tray, 1200-sheet LCT and 2000-sheet LCT) A4, 81/2" x 11" and Paper Output Power Source smaller: 500 sheets B4 and larger: 250 sheets North America: 120 – 127V/60 Hz, 12 A Europe/Asia: 220 – 240 V/50, 60 Hz, 7 A Taiwan 110V/60Hz, 14 A Without ADF 670 mm x 682 mm x 760 mm (26.4" x 26.9" x 30.0") Dimensions (w x d x h) With ADF D129/D130 670 mm x 682 mm x 895 mm (26.3" x 26.9" x 35.3") 1-2 SM Appendix EU Less than 85 kg (187.4 lb.) NA Less than 97 kg (213.9 lb.) Appendix: Specifications General Specifications Weight Resolution 600 dpi (Scanning and Printing) Gradation 256 levels (Scanning and Printing) Original Archive More than 2,500 A4 pages for document server (ITU-T No. 4 Chart) Toner Replenishment Cartridge exchange (630 g) Total Counter Electric counter Noise Emission: Copying Noise Emission: Stand-by SM Appendix Mainframe Only Full System D129 64.6 dB(A) 71.1 dB(A) D130 66.4 dB(A) 71.6 dB(A) Mainframe Only Full System D129 33.8 dB(A) 34.0 dB(A) D130 32.6 dB(A) 33.6 dB(A) 1-3 D129/D130 General Specifications 1.1.2 POWER CONSUMPTION Basic D129 D130 NA 156 W NA 165 W EU, Asia 157 W EU, Asia 166 W NA 745 W NA 835 W EU, Asia 742 W EU, Asia 849 W NA 1490 W NA 1490 W EU, Asia 1460W EU, Asia 1460 W Ready Operating Maximum SP D129 D130 NA 160 W NA 167 W EU, Asia 159 W EU, Asia 172 W NA 736 W NA 828 W EU, Asia 754 W EU, Asia 864 W NA 1490 W NA 1490 W EU, Asia 1460W EU, Asia 1460 W Ready Operating Maximum Full System D129 D130 NA 1584 W NA 1584 W EU, Asia 1550 W EU, Asia 1550 W Maximum The above measurements were made in accordance with ISO 7779. In the above "Panel Off" condition, the polygonal mirror motor is not rotating. D129/D130 1-4 SM Appendix Appendix: Specifications General Specifications 1.1.3 PRINTER CONTROLLER PCL 6/5e PDF Direct Printer Languages: Adobe PostScript 3 (optional) IPDS (optional) MediaPrint: JPEG/TIFF PCL 5e: 300 x 300 dpi 600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1-bit) PCL 6: 600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1-bit) Resolution and Gradation: PDF Direct: 300 x 300 dpi/600 x 600 dpi PS3: 300 x 300 dpi/600 x 600 dpi XPS: 600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1-bit) IPDS: 300 x 300 dpi/ 600 x 600 dpi Printing speed: D129: Maximum 40 ppm (A4/LT LEF) D130: Maximum 50 ppm (A4/LT LEF) PCL 6/5e (Standard): 45 Compatible fonts, 13 International fonts, Resident Fonts: 6 Bitmap fonts PDF Direct: 136 fonts IPDS (Optional): 108 fonts USB2.0 Type A and Type B: Standard Ethernet (100 Base-TX/10 Base-T): Standard Host Interfaces: Gigabit Ethernet (1000 Base-T): Optional IEEE1284 parallel x 1: Optional IEEE802.11a/b/g (Wireless LAN): Optional Bluetooth (USB type): Optional SM Appendix 1-5 D129/D130 General Specifications Network Protocols: TCP/IP (IPv4, IPv6), IPX/SPX Maximum Basic model: 512 MB RAM: SP model: 1024 MB (Resident 512 MB + Additional 512) Additional 512 MB is required for all printer/scanner unit and printer units. D129/D130 1-6 SM Appendix Appendix: Specifications General Specifications 1.1.4 SCANNER SPECIFICATIONS Standard Scanner Main scan/Sub scan Resolution: 100 to 600 dpi Twain Mode: Available scanning 100 to 1200 dpi Resolution Range: Delivery Mode: 100/200/300/400/600 dpi Grayscales: Scanning Throughput (ARDF mode): Interface: 1 bit or 8 bits/pixel each for RGB BW: 61 ipm (A4LEF / BW Text/ Photo / 200dpi /Compression: On (MH)) FC: 31 ipm (A4LEF / FC Text / Photo / 200dpi / Compression: Standard) Ethernet 10Base-T / 100Base-TX, Gigabit Ethernet (1000Base-T), Wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11a/b/g) Compression B&W: TIFF (MH, MR, MMR, JBIG2) Method: Gray Scale/Full Color: JPEG Video Memory Capacity: 109.41 MB (A4, Full Color, 600dpi) Number of originals per file: Maximum 1,000 pages Image Storage Maximum of files: 3,000 files Capacity: Storage on Doc.Server: Maximum 9,000 pages (B&W (ITU-T No.1/200 dpi MMR) SM Appendix 1-7 D129/D130 Optional Equipment 1.2 OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT 1.2.1 ARDF (D630) Size A3 to A5, DLT to HLT Weight 40 to 128 g/m 2 (11 to 34 lb.) Size A3 to A5, DLT to HLT Weight 52 to 128 g/m 2 (14 to 34 lb.) Simplex Paper Size/Weight: Duplex Table Capacity: 100 sheets (81.4 g/m 2, 22 lb) Original Standard Position: Rear left corner Separation: Feed belt and separation roller Original Transport: Roller transport Original Feed Order: From the top original Supported Magnification Ratios: 32 to 200 % Power Source: DC 24V, 5V from the scanner unit Power Consumption: Less than 70W Dimensions (W x D x H): 570 mm x 520 mm x 135 mm (22.4"x20.5"x5.3") Weight: Less than 12kg (26.5 lb.) D129/D130 1-8 SM Appendix Appendix: Specifications Optional Equipment 1.2.2 TWO-TRAY PAPER FEED UNIT (D580) Paper Feed System: FRR Paper Height Detection: 5 steps (100%, 70%, 30%, 10% (Near end), and Empty) Capacity: 550 sheets x 2 trays Paper Weight: 60 to 216 g/m 2 (16 to 80 lb. Cover) Paper Size: A3 SEF to A5, DLT SEF to HLT Power Source: DC 24V, 5V (from the main frame) Power Consumption: Less than 40 W (Max.)/ Less than 25 W (Ave,) Dimensions (W x D x H): 580 mm x 629 mm x 260 mm (22.8" x 24.8" x 10.2") Weight: 26 kg (57.3 lb.) 1.2.3 LCT 2000-SHEET (D581) Paper Size: A4 LEF/LT LEF Paper Weight: 60 g/m 2 to 216 g/m 2, 16 lb. Bond to 80 lb. Cover Tray Capacity: 2,000 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond) Remaining Paper Detection: 5 steps (100%, 70%, 30%, 10%, Empty): Right Tray 4 steps (100%, 70%, 30%, Empty): Left Tray Power Source: DC 24 V, 5 V (from copier/printer) Power Consumption: 45 W (Max.)/27 W (Ave.) Dimensions (W x D x H): 580 mm x 620 mm x 260 mm (22.8" x 24.4" x 10.2") Weight: 26 kg (57.3 lb.) SM Appendix 1-9 D129/D130 Optional Equipment 1.2.4 LCT 1200-SHEET (D631) Paper Size: A4 LEF/ LT LEF/ B5 LEF Paper Weight: 60 g/m 2 to 216 g/m 2, 16 lb. Bond to 80 lb. Cover Tray Capacity: 1200 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20lb. Bond) Remaining Paper Detection: 5 steps (100%, 75%, 30%, 10%, End) Power Source: DC 24 V, 5 V (from copier/printer) Power Consumption: 55 W (Max)/ 25 W (Ave.) Dimensions (W x D x H): 348 mm x 540 mm x 290 mm (13.7" x 21.3" x 11.4") Weight: 14 kg (30.8 lb.) 1.2.5 1-BIN TRAY UNIT (D632) Paper Size: Standard Size: A3 /DLT to A6/ HLT SEF Paper Weight: 60 to 169 g/m 2, 16 to 45 lb. Bond Tray Capacity: 125 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond, A4) Power Source: DC 24 V, 5 V (from the copier) Power Consumption: 12 W or less Dimensions (W x D x H): 565 mm x 410 mm x 115 mm (22.3"x16.2"x4.6") Weight: 2 .5 kg (5.6 lb.) D129/D130 1-10 SM Appendix Appendix: Specifications Optional Equipment 1.2.6 SIDE TRAY (D635) Paper Size: Paper Weight: Standard Size: A3 /DLT to A6/ HLT SEF 52 to 300 g/m 2, 14 lb. Bond to 110 lb. Cover Internal tray: 250 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond, A4/LT or smaller) Tray Capacity: 125 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond, B4, LG or larger) External tray: 125 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond) Power Source: DC 24 V, 5 V (from the copier) Power Consumption: 20 W or less Dimensions (W x D x H): 780 mm x 412 mm x 138 mm (30.8"x16.3"x5.5") Weight: 4.5 kg (10.0 lb.) 1.2.7 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY (D633) Paper Size: Paper Weight: Tray Capacity: Standard Size: A3 /DLT to A6/ HLT SEF 52 to 160 g/m 2, 14 lb. Bond to 60 lb. Cover 250 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond, A4/LT or smaller) 125 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond, B4, LG or larger) Power Source: DC 24 V, 5 V (from the copier) Power Consumption: 10 W or less Dimensions (W x D x H): 432 mm x 468 mm x 114 mm (16.7"x18.5"x4.5") Weight: 2 kg (4.5 lb.) SM Appendix 1-11 D129/D130 Optional Equipment 1.2.8 BRIDGE UNIT (D634) Paper Weight: Tray Capacity: 52 g/m 2 to 256 g/m 2, 16 lb. Bond to 68 lb. Bond 250 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond, A4/LT or smaller) 125 sheets (80 g/m 2, 20 lb. Bond, B4, LG or larger) Power Source: DC 24 V, 5 V (form the copier/printer) Power Consumption: 20 W or less Dimensions (W x D x H): 415 mm x 412 mm x 111 mm (16.3" x 16.2" x 4.4") Weight 4 kg (8.9 lb.) 1.2.9 1000-SHEET FINISHER (D588) Upper Tray Paper Size: Paper Weight: Paper Capacity: D129/D130 12" x 18"/305 x 457.2 mm, A3 to A6, 11" x 17" to 5.5" x 8.5" 52 to 256 g/m 2 (14 to 68 lb. Bond) 250 sheets (A4, LT or smaller) 50 sheets (B4, LG or larger) 1-12 SM Appendix Appendix: Specifications Optional Equipment Lower Tray No staple mode: 12" x 18"/305 x 457.2 mm, A3 to B5, DLT to HLT Paper Size: Staple mode: 12" x 18"/305 x 457.2 mm, A3, B4, A4, B5, DLT to LT No staple mode: 52 to 160 g/m 2 (14 lb. Bond to 60 lb. Paper Weight: Cover) Staple mode: 64 to 90 g/m 2 (17 to 24 lb. Bond) Stapler Capacity: 50 sheets (A4, B5, LT) 30 sheets (A3, B4, DLT, LG) No staple mode: 1,000 sheets (A4/LT or smaller: 80 g/m 2, 20 lb.) 500 sheets (B4 /LG or larger: 80 g/m 2, 20 lb.) Staple mode: (80 g/m 2, 20 lb., number of sets) Paper Capacity: Paper Size Sheets Sets A4,/LT LEF, B5 LEF 2 to 9 100 A4,/LT LEF, 10 to 50 100 to 20 A4,/LT LEF, B5 LEF 10 to 50 50 to 10 A3, B4, DLT, LG 2 to 9 50 A3, B4, DLT, LG 10 to 30 50 to 10 Staple positions: Top, Bottom, 2 Staples Staple Replenishment: Cartridge (5,000 staples/cartridge) Power Source: DC 24 V, 5 V (from the copier/printer) Power Consumption: 50 W Weight: 25 kg (55.2 lbs) Dimensions SM Appendix (W x D x H): 520 x 520 x 790 mm (20.5" x 20.5" x 31.2") 1-13 D129/D130 Optional Equipment 1.2.10 3000-SHEET FINISHER (D636) Finisher Dimension (w x d x h) 657 mm x 613 mm x 960 mm (25.9" x 24.2" x 37.8") Less than 54 kg (119 lb.) (no punch unit) Weight Less than 56 kg (123.5 lb.) (with punch unit) Power Consumption Less than 96 W Noise Less than 75 db Configuration Console type attached base-unit Power Source From base-unit Stack Capacity Proof Tray Paper Size Paper Weight 250 sheets: A4, 8.5" x 11" or smaller 50 sheets: B4, 8.5" x 14 or larger A6 SEF, B6 SEF, A5-A3 SEF, 5.5" x 8.5"-11" x 17" SEF, 12" x 18" SEF 52 g/m 2 - 160 g/m 2 (14 lb. Bond - 60 lb. Cover) 3,000 sheets A4 LEF, 8.5" x 11" LEF A3 SEF, A4 SEF, B4 SEF, B5, 11" x 1,500 sheets Stack Capacity 100 sheets Paper Size Paper Weight SEF, 12" x 18" SEF 500 sheets Shift Tray 17" SEF, 8.5" x 14" SEF, 8.5" x 11" A5 LEF A5 SEF, B6 SEF, A6 SEF, 5.5" x 8.5" SEF A5 - A3 SEF, A6 SEF, B6 SEF, 5.5" x 8.5"- 11" x 17" SEF, 12" x 18" SEF 52 g/m 2 - 256 g/m 2 (14 lb. Bond - 68 lb. Bond) Staples D129/D130 1-14 SM Appendix Optional Equipment 8.5" x 11" - 11" x 17", 12" x 18" Paper Weight 64 g/m 2 - 90 g/m 2 (17 lb. Bond - 20 lb. Bond) Staple Position Top, Bottom, 2 Staple, Top-slant Stapling Capacity Appendix: Specifications B5 - A3 Paper Size Same Paper 50 sheets A4, 8.5" x 11" or smaller Size 30 sheets B4, 8.5" x 14" or larger Mixed Paper 30 sheets Size Staple Replenishment A4 LEF + A3 SEF, B5 LEF + B4 SEF, 8.5" x11" LEF + 11" x 17" SEF Cartridge exchange / 5000 pins per cartridge Paper Size Pages/Set Sets 20 - 50 pages 150 - 60 sets 2 - 19 pages 150 sets A4 SEF, B5, 8.5" x 11" 15 - 50 pages 100 - 30 sets SEF 2 - 14 pages 100 sets 15 - 30 pages 100 - 33 sets 2 - 14 pages 100 sets 2 - 30 pages 50 set A4 LEF, 8.5" x 11" LEF Stapled Stack Capacity (same size) Others Stapled Stack Capacity (mixed sizes) SM Appendix A4 LEF & A3 SEF, B5 LEF & B4 SEF, 8.5" x11" LEF & 11" x 17" SEF, 1-15 D129/D130 Optional Equipment 1.2.11 2000-SHEET BOOKLET FINISHER (D637) Finisher Dimension W x D x H 657 mm x 613 mm x 960 mm (25.9 x 24.2 x 37.8") Less than 63 kg (138.6 lb.) (no punch unit) Weight Less than 65 kg (143 lb.) (with punch unit) Power Consumption Less than 96 W Noise Less than 75 db Configuration Console type attached base-unit Power Source From base-unit Stack Capacity Proof Tray Paper Size Paper Weight 250 sheets: A4, 8.5" x 11" or smaller 50 sheets: B4, 8.5" x 14 or larger A6 SEF, B6 SEF, A5-A3 SEF, 5.5" x 8.5"-11" x 17" SEF, 12" x 18" SEF 52 g/m 2 - 160 g/m 2 (14 lb. Bond - 60 lb. Cover) 2,000 A4 LEF, 8.5" x 11" LEF sheets A3 SEF, A4 SEF, B4 SEF, B5 1,000 Stack Capacity 11" x 17" SEF, 8.5" x 14" SEF, sheets 8.5" x 11" SEF, 12"x18" SEF 500 sheets A5 LEF Shift Tray 100 sheets Paper Size Paper Weight A5 SEF, B6 SEF, A6 SEF, 5.5" x 8.5" SEF A5 - A3 SEF, A6 SEF, B6 SEF 5.5" x 8.5" to 11" x 17" SEF, 12" x 18" SEF 52 g/m 2 - 256 g/m 2 (14 lb. Bond - 68 lb. Bond) Staple Paper Size D129/D130 B5-A3, 8.5" x 11" - 11" x 17", 12" x 18" 1-16 SM Appendix Paper Weight 64 g/m 2 - 90 g/m 2, 17 lb. Bond - 28 lb. Bond Staple Position Top, Bottom, 2 Staple, Top-slant Same Paper 50 sheets A4, 8.5" x 11" or smaller Size 30 sheets B4, 8.5" x 14" or larger Mixed Paper Staples Capacity Size Appendix: Specifications Optional Equipment A4 LEF & A3 SEF, B5 LEF & B4 30 sheets SEF, 8.5" x 11" LEF & 11" x 17" SEF A4 SEF, A3 SEF, B5 SEF, B4 SEF, Booklet Stapling 15 sheets 8.5" x 11" SEF, 8.5" x 14" SEF, 11" x 17" SEF, 12" x 18" SEF Corner staple 5,000 staples per cartridge Staple Replenishment Booklet staple 2,000 staples per cartridge 13 - 50 pages A4 LEF, 8.5" x 11" LEF 2 - 12 pages 10 - 50 pages Same Size A4 SEF, B5, 8.5" x 11" SEF 2 - 9 pages Corner Staple Capacity 10 - 30 pages Others 2 - 9 pages A4 LEF + A3 SEF Mixed Size B5 LEF + B4 SEF 2 - 30 pages 8.5" x 11" LEF + 11" x 17" SEF Booklet Staple Capacity SM Appendix A4 SEF, A3 SEF, B5 SEF, B4 SEF 8.5" x 11" SEF, 8.5" x 14" SEF, 11" x 17" SEF 12" x 18" SEF 2 - 5 pages 6 - 10 pages 11 - 15 pages 1-17 D129/D130 Optional Equipment 1.2.12 PUNCH UNIT FOR 2000/3000-SHEET (BOOKLET) FINISHER Available Punch Units Punch Waste Replenishment NA 2/3 holes switchable EU 2/4 holes switchable Scandinavia 4 holes NA 2-holes Up to 5,000 sheets NA 3-holes Up to 5,000 sheets EU 2-holes Up to 14,000 sheets EU 4-holes Up to 7,000 sheets Scandinavia 4-holes Up to 7,000 sheets 52 g/m 2 - 163 g/m 2, 14 lb Bond - 43 lb Bond Paper Weight SEF A5 to A3, 5.5" x 8.5" to 11" x 17" LEF A5 to A4, 5.5" x 8.5" , 8.5" x 11" SEF A3, B4, 11" x 17" LEF A4, B5, 8.5" x 11" SEF A5 to A3, 5.5" x 8.5" to 11" x 17" LEF A5 to A4, 5.5" x 8.5", 8.5" x 11" SEF A3, B4, 11"x17" LEF A4, B5, 8.5" x 11" Scandinavia SEF A5 to A3, 5.5" x 8.5" to 11" x 17" 4-holes LEF A5 to A4, 5.5" x 8.5", 8.5" x 11" NA 2-holes NA 3-holes Paper Sizes EU 2-holes EU 4-holes D129/D130 1-18 SM Appendix APPENDIX: PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE TABLES R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY P a ge Date 1~9 8/21/2012 A d de d /U pd at e d /N ew PM tables PM Tables Rev. 8/21/2012 2. APPENDIX: PM TABLES 2.1 PM TABLES Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables Amounts mentioned as the PM interval indicate the number of prints. 2.1.1 MAINFRAME Symbol key: C: Clean, R: Replace, L: Lubricate, I: Inspect EM 160K 320K 800K Note Scanner/Optics Reflector C Optics cloth 1st Mirror C Optics cloth 2nd Mirror C Optics cloth 3rd Mirror C Optics cloth Scanner Guide Rails C Do not use alcohol. Exposure Glass C C Cleaner Toner Shield Glass C C Dry cloth or cleaner C Dry cloth C Cleaner APS Sensor Exposure Glass (Sheet through) ⇒ LED Board C C Drum (OPC) Area OPC Drum Charge Roller Charge Roller Cleaning Roller Drum Cleaning Blade 1 SM Appendix I R R R R 2-1 D129/D130 PM Tables Rev. 08/21/2012 EM ⇒ Quenching Lamp 320K 800K C Pick-off Pawls Note Dry cloth R Spurs C C ID Sensor C C Cleaning Entrance Seal ⇒ 160K Dry cloth Perform SP3-001-2 after blower brush cleaning. Blower brush. C Side Seal Replace if required. C Development Unit Development Drive C Gears Development Filter ⇒ ⇒ ⇒ ⇒ ⇒ R Developer Entrance Seal I C R C Side Seal I Development Roller C Development Case C Development Sleeve Lock Lever Dry cloth Dry cloth C C C C I C Paper Feed Registration Roller Water Detach and tap gently on Idle Roller Dust Blade I C flat surface to empty. Blower brush. D129/D130 2-2 SM Appendix PM Tables Rev. 08/21/2012 160K I C Blower brush. Feed Rollers I C Water Pick-up Rollers I C Water Separation Rollers I C Water By-pass Feed Roller I C Water By-pass Pick-up Roller I C Water I C Water Paper Feed Guides I C Dry cloth Relay Rollers I C Water Bottom Plate Pad I C Water I C Water I C Blower brush I L Silicone Grease G-501 Relay Sensors I C Blower Brush Paper Feed Sensors I C Blower Brush Inverter Rollers I C Water Transport Rollers I C Water Entrance Sensor I C Water Exit Sensor I C Water Registration Roller Dust Blade By-pass Separation Roller Bottom Plate Pad (By-pass feed) Registration Sensor By-pass Feed Roller Gear 320K 800K Note Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables EM Duplex Unit ⇒ ⇒ ⇒ ⇒ SM Appendix 2-3 D129/D130 PM Tables Rev. 8/21/2012 EM 160K 320K 800K Note Transfer Belt Unit Dry cloth. To prevent damage to the Transfer Belt C cleaning blade, always R replace these items together. Transfer Belt Cleaning R Blade ⇒ Transfer Belt Rollers C Dry cloth Entrance Seal C Dry cloth Transfer Entrance Guide C C Dry cloth Used Toner Tank I C Empty the tank Seal (for paper dust) C Paper Exit Paper Exit Sensor I I Blower brush I C Blower brush Fusing Exit Sensor I I Blower brush Paper Exit Rollers I I Water Junction Transport Roller I I Water Paper Exit Guide I I Water Junction Gate Jam sensor Due to their durability and extended service life, the feed rollers, separation rollers, and pick-up rollers of the mainframe, optional paper trays, and LCT are not replaced at PM. *1 : Lubricate the by-pass feed clutch gear with Silicone Grease G501 every P.M. D129/D130 2-4 SM Appendix PM Tables Rev. 8/21/2012 EM 160K 320K 800K Note Fusing Unit and Paper Exit Exit Guide Plates C Hot Roller R Pressure Roller R Fusing Thermistors R Cleaning Roller Bushings Water or alcohol Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables Fusing Entrance and L Hot Roller Strippers Grease: Barrierta JFE 55/2 R ⇒ Web Supply Roller R Web Holder Roller R Brake Pad R 2.1.2 OPTIONS Amounts mentioned as the PM interval indicate the number of prints/ originals. Symbol key: C: Clean, R: Replace, L: Lubricate, I: Inspect SM Appendix 2-5 D129/D130 PM Tables Rev. 8/21/2012 ARDF ⇒ D630 120K EM Note (Originals) ARDF (for originals) ⇒ ⇒ ⇒ Pick-up Roller C R Damp cloth; alcohol Feed Belt C R Damp cloth; alcohol Separation Roller C R Damp cloth; alcohol Sensors C Blower brush Platen Sheet Cover C Damp cloth; alcohol (Replace if required.) White Plate C Dry or damp cloth Drive Gear L Grease G501 Transport Roller C Damp cloth; alcohol Exit Roller C Damp cloth; alcohol Inverter Roller C Damp cloth; alcohol Idle Rollers C Damp cloth; alcohol ⇒ PFU D580 EM 150K 300K 450K Note Paper Feed Unit Relay Rollers C Dry or damp cloth Bottom Plate Pad C Dry or damp cloth Relay Sensors C Dry or damp cloth Paper Feed Sensors C Dry or damp cloth Paper Feed Rollers C Dry or damp cloth D129/D130 2-6 SM Appendix PM Tables Rev. 08/21/2012 ⇒ LCT D581 EM 150K 300K 450K Note Bottom Plate Pad C Dry or damp cloth Relay Rollers C Dry or damp cloth Relay Sensors C Dry or damp cloth Paper Feed Sensors C Dry or damp cloth Paper Feed Rollers C Dry or damp cloth D631 EM 150K 300K 450K Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables LCT 2000-sheet Note LCT 1200-sheet Bottom Plate Pad C Dry or damp cloth Relay Rollers C Dry or damp cloth Relay Sensors C Dry or damp cloth Paper Feed Sensors C Dry or damp cloth Paper Feed Rollers C Dry or damp cloth B588 EM 150K 300K 450K Note 1000-Sheet Finisher Rollers C Discharge Brush C Sensors C Jogger Fences I SM Appendix Water or alcohol. C Dry cloth Blower brush I Replace if required. 2-7 D129/D130 PM Tables Rev. 8/21/2012 2000/3000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher ⇒ D637/D636 EM Note 2000/3000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher Rollers C Water or alcohol. Discharge Brush C Dry cloth Sensors C Blower brush Jogger Fences I Replace if required. C Discard chads. Punch Unit Punch Chads Bridge Unit ⇒ D634 EM Note Bridge Unit Rollers C Dry or damp cloth Copy Tray C Dry or damp cloth Sensors C Blower brush D129/D130 2-8 SM Appendix PM Tables Rev. 8/21/2012 1-Bin Tray Unit ⇒ D632 EM Note Rollers C Dry or damp cloth Copy Tray C Dry or damp cloth Sensors C Blower brush Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables 1-Bin Tray Unit Side Tray ⇒ D635 EM Note Side Tray Rollers C Dry or damp cloth Sensors C Blower brush Shift Tray ⇒ D633 EM Note Shift Tray Copy Tray SM Appendix C Dry or damp cloth 2-9 D129/D130 APPENDIX: SERVICE PROGRAM MODE TABLES R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY P a ge Date A d de d /U pd at e d /N ew 82 11/15/2012 SP5104 Default changed to 1 Blinks, added Note to SP5083 82 ~ 83 08/21/2012 SP5083 [LED Light Switch Setting - Toner Near End] 08/27/2012 Added SP5747 204 and 205. 105 System SP Table-1 3. APPENDIX: SERVICE PROGRAM MODE TABLES 3.1 SYSTEM SP TABLE-1 3.1.1 SP1-XXX: FEED 1001* Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Leading Edge Registration: Adjusts the leading edge registration by changing the registration clutch operation timing. 001 Tray: Plain 002 Tray: Thick 1 003 Tray: Thick 2 004 By-pass: Plain [–9 to 9/ 0 / 0.1 mm step] 005 By-pass: Thick 1 006 By-pass: Thick 2 007 Duplex: Plain 008 Duplex: Thick 1 SM Appendix 3-1 D129/D130 System SP Table-1 Side-to-Side Registration 1002* Adjusts the side to side registration by changing the laser main scan start position for each mode. 001 By-pass 002 Tray 1 003 Tray 2 004 Tray 3 [–4 to 4/ 0 / 0.1 mm step] 005 Tray 4 006 LCT 007 Duplex Registration Buckle Adjustment Adjusts the paper feed motor timing. Paper feed motor timing determines 1003* the amount of paper buckle at Registration. (A "+" setting causes more buckling.) 001 Tray 1: Plain 002 Tray 1: Thick 1 003 Tray 1: Thick 2 [-9 to 5 / -4 / 1 mm step] 004 Tray 2, 3, 4: Plain 005 Tray 2, 3, 4: Thick1 006 Tray 2, 3, 4: Thick2 007 By-pass: Plain 008 By-pass: Thick 1 [-9 to 5 / -2 /1 mm step] 009 By-pass: Thick 2 010 Duplex: Plain [-9 to 5 / -4 / 1 mm step] 011 Duplex: Thick 1 [-9 to 5 / -3 / 1 mm step] D129/D130 3-2 SM Appendix System SP Table-1 012 LCT: Plain 013 LCT: Thick1 [-9 to 5 / -4 / 1 mm step] 014 LCT: Thick2 By-pass Paper Size Detection 1007* Controls paper size detection for the by-pass feed table. 002 LG Detection [-15 to 15 / 0 / 5 mm step] Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 001 Detection Timing [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: LT SEF, 1: LG Fusing Idling Switches fusing idling on/off. When on, printing will not start until enough time has elapsed so the hot roller can reach optimum temperature. This 1103* ensures even heat on the hot roller. Switch on if fusing on the 1st and 2nd copies is incomplete (this may occur if the room is cold.). You must switch SP1103-1 ON before you set the fusing interval with SP1103-2. 001 Enable Fusing Idling 0 = Off, 1 = On 002 Interval [0 to 60 / 30 / 1 sec.] Sets the machine to fusing idling only for 30 sec. for every job (when the original is set on the ARDF, when the ARDF cover is opened, 003 Idling Time at Every Job etc.) and the fusing unit has reached the reload temperature (optimum temperature for operation). [0 to 30 / 0 / 1 sec.] 0: No idling done before a job. SM Appendix 3-3 D129/D130 System SP Table-1 Fusing Temperature Control On-Off/Phase Selects the fusing temperature control method. After changing this setting, be sure to turn the machine off and on again with the main power switch to enable the new setting. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Normal (ON/OFF control). Allows full application from ac power supply to bring the hot roller up to the target fusing temperature then shuts off. Determines the on-time from the present temperature (detected by the thermistor on the hot roller) and the temperature of 1 cycle before. 1: Phase (hysterisis) control. Sets the upper and lower limits for the 1104* temperature; at the lower temperature the fusing lamp is on and at the higher temperature the fusing lamp is off. Change this setting to "0" only if the user has excessive electrical noise or interference on the power supply line. Such interference can cause voltage to drop when power is applied using the ON/OFF control method. Interference can be caused by the general poor quality of the power supply lines, or if the machine is sharing a power supply with other electrical devices such as fluorescent lights. Before changing this setting, make sure that the machine is connected to a power supply not shared by other electrical equipment. Selecting Phase control ("1") could cause the fusing temperature control board to emit low pitched noise Fusing Temperature Adjustment Allows adjustment of the hot roller temperature at the center and ends of the roller for the quality or thickness of the paper. The hot roller in this machine has two fusing lamps: one heats the center of the roller, the other heats both 1105* ends. Each fusing lamp can be adjusted separately. The "re-load temperature" is the "print ready temperature". When the fusing temperature exceeds this setting, the machine can operate. Do not set up a re-load temperature (Re-load Temp. = Fusing. Temp – SP Value.) that is higher than the SP1-105-2 setting. D129/D130 3-4 SM Appendix System SP Table-1 Roller Center 001 C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg] C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg] Adjusts the fusing temperature at the center of the hot roller. Roller Ends 002 C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg] C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg] Adjusts the fusing temperature at the ends of the hot roller. Re-load Temp. Minus: Roller Center [0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg] Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Sets the reload temperature for the center of the hot roller. This setting depends on the target temperature. 003 Reload temp. = Target Temp – This SP Setting Do not set a temperature that is higher than the setting for SP1105 1 (Roller Center: Trays) Re-load Temp. Minus: Roller Ends [0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg] Sets the reload temperature for the ends of the hot roller. This setting depends on the target temperature. 004 Reload temp. = Target Temp – This SP Setting Do not set a temperature that is higher than the setting for SP1105 2 (Roller Ends: Trays) 005 to The following SPs adjust the fusing temperature at the center or ends of the 022 hot roller for each paper type. 005 Roller Center: M-Thick 006 Roller Ends: M-Thick C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg] C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg] C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg] C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 160 / 1 deg] 007 Roller Center: Thick 1 [100 to 170 / 130 / 1 deg] 008 Roller Ends: Thick 1 009 Roller Center: Thick 2 [100 to 170 / 150/ 1 deg] 010 Roller Ends: Thick 2 SM Appendix 3-5 D129/D130 System SP Table-1 011 Roller Center: Thin 012 Roller Ends: Thin 013 Roller Center: OHP: Plain C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 130 / 1 deg] C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg] C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 135 / 1 deg] C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg] [100 to 170 / 150/ 1 deg] 014 Roller Ends: OHP: Plain [100 to 170 / 155/ 1 deg] 015 Roller Center: OHP: Thick 016 Roller Ends: OHP: Thick 017 Roller Center: Special 1 018 Roller Ends: Special 1 019 Roller Center: Special 2 020 Roller Ends: Special 2 021 Roller Center: Special 3 022 Roller Ends: Special 3 023 Feed Waiting: Plain 024 Feed Waiting: M-Thick 025 Feed Waiting: Thick 1 [100 to 170 / 160/ 1 deg] C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg] C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg] C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg] C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg] C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg] C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg] C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg] C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg] C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 140 / 1 deg] C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 150 / 1 deg] C1b/C1.5b: [100 to 170 / 145 / 1 deg] C1c/C1.5c: [100 to 170 / 155 / 1 deg] Turns the feed waiting mode on or off for each paper type. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0=Off, 1=On The paper waits at the registration roller 026 Feed Waiting: Thick 2 until the fusing temperature reaches the prescribed temperature (adjustable with SP1105-028 to -37). 027 Feed Waiting: Thin If you enable this feature, also set SP 1105-38 to a convenient value for the customer. D129/D130 3-6 SM Appendix System SP Table-1 028 Feed Wait: Center Minus: Plain 029 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: Plain 030 Feed Wait: Center Minus: M-Thick 031 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: M-Thick Adjusts the offset value for each re-load 032 Feed Wait: Center Minus: Thick 1 temperature to exit the feed waiting 033 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: Thick 1 mode. [0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg] Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 034 Feed Wait: Center Minus: Thick 2 035 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: Thick 2 036 Feed Wait: Center Minus: Thin 037 Feed Wait: Ends Minus: Thin Sets the maximum feed waiting time. [0 to 30 / 0 / 1 sec] The paper is fed when the time specified 038 Feed Waiting: Maximum Time with this SP has passed even though the fusing temperature has not reached the prescribed temperature. 0: Disabled. 1106 Fusing Temperature Display 001 Roller Center Displays the temperature of the fusing unit. 002 Roller Ends [-20 to 250 / 0 / 1 deg] 003 Machine Inside at Power On Displays the temperature inside the machine. 004 Machine Inside SM Appendix [-20 to 250 / 0 / 1 deg] 3-7 D129/D130 System SP Table-1 Fusing Nip Band Check 1109* Checks the fusing nip band. 001 Execution Idling Rotation Time [0 to 120 / 60 / 1 sec] 002 Specifies the fusing rotation time before executing SP1109-001. Pre-Idling Time [5 to 30 / 10 / 1 sec] 003 Specifies the time that the paper stops in the fusing unit for measuring the nip. Fusing Jam Detection 1159 SC Code Display [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0:OFF, 1:ON This SP setting determines whether SC559 is issued after three paper late jams occur in the fusing unit. After this SP code is turned on, a counter monitors the number of paper late jams that occur in the fusing unit. After the 3rd occurrence of a fusing jam, SC559 is issued and the machine cannot be used until the service technician releases the error. Switching the machine off/on does not reset this jam counter. The counter is reset after the cause of the jam has been removed and a sheet of paper successfully passes the fusing exit sensor. D129/D130 3-8 SM Appendix System SP Table-1 Motor Speed Adjustment Adjusts the speeds of each motor. Each step decreases or increases motor speed in 0.05% increments Regist: Registration motor, Feed: Feed motor, 1801* Duplex: Duplex/By-pass motor, Inverter: Duplex inverter motor, Exit: Paper exit motor, Bridge: Bridge unit drive motor, OpcMot: Drum motor, TransferMot: Transfer/Development Motor, FusingMot: Fusing motor, Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables DevPuddleMot: Development Paddle motor 001 Regist: 90: Thick 2 002 Regist: 154: Thick 1 [-2 to 2 / 0.4 / 0.05 %] 003 Regist: 180: Plain 004 Regist: 230: Plain 005 Feed: 90: Thick 2 [-2 to 2 / -0.4 / 0.05 %] 006 Feed: 154: Thick 1 007 Feed: 180: Plain [-2 to 2 / -1 / 0.05 %] 008 Feed: 230: Plain 009 Duplex_CW: 90: Thick 2 [-4 to 4 / 0.4 / 0.1 %] 010 Duplex_CW: 154: Thick 1 011 Duplex_CW: 180: Plain [-4 to 4 / -2.3 / 0.1 %] 012 Duplex_CW: 230: Plain 013 Duplex_CCW: 90: Thick 2 [-4 to 4 / 0.4 / 0.1 %] 014 Duplex_CCW: 154: Thick 1 015 Duplex_CCW: 180: Plain [-4 to 4 / -2.3 / 0.1 %] 016 Duplex_CCW: 230: Plain 017 Inverter_CW: 90: Thick 2 [-4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %] 018 Inverter_CW: 154: Thick 1 SM Appendix 3-9 D129/D130 System SP Table-1 019 Inverter_CW: 180: Plain 020 Inverter_CW: 230: Plain 021 Inverter_CCW: 90: Thick 2 022 Inverter_CCW: 154: Thick 1 023 Inverter_CCW: 180: Plain 024 Inverter_CCW: 230: Plain 025 Exit_CW: 90: Thick 2 026 Exit_CW: 154: Thick 1 027 Exit_CW: 180: Plain 028 Exit_CW: 230: Plain 029 Bridge: 90: Thick 2 030 Bridge: 154: Thick 1 031 Bridge: 180: Plain 032 Bridge: 230: Plain 033 OpcMot:90 034 OpcMot:154 035 OpcMot:180 036 OpcMot:230 037 TransferMot:90 038 TransferMot:154 [-4 to 4 / 0 / 0.01 %] 039 TransferMot:180 040 TransferMot:230 041 FusingMot:90 042 FusingMot:154 043 FusingMot:180 D129/D130 3-10 SM Appendix System SP Table-1 044 FusingMot:230 045 DevPuddleMot 1902 [-4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %] Cleaning Web Setting Web Consumption [0 to 120 / 0 / 1 %] 001 Displays the consumed amount of the web roll. 002 C1b/C1.5b: [3 to 130 / 8.4 / 0.1 sec] C1c/C1.5c: [3 to 130 / 6.7 / 0.1 sec] Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Web Motor Interval Adjusts the interval for web motor rotation. Web Motor Time [0.3 to 10 / 4.2 / 0.1 sec] 003 Adjusts the rotation time of the web motor. C1b/C1.5b: EU [0 to 100 / 90 / 1 %] Web Near End Setting 004 C1b/C1.5b: ASIA/NA [0 to 100 / 92 / 1 %] C1c/C1.5c: EU [0 to 100 / 90 / 1 %] C1c/C1.5c: ASIA/NA [0 to 100 / 92 / 1 %] Adjusts the threshold for web near end. Web Motor Interval: Thick 1 [3 to 130 / 11.2 / 0.1 sec] 005 Adjusts the interval for web motor rotation (thick 1). Web Motor Interval: Thick 2 [3 to 130 / 16.8 / 0.1 sec] 006 Adjusts the interval for web motor rotation (thick 2). Paper Interval Time [0 to 10 / 5 / 1 sec] 007 Adjusts the threshold for paper feeding. When the time between trailing edge detection and leading edge detection is within the value of this setting, the machine determines that the paper is still being fed. Web Motor Setting: Web End [0 to 60 / 27 / 1 sec] 008 Adjusts the motor rotation time after the web end. 009 Web Motor Rotation: Power On SM Appendix [0 to 10 / 2 / 1 times] 3-11 D129/D130 System SP Table-1 Adjusts the number of web motor rotations at the re-load state. Web Motor Interval: Pre-idle [0 to 30 / 5 / 1 sec] 010 Adjusts the motor waiting time after the fusing motor idling. Web Motor Rotation: Pre-idle [0 to 10 / 2 / 1 times] 011 Adjusts the number of web motor rotations at the fusing idling state. 1903 Cleaning Web Setting Total Paper Counter [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 sec] 001 Displays the total paper feeding time. Total Web Motor Drive Time [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 sec] 002 Displays the total time of web motor rotation. 1907 Paper Feed Timing Adj. (DFU) 001 Feed Solenoid ON: Plain [-10 to 40 / 0 / 2.5 mm] 002 Feed Solenoid ON: Thick 003 Feed Solenoid OFF: Plain 004 Feed Solenoid OFF: Thick 005 Feed Clutch ON: Plain [-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm] 006 Feed Clutch ON: Thick 007 Stop Position before Inverter 008 Stop Position after Inverter 009 Re-Feed Stop Position 010 By-pass Solenoid OFF [0 to 40 / 0 / 1 mm] 011 By-pass Solenoid ON [0 to 1 / 1 / 1 mm] 012 By-pass Feed Clutch ON [-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm] D129/D130 3-12 SM Appendix System SP Table-1 013 Exit Roller: Shift: 180 014 Exit Roller: Shift: 230 015 Exit: Junction Solenoid ON 016 Exit: Junction Solenoid OFF 017 Bridge: Junction Solenoid ON 018 Bridge: Junction Solenoid OFF Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 019 1-Bin: Junction Solenoid ON 020 1-Bin: Junction Solenoid OFF 021 Shift Motor ON 1908 [-1 to 1 / 0 / 0.1 mm] Paper Bank Feed Timing Adj (DFU) 001 Feed Clutch ON: Plain [-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm] 002 Feed Clutch ON: Thick SM Appendix 3-13 D129/D130 System SP Table-1 CPM Down Setting When this machine gets a sequence of coping/printing jobs, the machine 1916 uses CPM down mode to prevent the fusing temperature from becoming too low. 001 Temp.: Plain 002 Temp.: M-Thick Adjusts the thresholds for each environmental condition (between Low 003 Temp.: Thick 1 and Medium). [10 to 23 / 17 / 1 deg] 004 Temp.: Thick 2 005 Temp.: Thin 006 ON/OFF: Low: Plain 007 ON/OFF: Low: M-Thick 008 ON/OFF: Low: Thick 1 009 ON/OFF: Low: Thick 2 Turns on or off the CPM down setting 010 ON/OFF: Low: Thin for each paper type and ambient temperature. 011 ON/OFF: Medium: Plain [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] 012 ON/OFF: Medium: M-Thick 0= Off, 1= On 013 ON/OFF: Medium:: Thick 1 014 ON/OFF: Medium: Thick 2 015 ON/OFF: Medium: Thin 016 Waiting Time: Low: Plain Adjusts the threshold time to enter the 017 Waiting Time: Low: M-Thick CPM down mode. [0 to 180 / 60 / 1 sec] 018 Waiting Time: Low: Thick 1 The machine determines whether the 019 Waiting Time: Low: Thick 2 CPM down mode is activated or not 020 Waiting Time: Low: Thin after the time specified with these SPs has passed. 021 Waiting Time: Medium: Plain D129/D130 3-14 SM Appendix System SP Table-1 022 Waiting Time: Medium: M-Thick 023 Waiting Time: Medium: Thick 1 024 Waiting Time: Medium: Thick 2 025 Waiting Time: Medium: Thin 026 Temp.: Low: Plain 027 Temp.: Low: Plain the fusing unit to enter the CPM down 029 Temp.: Low: Thick 2 mode. [100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg] 030 Temp.: Low: Thin If the temperature of the fusing unit is 031 Temp.: Medium: Plain less than the temperature specified 032 Temp.: Medium: M-Thick with these SPs, the machine changes the CPM (adjustable with SP1916-36 033 Temp.: Medium: Thick 1 to -45). 034 Temp.: Medium: Thick 2 035 Temp.: Medium: Thin Adjusts the CPM in the CPM down mode. 036 CPM: Low: Plain C1b/C1.5b: [20 to 35 / 35 / 5 cpm] C1c/C1.5c: [20 to 45 / 45 / 5 cpm] Adjusts the CPM in the CPM down mode. 037 CPM: Low: M-Thick C1b/C1.5b: [20 to 35 / 35 / 5 cpm] C1c/C1.5c: [20 to 45 / 45 / 5 cpm] Adjusts the CPM in the CPM down mode. 038 CPM: Low: Thick 1 C1b/C1.5b: [5 to 15 / 15 / 5 cpm] C1c/C1.5c: [5 to 25 / 25 / 5 cpm] Adjusts the CPM in the CPM down 039 CPM: Low: Thick 2 mode. [5 to 15 / 15 / 5 cpm] SM Appendix 3-15 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Adjusts the threshold temperature of 028 Temp.: Low: Thick 1 System SP Table-1 040 CPM: Low: Thin Adjusts the CPM in the CPM down mode. 041 CPM: Medium: Plain C1b/C1.5b: [20 to 35 / 35 / 5 cpm] C1c/C1.5c: [30 to 45 / 45 / 5 cpm] 042 CPM: Medium: M-Thick Adjusts the CPM in the CPM down mode. 043 CPM: Medium: Thick 1 C1b/C1.5b: [5 to 15 / 15 / 5 cpm] C1c/C1.5c: [5 to 25 / 25 / 5 cpm] Adjusts the CPM in the CPM down 044 CPM: Medium: Thick 2 mode. [5 to 15 / 15 / 5 cpm] Adjusts the CPM in the CPM down mode. 045 CPM: Medium: Thin C1b/C1.5b: [20 to 35 / 35 / 5 cpm] C1c/C1.5c: [30 to 45 / 45 / 5 cpm] 1930 OnOff Time Adjust On Time Adjust [0 to 100 / 40 / 10 msec] 001 Adjusts the Off-On interval of the transfer belt contact motor. ("On" means that the transfer belt is in contact with the drum.) Off Time Adjust [0 to 100 / 20 / 10 msec] 002 Adjusts the On-Off interval of the transfer belt contact motor. ("Off" means that the transfer belt is away from the drum.) Tray Lock at Jam [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0= OFF, 1= ON 1950 Not used D129/D130 3-16 SM Appendix System SP Tables-2 3.2 SYSTEM SP TABLES-2 3.2.1 SP2-XXX: DRUM 2001* Charge Bias Setting (Copying) [1000 to 2000 / 1500 / 10 V] 001 Setting (P Pattern) [0 to 700 / 250 / 10 V] 002 Adjusts the voltage applied to the charge roller when making the VSDP ID sensor pattern (for charge roller voltage correction). The actual charge roller voltage is this value plus the value of SP2001-1. 2005* Bias Control Bias Correction 1 [0.1 to 1 / 0.85 / 0.05 step] 001 Adjusts the lower threshold value for the charge roller correction. When the value of VSDP/VSG is greater than this value, the charge roller voltage increases by 30 V (e.g., from –500 to –530). Bias Correction 2 [0.1 to 1 / 0.9 / 0.05 step] 002 Adjusts the upper threshold value for the charge roller correction. When the value of VSDP/VSG is greater than this value, the charge roller voltage decreases by 30 V (absolute value). Bias Adjustment 1 [1000 to 2000 / 1500 / 10 vol] 003 Adjusts the lower limit value for charge roller voltage correction. Bias Adjustment 2 [1000 to 2000 / 2000 / 10 vol] 004 Adjusts the upper limit value for charge roller voltage correction. Bias Adjustment 3 [0 to 100 / 30 / 10 vol] 005 Adjusts the correction voltage adjustment step size. SM Appendix 3-17 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Adjusts the voltage applied to the charge roller for copying. System SP Tables-2 Magnification Adjustment Main Scan 2102* [-2 to 2 / 0 / 0.1 %] Adjusts the magnification in the main scan direction for copy mode and printer mode. Erase Margin Adjustment Adjusts the erase margin by deleting image data at the margins. 2103* L Size: 297.1 mm or more (length) M Size: 216.1 to 297 mm (length) S Size: 216 mm or less (length) 001 Leading Edge [0 to 9 / 3 / 0.1mm] 002 Trailing Edge 003 Left [0 to 9 / 2 / 0.1mm] 004 Right 005 Duplex Trail.: L Size: Plain [0 to 4 / 1 / 0.1mm] 006 Duplex Trail.: M Size: Plain [0 to 4 / 0.8 / 0.1mm] 007 Duplex Trail.: S Size: Plain [0 to 4 / 0.6 / 0.1mm] 008 Duplex Left: Plain [0 to 1.5 / 0.3 / 0.1mm] 009 Duplex Right: Plain 010 Duplex Trail.: L Size: Thick [0 to 4 / 0.8 / 0.1mm] 011 Duplex Trail.: M Size: Thick [0 to 4 / 0.6 / 0.1mm] 012 Duplex Trail.: S Size: Thick [0 to 4 / 0.4 / 0.1mm] 013 Duplex Left: Thick [0 to 1.5 / 0.1 / 0.1mm] 014 Duplex Right: Thick D129/D130 3-18 SM Appendix System SP Tables-2 LD Power Adjustment(DFU) 2105* Adjusts the LD power for each mode. Each LD power setting is decided by the process control. 001 LD1: Copy [–50 to 79 / -24 (C2b), 5 (C2c) /1 ] 002 LD2: Copy 003 LD1: Printer/Fax [–50 to 79 / -44 (C2b), -25 (C2c)/1 ] 2106* Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 004 LD2: Printer/Fax POL REV TIME (Polygon motor rotation time) PRE TIME [0 to 60 / 10 /1 sec] 001 Adjusts the time of polygon motor rotation before a job. If this is set to "0", this SP is not activated. POST TIME [0 to 60 / 0 /1 sec] Adjusts the time of the polygon motor rotation after a job. 002 If this is set to "0", the polygon motor never switches off in standby mode. However, if the machine enters the energy saver mode, the polygon motor will ignore the zero setting and switch itself off. SM Appendix 3-19 D129/D130 System SP Tables-2 2109 Test Pattern 001 Pattern Selection [0 to 24 / 0 /1 ] Test pattern of the GAVD 0: None 13: Independent Pattern (4 dot) 1: Vertical Line (1 dot) 14: Trimming Area 2: Vertical Line (2 dot) 15: Hound's Tooth Check (Vertical) 3: Horizontal Line (1 dot) 16: Hound's Tooth Check (Horizontal) 4: Horizontal Line (2 dot) 17: Black Band (Horizontal) 5: Grid Vertical Line 18: Black band ( Vertical) 6: Grid Horizontal Line 19: Checker Flag Pattern 7: Grid pattern small 20: Grayscale (Vertical Margin) 8: Grid Pattern Large 21: Grayscale (Horizontal Margin) 9: Argyle Pattern Small 22: Two Beam Density Pattern 10: Argyle Pattern Large 23: Full Dot Pattern 11: Independent pattern (1 dot) 24:All white Pattern 12: Independent Pattern (2 dot) [0 to 15 / 15 /1 ] 002 Density Set the density of the test pattern which is output in SP2109-001. This SP is not used for the Grayscale patterns. 2201* Development Bias Adjustment Development Bias [200 to 700 / 560 / 10V ] 001 Adjusts the development bias for copying. Use as a temporary measure to correct faint copies from an aging drum. ID Sensor Pattern [200 to 700 / 400 / 10V ] 002 Adjusts the development bias for the ID sensor pattern for VSP D129/D130 3-20 SM Appendix System SP Tables-2 Forced Toner Supply 2207 Forces the toner bottle to supply toner at 1-second intervals for up to 30 seconds. To start, press [EXECUTE]. Toner Supply Mode [0: Sensor, 1: pixel ] Selects the toner mode. 2208* pixel count modes only as a temporary measure if the ID or TD sensor is defective. 2209* Toner Supply Rate Toner Rate [10 to 800 / 60 mg/s / 5 mg ] Sets the amount of toner supplied every second by the toner supply motor. The length of time the motor remains on is determined by the data read by 001 the TD sensor and ID sensor. Increasing this value reduces the toner supply clutch on time. Use a lower value if the user tends to make lots of copies that have a high proportion of black. Correction Data [25 to 300 / 300 / 25 ] Displays the toner supply correction coefficient (K). It can also be used to adjust K, but the value is changed again when VT is measured for the next 002 copy. The toner supply rate depends on the amount of toner in the toner bottle. This change is corrected using this coefficient. This SP can be used to check the toner supply condition. The lower the value of K, the lower the toner density SM Appendix 3-21 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables If you select "1", SP2-209-002 should be set to its default value. Use image System SP Tables-2 P Pattern Cycle 2210* Sets the interval between ID sensor pattern prints. Job Page Count [0 to 200 / 10 / 1 sheet] 001* Sets the interval between ID sensor pattern printing. For users that do not make many copies daily, set a smaller interval to compensate for the effects of seasonal and weather changes. Forced Page Count [2 to 999 / 100 / 1 sheet] 002* Sets the interval between ID sensor pattern printing. Forces creation of the ID sensor pattern to prevent low density copies for customers who use the copier for long copy jobs. Toner End Setting Selects the detection type for toner end. [0 to 2 / 0 / 1 step] [0: 90 copies, 1: No copies, 2: 10 copies] 2213* 90 copies: Toner end is determined if a low density image (Vref < Vt(10)) is detected 90 times after toner near end. If "1" is selected, the machine stops printing when the TD sensor output drops below the prescribed level. Select 1 or 2 if the customer normally makes copies of very high density. D129/D130 3-22 SM Appendix System SP Tables-2 Vref Setting Adjusts the TD sensor reference voltage (Vref). Change this value after replacing the development unit with another development unit that contains toner. [1 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 ] 2220* 1. Check the value of SP2-220 in both the machine containing the test unit and the machine that you are going to move it to. 2. Install the test development unit, and then input the VREF for this unit 3. After the test, put back the old development unit, and change SP2-220 back to the original value. Reverse Interval Drum,Transfer [0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 sheets] Adjusts the threshold for the reverse rotation of the drum and 2221* development/transfer motors. This helps the drum and transfer belt cleaning operations. This reverse rotation will interrupt a multiple printing job. 2223* Vt Display Current [0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01] 001 Displays the TD sensor output voltage for the immediately previous copy. Average 10 copies [0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01] 002 Displays the average of the most recent TD sensor outputs (from the previous 10 copies). Rate of Change [-10000 to 10000 / 0 / 1] 003 Displays the rate of change in the TD sensor output. GAIN [0 to 255 / 0 / 1] 004 Displays the GAIN value used to calculate the on time for the toner supply motor. SM Appendix 3-23 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables into SP2-220. System SP Tables-2 Image Pixel Count [0 to 255 / 0 / 1] 005 Displays the image pixel count. Developer Lot 2228* Displays the lot number of the developer. (The lot number is embossed on the top edge of the developer pack.) Transfer Current Adjustment If the transfer current of image area is set highly than normal, the print 2301* image is easily come out. If the leading transfer current is set as same, the black line is come out due to exfoliation leave. Image Area: 1st Side 001 C2b: [10 to 100 / 35 / 1 A] C2c: [10 to 100 / 45 / 1 A] Adjusts the transfer current for printing the first side of the paper Image Area: 2nd Side 002 C2b: [10 to 100 / 35 / 1 A] C2c: [10 to 100 / 40 / 1 A] Adjusts the transfer current for printing the second side of the paper Leading Edge: 1st Side [10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A] Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the first side of the 003 paper. Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions. Leading Edge: 2nd Side [10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A] Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the second side of 004 the paper. Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions. D129/D130 3-24 SM Appendix System SP Tables-2 By-pass: Image Area C2b: [10 to 100 / 35 / 1 A] C2c: [10 to 100 / 45 / 1 A] 005 Adjusts the transfer current for copying from the by-pass tray. If the user normally feeds thicker paper from the bypass tray, use a higher setting. [10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A ] Adjusts the transfer current for copying at the leading edge of paper fed 006 from the by-pass tray. Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions. No Image Area (SSP) [10 to 100 / 15 / 1 A ] 008 Adjusts the transfer current for copying. 2309* Current: Paper Size Correction (SSP) Paper Lower Width (a) [1 to 150 / 150 / 1 mm ] Adjusts the lower paper width threshold for the transfer current, charge voltage, and development bias corrections. 001 Use this SP when an image problem (e.g., insufficient toner transfer) occurs with a small width paper. If the paper width is smaller than this value, the transfer current will be multiplied by the factor in SP2-309-3 (paper tray) or SP2-309-5 (by-pass). Paper Upper Width (a) [151 to 296 / 216 / 1 mm ] Adjusts the upper paper width threshold for the transfer current, charge 002 voltage, and development bias corrections. As for SP2-309-1, but the factors are in SP2-309-4 (paper tray) and SP2-309-6 (by-pass). SM Appendix 3-25 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables By-pass: Leading Edge System SP Tables-2 Paper Tray: Plain (alpha) [1 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 ] 003 Adjusts the transfer current correction coefficient used if the paper width is less than the setting of SP2-309-1. Paper Tray: Plain (beta) [1 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 ] 004 Adjusts the transfer current correction coefficient used if the paper width is less than the setting of SP2-309-2. By-pass: Plain (gamma) [1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ] 005 Adjusts the transfer current correction coefficient used if the paper width is less than the setting of SP2-309-1. By-pass: Plain (delta) [1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ] 006 Adjusts the transfer current correction coefficient used if the paper width is less than the setting of SP2-309-2. 007 Paper Tray: Thick 1 (alpha) [1 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 ] 008 Paper Tray: Thick 1 (beta) 009 By-pass: Thick 1 (gamma) [1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ] 010 By-pass: Thick 1 (delta) 011 Paper Tray: Thick 2 (alpha) [1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ] 012 Paper Tray: Thick 2 (beta) 013 By-pass: Thick 2 (gamma) [1 to 3 / 1.5 / 0.1 ] 014 By-pass: Thick 2 (delta) 015 Paper Tray: M-Thick (alpha) [1 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 ] 016 Paper Tray: M-Thick (beta) 017 By-pass: M-Thick (gamma) [1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ] 018 By-pass: M-Thick (delta) D129/D130 3-26 SM Appendix System SP Tables-2 019 Paper Tray: Thin (alpha) [1 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 ] 020 Paper Tray: Thin (beta) 021 By-pass: Thin (gamma) [1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ] 022 By-pass: Thin (delta) 023 Paper Tray: Special 1 (alpha) [1 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 ] Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 024 Paper Tray: Special 1 (beta) 025 By-pass: Special 1 (gamma) [1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ] 026 By-pass: Special 1 (delta) 027 Paper Tray: Special 2 (alpha) [1 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 ] 028 Paper Tray: Special 2 (beta) 029 By-pass: Special 2 (gamma) [1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ] 030 By-pass: Special 2 (delta) 031 Paper Tray: Special 3 (alpha) [1 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 ] 032 Paper Tray: Special 3 (beta) 033 By-pass: Special 3 (gamma) [1 to 3 / 1.1 / 0.1 ] 034 By-pass: Special 3 (delta) SM Appendix 3-27 D129/D130 System SP Tables-2 Current: Paper Type Correction (SSP) Adjust the transfer current for each paper type. If the transfer current of 2310* image area is set highly than normal, the print image is easily come out. If the leading transfer current is set as same, the black line is come out due to exfoliation leave. Image 1st Side: Thick 1 [10 to 100 / 18 / 1 A] 001 Adjusts the transfer current for printing the first side of the paper (Thick 1). Leading Edge 1st Side: Thick 1 [10 to 100 / 15 / 1 A] 002 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the first side of the paper. Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions (Thick 1). Image 2nd Side: Thick 1 [10 to 100 / 18 / 1 A] 003 Adjusts the transfer current for printing the second side of the paper (Thick 1). Leading Edge 2nd Side: Thick 1 [10 to 100 / 15 / 1 A] 004 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the second side of the paper (Thick 1). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions. Image: Thick 2 [10 to 100 / 18 / 1 A] 005 Adjusts the transfer current for printing (Thick 2). Leading Edge: Thick 2 [10 to 100 / 15 / 1 A] 006 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at the leading edge of paper (Thick 2). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions. D129/D130 3-28 SM Appendix System SP Tables-2 Image: OHP [10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A] 007 Adjusts the transfer current for printing (OHP). Leading Edge: OHP [10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A] 008 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at the leading edge of paper (OHP). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions. Image: Envelope [10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A] Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 009 Adjusts the transfer current for printing (Envelope). Leading Edge: Envelope [10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A] 010 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at the leading edge of paper (Envelope). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions. C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A] Image 1st Side: M-Thick C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A] 011 Adjusts the transfer current for printing the first side of the paper (M-Thick). Leading Edge 1st Side: M-Thick [10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A] 012 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the first side of the paper (M-Thick). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions. C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A] Image 2nd Side: M-Thick C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A] 013 Adjusts the transfer current for printing the second side of the paper (M-Thick). SM Appendix 3-29 D129/D130 System SP Tables-2 Leading Edge 2nd Side: M-Thick [10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A] 014 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the second side of the paper (M-Thick). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions. C2b: [10 to 100 / 35 / 1 A] Image 1st Side: Special 1 C2c: [10 to 100 / 45 / 1 A] 015 Adjusts the transfer current for printing the first side of the paper (Special 1). Leading Edge 1st Side: Special 1 [10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A] 016 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the first side of the paper (Special 1). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions. C2b: [10 to 100 / 35 / 1 A] Image 2nd Side: Special 1 C2c: [10 to 100 / 40 / 1 A] 017 Adjusts the transfer current for printing the second side of the paper (Special 1). Leading Edge 2nd Side: Special 1 [10 to 100 / 20 / 1 A] 018 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the second side of the paper (Special 1). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions. C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A] Image 1st Side: Special 2 C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A] 019 Adjusts the transfer current for printing the first side of the paper (Special 2). D129/D130 3-30 SM Appendix System SP Tables-2 Leading Edge 1st Side: Special 2 C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A] C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A] 020 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the first side of the paper (Special 2). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions. C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A] Image 2nd Side: Special 2 C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A] 021 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Adjusts the transfer current for printing the second side of the paper (Special 2). Leading Edge 2nd Side: Special 2 C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A] C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A] 022 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the second side of the paper (Special 2). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions. C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A] Image 1st Side: Special 3 C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A] 023 Adjusts the transfer current for printing the first side of the paper (Special 3). Leading Edge 1st Side: Special 3 C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A] C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A] 024 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the first side of the paper (Special 3). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions. C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A] Image 2nd Side: Special 3 C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A] 025 Adjusts the transfer current for printing the second side of the paper (Special 3). SM Appendix 3-31 D129/D130 System SP Tables-2 Leading Edge 2nd Side: Special 3 C2b: [10 to 100 / 24 / 1 A] C2c: [10 to 100 / 32 / 1 A] 026 Adjusts the transfer current for copying at leading edge the second side of the paper (Special 3). Increase the current to separate the paper from the drum properly in high humidity and high temperature conditions. PTL Control (SSP) Use this SP when an image problem occurs caused by the pick-off paws. This SP is for the printing which target line speed is 230 or 180 mm/sec. Set 2602* the PTL control (SP2603-001) to “1: ON” after installing the PTL. If the PTL control is set to ON, the black line is come out due to exfoliation leave. Set SP2911-002 (or 005, 008, 011) to “20” when using the PTL. 1st Side: OFF/ON [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 001 Sets the PTL control setting for printing the first side of the paper. 1st Side: OFF Timing [-10 to 10 / 2 / 1] 002 Sets the PTL control time for printing the first side of the paper when SP2602-001 is set to “1”. 2nd Side: OFF/ON [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 003 Sets the PTL control setting for printing the second side of the paper. 2nd Side: OFF Timing [-10 to 10 / 2 / 1] 004 Sets the PTL control time for printing the second side of the paper when SP2602-003 is set to “1”. D129/D130 3-32 SM Appendix System SP Tables-2 PTL Control: 154 mm/s (SSP) Use this SP when an image problem occurs caused by the pick-off paws. This SP is for the printing which target line speed is 154 mm/sec. Set the 2603* PTL control (SP2603-001) to “1: ON” after installing the PTL. If the PTL control is set to ON, the black line is come out due to exfoliation leave. Set SP2911-002 (or 005, 008, 011) to “20” when using the PTL. 1st Side: OFF/ON [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 001 1st Side: OFF Timing Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Sets the PTL control setting for printing the first side of the paper. [-10 to 10 / 2 / 1] 002 Sets the PTL control time for printing the first side of the paper when SP2602-001 is set to “1”. 2nd Side: OFF/ON [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 003 Sets the PTL control setting for printing the second side of the paper. 2nd Side: OFF Timing [-10 to 10 / 2 / 1] 004 Sets the PTL control time for printing the second side of the paper when SP2602-003 is set to “1”. SM Appendix 3-33 D129/D130 System SP Tables-2 PTL Control: 90 mm/s (SSP) Use this SP when an image problem occurs caused by the pick-off paws. This SP is for the printing which target line speed is 90 mm/sec. Set the PTL 2604* control (SP2603-001) to “1: ON” after installing the PTL. If the PTL control is set to ON, the black line is come out due to exfoliation leave. Set SP2911-002 (or 005, 008, 011) to “20” when using the PTL. 1st Side: OFF/ON [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 001 Sets the PTL control setting for printing the first side of the paper. 1st Side: OFF Timing [-10 to 10 / 2 / 1] 002 Sets the PTL control time for printing the first side of the paper when SP2602-001 is set to “1”. 2nd Side: OFF/ON [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 003 Sets the PTL control setting for printing the second side of the paper. 2nd Side: OFF Timing [-10 to 10 / 2 / 1] 004 Sets the PTL control time for printing the second side of the paper when SP2602-003 is set to “1”. TD Sensor Initial Setting Initialization Performs the TD sensor initial setting and allows the service technician to enter the lot number of the developer. (The lot number is embossed on the edge of the developer package.) This SP mode controls the voltage applied 2801* to the TD sensor to make the TD sensor output about 3.0 V. Press "Execute" to start. After finishing this, the TD sensor output voltage is displayed. Use this mode only after installing the machine, changing the TD sensor, or adding new developer. D129/D130 3-34 SM Appendix System SP Tables-2 TD Sensor Manual Setting 2802* Allows you to adjust the TD sensor output manually for the following. VTS [1 to 5 / 4.78 / 0.01vol ] Adjusts the TD sensor output (VT). 001 Change this value after replacing the development unit with another one that already contains toner. For example, when using a development unit from another machine for test purposes. To adjust VT, use a similar VTMAX Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables procedure as for SP2-220. [1 to 5 / 4.78 / 0.01vol ] 002 Adjusts the maximum value for SP2802 1. VTMIN [1 to 5 / 1 / 0.01vol ] 003 Adjusts the minimum value for SP2802 1. Process Setting 2805 Performs the developer initialization. Press "Execute" to start. This SP should be performed after doing SP2801 at installation and after replacing the drum. Grayscale Setting 2810 Initializes the LD power setting. This SP should be done after replacing the drum. SM Appendix 3-35 D129/D130 System SP Tables-2 2812* Drum Reverse Rotation (SSP) Reverse time [0 to 9 / 4 / 1 ] 001 Sets the reverse time of the drum motor after the end of a job. Interval time [0 to 19 / 9 /1 ] 002 Sets the waiting time of the drum motor reverse after the end of a job. 2911* Transfer Current On/Off Timing (SSP) La (On Timing) [-20 to 20 / 0 / 1 mm] 001 Adjust the timing to turn on the transfer current for the leading edge. Lb (Switch Timing) [0 to 30 / 10 / 1 mm] 002 Adjust the timing to switch transfer current from the leading edge to the image area. Lc (Off Timing) [-20 to 20 / -5 / 1 mm] 003 Adjust the timing to turn off the transfer current for the image area. La (On Timing): Special 1 [-20 to 20 / 0 / 1 mm] 004 Adjust the timing to turn on the transfer current for the leading edge (Special 1). Lb (Switch Timing): Special 1 [0 to 30 / 10 / 1 mm] 005 Adjust the timing to switch transfer current from the leading edge to the image area (Special 1). D129/D130 3-36 SM Appendix System SP Tables-2 Lc (Off Timing): Special 1 [-20 to 20 / -5 / 1 mm] 006 Adjust the timing to turn off the transfer current for the image area (Special 1). La (On Timing): Special 2 [-20 to 20 / 0 / 1 mm] 007 Adjust the timing to turn on the transfer current for the leading edge (Special 2). [0 to 30 / 10 / 1 mm] Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Lb (Switch Timing): Special 2 008 Adjust the timing to switch transfer current from the leading edge to the image area (Special 2). Lc (Off Timing): Special 2 [-20 to 20 / -5 / 1 mm] 009 Adjust the timing to turn off the transfer current for the image area (Special 2). La (On Timing): Special 3 [-20 to 20 / 0 / 1 mm] 010 Adjust the timing to turn on the transfer current for the leading edge (Special 2). Lb (Switch Timing): Special 3 [0 to 30 / 10 / 1 mm] 011 Adjust the timing to switch transfer current from the leading edge to the image area (Special 2). Lc (Off Timing): Special 3 [-20 to 20 / -5 / 1 mm] 012 Adjust the timing to turn off the transfer current for the image area (Special 2). 2912* Transfer Reverse Rotation Interval [0 to 10 / 3 / 1 ] 002 Sets the reverse time of the transfer/development motor after the end of a job. SM Appendix 3-37 D129/D130 System SP Tables-2 2914* Paper Setting C-alpha [0 to 400 / 150 / 10vol ] Adjusts the charge roller voltage used when paper with a small width is fed from the by-pass tray. The paper width below which the correction starts 001 depends on the value of SP2-309-1. Use this SP when an image problem (such as white spots at the center of black dots or breaks in thin black lines) occurs when paper with a small width is fed from the by-pass feed tray. C-beta [0 to 400 / 0 / 10vol ] Adjusts the charge roller voltage used when paper with a small width is fed 002 from the by-pass tray. The paper width below which the correction starts depends on the value of SP2-309-2. Use this SP when an image problem (see 2-914-1) occurs when paper with a small width is fed from the by-pass feed tray. B-gamma [0 to 300 / 200 / 10vol ] Adjusts the development bias used when paper with a small width is fed 003 from the by-pass tray. The paper width below which the correction starts depends on the value of SP2-309-1. Use this SP when an image problem (see 2-914-1) occurs when paper with a small width is fed from the by-pass feed tray. B-delta [0 to 300 / 50 / 10vol ] Adjusts the development bias used when paper with a small width is fed 004 from the by-pass tray. The paper width below which the correction starts depends on the value of SP2-309-2. Use this SP when an image problem (see 2-914-1) occurs when paper with a small width is fed from the by-pass feed tray. D129/D130 3-38 SM Appendix System SP Tables-2 2940* Toner consump. (SSP) [0: OFF 1: ON] [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 001 If this SP is set to ON, toner bottle consumes toner when the SP2801 (TD Sensor Initial Setting) is executed. This prevents the image offset. Setting [0 to 1 / 0.06 / 0.01] 002 Specifies the threshold value for the toner consumption mode if Toner Overflow Sensor Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables SP2940-001 is set to ON. [0 = OFF, 1= ON] 2960* Selects whether or not the toner overflow sensor is activated. Trans Cleaning Blade Forming (SSP) Applies a pattern of toner to the transfer belt at a defined interval between sheets on the transfer belt in order to reduce friction between the belt surface and the cleaning blade. 2964* Under conditions of high temperature and high humidity, the density control feature may reduce the amount of toner, which also reduces the amount of toner on the surface of the transfer belt. With less toner on the belt, the friction between the belt and the blade increases, and could cause the blade to bend or scour the surface of the belt. 001 0: OFF, 1: ON [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] 002 Pattern Interval [1 to 100 / 15 / 1 sheet] 003 Pattern Number [1 to 3 / 1 / 1 line] 004 Pattern LD Power [0 to 15 / 2 / 1 ] SM Appendix 3-39 D129/D130 System SP Tables-2 Grayscale Limit (SSP) Controls the halftone density level to prevent deterioration of the OPC. The 2972* halftone density is detected by the ID sensor, and the machine adjusts the intensity of the LD beam according to the upper/lower limit setting. Upper Limit [0 to 100 / 58 (C2b), 63 (C2c)/ 1vol ] Defines the upper limit for grayscale. 001 A larger value allows a wider range of halftones at the pale end of the scale. If the image contains pale areas with fuzzy borders surrounded by dark areas, reduce this value to make the borders clearer. Lower Limit [0 to 100 / 52 (C2b), 57 (C2c) / 1vol ] 002 Defines the lower limit for grayscale. A smaller value allows a wider range of halftones at the dark end of the scale. Grayscale Cycle (SSP) [0 to 1000 / 100 / 10 sheets ] Set s the halftone operation interval in order to prevent deterioration of the 2973* OPC. If the number of copies exceeds this setting, at the end of the job, or if the door is opened and closed, charge correction is executed. 2974* Image Density Adjustment Mode [1 to 5 / 3 / 1 ] 001 Adjusts image density. Changing this setting adjusts development bias and ID sensor output voltage that in turn raises or lowers image density. D129/D130 3-40 SM Appendix System SP Tables-2 Near End Setting Detection Time 2975* [0 to 2000 / 0 / 10 sec ] Sets a time for toner supply motor rotation for issuing the toner near end warning on the operation panel. The time may need to be shorter for customers who run especially large print jobs (working at night, for example) to ensure earlier warning of the toner near end condition so toner out does Bottle Motor Time Displays the total ON time of the toner supply motor, calculated from when the toner bottle was replaced. Use this to check that the toner end count 2976* (SP2975) is working properly. When SP2975 is set to any value other than "0", this value is displayed when it matches the setting of SP2975. When SP2975 is set to "0", SP2976 is disabled. SP2976 is automatically set to zero by toner end recovery.) Time SM Appendix [0 to 7,000,000 / 0 / 1 msec] 3-41 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables not interrupt a long job. System SP Tables-2 Toner End Status 2977* Indicates the toner near end or end condition. [0 to 10 / 0 / 1 ] 0: Not detected 1: Detected by SP2975-001 001 Near End 2: Vt (10) - Vref > 0.2 and Vsp > 0.6 3: Vt (10) - Vref > 0.45 4: 0.45 > Vt (10) - Vref > 0.2 and toner end counter > 300 5 to 10: Not used [0 to 10 / 0 / 1 ] 0: Not detected 1: Vsp > 2.0 2: Toner end counter > 90 when SP2213-001 is set to "0". 002 End 3: Toner end counter < 90 and Vt (10) > (Vref + 0.3) when SP2213-001 is set to "0". 4: When SP2213-001 is set to "2" 5: Vsp > 0.9 when SP2213-001 is set to "2" 6: Special order 7 to 10: Not used Charge Counter [0 to 1000000 / 0 / 1 sheets ] Set the number of pages to print after toner and carrier initialization before the charge input is increased to compensate for deterioration over time in 2980* the polarity of the carrier. The strength in the polarity of the carrier in the toner will eventually decrease and cause lower charge output. Setting the charge output to increase after a specified number of copies can compensate for this effect. D129/D130 3-42 SM Appendix System SP Table-3 3.3 SYSTEM SP TABLE-3 3.3.1 SP3-XXX: PROCESS P Sensor Setting Current [0 to 43 / 13 / 0.1 mA ] 001 Allows you to reset the PWM of the ID sensor LED to avoid a service call error after clearing NVRAM or replacing the NVRAM. The PWM data is stored by executing SP-3001-2. ID Initialization - Performs the ID sensor initial setting. ID sensor output for the bare drum 002 (VSG) is adjusted automatically to 4.0 ±0.2 V. Press "Execute" to start. Perform this setting after replacing or cleaning the ID sensor, replacing the drum, or clearing NVRAM. Toner End Setting, ON/OFF DFU 3045* [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0=Off, 1=On P Sensor Output Displays the current VSG, VSP, VSDP, and grayscale control. If the P sensor does not detect the P pattern, "VSP = 5.0 V/VSG = 5.0 V" is 3103* displayed and an SC code is generated. If the P sensor does not detect the bare area of the drum, "VSP = 0.0 V/VSG =0.0 V" is displayed and an SC code is generated. 001 Vsg [0 to 5 / 0 / 0.1] 002 Vsp [0 to 5 / 0 / 0.1] 003 Vsdp [0 to 5 / 0 / 0.1] 004 Vsm/Vsg [0 to 5 / 0 / 0.1] SM Appendix 3-43 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 3001* System SP Table-3 3902* New PCU Detection (Not used) On/OFF Setting [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: On, 1: Off 001 Turns on or off the new unit detection for the transfer belt unit and fusing unit. Hot Roller Stripper Cleaning 3905* "Cleaning A": 15 sec. off/on cycle for the fusing motor. "Cleaning B": Off (45 sec.) and On (15 sec.) cycle for the fusing motor. 1st Cleaning: Interval 001 Sets the threshold for the 1st cleaning mode. "Cleaning A" is done once. [0 to 5 / 5 / 1 sheets] 1st Cleaning: Mode Setting 002 Sets the number of additional execution times of the 1st cleaning mode. [0 to 5 / 0 / 1 times] 2nd Cleaning: Interval 003 Sets the threshold for the 2nd cleaning mode. "Cleaning A" is done twice. [6 to 49 / 30 / 1 sheets] 2nd Cleaning: Mode Setting 004 Sets the number of additional execution times of the 2nd cleaning mode. [0 to 5 / 0 / 1 times] 3rd Cleaning: Interval Sets the threshold for the 3rd cleaning mode. 005 "Cleaning A" is done twice and "Cleaning B" is done "N" times. "N" is specified with SP3905-006. [50 to 999 / 100 / 1 sheets] D129/D130 3-44 SM Appendix System SP Table-3 3rd Cleaning: Mode Setting Sets the number of execution times of the 3rd cleaning mode. 006 [0 to 5 / 0 / 1 times] All fans remain on during cleaning and then switch off 60sec after the cleaning cycle ends. Cleaning Priority Setting Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 007 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 sheets] 0: Priority to printing (No job interruption) 1: Priority to cleaning (Job interruption) SM Appendix 3-45 D129/D130 System SP Tables-4 3.4 SYSTEM SP TABLES-4 3.4.1 SP4-XXX: SCANNER Sub Scan Mag. Adjustment Adjusts the magnification of the sub scan direction during scanning. 4008* Changing this value changes the scanner motor speed. [–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.1% ] L-Edge Regist Adjustment Adjusts the leading edge registration for scanning. 4010* [–2 to 2 / 0 / 0.1 mm ] As you enter a negative value, the image moves toward the leading edge. S-to-S Regist Adjustment Adjusts side-to-side registration for scanning. 4011* [–2.5 to 2.5 / 0 / 0.1 mm ] As you enter negative values, the image will disappear at the left, and as you enter positive values, the image will appear at the left. Scanner Erase Margin: Scale Adjusts scanning margins for the leading and trailing edges (sub scan) and right and left edge (main scan). 4012* Do not adjust unless the customer desires a scanner margin greater than the printer margin. These settings are adjusted to erase shadows caused by the gap between the original and the scale of the scanner unit. 001 Book: Leading Edge [0 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 mm] 002 Book: Trailing Edge [0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm] 003 Book: Left [0 to 3 / 1 / 0.1 mm] D129/D130 3-46 SM Appendix System SP Tables-4 004 Book: Right [0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm] 005 ADF: Leading Edge [0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm] 007 ADF: Right [0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm] 008 ADF: Left [0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm] Scanner Free Run 4013 001 Lamp: OFF [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 002 Lamp: ON 0=Off, 1=On 4014 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Performs a scanner free run with the exposure lamp on or off. Scan 001 HP Detection Enable Scanner free run with HP sensor check. 002 HP Detection Disable Scanner free run without HP sensor check. Dust Check This function checks the narrow scanning glass of the ADF for dust that can 4020* cause black lines in copies. If dust is detected a system banner message is displayed, but processing does not stop. Dust Detect: On/Off Issues a warning if there is dust on the narrow scanning glass of the ADF when the original size is detected before a job starts. This function can detect dust on the white plate above the scanning glass, as well as dust on the glass. Sensitivity of the level of detection is adjusted with SP4020-2. 001 [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Off. No dust warning. 1: On. Dust warning. This warning does not stop the job. Before switching this setting on, clean the ADF scanning glass and the white plate above the scanning glass. SM Appendix 3-47 D129/D130 System SP Tables-4 Dust Detect: Lvl Adjusts the sensitivity for dust detection on the ADF scanning glass. This SP is available only after SP4020-1 is switched on. [0 to 8 / 4 / 1] If you see black streaks in copies when no warning has been issued, raise 002 the setting to increase the level of sensitivity. If warnings are issued when you see not black streaks in copies, lower the setting. Dust that triggers a warning could move be removed from the glass by the originals in the feed path. If the dust is removed by passing originals, this is not detected and the warning remains on. Dust Reject: Lvl 003 Selects the level of the sub scan line correction when using the ARDF. [0 to 4 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF, 1: Weakest, 2: Weak, 3: Strong, 4: Strongest APS Operation Check 4301 Displays a code that represents the original size detected by the original sensors. ( p.3-251 "Input Check") APS Min. Size Determines whether an original of non-standard size is detected as A5/HLT size by the APS sensor. 4303 0: No original 1: A5 - lengthwise (SEF) 2: A5 - Sideways (LEF) If "0" is selected, "Cannot detect original size" will be displayed. D129/D130 3-48 SM Appendix System SP Tables-4 8K/16K Detection [0 to 3 / 0 / 1 step] 0: Normal Detection ( the machine detects A4/LT size as A4 or LT, 4305 depending on the paper size setting) 1: A4-sideways LT-Lengthwise 2: LT-sideways A4-Lenghtwise 4308* Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 3: 8K 16K Scan Size Detection Detection ON/OFF Selects whether the machine detects the original size. 001 [0 to 1 / 1 / 1 step] 0: OFF 1: ON 4309* Scan Size Detect: Setting Original Density Thresh 001 Adjust the density for the scan size detection. [0 to 255 / 18 / 1 step] Detection Time 002 Adjust the detection time for scan size detection. [20 to 100 / 60 / 20 msec] Lamp ON: Delay Time 003 Adjust the timing when to lamp on for the scan size detection. [0 to 200 / 40 / 20 msec] LED PWM Duty 004 Adjust the light value for the scan size detection. [0 to 100 / 60 / 1 %] SM Appendix 3-49 D129/D130 System SP Tables-4 Scan Size Detect Value [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 digit] 4310 Displays the scanned data for the original width detection. 001 S1: R 002 S1: G 003 S1: B 004 S2: R 005 S2: G 006 S2: B 007 S3: R 008 S3: G 009 S3: B Each detection point (S1, S2, S3) in SP4310 is as follows. D129/D130 3-50 SM Appendix System SP Tables-4 Scanner Erase Margin 4400* These SPs set the area to be masked during platen (book) mode scanning. 001 Book: Leading Edge 002 Book: Trailing Edge 003 Book: Left [0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm] Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 004 Book: Right 005 ADF: Leading Edge 007 ADF: Right 008 ADF: Left SM Appendix 3-51 D129/D130 System SP Tables-4 IPU Test Pattern Selects the IPU test Pattern. [0 to 28 / 0 / 1] 0: Scanned image 15: Gray pattern (1) 1: Gradation main scan A 16: Gray pattern (2) 2: Gradation main scan B 17: Gray pattern (3) 3: Gradation main scan C 18: Shading pattern 4: Gradation main scan D 19: Thin line pattern 5: Gradation sub scan (1) 20: Scanned + Grid pattern Test 6: Grid pattern (1) 21: Scanned + Grid scale Pattern 7: Slant grid pattern 22: Scanned + Color patch 8: Gradation K 23: Scanned + Slant Grid C 9: Check pattern 16 24: Scanned + Slant Grid D 10: Gray patch 16 (1) 25: Gray Scale 18 text 11: Gray patch 16 (2) 26: Gray Scale 18 photo 12: Gray patch 64 27: Gray Scale 256 text 13: Grid pattern (2) 28: Gray Scale 256 photo 4417 14: Color patch K 4429* Select Copy Data Security 001 Copying 002 Scanning 003 Fax Operation D129/D130 Adjusts the density of the embedded message with the copy data security unit. [0 to 3 / 3 / 1 ] 3: Darkest density 3-52 SM Appendix System SP Tables-4 4450 Scan Image Path Selection Black Subtraction ON/OFF [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0=OFF, 1=ON 001 Uses or does not use the black reduction image path. SH ON/OFF [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0=OFF, 1=ON 002 Uses or does not use the shading image path. 4460* Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Digital AE Specifies the level of deleting the background in the ADS mode. You can adjust its level for each scanning method (platen, ADF). 001 Low Limit Value [0 to 1023 / 364 / 1 digit] 002 Background level [512 to 1535 / 932 / 1 digit] Printer Vector Correction 4540* This SP corrects the printer coverage of 12 hues (RY, YR, YG, etc. x 4 Colors [R, G, B, Option]) for a total of 48 parameters. 001-004 RY Phase: Option/R/G/B 005-008 YR Phase: Option/R/G/B 009-012 YG Phase: Option/R/G/B 013-016 GY Phase: Option/R/G/B 017-020 GC Phase: Option/R/G/B Specifies the printer vector correction value. 021-024 CG Phase: Option/R/G/B [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ] 025-028 CB Phase: Option/R/G/B 029-032 BC Phase: Option/R/G/B 033-036 BM Phase: Option/R/G/B 037-040 MB Phase: Option/R/G/B SM Appendix 3-53 D129/D130 System SP Tables-4 041-044 MR Phase: Option/R/G/B 045-048 RM Phase: Option/R/G/B 4550* Scan Apli:Txt/Print 4551* Scan Apli:Txt 4552* Scan Apli:Txt Dropout 4553* Scan Apli:Txt/Photo 4554* Scan Apli:Photo 4565* Scan Apli:GrayScale 4570* Scan Apli:Col Txt/Photo 4571* Scan Apli:Col Gloss Photo 4572* Scan Apli:AutoCol [0 to 15 / 8 / 1 ] MTF: 0(Off) 1-15 (Weak-Strong) 0: MTF OFF -005 Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7 [0 to 7 / 4 / 1 ] -006 (Weak-Strong) Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear. Set higher for smoother images. Brightness: 1-255 [1 to 255 / 128 / 1 ] -007 Set higher for darker, set lower for lighter. Contrast: 1-255 [1 to 255 / 128 / 1 ] -008 Set higher for more contrast, set lower for less contrast. D129/D130 3-54 SM Appendix System SP Tables-4 Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7 [0 to 7 / 0 / 1 ] (Weak-Strong) -009 Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. 4580* Fax Apli:Txt/Chart 4581* Fax Apli:Txt 4582* Fax Apli:Txt/Photo 4583* Fax Apli:Photo 4584* Fax Apli:Original 1 4585* Fax Apli:Original 2 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 0: Not activated [0 to 15 / 8 / 1 ] MTF: 0(Off) 1-15 (Weak-Strong) 0: MTF OFF -005 Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7 [0 to 7 / 4 / 1 ] -006 (Weak-Strong) Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear. Set higher for smoother images. Brightness: 1-255 [1 to 255 / 128 / 1 ] -007 Set higher for darker, set lower for lighter. Contrast: 1-255 [1 to 255 / 128 / 1 ] -008 Set higher for more contrast, set lower for less contrast. Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7 [0 to 7 / 0 / 1 ] (Weak-Strong) -009 Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. 0: Not activated SM Appendix 3-55 D129/D130 System SP Tables-4 Texture Erase: 0 (Fix), 1-2 [0 to 2 / 0 / 1 ] -010 Sets the erasure level of textures. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. Note: This SP code exists for SP4580, SP4582 and SP4583 only. 4600 SBU Version 001 SBU ID Displays the ID of the SBU. 002 GASBU-N ID Displays the ID of the GASBU. 003 VSP5100 ID Displays the ID of the VSP5100. 4602 Scanner Memory Access 001 Scanner Memory Access 4603 Enables the read and write check for the SBU registers. AGC Execution 001 HP Detection Enable Executes the AGC with the scanner detection. 002 HP Detection Disable Executes the AGC with the scanner detection. FGATE Open/Close Opens or closes the FGATE signal. This SP automatically returns to the 4604 default status (close) after exiting this SP. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF, 1: ON D129/D130 3-56 SM Appendix System SP Tables-4 4609* Gray Balance Set: R Book Scan [-384 to 255 / -46 / 1 digit] 001 Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the red signal in Book Scan. DF Scan [-384 to 255 / -46 / 1 digit] 002 4610* Gray Balance Set: G Book Scan [-384 to 255 / -20 / 1 digit] 001 Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the green signal in Book Scan. DF Scan [-384 to 255 / -20 / 1 digit] 002 Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the green signal in DF Scan. 4611* Gray Balance Set: B Book Scan [-384 to 255 / -28 / 1 digit] 001 Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the blue signal in Book Scan. DF Scan [-384 to 255 / -28 / 1 digit] 002 Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the blue signal in DF Scan. SM Appendix 3-57 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Displays the scanning level value (adjustment) for the red signal in DF Scan. System SP Tables-4 4623 Black Level Adj. Display Latest: RE Color [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit] 001 Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even red signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Latest: RO Color [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit] 002 Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd red signal in the SBU (color printing speed). 4624 RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal Black Level Adj. Display Latest: GE Color 001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit] Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even green signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Latest: GO Color 002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit] Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd green signal in the SBU (color printing speed). 4625 GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal Black Level Adj. Display Latest: BE Color 001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit] Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed). 002 Latest: BO Color D129/D130 3-58 SM Appendix System SP Tables-4 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit] Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed). BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal Analog Gain Adjust Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red. Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 4628 Only for the color scanner 001 Latest: R Color [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 digit] Analog Gain Adjust 4629 Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green. SP4629-003 and -004 are used only for the color scanner model. 001 Latest: G Color [0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit] Analog Gain Adjust 4630 Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue. 001 Latest: B Color [0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit] Digital Gain Adjust 4631 Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for RE or RO. 001 Latest: RE Color [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit] 002 Latest RO Color [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit] SM Appendix 3-59 D129/D130 System SP Tables-4 Digital Gain Adjust 4632 Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for GE or GO. 001 Latest: GE Color [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit] 002 Latest: GO Color [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit] Digital Gain Adjust 4633 Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for BE or BO. 001 Latest: BE Color [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit] 002 Latest: BO Color [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit] 4635* SSCG Correction Set (DFU) Apply ON/OFF [0 to 1 / 1 / 1 digit] Calculation ON/OFF [0 to 1 / 1 / 1 digit] 001 002 4636 SSCG Correction Execution (DFU) SSCG Correction Execution [0 to 1 / 1 / 1 digit] SSCG Correction Error Flag [0 to 2 / 0 / 1 digit] 001 002 SSCG Result Apply 003 Execution 80H D129/D130 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 digit] 3-60 SM Appendix System SP Tables-4 SSCG Result Apply 004 Execution Last 4637 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 digit] SSCG Correction Adj (DFU) Latest:RE [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] Latest:RO [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] Latest:GE [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] Latest:GO [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] Latest:BE [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] Latest:BO [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 001 002 003 004 005 006 4638* SSCG Correction Adj (DFU) Last:RE [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] Last:RO [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] 001 002 SM Appendix 3-61 D129/D130 System SP Tables-4 Last:GE [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] Last:GO [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] Last:BE [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] Last:BO [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] 003 004 005 006 4639* SSCG Correction Adj (DFU) Factory Setting:RE [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] Factory Setting:RO [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] Factory Setting:GE [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] Factory Setting:GO [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] Factory Setting:BE [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] Factory Setting:BO [0 to 225 / 128 / 1] 001 002 003 004 005 006 D129/D130 3-62 SM Appendix System SP Tables-4 4640 SSCG Noise Size (DFU) Before Adj: RE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ] Before Adj: RO [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ] Before Adj: GE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ] Before Adj: GO [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ] Before Adj: BE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ] Before Adj: BO [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ] After Adj: RE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ] After Adj: RO [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ] After Adj: GE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ] After Adj: GO [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ] 001 002 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 003 004 005 006 007 008 009 010 SM Appendix 3-63 D129/D130 System SP Tables-4 After Adj: BE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ] After Adj: BO [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 ] 011 012 Scan Adjust Error 4645 Displays the error value of the white level or black level adjustment. 001 White level [0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 digit] 002 Black level [0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 digit] Scanner Hard Error Displays the result of the SBU connection check. 4647 [0 to 35535 / 0 / 1 ] Power-ON 0: OK, 1: SBU connection check failure If the SBU connection check fails, SC144-001, -002 or -003 occurs. 4654* Black Level Adj. Display Latest Correct Value: RE Color 001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even red signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Last Correct Value: RO Color 002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd red signal in the SBU (color printing speed). D129/D130 3-64 SM Appendix System SP Tables-4 RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal 4655* Black Level Adj. Display Last Correct Value: GE Color 001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even green Last Correct Value: GO Color 002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even green signal in the SBU (color printing speed). GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal 4656* Black Level Adj. Display Last Correct Value: BE Color 001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Last Correct Value: BO Color 002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed). SM Appendix 3-65 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables signal in the SBU (color printing speed). System SP Tables-4 BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal Analog Gain Adjust 4658* Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red. 001 Last Correct Value: R Color [0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit ] Analog Gain Adjust 4659* Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green. SP4659-003 and -004 are used only for the color scanner model. 001 Last Correct Value: G Color [0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit ] Analog Gain Adjust 4660* Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue. 001 Last Correct Value: B Color 4661* [0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit ] Digital Gain Adjust Last Correct Value: RE Color 001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even red signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Last Correct Value: RO Color 002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd red signal in the SBU (color printing speed). D129/D130 3-66 SM Appendix System SP Tables-4 RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal 4662* Digital Gain Adjust Last Correct Value: GE Color 001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even Last Correct Value: GO Color 002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd green signal in the SBU (color printing speed). GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal 4663* Digital Gain Adjust Last Correct Value: BE Color 001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Last Correct Value: BO Color 002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the previous 2nd black offset value (rough adjustment) for the odd blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed). SM Appendix 3-67 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables green signal in the SBU (color printing speed). System SP Tables-4 BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal 4673 Black Level Adj. Display Factory Setting: RE Color 001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the factory setting value of the 2nd black offset level rough adjustment for the even red signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Factory Setting: RO Color 002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the factory setting values of the 2nd black offset level rough adjustment for the odd red signal in the SBU (color printing speed). RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal 4674 Black Level Adj. Display Factory Setting: GE Color 001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the factory setting value of the 2nd black offset level rough adjustment for the even green signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Factory Setting: GO Color 002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the factory setting values of the 2nd black offset level rough adjustment for the odd green signal in the SBU (color printing speed). D129/D130 3-68 SM Appendix System SP Tables-4 4675 GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal Black Level Adj. Display Factory Setting: BE Color 001 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the factory setting value of the 2nd black offset level rough Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables adjustment for the even blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed). Factory Setting: BO Color 002 [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the factory setting values of the 2nd black offset level rough adjustment for the odd blue signal in the SBU (color printing speed). BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal Analog Gain Adjust 4677 Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Red. SP4677-003 and -004 are used only for the color scanner model. 001 Factory Setting: R [ 0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit] Analog Gain Adjust 4678 Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Green. SP4678-003 and -004 are used only for the color scanner model. 001 Factory Setting: G SM Appendix [ 0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit] 3-69 D129/D130 System SP Tables-4 Analog Gain Adjust 4679 Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Blue. 001 Factory Setting: B 4680* [ 0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit] Digital Gain Adjust Factory Setting: RE Color 001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red. Factory Setting: RO Color 002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for odd Red. 4681* Digital Gain Adjust Factory Setting: GE Color 001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green. Factory Setting: GO Color 002 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for odd Green. 4682* Digital Gain Adjust Factory Setting: BE Color 001 [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue. Factory Setting: BO Color 002 Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for odd Blue. D129/D130 3-70 SM Appendix System SP Tables-4 Scan Image Density Adjustment Adjusts the white shading parameter when scanning an image with the ARDF. 4688* Adjusts the density level if the ID of outputs made in the DF and Platen mode is different. [80 to 120 / 98 / 1 % ] White Level Peak Read Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 4690 Displays the peak level of the white level scanning. 001 RE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] 002 RO White Level Peak Read 4691 Displays the peak level of the white level scanning. 001 GE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] 002 GO White Level Peak Read 4692 Displays the peak level of the white level scanning. 001 BE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] 002 BO Black Level Peak Read 4693 Displays the peak level of the black level scanning. 001 RE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] 002 RO SM Appendix 3-71 D129/D130 System SP Tables-4 Black Level Peak Read 4694 Display the peak level of the black level scanning. 001 GE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] 002 GO Black Level Peak Read 4695 Display the peak level of the black level scanning. 001 BE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit ] 002 BO 4802 DF Shading FreeRun 001 Lamp OFF [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] Executes the scanner free run of the shading movement with exposure lamp on or off. 002 Lamp ON Press "OFF" to stop this free run. Otherwise, the free run continues. Moves the exposure lamp a short distance 4804 Home Position and immediately returns it to its home position. Touch [Execute] > "Completed" > [Exit] D129/D130 3-72 SM Appendix System SP Tables-4 Carriage Save Moves the exposure lamp a short distance away from the home position and stops. Touch [Execute] > "Completed" > [Exit] 4806 Do SP4804 to return the exposure lamp to its home position. This SP is done before shipping the machine to another location. Cycling the machine power off/on also returns the exposure lamp to Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables its home position. SBU Test Pattern Change [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step] 4807 1: Grid pattern 2: Gradation main scan 3: Gradation sub scan 4 to 250: Default (Scanning Image) Factory Setting Input (DFU) 4808* Execution Flag [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step] Scanner Lamp Select [0 to 1 / 1 / 1 /step] 4809* 0: Xenon Lamp 1: LED This SP switch the light value depends on the scanner lamp type. SM Appendix 3-73 D129/D130 System SP Tables-4 4810 PWM (DFU) Latest [0 to 8191 / 0 / 1 /step] Factory Setting [0 to 8191 / 0 / 1 /step] 001 002* 4811 LED White Level Peak Read (DFU) Latest: RE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step] Latest: RO [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step] Latest: GE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step] Latest: GO [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step] Latest: BE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step] Latest: BO [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step] 001 002 003 004 005 006 D129/D130 3-74 SM Appendix System SP Tables-4 4812* LED White Level Peak Read (DFU) Factory Setting: RE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step] Factory Setting: RO [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step] Factory Setting: GE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step] Factory Setting: GO [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step] Factory Setting: BE [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step] Factory Setting: BO [0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 /step] 001 002 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 003 004 005 006 Filter Setting This SP code sets the threshold value for independent dot erase. These adjustments are effective only for the "Custom Setting" original type. 4903* The "0" setting disables independent dot erase. A higher setting detects more spurious dots for erasing. However, this could erase dots in images that contain areas filled by dithering. 001 Ind Dot Erase: Text [0 to 7 / 0 / 1 ] 002 Ind Dot Erase: Generation Copy SM Appendix 3-75 D129/D130 System SP Tables-4 4905* Select Gradation Level 4918 Man Gamma Adj (DFU) Changes the parameters for dithering. [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ] Adjusts the offset data of the printer gamma for black in Photo mode or Letter mode. Touch [Change] to open the printer gamma screen. Enter the manual gamma adjustment screen. 4954 Read/Restore Std Read New Chart 001 Execute the scanning of the A4 chart. Recall Prev Chart 002 Clear the data of the scanned A4 chart. Read Std Chart 003 Execute the scanning of the A4 standard chart. Set Std Chart 004 Overwrite the standard data. Read/Restore Std [0 to 255 / 0 / 1] 005* Adjusts chromaticity rank. When replacing the scanner lamp, select a number according to the barcode on the new scanner lamp. D129/D130 3-76 SM Appendix System SP Tables-4 4991 IPU Image Pass Selection DFU RGB Frame Memory Selects the image path. Enter the number to be selected using the 10-key pad. 001 SM Appendix 0 Scanner input RGB images 1 Scanner I/F RGB images 2 RGB images done by Shading correction (Shading ON, Black offset ON) 3 Shading data 4 Inner pattern data: Gray scale 5 RGB images done by Line skipping correction 6 RGB images done by Digital AE 7 RGB images done by Vertical line correction 8 RGB image done by Scanner gamma correction 9 RGB image done by Filtering correction 10 RGB images done by Full color ADS 11 RGB image done by Color correction 3-77 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables [0 to 11 / 2/ 1] System SP Tables-4 4993* High Light Correction Selects the Highlight correction level. 001 Sensitivity Selection [0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step] 0: weakest sensitivity 9: strongest sensitivity Selects the Highlight correction level. 002 Range Selection [0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step] 0: weakest skew correction, 9: strongest skew correction 4994* Text/Photo Detect Level Adj. High Compression PDF Selects the definition level between Text and Photo for high compression PDF. 001 [0 to 2 / 1 / 1 ] 0: Text priority 1: Normal 2: Photo priority 4996* White Paper Level 001 D129/D130 Select the detection level for the white paper. [0 to 6 / 3 / 1 ] 3-78 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 3.5 SYSTEM SP TABLES-5 3.5.1 SP5-XXX: MODE mm/inch Display Selection 0: Europe/Asia (mm) 1: North America (inch) 5024* Selects the unit of measurement. Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables After selection, turn the main power switch off and on. Accounting counter Selects whether the printer counter is displayed on the LCD. 5045* [0-1 / 0 / 1] 0: Displays the total counter only. 1: Displays both total counter and printer counter. 5047* Paper Display Turns on or off the printed paper display on the LCD. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Not displayed, 1: Displayed ReturnTimePriorityType Select the priority to return to the stand-by mode. 5052* [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Energy Save has priority 1: Return time has priority Display IP Address 5055* Display or does not display the IP address on the LCD. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF, 1: ON SM Appendix 3-79 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 5056* Coverage Counter Display Display or does not display the coverage counter on the LCD. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Not displayed, 1: Displayed 5061* Toner Remaining Icon Display Change Display or does not display the remaining toner display icon on the LCD. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0: Not display, 1: Display Parts Replacement Alert Display 5062 Display or does not display the parts replacement alert on the LCD. PCU_Bk 001 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0: Not displayed, 1: Display Fuser 002 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0: Not displayed, 1: Display Transfer Unit 003 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0: Not displayed, 1: Display FuserCleaner 004 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0: Not displayed, 1: Display D129/D130 3-80 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 5071 Set Bypass Paper Size Display Turn on or off the paper size confirmation pop-up on the LED. This pop-up prevents mismatching between a paper size selected by the operation 001 panel and the actual paper size on the by-pass tray. [0 or 1 / 0 / -] 0: Off, 1: On Home Screen Login Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 5074* Sets the application that appears when the home key is pressed. Setting 002 [0 to 11111111 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF, 1: ON Home Key Customization 091 [0 to 2 / 0 / 1 ] 0: OFF (Function disable), 1: SDK, 2: Reserve (Legacy application) Product ID 092 Sets the Application product ID. [0x00 to 0xffff / 0x00 / 1] Application Screen ID 093 Sets the display category of the application that is specified in the SP5075-001. [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ] SM Appendix 3-81 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 5075* Rev. 11/15/2012 USB Keyboard Function Setting 001 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0: Disable, 1: Enable 5083 [LED Light Switch Setting - Toner Near End] 001 Choose whether or not the [Check Status] key blinks when Toner Near End is reached. ⇒ [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] [0: Does not blink/ 1: Blinks] 5104* NOTE: (Requires System/Copy Firmware 2.05 of later) - This SP makes it possible to set whether or not the [Check Status] key blinks when Toner Near End is reached. - With previous firmware versions, this key always blinked when Toner Near End was reached. A3/DLT Double Count (SSP) 001 When "Yes" is selected, A3 and DLT paper are counted twice, that is A4 x2 and LT x2 respectively. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1 ] ⇒ [0: Single Count/ 1: Double Count (Default)] 5113* NOTE: (Requires System/Copy Firmware 2.06 of later) for default = 1. Optional Counter Type Default Optional Counter Type Selects the type of counter: 0: None 1: Key Card (RK3, 4) Japan only 001 2: Key Card Down 3: Pre-paid Card 4: Coin Rack 5: MF Key Card 11: Exp. Key Card (Add) 12: Exp. Key Card (Deduct) 002 External Optional Counter Type D129/D130 3-82 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 Rev. 8/21/2012 Enables the SDK application. This lets you select a number for the external device for user access control. Note: "SDK" refers to software on an SD card. [0 to 3 / 0 / 1] 0: None 1: Expansion Device 1 2: Expansion Device 2 5114* Optional Counter I/F MF Key Card Extension 001 Use this SP and change the setting to "1" only when the "5" (MF Key Card) is selected with SP5113-001. [0: Not installed/ 1: Installed (scanning accounting)] Disable Copying Temporarily denies access to the machine. Japan Only 5118* [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Release for normal operation [Default] 1: Prohibit access to machine Mode Clear Opt. Counter Removal Selects if mode clear is done for an optional counter when an optional 5120* counter is removed. 0: Yes. (Always mode clear) 1: StandBy. (Mode clear before/after a job) 2: No. (No mode clear) Counter Up Timing Determines whether the optional key counter counts up at paper feed-in or 5121* at paper exit. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0: Feed, 1: Exit SM Appendix 3-83 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 3: Expansion Device 3 System SP Tables-5 F Size Original Setting Selects F size original setting. 5126* [0 to 2 / 0 / 1 step] 0: 8 1/2 x 13 (Foolscap) 1: 8 1/4 x 13 (Folio) 2: 8 x 13 (F) APS Mode 5127* Selects whether the APS function is enabled or disabled with the contact of a pre-paid card or coin lock. 0: Disable (APS active) [Default], 1: Enable (APS not active) Paper Size Type Selection Selects the paper size (type) for both originals and copy paper. 5131* [0 to 2 / - / 1 step] 0: Japan, 1: North America, 2: Europe After changing the setting, turn the copier off and on. If the paper size of the archive files stored on the HDD is different, abnormal copies could result. Bypass Length Setting Sets up the by-pass tray for long paper. 5150 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Off [Default] 1: On. Sets the tray for feeding paper up to 600 mm long. With this SP selected on, paper jams are not detected in the paper path. D129/D130 3-84 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 App. Switch Method Determines whether the application screen is switched with a hardware 5162* switch or software switch. 0: Soft Key Set 1: Hard Key Set Z-Fold Position 5165* 5166* Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Not Used Lump Delete Form Setting Last Deleted Time 021 Displays the last delete time. [0 to 4294967295 / 0 / 1] Fax Printing Mode at Optional Counter Off Enables or disables the automatic print out without an accounting device. 5167* This SP is used when the receiving fax is accounted for by an external accounting device. 0: Automatic printing 1: No automatic printing CE Login If you will change the printer bit switches, you must 'log in' to service mode 5169* with this SP before you go into the printer SP mode. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Off. Printer bit switches cannot be adjusted. 1: On. Printer bit switches can be adjusted. SM Appendix 3-85 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 By-pass Tray Paper Size Error [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0= OFF, 1= ON This SP determines whether a paper size error prompt appears when the 5179* machine detects the wrong paper size for the job and during feed from the by-pass tray. Paper Size Setting 5181* Adjusts the paper size for each tray. [0 to 1 / - / 1] 001 Tray 1: 1 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF 002 Tray 1: 2 0: A3, 1: DLT 003 Tray 1: 3 0: B4, 1: LG 004 Tray 1: 4 0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF 005 Tray 2: 1 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF 006 Tray 2: 2 0: A3, 1: DLT 007 Tray 2: 3 0: B4, 1: LG 008 Tray 2: 4 0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF 009 Tray 3: 1 (Tandem) 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF 010 Tray 3: 2 0: A3, 1: DLT 011 Tray 3: 3 0: B4, 1: LG 012 Tray 3: 4 0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF 013 Tray 4: 1 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF 014 Tray 4: 2 0: A3, 1: DLT 015 Tray 4: 3 0: B4, 1: LG 016 Tray 4: 4 0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF 017 LCT [0 to 2 / - / 1 ] 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF, 2: B5 LEF D129/D130 3-86 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 RK4: Setting (Japan only) Enable or distance the prevention for RK4 (Accounting device) 5186 Disconnection. If the RK4 is disconnected for 10 seconds when this SP is set to "1 (Enable)", the machine automatically jams a sheet of paper and stops. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] Copy Nv Version Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 5188* Displays the NV version on the controller. External Controller Info. Settings 5193 DFU Limitless SW 5195* DFU Paper Exit After Staple End This SP determines whether the machine can output paper if staple supply 5199 runs out. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF. Paper cannot exit if no staples are available. 1: ON. Paper can exit with no staples. SM Appendix 3-87 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 5212* Page Numbering Horizontally positions the page numbers 003 Duplex Printout Left/Right printed on both sides during duplexing. Position [–10 to 10/ 0 / 1 mm] 0 is center, minus is left, + is right. Vertically positions the page numbers printed 004 Duplex Printout High/Low on both sides during duplexing. Position [–10 to 10/ 0 / 1 mm] 0 is center, minus is down, + is up. 5227* Page Numbering Sets the number of input digits for the job 201 Allow Page No. Entry serial number of the starting page numbering. [2 to 9 / 9 / 1] Sets the zero surplus serial number of the 202 Zero Surplus Setting starting page numbering. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Disable, 1: Enable 5302* Set Time Time Difference Sets the time clock for the local time. This setting is done at the factory before delivery. The setting is GMT expressed in minutes. [–1440 to 1440 / - / 1 min.] Japan: +540 (Tokyo) 002 NA: -300 (NY) EU: +60 (Paris) CH: +480 (Peking) TW: +480 (Taipei) AS: +480 (Hong Kong) KO: +540 (Korea) D129/D130 3-88 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 5307 Summer Time [0 to 1 / 1 (NA/EU), 0 (ASIA) / 1 /step] Setting 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 001 Enables or disables the summer time mode. Make sure that both SP5-307-3 and -4 are correctly set. Otherwise, Rule Set (Start) Specifies the start setting for the summer time mode. There are 8 digits in this SP. For months 1 to 9, the "0" cannot be input in the first digit, so the eight-digit setting for -2 or -3 becomes a seven-digit setting. 1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12] 3rd digit: The week of the month. [1 to 5] 003 4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 6 = Sunday to Saturday] 5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23] 7th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 9 / 1 hour /step] 8th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 5 / 10 minutes /step] For example: 3500010 The timer is advanced by 1 hour at am 0:00 on the 5th Sunday in March. The digits are counted from the left. Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to "1". Rule Set (End) Specifies the end setting for the summer time mode. There are 8 digits in this SP. 1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12] 004 3rd digit: The week of the month. [0 to 5] 4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 7 = Sunday to Saturday] 5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23] The 7th and 8 digits must be set to "00". The digits are counted from the left. Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to "1". SM Appendix 3-89 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables this SP is not activated even if this SP is set to "1". System SP Tables-5 Access Control (DFU) 5401* This SP stores the settings that limit uses access to SDK application data. Default Document ACL Whenever a new login user is added to the address book in external certification mode (for Windows, LDAP, RDH), the default document ACL is updated according to this SP setting. [0 to 3 / 0 / 1] 103 0: View 1: Edit 2: Edit/Delete 3: Full control Note: This SP setting is ignored on a machine that is not using document server. Specifies the timeout of the authentication. 104 Authentication Time [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 sec./step] 0: 60 seconds 1 to 250 seconds Selects the log out type for the extend authentication device. 162 Extend Certification Detail Bit 0: Log-out without an IC card 0: Not allowed (default) 1: Allowed 200 SDK1 Unique ID 201 SDK1 Certification Method 210 SDK2 Unique ID 211 SDK2 Certification Method "SDK" is the "Software Development Kit". This data can be converted from SAS (VAS) when installed or uninstalled. (DFU) 220 SDK3 Unique ID D129/D130 3-90 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 221 SDK3 Certification Method 230 SDK certification device Enables or disables the log out confirmation option. Bit 0: Log out confirmation option 0: Enable (default), 1: Disable 240 Detail Option Selects the automatic log out time. Bit 1 and 2: Automatic log out timer Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables reduction 00: 60 seconds (default), 01: 10 seconds, 10: 20 seconds, 11: 30 seconds Access Control (DFU) 5402 Sets limited uses for SDKJ application data. 101 to 130 SDKJ1 Limit Setting….. SDKJ30 Limit Setting 141 to 170 SDKJ1 Product ID….. SDKJ30 Product ID User Code Count Clear 5404 Clears the counts of the user codes assigned by the key operator to restrict the use of the machine. Press [Execute] to clear. SM Appendix 3-91 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 5411* LDAP-Certification Turns simple authentication on or off for LDAP. 004 Simplified [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] Certification 0: OFF 1: ON This SP is enabled only when SP5411-4 is set to "1" 005 Password Null Not Permit (ON). [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Password null is permitted. 1: Password null is not permitted. Determines whether LDAP option (anonymous 006 Detail Option certification) is turned on or off. [0 to 11111111 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF, 1: ON 5412 Krb-Certification Sets the level of Kerberos Certification. [0x01:AES256-CTS-HMAC-SHA1-96 / 100 Encrypt Mode 0x02:AES128-CTS-HMAC-SHA1-96 / 0x04:DES3-CBC-SHA / 0x08:RC4-HMAC / 0x10:DES-CBC-MD5 / 0xFF:ALL / 0xFF / 1bit] D129/D130 3-92 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 5413 Lockout Setting Lockout On/Off [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF, 1:ON 001 Turns on or off the account lock for the local address book account. Lockout Threshold [1 to 10 / 5 / 1] 002 Sets the maximum trial times for accessing the address book account. 0: OFF (Lockout is not cancelled.) Cancellation On/Off 003 1: ON (Lockout is cancelled if a user ID and password are correctly entered after the lockout function has been executed and a specific time has passed.) Turns on or off the cancellation function of the account lockout. Cancellation Time [1 to 9999 / 60 / 1 min] 004 Sets the interval of the retry for accessing the local address book account after the lockout function has been executed. This setting is enabled only if SP5413-3 is set to "1" (ON). 5414 Access Mitigation Mitigation ON/OFF Permits or does not permit consecutive access to the machine with the 001 same ID and password. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF (Permitted) 1: ON (Not permitted) Mitigation Time 002 Sets the prohibiting time for consecutive access to the machine with the same ID and password. [0 to 60 / 15 / 1 min] SM Appendix 3-93 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] System SP Tables-5 5415* Password Attack Permissible Number [0 to 100 / 30 / 1 times] 001 Sets the threshold number of attempts to attack the system with random passwords to gain illegal access to the system. Detect Time [0 to 10 / 5 / 1 sec] 002 Sets a detection time to count a password attack. 5416* Access Information Access User Max Num [50 to 200 / 200 / 1 ] 001 Sets the number of users for the access exclusion and password attack detection function. Access Password Num [50 to 200 / 200 / 1 ] 002 Sets the number of passwords for the access exclusion and password attack detection function. Monitor interval [1 to 10 / 3 / 1 sec] 003 Sets the interval of watching out for user information and passwords. D129/D130 3-94 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 5417 Access Attack Access Permissible number [0 to 500 / 100 / 1] 001 Sets a limit on access attempts to prevent password cracking. Access Detect Time [10 to 30 / 10 / 1 sec] 002 Sets a detection time to count password cracking. [0 to 9 / 3 / 1 sec] 003 Sets the wait time to slow down the speed of certification when an excessive number of access attempts have been detected. Attack Max Num [50 to 200 / 200 / 1] 004 Sets a limit on the number of requests received for certification in order to slow down the certification speed when an excessive number of access attempts have been detected. User Authentication These settings should be done with the System Administrator. 5420* These functions are enabled only after the user access feature has been enabled. [0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF 001 Copy Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the copy application. [0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF 011 Document Server Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the document server. SM Appendix 3-95 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Productivity Fall Weight System SP Tables-5 [0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF 021 Fax Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the fax application. [0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF 031 Scanner Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the scanner application. [0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF 041 Printer Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the printer application. 051 SDK1 061 SDK2 071 SDK3 [0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the SDK application. [0 or 1/ 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF 081 Browser Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the browser application. 5430 Auth Dialog Message Change Turns on or off the displayed message 001 Message Change On/Off change for the authentication. [0 or 1 / 0 / -] 0: Off, 1: On 002 Message Text Download 003 Message Text ID D129/D130 Executes the message download for the authentication. Inputs message text for the authentication. 3-96 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 5431 External Auth User Preset Tag 010 [0 or 1 / 1 / -] 0: Not permit, 1: Permit Turns on or off the tag copy permission for the external authentication. Entry [0 or 1 / 1 / -] 0: Not permit, 1: Permit 011 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Turns on or off the copy permission of the entry information for the external authentication. Group [0 or 1 / 1 / -] 0: Not permit, 1: Permit 012 Turns on or off the copy permission of the group information for the external authentication. Mail [0 or 1 / 1 / -] 0: Not permit, 1: Permit 020 Turns on or off the copy permission of the mail information for the external authentication. Fax [0 or 1 / 1 / -] 0: Not permit, 1: Permit 030 Turns on or off the copy permission of the fax information for the external authentication. FaxSub [0 or 1 / 1 / -] 0: Not permit, 1: Permit 031 Turns on or off the copy permission of the fax additional information for the external authentication. Folder [0 or 1 / 1 / -] 0: Not permit, 1: Permit 032 Turns on or off the copy permission of the folder information for the external authentication. SM Appendix 3-97 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 ProtectCode [0 or 1 / 1 / -] 0: Not permit, 1: Permit 033 Turns on or off the copy permission of the protection code information for the external authentication. SmtpAuth [0 or 1 / 1 / -] 0: Not permit, 1: Permit 034 Turns on or off the copy permission of the SMTP information for the external authentication. LdapAuth [0 or 1 / 1 / -] 0: Not permit, 1: Permit 035 Turns on or off the copy permission of the LDAP information for the external authentication. Smb Ftp Fldr Auth [0 or 1 / 1 / -] 0: Not permit, 1: Permit 036 Turns on or off the copy permission of the SMB/FTP information for the external authentication. AcntAcl [0 or 1 / 1 / -] 0: Not permit, 1: Permit 037 Turns on or off the copy permission of the account ACL information for the external authentication. DocumentAcl [0 or 1 / 1 / -] 0: Not permit, 1: Permit 038 Turns on or off the copy permission of the document ACL information for the external authentication. D129/D130 3-98 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 [0 or 1 / 1 / -] CertCrypt 0: Not permit, 1: Permit 040 Turns on or off the copy permission of the authentication information for the external authentication. [0 or 1 / 1 / -] UserLimitCount 0: Not permit, 1: Permit 050 Turns on or off the copy permission of the maximum number information for Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables the external authentication. Authentication Error Code 5481 These SP codes determine how the authentication failures are displayed. [0 or 1 / 0 / -] 001 System Log Disp 0: OFF [Default], 1: ON Determines whether an error code appears in the system log after a user authentication failure occurs. [0 or 1 / 1 / 1] 0: OFF, 1: ON [Default] 002 Panel Disp Determines whether an error code appears on the operation panel after a user authentication failure occurs. SM Appendix 3-99 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 MF KeyCard (Japan only) Sets up operation of the machine with a keycard. 5490 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Disabled. Cancels operation without a user code. 1: Enabled. Allows operation without a user code. Optional Counter Determines whether to cancel the job when MK1 keycard is pulled out from the machine during job. 5491* [0 to 11111111 / 0 / 1] 0: On. Cancels the job. 1: Off. Allows operation if MK1 keycard is pulled out from the machine during the job. 5501* PM Alarm PM Alarm Level 001 Sets the PM alarm level. [0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 k copies/step] 0: No PM alarm Original Count Alarm (DFU) 002 Selects whether the PM alarm for the number of scans is enabled or not. If this is "1", the PM alarm function is enabled. [0 = No / 1 = Yes] D129/D130 3-100 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 Jam Alarm Sets the alarm to sound for the specified jam level (document misfeeds are not included). [0 to 3 / 3 / 1 step] 5504* 0: Zero (Off) 1: Low (2.5K jams) 2: Medium (3K jams) Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 3: High (6K jams) Error Alarm Sets the number of sheets to clear the error alarm counter. The error alarm counter counts "1" when any SC is detected. However, the error alarm counter decreases by "1" when an SC is not detected during a 5505* set number of copied sheets (for example, default 5000 (C1b) or 10000 (C1c) sheets). The error alarm occurs when the SC error alarm counter reaches "5". [0 to 255 / 45 (C2b), 50 (C1b/C1.5b), 60 (C2c), 100 (C1c/C1.5c) / 100 copies / step] 5507* Supply Alarm Switches the control call on/off for the paper supply. (DFU) 001 Paper supply Alarm (0:Off 1:On) 0: Off, 1: On 0: No alarm. 1: Sets the alarm to sound for the specified number transfer sheets for each paper size (A3, A4, B4, B5, DLT, LG, LT, HLT) Switches the control call on/off for the stapler 002 Staple Supply Alarm (0:Off 1:On) installed in the finisher. (DFU) 0: Off, 1: On 0: No alarm 1: Alarm goes off for every 1K of staples used. SM Appendix 3-101 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 Switches the control call on/off for the toner end. 003 Toner Supply Alarm (0:Off 1:On) (DFU) 0: Off, 1: On If you select "1" the alarm will sound when the copier detects toner end. Changes the timing of the "Toner Supply Call" via the @Remote, when the following conditions 080 Toner Call Timing occur. 0: At replacement 1: At near end 128 Interval: Others 132 Interval: A3 133 Interval: A4 134 Interval: A5 The "Paper Supply Call Level: nn" SPs specify the 141 Interval: B4 paper control call interval for the referenced paper 142 Interval: B5 sizes. (DFU) [250 to 10000 / 1000 / 1 Step] 160 Interval: DLT 164 Interval: LG 166 Interval: LT 172 Interval: HLT D129/D130 3-102 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 5508 CC Call 001 Jam Remains 002 Continuous Jams 003 Continuous Door Open Enables/disables initiating a call. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Disable 1: Enable Sets the length of time to determine the 011 Jam Detection: Time Length length of an unattended paper jam. 012 Jam Detection Continuous Count Sets the number of continuous paper jams required to initiate a call. [2 to 10 / 5 / 1 time] Sets the length of time the remains opens 013 Door Open: Time Length to determine when to initiate a call. [3 to 30/ 10 / 1 minute] SC/Alarm Setting With @Remote in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an SC call when 5515* an SC error occurs. If this SP is switched off, the SC call is not issued when an SC error occurs. 001 SC Call 002 Service Parts Near End Call 003 Service Parts End Call [0 or 1 / 1 / 1] 004 User Call 0: OFF 006 Communication Information Test Call 1: ON 007 Machine Information Notice 008 Alarm Notice SM Appendix 3-103 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables [3 to 30 / 10 / 1 minute] System SP Tables-5 010 Supply Automatic Ordering Call 011 Supply Management Report Call 012 Jam/Door Open Call Individual PM Part Alarm Call 5516 With @Remote in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an PM alarm call when one of SP parts reaches its yield. 001 Disable/Enable Setting (0: Not [0 or 1 / 1 / - ] send, 1: Send) 0: Not send, 1: Send 004 Percent yield for triggering PM alert [1 to 255 / 75 / 1 %/step] Extend Function Setting 5730 DFU 5734 PDF Setting PDF/A Fixed 001 [0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: No Limit 1: Limited Node Authentication Timuout 5741 DFU Network Security Level 5743 DFU D129/D130 3-104 SM Appendix Rev. 11/15/2012 5744 System SP Tables-5 Management DFU EcoCountTime 5745 DFU Scroll Bar display 204 Vertical mode Confirmation dialog display setting 205 NOTE: - If enabled, the “Page change confirmation dialog” is displayed when the user moves from the current page to a different one. - The “SSL certificate confirmation dialog” is displayed when an SSL-related problem occurs. - If the customer is using an internal (original) Web application, i.e. a fully trusted application, this SP can be set to “2” (do not display either dialog). 0: Always display (Default) 1: Display when pressing “Program Key Value Page change confirmation dialog SSL certificate confirmation dialog 0 (Default) Display Display 1 Not display Display 2 Not Display Not display 3 Display Not display IMPORTANT: Only use these SP Modes with Browser Version 2.00.0 or newer, EXJS version 1.11.00 or newer, and Specification 2.01 or newer. 206 Displayed but it should not be used (Not for field use). ⇒ 5749 Import/Export NOTE: Refer to Section 3-13 Detailed Description of SP5749 for more information. DFU 001 Import 101 Export 251 Export Result Print (SP) 252 Import Result Print (SP) MCS Debug SW 5792 DFU ECS Debug SW 5793 DFU SM Appendix 3-105 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables [Vertical Scroll Bar display mode] (See IMPORTANT below) 5747 System SP Tables-5 Memory Clear 5801 Resets NVRAM data to the default settings. Before executing any of these SP codes, print an SMC Report. 001 All Clear 002 Engine Initializes items 2 to 15 below. Initializes all registration settings for the engine and copy process settings. Initializes default system settings, SCS (System 003 SCS Control Service) settings, operation display coordinates, and ROM update information. 004 IMH Memory Clr Initializes the image file system. (IMH: Image Memory Handler) Initializes the automatic delete time setting for stored 005 MCS documents. (MCS: Memory Control Service) 006 Copier application Initializes all copier application settings. Initializes the fax reset time, job login ID, all TX/RX 007 Fax Application settings, local storage file numbers, and off-hook timer. Initializes the printer defaults, programs registered, 008 Printer Application the printer SP bit switches, and the printer CSS counter. 009 Scanner Application D129/D130 Initializes the defaults for the scanner and all the scanner SP modes. 3-106 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 Deletes the Netfile (NFA) management files and 010 Web Service thumbnails, and initializes the Job login ID. Netfiles: Jobs to be printed from the document server using a PC and the DeskTopBinder software Initializes the system defaults and interface settings (IP addresses also), the SmartDeviceMonitor for 011 NCS Admin settings, WebStatusMonitor settings, and the TELNET settings. 012 R-FAX 014 Clear DCS Setting 015 Clear UCS Setting 016 MIRS Setting 017 CCS 018 SRM Memory Clr Initializes the job login ID, SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin, job history, and local storage file numbers. Initializes the DCS (Delivery Control Service) settings. Initializes the UCS (User Information Control Service) settings. Initializes the MIRS (Machine Information Report Service) settings. Initializes the CCS (Certification and Charge-control Service) settings. Initializes the SRM (System Resource Manager) settings. 019 LCS Initializes the LCS (Log Count Service) settings. 020 Web Uapli Initializes the web user application settings. 021 ECS Initializes ECS (Engine Control Service). 023 AICS Initializes the AICS settings. SM Appendix 3-107 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables (NCS: Network Control Service) System SP Tables-5 FreeRun Performs a free run on the copier engine. The correct paper should be loaded in the 1st tray or 2nd tray, but paper is 5802* not fed. The main switch has to be turned off and on after using the free run mode for a test. 001 TRAY1:A4LEF - 002 TRAY2:A3 - 003 TRAY2:A4SEF - Input Check 5803 Displays the signals received from sensors and switches. ( p.3-251 "Input Check") Output Check 5804 Turns on the electrical components individually for test purposes. ( p.3-263 "Output Check") Anti-Condensation Heater 5805 [0 or 1 / 0 / -] 0:OFF / 1:ON 5810 SC Reset Resets all level A service call conditions, such as 001 Fusing SC Reset fusing errors. To clear the service call, touch "Execute" on the LCD, then turn the main power switch off/on. D129/D130 3-108 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 5811 MachineSerial 002 Display Displays the machine serial number. 003 BCU Inputs the serial number. 005 FRAM Displays the FRAM serial number. Service Tel. No. Setting 001 Service 002 Facsimile 003 Supply 004 Operation 5816 Inputs the telephone number of the CE (displayed when a Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 5812* service call condition occurs.) Use this to input the fax number of the CE printed on the Counter Report (UP mode). Inputs the telephone number of the supplier displayed on the user mode screen. Allows the service center contact telephone number to be displayed on the user mode screen. Remote Service I/F Setting Selects the remote service setting. 001 [0 to 2 / 2 / 1 /step] 0: Remote service off 1: CSS remote service on 2: @Remote service on CE Call Performs the CE Call at the start or end of the service. 002 [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Start of the service 1: End of the service NOTE: This SP is activated only when SP 5816-001 is set to “2”. SM Appendix 3-109 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 Function Flag Enables or disables the remote service function. 003 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled NOTE: This SP setting is changed to "1" after @Remote registration has been completed. Communication Test Call 004 This SP issues a test call from a GW machine to determine whether it can communicate successfully with the call center after it has been set up for NRS. Successful return will be in the range 0 to 99. Device Information Call 005 This SP issues a call to notify the NRS device information to the call center. Successful return will be in the range 0 to 99. SSL Disable Uses or does not use the RCG certification by SSL when calling the RCG. 007 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Uses the RCG certification 1: Does no use the RCG certification RCG Connect Timeout 008 Specifies the connect timeout interval when calling the RCG. [1 to 90 / 30 / 1 second /step] RCG Write Timeout 009 Specifies the write timeout interval when calling the RCG. [0 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step] D129/D130 3-110 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 RCG Read Timeout 010 Specifies the read timeout interval when calling the RCG. [0 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step] Port 80 Enable 011 Enables/disables access via port 80 to the SOAP method. [0 or 1 / 0 / – ] Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled @Remote Communication Permission [0 to 2 / 1 / 1 ] 012 0: Not permitted 1: Permitted 2: Partially limit RFU (Remote Firmware Update) Timing Selects the RFU timing. 013 [0 or 1 / 1 / – ] 0: RFU is executed whenever update request is received. 1: RFU is executed only when the machine is in the sleep mode. RCG Error Cause [0 or 1 / 0 / – ] 014 0: Normal 1: Fails to reflect the client/server certificate settings by network failure to reboot. Transition to 0 on restart the machine. SM Appendix 3-111 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 RCG–C Registed 021 This SP displays the Embedded RC Gate installation end flag. 0: Installation not completed 1: Installation completed Connect Type (N/M) This SP displays and selects the Embedded RC Gate connection method. 023 [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step 0: Internet connection 1: Dial-up connection Cert. Expire Timing DFU 061 Proximity of the expiration of the certification. Use Proxy 062 This SP setting determines if the proxy server is used when the machine communicates with the service center. Proxy Host This SP sets the address of the proxy server used for communication between Embedded RC Gate-N and the gateway. Use this SP to set up or display the customer proxy server address. The address is necessary to set 063 up Embedded RC Gate-N. The address display is limited to 128 characters. Characters beyond the 128 character are ignored. This address is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report. D129/D130 3-112 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 Proxy Port Number This SP sets the port number of the proxy server used for communication between Embedded RC Gate-N and the gateway. This setting is necessary to 064 set up Embedded RC Gate-N. This port number is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report. Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Proxy User Name This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification user name. 065 The length of the name is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st character is ignored. This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report. Proxy Password This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification password. 066 The length of the password is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st character is ignored. This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report. SM Appendix 3-113 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 CERT: Up State Displays the status of the certification update. 0 1 2 3 4 11 067 12 The certification used by Embedded RC Gate is set correctly. The certification request (setAuthKey) for update has been received from the GW URL and certification is presently being updated. The certification update is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the successful update. The certification update failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the failed update. The period of the certification has expired and new request for an update is being sent to the GW URL. A rescue update for certification has been issued and a rescue certification setting is in progress for the rescue GW connection. The rescue certification setting is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the certification update request. The notification of the request for certification update has completed 13 successfully, and the system is waiting for the certification update request from the rescue GW URL. 14 15 16 The notification of the certification request has been received from the rescue GW controller, and the certification is being stored. The certification has been stored, and the GW URL is being notified of the successful completion of this event. The storing of the certification has failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the failure of this event. The certification update request has been received from the GW URL, 17 the GW URL was notified of the results of the update after it was completed, but a certification error has been received, and the rescue certification is being recorded. D129/D130 3-114 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 18 The rescue certification of No. 17 has been recorded, and the GW URL is being notified of the failure of the certification update. CERT: Error Displays a number code that describes the reason for the request for update of the certification. 1 068 2 3 Normal. There is no request for certification update in progress. Request for certification update in progress. The current certification has expired. An SSL error notification has been issued. Issued after the certification has expired. Notification of shift from a common authentication to an individual certification. 4 Notification of a common certification without ID2. 5 Notification that no certification was issued. 6 Notification that GW URL does not exist. 069 CERT: Up ID The ID of the request for certification. 083 Firm Up Status Displays the status of the firmware update. This SP setting determines if the operator can confirm the previous version of the firmware before the firmware update execution. If the 085 Firm Up User Check option to confirm the previous version is selected, a notification is sent to the system manager and the firmware update is done with the firmware files from the URL. Allows the service technician to confirm the size 086 Firmware Size of the firmware data files during the firmware update execution. SM Appendix 3-115 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 0 System SP Tables-5 087 CERT: Macro Ver. 088 CERT: PAC Ver. Displays the macro version of the @Remote certification. Displays the PAC version of the @Remote certification. Displays ID2 for the @Remote certification. Spaces are displayed as underscores (_). 089 CERT: ID2 Code Asteriskes (*) indicate that no @Remote certification exists. "000000___________" indicates "Common certification". Displays the common name of the @Remote certification subject. CN = the following 17 bytes. 090 CERT: Subject Spaces are displayed as underscores (_). Asterisks (*) indicate that no @Remote certification exists. "000000___________" indicates "Common certification". Displays serial number for the @Remote 091 CERT: SerialNo. certification. Asterisks (*) indicate that no @Remote certification exists. Displays the common name of the issuer of the 092 CERT: Issuer @Remote certification. CN = the following 30 bytes. Asteriskes () indicate that no @Remote certification exists. 093 CERT: Valid Start 094 CERT: Valid End Displays the start time of the period for which the current @Remote certification is enabled. Displays the end time of the period for which the current @Remote certification is enabled. Server CN Check 096 Not used D129/D130 3-116 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 GW Host 096 Not used GW URL Path 097 Not used Debug RescueG/WURL Set 099 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Not used 102* CERT: Encrypt Level Displays the encryption level for the NRS certificate. [1 or 2 / 1 / – ] 1: Indicates that the certificate encryption level is 512-bit. 2: Indicates that the certificate encryption level is 2048-bit. Selection Country 150 Not used Line Type Automatic Judgment 151 Not used Line Type Judgment Result 152 Not used Selection Dial / Push 153 Not used Outside Line Outgoing Number 154 Not used Dial Up User Name 156 Not used SM Appendix 3-117 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 Dial Up Password 157 Not used Local Phone Number 161 Not used Connection Timing Adjustment Incoming 162 Not used Access Point 163 Not used Line Connecting 164 Not used Modem Serial No. 173 Not used Retransmission Limit 174 Not used RCG-C M DebugBitSW 186 Not used FAX TX Priority 187 Not used Manual Polling 200 Executes the manual polling. D129/D130 3-118 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 Regist Status Displays a number that indicates the status of the @Remote service device. 0: Neither the @Remote device nor Embedded RCG Gate is set. 1: The Embedded RCG Gate is being set. Only Box registration is completed. 201 In this status, @Remote device cannot communicate with this device. 2: The Embedded RCG Gate is set. In this status, the @Remote device cannot communicate with this device. 3: The @Remote device is being set. In this status the Embedded RCG Gate 4: The @Remote module has not started. 202 Letter Number 203 Confirm Execute Allows entry of the request number needed for the Embedded RCG Gate. Executes the confirmation request to the @Remote Gateway. 204 Confirm Result Displays a number that indicates the result of the confirmation executed with SP5816-203. 0: Succeeded 1: Confirmation number error 2: Registration in progress 3: Proxy error (proxy enabled) 4: Proxy error (proxy disabled) 5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password) 6: Communication error 7: Certification update error 8: Other error 9: Confirmation executing Confirm Place 205 Displays the result of the notification sent to the device from the Gateway in answer to the confirmation request. Displayed only when the result is registered at the Gateway. SM Appendix 3-119 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables cannot be set. System SP Tables-5 206 Register Execute Executes "Embedded RCG Registration". Register Result Displays a number that indicates the registration result. 0: Succeeded 2: Registration in progress 3: Proxy error (proxy enabled) 207 4: Proxy error (proxy disabled) 5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password) 6: Communication error 7: Certification update error 8: Other error 9: Registration executing D129/D130 3-120 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 Error Code Displays a number that describes the error code that was issued when either Cause Illegal Modem Parameter Code Meaning -11001 Chat parameter error -11002 Chat execution error -11003 Unexpected error -12002 -12003 -12004 208 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables SP5816-204 or SP5816-207 was executed. Inquiry, registration attempted without acquiring device status. Attempted registration without execution of an inquiry and no previous registration. Attempted setting with illegal entries for certification and ID2. @Remote communication is prohibited. -12005 The device has an Embedded RC gate-related problem. A confirmation request was made after Operation Error, Incorrect Setting -12006 the confirmation had been already completed. The request number used at registration -12007 was different from the one used at confirmation. -12008 -12009 -12010 SM Appendix Update certification failed because mainframe was in use. ID2 mismatch between an individual certification and NVRAM Certification area is not initialized. 3-121 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 Attempted dial up overseas without the -2385 correct international prefix for the telephone number. Error Caused by -2387 Not supported at the Service Center Response from GW -2389 Database out of service -2390 Program out of service -2391 Two registrations for same device -2392 Parameter error -2393 RCG device not managed -2394 Device not managed -2395 Box ID for RCG device is illegal -2396 Device ID for RCG device is illegal -2397 Incorrect ID2 format -2398 Incorrect request number format URL Releases the machine from its Embedded RCG 209 Instl Clear Gate setup. NOTE: Turn off and on the main power switch after this setting has been changed. 250 CommLog Print D129/D130 Prints the communication log. 3-122 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 5821* Remote Service Address Sets the IP address of the RCG (Remote 002 RCG IP Address Communication Gate) destination for call processing at the remote service center. [00000000h to FFFFFFFFh / 00000000h / 1] Sets the port number of the RCG (Remote 003 RCG Port Communication Gate) destination for call processing at the remote service center. Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables [0 to 65535 / 443 / 1] Sets the URL path of the RCG (Remote 004 RCG URL Path Communication Gate) destination for call processing at the remote service center. [0 to 16 characters / /RCG/services/ /-] NV-RAM Data Upload 5824 Uploads the NVRAM data to an SD card. Push Execute. Note: When uploading data in this SP mode, the front door must be open. NV-RAM Data Download 5825 Downloads data from an SD card to the NVRAM in the machine. After downloading is completed, remove the card and turn the machine power off and on. SM Appendix 3-123 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 5828 Network Setting IPv4 Address (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11) 001 This SP allows you to check and reset the IPv4 address for Ethernet and wireless LAN (802.11): aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd IPv4 Subnet Mask (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11) 002 This SP allows you to check and reset the IPv4 subnet mask for Ethernet and wireless LAN (802.11): aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd IPv4 Default Gateway (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11) 003 This SP allows you to check and reset the IPv4 default gateway used by the network for Ethernet and wireless LAN (802.11): aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd DHCP (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11) This SP code allows you check and change the setting that determines whether the IP address is used with DHCP on an Ethernet or wireless 006 (802.11) LAN network. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Not used (manual setting) 1: Used Active IPv4 Address 021 This SP allows you to check the IPv4 address that was used when the machine started up with DHCP. Active IPv4 Subnet Mask 022 This SP allows you to check the IPv4 subnet mask setting that was used when the machine started up with DHCP. Active IPv4 Gateway Address 023 This SP allows you to check the IPv4 default gateway setting that was used when the machine started up with DHCP. D129/D130 3-124 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 Enables and disables bi-directional 050 1284 Compatibility (Centro) communication on the parallel connection between the machine and a computer. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1 ] 0:Off, 1: On Disables and enables the ECP feature (1284 052 ECP (Centro) Mode) for data transfer. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled 065 Job Spooling Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Switches the job spooling on and off. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: No spooling, 1: Spooling enabled This SP determines whether the job interrupted at power off is resumed at the next power on. 066 Job Spooling Clear: Start Time This SP operates only when SP5828-065 is set to "1". [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 1: OFF Resumes printing spooled jog. 0: ON Clears spooled job. This SP determines whether job spooling is enabled or disabled for each protocol. This is a Job Spooling (Protocol) 8-bit setting. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: No spooling, 1: Spooling enabled 069 0 LPR 4 BMLinks (Japan Only) 1 FTP (Not Used) 5 DIPRINT 2 IPP 6 Reserved (Not Used) 3 SMB 7 Reserved (Not Used) 087 @Remote Protocol Cnt (DFU) SM Appendix 3-125 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 Disables or enables Telnet operation. If this SP 090 TELNET is disabled, the Telnet port is closed. (0:OFF 1:ON) [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Disable, 1: Enable 091 Web (0:OFF 1:ON) Disables or enables the Web operation. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Disable, 1: Enable This is the IPv6 local address referenced on the Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11) in the format: 145 Active IPv6 Link Local Address "Link-Local address" + "Prefix Length" The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each. These notations can be abbreviated. See "Note: IPV6 Addresses " below this table. 147 149 151 153 155 D129/D130 Active IPv6 Stateless Address 1 Active IPv6 Stateless Address 2 These SPs are the IPv6 stateless addresses (1 to 5) referenced on the Ethernet or wireless LAN Active IPv6 Stateless (802.11) in the format: Address 3 "Stateless Address" + "Prefix Length" Active IPv6 Stateless Address 4 The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each. Active IPv6 Stateless Address 5 3-126 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 IPv6 Manual Address This SP is the IPv6 manually set address referenced on the Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11) in the format: 156 "Manual Set Address" + "Prefix Length" The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each. These notations can be abbreviated. See "Note: IPV6 Addresses" below this table. This SP is the IPv6 gateway address referenced on the Ethernet or wireless 158 LAN (802.11). The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each. These notations can be abbreviated. See "Note: IPV6 Addresses" below this table. Note: IPV6 Addresses Ethernet and the Wireless LAN (802.11) reference the IPV6 "Link-Local address + Prefix Length". The IPV6 address consists of 128 bits divided into 8 blocks of 16 bits: aaaa:bbbb:cccc:dddd:eeee:ffff:gggg:hhhh: The prefix length is inserted at the 17th byte (Prefix Range: 0x0 to 0x80). The initial setting is 0x40 (64). For example, the data: "2001123456789012abcdef012345678940h" is expressed: "2001:1234:5678:9012:abcd:ef01:2345:6789": prefixlen 64 However, the actual IPV6 address display is abbreviated according to the following rules. SM Appendix 3-127 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables IPv6 Gateway Address System SP Tables-5 Rules for Abbreviating IPV6 Addresses 1. The IPV6 address is expressed in hexadecimal delimited by colons (:) with the following characters: 0123456789abcdefABCDEF 2. A colon is inserted as a delimiter every 4th hexadecimal character. fe80:0000:0000:0000:0207:40ff:0000:340e 3. The notations can be abbreviated by eliminating zeros where the MSB and digits following the MSB are zero. The example in "2" above, then, becomes fe80:0:0:0207:40ff:0:340e 4. Sections where only zeros exist can be abbreviated with double colons (::). This abbreviation can be done also where succeeding sections contain only zeros (but this can be done only at one point in the address). The example in "2" and "3" above then becomes: fe80::207:40ff:0:340e (only the first null sets zero digits are abbreviated as "::") -orfe80:0:0:0:207:40ff::340e (only the last null set before "340e" is abbreviated as "::") Enable or disables the automatic setting for IPv6 161 IPv6 Stateless Auto stateless. Setting [0 or 1 / 1 / 1] 1: Enable, 0: Disable Web Item visible Displays or does not display the Web system items. 236 [0 x 0000 to 0 x ffff / 0 x ffff] 0: Not displayed, 1: Displayed bit0: Net RICOH bit1: Consumable Supplier bit2-15: Reserved (all) Web shopping link visible Displays or does not display the link to Net RICOH on the top page and link 237 page of the web system. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Not display, 1:Display D129/D130 3-128 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 Web supplies Link visible Displays or does not display the link to Consumable Supplier on the top 238 page and link page of the web system. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Not display, 1:Display Web Link1 Name 239 This SP confirms or changes the URL1 name on the link page of the web Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables system. The maximum characters for the URL name are 31 characters. Web Link1 URL 240 his SP confirms or changes the link to URL1 on the link page of the web system. The maximum characters for the URL are 127 characters. Web Link1 visible Displays or does not display the link to URL1 on the top page of the web 241 system. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Not display, 1:Display 242 Web Link2 Name Same as "-239" 243 Web Link2 URL Same as "-240" 244 Web Link2 visible Same as "-241" DHCPv6 DUID Sets DHCPv6 DUID. 249 [0000000000000000000000000000h to FFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFh / 0000000000000000000000000000h / -] SM Appendix 3-129 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 HDD 5832 Enter the SP number for the partition to initialize, then press #. When the execution ends, cycle the machine off and on. 001 HDD Formatting (All) 002 HDD Formatting (IMH) 003 HDD Formatting (Thumbnail) 004 HDD Formatting (Job Log) 005 HDD Formatting (Printer Fonts) 006 HDD Formatting (User Info) 007 Mail RX Data 008 Mail TX Data 009 HDD Formatting (Data for Design) 010 HDD Formatting (Log) 011 HDD Formatting (Ridoc I/F) (for Ridoc Desk Top Binder) 5836* Capture Setting Capture Function (0:Off 1:On) With this function disabled, the settings related to the capture feature cannot 001 be initialized, displayed, or selected. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Disable, 1: Enable Panel Setting Determines whether each capture related setting can be selected or 002 updated from the initial system screen. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Disable, 1: Enable The setting for SP5836-001 has priority. D129/D130 3-130 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 [0 to 6 / 0 / 1] 072 Reduction for Copy B&W Text 0:1, 1:1/2, 2:1/3, 3:1/4, 6:2/3 [0 to 6 / 0 / 1] 073 Reduction for Copy B&W Other 0:1, 1:1/2, 2:1/3, 3:1/4, 6:2/3 [0 to 6 / 0 / 1] 075 Reduction for Printer B&W 0 1, 1:1/2, 2:1/3, 3:1/4, 6:2/3 078 Reduction for Printer B&W 1200 1: 1/2, 3: 1/4, 4: 1/6, 5: 1/8 082 Format for Copy B&W Text Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables [0 to 3 / 1 / 1] 0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR, 2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR [0 to 3 / 1 / 1] 083 Format Copy B&W Other 0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR, 2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR [0 to 3 / 1 / 1] 085 Format for Printer B&W 0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR, 2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR Default for JPEG [5 to 95 / 50 / 1] Sets the JPEG format default for documents sent to the document 091 management server with the MLB, with JPEG selected as the format. Enabled only when optional File Format Converter (MLB: Media Link Board) is installed. Sets the IP address for the primary capture 101 Primary srv IP address server. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 102 Primary srv scheme 103 Primary srv port number SM Appendix This is basically adjusted by the remote system. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 3-131 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 104 Primary srv URL path This is basically adjusted by the remote system. Sets the IP address for the secondary capture 111 Secondary srv IP address server. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 112 Secondary srv scheme 113 Secondary srv port number 114 Secondary srv URL path 122 Reso: Copy (Mono) This is basically adjusted by the remote system. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. [0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step] Selects the resolution for BW copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi This is basically adjusted by the remote 124 Reso: Print (Mono) system. [0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step] Selects the resolution for BW print mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi This is basically adjusted by the remote 126 Reso: Fax (Mono) system. [0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step] Selects the resolution for BW fax mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi D129/D130 3-132 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 This is basically adjusted by the remote 127 Reso: Scan (Color) system. [0 to 255 / 4 / 1/step] Selects the resolution for color scanning mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi This is basically adjusted by the remote system. [0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step] Selects the resolution for BW scanning mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi 141 All Addr Info Switch [0 or 1 / 1 / -] 0: Off, 1: On Turns on or off the all address information transmission for the captured resources. 142 Stand-by Doc Max Number [10 to 9999 / 2000 / 1/step] Selects the maximum number of captured documents to be transmitted to the document server. SM Appendix 3-133 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 128 Reso: Scan (Mono) System SP Tables-5 5840* IEEE 802.11 Channel MAX Sets the maximum range of the bandwidth for the wireless LAN. This 006 bandwidth setting varies for different countries. [1 to 14 / 11 (NA), 13 (EU), 14 (JPN) / 1] JPN: 1 to 14, NA: 1 to 11, EU: 1 to 13 Channel MIN Sets the minimum range of the bandwidth for operation of the wireless LAN. 007 This bandwidth setting varies for different countries. [1 to 14 / 1 / 1] JPN: 1 to 14, NA: 1 to 11, EU: 1 to 13 Transmission speed [0 x 00 to 0 x FF / 0 x FF to Auto / -] 0 x FF to Auto [Default] 0 x 11 - 55M Fix 0 x 10 - 48M Fix 008 0 x 0F - 36M Fix 0 x 07 - 11M Fix 0 x 05 - 5.5M Fix 0 x 08 - 1M Fix 0 x 0E - 18M Fix 0 x 13 - 0 x FE (reserved) 0 x 0D - 12M Fix 0 x 12 - 72M (reserved) 0 x 0B - 9M Fix 0 x 09 - 22M (reserved) 0 x 0A - 6M Fix WEP Key Select Selects the WEP key. 011 Bit 1 and 0 00: Key1, 01: Key2 (Reserved), 10: Key3 (Reserved), 11: Key4(Reserved) This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed. D129/D130 3-134 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 RTS/CTS Thresh 013 Adjusts the RTS/CTS threshold for the IEEE802.11 card. [0 to 3000 / 2432 / 1] This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed. Fragment Thresh 042 Adjusts the fragment threshold for the IEEE802.11 card. [256 to 2346 / 2346 / 1] Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed. 11g CTS to Self 043 Determines whether the CTS self function is turned on or off. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Off, 1: On This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed. 11g Slot Time 044 Selects the slot time for IEEE802.11. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: 20 m, 1: 9 m This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed. WPA Debug Lvl 045 Selects the debug level for WPA authentication application. [1 to 3 / 3 / 1] 1: Info, 2: warning, 3: error This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed. SM Appendix 3-135 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 Supply Name Setting 5841* Press the User Tools key. These names appear when the user presses the Inquiry button on the User Tools screen. 001 Toner Name Setting: Black 007 OrgStamp 011 StapleStd1 012 StapleStd2 013 StapleStd3 014 StapleStd4 021 StapleBind1 022 StapleBind2 023 StapleBind3 GWWS Analysis (DFU) Bit Groups 0 System & other groups (LSB) 1 Capture related 2 Certification related process. 3 Address book related Bit SW 0011 1111 4 Machine management related 5 Output related (printing, delivery) 6 Repository related This is a debugging tool. It 5842* sets the debugging output mode of each Net File D129/D130 3-136 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 Default: 00000000 – do not change 001 Setting 1 Netfiles: Jobs to be printed from the document server using a PC and the DeskTopBinder software Adjusts the debug program mode setting. Bit7: 5682 mmseg-log setting 002 Setting 2 0: Date/Hour/Minute/Second 1: Minute/Second/Msec. 5844 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 0 to 6: Not used USB Transfer Rate 001 Sets the speed for USB data transmission. [0 x 01 or 0 x 04 / 0 x 04 /-] 0 x 01 [Full Speed], 0 x 04 [Auto Change] Vendor ID 002 Sets the vendor ID: Initial Setting: 0x05A Ricoh Company [0x0000 to 0xFFFF/1] (DFU) Product ID 003 Sets the product ID. [0x0000 to 0xFFFF/1] (DFU) Device Release No. Sets the device release number of the BCD (binary coded decimal) display. 004 [0000 to 9999 / 100 / 1] (DFU) Enter as a decimal number. NCS converts the number to hexadecimal number recognized as the BCD. SM Appendix 3-137 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 005 Fixed USB Port This SP standardizes for common use the model name and serial number for USB PnP (Plug & Play). It determines whether the driver requires re-installation. [0 to 2 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF 1: Level 1 2: Level 2 006 PnP Model Name This SP sets the model name to be used by the USB PnP when "Function Enable (Level 2) is set so the USB Serial No. can have a common name (SP5844-5). Default: Laser Printer (up to 20 characters allowed). 007 PnP Serial Number This SP sets the serial number to be used by the USB PnP when "Function Enable (Level 2) set so the USB Serial No. can have a common name (SP5844-5). Default: None (up to 12 characters allowed for entry). Make sure that this entry is the same as the serial number in use. At initialization the serial number generated from the model name is used, not the setting of this SP code. D129/D130 At times other than initialization, the value set for this SP code is used. 3-138 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 100 Notify Unsupport This SP determines whether an alert message appears on the control panel when a USB device (unsupported device) that cannot use an A-connector is connected. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Function enable 1: Function disable An unsupported device is a device that cannot use the functions of the Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables USB device. For example, a USB mouse cannot be used even if it connected. If the PictBridge option is not mounted, even if a digital camera is connected it cannot be used because it is an unsupported device. Delivery Server Setting 5845* These are delivery server settings. FTP Port No. 001 [0 to 65535 / 3670 / 1] IP Address (Primary) 002 Use this SP to set the Scan Router Server address. The IP address under the transfer tab can be used with the initial system setting. [Range: 000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255] Delivery Error Display Time Use this setting to set the length of time that the message is shown when a 006 test error occurs during document transfer with the NetFile application and an external device. [0 to 999 / 300 / 1 sec] IP Address (Secondary) Sets the IP address that is given to the computer that is the secondary 008 delivery server for Scan Router. This SP lets you set only the IP address, and does not refer to the DNS setting. [Range: 000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255] SM Appendix 3-139 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 Delivery Server Model Lets you change the model of the delivery server that is registered by the I/O device. [0 to 4 / 0 / 1 step] 009 0: Unknown 1: SG1 Provided 2: SG1 Package 3: SG2 Provided 4: SG2 Package Delivery Svr. Capability Changes the functions that the registered I/O device can do. [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 step] Bit7 = 1 Comment information exits Bit6 = 1 Direct specification of mail address possible 010 Bit5 = 1 Mail RX confirmation setting possible Bit4 = 1 Address book automatic update function exists Bit3 = 1 Fax RX delivery function exists Bit2 = 1 Sender password function exists Bit1 = 1 Function to link MK-1 user and Sender exists Bit0 = 1 Sender specification required (if set to 1, Bit6 is set to "0") Delivery Svr.Capability (Ext) 011 These settings are for future use. They will let you increase the number of registered devices (in addition to those registered for SP5845 010). There are eight bits (Bit 0 to Bit 7). All are unused at this time. 013 Server Scheme (Primary) 014 Server port Number (Primary) [1 to 65535 / 80 / 1] 015 Server URL Path (Primary) 016 Server Scheme (Secondary) 017 Server Port Number(Secondary) D129/D130 3-140 [1 to 65535 / 80 / 1] SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 018 Server URL Path (Secondary) [0 to 1 / 1 / -] Rapid Sending Control 0: Disable, 1: Enable 022 Enables or disables the prevention function for the continuous data sending error. UCS Setting Machine ID (for Delivery Server) Displays the unique device ID in use by the delivery server directory. The 001 value is only displayed and cannot be changed. This ID is created from the NIC MAC or IEEE 1394 EUI. The ID is displayed as either 6-byle or 8-byte binary. Machine ID Clear (for Delivery Server) Clears the unique ID of the device used as the name in the file transfer 002 directory. Execute this SP if the connection of the device to the delivery server is unstable. After clearing the ID, the ID will be established again automatically by cycling the machine off and on. Maximum Entries Changes the maximum number of entries that UCS can handle. 003 [2000 to 20000 / 2000 / 1 step] If a value smaller than the present value is set, the UCS managed data is cleared, and the data (excluding user code information) is displayed. SM Appendix 3-141 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 5846* System SP Tables-5 Delivery Server Retry Timer Sets the interval for retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire 006 the delivery server address book. [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 step] 0: No retries Delivery Server Retry Times 007 Sets the number of retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire the delivery server address book. [0 to 255 / 0 / 1step] Delivery Server Maximum Entries 008 Lets you set the maximum number of account entries and information about the users of the delivery server controlled by UCS. [2000 to 20000 / 2000 / 1 step] LDAP Search Timeout 010 Sets the length of the time-out for the search of the LDAP server. [1 to 255 / 60 /1 step] WSD Maximum Entries 020 WSD (Web Services on Devices) is the Microsoft standard for connectivity to web-service enabled devices. [50 to 250 / 250 / 1] Folder Auth Change This SP determines whether the user login information (Login User name and Password) or address (destination setting in the address book for Scan-to-SMB) is used to permit folder access. The machine must be cycled 021 off/on for this setting to take effect if it is changed. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Login User Uses operator login information (initial value of main machine) 1: Destination Uses address authorization information D129/D130 3-142 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 Initial Value of Upper Limit Count 022 [0 to 999999 / 500 / 1] Addr Book Migration (USB -> HDD) This SP moves the address book data from the SD card or flash ROM on the controller board to the HDD. You must cycle the machine off and on after 1. Turn the machine off. 2. Install the HDD. 3. Turn the machine on. 4. 040 5. Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables executing this SP. Do SP5846 040. Turn the machine off/on. Executing this SP overwrites any address book data already on the HDD with the data from the flash ROM on the controller board. We recommend that you back up all directory information to an SD card with SP5846-051 before you execute this SP. After the address book data is copied to HDD, all the address book data is deleted from the flash ROM. If the operation fails, the data is not erased from the flash ROM. SM Appendix 3-143 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 041 Fill Addr Acl Info. This SP must be executed immediately after installation of an HDD unit in a basic machine that previously had no HDD. The first time the machine is powered on with the new HDD installed, the system automatically takes the address book from the NVRAM and writes it onto the new HDD. However, the new address book on the HDD can be accessed only by the system administrator at this stage. Executing this SP by the service technician immediately after power on grants full address book access to all users. Procedure 1. Turn the machine off. 2. Install the new HDD. 3. Turn the machine on. 4. The address book and its initial data are created on the HDD automatically. However, at this point the address book can be accessed by only the system administrator or key operator. 5. Enter the SP mode and do SP5846 041. After this SP executes successfully, any user can access the address book. Addr Book Media Displays the slot number where an address book data is in. [0 to 30 / - /1] 043 0: Unconfirmed 1: SD Slot 1 20: HDD 2: SD Slot 2 30: Nothing 4: USB Flash ROM Initialize All Setting & Addr Book 046 Initializes all settings and the address book. Initialize Local Address Book 047 Clears all of the address information from the local address book of a machine managed with UCS. D129/D130 3-144 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 Initialize Delivery Addr Book 048 Push [Execute] to delete all items (this does not include user codes) in the delivery address book that is controlled by UCS. Initialize LDAP Addr Book 049 Push [Execute] to delete all items (this does not include user codes) in the LDAP address book that is controlled by UCS. Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Initialize All Addr Book 050 Clears everything (including users codes) in the directory information managed by UCS. However, the accounts and passwords of the system administrators are not deleted. Backup All Addr Book 051 Copies all directory information to the SD card. Do this SP before replacing the controller board or HDD. The operation may not succeed if the controller board or HDD is damaged. Restore All Addr Book 052 Copies back all directory information from the SD card to the flash ROM or HDD. Upload the address book from the old flash ROM or HDD with SP5846-51 before removing it. Do SP5846 52 after installing the new HDD. Clear Backup Info Deletes the address book uploaded from the SD card in the slot 2. Deletes 053 only the files uploaded for that machine. This feature does not work if the card is write-protected. Note: After you do this SP, go out of the SP mode, turn the power off. Do not remove the SD card until the Power LED stops flashing. SM Appendix 3-145 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 Search Option This SP uses bit switches to set up the fuzzy search options for the UCS local address book. Bit Meaning 0 Checks both upper/lower case characters 1 060 2 Japan Only 3 4 --- Not Used --- 5 --- Not Used --- 6 --- Not Used --- 7 --- Not Used --- Complexity Option 1 Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to upper case and sets the length of the password. 062 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1step] This SP does not normally require adjustment. This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a group password policy to control access to the address book. D129/D130 3-146 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 Complexity Option 2 Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to lower case and defines the length of the password. 063 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1step] This SP does not normally require adjustment. This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables group password policy to control access to the address book. Complexity Option 3 Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to numbers and defines the length of the password. 064 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1step] This SP does not normally require adjustment. This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a group password policy to control access to the address book. Complexity Option 4 Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to symbols and defines the length of the password. 065 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1step] This SP does not normally require adjustment. This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a group password policy to control access to the address book. FTP Auth Port Setting 091 Sets the FTP port to get the delivery server address book that is used in the individual authorization mode. [0 to 65535 / 3671 / 1step] SM Appendix 3-147 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 Encryption Start 094 Shows the status of the encryption function of the address book on the LDAP server. [0 to 255 / 1 ] No default Rep Resolution Reduction 5847-2 through 5847-6 changes the default settings of image data sent externally by the Net File page reference function. 5847* 5847-21 sets the default for JPEG image quality of image files controlled by NetFile. "NetFile" refers to jobs to be printed from the document server with a PC and the DeskTopBinder software. 002 Rate for Copy B&W Text [0 to 6 / 0 / 1] 003 Rate for Copy B&W Other [0 to 6 / 0 / 1] 005 Rate for Printer B&W [0 to 6 / 0 / 1] 0: 1x 1: 1/2x 2: 1/3x 3: 1/4x 4: 1/5x 007 Rate for Printer B&W 1200dpi [0 to 6 / 1 / 1] 5: 1/8x 6: 2/3x1 Network Quality Default for JPEG Sets the default value for the quality of JPEG images sent as NetFile pages. 021 This function is available only with the MLB (Media Link Board) option installed. [5 to 95 / 50 / 1step] D129/D130 3-148 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 Web Service 5848-2 sets the 4-bit switch assignment for the access control setting. 5848* Setting of 0001 has no effect on access and delivery from Scan Router. 5848-100 sets the maximum size of images that can be downloaded. The default is equal to 1 gigabyte. 0000: No access control 002 Acc. Ctrl.: Repository (only Lower 4 Bits) 0001: Denies access to Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables DeskTop Binder. 003 Acc. Ctrl.: Doc. Svr. Print (Lower 4 Bits) 004 Acc. Ctrl.: User Directory (Lower 4 Bits) 007 Acc. Ctrl Comm. Log Fax (Lower 4 Bits) 009 Acc. Ctrl.: Job Control (Lower 4 Bits) Switches access control on and off. 011 Acc. Ctrl: Device Management (Lower 4 Bits) 0000: OFF, 0001: ON 021 Acc. Ctrl: Delivery (Lower 4 Bits) 022 Acc. Ctrl: User Administration (Lower 4 Bits) 099 Repository: Download Image Setting Specified the max size of 100 Repository: Download Image Max. Size the image data that the machine can download/ [1 to 2048 / 2048 / 1 MB] Setting: Log Type: Job 1 210 No information is available at this time. Setting: Log Type: Job 2 211 No information is available at this time. SM Appendix 3-149 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 Setting: Log Type: Access 212 No information is available at this time. Setting: Primary Srv 213 No information is available at this time. Setting: Secondary Srv 214 No information is available at this time. Setting: Start Time 215 No information is available at this time. Setting: Interval Time 216 No information is available at this time. Setting: Timing 217 No information is available at this time. Installation Date 5849 Displays or prints the installation date of the machine. 001 Display The "Counter Clear Day" has been changed to "Installation Date" or "Inst. Date". Determines whether the installation date is printed on the printout for the total counter. 002 Switch to Print [0 to 1 / 1 / -] 0: OFF (No Print) 1: ON (Print) When the total number of pages that are made reaches 003 Total Counter this value, the current date becomes the 'official' installation date for this machine. [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1] D129/D130 3-150 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 5850* Address Book Function Japan Only Replacement of Circuit Classification The machine is sold ready to use with a G3 line. This SP allows you to 003 switch all at once to convert to G4 after you add a G4 line. Conversely, if for some reason the G4 line becomes unusable, you can easily switch back to G3. 5851* Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Bluetooth Sets the operation mode for the Bluetooth Unit. Press either key. [0: Public] / [1: Private] Stamp Data Download Push [Execute] to download the fixed stamp data from the machine ROM onto the hard disk. Then these stamps can be used by the system. If this is 5853 not done, the user will not have access to the fixed stamps ("Confidential", "Secret", etc.). You must always execute this SP after replacing the HDD or after formatting the HDD. Always switch the machine off and on after executing this SP. 5856 Remote ROM Update When set to "1" allows reception of firmware data via the local port (IEEE 1284) during a remote ROM update. This setting is reset to zero after the machine is cycled off and on. Allows the technician to upgrade the firmware 002 using a parallel cable [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 step] 0: Not allowed 1: Allowed SM Appendix 3-151 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 5857 Save Debug Log On/Off (1:ON 0:OFF) Switches on the debug log feature. The debug log cannot be captured until 001 this feature is switched on. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: OFF, 1: ON Target (2: HDD 3: SD) Selects the destination where the debugging information generated by the 002 event selected by SP5858 will be stored if an error is generated [2 to 3 / 2 / 1] 2: HDD, 3: SD Card Save to HDD 005 Specifies the decimal key number of the log to be written to the hard disk. Save to SD Card 006 Specifies the decimal key number of the log to be written to the SD Card. Copy HDD to SD Card (Latest 4 MB) Takes the most recent 4 MB of the log written to the hard disk and copies 009 them to the SD Card. A unique file name is generated to avoid overwriting existing file names on the SD Card. Up to 4MB can be copied to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can be copied one by one to each SD Card. Copy HDD to SD Card Latest 4 MB Any Key) Takes the log of the specified key from the log on the hard disk and copies it to the SD Card. 010 A unique file name is generated to avoid overwriting existing file names on the SD Card. Up to 4 MB can be copied to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can be copied one by one to each SD Card. This SP does not execute if there is no log on the HDD with no key specified. D129/D130 3-152 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 Erase HDD Debug Data 011 Erases all debug logs on the HDD Erase SD Card Debug Data Erases all debug logs on the SD Card. If the card contains only debugging 012 files generated by an event specified by SP5858, the files are erased when SP5857 010 or 011 is executed. Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables To enable this SP, the machine must be cycled off and on. Free Space on SD Card 013 Displays the amount of space available on the SD card. Copy SD to SD (Latest 4MB) 014 Copies the last 4MB of the log (written directly to the card from shared memory) onto an SD card. Copy SD to SD (Latest 4MB Any Key) 015 This SP copies the log on an SD card (the file that contains the information written directly from shared memory) to a log specified by key number. Make HDD Debug 016 This SP creates a 32 MB file to store a log on the HDD. Make SD Debug 017 This SP creates a 4 MB file to store a log on an SD card. SM Appendix 3-153 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 Debug Save When These SPs select the content of the debugging information to be saved to 5858* the destination selected by SP5857-002. SP5858-003 stores one SC specified by number. 001* Engine SC Error (0:OFF 1:ON) 002* Stores SC codes generated by copier engine errors. Controller SC Error (0:OFF Stores SC codes generated by GW 1:ON) controller errors. 003* Any SC Error [0 to 65535 / 0 / 1step] 004* Jam (0:OFF 1:ON) Stores jam errors. 5859* Debug Save Key No. 001 Key 1 002 Key 2 003 Key 3 004 Key 4 005 Key 5 These SPs allow you to set up to 10 keys for log files for functions that use common memory on the controller board. 006 Key 6 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 007 Key 7 008 Key 8 009 Key 9 010 Key 10 D129/D130 3-154 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 5860* SMTP/POP3/IMAP4 Partial Mail Receive Timeout [1 to 168 / 72 / 1 hour] 020 Sets the amount of time to wait before saving a mail that breaks up during reception. The received mail is discarded if the remaining portion of the mail is not received during this prescribed time. Determines whether RFC2298 compliance is switched on for MDN reply 021 mail. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: No, 1: Yes SMTP Auth. From Field Replacement Determines whether the FROM item of the mail header is switched to the 022 validated account after the SMTP server is validated. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: No. "From" item not switched. 1: Yes. "From" item switched. SMTP Auth Direct Sending Select the authentication method for SMPT. Bit 0: LOGIN Bit 1: PLAIN 025 Bit 2: CRAM_MD5 Bit 3: DIGEST_MD5 Bit 4 to Bit 7: Not Used This SP is activated only when SMTP authentication is enabled by UP mode. SM Appendix 3-155 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables MDN Response RFC2298 Compliance System SP Tables-5 S/MIME: MIME Header Setting Selects the MIME header type of an E-mail sent by S/MIME. 026 [0 to 2 / 0 / 1] 0: Microsoft Outlook Express standard 1: Internet Draft standard 2: RFC standard S/MIME: Authentication Check When sending S/MIME mail, specify whether to check the destination 028 authentication. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Not checked 1: Checked 5866 E-Mail Report 001 Report Validity Enables or disables the E-mail alert function. [0 or 1 / 0 / – ] 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled Adds or does not add the date field to the header of the 005 Add Date Field alert mail. [0 or 1 / 0 / – ] 0: Not added, 1: Added 5870 Common Key Info Writing 001 Writing 003 Initialize 004 D129/D130 Writes to flash ROM the common proof for validating the device for @Remote specifications. Initializes the data area of the common proof for validating. Writing: Writes to flash ROM the common proof (2048-bit) for validating 2048bit the device for @Remote specifications. 3-156 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 SD Card Appli. Move 5873 Allows you to move applications from one SD card another. For more, see "SD Card Appli Move" in the chapter "System Maintenance (Main Chapters). 001 Move Exec Executes the move from one SD card to another. 002 Undo Exec This is an undo function. It cancels the previous execution. SC Auto Reboot This SP determines whether the machine reboots automatically when an SC error occurs. The reboot does not occur for Type A SC codes. [0 to 1/ 0 / 1] 001 Reboot Setting 0: The machine reboots automatically when the machine issues an SC error and logs the SC error code. If the same SC occurs again, the machine does not reboot. 1: The machine does not reboot when an SC error occurs. 002 Reboot Type 5878 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Manual reboot, 1: Automatic reboot Option Setup Press [Execute] to initialize the Data Overwrite 001 Data Overwrite Security Security option for the copier. For more, see "DataOverwriteSecurity Unit" in the chapter "Installation". Fixed Phase Block Erasing 5881 Detects the Fixed phrase. SM Appendix 3-157 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 5875 System SP Tables-5 CPM Set 5882 DFU 5885* Set WIM Function Allows or disallows the functions of web image monitor. 0: OFF, 1: ON Bit: 0: Forbid all document server access 020 DocSvr Acc Ctrl 1: Forbid user mode access 2: Forbid print function 3: Forbid Fax 4: Forbid scan sending 5: Forbid download 6: Forbid delete 7: Forbid guest user DocSvr Format 050 Selects the display type for the document box list. [0 to 2 / 0 / 1] 0: Thumbnail, 1: Icon, 2: Details DocSvr Trans 051 Sets the number of documents to be displayed in the document box list. [5 to 20 / 10 / 1] Set Signature [0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step] 0: Signature for each e-mail 100 1: Signature for all e-mails 2: No signature Selects whether the signature is added to the scanned documents with the WIM when they are transmitted by an e-mail. D129/D130 3-158 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 Set Encryption Determines whether the scanned documents with the WIM are encrypted 101 when they are transmitted by an e-mail. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 200 Detect Mem Leak Not used 201 DocSvr Timeout Not used Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 0: Not encrypted, 1:Encryption SD Get Counter 5887 This SP determines whether the ROM can be updated. This SP sends a text file to an SD card inserted in SD card Slot 2 (lower slot). The operation stores. The file is stored in a folder created in the root directory of the SD card called SD_COUNTER. The file is saved as a text 001 file (*.txt) prefixed with the number of the machine. 1. Insert the SD card in SD card Slot 2 (lower slot). 2. Select SP5887 then touch [EXECUTE]. Touch [Execute] in the message when you are prompted. Personal Information Protect Selects the protection level for logs. 5888* [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: No authentication, No protection for logs 1: No authentication, Protected logs (only an administrator can see the logs) SM Appendix 3-159 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 SDK Application Counter 5893 Displays the counter name of each SDK application. 001 SDK-1 002 SDK-2 003 SDK-3 004 SDK-4 005 SDK-5 006 SDK-6 Plug & Play Maker/Model Name Selects the brand name and the production name for Windows Plug & Play. This information is stored in the NVRAM. If the NVRAM is defective, these 5907 names should be registered again. After selecting, press the "Original Type" key and "#" key at the same time. When the setting is completed, the beeper sounds five times. LCT Paper Size Specifies the paper size in the LCT. 5908* [0 or 1 / 0 / -] 0: A4 1: LT 5913* Switchover Permission Time Print Application Timer [3 to 30 / 3 / 1 second step] 002 Sets the length of time to elapse before allowing another application to take control of the display when the application currently controlling the display is not operating because a key has not been pressed. D129/D130 3-160 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 5919* HDD Encryption Display Operation State Shows the status of the encryption function for the HDD. 001 [0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: Not Activated Copy Server: Set Function 0: ON, 1: OFF Enable and disable the document server. This is a security measure that 5967* prevents image data from being left in the temporary area of the HDD. After changing this setting, you must switch the main switch off and on to enable the new setting. 5973* User Stamp Registration 101 Frame deletion setting [0 to 3 / 0 / 1 mm] Cherry Server Selects which version of the Scan Router application program, "Light" or 5974* "Full" (Professional) is installed. [0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: Light 1: Full SM Appendix 3-161 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 1: Activated System SP Tables-5 Device Setting The NIC and USB support features are built into the GW controller. Use this 5985 SP to enable and disable these features. In order to use the NIC and USB functions built into the controller board, these SP codes must be set to "1". [0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Disable, 1: Enable, 2: Function limitation When the "Function limitation" is set, "On board NIC" is limited only for the NRS or LDAP/NT authentication. 001 On Board NIC Other network applications than @Remote or LDAP/NT authentication are not available when this SP is set to "2". Even though you can change the initial settings of those network applications, the settings do not work 002 On Board USB 5987* [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] 0: Disable, 1: Enable Counter Falsification Prevention This SP detects that a mechanical counter device is removed. If it is detected, SC610 occurs. [0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step] 0: OFF. 1: ON D129/D130 3-162 SM Appendix System SP Tables-5 SP Print Mode 5990 Prints out the SMC sheets. 001 All ( Data List) 002 SP (Mode Data List) 003 User Program Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 004 Logging Data 005 Diagnostic Report 006 Non-Default 007 NIB Summary 008 Capture Log 021 Copier User Program 022 Scanner SP 023 Scanner User Program 024 SDK/J Summary 025 SDK/J Application Info 026 Print SP SM Appendix 3-163 D129/D130 System SP Tables-5 SP Text Mode 5992 Writes the SMC sheets into the SD card. 001 All ( Data List) 002 SP (Mode Data List) 003 User Program 004 Logging Data 005 Diagnostic Report 006 Non-Default 007 NIB Summary 008 Capture Log 021 Copier User Program 022 Scanner SP 023 Scanner User Program 024 SDK/J Summary 025 SDK/J Application Info 026 Print SP D129/D130 3-164 SM Appendix System SP Tables-6 3.6 SYSTEM SP TABLES-6 3.6.1 SP6-XXX: PERIPHERALS ADF Registration Adjust Adjusts the side-to-side and leading edge registration for simplex and 6006* duplex original feeding in ARDF mode. Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables SP6006-5 sets the maximum setting allowed for rear edge erase. 001 Side-to-Side Regist: Front [–3 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step] 002 Side-to-Side Regist: Rear 003 Leading Edge Registration [–5 to 5 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step] 005 Buckle: Duplex Front [–3 to 3 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step] 006 Buckle: Duplex Rear [–2.5 to 2.5 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step] 007 Rear Edge Erase [–10 to 10 / 0 / 0.1 mm / step] 6007 ADF Input Check 001 002 003 Original Length 1 (B5 Detection Sensor) Original Length 2 (A4 Detection Sensor) Original Length 3 (LG Detection Sensor) 004 Original Width Sensor 1 0: Paper not detected 1: Paper detected 005 Original Width Sensor 2 006 Original Width Sensor 3 007 Original Width Sensor 4 008 Original Width Sensor 5 SM Appendix 3-165 D129/D130 System SP Tables-6 009 Original Set Sensor 010 Separation Sensor 011 Skew Correction Sensor 012 Scan Entrance Sensor 013 Registration Sensor 014 Exit Sensor 015 Feed Cover Sensor 016 Lift Up Sensor 017 Inverter Sensor 018 Pick-up Roller HP Sensor 019 Original Set HP Sensor D129/D130 0: ADF cover closed 1: ADF cover open 0: ADF closed 1: ADF open 0: Paper not detected 1: Paper detected 0: HP (Pick-up roller: Up) 1: Not HP (Pick-up roller: Down) 0: HP (Stopper: UP) 1: Not HP (Stopper: Down) 3-166 SM Appendix System SP Tables-6 6008 ADF Output Check 001 Pick-up Motor Forward 002 Pick-up Motor Reserve 003 Feed Motor Forward 004 Feed Motor Reserve Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 005 Relay Motor Forward 007 Inverter Motor Forward 008 Inverter Motor Reserve 011 Inverter Solenoid 012 Stamp 013 Fan Motor ADF FreeRun Performs an ARDF free run in duplex mode. Press [ON] to start, press [OFF] 6009 to stop. Note: This is a general free run controlled from the copier. 001 Free Run: Simplex Motion 002 Free Run: Duplex Motion 003 Free Run: Stamp Motion ADF Stamp Position Adjust. [–5 to 5 / 0 / 0.1 mm step] 6010* Adjusts the horizontal position of the stamp on the scanned originals. SM Appendix 3-167 D129/D130 System SP Tables-6 Original Size Detect Setting Specifies the original size for a size detected by the original sensor, since original sensors cannot recognize all sizes. (7) 0000 0000 (0) Different bits are used for detection, depending on the location as shown below. Bit 6016* Size 7 A4 (L)/LT (L) 6 11" x 15"/DLT (L) 5 DLT (L)/ 11" x 15" 4 LT (S)/ US Exec (S) Location Japan only NA only 3 LT (L)/ 8" x 10" (L) 2 LG (L)/ F4 (L) 1 A4 (L)/ 16K (L) 0 8K (L)/ DLT (L) EU/AA only DF Magnification Adj. 6017* [–5 to 5 / 0 / 0.1% step] Adjusts the magnification in the sub-scan direction for ADF mode. Use the key to toggle between + and - before entering the value Skew Correction Moving Setting Turns the original skew correction in the ARDF for all original sizes on or off. 6020* [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0: Off (only for small original sizes) 1: On (for all original sizes) D129/D130 3-168 SM Appendix System SP Tables-6 Punch Position: Sub Scan 6128 Adjusts the punching position in the sub scan direction. (For D636/D637) 001 2-Hole: DOM (Japan) 002 3-Hole: NA 003 4-Hole: EU [-7.5 to 7.5 / 0 / 0.5 mm] Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 004 5-Hole: SCAN 005 2-Hole: NA Punch Position: Main Scan 6129 Adjusts the punching position in the main scan direction. (For D636/D637) 001 2-Hole: DOM (Japan) 002 3-Hole: NA 003 4-Hole: EU [-2 to 2 / 0 / 0.4 mm] 004 4-Hole: SCAN 005 2-Hole: NA Skew Correction: Buckle Adj. 6130* Adjusts the paper buckle at the punch unit for each paper size. (For D636/D637) 001 A3 SEF 002 B4 SEF 003 A4 SEF [-5 to 5 / 0 / 0.25 mm] 004 A4 LEF 005 B5 SEF 006 B5 LEF SM Appendix 3-169 D129/D130 System SP Tables-6 007 DLT SEF 008 LG SEF 009 LT SEF 010 LT LEF 011 12" x 18" 012 Other Skew Correction Control 6131* Selects the skew correction control for each paper size. (For D636/D637) 001 A3 SEF 002 B4 SEF 003 A4 SEF 004 A4 LEF 005 B5 SEF 006 B5 LEF [0 to 1 / 1 / 1 mm] 007 DLT SEF 008 LG SEF 009 LT SEF 010 LT LEF 011 12" x 18" 012 Other D129/D130 3-170 SM Appendix System SP Tables-6 Jogger Fence Fine Adj. This SP adjusts the distance between the jogger fences and the sides of the 6132* stack on the finisher stapling tray in the (Booklet) Finisher D636/D637. The adjustment is done perpendicular to the direction of paper feed. 001 A3 SEF 002 B4 SEF Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 003 A4 SEF 004 A4 LEF 005 B5 SEF 006 B5 LEF [-1.5 to 1.5 / 0 / 0.5 mm] 007 DLT SEF 008 LG SEF 009 LT SEF 010 LT LEF 011 12" x 18" 012 Other Staple Position Adjustment Adjusts the staple position for each finisher (D636/D637). 6133* + Value: Moves the staple position to the rear side. - Value: Moves the staple position to the front side. [-3.5 to 3.5 / 0 / 0.5 mm] SM Appendix 3-171 D129/D130 System SP Tables-6 Saddle Stitch Position Adj. 6134* Use this SP to adjust the stapling position of the booklet stapler when paper is stapled and folded in the Booklet Finisher (D637). 001 A3 SEF 002 B4 SEF [-3 to 3 / 0 / 0.2 mm] 003 A4 SEF 004 B5 SEF + Value: Shifts staple position toward the crease. - Value: Shifts staple position away from the crease 005 DLT SEF 006 LG SEF 007 LT SEF 008 12" x 18" 009 Other Folder Position Adj. 6135* This SP corrects the folding position when paper is stapled and folded in the Booklet Finisher D637. 001 A3 SEF 002 B4 SEF [-3 to 3 / 0 / 0.2 mm] 003 A4 SEF 004 B5 SEF + Value: Shifts staple position toward the crease. - Value: Shifts staple position away from the crease. 005 DLT SEF 006 LG SEF 007 LT SEF 008 12" x 18" 009 Other D129/D130 3-172 SM Appendix System SP Tables-6 Book Fold Repeat 6136* Sets the number of times that folding is done in the Booklet Finisher D637. [2 to 30 / 2 / 1 time/step] Finisher Free Run 6137 These SPs are used for the D588 or D636/D637. 002 Free Run 2 D588: System free run D636/D637: Free run for paper edge stapling. Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 001 Free Run 1 D588: Free run for durability testing D636/D637: Not used 003 Free Run 3 Not used 004 Free Run 4 Not used Entrance Sensor 6139 Display the signals received from sensors and switches of the (booklet) finisher. (D588) ( p.3-251 "Input Check") FIN (EUP) INPUT Check 6140 Display the signals received from sensors and switches of the (booklet) finisher. (D636/D637) ( p.3-251 "Input Check") FIN (KIN) OUPUT Check 6144 Display the signals received from sensors and switches of the (booklet) finisher. (D588) ( p.3-263 "Output Check") FIN (EUP) OUPUT Check 6145 Display the signals received from sensors and switches of the (booklet) finisher. (D636/D637) ( SM Appendix p.3-263 "Output Check") 3-173 D129/D130 System SP Tables-6 Max. Pre-Stack Sheet [0 to 3 / 3 / 1 sheets step] This SP sets the number of sheets sent to the pre-stack tray. 6149* You may need to adjust this setting or switch it off when feeding thick or slick paper. 6800 Sheet Conversion (Thick Paper) Permits punching, including tab sheets. Note: Do not change this setting. [1 to 3 / 3 / 1 sheet] 1: 1 Sheet 2: 2 Sheets 3: 3 Sheets Extra Staples More than the standard number of sheets can be stapled. This SP sets the additional number of sheets (This Setting + Standard Number = maximum number of sheets). 6830* If the number of the maximum for staples is increased, and the mechanical warranty of the unit can be guaranteed, then the setting can take effect without changing the controller software. However, assurance that mechanical performance can be guaranteed is required before changing the setting to increase the staple load for more than the maximum in the feed/exit specifications. Raising this setting without quality assurance could damage the machine. Staple positions other than booklet stapling 1 [0 to 50 / 0 /1] 2 Booklet stapling 2 [0 to 50 / 0 /1] D129/D130 3-174 SM Appendix System SP Tables-6 6910 Shading Control ON/OFF 001 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 ] 0= OFF, 1= ON Enables or disables the shading adjustment for DF mode. [0 to 60 / 3 / 1 sec] DFU 003 Shading Interval: B [0 to 120 / 60 / 1 ] DFU Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 002 Shading Interval: A SM Appendix 3-175 D129/D130 System SP Tables-7 3.7 SYSTEM SP TABLES-7 3.7.1 SP7-XXX: DATA LOG 7401* Total SC Counter SC Counter 001 Displays the total number of service calls that have occurred. This SC counter can be reset by executing SP7807 (SC/Jam Counter Reset). Total SC Counter 002 Displays the cumulative sum of service calls that have occurred. This SC counter cannot be reset by executing SP7807 (SC/Jam Counter Reset). 7403* SC History 001 Latest 002 Latest 1 003 Latest 2 004 Latest 3 005 Latest 4 Displays the most recent 10 service calls. 006 Latest 5 007 Latest 6 008 Latest 7 009 Latest 8 010 Latest 9 D129/D130 3-176 SM Appendix System SP Tables-7 7404* SC991 History 001 Latest 002 Latest 1 003 Latest 2 004 Latest 3 005 Latest 4 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Displays the 10 most recently detected SC991 codes. 006 Latest 5 007 Latest 6 008 Latest 7 009 Latest 8 010 Latest 9 7502* Total Paper Jam Jam Counter 001 Displays the total number of paper jams. This SC counter can be reset by executing SP7807 (SC/Jam Counter Reset). Total Jam Counter 002 Displays the cumulative sum of paper jams. This SC counter cannot be reset by executing SP7807 (SC/Jam Counter Reset). SM Appendix 3-177 D129/D130 System SP Tables-7 7503* Total Original Jam Original Jam Counter 001 Displays the total number of original jams. This SC counter can be reset by executing SP7807 (SC/Jam Counter Reset). Total Original Counter 002 Displays the cumulative sum of original jams. This SC counter cannot be reset by executing SP7807 (SC/Jam Counter Reset). Total Jams Location These SPs display the total number of paper jams by location. A "Check-in" 7504* (paper late) error occurs when the paper fails to activate the sensor at the precise time. A "Check-out" ("paper lag") paper jam occurs when the paper remains at the sensor for longer than the prescribed time. 001 At power On 003 Tray 1: On 004 Tray 2: On 005 Tray 3: On 006 Tray 4: On 007 LCT: On 008 Bypass: On 009 Duplex: On 011 Vertical Transport 1: On 012 Vertical Transport 2: On 013 Bank: Transport Sn 1: On D129/D130 3-178 SM Appendix System SP Tables-7 014 Bank: Transport Sn 2: On 017 Registration: On 019 Fusing Exit: On 020 Paper Exit: On 021 Bridge Exit On Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 022 Bridge Transport: On 024 Junction Gate Sensor: On 025 Duplex Exit: On 026 Duplex Entrance: On (In) 027 Duplex Entrance: On (Out) 051 Vertical Transport 1: Off 052 Vertical Transport 2: Off 053 Bank Transport 1: Off 054 Bank Transport 2: Off 057 Registration Sensor: Off 058 LCT Feed Sensor: Off 060 Paper Exit: Off 061 Bridge: Exit: Off 062 Bridge: Transport: Off 064 Junction Gate Sensor: Off 065 Duplex Exit: Off 066 Duplex Entrance: Off (In) 067 Duplex Entrance: Off (Out) SM Appendix 3-179 D129/D130 System SP Tables-7 100 Finisher Entrance: KIN 101 Finisher Shift Tray Exit: KIN 102 Finisher Staple: KIN 103 Finisher Exit: KIN 105 Finisher Tray Lift Motor: KIN 106 Finisher Jogger Motor: KIN 107 Finisher Shift Motor: KIN 108 Finisher Staple Motor: KIN 109 Finisher Exit Motor: KIN 191 Finisher Entrance: EUP 192 Finisher Proof Exit: EUP 193 Finisher Shift Tray Exit: EUP 194 Finisher Staple Exit: EUP 195 Finisher Exit: EUP 198 Finisher Folder: EUP 199 Finisher Tray Motor: EUP 200 Finisher Jogger Motor: EUP 201 Finisher Shift Motor: EUP 202 Finisher Staple Moving Motor: EUP 203 Finisher Staple Motor: EUP 204 Finisher Folder Motor: EUP 206 Finisher Punch Motor: EUP D129/D130 3-180 SM Appendix System SP Tables-7 Original Jam Detection Displays the total number of original jams by location. These jams occur when the original does not activate the sensors. A Check-in ("paper late") 7505 error occurs when the paper fails to activate the sensor at the precise time. A Check-out ("paper lag") paper jam occurs when the paper remains at the sensor for longer than the prescribed time. 001 At Power: On Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 003 Separation Sensor: On 004 Skew Correction Sensor: On 005 Interval Sensor: On 006 Registration Sensor: On 007 Inverter Sensor: On 008 Original Exit Sensor: On 053 Separation Sensor: Off 054 Skew Correction Sensor: Off 055 Interval Sensor: Off 056 Registration Sensor: Off 057 Inverter Sensor: Off 058 Original Exit Sensor: Off SM Appendix 3-181 D129/D130 System SP Tables-7 7506* Jam Count by Paper Size 005 A4 LEF 006 A5 LEF 014 B5 LEF 038 LT LEF 044 HLT LEF 132 A3 SEF 133 A4 SEF 134 A5 SEF Displays the total number of copy jams by paper size. 141 B4 SEF 142 B5 SEF 160 DLT SEF 164 LG SEF 166 LT SEF 172 HLT SEF 255 Others D129/D130 3-182 SM Appendix System SP Tables-7 7507* Plotter Jam History 001 Last 002 Latest 1 003 Latest 2 Displays the copy jam history (the most recent 10 jams) Sample Display: CODE:007 004 Latest 3 005 Latest 4 SIZE:05h TOTAL:0000334 006 Latest 5 where: 007 Latest 6 CODE is the SP7504-*** number (see above. Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables DATE: Mon Mar 15 11:44:50 2000 SIZE is the ASAP paper size code in hex. 008 Latest 7 009 Latest 8 TOTAL is the total jam error count (SP7502) DATE is the date the jams occurred. 010 Latest 9 Size Code Size Code Size Code A4 (S) 05 A3 (L) 84 DLT (L) A0 A5 (S) 06 A4 (L) 85 LG (L) A4 B5 (S) 0E A5 (L) 86 LT (L) A6 LT (S) 26 B4 (L) 8D HLT (L) AC HLT (S) 2C B5 (L) 8E Others FF SM Appendix 3-183 D129/D130 System SP Tables-7 7508* Original Jam History 001 Last 002 Last 1 003 Last 2 Displays the original jam history (the most recent 10 jams). Sample Display: CODE:007 004 Last 3 005 Last 4 SIZE:05h TOTAL:0000334 DATE: Mon Mar 15 11:44:50 2000 006 Last 5 where: 007 Last 6 CODE is the SP7505*** number (see above. SIZE is the ASAP paper size code in hex. 008 Last 7 009 Last 8 TOTAL is the total jam error count (SP7503) DATE is the date the jams occurred. 010 Last 9 Size Code Size Code Size Code A4 (S) 05 A3 (L) 84 DLT (L) A0 A5 (S) 06 A4 (L) 85 LG (L) A4 B5 (S) 0E A5 (L) 86 LT (L) A6 LT (S) 26 B4 (L) 8D HLT (L) AC HLT (S) 2C B5 (L) 8E Others FF D129/D130 3-184 SM Appendix System SP Tables-7 Part Replacement Operation 7624* Selects the PM maintenance for each part. 001 PCU-BK 002 Fuser [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0:No (Not PM maintenance) 003 Transfer Unit 1: Yes (PM maintenance) Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 004 FuserCleaner ROM No./Firmware Version 7801 This SP codes display the firmware versions of all ROMs in the system, including the mainframe, the ARDF, and peripheral devices. PM Counter Display 7803* Displays the PM counter since the last PM. Paper [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 001 Displays the paper counter (pages) Page: PCD [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 002 Displays the PCD (Drum and Development unit) counter (pages) Page: Transfer [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 003 Displays the transfer unit counter (pages). Page: Fuser [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 004 Displays the fusing unit counter (pages). Rotation: PCD [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 005 Displays the PCD rotation counter (distance). SM Appendix 3-185 D129/D130 System SP Tables-7 Rotation: Transfer [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 006 Displays the transfer unit rotation counter (distance). Rotation: Fuser [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 007 Displays the fuser unit rotation counter (distance). Rotation(%): PCD [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %] 008 Displays the PCD (%) rotation counter (Distance/PM). Rotation(%):Transfer [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %] 009 Displays the transfer unit (%) rotation counter (distance/PM). Rotation(%):Fuser [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %] 010 Displays the fuser unit (%) rotation counter (distance/PM). Rotation(%):Web [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %] 011 Displays the web unit (%) rotation counter (distance/PM). PM Counter Reset 7804 Resets the PM counter. Touch [Execute] two times > "Completed" > [Exit] Paper 001 Resets the PM counter of the paper. PCD 002 Resets the PM counter of the PCD (Drum and Development unit except developer). Transfer 003 Resets the PM counter of the transfer unit. D129/D130 3-186 SM Appendix System SP Tables-7 Fuser 004 Resets the PM counter of the fuser unit. Web 005 Reset the PM counter of the web unit. All Clear 006 7805 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Resets all PM counter Parts Counter Page: OPC [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 001 Displays the parts counter (pages) of the OPC. Page: Charge Roller [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 002 Displays the parts counter (pages) of the charge roller. Page: Developer [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 003 Displays the parts counter (pages) of the developer. Page: Belt Blade [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 004 Displays the parts counter (pages) of the transfer belt cleaning blade. Page: Heat Roller [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 005 Displays the parts counter (pages) of the hot roller. Page: Pressure Roller [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 006 Displays the parts counter (pages) of the pressure roller. Page: Cleaning Roller [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 007 Displays the parts counter (pages) of the cleaning roller. Page: Thermistor [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 008 Displays the parts counter (pages) of the thermistors. SM Appendix 3-187 D129/D130 System SP Tables-7 Page: Stripper [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 009 Displays the parts counter (pages) of the strippers. Rotation: OPC [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 010 Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the OPC. Rotation: Charge Roller [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 011 Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the charge roller. Rotation: Developer [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 012 Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the developer. Rotation: Belt Blade [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 013 Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the transfer belt, blade. Rotation: Heat Roller [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 014 Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the hot roller. Rotation: Pressure Roller [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 015 Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the pressure roller. Rotation: Cleaning Roller [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 016 Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the cleaning roller. Rotation: Thermistor [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 017 Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the thermistors. Rotation: Stripper [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 018 Displays the parts counter (rotations) of the strippers. Page(%): Web [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %] 019 Displays the parts counter (rotations/PM %) of the cleaning web. D129/D130 3-188 SM Appendix System SP Tables-7 7806 Counter Clear OPC 001 Resets the parts counter of the OPC. Charge Roller 002 Resets the parts counter of the charge roller. Developer Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 003 Resets the parts counter of the developer. Belt: Blade 004 Resets the parts counter of the transfer belt cleaning blade. Heat Roller 005 Resets the parts counter of the hot roller. Pressure Roller 006 Resets the parts counter of the pressure roller. Cleaning Roller 007 Resets the parts counter of the cleaning roller. Web 008 Resets the parts counter of the cleaning web. Thermistor 009 Resets the parts counter of the thermistors. Stripper 010 Resets the parts counter of the strippers. All Clear 011 Resets all parts counters. SM Appendix 3-189 D129/D130 System SP Tables-7 SC/Jam Counter Reset Resets the SC and jam counters. To reset, press Execute on the touch 7807 panel. This SP does not reset the jam history counters: SP7507, SP7508. MF Error Counter Japan Only 7826 Displays the number of counts requested of the card/key counter. 001 Error Total 002 Error Staple A request for the count total failed at power on. This error will occur if the device is installed but disconnected. The request for a staple count failed at power on. This error will occur if the device is installed but disconnected. MF Error Counter Clear Japan Only 7827 Press Execute to reset to 0 the values of SP7826. Japan Only Self-Diagnose Result Display Execute to open the "Self-Diagnostics Result Display" to view details about 7832 errors. Use the keys in the display on the touch-panel to scroll through all the information. If no errors have occurred, you will see the "No Error" message on the screen. Total Memory Size 7836 Displays the memory capacity of the controller system. D129/D130 3-190 SM Appendix System SP Tables-7 DF Glass Dust Check Counts the number of occurrences (0 to 65,535) when dust was detected on 7852* the scanning glass of the ADF or resets the dust detection counter. Counting is done only if SP4-020-1 (Dust Check) is switched on. 002 7853 Dust Detection Clear Counter [0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step] [0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step] Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 001 Dust Detection Counter Replacement Counter PCD [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ] 001 Displays the replacement counter of the PCD (Drum and Development unit). Transfer [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ] 002 Displays the replacement counter of the transfer unit. Fuser [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ] 003 Displays the replacement counter of the fusing unit. Web [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 ] 004 Displays the replacement counter of the cleaning web. zero cross 7856* [0 to 255 / 60 / 1 ] Stores and displays the detected zero cross frequency of the main ac power supply from the wall socket. SM Appendix 3-191 D129/D130 System SP Tables-7 Assert Info. DFU 7901 These SP numbers display the results of the occurrence of the most recent SC code generated by the machine. 001* File Name Module name 002* Number of Lines Number of the lines where error occurred. 003* Location Value 7906 Prev Counter Page: PCD [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 001 Displays the counter (pages) of the previous PCD Page: Transfer [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 002 Displays the previous counter (pages) of the previous transfer unit. Page: Fuser [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 page] 003 Displays the previous counter (pages) of the previous fusing unit. Rotation: PCD [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 004 Displays the previous counter (rotations) of the previous PCD Rotation: Transfer [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 005 Displays the previous counter (rotations) of the previous transfer unit. Rotation: Fuser [0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm ] 006 Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous fusing unit. Rotation(%):PCD [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 mm] 007 Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous PCD D129/D130 3-192 SM Appendix System SP Tables-7 Rotation(%):Transfer [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 mm] 008 Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous transfer unit. Rotation(%):Fuser [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 mm] 009 Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous fusing unit. Rotation(%):Web [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %] 010 Displays the previous counter (rotations/PM %) of the previous cleaning 7950 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables web. Replacement Date PCD 001 Displays the replacement date of the PCD. Transfer 002 Displays the replacement date of the transfer unit. Fuser 003 Displays the replacement date of the fusing unit. Web 004 Displays the replacement date of the web unit. SM Appendix 3-193 D129/D130 System SP Tables-7 7951 Remaining Counter PCD(Page) [0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days] 001 Displays the remaining counter (pages) of the PCD. Transfer(Page) [0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days] 002 Displays the remaining counter (pages) of the transfer unit. Fuser(Page) [0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days] 003 Displays the remaining counter (pages) of the fusing unit. PCD(Rotation) [0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days] 005 Displays the remaining counter (rotations) of the PCD. Transfer(Rotation) [0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days] 006 Displays the remaining counter (rotations) of the transfer unit. Fuser(Rotation) [0 to 255 / 255 / 1 days] 007 Displays the remaining counter (rotations) of the fusing unit. PCD (%) [0 to 255 / 100 / 1 %] 009 Displays the remaining counter (%) of the PCD. Transfer (%) [0 to 255 / 100 / 1 %] 010 Displays the remaining counter (%) of the transfer unit. Fuser (%) [0 to 255 / 100 / 1 %] 011 Displays the remaining counter (%) of the fusing unit. Web (%) [0 to 255 / 100 / 1 %] 013 Displays the remaining counter (%) of the cleaning web. D129/D130 3-194 SM Appendix System SP Tables-7 PM Yield Setting 7952 Sets the each yield of the following. PCD(Page) [0 to 99999999/ 160000 / 1 sheet] 001 Sets the PM yield of the PCD (Pages). Transfer(Page) [0 to 9999999 / 160000 / 1 sheet] 002 Fuser(Page) [0 to 9999999 / 160000 / 1 sheet] 003 Sets the PM yield of the fusing unit (Pages). PCD(Rotation) 005 C2b: [0 to 999999999 / 71990000 / 1 mm] C2c: [0 to 999999999 / 75500000 / 1 mm] Sets the PM yield of the PCD (Rotations). Transfer(Rotation) 006 C2b: [0 to 999999999 / 62770000 / 1 mm] C2c: [0 to 999999999 / 65420000 / 1 mm] Sets the PM yield of the transfer unit (Rotations). Fuser(Rotation) 007 C2b: [0 to 999999999 / 54880000 / 1 mm] C2b: [0 to 999999999 / 55800000 / 1 mm] Sets the PM yield of the fusing unit (Rotations). Web (%) [0 to 255 / 92 / 1 %] 009 Sets the PM yield (%) of the web unit. Day Threshold: PCD [1 to 30 / 15 / 1 days] 021 Adjusts the threshold day for the near end for the PCD. Day Threshold: Transfer Unit [1 to 30 / 15 / 1 days] 022 Adjusts the threshold day for the near end for the transfer unit. Day Threshold: Fusing Unit [1 to 30 / 15 / 1 days] 023 Adjusts the threshold day for the near end for the fusing unit. SM Appendix 3-195 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Sets the PM yield of the transfer unit (Pages). System SP Tables-7 7953 Operation Env Log T<10 [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1 mm] 001 Displays the PCU rotation distance in the environment: T<10°C 10<=T<=17 [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1 mm] 002 Displays the PCU rotation distance in the environment: 10°C<=T<=17°C 17 More (2> "2 or more", 4> "4 or more" AddBook Address Book Apl Application B/W Black & White Bk Black C Cyan ColCr Color Create ColMode Color Mode D129/D130 3-198 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 Abbreviation What It Means Comb Combine Comp Compression Deliv Delivery Designated Application. The application (Copy, Fax, Scan, Print) used to store the job on the document server, for example. Dev Counter Development Count, no. of pages developed. Dup, Duplex Duplex, printing on both sides Emul Emulation FC Full Color FIN Post-print processing, i.e. finishing (punching, stapling, etc.) Full Bleed No Margins GenCopy Generation Copy Mode Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables DesApl Get Print Counter. For jobs 10 pages or less, this counter does GPC not count up. For jobs larger than 10 pages, this counter counts up by the number that is in excess of 10 (e.g., for an 11-page job, the counter counts up 11-10 =1) IFax ImgEdt Internet Fax Image Edit performed on the original with the copier GUI, e.g. border removal, adding stamps, page numbers, etc. K Black (YMCK) LS Local Storage. Refers to the document server. LSize Large (paper) Size Mag Magnification MC One color (monochrome) SM Appendix 3-199 D129/D130 System SP Tables-8 Abbreviation What It Means New Remote Service, which allows a service center to monitor NRS machines remotely. "NRS" is used overseas, "CSS" is used in Japan. Org Original for scanning OrgJam Original Jam Print Job Manager/Desk Top Editor: A pair of utilities that allows Palm 2 print jobs to be distributed evenly among the printers on the network, and allows files to moved around, combined, and converted to different formats. PC Personal Computer Pages. A page is the total scanned surface of the original. PGS Duplex pages count as two pages, and A3 simplex count as two pages if the A3/DLT counter SP is switched ON. PJob Print Jobs Ppr Paper PrtJam Printer (plotter) Jam PrtPGS Print Pages Red (Toner Remaining). Applies to the wide format model A2 R only. This machine is under development and currently not available. Rez Resolution SC Service Code (Error SC code displayed) Scn Scan Sim, Simplex Simplex, printing on 1 side. S-to-Email Scan-to-E-mail D129/D130 3-200 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 Abbreviation What It Means SMC report printed with SP5990. All of the Group 8counters are SMC Svr Server TonEnd Toner End TonSave Toner Save TXJob Send, Transmission YMC Yellow, Magenta, Cyan YMCK Yellow, Magenta, Cyan, BlacK Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables recorded in the SMC report. All of the Group 8 SPs are reset with SP5 801-1 Memory All Clear. 8001 8002 T:Total Jobs These SPs count the number of times each C:Total Jobs application is used to do a job. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8003 F:Total Jobs Note: The L: counter is the total number of times the 8004 P:Total Jobs other applications are used to send a job to the 8005 S:Total Jobs 8006 L:Total Jobs document server, plus the number of times a file already on the document server is used. These SPs reveal the number of times an application is used, not the number of pages processed. When an application is opened for image input or output, this counts as one job. Interrupted jobs (paper jams, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish. Only jobs executed by the customer are counted. Jobs executed by the customer engineer using the SP modes are not counted. When using secure printing (when a password is required to start the print job), the job is counted at the time when either "Delete Data" or "Specify Output" is specified. A job is counted as a fax job when the job is stored for sending. SM Appendix 3-201 D129/D130 System SP Tables-8 When a fax is received to fax memory, the F: counter increments but the L: counter does not (the document server is not used). A fax broadcast counts as one job for the F: counter (the fax destinations in the broadcast are not counted separately). A fax broadcast is counted only after all the faxes have been sent to their destinations. If one transmission generates an error, then the broadcast will not be counted until the transmission has been completed. A printed fax report counts as one job for the F: counter. The F: counter does not distinguish between fax sending or receiving. When a copy job on the document server is printed, SP8022 also increments, and when a print job stored on the document server is printed, SP8024 also increments. When an original is both copied and stored on the document server, the C: and L: counters both increment. When a print job is stored on the document server, only the L: counter increments. When the user presses the Document Server button to store the job on the document server, only the L: counter increments. When the user enters document server mode and prints data stored on the document server, only the L: counter increments. When an image received from Palm 2 is received and stored, the L: counter increments. When the customer prints a report (user code list, for example), the O: counter increments. However, for fax reports and reports executed from the fax application, the F: counter increments. 8011 T:Jobs/LS 8012 C:Jobs/LS 8013 F:Jobs/LS 8014 P:Jobs/LS 8015 S:Jobs/LS 8016 L:Jobs/LS 8017 O:Jobs/LS These SPs count the number of jobs stored to the document server by each application, to reveal how local storage is being used for input. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. When a scan job is sent to the document server, the S: counter increments. When you enter document server mode and then scan an original, the L: counter increments. When a print job is sent to the document server, the P: counter increments. When a network application sends data to the document server, the O: counter increments. D129/D130 3-202 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 When an image from Palm 2 is stored on the document server, the O: counter increments. When a fax is sent to the document server, the F: counter increments. 8021 T:Pjob/LS 8022 C:Pjob/LS These SPs reveal how files printed from the document 8023 F:Pjob/LS 8024 P:Pjob/LS 8025 S:Pjob/LS 8026 L:Pjob/LS 8027 O:Pjob/LS server were stored on the document server originally. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables panel. When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the C: counter increments. When an application like DeskTopBinder merges a copy job that was stored on the document server with a print job that was stored on the document server, the C: and P: counters both increment. When a job already on the document server is printed with another application, the L: counter increments. When a scanner job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the S: counter increments. If the original was scanned from within document server mode, then the L: counter increments. When images stored on the document server by a network application (including Palm 2), are printed with another application, the O: counter increments. When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with a network application (Web Image Monitor, for example), the C: counter increments. When a fax on the document server is printed, the F: counter increments. SM Appendix 3-203 D129/D130 System SP Tables-8 8031 T:Pjob/DesApl 8032 C:Pjob/DesApl These SPs reveal what applications were used to 8033 F:Pjob/DesApl 8034 P:Pjob/DesApl 8035 S:Pjob/DesApl 8036 L:Pjob/DesApl 8037 O:Pjob/DesApl output documents from the document server. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of jobs printed from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. When documents already stored on the document server are printed, the count for the application that started the print job is incremented. When the print job is started from a network application (Desk Top Binder, Web Image Monitor, etc.) the L: counter increments. 8041 T:TX Jobs/LS These SPs count the applications that stored files on 8042 C:TX Jobs/LS 8043 F:TX Jobs/LS 8044 P:TX Jobs/LS 8045 S:TX Jobs/LS 8046 L:TX Jobs/LS 8047 O:TX Jobs/LS the document server that were later accessed for transmission over the telephone line or over a network (attached to an e-mail, or as a fax image by I-Fax). [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] Note: Jobs merged for sending are counted separately. The L: counter counts the number of jobs scanned from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. When a stored copy job is sent from the document server, the C: counter increments. When images stored on the document server by a network application or Palm2 are sent as an e-mail, the O: counter increments. D129/D130 3-204 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 8051 T:TX Jobs/DesApl These SPs count the applications used to send C:TX Jobs/DesApl 8053 F:TX Jobs/DesApl 8054 P:TX Jobs/DesApl 8055 S:TX Jobs/DesApl 8056 L:TX Jobs/DesApl 8057 O:TX Jobs/DesApl files from the document server over the telephone line or over a network (attached to an e-mail, or as a fax image by I-Fax). Jobs merged for sending are counted separately. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of jobs sent from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. If the send is started from Desk Top Binder or Web Image Monitor, for example, then the O: counter increments. T:FIN Jobs 8061 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs total the finishing methods. The finishing method is specified by the application. C:FIN Jobs 8062 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs total finishing methods for copy jobs only. The finishing method is specified by the application. F:FIN Jobs 8063 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs total finishing methods for fax jobs only. The finishing method is specified by the application. Note: Finishing features for fax jobs are not available at this time. P:FIN Jobs 8064 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs total finishing methods for print jobs only. The finishing method is specified by the application. S:FIN Jobs 8065 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs total finishing methods for scan jobs only. The finishing method is specified by the application. Note: Finishing features for scan jobs are not available at this time. SM Appendix 3-205 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 8052 System SP Tables-8 L:FIN Jobs 8066 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs total finishing methods for jobs output from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. The finishing method is specified from the print window within document server mode. O:FIN Jobs 8067 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs total finishing methods for jobs executed by an external application, over the network. The finishing method is specified by the application. Number of jobs started in Sort mode. When a stored 806x 1 Sort copy job is set for Sort and then stored on the document server, the L: counter increments. (See SP8066 1) 806x 2 Stack Number of jobs started out of Sort mode. 806x 3 Staple Number of jobs started in Staple mode. Number of jobs started in Booklet mode. If the 806x 4 Booklet machine is in staple mode, the Staple counter also increments. 806x 5 Z-Fold Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set for folding (Z-fold). Number of jobs started in Punch mode. When Punch 806x 6 Punch is set for a print job, the P: counter increments. (See SP8064 6.) 806x 7 Other 806x 8 Inside-Fold 806x 9 Three-IN-Fold Reserved. Not used Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set for folding (Inside-fold). Letter Fold-in Not Used 806x 10 Three-OUT-Fold Letter Fold-out Not Used 806x 11 Four-Fold Double Parallel Fold Not Used 806x 12 KANNON-Fold Gate Fold Not Used D129/D130 3-206 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 806x 13 Perfect-Bind Perfect Binder Not Used 806x 14 Ring-Bind Ring Binder Not Used T:Jobs/PGS 8071 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of jobs broken down by the number of pages in the job, regardless of which application was used. 8072 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count and calculate the number of copy jobs by size based on the number of pages in the job. F:Jobs/PGS 8073 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count and calculate the number of fax jobs by size based on the number of pages in the job. P:Jobs/PGS 8074 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count and calculate the number of print jobs by size based on the number of pages in the job. S:Jobs/PGS 8075 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count and calculate the number of scan jobs by size based on the number of pages in the job. L:Jobs/PGS 8076 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count and calculate the number of jobs printed from within the document server mode window at the operation panel, by the number of pages in the job. O:Jobs/PGS 8077 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count and calculate the number of "Other" application jobs (Web Image Monitor, Palm 2, etc.) by size based on the number of pages in the job. 807x 1 1 Page 807x 8 21 to 50 Pages 807x 2 2 Pages 807x 9 51 to 100 Pages SM Appendix 3-207 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables C:Jobs/PGS System SP Tables-8 807x 3 3 Pages 807x 10 101 to 300 Pages 807x 4 4 Pages 807x 11 301 to 500 Pages 807x 5 5 Pages 807x 12 501 to 700 Pages 807x 6 6 to 10 Pages 807x 13 701 to 1000 Pages 807x 7 11 to 20 Pages 807x 14 1001 to Pages For example: When a copy job stored on the document server is printed in document server mode, the appropriate L: counter (SP8076 0xx) increments. Printing a fax report counts as a job and increments the F: counter (SP 8073). Interrupted jobs (paper jam, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish. If a job is paused and re-started, it counts as one job. If the finisher runs out of staples during a print and staple job, then the job is counted at the time the error occurs. For copy jobs (SP 8072) and scan jobs (SP 8075), the total is calculated by multiplying the number of sets of copies by the number of pages scanned. (One duplex page counts as 2.) The first test print and subsequent test prints to adjust settings are added to the number of pages of the copy job (SP 8072). When printing the first page of a job from within the document server screen, the page is counted. T:FAX TX Jobs [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by 8111 fax, either directly or using a file stored on the document server, on a telephone line. Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time. 001 B/W Black TX F:FAX TX Jobs [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by 8113 fax directly on a telephone line. Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time. 001 B/W D129/D130 Black TX 3-208 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 These counters count jobs, not pages. This SP counts fax jobs sent over a telephone line with a fax application, including documents stored on the document server. If the mode is changed during the job, the job will count with the mode set when the job started. If the same document is faxed to both a public fax line and an I-Fax at a destination where both are available, then this counter increments, and the I-Fax counter (812x) also increments. The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent. T:IFAX TX Jobs [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent, 8121 either directly or using a file stored on the document server, as fax images using I-Fax. Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time. 001 B/W Black TX F:IFAX TX Jobs [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent (not 8123 stored on the document server), as fax images using I-Fax. Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time. 001 B/W Black TX These counters count jobs, not pages. The counters for color are provided for future use; the color fax feature is not available at this time. The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent. SM Appendix 3-209 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables System SP Tables-8 T:S-to-Email Jobs 8131 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of jobs scanned and attached to an e-mail, regardless of whether the document server was used or not. 001 B/W Black TX 002 Color Color TX 003 ACS Color TX S:S-to-Email Jobs 8135 These SPs count the number of jobs scanned and attached to an e-mail, without storing the original on the document server. 001 B/W Black TX 002 Color Color TX 003 ACS Color TX These counters count jobs, not pages. If the job is stored on the document server, after the job is stored it is determined to be color or black-and-white then counted. If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is waiting to be sent, the job is not counted. If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled. If several jobs are combined for sending to the Scan Router, Scan-to-Email, or Scan-to-PC, or if one job is sent to more than one destination. each send is counted separately. For example, if the same document is sent by Scan-to-Email as well as Scan-to-PC, then it is counted twice (once for Scan-to-Email and once for Scan-to-PC). D129/D130 3-210 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 T:Deliv Jobs/Svr 8141 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of jobs scanned and sent to a Scan 001 B/W Black Deliv 002 Color Color Deliv 003 ACS Color Deliv S:Deliv Jobs/Svr 8145 These SPs count the number of jobs scanned and sent to a Scan Router server. 001 B/W Black Deliv 002 Color Color Deliv 003 ACS Color Deliv These counters count jobs, not pages. The jobs are counted even though the arrival and reception of the jobs at the Scan Router server cannot be confirmed. If even one color image is mixed with black-and-white images, then the job is counted as a "Color" job. If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is waiting to be delivered, the job is not counted. If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled. Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job. SM Appendix 3-211 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Router server. System SP Tables-8 T:Deliv Jobs/PC [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of jobs scanned and sent to a folder on a 8151 PC (Scan-to-PC). Note: At the present time, 8151 and 8155 perform identical counts. 001 B/W Black Deliv 002 Color Color Deliv 003 ACS Color Deliv S:Deliv Jobs/PC 8155 These SPs count the total number of jobs scanned and sent with Scan-to-PC. 001 B/W Black Deliv 002 Color Color Deliv 003 ACS Color Deliv These counters count jobs, not pages. If the job is cancelled during scanning, it is not counted. If the job is cancelled while it is waiting to be sent, the job is not counted. If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled. Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job. 8161 T:PCFAX TX Jobs These SPs count the number of PC Fax transmission jobs. A job is counted from when it is registered for sending, not when it is sent. 8163 F:PCFAX TX Jobs [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] Note: At the present time, these counters perform identical counts. This counts fax jobs started from a PC using a PC fax application, and sending the data out to the destination from the PC through the copier. D129/D130 3-212 SM Appendix 8171 T:Deliv Jobs/WSD These SPs count the pages scanned by WSD. 8175 S:Deliv Jobs/WSD [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 001 B/W Black Deliv 002 Color Color Deliv 003 ACS Color Deliv 8181 T:Scan to Media Jobs These SPs count the pages scanned to media by the scanner application. 8185 S:Scan to Media Jobs 001 B/W Black Deliv 002 Color Color Deliv 003 ACS Color Deliv 8191 T:Total Scan PGS 8192 C:Total Scan PGS 8193 F:Total Scan PGS 8195 S:Total Scan PGS 8196 L:Total Scan PGS [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the pages scanned by each application that uses the scanner to scan images. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] SP 8191 to 8196 count the number of scanned sides of pages, not the number of physical pages. These counters do not count reading user stamp data, or reading color charts to adjust color. Previews done with a scanner driver are not counted. A count is done only after all images of a job have been scanned. Scans made in SP mode are not counted. Examples If 3 B5 pages and 1 A3 page are scanned with the scanner application but not stored, the S: count is 4. If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server using the Store SM Appendix 3-213 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables System SP Tables-8 System SP Tables-8 File button in the Copy mode window, the C: count is 6 and the L: count is 6. If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied but not stored, the C: count is 6. If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6. 8201 T:LSize Scan PGS [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8203 F Lsize Scan PGS [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] S:LSize Scan PGS [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SP codes count the total number of large pages input with the 8205 scanner for scan jobs only. Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission are not counted. Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.. 8211 T:Scan PGS/LS 8212 C:Scan PGS/LS 8213 F:Scan PGS/LS 8215 S:Scan PGS/LS 8216 L:Scan PGS/LS These SPs count the number of pages scanned into the document server . [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen Reading user stamp data is not counted. If a job is cancelled, the pages output as far as the cancellation are counted. If the scanner application scans and stores 3 B5 sheets and 1 A4 sheet, the S: count is 4. If pages are copied but not stored on the document server, these counters do not change. If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server, the C: count is 6 and the L: count is 6. If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6. D129/D130 3-214 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 ADF Org Feeds 8221 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of pages fed through the ADF for front and back side scanning. Number of front sides fed for scanning: With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Front side count is the same as the number of pages fed for either simplex or duplex scanning. With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Front side count is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex front side scanning. (The front side is determined by which side the user loads face up.) Number of rear sides fed for scanning: With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex 002 Back scanning. With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex rear-side scanning. When 1 sheet is fed for duplex scanning the Front count is 1 and the Back count is 1. If a jam occurs during the job, recovery processing is not counted to avoid double counting. Also, the pages are not counted if the jam occurs before the first sheet is output. SM Appendix 3-215 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 001 Front System SP Tables-8 Scan PGS/Mode 8231 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each ADF mode to determine the work load on the ADF. 001 Large Volume 002 SADF 003 Mixed Size 004 Custom Size 005 Platen 006 Mixed 1side/2side Selectable. Large copy jobs that cannot be loaded in the ADF at one time. Selectable. Feeding pages one by one through the ADF. Selectable. Select "Mixed Sizes" on the operation panel. Selectable. Originals of non-standard size. Book mode. Raising the ADF and placing the original directly on the platen. Selectable. Select "Simplex/Duplex" on the operation panel. If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode, the count is done for the last selected mode. The user cannot select mixed sizes or non-standard sizes with the fax application so if the original's page sizes are mixed or non-standard, these are not counted. If the user selects "Mixed Sizes" for copying in the platen mode, the Mixed Size count is enabled. In the SADF mode if the user copies 1 page in platen mode and then copies 2 pages with SADF, the Platen count is 1 and the SADF count is 3. D129/D130 3-216 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 T:Scan PGS/Org 8241 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of scanned pages by original type for all jobs, regardless of which application was used. C:Scan PGS/Org 8242 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Copy jobs. 8243 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables F:Scan PGS/Org These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Fax jobs. S:Scan PGS/Org 8245 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Scan jobs. L:Scan PGS/Org 8246 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of pages scanned and stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen 8241 8242 8243 8245 8246 824x 1: Text Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 824x 2: Text/Photo Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 824x 3: Photo Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 824x 4: GenCopy, Pale Yes Yes No Yes Yes 824x 5: Map Yes Yes No No Yes 824x 6: Normal/Detail Yes No Yes No No 824x 7: Fine/Super Fine Yes No Yes No No 824x 8: Binary Yes No No Yes No 824x 9: Grayscale Yes No No Yes No SM Appendix 3-217 D129/D130 System SP Tables-8 824x 10: Color Yes No No Yes No 824x 11: Other Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode, the count is done for the last selected mode. 8251 T:Scan PGS/ImgEdt 8252 C:Scan PGS/ImgEdt 8255 S:Scan PGS/ImgEdt 8256 L:Scan PGS/ImgEdt These SPs show how many times Image Edit features have been selected at the operation panel for each application. Some examples of these editing features are: Erase> Border Erase> Center Image Repeat Centering Positive/Negative 8257 O:Scan PGS/ImgEdt [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] Note: The count totals the number of times the edit features have been used. A detailed breakdown of exactly which features have been used is not given. The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen. D129/D130 3-218 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 8281 T:Scan PGS/TWAIN These SPs count the number of pages scanned using a TWAIN driver. These counters reveal how the TWAIN driver is used for delivery functions. 8285 S:Scan PGS/TWAIN [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] Note: At the present time, these counters perform identical counts. T:Scan PGS/Stamp 8293 F:Scan PGS/Stamp These SPs count the number of pages stamped with the stamp in the ADF unit. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of pages stored 8295 S:Scan PGS/Stamp from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen T:Scan PGS/Size 8301 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by all applications. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output (printing) page size [SP 8-441]. C:Scan PGS/Size 8302 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Copy application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output (printing) page size [SP 8-442]. F:Scan PGS/Size 8303 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Fax application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP 8-443]. S:Scan PGS/Size 8305 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Scan application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP 8-445]. SM Appendix 3-219 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 8291 System SP Tables-8 L:Scan PGS/Size [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned and stored 8306 from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP 8-446]. 830x 1 A3 830x 2 A4 830x 3 A5 830x 4 B4 830x 5 B5 830x 6 DLT 830x 7 LG 830x 8 LT 830x 9 HLT 830x 10 Full Bleed 830x 254 Other (Standard) 830x 255 Other (Custom) D129/D130 3-220 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 T:Scan PGS/Rez 8311 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by applications that can specify resolution settings. S:Scan PGS/Rez 8315 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by applications that can specify resolution settings. 831x 1 1200dpi to 831x 2 600dpito1199dpi 831x 3 400dpito599dpi 831x 4 200dpito399dpi 831x 5 to199dpi Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Note: At the present time, 8311 and 8315 perform identical counts. Copy resolution settings are fixed so they are not counted. The Fax application does not allow finely-adjusted resolution settings so no count is done for the Fax application. 8381 T:Total PrtPGS These SPs count the number of pages printed by 8382 C:Total PrtPGS 8383 F:Total PrtPGS 8384 P:Total PrtPGS 8385 S:Total PrtPGS 8386 L:Total PrtPGS 8387 O:Total PrtPGS the customer. The counter for the application used for storing the pages increments. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. Pages stored with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen go to the C: counter. When the A3/DLT double count function is switched on with SP5104, 1 A3/DLT page is counted as 2. When several documents are merged for a print job, the number of pages stored are counted for the application that stored them. SM Appendix 3-221 D129/D130 System SP Tables-8 These counters are used primarily to calculate charges on use of the machine, so the following pages are not counted as printed pages: Blank pages in a duplex printing job. Blank pages inserted as document covers, chapter title sheets, and slip sheets. Reports printed to confirm counts. All reports done in the service mode (service summaries, engine maintenance reports, etc.) Test prints for machine image adjustment. Error notification reports. Partially printed pages as the result of a copier jam. LSize PrtPGS 8391 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count pages printed on paper sizes A3/DLT and larger. Note: In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine. 8401 T:PrtPGS/LS 8402 C:PrtPGS/LS 8403 F:PrtPGS/LS 8404 P:PrtPGS/LS within the document server mode screen at the 8405 S:PrtPGS/LS operation panel. These SPs count the number of pages printed from the document server. The counter for the application used to print the pages is incremented. The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8406 L:PrtPGS/LS Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the L: count. Fax jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the F: count. D129/D130 3-222 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 This SP counts the amount of paper (front/back 8411 Prints/Duplex counted as 1 page) used for duplex printing. Last pages printed only on one side are not counted. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] T:PrtPGS/Dup Comb 8421 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of C:PrtPGS/Dup Comb 8422 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by the copier application. F:PrtPGS/Dup Comb 8423 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by the fax application. P:PrtPGS/Dup Comb 8424 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by the printer application. S:PrtPGS/Dup Comb 8425 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by the scanner application. L:PrtPGS/Dup Comb 8426 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing from within the document server mode window at the operation panel. O:PrtPGS/Dup Comb 8427 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by Other applications SM Appendix 3-223 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables pages processed for printing. This is the total for all applications. System SP Tables-8 842x 1 Simplex> Duplex 842x 2 Duplex> Duplex 842x 3 Book> Duplex 842x 4 Simplex Combine 842x 5 Duplex Combine 842x 6 2in1 2 pages on 1 side (2-Up) 842x 7 4in1 4 pages on 1 side (4-Up) 842x 8 6in1 6 pages on 1 side (6-Up) 842x 9 8in1 8pages on 1 side (8-Up) 842x 10 9in1 9 pages on 1 side (9-Up) 842x 11 16in1 16 pages on 1 side (16-Up) 842x 12 Booklet 842x 13 Magazine 842x 14 2in1 + Booklet 842x 15 4in1 + Booklet 842x 16 6in1 + Booklet 842x 17 8in1 + Booklet 842x 18 9in1 + Booklet 842x 19 2in1 + Magazine 842x 20 4in1 + Magazine 842x 21 6in1 + Magazine 842x 22 8in1 + Magazine 842x 23 9in1 + Magazine 842x 24 16in1 + Magazine D129/D130 3-224 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 These counts (SP8421 to SP8427) are especially useful for customers who need to improve their compliance with ISO standards for the reduction of paper consumption. Pages that are only partially printed with the n-Up functions are counted as 1 page. Here is a summary of how the counters work for Booklet and Magazine modes: Magazine Original Pages Count Original Pages Count 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 3 2 3 2 4 2 4 2 5 3 5 4 6 4 6 4 7 4 7 4 8 4 8 4 T:PrtPGS/ImgEdt 8431 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Booklet [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below, regardless of which application was used. C:PrtPGS/ImgEdt 8432 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with the copy application. P:PrtPGS/ImgEdt 8434 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with the print application. L:PrtPGS/ImgEdt 8436 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of pages output from within the document server mode window at the operation panel with the three features below. SM Appendix 3-225 D129/D130 System SP Tables-8 O:PrtPGS/ImgEdt 8437 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with Other applications. 843x 1 Cover/Slip Sheet 843x 2 Series/Book Total number of covers or slip sheets inserted. The count for a cover printed on both sides counts 2. The number of pages printed in series (one side) or printed as a book with booklet right/left pagination. The number of pages printed where stamps were 843x 3 User Stamp applied, including page numbering and date stamping. T:PrtPGS/Ppr Size 8441 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by all applications. C:PrtPGS/Ppr Size 8442 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the copy application. F:PrtPGS/Ppr Size 8443 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the fax application. P:PrtPGS/Ppr Size 8444 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the printer application. S:PrtPGS/Ppr Size 8445 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the scanner application. L:PrtPGS/Ppr Size 8446 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed from within the document server mode window at the operation panel. D129/D130 3-226 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 O:PrtPGS/Ppr Size 8447 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by Other 844x 1 A3 844x 2 A4 844x 3 A5 844x 4 B4 844x 5 B5 844x 6 DLT 844x 7 LG 844x 8 LT 844x 9 HLT 844x 10 Full Bleed 844x 254 Other (Standard) 844x 255 Other (Custom) Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables applications. These counters do not distinguish between LEF and SEF. SM Appendix 3-227 D129/D130 System SP Tables-8 PrtPGS/Ppr Tray [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8451 These SPs count the number of sheets fed from each paper feed station. 001 Bypass Tray Bypass Tray 002 Tray 1 Copier 003 Tray 2 Copier 004 Tray 3 Paper Tray Unit (Option) 005 Tray 4 Paper Tray Unit (Option) 006 Tray 5 LCT (Option) 007 Tray 6 Currently not used. 008 Tray 7 Currently not used. 009 Tray 8 Currently not used. 010 Tray 9 Currently not used. 011 Tray 10 Currently not used. 012 Tray 11 Currently not used. 013 Tray 12 Currently not used. 014 Tray 13 Currently not used. 015 Tray 14 Currently not used. 016 Tray 15 Currently not used. D129/D130 3-228 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 T:PrtPGS/Ppr Type [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by all applications. These counters are not the same as the PM counter. The PM counter is 8461 based on feed timing to accurately measure the service life of the feed rollers. However, these counts are based on output timing. Blank sheets (covers, chapter covers, slip sheets) are also counted. During duplex printing, pages printed on both sides count as 1, and a page C:PrtPGS/Ppr Type 8462 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables printed on one side counts as 1. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the copy application. F:PrtPGS/Ppr Type 8463 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the fax application. P:PrtPGS/Ppr Type 8464 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the printer application. L:PrtPGS/Ppr Type 8466 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed from within the document server mode window at the operation panel. 846x 1 Normal 846x 2 Recycled 846x 3 Special 846x 4 Thick 846x 5 Normal (Back) 846x 6 Thick (Back) 846x 7 OHP SM Appendix 3-229 D129/D130 System SP Tables-8 846x 8 Other PrtPGS/Mag [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8471 These SPs count by magnification rate the number of pages printed. 001 to 49% 002 50% to 99% 003 100% 004 101% to 200% 005 201% to Counts are done for magnification adjusted for pages, not only on the operation panel but performed remotely with an external network application capable of performing magnification adjustment as well. Magnification adjustments done with printer drivers with PC applications such as Excel are also counted. Magnification adjustments done for adjustments after they have been stored on the document server are not counted. Magnification adjustments performed automatically during Auto Reduce/Enlarge copying are counted. The magnification rates of blank cover sheets, slip sheets, etc. are automatically assigned a rate of 100%. 8481 T:PrtPGS/TonSave 8484 P:PrtPGS/TonSave These SPs count the number of pages printed with the Toner Save feature switched on. Note: These SPs return the same results as this SP is limited to the Print application. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] D129/D130 3-230 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 T:PrtPGS/Emul 8511 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages printed. P:PrtPGS/Emul 8514 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages printed. 002 RPDL Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 001 RPCS Japan Only 003 PS3 004 R98 005 R16 006 GL/GL2 Japan Only 007 R55 008 RTIFF 009 PDF 010 PCL5e/5c 011 PCL XL 012 IPDL-C 013 BM-Links Japan Only 014 Other 015 IPDS SP8511 and SP8514 return the same results as they are both limited to the Print application. Print jobs output to the document server are not counted. SM Appendix 3-231 D129/D130 System SP Tables-8 T:PrtPGS/FIN 8521 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by all applications. C:PrtPGS/FIN 8522 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Copy application. F:PrtPGS/FIN [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the 8523 Fax application. Note: Print finishing options for received faxes are currently not available. P:PrtPGS/FIN 8524 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Print application. S:PrtPGS/FIN 8525 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Scanner application. L:PrtPGS/FIN 8526 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed from within the document server mode window at the operation panel. 852x 1 Sort 852x 2 Stack 852x 3 Staple 852x 4 Booklet 852x 5 Z-Fold 852x 6 Punch 852x 7 Other D129/D130 3-232 SM Appendix 852x 8 Inside-Fold 852x 9 Three-IN-Fold 852x 10 Three-OUT-Fold 852x 11 Four-Fold 852x 12 KANNON-Fold 852x 13 Perfect-Bind 852x 14 Ring-Bind If stapling is selected for finishing and the stack is too large for stapling, the unstapled pages are still counted. The counts for staple finishing are based on output to the staple tray, so jam recoveries are counted. This SP counts the amount of staples used by the 8531 Staples machine. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8551 T:PrtBooks/FIN 8552 C:PrtBooks/FIN 8554 P:PrtBooks/FIN 8556 L:PrtBooks/FIN 001 Perfect-Bind Not Used 002 Ring-Bind Not Used SM Appendix 3-233 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables System SP Tables-8 System SP Tables-8 8561 T:A Sheet Of Paper [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8562 C:A Sheet Of Paper [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8563 F:A Sheet Of Paper [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8564 P:A Sheet Of Paper [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8566 L:A Sheet Of Paper [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] O:A Sheet Of Paper [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8567 These SPs count the totals number of duplex pages printed. 001 Total: Over A3/DLT 002 Total: Under A3/DLT 003 Duplex: Over A3/DLT 004 Duplex: Under A3/DLT T: Counter [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the total output broken down by color output, regardless of the application used. In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, 8581 these counters are also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine. Note: This SP is expanded for color MFP and color LP machines. For this machine, the count is done for black only. O: Counter [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the totals for A3/DLT paper use, number of duplex pages 8591 printed, and the number of staples used. These totals are for Other (O:) applications only. 001 A3/DLT 002 Duplex D129/D130 3-234 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 T:Coverage Counter 8601 These SPs count the total coverage for each color and printout pages. 001 B/W [0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1] 011 B/W Printing Pages [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] C:Coverage Counter [0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1] 8602 F:Coverage Counter Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables These SPs count the total coverage for B/W. [0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1] 8603 These SPs count the total coverage for B/W. P:Coverage Counter [0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1] 8604 These SPs count the total coverage for B/W. L:Coverage Counter [0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1] 8606 These SPs count the total coverage for B/W. SDK Apli Counter [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8617 These SPs count the total printout pages for each SDK applicaion. 001 SDK-1 002 SDK-2 003 SDK-3 004 SDK-4 005 SDK-5 006 SDK-6 SM Appendix 3-235 D129/D130 System SP Tables-8 8621 Func Use Counter - 001 to 064 Function-001 to Function-064 T:FAX TX PGS 8631 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number. 001 B/W Black TX F:FAX TX PGS 8633 [0 to 999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number. 001 B/W Black TX If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/W or Color. At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8631 and SP8633 are the same. The counts include error pages. If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is done for each destination. Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not. Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each destination. D129/D130 3-236 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 T:FAX TX PGS 8641 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to as fax images using I-Fax. 001 B/W Black TX F:FAX TX PGS 8643 [0 o 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by Fax as fax 001 B/W Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables images using I-Fax. Black TX If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/W or Color. At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8641 and SP8643 are the same. The counts include error pages. If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is done for each destination. Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not. Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each destination. SM Appendix 3-237 D129/D130 System SP Tables-8 T:S-to-Email PGS 8651 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an e-mail for both the Scan and document server applications. 001 B/W 002 Color S:S-to-Email PGS 8655 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an e-mail for the Scan application only. 001 B/W 002 Color The count for B/W and Color pages is done after the document is stored on the HDD. If the job is cancelled before it is stored, the pages are not counted. If Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to 5 addresses, the count is 10 (the pages are sent to the same SMTP server together). If Scan-to-PC is used to send a 10-page document to 5 folders, the count is 50 (the document is sent to each destination of the SMB/FTP server). Due to restrictions on some devices, if Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to a large number of destinations, the count may be divided and counted separately. For example, if a 10-page document is sent to 200 addresses, the count is 10 for the first 100 destinations and the count is also 10 for the second 100 destinations, for a total of 20). D129/D130 3-238 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 T:Deliv PGS/Svr 8661 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan Router server by both Scan and LS applications. 001 B/W 002 Color 8665 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan Router server by the Scan application. 001 B/W 002 Color The B/W and Color counts are done after the document is stored on the HDD of the Scan Router server. If the job is canceled before storage on the Scan Router server finishes, the counts are not done. The count is executed even if regardless of confirmation of the arrival at the Scan Router server. SM Appendix 3-239 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables S:Deliv PGS/Svr System SP Tables-8 T: Deliv PGS/PC 8671 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a folder on a PC (Scan-to-PC) with the Scan and LS applications. 001 B/W 002 Color S: Deliv PGS/PC 8675 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent with Scan-to-PC with the Scan application. 001 B/W 002 Color 8681 T:PCFAX TXPGS These SPs count the number of pages sent by PC Fax. These SPs are provided for the Fax application only, so the counts for SP8681 and SP8683 are the 8683 F:PCFAX TXPGS same. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] This counts pages sent from a PC using a PC fax application, from the PC through the copier to the destination. When sending the same message to more than one place using broadcasting, the pages are only counted once. (For example, a 10-page fax is sent to location A and location B. The counter goes up by 10, not 20.) D129/D130 3-240 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 8691 T:TX PGS/LS 8692 C:TX PGS/LS 8693 F:TX PGS/LS [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8694 P:TX PGS/LS The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from These SPs count the number of pages sent from the document server. The counter for the application that was used to store the pages is incremented. within the document server mode screen at the S:TX PGS/LS 8696 L:TX PGS/LS operation panel. Pages stored with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen go to the C: counter. Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the count. If several documents are merged for sending, the number of pages stored are counted for the application that stored them. When several documents are sent by a Fax broadcast, the F: count is done for the number of pages sent to each destination. TX PGS/Port [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of pages sent by the physical port used to 8701 send them. For example, if a 3-page original is sent to 4 destinations via ISDN G4, the count for ISDN (G3, G4) is 12. 001 PSTN-1 002 PSTN-2 003 PSTN-3 004 ISDN (G3,G4) 005 Network SM Appendix 3-241 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 8695 System SP Tables-8 T:Scan PGS/Comp 8711 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of compressed pages scanned into the document server, counted by the formats listed below. 001 JPEG/JPEG2000 002 TIFF (Multi/Single) 003 PDF 004 Other 005 PDF/Comp 006 PDF/A S:Scan PGS/Comp 8715 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of compressed pages scanned by the scan application, counted by the formats listed below. 001 JPEG/JPEG2000 002 TIFF (Multi/Single) 003 PDF 004 Other 005 PDF/Comp 006 PDF/A D129/D130 3-242 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 8721 T:Deliv PGS/WSD [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] S:Deliv PGS/WSD [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8725 These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each scanner mode. 001 B/W 8731 8735 T:Scan PGS/Media [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] S:Scan PGS/Media [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 002 Color These SPs count the number of pages scanned and saved in a meia by each scanner mode. 001 B/W 002 Color RX PGS/Port 8741 [0to9999999/ 0 / 1] These SPs count the number of pages received by the physical port used to receive them. 001 PSTN-1 002 PSTN-2 003 PSTN-3 004 ISDN (G3,G4) 005 Network SM Appendix 3-243 D129/D130 System SP Tables-8 Dev Counter [0to9999999/ 0 / 1] These SPs count the frequency of use (number of rotations of the 8771 development rollers) for black and other color toners. Note: For machines that do not support color, the Black toner count is the same as the Total count. Toner_Botol_Info. 8781 This SP displays the number of toner bottles used. The count is done based on the equivalent of 1,000 pages per bottle. This SP displays the percent of space 8791 LS Memory Remain available on the document server for storing documents. [0 to 100 / 0 / 1] Toner Remain [0 to 100 / 0 / 1] This SP displays the percent of toner remaining for each color. This SP allows the user to check the toner supply at any time. Note: 8801 This precise method of measuring remaining toner supply (1% steps) is better than other machines in the market that can only measure in increments of 10 (10% steps). This SP is expanded for color MFP and color LP machines. For this machine, the count is done for black only. D129/D130 3-244 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 8811 Eco Counter Eco Total [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 001 Displays the number of pages reduced by using the duplex and the combine function. Duplex [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 004 Displays the number of pages reduced by using the duplex function. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Combine 005 Displays the number of pages reduced by using the combine function. Duplex(%) [0 to 100 / 0 / 1] 008 Displays the utilization ratio of the duplex function. Combine(%) [0 to 100 / 0 / 1] 009 Displays the utilization ratio of the duplex function. Paper Cut(%) [0 to 100 / 0 / 1] 010 Displays the paper reduction ratio. Eco Totalr:Last [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1] Duplex:Last [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1] Combine:Last [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1] Duplex(%):Last [0 to 100 / 0 / 1] 101 104 105 108 SM Appendix 3-245 D129/D130 System SP Tables-8 Combine(%):Last [0 to 100 / 0 / 1] Paper Cut(%):Last [0 to 100 / 0 / 1] 109 110 Cvr Cnt:0-10% 8851 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the percentage of dot coverage for black other color toners. 011 0 to 2%: BK 021 3 to 4%: BK 031 5 to 7%: BK 041 8 to 10%: BK Cvr Cnt:11-20% 8861 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the percentage of dot coverage for black other color toners. 001 BK Black toner Cvr Cnt:21-30% 8871 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the percentage of dot coverage for black other color toners. 001 BK D129/D130 Black toner 3-246 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 Cvr Cnt:31%8881 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the percentage of dot coverage for black other color toners. 001 BK Black toner Page/Toner Bottle [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8891 001 BK Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables These SPs display the amount of the remaining current toner. Black toner Page/Toner_Prev1 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8901 These SPs display the amount of the remaining previous toner. 001 BK Black toner Page/Toner_Prev2 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8911 These SPs display the amount of the remaining 2nd previous toner. 001 BK Black toner Cvr Cnt/Total [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8921 Displays the total coverage and total printout number for each color. 001 Coverage (%) BK 011 Coverage/P:BK SM Appendix 3-247 D129/D130 System SP Tables-8 Machine Status [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] These SPs count the amount of time the machine spends in each operation 8941 mode. These SPs are useful for customers who need to investigate machine operation for improvement in their compliance with ISO Standards. Engine operation time. Does not include time while 001 Operation Time controller is saving data to HDD (while engine is not operating). Engine not operating. Includes time while controller 002 Standby Time saves data to HDD. Does not include time spent in Energy Save, Low Power, or Off modes. 003 Energy Save Time Includes time while the machine is performing background printing. Includes time in Energy Save mode with Engine on. 004 Low Power Time Includes time while machine is performing background printing. Includes time while machine is performing 005 Off Mode Time background printing. Does not include time machine remains powered off with the power switches. 006 SC Total down time due to SC errors. 007 PrtJam Total down time due to paper jams during printing. 008 OrgJam 009 Supply PM Unit End D129/D130 Total down time due to original jams during scanning. Total down time due to supply unit end. 3-248 SM Appendix System SP Tables-8 AddBook Register 8951 These SPs count the number of events when the machine manages data registration. User Code /User ID User code registrations. 002 Mail Address Mail address registrations. 003 Fax Destination Fax destination registrations. 004 Group 005 Transfer Request 006 F-Code Group destination [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] registrations. Fax relay destination registrations for relay TX. F-Code box registrations. Copy application 007 Copy Program registrations with the Program (job settings) feature. Fax application registrations 008 Fax Program with the Program (job settings) feature. Printer application 009 Printer Program [0 to 255 / 0 / 255] registrations with the Program (job settings) feature. Scanner application 010 Scanner Program registrations with the Program (job settings) feature. SM Appendix 3-249 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 001 System SP Tables-8 Adomin. Counter List [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1] 8999 Display the total coverage and total printout number for each color. 001 Total 003 Copy: BW 007 Printer: BW 010 Fax Print: BW 012 A3/DLT 013 Duplex 023 Copy: BW (%) 027 Printer: BW (%) 030 Fax Print: BW (%) 101 Transmission Total: Color 102 Transmission Total: BW 103 Fax Transmission 104 Scanner Transmission: Color 105 Scanner Transmission: BW D129/D130 3-250 SM Appendix Input Check 3.9 INPUT CHECK 3.9.1 COPIER When entering the Input Check mode, 8 digits display the result for a section. Each digit corresponds to a different device as shown in the table. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Result 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Bit No. Input Check 5803 Reading Description 0 001 Tray 1: Paper Size Sensor 1 See the table 1 following this table. 002 Tray 1: Tray Set Sensor Set Not set 003 Tray 1: Paper Lift Sensor Not upper limit Upper limit 004 Tray 1: Paper End Sensor No paper Paper remaining 005 Tray 1: Paper Height Sensor 1 See the table 2 following this table. 006 Tray 1: Paper Height Sensor 2 007 Tray 2: Paper Size Sensor See the table 1 following this table. 008 Tray 2: Tray Set Sensor Set Not set 009 Tray 2: Paper Lift Sensor Not upper limit Upper limit 010 Tray 2: Paper End Sensor No paper Paper remaining 011 Tray 2: Paper Height Sensor 1 SM Appendix See the table 2 following this table. 3-251 D129/D130 Input Check 012 Tray 2: Paper Height Sensor 2 013 Tray 1: Paper Feed Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 014 Tray 2: Paper Feed Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 015 Tray 3: Paper Feed Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 016 Tray 4: Paper Feed Sensor Paper detected No paper detected No paper detected Paper detected 018 Relay Sensor 1 Paper detected No paper detected 019 Relay Sensor 2 Paper detected No paper detected 020 Relay Sensor 3 No paper detected Paper detected 021 Relay Sensor 4 No paper detected Paper detected 022 Relay Sensor: LCT No paper detected Paper detected Not end Paper end 017 LCT: Paper Feed Sensor 023 By-pass: Paper End Sensor 024 By-pass: Paper Size Sensor See the table 3 following this table. 025 Registration Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 026 Fusing Exit Sensor No paper detected Paper detected 027 Fusing Entrance Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 028 Junction Gate Relay Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 029 Exit Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 030 Paper Overflow Sensor Not full Full 031 Right Cover Open/Close Close Open 032 Duplex Unit Open/Close Open Close 033 Duplex Entrance Sensor Paper detected No paper detected D129/D130 3-252 SM Appendix Input Check Paper detected No paper detected 035 Bank Right Cover Open/Close Close Open 036 Tray Cover Open/Close Close Open Set Not set 038 Bridge/Exit Tray: Exit Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 039 Bridge/Exit Tray: Relay Sensor Paper detected No paper detected 040 Bridge/Exit/Shift: Set Detection Set Not set Close Open Close Open Not HP HP Set (Bit1) Not set (Bit1) Not full Full 037 LCT Set 041 042 Bridge/Exit Tray: Left Guide Open/Close Bridge/Exit Tray: Right Guide Open/Close 043 Transfer Belt Unit HP Sensor 046 Fusing Unit Set 047 Toner Overflow Sensor 048 Interlock Detection 1 049 Interlock Detection 2 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 034 Duplex Exit Sensor Right or front door is Right or front door is open. close. Right or front door is Right or front door is open. close. 050 Key Card Set Set Not set 051 Key Counter Set Set Not set Not set set Set Not set Paper detected No paper detected Not end End No paper detected Paper detected Stay at rear Stay at front 052 Mechanical Counter Set 053 1-Bin Unit Set 054 1-Bin Unit: Paper Set 057 Cleaning Web End 060 Shift Sensor 064 Shift Tray Sensor SM Appendix 3-253 D129/D130 Input Check Bypass Tray Paper Length 065 Paper detected No paper detected 200 Scanner HP Sensor Not HP HP 201 Platen Cover Sensor Open Close Detection Table 1: Paper Height Sensor 0: Deactivated, 1: Activated (actuator inside sensor) Remaining paper Paper height sensor 1 Paper height sensor 2 Full 0 0 Nearly full 1 0 Near end 1 1 Almost empty 0 1 D129/D130 3-254 SM Appendix Input Check Table 2: Paper Size Switch Switch 1 is used for the tray set detection. 0: Pushed, 1: Not pushed North America Switch Location Europe/Asia 4 3 2 0 0 1 0 0 0 11" x 17" SEF*1 A3 SEF*1 (A3 SEF) (11" x 17" SEF) 8.5" x 14" SEF *2 B4 SEF *2 (B4 SEF) (8.5" x 14" SEF) A4 SEF A4 SEF 1 1 0 8.5" x 11" SEF 8.5" x 11" SEF 1 1 1 B5 SEF B5 SEF 0 1 1 11" x 81/2" LEF*3 A4 LEF*3 (A4 LEF) (11" x 81/2" LEF) 1 0 0 10.5" x 7.25" LEF*4 B5 LEF*4 (B5 LEF) (10.5" x 7.25" LEF) 0 1 0 A5 LEF A5 LEF 1 0 1 *1: The machine detects either 11" x 17" SEF or A3 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-002 (Tray 1) or -006 (Tray 2). *2: The machine detects either 8.5" x 14" SEF or B4 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-003 (Tray 1) or -007 (Tray 2). *3: The machine detects either 11" x 81/2" LEF or A4 LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-001 (Tray 1) or -005 (Tray 2). *4: The machine detects either B5 LEF or 10.5" x 7.25" LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-004 (Tray 1) or -008 (Tray 2).. SM Appendix 3-255 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Models Input Check Table 3: Paper Size (By-pass Table) 0: Pushed, 1: Not pushed Models Bit No. North America Europe/Asia 3 2 1 0 11" x 17" SEF*1 A3 SEF*1 (11" x 8.5" LEF) (A4 LEF) 1 1 1 0 11" x 17" SEF*1 A3 SEF*1 (11" x 8.5" LEF) (A4 LEF) 1 1 0 0 8.5" x 11" SEF*1 A4 SEF*1 (8.5" x 11" SEF*2) (A5 LEF) 1 1 0 1 8.5" x 11" SEF*1 A4 SEF*1 (8.5" x 11" SEF*2) (B5 LEF) 1 0 0 1 5.5" x 8.5" SEF A5 SEF 1 0 1 1 5.5" x 8.5" SEF A5 SEF 0 0 1 1 5.5" x 8.5" SEF A6 SEF 0 1 1 1 5.5" x 8.5" SEF A6 SEF 1 1 1 1 *1: When the machine determines that the paper feed direction is "LEF", it considers that the paper size is bracketed size. D129/D130 3-256 SM Appendix Input Check APS Original Size Detection Original Size Length Sensor Width Sensor SP4-301 Metric version Inch version L3 L2 L1 W1 W2 A3 11" x 17" O O O O O 00011111 B4 10" x 14" O O O O X 00011110 8.5" x 14" O O O X X 00011100 A4 LEF 8.5" x 11" X X X O O 00000011 B5 LEF - X X X O X 00000010 A4 SEF 11" x 8.5" X O O X X 00001100 B5 SEF - X X O X X 00000100 X X X X X 00000000 F4 8.5" x 13", 8.25" x 13", or 8" x 13" SP 5126 controls the size that is detected A5 LEF/ SEF SM Appendix 5.5" x 8.5", 8.5" x 5.5" 3-257 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables display Input Check 3.9.2 OPTIONS 3000/2000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher (D636/D637) Reading 6140 Bit Description 0 1 001 Entrance Sensor No paper detected Paper detected 002 Proof Exit Sensor No paper detected Paper detected Not Full Full No paper Paper detected*1 detected*1 No paper detected Paper detected Not HP HP No paper detected Paper detected Not HP HP 009 Lower Tray Height Sensor No paper detected Paper detected 010 Upper Tray Height Sensor No paper detected Paper detected 011 Upper Tray Full Sensor Not Full Full 012 Stack Roller HP Sensor Not HP HP 013 Jogger HP Sensor Not HP HP HP Not HP No paper detected Paper detected 016 Corner Stapler HP Sensor Not HP HP 017 Stapler Rotation HP Sensor Not HP HP Not Limit Limit Closed Open 003 Proof Full Detection Sensor 004 Upper Tray Exit Sensor 005 Staple Exit Sensor 006 Shift Roller HP Sensor 007 Shift Exit Sensor 008 Exit Guide Plate HP Sensor 014 Feed Out Belt HP Sensor 015 Stapling Tray Paper Sensor 018 Upper Tray Limit SW 019 Door Switch D129/D130 3-258 SM Appendix Input Check Reading Bit Description 0 1 Not HP HP 021 Staple Detection No staple detected Staple detected 022 Staple Dip Detection No staple detected Staple detected 023 Punch Movement HP Sensor Not HP HP 024 Paper Position Slide HP Sensor Not HP HP No paper detected Paper detected 026 Punch Full Sensor Not Full Full 027 Punch HP Sensor Not HP HP 020 Corner Stapler Operation 025 Paper Position Sensor 028 Punch DIP SW 1 See *1 029 Punch DIP SW 2 See *1 030 Stack Junction Gate HP Sensor Not HP HP No paper detected Paper detected Not HP HP No paper detected Paper detected 034 Bottom Fence HP Sensor Not HP HP 035 Fold Cam HP Sensor Not HP HP 036 Fold Plate HP Sensor Not HP HP 037 Fold Unit Exit Sensor No paper detected Paper detected No paper Paper detected*2 detected*2 No paper Paper detected*2 detected*2 Not HP HP No staple detected Staple detected 031 Stack Present Sensor 032 Clamp Roller HP Sensor 033 Fold Entrance Sensor 038 Lower Tray Full Sensor: Front 039 Lower Tray Full Sensor: Rear 040 Booklet Stapler 1: Operation 041 Booklet Stapler 1: Staple In (Front) SM Appendix 3-259 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 6140 Input Check Reading 6140 Bit Description 042 043 Booklet Stapler 1: Staple In (Leading Edge) Booklet Stapler 1: Operation (Rotation/Rear) 044 Booklet Stapler 1: Staple In (Rear) 045 Booklet Stapler 1: Staple In (Leading Edge/Rear) 046 Upper Tray Full Sensor: 3000 0 1 No staple detected Staple detected Not HP HP No staple detected Staple detected No staple detected Staple detected Not Full Full *1: Combination of DIP SW 1 and SW 2 DIP SW 1 DIP SW 2 Punch Type 0 0 Japan 1 0 Europe 0 1 North America 1 1 North Europe *2: Please refer to "Lower Tray (D637 Only)" in the Service Manual for the "3000/2000 (Booklet) Finisher". D129/D130 3-260 SM Appendix Input Check 1000-Sheet Finisher (D588) Reading Bit Description 0 001 Entrance Sensor 002 003 004 005 Paper detected Shift Exit Sensor No paper detected (Lower Tray Exit Sensor) Staple Entrance Sensor Paper detected (Stapler Tray Entrance Sensor) Staple Moving HP Sensor (Stapler HP Sensor) Jogger HP Sensor (Jogger Fence HP Sensor) 006 Stack Feed-out Belt HP Sensor 007 Staple Tray Paper Sensor 008 Staple Rotation Sensor (Staple Rotation HP Sensor) SM Appendix 3-261 No paper detected HP HP Not HP No paper detected Paper detected Not HP HP Staple detected 012 Shift HP Sensor Paper detected Not HP 010 Staple READY Detection (Exit Guide Plate HP Sensor) detected HP Staple detected Exit Guide Plate HP No paper Not HP 009 Staple Sensor 011 1 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 6139 No staple detected No staple detected Not HP HP Not HP HP D129/D130 Input Check 013 014 015 D129/D130 Paper Sensor (Stack Height Sensor) Tray Lower Sensor (Lower Tray Lower Limit Sensor) Proof Full Sensor (Paper Limit Sensor) 3-262 No output tray Output tray detected detected Lower limit Not lower limit Not full Full SM Appendix Output Check 3.10 OUTPUT CHECK 3.10.1 COPIER 5804 Output Check 001 Exit Motor: 350 002 Exit Motor: 175 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 003 Exit Motor: 230 Paper exit motor (Mainframe) 004 Exit Motor: 180 005 Exit Motor: 154 006 Exit Motor: 90 007 Feed Motor: 300 008 Feed Motor: 255 009 Feed Motor: 230 Paper feed motor (Mainframe) 010 Feed Motor: 215 011 Feed Motor: 180 012 Feed Motor: 154 013 Feed Motor: 90 014 Bank: Feed Motor: 300 015 Bank: Feed Motor: 255 Paper feed motor (Optional paper 016 Bank: Feed Motor: 230 feed unit) 017 Bank: Feed Motor: 215 018 Bank: Feed Motor: 180 SM Appendix 3-263 D129/D130 Output Check 5804 Output Check 019 Bank: Feed Motor: 154 020 Bank: Feed Motor: 90 021 LCT: Feed Motor: 300 022 LCT: Feed Motor: 255 023 LCT: Feed Motor: 230 Paper feed motor (Optional LCT) 024 LCT: Feed Motor: 215 025 LCT: Feed Motor: 180 026 LCT: Feed Motor: 154 027 LCT: Feed Motor: 90 028 Paper Feed Clutch 1 Paper feed clutch 1/2 (Mainframe) 029 Paper Feed Clutch 2 030 Bank: Paper Feed Clutch 3 Paper feed clutch 3/4 (Optional 031 Bank: Paper Feed Clutch 4 paper feed unit) 032 LCT: Paper Feed Clutch Paper feed clutch (Optional LCT) 033 Pick-up Solenoid 1 Pick-up Solenoid 1/2 (Mainframe) 034 Pick-up Solenoid 2 035 Bank: Pick-up Solenoid 3 Pick-up Solenoid 3/4 (Optional 036 Bank: Pick-up Solenoid 4 paper feed unit) 037 LCT: Pick-up Solenoid Pick-up Solenoid (LCT) 038 Tray Lift Motor 1: Up 039 Tray Lift Motor 1: Down - 040 Tray Lift Motor 2: Up D129/D130 3-264 SM Appendix Output Check 5804 Output Check 041 Tray Lift Motor 2: Down 042 Paper Tray Lock Solenoid Not used 043 Bank: Paper Tray Lock Solenoid Tray lock solenoid (Optional paper feed unit) 044 Registration Motor: 230 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 045 Registration Motor: 180 046 Registration Motor: 154 047 Registration Motor: 90 048 Exit: Junction Gate Solenoid Junction gate 1 solenoid 049 Duplex: Inverter Gate Solenoid Not used 050 Duplex Inverter Motor: Fwd: 230 051 Duplex Inverter Motor: Fwd: 180 052 Duplex Inverter Motor: Fwd: 154 053 Duplex Inverter Motor: Fwd: 90 054 Duplex Inverter Motor: Rev: 230 055 Duplex Inverter Motor: Rev: 180 056 Duplex Inverter Motor: Rev: 154 057 Duplex Inverter Motor: Rev: 90 058 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Fwd: 230 059 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Fwd: 180 060 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Fwd: 154 061 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Fwd: 90 062 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Rev: 230 063 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Rev: 180 SM Appendix 3-265 D129/D130 Output Check 5804 Output Check 064 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Rev: 154 065 Duplex/By-pass Motor: Rev: 90 066 By-pass Feed Clutch - 067 By-pass Pick-up Solenoid - 068 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: 230 069 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: 180 Drive motor (Bridge unit) 070 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: 154 071 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: 90 072 Bridge/Exit Tray: Junction Gate Junction Gate Solenoid (Bridge Solenoid unit) 073 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: Reset - 074 Bridge/Exit Tray: Drive Motor: Enable - 075 Bridge: Cooling Fan Motor Not used 076 Transfer Belt Contact Motor - 077 OPC Motor: 230 078 OPC Motor: 180 Drum motor 079 OPC Motor: 154 080 OPC Motor: 90 081 Transfer/Development Motor: 230 082 Transfer/Development Motor: 180 083 Transfer/Development Motor: 154 084 Transfer/Development Motor: 90 085 Fusing Motor: 230 086 Fusing Motor: 180 D129/D130 3-266 SM Appendix Output Check 5804 Output Check 087 Fusing Motor: 154 088 Fusing Motor: 90 089 Development Puddle Motor - 090 PTL Control - 091 Fusing Fan Motor: High Fusing exhaust fan motor Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 092 Fusing Fan Motor: Low 093 Exhaust Fan Motor: High Exhaust fan motor 094 Exhaust Fan Motor: Low 095 Duct Fan Motor Cooling fan motor 096 Exit Fan Motor: High Paper exit cooling fan motor 097 Exit Fan Motor: Low 098 PSU Fan Motor Junction gate 2 solenoid (1-bin 099 1-Bin Junction Gate Solenoid unit) 100 Polygon Motor: 230 101 Polygon Motor: 180 102 Polygon Motor: 154 103 Polygon Motor: 90 104 LD 1 105 LD 2 106 Toner Bottle Motor: Fwd Toner supply motor 107 Quenching Lamp - 108 Charge Bias - 109 Development Bias - SM Appendix 3-267 D129/D130 Output Check 5804 Output Check 110 Transfer Belt Voltage - 111 ID Sensor LED - 115 Cleaning Web Motor Web motor 116 Shift Tray Motor Not used 117 CTL Cooling FAN Controller fan 202 Scanner Lamp - 3.10.2 1000-SHEET FINISHER (D588) Output Check 6144 Display Description 001 Upper Relay Motor Upper Transport Motor 002 Lower Relay Motor Lower Transport Motor 003 Exit Motor - 004 Proof Junction Gate SOL Tray Junction Gate Solenoid 005 Lower Tray Lift Motor - 006 Jogger Fence Motor - 007 Stapler Motor - 008 Stapler Hammer - 009 Stapler Junction Gate Solenoid - 010 Positioning Roller Solenoid - 011 Stack Feed-out Motor - 012 Shift Motor - 013 Exit Guide Plate Motor - D129/D130 3-268 SM Appendix Output Check 3.10.3 3000 /2000-SHEET (BOOKLET) FINISHER (D636/D637) Output 6145 Description 001 Entrance Motor - 002 Upper Transport Motor - 003 Lower Transport Motor - 004 Upper/Proof Tray Exit Motor - 005 Clamp Roller Retraction Motor - 006 Shift Roller Motor - 007 Exit Guide Plate Motor - 008 Upper Tray Lift Motor - 009 Stacking Sponge Roller Motor - 010 Jogger Fence Motor - 011 Feed Out Belt Motor - 012 Corner Stapler Movement Motor - 013 Corner Stapler Rotation Motor - 014 Corner Stapler - 015 Proof Junction Gate Solenoid - 016 Stapling Tray Junction Gate Solenoid - 017 Stapling Edge Pressure Plate - Solenoid 018 Positioning Roller Solenoid - 019 Booklet Pressure Roller Solenoid - 020 Stack Junction Gate Motor - 021 Fold Unit Bottom Fence Lift Motor - SM Appendix Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Display 3-269 D129/D130 Output Check 022 Booklet Stapler: Front - 023 Booklet Stapler: Rear - 024 Fold Plate Motor - 025 Fold Roller Motor - 026 Positioning Roller Motor - 027 Punch Drive Motor - 028 Punch Movement Motor - 029 Paper Position Sensor Slide Motor - D129/D130 3-270 SM Appendix Printer Service Tables 3.11 PRINTER SERVICE TABLES 3.11.1 SP1-XXX (SERVICE MODE) Bit Switch 001 Bit Switch 1 0 1 bit 0 DFU - - bit 1 DFU - - bit 2 DFU - - bit 3 No I/O Timeout 0: Disable 1: Enable Enable: The MFP I/O Timeout setting will have no effect. I/O Timeouts will never occur. bit 4 SD Card Save Mode 0: Disable 1: Enable Enable: Print jobs will be saved to an SD Card in the GW SD slot. bit 5 DFU - - bit 6 DFU - - bit 7 [RPCS,PCL]: Printable area frame border 0: Disable 1: Enable Enable: The machine prints all RPCS and PCL jobs with a border on the edges of the printable area. SM Appendix 3-271 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 1001 Printer Service Tables 1001 Bit Switch 002 Bit Switch 2 0 1 bit 0 DFU - - bit 1 DFU - - bit 2 Applying a collation Type Shift Normal Collate Collate A collation type (shift or normal) will be applied to all jobs that do not already have a ‘Collate Type’ configured. bit 3 If #5-0 is enabled, this Bit Switch has no effect. [PCL5e/c,PS]: PDL Auto Switching 0: Enable 1: Disable Disable: The MFPs ability to change the PDL processor mid-job. Some host systems submit jobs that contain both PS and PCL5e/c. If Auto PDL switching is disabled, these jobs will not be printed properly. bit 4 DFU - - bit 5 DFU - - bit 6 DFU - - bit 7 DFU - - D129/D130 3-272 SM Appendix Printer Service Tables 1001 Bit Switch 003 Bit Switch 3 0 1 bit 0 DFU - - bit 1 DFU - - bit 2 [PCL5e/c]: Legacy HP compatibility 0: Disable 1: Enable HP4000/HP8000. In other words, the left margin defined in the job (usually " *r0A") will be changed to " *r1A" bit 3 DFU - - bit 4 DFU - - bit 5 DFU - - bit 6 DFU - - bit 7 DFU - - SM Appendix 3-273 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Enable: Uses the same left margin as older HP models such as Printer Service Tables 1001 Bit Switch 004 Bit Switch 4 0 1 bit 0 DFU - - bit 1 DFU - - bit 2 DFU - - bit 3 IPDS print-side reversal 0: Disable 1: Enable Enable: Increases printing speed but simplex pages may be printed on the back side of the sheet. bit 4 DFU - - bit 5 DFU - - bit 6 DFU - - bit 7 IPDS support tools 0: Disable 1: Enable Enable: Enables the port for IPDS support tools. D129/D130 3-274 SM Appendix Printer Service Tables 1001 Bit Switch 005 Bit Switch 5 0 1 Disable Enable Show "Collate Type", "Staple Type" and "Punch Type" buttons on the operation panel. bit 0 If enabled, users will be able to configure a Collate Type, Staple Type, and Punch Type from the operation panel. The available types will depend on Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables the device and configured options. After enabling the function, the settings will appear under: "User Tools > Printer Features > System" bit 1 Multiple copies if a paper size or type mismatch occurs 0: Disable (Single copy) 1: Enable (Multiple copy) If a paper size or type mismatch occurs during the printing of multiple copies, only a single copy is output by default. Using this Bit Switch, the device can be configured to print all copies even if a paper mismatch occurs. bit 2 Prevent SDK applications from altering the contents of a job 0: Disable 1: Enable If this BitSw is enabled, SDK applications will not be able to alter print data. This is achieved by preventing SDK applications from accessing a module called the "GPS Filter". Note: The main purpose of this BitSw is for troubleshooting the effects of SDK applications on data. bit 3 [PS] PS Criteria Pattern3 Pattern1 Change the number of PS criterion used by the PS interpreter to determine whether a job is PS data or not. Pattern3: includes most PS commands. Pattern1: A small number of PS tags and headers bit 4 Increase max number of the stored jobs to 1000 jobs. SM Appendix Disable Enable (1000) (100) 3-275 D129/D130 Printer Service Tables Enable: Changes the maximum number of jobs that can be stored on the HDD via Job Type settings to 1000. The default is 100. bit 5 DFU bit 6 Method for determining the image rotation for the edge to bind on. - - 0: Disable 1: Enable If enabled, the image rotation will be performed as they were in the specifications of older models for the binding of pages of mixed orientation jobs. The old models are below: - PCL: Pre-04A models - PS/PDF/RPCS:Pre-05S models bit 7 Letterhead mode printing 0: Disable 1: Enable (Duplex) Routes all pages through the duplex unit. If this is disabled, simplex pages or the last page of an odd-paged duplex job are not routed through the duplex unit. This could result in problems with letterhead/pre-printed pages. Only affects pages specified as Letterhead paper. 1001 Bit Switch 006 Bit Switch 6 DFU D129/D130 - 3-276 - SM Appendix Printer Service Tables 1001 Bit Switch 007 Bit Switch 7 Print path 0 1 0: Disable 1: Enable If enabled, simplex pages (in mixed simplex/duplex PS/PCL5 jobs only) bit 0 and the last page of an odd paged duplex job (PS, PCL5, PCL6), are always routed through the duplex unit. Not having to switch paper paths bit 1 to 7 1001 DFU Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables increases the print speed slightly. - - - - - - 0: Disable 1: Enable (Standard) (BMS) Bit Switch 008 Bit Switch 8 DFU bit 0 to 3 DFU PCL edge to edge printing setting bit 4 Switch the edge to edge printing setting for the custom-made machine (BMS). bit 5 to 7 SM Appendix DFU - 3-277 - D129/D130 Printer Service Tables 1001 Bit Switch 009 Bit Switch 9 PDL Auto Detection timeout of jobs submitted via USB or Parallel Port (IEEE 1284). 0 1 "Disabled "Enabled (Immediately)" (10 seconds)" bit 0 To be used if PDL auto-detection fails. A failure of PDL autodetection doesn't necessarily mean that the job can't be printed. This bit switch tells the device whether to time-out immediately (default) upon failure or to wait 10 seconds. bit 1 DFU bit 2 Job Cancel - - Disabled (Not cancelled) Enabled (Cancelled) If this bit switch, all jobs will be cancelled after a jam occurs. Note: If this bitsw is enabled, printing under the following conditions might result in problems: - Job submission via USB or Parallel Port - Spool printing (WIM >Configuration > Device Settings > System) bit 3 PCL/PS bypass tray paper rotation (SEF/LEF) 0: Disable 1: Enable This bitsw causes the device to revert to the behavior of previous generations. It only takes effect if "Bypass Tray Setting Priority" = "Driver/Command". Previous spec (bitsw=1): If a standard sized paper mismatch occurred in the bypass tray, the MFP always prompted for SEF paper. If this bitsw=0 (default) then in the event of a standard sized paper mismatch, the MFP will always prompt for paper of the rotation (SEF/LEF) determined by the MFP bypass tray paper setting or by the bypass tray sensor. D129/D130 3-278 SM Appendix Printer Service Tables bit 4 Response to PJL USTATUS when multiple collated copies are printed 0: Disable 1: Enable When enabled, if multiple collated copies are printed, the device no longer responds to PJL USTATUS with the number of pages in the current copy. Instead the device will return the total number of pages for all copies. Bit 5 DFU - - Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables to 7 SM Appendix 3-279 D129/D130 Printer Service Tables 1001 Bit Switch 010 Bit Switch 10 bit 0 to 4 bit 5 DFU List / Test Print Lock 0 1 - - 0: Disable 1: Enable If enabled, you can lock or unlock the [List/Test Print] items under the Pinter Features menu when the Store and Skip Errored Job Function is on. Bit 6 Optional charge machines - - 0: Disable 1: Enable - - 0 1 0: Disable 1: Enable If enabled, you can use the optional charge machines when the Store and Skip Errored Job Function is on. Bit 7 1001 DFU Bit Switch 011 Bit Switch 11 bit 0 List / Test Print menu When enabled, [Multiple Lists] menu is displayed in [List / Test Print] under the Printer Features menu. bit 1 Interrupt printing 0: Job 1: Page Selects the interrupting units for the interrupt printing function. When you select "0," you can interrupt printing of a job while being processed. When you select "1," you can interrupt printing of a page while being processed. Bit 2 DFU - to 7 D129/D130 3-280 - SM Appendix Printer Service Tables 1001 Bit Switch 012 Bit Switch 12 bit 0 to 7 1003 DFU 0 1 - - [Clear Setting] Initialize Printer System Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 1003 001 Initializes settings in the "System" menu of the user mode. 1003 003 Delete Program 1004 [Print Summary] Print Printer Summary 1004 001 Prints the service summary sheet (a summary of all the controller settings). 1006 [Sample/Locked Print] *CTL 0: Link with Doc. Svr, 1: Enable Enables and disables the document server. When you select "0," the 1006 001 document server is enabled or disabled in accordance with Copy Service Mode SP5-967. When you select "1," the document server is enabled regardless of Copy Service Mode SP5-967. 1110 [Media Print Device Setting] 1110 002 0: Disable 1: Enable 1111 1111 001 SM Appendix Selects the setting for the media print device. [All Job Delete Mode] Select whether to include an image 0: excluding New Job processing job in jobs subject to full 1: including New Job cancellation from the SCS job list. 3-281 D129/D130 Scanner Service Table 3.12 SCANNER SERVICE TABLE 3.12.1 SP TABLES SP Number/Name Function/[Setting] 1001 Scan NV Version Displays the version of the scanner NV. Selects the compression type for binary 1004 Compression Type picture processing. [1 to 3 / 1 / 1/step] 1: MH, 2: MR, 3: MMR Creates an erase margin for all edges of the scanned image. 1005 Erase Margin If the machine has scanned the edge of the original, create a margin. [0 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step] Enables or disables the TWAIN function. 1009 Remote scan disable [0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: Enable, 1: Disable Displays or does not display the clear light 1010 Non Display Clear Light PDF PDF function. [0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: Display, 1: Not display Displays or does not display the original 1011 Org Count Disp counter. [0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: Not display, 1: Display Clears or does not clear a user information 1012 User Info Release after a job. [0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: Not clear, 1: Clear D129/D130 3-282 SM Appendix Scanner Service Table SP Number/Name Function/[Setting] Compression level (grayscale) These SP codes set the compression ratio for the grayscale processing mode 2021 that can be selected with the notch settings on the operation panel. 1 Comp 1: 5 - 95 [5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step] 2 Comp 2: 5 - 95 [5 to 95 / 40 / 1 /step] 3 Comp 3: 5 - 95 [5 to 95 / 65 / 1 /step] 4 Comp 4: 5 - 95 [5 to 95 / 80 / 1 /step] 5 Comp 5: 5 - 95 [5 to 95 / 95 / 1 /step] Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables Range: 5 (lowest ratio) <-> 95 (highest ratio) [Compression ratio of ClearLight PDF] 2024* Selects the compression ratio for clearlight PDF for the two settings that can be selected at the operation panel. 1 Compression Ratio (Normal image) [5 to 95 / 25 / 1 /step ] 2 Compression Ratio (High comp image) [5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ] SM Appendix 3-283 D129/D130 Detailed Description of SP5-749 Rev. 11/15/2012 ⇒ 3.13 DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF SP5-749 5749 Import/Export 001 Import 101 Export 251 Export Result Print (SP) 252 Import Result Print (SP) If part of the panel display for SP5-749 appears garbled, please apply the following modification firmware to the machine. Target model Module Program No Version Effective date D130 System/Copy D1295751K 2.04 July 2012 Production 3.13.1 DATA THAT CAN BE IMPORTED AND EXPORTED Copier / Document Server Features Printer Features Scanner Features Facsimile Features Extended Feature Settings Program (Document Server) Program (Copier) Program (Scanner) Web Image Monitor Setting Web Service Settings System Settings D129/D130 3-284 SM Appendix Detailed Description of SP5-749 Rev. 11/15/2012 Address book Programs (fax function) Programs (printer function) Scanner function programs that include password settings User stamp in the copy default settings Settings for configuring from telnet @Remote-related data Counters Settings that can be specified using Web Image Monitor or Web Service only (such as Bonjour or SSDP settings) Some System Settings*1 *2 *1 The setting for the date, those settings that require the device certificate, and those settings that need to be adjusted for each device (for example, image adjustment settings) cannot be imported or exported. *2 Settings only for executing functions and settings only for viewing cannot be imported or exported. 3.13.3 IMPORT/EXPORT CONDITION Import/export is possible between devices only if their models, region of use, and the following device configuration match. Input Tray Output Tray Whether or not equipped with the duplex function Whether or not equipped with a finisher and the type of finisher ADF Whether or not equipped with a hard disk Whether or not equipped with the Remote Machine function 3.13.4 LOCATION OF STORED DATA (LOG) The log is stored in the same location as the exported device setting information file. To use this function, it is necessary to create the device setting information file with special software and store it on the web server. For details, contact your sales representative. SM Appendix 3-285 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 3.13.2 DATA THAT CANNOT BE IMPORTED OR EXPORTED Detailed Description of SP5-749 Rev. 11/15/2012 3.13.5 POSSIBLE SOLUTIONS FOR IMPORT/EXPORT PROBLEMS If an error occurs, check the log's result code first. Values other than 0 indicate that an error occurred. The result code will appear in the circled area illustrated below. - Example of a log file If you cannot solve the problem or do not know how to solve it after checking the code, note down the error log entry, and then contact your service representative. Result Code Cause Solutions 2 (INVALID REQUEST) A file import was attempted between Import files exported from the same model different models or machines with with the same different device configurations. device configurations. Failed to write the device Check whether the destination device is information to the destination operating normally. 4 (INVALID OUTPUT DIR) device. 7( MODULE ERROR) An unexpected error occurred Switch the power off and then back on, and during import or export. then try the operation again. If the error persists, contact your service representative. 8 (DISK FULL) 9 (DEVICE ERROR) The available storage space on the Execute the operation again after making external medium is insufficient. sure there is enough storage space. Failed to write or read the log file. Check whether the path to the folder for storing the file or the folder in which the file is stored is missing. 10 (LOG ERROR) D129/D130 The hard disk is faulty. Contact your service representative. 3-286 SM Appendix Detailed Description of SP5-749 Rev. 11/15/2012 Result Code Cause Solutions 20 (PART FAILED) Failed to import some settings. The reason for the failure is logged in "NgCode". Check the code. ♦ Reason for the Error (Ng-Name) 2. INVALID VALUE The specified value exceeds the allowable range. 3. PERMISSION ERROR The permission to edit the setting is missing. The setting does not exist in the system. 5. INTERLOCK ERROR The setting cannot be changed because of the system status or interlocking with other specified settings. 6. OTHER ERROR The setting cannot be changed for some other reason. 21 (INVALID FILE) Failed to import the file because it is Check whether the file format is correct. The in the wrong format in the external log is in the form of a CSV file medium. 22 (INVALID KEY) The encryption key is not valid. Use the correct encryption key. When exporting device information from the control panel, the data can be saved only on an SD card. The file format for exports is CSV. 3.13.6 EXPORTING DEVICE INFORMATION When exporting SP device information from the control panel, the data is saved on an SD card. 1. Insert an SD card into the media slot on the side of the control panel. 2. Enter SP mode. 3. Press SP5-749-001 4. Select target SP settings to be exported. SM Appendix 3-287 D129/D130 Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables 4. NOT EXIST Detailed Description of SP5-749 5. Rev. 11/15/2012 Select the Option Settings. Item Specification Unique Unique information of the Unique information that can be updated machine is included in Note #1. Items that are to be use to identify the machine itself among some exported file if you select devices. "Unique" setting. Example: IP address / Host name / Information related to FAX number /Mail address assigned the machine #2. Items for specifying the options equipped the machine. Example: Lot number for developer Unique information that cannot be updated #3. Items that the problem may occur by importing Example: Serial number / Information related to @remote #4. Items for managing the history of the machine Example: time and date / counter information / Installation date #5. Setting value for Engine Secret Secret information is Secret information exported if you select #1. Data that absolutely cannot be exported. "Secret" setting. (Exported data becomes turned letter) Example: Password / Encryption key / PIN code #2. Confidential information for the customer Example: User name / User ID / Department code / Mail address / Phone number #3. Personal information Example: Document name / Image data #4. Sensitive information for the customer Example: IP address / MAC address / Network parameter D129/D130 3-288 SM Appendix Detailed Description of SP5-749 Rev. 11/15/2012 6. Select an Encryption Setting. Item Specification Encryption Select whether perform Note If the encryption function is used, setting of encryption key is required by the encryption function or direct input. not when exporting. - Type the arbitrary password using soft keyboard If you push "Encryption" - Can enter up to 32 characters key, you can export secret 7. Press “Execute” key. 8. Press [OK]. Appendix: Service Program Mode Tables information. If data export fails, the details of the error can be viewed in the log. 3.13.7 IMPORTING DEVICE INFORMATION Import device information saved on an SD card. 1. Insert an SD card into the media slot on the side of the control panel. 2. Enter SP mode. 3. Press SP5-749-101 4. Select a unique setting. SM Appendix 3-289 D129/D130 Detailed Description of SP5-749 5. Rev. 11/15/2012 Press “Encryption key”, if the encryption key was created when the file was exported. Item Specification Note Unique If you want to apply the unique Refer to the above information information to the target machine, select the "Unique" key. Encryption If the encrypted fail is selected as import file, this setting is required. 6. Press “Execute” key. 7. Press [OK]. If data export fails, the details of the error can be viewed in the log. D129/D130 3-290 SM Appendix SR790(B408)/SR3090(D588) 1000-SHEET FINISHER REVISION HISTORY Page Date Added/Updated/New None 1000-SHEET FINISHER B408/D588 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT............................................1 1.1 MAIN PCB .................................................................................................... 1 1.2 STAPLER UNIT ............................................................................................ 2 1.3 MOTORS ...................................................................................................... 3 1.3.1 SHIFT MOTOR .................................................................................... 3 1.3.2 STAPLER MOTOR .............................................................................. 3 1.3.3 UPPER TRANSPORT MOTOR AND EXIT MOTOR ........................... 4 1.3.4 LOWER TRANSPORT MOTOR .......................................................... 4 1.4 MOTORS AND SENSORS ........................................................................... 5 1.4.1 PREPARATION ................................................................................... 5 1.4.2 STACK HEIGHT SENSOR .................................................................. 6 1.4.3 STAPLER TRAY PAPER SENSOR..................................................... 6 1.4.4 LOWER TRAY LIFT MOTOR .............................................................. 7 1.4.5 STACK FEED-OUT MOTOR ............................................................... 7 2. TROUBLESHOOTING ....................................................................8 2.1 JAM DETECTION......................................................................................... 8 3. SERVICE TABLES..........................................................................9 3.1 DIP SWITCH SETTINGS ............................................................................. 9 4. DETAILED DESCRIPTIONS .........................................................10 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 GENERAL LAYOUT ................................................................................... 10 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT ...................................................... 11 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTION ............................................ 13 DRIVE LAYOUT ......................................................................................... 15 JUNCTION GATES .................................................................................... 16 Upper Tray Mode ................................................................................... 16 Sort/Stack Mode .................................................................................... 16 Staple Mode ........................................................................................... 16 4.6 UPPER TRAY............................................................................................. 17 4.7 LOWER TRAY UP/DOWN MECHANISMS ................................................ 18 4.8 PAPER SHIFT MECHANISM ..................................................................... 19 4.9 JOGGER UNIT PAPER POSITIONING MECHANISM............................... 20 4.10 EXIT GUIDE PLATE ................................................................................. 21 4.11 STAPLER MECHANISM .......................................................................... 22 4.12 STAPLER UNIT MOVEMENT MECHANISM ........................................... 23 4.13 PAPER FEED-OUT MECHANISM ........................................................... 24 SM i B408/D588 MAIN PCB 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT CAUTION Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the procedures in this section. NOTE: This manual uses the following symbols. : See or Refer to : Screws : Connector : E-ring : Clip ring 1.1 MAIN PCB 1000-Sheet Finisher SR790/SR3090 B408/D588 [A] [B] B408R109.WMF B408R110.WMF 1. Rear cover [A] ( x 2) 2. Main PCB [B] ( x 4, All ) SM 1 B408/D588 STAPLER UNIT 1.2 STAPLER UNIT [B] 1. Side cover [A] ( x 2) [C] 2. Open exit guide plate [B] 3. Upper side cover [C] ( x 2) [A] B408R102.WMF [D] 4. Front cover support plate [D] ( x 1) [E] 5. Front cover [E] [F] 6. Front inner cover [F] ( x 2) B408R113.WMF 7. Harness [G] 8. Unhook the spring [H] 9. Turn the stapler unit [I] and take it out. [J] 10. Bracket [J] ( x 2) [H] [G] [I] B408R114.WMF B408/D588 2 SM MOTORS 1.3 MOTORS 1.3.1 SHIFT MOTOR 1. Rear cover (1.1) 2. Shift motor [A] ( x 2, x 1) [A] 1000-Sheet Finisher SR790/SR3090 B408/D588 B408R123.WMF 1.3.2 STAPLER MOTOR 1. Rear cover (1.1) 2. Stapler motor [A] ( x 2, x 1) [A] B408R124.WMF SM 3 B408/D588 MOTORS 1.3.3 UPPER TRANSPORT MOTOR AND EXIT MOTOR 1. Rear cover (1.1) 2. Motor assembly [A] ( x 4, x 2) 3. Upper transport motor [B] ( x 4) [A] 4. Exit motor [C] ( x 4) [B] [C] B408R112.WMF 1.3.4 LOWER TRANSPORT MOTOR 1. Main PCB (1.1) 2. Lower transport motor [A] ( x 2, x 1) [A] B408R111.WMF B408/D588 4 SM MOTORS AND SENSORS 1.4 MOTORS AND SENSORS [A] 1.4.1 PREPARATION 1. Front cover and inner cover (1.2) [B] 2. Upper side cover [A] ( x 2) 3. Upper tray [B] ( x 1) [C] B408R116.WMF [E] 5. Loosen the 2 screws [D]. [D] 6. Lower the lower tray guide plate [E]. B408R117.WMF 7. Guide plate [F] ( x 4) [F] B408R118.WMF SM 5 B408/D588 1000-Sheet Finisher SR790/SR3090 B408/D588 4. Lower side cover [C] ( x 2) MOTORS AND SENSORS 1.4.2 STACK HEIGHT SENSOR 1. Stack height sensor assembly [A] ( x 1) [A] 2. Stack height sensor [B] ( x 1) [B] B408R121.WMF 1.4.3 STAPLER TRAY PAPER SENSOR 1. Stapler tray paper sensor [A] ( x 1) B408R120.WMF [A] B408/D588 6 SM MOTORS AND SENSORS 1.4.4 LOWER TRAY LIFT MOTOR 1. Lower tray lift motor [A] ( x 2, x 1) [A] 1000-Sheet Finisher SR790/SR3090 B408/D588 B408R119.WMF 1.4.5 STACK FEED-OUT MOTOR 1. Stack feed-out motor [A] ( x 2, x 1) [A] B408R122.WMF SM 7 B408/D588 JAM DETECTION 2. TROUBLESHOOTING 2.1 JAM DETECTION Mode Shift Staple Content Entrance sensor: On check Entrance sensor: Off check Lower tray exit sensor: On check Tray exit sensor: Off check Stapler tray entrance sensor: On check Stapler tray entrance sensor: Off check Lower tray exit sensor: On check Lower tray exit sensor: Off check B408/D588 Jam 8 The entrance sensor does not turn on within the normal time after the main machine exit sensor turns on The entrance sensor does not turn off within the normal time after it turns on. The lower tray exit sensor does not turn on within the normal time after the entrance sensor turns off. The tray exit sensor does not turn off within the normal time after it turns on. The stapler tray entrance sensor does not switch on within the normal time after the entrance sensor switched on. The staple tray entrance sensor does not turn off within the normal time after it turns on. The lower exit sensor does not turn on after the feed-out pawl feeds out the outputs. The lower exit sensor turns on when the feed-out pawl returns to its home position after feeding out the outputs. SM DIP SWITCH SETTINGS 3. SERVICE TABLES 3.1 DIP SWITCH SETTINGS The DIP switches should not be set to any combination other than those listed in the table below. SW100 1 0 1 2 0 0 Description Normal operation mode (Default) Packing mode. 1000-Sheet Finisher SR790/SR3090 B408/D588 • Before packing the machine, do the following: Set switch 1 to 1 then back to zero. The lower tray moves to the lowest position. Then turn off the main switch. • After unpacking the machine, do the following: After turning the main switch back on, the lower tray returns to home position automatically. SM 9 B408/D588 GENERAL LAYOUT 4. DETAILED DESCRIPTIONS 4.1 GENERAL LAYOUT 2 3 1 13 4 5 6 12 7 11 10 8 9 B408D101.WMF 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Upper Tray Upper Tray Exit Roller Entrance Roller Tray Junction Gate Upper Transport Roller Stapler Junction Gate Lower Transport Rollers B408/D588 8. Stapler 9. Stack Feed-out Belt 10. Positioning Roller 11. Shift Roller 12. Lower Tray 13. Lower Tray Exit Roller 10 SM ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT 4.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT 1 3 2 11 4 5 10 8 7 12 6 B408D102.WMF 19 13 18 14 20 21 15 16 17 B408D103.WMF 1. Upper Cover Switch 2. Paper Limit Sensor 3. Entrance Sensor 4. Exit Guide Plate Motor 5. Exit Guide Plate HP Sensor 6. Front Door Safety Switch 7. Stack Height Sensor 8. Lower Tray Exit Sensor 9. Lower Tray Upper Limit Switch 10. Shift HP Sensor 11. Shift Motor SM 11 12. Jogger Fence HP Sensor 13. Positioning Roller Solenoid 14. Stapler HP Sensor 15. Stapler Tray Entrance Sensor 16. Stapler Tray Paper Sensor 17. Stapler Hammer Motor 18. Staple Sheet Sensor 19. Stack Feed-out Belt HP Sensor 20. Stapler Rotation HP Sensor 21. Staple Sensor B408/D588 1000-Sheet Finisher SR790/SR3090 B408/D588 9 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT 22 32 31 30 29 28 27 23 26 25 24 B408D104.WMF 22. Tray Junction Gate Solenoid 23. Lower Tray Lift Motor 24. Lower Tray Lower Limit Sensor 25. Stapler Motor 26. Jogger Fence Motor 27. Stack Feed-out Motor 28. Main Board 29. Lower Transport Motor 30. Stapler Junction Gate Solenoid 31. Exit Motor 32. Upper Transport Motor B408/D588 12 SM ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTION 4.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTION Symbol Motors M1 M2 M3 M4 M5 M6 M7 M8 M9 M10 Name Function Upper Transport Lower Transport Jogger Fence Staple Hammer Stack Feed-out Exit Guide Plate Exit Lower Tray Lift Shift Stapler Drives the entrance roller and upper transport rollers. Drives the lower transport rollers and the positioning roller. Drives the jogger fences. Drives the staple hammer. Drives the stack feed-out belt. Opens and closes the exit guide plate. Drives the exit roller. Moves the lower tray up or down. Moves the shift roller from side to side. Moves the stapler unit from side to side. Entrance Detects copy paper entering the finisher and checks for misfeeds. Detects when the paper stack height in the upper tray is at its limit. Detects when the jogger fence is at home position. Detects when the shift roller is at home position. Detects when the stack feed-out belt is at home position. Detects when the stapler is at home position. Detects when the exit guide plate is at home position. Detects copy paper entering the stapler tray and checks for misfeeds. Checks for misfeeds. Detects the top of the copy paper stack. Detects when the lower tray is at its lower limit position. Detects when there is copy paper in the stapler tray. Detects the leading edge of the staple sheet. Detects when the staple hammer is at home position. Detects whether there are staples in the staple cartridge. Index No. 32 29 26 17 27 4 31 23 11 25 S1 S2 S3 S4 S5 S6 S7 S8 S9 S10 S11 S12 S13 S14 S15 Paper Limit Jogger Fence HP Shift HP Stack Feed-out Belt HP Stapler HP Exit Guide Plate HP Stapler Tray Entrance Lower Tray Exit Stack Height Lower Tray Lower Limit Stapler Tray Paper Staple Sheet Stapler Rotation HP Staple 3 2 12 10 19 14 5 15 8 7 24 16 18 20 21 Solenoids SOL1 SOL2 SM Tray Junction Gate Stapler Junction Gate Drives the tray junction gate. Drives the stapler junction gate. 13 22 30 B408/D588 1000-Sheet Finisher SR790/SR3090 B408/D588 Sensors ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTION Symbol SOL3 Name Positioning Roller Function Moves the positioning roller. Lower Tray Upper Limit Front Door Safety Upper Cover Detects when the lower tray is at its upper limit position. Cuts the dc power when the front door is opened. Cuts the dc power when the upper cover is opened. Main Controls the finisher and communicates with the copier/printer. Index No. 13 Switches SW1 SW2 SW3 9 6 1 PCBs PCB1 B408/D588 14 28 SM DRIVE LAYOUT 4.4 DRIVE LAYOUT 1 2 5 4 3 B408D106.WMF B408D105.WMF 7 8 9 B408D107.WMF 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. SM Exit Motor Upper Transport Motor Lower Transport Motor Shift Motor Exit Guide Plate Motor 6. 7. 8. 9. 15 Lower Tray Lift Motor Stack Feed-out Motor Jogger Motor Stapler Motor B408/D588 1000-Sheet Finisher SR790/SR3090 B408/D588 6 JUNCTION GATES 4.5 JUNCTION GATES [A] [C] [B] [D] B408D108.WMF Depending on the finishing mode, the copies are directed up, straight through, or down by the combination of the tray junction gate [A] and stapler junction gate [B]. These gates are controlled by the tray junction gate solenoid [C] and stapler junction gate solenoid [D]. Upper Tray Mode The tray junction gate solenoid remains off. The copies go up to the upper tray. Sort/Stack Mode The tray junction gate solenoid turns on and the stapler junction gate solenoid remains off. The copies are sent to the lower tray directly. Staple Mode The tray junction gate solenoid and the stapler junction gate solenoid both turn on. The copies go down to the jogger unit. B408/D588 16 SM UPPER TRAY 4.6 UPPER TRAY [A] When the paper limit sensor [A] switches on during feed-out for each of three consecutive sheets of paper, paper overflow is detected. SM 17 B408/D588 1000-Sheet Finisher SR790/SR3090 B408/D588 B408D109.WMF LOWER TRAY UP/DOWN MECHANISMS 4.7 LOWER TRAY UP/DOWN MECHANISMS [G] [B] [F] [A] [D] [E] [C] B408D112.WMF The vertical position of the lower tray [A] depends on the height of the copied paper stack on the lower tray. The stack height sensor feeler [B] contacts the top of the stack, and the lower tray lift motor [C] controls the tray height. When the lower tray reaches its lowest possible position, the actuator [D] turns on the lower tray lower limit sensor [E], and copying stops. Tray Up When the copy paper on the tray is removed, the stack height sensor [F] turns off and the tray lifts up. Then, the tray stops when the sensor turns on again (the tray pushes up the feeler). If the stack height sensor fails, the lower tray upper limit switch [G] detects the tray and stops the motor. This is a safety measure against stack height sensor failure. Sort/Stack Mode (Tray Down) Every five sheets of paper, the tray goes down until the sensor turns off again. Then, it goes up until the sensor is on again. Staple Mode (Tray Down) After a stapled copy is fed out, the tray goes up for 220 ms and stops for 300 ms. Then, it goes down for 1 second, waits for 500 ms, then goes up until the sensor turns on. B408/D588 18 SM PAPER SHIFT MECHANISM 4.8 PAPER SHIFT MECHANISM [F] [C] [B] [A] [D] B408D110.WMF In the sort/stack mode, the shift roller [A] moves from side to side to separate the sets of copies. The horizontal position of the shift roller is controlled by the shift motor [B] and the shift gear disk [C]. After the trailing edge of the copy passes the upper transport roller, the shift motor turns on, driving the shift gear disk and the link [D]. After the paper is delivered to the lower tray [E], the shift roller moves to its home position, which is detected by the shift HP sensor [F]. Then, when the trailing edge of the next copy passes the upper transport roller, the shift roller shifts again. This operation is done every sheet. When the trailing edge of each page in the next set of copies passes the upper transport roller, the shift roller shifts in the opposite direction. SM 19 B408/D588 1000-Sheet Finisher SR790/SR3090 B408/D588 [E] JOGGER UNIT PAPER POSITIONING MECHANISM 4.9 JOGGER UNIT PAPER POSITIONING MECHANISM B408D113.WMF [B] [F] [E] [A] [C] B408D114.WMF [D] In staple mode, each sheet of copy paper is vertically and horizontally aligned when it arrives in the jogger unit. For the vertical paper alignment, the positioning roller solenoid [A] turns on shortly after the stapler tray entrance sensor [B] turns off, and the positioning roller [C] pushes the copy against the bottom of the stack stopper [D]. For the horizontal paper alignment, the jogger front fence [E] and the rear fence [F] move to the waiting position, which is 18 mm away from the side of the paper. When aligning the paper vertically, the jogger fence moves in 14 mm from the waiting position. After the vertical position has been aligned, the jogger fence pushes the paper 4 mm against the rear fence to align the paper horizontally. Then the jogger fence moves back to the previous position. B408/D588 20 SM EXIT GUIDE PLATE 4.10 EXIT GUIDE PLATE [B] [C] [A] B408D111.WMF When stacking a large size of paper (such as A3, DLT) in the jogger unit, the leading edge of the paper reaches the exit rollers. To prevent the paper from running into the exit rollers and not being aligned correctly, the exit guide plate [A] is moved up to make a gap between the exit rollers. This operation is done for all paper sizes, but is only needed for the larger sizes. The exit guide plate motor [B] and exit roller release cam [C] control the exit guide plate movement. When the exit guide plate motor starts, the cam turns and the exit guide plate moves up. When stapling is finished, the exit guide plate motor turns on again to close the exit guide plate. When the exit guide plate HP sensor [D] turns on, the motor stops. SM 21 B408/D588 1000-Sheet Finisher SR790/SR3090 B408/D588 [D] STAPLER MECHANISM 4.11 STAPLER MECHANISM [E] [B] [D] [C] [A] B408D116.WMF The staple hammer motor [A] drives the staple hammer. The staple sheet sensor [B] detects the leading edge of the staple sheet at the stapling position to prevent the hammer from operating if there are no staples at the stapling position. If there is no staple cartridge in the stapler unit or no staples in the staple cartridge, staple end is indicated on the operation panel. The stapler sensor [C] detects this. The stapler rotation HP sensor [D] checks whether the staple hammer mechanism returns to home position after each stack has been stapled. When excessive load is applied to the staple hammer motor, the copier detects a staple jam. When a staple jam has occurred, the jammed staple is inside the staple cartridge [E]. Therefore, the jammed staple can be removed easily after pulling out the staple cartridge. B408/D588 22 SM STAPLER UNIT MOVEMENT MECHANISM 4.12 STAPLER UNIT MOVEMENT MECHANISM [B] [A] The stapler motor moves the stapler [A] from side to side. After the start key is pressed, the stapler moves from its home position to the stapling position. If two-staple-position mode is selected, the stapler moves to the front stapling position first, then moves to the rear stapling position. However, for the next copy set, it staples in the reverse order (at the rear side first, then at the front side). After the job is completed, the stapler moves back to its home position. The stapler HP sensor [B] detects this. SM 23 B408/D588 1000-Sheet Finisher SR790/SR3090 B408/D588 B408D117.WMF PAPER FEED-OUT MECHANISM 4.13 PAPER FEED-OUT MECHANISM [A] [B] [C] [D] B408D118.WMF After the copies have been stapled, the stack feed-out motor [A] starts. The pawl [B] on the stack feed-out belt [C] transports the set of stapled copies up and feeds it to the shift roller. The shift roller takes over stack feed-out after the leading edge reaches this roller. Just before the stapled stack passes through the lower tray exit sensor, the stackfeed-out motor turns off until the shift rollers have completely fed the stack out to the lower tray. Then, the stack-feed-out motor turns on again until the pawl [B] actuates the stack feed-out belt home position sensor [D]. B408/D588 24 SM B802/D630 ARDF DF3010/DF3070 R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY P ag e Dat e Ad d ed/ Upd at ed/ New None ARDF DF3010/DF3070 (B802/D630) TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT........................................... 1 1.1 COVERS AND TRAY .....................................................................................1 1.1.1 FRONT AND REAR COVER ................................................................1 1.1.2 ORIGINAL TRAY ..................................................................................2 1.2 DOCUMENT FEED COMPONENTS .............................................................3 1.2.1 PICK-UP ROLLER ................................................................................3 1.2.2 FEED BELT ..........................................................................................4 1.2.3 SEPARATION ROLLER .......................................................................6 1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ......................................................................7 1.3.1 DF DRIVE BOARD ...............................................................................7 1.3.2 ORIGINAL LENGTH SENSORS AND TRAILING EDGE SENSOR......8 1.3.3 ORIGINAL SET, SEPARATION, SKEW CORRECTION AND SCANNING ENTRANCE SENSOR ...............................................................9 1.3.4 ORIGINAL WIDTH SENSORS ...........................................................10 1.3.5 REGISTRATION SENSOR .................................................................10 1.3.6 ORIGINAL EXIT SENSOR..................................................................11 1.3.7 DF POSITION SENSOR .....................................................................12 1.3.8 COVER SENSOR ...............................................................................12 1.3.9 PICK-UP ROLLER HP AND ORIGINAL STOPPER HP SENSOR .....13 1.3.10 STAMP SOLENOID .....................................................................14 1.4 ORIGINAL FEED DRIVE .............................................................................16 1.4.1 ADF FEED MOTOR ............................................................................16 1.4.2 ADF INVERTER MOTOR ...................................................................17 1.4.3 ADF TRANSPORT MOTOR ...............................................................17 1.4.4 ADF PICK-UP MOTOR .......................................................................18 2. DETAILED DESCRIPTIONS ........................................................ 19 2.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT ..............................................................................19 2.1.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT .............................................19 2.1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT ..............................................20 Sensors and Drive Components ............................................................20 Electrical Component Descriptions ........................................................21 2.1.3 DRIVE LAYOUT .................................................................................23 SM i B802/D630 ADF Feed Motor.....................................................................................24 ADF Transport Motor and ADF Inverter Motor .......................................24 2.2 BASIC OPERATION ....................................................................................25 2.2.1 ORIGINAL SIZE DETECTION ............................................................25 2.2.2 MIXED ORIGINAL SIZE MODE ..........................................................27 Document length detection.....................................................................27 Feed-in cycle ..........................................................................................27 Normal feed-in........................................................................................28 2.2.3 PICK-UP AND SEPARATION .............................................................28 2.2.4 SKEW CORRECTION ........................................................................29 2.2.5 SLIP DETECTION ..............................................................................30 2.2.6 ORIGINAL TRANSPORT AND EXIT ..................................................31 Single-Sided Originals ............................................................................31 Double-Sided Originals ..........................................................................31 Original Sensor ......................................................................................32 2.2.7 CONDITIONS FOR JAM DETECTION ...............................................33 3. SERVICE TABLES ....................................................................... 34 3.1 DIP SWITCHES ...........................................................................................34 B802/D630 ii SM READ THIS FIRST Safety and Symbols Replacement Procedure Safety Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the replacement procedures in this manual. Symbols Used in this Manual This manual uses the following symbols. : See or Refer to : Screws : Connector : Clip ring : E-ring : Clamp Covers and Tray ARDF DF3010/ DF3070 (B802/D630) 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 COVERS AND TRAY 1.1.1 FRONT AND REAR COVER 1. Open the left cover [A]. 2. Front cover [B] ( x 1, hook x 2) 3. Rear cover [C] (x 2, hook x 2) SM 1 B802/D630 Covers and Tray 1.1.2 ORIGINAL TRAY 1. Open the left cover. 2. Rear cover ( "Front and Rear Cover") 3. Front cover ( "Front and Rear Cover") 4. Pivot cover [A] ( x 1) 5. Original tray [B] (x 1, x 1, x 2) B802/D630 2 SM Document Feed Components ARDF DF3010/ DF3070 (B802/D630) 1.2 DOCUMENT FEED COMPONENTS 1.2.1 PICK-UP ROLLER 1. Open the left cover. 2. Bushings [A] ( x 1 each) 3. Pick-up roller [B] (gear x 1, one-way gear x 1) SM 3 B802/D630 Document Feed Components 1.2.2 FEED BELT 1. Open the left cover. 2. Front feed unit cover [A] 3. Rear feed unit cover [B] (hook x 2) 4. Feed belt unit [C] B802/D630 4 SM ARDF DF3010/ DF3070 (B802/D630) Document Feed Components 5. Slide the tension plate [D] (hook) 6. Belt unit cover [E] ( x 1) 7. Belt tension unit [F] 8. Feed belt [G] SM 5 B802/D630 Document Feed Components 1.2.3 SEPARATION ROLLER 1. Open the left cover. 2. Separation roller cover [A] 3. Remove the bushing [B] ( x 1). 4. Slide the separation roller shaft to the front side, and then remove it. 5. Separation roller [C] ( x 1) B802/D630 6 SM Electrical Components ARDF DF3010/ DF3070 (B802/D630) 1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 1.3.1 DF DRIVE BOARD 1. Rear cover ("Front and Rear Cover") 2. DF drive board [A] ( x 4, all s) SM 7 B802/D630 Electrical Components 1.3.2 ORIGINAL LENGTH SENSORS AND TRAILING EDGE SENSOR 1. Open the left cover. 2. Remove the tray stopper [A], while pushing the hook with a screw driver. 3. Open the original tray [B]. 4. Original tray cover [C] ( x 3) 5. Original trailing edge sensor [D] ( 6. Original length sensors [E] ( B802/D630 x 1, hook) x 1 each, hook) 8 SM 1.3.3 ORIGINAL SET, SEPARATION, SKEW CORRECTION AND SCANNING ENTRANCE SENSOR 1. Open the left cover. 2. Open the inner upper cover [A] (stepped screw x 3). 3. Original set sensor [B] ( x 1, hook) 4. Separation sensor [C] ( x 1, hook) 5. Skew correction sensor [D] ( x 1, hook) 6. Scanning entrance sensor [E] ( x 1, hook) SM 9 B802/D630 ARDF DF3010/ DF3070 (B802/D630) Electrical Components Electrical Components 1.3.4 ORIGINAL WIDTH SENSORS 1. Open the left cover. 2. Open the inner upper cover ( " Original Set, Separation, Skew Correction and Registration Sensor"). 3. Original width sensor bracket [A] ( x 2, ground cable x 1). 4. Original width sensors [B] ( x 1 each, hook) 1.3.5 REGISTRATION SENSOR 1. Open the ARDF. 2. White plate [A] (stud screw x 1) 3. Registration sensor bracket [B] ( x 1) 4. Registration sensor [C] ( x 1) B802/D630 10 SM Electrical Components ARDF DF3010/ DF3070 (B802/D630) 1.3.6 ORIGINAL EXIT SENSOR 1. Open the left cover. 2. Open the feed-in guide plate [A]. 3. Guide plate [B] ( x 2, stepped screw x 1; front side) 4. Original exit sensor [C] ( x 1, hook) SM 11 B802/D630 Electrical Components 1.3.7 DF POSITION SENSOR 1. Rear cover ( "Front and Rear Cover") 2. ARDF drive board ( "ARDF Drive Board") 3. DF position sensor bracket [A] ( x 1) 4. DF position sensor [B] ( x 1, hook) 1.3.8 COVER SENSOR 1. Open the left cover. 2. Rear cover ( "Front and Rear Cover") 3. Cover sensor [A] ( x 1, hook) B802/D630 12 SM Electrical Components 1. Open the left cover. 2. Rear cover ( "Front and Rear Cover") 3. Release the clamp [A] ( x 1), and then slide the harnesses away. 4. Sensor bracket [B] ( x 1, x 2) 5. Pick-up roller HP sensor [C] (hook) 6. Original stopper HP sensor [D] (hook) SM 13 ARDF DF3010/ DF3070 (B802/D630) 1.3.9 PICK-UP ROLLER HP AND ORIGINAL STOPPER HP SENSOR B802/D630 Electrical Components 1.3.10 STAMP SOLENOID 1. Open the left cover. 2. Remove the platen plate [A]. 3. Stamp solenoid cover [B] ( x 1) 4. Remove the screw [C] ( x 1). You cannot remove the stamp solenoid at this time. 5. Rear cover ( "Front and Rear Cover") 6. Disconnect the stamp solenoid harness [D]. 7. ADF feed motor ( "ADF Feed Motor") B802/D630 14 SM ARDF DF3010/ DF3070 (B802/D630) Electrical Components 8. Put the stamp solenoid harness into the cutout [E]. 9. Pull out the stamp solenoid [F] SM 15 B802/D630 Original Feed Drive 1.4 ORIGINAL FEED DRIVE 1.4.1 ADF FEED MOTOR 1. Rear cover ( "Front and Rear Cover") 2. Harness guide [A] ( x 2, all s, all s) 3. Remove the spring [B]. 4. Stay bracket [C] (stepped screw x 1) 5. Slide the feed motor gear [D] to the left side (seen from the front of the machine), and then remove the timing belt [E]. 6. ADF feed motor bracket [F] ( x 3) 7. ADF feed motor [G] ( x 1) B802/D630 16 SM Original Feed Drive ARDF DF3010/ DF3070 (B802/D630) 1.4.2 ADF INVERTER MOTOR 1. ADF feed motor ( " ADF Feed Motor") 2. ADF inverter motor bracket [A] ( x 2, x 1, timing belt) 3. ADF inverter motor [B] ( x 4) 1.4.3 ADF TRANSPORT MOTOR 1. Rear cover ( "Front and Rear Cover") 2. Ground cable [A] ( x 1) 3. ADF transport motor bracket [B] ( x 2, x 1) 4. ADF transport motor [C] ( x 2) SM 17 B802/D630 Original Feed Drive 1.4.4 ADF PICK-UP MOTOR 1. Rear cover ( "Front and Rear Cover") 2. Harness guide [A] ( x 2, all s, all s) 3. Stay bracket [B] (stepped screw x 1) 4. Release 6 clamps on the ADF pick-up motor bracket [C] ( x 6). 5. ADF pick-up motor bracket [D] ( x 3, 6. ADF pick-up motor [E] ( x 2, x 1, timing belt) B802/D630 x 1) 18 SM Component Layout ARDF DF3010/ DF3070 (B802/D630) 2. DETAILED DESCRIPTIONS 2.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT 2.1.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT 1. Original Width Sensor 2. Skew Correction Roller 3. Skew Correction Sensor 4. Separation Sensor 5. Feed Belt 6. Separation Roller 7. Original Set Sensor 8. Pick-up Roller 9. Original Length Sensor 1 10. Original Length Sensor 2 SM 11. Original Length Sensor 3 12. Inverter Roller 13. Junction Gate 14. Exit Roller 15. Original Exit Sensor 16. Transport Roller 17. Registration Sensor 18. Registration Roller 19. Scanning Entrance Sensor 19 B802/D630 Component Layout 2.1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT Sensors and Drive Components 1. Original Width Sensors 2. Scanning Entrance Sensor 3. Skew Correction Sensor 4. ADF Transport Motor 5. Left Cover Sensor 6. Pick-up Motor 7. Pick-up Roller HP Sensor 8. Original Stopper HP Sensor 9. ADF Inverter Motor 10. ADF Feed Motor 11. Original Length Sensor 1 B802/D630 12. Original Length Sensor 2 13. Original Length Sensor 4 14. DF Drive Board 15. Original Trailing Edge Sensor 16. Original Set Sensor 17. Stamp Solenoid 18. Separation Sensor 19. Original Exit Sensor 20. Junction Gate Solenoid 21. Registration Sensor 20 SM Electrical Component Descriptions Symbol Name Function Index No. Motors Drives the feed belt, separation, pick-up, and - ADF Feed - ADF Transport Drives the transport and exit rollers 4 - ADF Inverter Drives the Inverter rollers 9 - Pick-up Motor Moves the pick-up roller up and down. 6 - DF Position Detects whether the DF is lifted or not. - Skew Correction - Registration - Cover Sensor reverse table rollers. 10 Sensors - - - - - SM Original Width Sensor - S Original Width Sensor - M Original Width Sensor - L Original Width Sensor - LL Original Length S Detects the leading edge of the original to turn off the DF feed and transport motors. Detects the original exposure timing, and checks for original misfeeds. Detects whether the feed-in cover is opened or not. 3 21 4 Detects the original width - S. 1 Detects the original width - M. 1 Detects the original width - L. 1 Detects the original width - LL. 1 Detects the original length - S. 11 21 B802/D630 ARDF DF3010/ DF3070 (B802/D630) Component Layout Component Layout - Original Length - Detects the original length - M. 12 - Original Length - L Detects the original length - L. 13 - Original Set 16 M Detects if an original is on the feed table. Detects the leading edge of the original to turn on the junction gate solenoid and checks for original misfeeds. - Original Exit Detects the trailing edge of the original to turn off the transport and feed motor and junction 19 gate solenoid. In single-sided mode, used to detect original misfeeds. Detects the trailing edge of the last original to - Original Trailing stop copy paper feed and to turn off the Edge Sensor transport motor, and checks for original 15 misfeeds. The machine uses this sensor to check if the - Separation original has slipped during feed-in, to make Sensor sure that original feed starts at the correct 18 time. Solenoids - Stamp Energizes the stamper to mark the original. 17 - Junction Gate Opens and closes the junction gate. 20 PCBs Interfaces the sensor signals with the copier, - DF Drive and transfers the magnetic clutch, solenoid 14 and motor drive signals from the copier. B802/D630 22 SM Component Layout ARDF DF3010/ DF3070 (B802/D630) 2.1.3 DRIVE LAYOUT 1. Registration Roller 2. Transport Roller 3. Skew Correction Roller 4. Separation Roller 5. Feed Belt 6. ADF Transport Motor 7. Pick-up Roller 8. Exit Roller 9. ADF Inverter Motor 10. ADF Feed Motor 11. Inverter Roller SM 23 B802/D630 Component Layout ADF Feed Motor ADF Feed Motor [A] drives the pick-up [B], feed belt [C], separation [D] and skew correction rollers [E]. ADF Transport Motor and ADF Inverter Motor ADF Transport Motor [A] drives the registration roller [B], transport roller [C] and exit roller [D]. ADF Inverter Motor [E] drives the Inverter Roller [F]. B802/D630 24 SM Basic Operation ARDF DF3010/ DF3070 (B802/D630) 2.2 BASIC OPERATION 2.2.1 ORIGINAL SIZE DETECTION The original size detection mechanism consists of the five original width sensors ([A]: Width Sensor SS, [B]: Width Sensor S, [C] Width Sensor M, [D]: Width Sensor L, [E]: Width Sensor LL) and three original length sensors ([F]: Length Sensor S, [G]: Length Sensor M, [H]: Length Sensor L). Based on the combined output of the length sensors and the width sensors, the machine can detect the size of the original. This integrated detection mechanism is detailed in the table below. Width Sensor Length Sensor Area Size SS S M L LL S M L LT A/B A3/SEF (297 x 420) ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON O O B4/SEF (257 x 364) ON ON ON - - ON ON ON - O A4/SEF (210 x 297) ON ON - - - ON ON - O O A4/LEF (297 x 210) ON ON ON ON ON - - - O O B5/SEF (182 x 257) ON - - - - ON - - - O B5/LEF (257 x 182) ON ON ON - - - - - - O A5/SEF (148 x 210) ON - - - - - - - - O SM 25 B802/D630 Basic Operation A5/LEF (210 x 148) ON ON - - - - - - - O ON ON ON ON - ON ON ON O1 O5 11" x 15"/SEF ON ON ON ON - ON ON ON 1 10" x 14"/SEF ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON O - 8.5" x 14"/SEF (LG) ON ON - - - ON ON ON O2 - 8.5" x 13"/SEF (F4) ON ON - - - ON ON ON 2 8.25" x 13"/SEF ON ON - - - ON ON ON - - 8" x 13"/SEF (F) ON ON - - - ON ON ON - - 8.5" x 11"/SEF (LT) ON ON - - - ON - - O3 O6 8.5" x 11"/LEF (LT) ON ON ON On - - - - O4 O7 ON ON - - - ON - - O - ON ON ON ON - - - - 4 - ON ON - - - ON - - 3 - - - - - - - - - O - ON ON - - - - - - O - 267 mm x 390 mm ON ON ON ON - ON ON ON - 5 195 mm x 267 mm ON ON - - - ON - - - 6 267 mm x 195 mm ON ON ON ON - - - - - 7 11" x 17"/SEF (DLT) 7.25" x 10.5"/SEF (US EXE) 10.5" x 7.25"/SEF (US EXE) 10" x 8"/SEF 5.5" x 8.5"/SEF (HLT) 5.5" x 8.5"/LEF (HLT) - O Symbols O: Yes (Default), : Yes (Can select this with SP mode), ON: Paper present, LT: North America, A/B: Europe, Asia B802/D630 26 SM For "O/ " mark, which has superscripted number, it is possible to change the original detection size with SP6-016. For example, instead of LT (O3), the machine can be set up to detect 10” x 8” ( 3 ). The F size can be selected with SP5-126. The default is 8.5" x 13" The machine cannot detect more than one size of original in the same job. 2.2.2 MIXED ORIGINAL SIZE MODE This section explains what happens when the user selects mixed original size mode. Because this ARDF is a sheet-through document feeder, the method for original document width detection is the same as when the originals are the same size, but the document length detection method is different. Therefore, the scanning speed is slightly slower. Document length detection From when the skew correction sensor switches on until it switches off, the CPU counts the transport motor pulses. The number of pulses determines the length of the original. Feed-in cycle When the original size for the copy modes listed below cannot be determined, the image cannot be correctly scaled (reduced or enlarged) or processed until the original’s length has been accurately detected. The length must be determined before the image is scanned. Auto Reduce/Enlarge Centering Erase Center/Border Booklet Image Repeat The originals follow this path: Scanning glass Inverter table 1. Length detection 2. Inverter table Scanning glass 3. Inverter table Scanning glass (image scanned) SM Inverter table (restores the original order) 27 Exit tray B802/D630 ARDF DF3010/ DF3070 (B802/D630) Basic Operation Basic Operation Normal feed-in In a copy mode other than those listed above, when the reduction/enlargement ratio has been determined, the originals are scanned normally. In order to store the scanned images, a large area of memory (the detected original width x 432 mm length) is prepared. Next, only the portion of the image up to the detected original length is read from memory and printed. 2.2.3 PICK-UP AND SEPARATION The original is set with the image facing up. The original pushes actuator and the original set sensor is activated. After pressing the start button, the pick-up motor is activated and the original feed unit [A] moves down. At the same time, the ADF feed motor is activated and the pick-up roller [B] feeds original to the feed belt [C]. After being fed from feed belt [C], the topmost sheet is separated from the stack by the separation roller [D] and sent to the skew correction roller. The mechanism is an FRR system, consisting of the original feed belt [C] and separation roller [D]. B802/D630 28 SM Basic Operation ARDF DF3010/ DF3070 (B802/D630) 2.2.4 SKEW CORRECTION When an original is fed into the feeder, the feed motor [A] rotates forwards. At this time, the feed belt turns but the skew correction roller [B] does not, because these rollers have a one-way gear. (If the ADF feed motor rotates forward, the feed belt is moved. If the ADF feed motor rotates in reverse, the skew correction roller is moved.) As a result, when the leading edge of the paper gets to the skew correction roller, skew in the original is removed. A short time after the leading edge of the original turns on the skew correction sensor [C], the feed motor [A] turns off and rotates in reverse. At this time, the skew correction roller [B] and the feed belt [D] both turn, and original feed continues. The registration roller also has the same skew correction mechanism, but only for small size originals (6, A5 or HLT). This function can be effective for all size paper with SP6-020-001. SM 29 B802/D630 Basic Operation 2.2.5 SLIP DETECTION [A]: Separation sensor [B]: Skew correction sensor These two sensors are used to measure the amount of slippage and to correct for this. The machine measures the time it takes for the original to get to the separation sensor [A] after the [Start] key is pressed. If the original arrives at the correct time, it feeds normally. If the original arrives late, the machine enters the slip mode. In the slip mode, the machine measures the time for the leading edge of the original to move from the separation sensor to the skew correction sensor [B]. The machine uses this time to adjust the length of time that the entrance roller stays off to correct skew. This stops feed for enough time for the original to be in the correct position for feeding. B802/D630 30 SM Basic Operation ARDF DF3010/ DF3070 (B802/D630) 2.2.6 ORIGINAL TRANSPORT AND EXIT Single-Sided Originals The feed motor feeds the separated original to the skew correction roller [A] at maximum speed. After skew correction, the feed and transport motors feed the original through the scanning area at a lower speed (the scanning area contains the original exposure guide [B] and DF exposure glass [C]). After scanning, the original is fed out by the transport roller [D] and exit roller [E]. Double-Sided Originals After skew correction, the ADF feed and transport motors drive the skew correction roller [A], registration roller [B], transport roller [C] and the exit roller [D]. The front side of the original is then scanned. When the original exit sensor [E] detects the leading edge of the original, the junction gate solenoid is activated and the junction gate [F] opens. The original is then transported towards the inverter table. Soon after the trailing edge of the original passes the exit sensor, the junction gate solenoid switches off and the junction gate [F] is closed. When the original has been fed onto the inverter table, the ADF inverter motor switches on. The original is then fed by the inverter roller [G], and then by the skew correction roller [A] and registration roller [B] to the scanning area (where the reverse side will be scanned). SM 31 B802/D630 Basic Operation The original is then sent to the inverter table [H] again to be turned over. This is done so that the duplex copies will be properly stacked front side down in the exit tray [I] in the correct order. Original Sensor During one-to-one copying, copy paper is fed to the skew correction roller in advance (while the original is still being scanned), to increase the copy speed. The original set sensor monitors the stack of originals in the feeder, and detects when the trailing edge of the last page has been fed in. The main CPU then stops the copier from feeding an unwanted extra sheet of copy paper. B802/D630 32 SM Basic Operation Jam Mode ARDF DF3010/ DF3070 (B802/D630) 2.2.7 CONDITIONS FOR JAM DETECTION Detection Timing When turning on the machine, the skew correction sensor, separation sensor, registration sensor or exit sensor detects an original. Initial When the cover is closed or DF is down, the skew correction sensor, separation sensor, registration sensor or exit sensor detects an original. When the cover is opened or DF is lifted up, the skew correction sensor, separation sensor, registration sensor or exit sensor detects an original. The skew correction sensor does not turn off even if the original was fed by the maximum length of the original + 150 mm after the skew correction sensor turned on. Sensor stays on too long The registration sensor does not turn off even if the original was fed by its length x 1.5 after the registration sensor turned on. The exit sensor does not turn off even if the original was fed by its length x 1.5 after the exit sensor turned on. The separation sensor does not turn on even if the original was fed by transport path length x 1.5. The skew correction sensor does not turn on even if the original was fed Sensor does by transport path length x 1.5. not come on The registration sensor does not turn on even if the original was fed by transport path length x 1.5 after the skew correction sensor turned on. The exit sensor does not turn on even the original was fed by transport path length x 1.5 after the skew correction sensor turned on. SM 33 B802/D630 Dip Switches 3. SERVICE TABLES 3.1 DIP SWITCHES DIP-SW Function 1 2 3 4 0 0 0 0 Normal operating mode (Default) 0 0 0 1 Free run: With original: One-sided mode: 100% speed 0 0 1 0 Free run: With original: Two-sided mode: 100% speed 0 0 1 1 Free run: No original: One-sided mode: 100% speed 0 1 0 0 Free run: No original: Two-sided mode: 100% speed 0 1 0 1 Free run: With original: One-sided mode: 32% speed 0 1 1 0 Free run: With original: Two-sided mode: 32% speed 0 1 1 1 Free run: With original: One-sided mode: 70% speed 1 0 0 0 Free run: With original: Two-sided mode: 70% speed 1 0 0 1 Free run: With original: One-sided mode: 200% speed 1 0 1 0 Free run: With original: Two-sided mode: 200% speed 1 0 1 1 Transport Motor On 1 1 0 0 Feed Motor On 1 1 0 1 Transport Motor On with random mode 1 1 1 0 Feed Motor On with random mode 1 1 1 1 B802/D630 34 SM D386/D634 BRIDGE UNIT BU3030/BU3060 R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY P ag e Dat e Ad d ed/ Upd at ed/ New None BRIDGE UNIT BU3030/BU3060 (D386/D634) TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT........................................... 1 1.1 BRIDGE UNIT CONTROL BOARD................................................................1 1.2 BRIDGE UNIT DRIVE MOTOR......................................................................2 1.3 TRAY EXIT SENSOR ....................................................................................3 1.4 RELAY SENSOR ...........................................................................................4 2. DETAILS ........................................................................................ 5 2.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT ........................................................5 2.2 DRIVE LAYOUT.............................................................................................6 2.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT .........................................................7 2.4 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTION ...............................................8 2.5 JUNCTION GATE MECHANISM ...................................................................9 SM i D386/D634 READ THIS FIRST Safety and Symbols Replacement Procedure Safety Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the replacement procedures in this manual. When taking apart the bridge unit, first take the unit out of the copier. Symbols Used in this Manual This manual uses the following symbols. : See or Refer to : Screws : Connector : Clip ring : E-ring Bridge Unit Control Board 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 BRIDGE UNIT CONTROL BOARD Bridge unit ( "Installation Procedure" in the base copier manual) 2. Rear cover [A] ( x 2) 3. Bridge unit control board [B] ( x 3, x 4) Bridge Unit BU3030/ BU3060 (D386/D634) 1. SM 1 D386/D634 Bridge Unit Drive Motor 1.2 BRIDGE UNIT DRIVE MOTOR 1. Bridge unit ( "Installation Procedure" in the base copier manual) 2. Rear cover ( "Bridge Unit Control Board") 3. Bracket [A] ( x 3, x 2) 4. Bridge unit drive motor [B] ( x 4, x 1) D386/D634 2 SM Tray Exit Sensor 1.3 TRAY EXIT SENSOR Bridge unit ( "Installation Procedure" in the base copier manual) 2. Rear cover ( "Bridge Unit Control Board") 3. Paper tray [A] 4. Exit guide [B] ( x 1) 5. Tray exit sensor [C] ( x 1) Bridge Unit BU3030/ BU3060 (D386/D634) 1. SM 3 D386/D634 Relay Sensor 1.4 RELAY SENSOR 1. Bridge unit ( "Installation Procedure" in the base copier manual) 2. Paper tray [A] 3. Relay sensor [B] ( x 1) D386/D634 4 SM Mechanical Component Layout 2. DETAILS 2.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT 5. Relay Sensor 2. Tray Exit Sensor 6. 2nd Transport Roller 3. Junction Gate 7. Left Exit Roller 4. 1st Transport Roller 8. Paper Tray Bridge Unit BU3030/ BU3060 (D386/D634) 1. Upper Exit Roller SM 5 D386/D634 Drive Layout 2.2 DRIVE LAYOUT 1. Left Exit Roller 2. 2nd Transport Roller 3. 1st Transport Roller 4. Upper Exit Roller 5. Bridge Unit Drive Motor D386/D634 6 SM Electrical Component Layout 2.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT Left Guide Switch 2. Right Guide Switch 3. Junction Gate Solenoid 4. Tray Exit Sensor 5. Bridge Unit Control Board 6. Bridge Unit Drive Motor 7. Relay Sensor Bridge Unit BU3030/ BU3060 (D386/D634) 1. SM 7 D386/D634 Electrical Component Description 2.4 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTION Symbol Name Function Index No. Motors M1 Drive Motor Drives the bridge unit. 6 S1 Tray Exit Checks for misfeeds. 4 S2 Relay Checks for misfeeds. 7 SW2 Right Guide Detects when the right guide is opened. 2 SW3 Left Guide Detects when the left guide is opened. 1 Sensors Switches Solenoids Moves the junction gate to direct the paper SOL1 Junction Gate to the upper tray (on top of the bridge unit) or 3 to the finisher. PCBs PCB1 D386/D634 Bridge Unit Control Board Controls the bridge unit. 8 5 SM Junction Gate Mechanism 2.5 JUNCTION GATE MECHANISM The junction gate [A] directs any paper reaching the bridge unit to either the upper tray (on top of the bridge unit) or to the finisher, depending on which has been selected. If the junction gate solenoid has been activated, the junction gate [A] points downward and directs the paper to the upper tray [B] (dotted line path in illustration). When the solenoid is off, the junction gate points upward and the paper is fed out to the finisher [C] by the transport and left exit Bridge Unit BU3030/ BU3060 (D386/D634) rollers (solid line). SM 9 D386/D634 PB3110(D537)/PB3130(D580) PAPER FEED UNIT R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY P ag e Dat e Ad d ed/ Upd at ed/ New None PAPER FEED UNIT (D537/D580) TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ........................................... 1 1.1 EXTERIOR COVER ....................................................................................... 1 1.1.1 REAR COVER ...................................................................................... 1 1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ...................................................................... 2 1.2.1 LIFT MOTORS...................................................................................... 2 1.2.2 UPPER AND LOWER PAPER FEED CLUTCHES ............................... 3 1.2.3 PAPER FEED MOTOR ......................................................................... 4 1.2.4 MAIN BOARD ....................................................................................... 4 1.3 FEED ............................................................................................................. 5 1.3.1 PAPER FEED UNIT.............................................................................. 5 1.3.2 PICK-UP, PAPER FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLERS .................... 6 1.3.3 LIFT, PAPER END, AND RELAY SENSORS ....................................... 7 SM i D537/D580 Exterior Cover 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 EXTERIOR COVER 1. Securing brackets [A] ( 2. Rear cover [B] ( SM Paper Feed Unit PB3110/ PB3130 D537/D580 1.1.1 REAR COVER x 1 each) x 2) 1 D537/D580 Electrical Components 1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 1.2.1 LIFT MOTORS 1. Rear cover ( 2. Lift motors [A][B] ( D537/D580 "Rear Cover") x 2, x 1 each) 2 SM Electrical Components Paper Feed Unit PB3110/ PB3130 D537/D580 1.2.2 UPPER AND LOWER PAPER FEED CLUTCHES 1. Rear cover ( 2. Upper paper feed gear unit [A] ( 3. Upper paper feed clutch bracket [B] ( 4. Upper paper feed clutch [C] 5. Lower paper feed clutch bracket [D] ( 6. Lower paper feed clutch [E] ( SM "Rear Cover") x 3, x 1) x 1, x 2, bushing x 1) x 1, bushing x 1, x 2) x 1) 3 D537/D580 Electrical Components 1.2.3 PAPER FEED MOTOR "Rear Cover") 1. Rear cover ( 2. Paper feed motor [A] ( x 1, x 2) When installing the paper feed motor, make sure that the gear of the paper feed motor holds the timing belt [B]. 1.2.4 MAIN BOARD 1. Rear cover ( 2. Main board [A] (All D537/D580 "Rear Cover") s, x 2, snap pin x 2) 4 SM Feed 1.3 FEED Paper Feed Unit PB3110/ PB3130 D537/D580 1.3.1 PAPER FEED UNIT 1. Right cover [A] ( x 2) 2. Vertical transport guide [B] of the paper feed unit 3. Pull the tray 3 (or 4). 4. Paper guide [C] 5. Paper feed unit [D] ( x 2, x 1, x 2) When replacing the paper feed unit of tray 4, do the same. SM 5 D537/D580 Feed 1.3.2 PICK-UP, PAPER FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLERS 1. Paper feed unit ( "Paper Feed Unit) 2. Roller holder [A] ( x 1) 3. Pick-up roller [B] 4. Paper feed roller [C] 5. Separation roller [D] ( D537/D580 x 1) 6 SM Feed Paper Feed Unit PB3110/ PB3130 D537/D580 1.3.3 LIFT, PAPER END, AND RELAY SENSORS 1. Paper feed unit ( 2. Vertical transport sensor bracket [A] ( 3. Vertical transport sensor [B] ( 4. Paper feed sensor bracket [C] ( 5. Paper feed sensor [D] ( 6. Paper end sensor filler [E] 7. Paper end sensor [F] ( 8. Lift sensor [G] ( SM "Paper Feed Unit") x 1) x 1) x 1) x 1) x 1) x 1) 7 D537/D580 PB3110(D538)/PB3140(D581) LARGE CAPACITY TRAY R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY P ag e Dat e Ad d ed/ Upd at ed/ New None LARGE CAPACITY TRAY (D538/D581) TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ........................................... 1 1.1 EXTERIOR COVER ....................................................................................... 1 1.1.1 LEFT AND RIGHT TRAY ...................................................................... 1 1.1.2 CHANGING THE TRAY SIZE ............................................................... 2 1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ...................................................................... 3 1.2.1 PAPER HEIGHT SENSORS ON PAPER STORAGE SIDE ................. 3 1.2.2 END FENCE HP SENSOR/PAPER END SENSOR 2 .......................... 3 1.2.3 TRAY LIFT MOTOR ............................................................................. 4 1.2.4 TRAY MOTOR ...................................................................................... 5 1.2.5 MAIN BOARD ....................................................................................... 5 1.2.6 STACK TRANSPORT CLUTCH ........................................................... 6 1.3 FEED ............................................................................................................. 7 1.3.1 PAPER FEED UNIT.............................................................................. 7 1.3.2 PICK-UP, FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLERS ................................. 8 1.3.3 PAPER FEED, PAPER END, LIFT AND RELAY SENSORS ............... 9 SM i D538/D581 Exterior Cover 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 EXTERIOR COVER 1. Large Capacity Tray PB3110/ PB3140 D538/D581 1.1.1 LEFT AND RIGHT TRAY Pull the LCT drawer. If the right tray comes up with the left tray, push the right tray into the LCT. x 2) 2. Left tray [A] ( 3. Remove the right tray [B] pressing down the stopper [C]. When reinstalling the tray, set the tray on the guide rail and carefully push the tray in, making sure to keep the tray level. SM 1 D538/D581 Exterior Cover 1.1.2 CHANGING THE TRAY SIZE x 5). 1. Remove the fence screws ( 2. Change the position of the fences. Before fastening the screws, set paper in the tray. D538/D581 2 SM Electrical Components 1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS Large Capacity Tray PB3110/ PB3140 D538/D581 1.2.1 PAPER HEIGHT SENSORS ON PAPER STORAGE SIDE "Left and Right Tray") 1. Tray ( 2. Rear fence [A] ( 3. Rear fence bracket [B] ( 4. Paper height sensors [C] ( x 1) x 2) x 1 each) 1.2.2 END FENCE HP SENSOR/PAPER END SENSOR 2 1. Bottom cover [D] ( 2. End fence HP sensor [E] ( 3. Paper end sensor 2 (paper storage side) [F] ( SM x 1) x 1) 3 x 1) D538/D581 Electrical Components 1.2.3 TRAY LIFT MOTOR 1. Securing brackets [A] ( 2. Rear cover [B] ( 3. Tray lift motor [C] ( D538/D581 x 1 each) x 2) x 1, x 3) 4 SM Electrical Components 1. Rear cover ( 2. Tray motor [A] ( Large Capacity Tray PB3110/ PB3140 D538/D581 1.2.4 TRAY MOTOR "Tray Lift Motor") x 1, x 2) When installing the tray motor, make sure that the gear of the tray motor holds the timing belt [B]. 1.2.5 MAIN BOARD 1. Rear cover ( 2. Main board [A] (All SM "Tray Lift Motor" ) s, x 2, snap x 2) 5 D538/D581 Electrical Components 1.2.6 STACK TRANSPORT CLUTCH 1. Rear cover ( 2. Stack transport clutch [A] ( D538/D581 "Tray Lift Motor") x 1, x 1) 6 SM Feed 1.3 FEED Large Capacity Tray PB3110/ PB3140 D538/D581 1.3.1 PAPER FEED UNIT 1. Right cover [A] 2. Open the vertical guide plate [B] 3. Guide plate [C] 4. Pull the LCT drawer [D]. 5. Paper feed unit [E] ( SM x2 x 1) 7 D538/D581 Feed 1.3.2 PICK-UP, FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLERS 1. Paper feed unit ( 2. Separation roller [A] ( 3. Roller holder [B] ( 4. Feed roller [C] and pick-up roller [D] D538/D581 "Paper Feed Unit") x 1) x 1) 8 SM Feed Large Capacity Tray PB3110/ PB3140 D538/D581 1.3.3 PAPER FEED, PAPER END, LIFT AND RELAY SENSORS "Paper Feed Unit") 1. Paper feed unit ( 2. Vertical transport sensor bracket [A] ( 3. Relay sensor [B] 4. Paper feed sensor bracket [C] 5. Paper feed sensor [D] 6. Paper end feeler [E] 7. Paper end sensor holder [F] (hook x 3) 8. Paper end sensor [G] ( 9. Lift sensor ( SM x 1, x 1) x 1, hook x 3) x 1, hook x 3) 9 D538/D581 D542/D635 SIDE TRAY TYPE C5501/C5502 R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY P ag e Dat e Ad d ed/ Upd at ed/ New None SIDE TRAY TYPE C5501/C5502 (D542/D635) TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT........................................... 1 1.1 TRAYS AND COVERS ..................................................................................1 1.1.1 SUB AND MAIN OUTPUT TRAYS .......................................................1 1.1.2 TRAY LEFT FRONT AND REAR COVERS..........................................2 1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ......................................................................3 1.2.1 SIDE TRAY CONTROL BOARD ...........................................................3 1.2.2 SIDE TRAY DRIVE MOTOR.................................................................4 1.2.3 SIDE TRAY RELAY SENSOR ..............................................................5 1.2.4 SIDE TRAY EXIT SENSOR ..................................................................6 SM i D542/D635 Trays and Covers 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 TRAYS AND COVERS 1.1.1 SUB AND MAIN OUTPUT TRAYS 1. Sub output tray [A] 2. Release the rear tab of the sub output tray. Main output tray [B] Release the rear tab of the sub output tray. Side Tray Type C5501/C5502 (D542/D635) SM 1 D542/D635 Trays and Covers 1.1.2 TRAY LEFT FRONT AND REAR COVERS 1. Sub and main output trays ( 2. Tray left front cover [A] 3. Sub and Main Output Trays) Release the hooks of the tray left front cover. Tray left rear cover [B] Release the hooks of the tray left rear cover. D542/D635 2 SM Electrical Components 1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 1.2.1 SIDE TRAY CONTROL BOARD 1. Sub and main output trays ( 2. Tray left front and rear covers ( 3. Side tray ( 4. Rear cover [A] ( 5. Side tray control board [A] ( Sub and Main Output Trays) Tray Left Front and Rear Covers) Installation Procedure in the base copier manual) x 2) x 3) Side Tray Type C5501/C5502 (D542/D635) x 3, SM 3 D542/D635 Electrical Components 1.2.2 SIDE TRAY DRIVE MOTOR 1. Sub and main output trays ( 2. Tray left front and rear covers ( 3. Side tray ( 4. Rear cover ( Side Tray Control Board) 5. Bracket [A] ( x 3, 6. Side tray drive motor [A] ( D542/D635 Sub and Main Output Trays) Tray Left Front and Rear Covers) Installation Procedure in the base copier manual) x 3, x 1, timing belt x 1) x 4, x 1) 4 SM Electrical Components 1.2.3 SIDE TRAY RELAY SENSOR 1. Sub and main output trays ( Sub and Main Output Trays) 2. Tray left front and rear covers ( 3. Side tray ( 4. Open the paper tray [A]. 5. Remove the ground cable [B] ( 6. Remove the paper tray [A]. 7. Turn over the side tray. 8. Side tray relay sensor [A] ( 9. Turn over the side tray, and then remove the side tray relay sensor. Tray Left Front and Rear Covers) Installation Procedure in the base copier manual) x 1). Side Tray Type C5501/C5502 (D542/D635) x 1, hooks) SM 5 D542/D635 Electrical Components 1.2.4 SIDE TRAY EXIT SENSOR 1. Sub and main output trays ( 2. Tray left front and rear covers ( 3. Side tray ( 4. Paper tray ( 5. Exit guide [A] ( 6. Side tray exit sensor [A] ( D542/D635 Sub and Main Output Trays) Tray Left Front and Rear Covers) Installation Procedure in the base copier manual) Side Tray Relay Sensor) x 1) x 1, x 1, hooks) 6 SM D629 FAX OPTION TYPE 5002 R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY P a ge Date 3∼4 11/15/2012 A d de d /U pd at e d /N ew Added step 6 to Installation for Fax Option (D629) FAX OPTION TYPE 5002 (D629) TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. INSTALLATION ............................................................................. 1 1.1 FAX OPTION INSTALLATION .......................................................................1 1.1.1 COMPONENT CHECK .........................................................................1 1.1.2 FAX OPTION INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................2 1.2 G3 INTERFACE BOARD INSTALLATION .....................................................5 1.2.1 COMPONENT CHECK .........................................................................5 1.2.2 INSTALLATION: ONE G3 BOARD .......................................................6 1.2.3 INSTALLATION: TWO G3 BOARDS ....................................................8 1.3 FAX UNIT OPTIONS ...................................................................................10 1.3.1 MEMORY UNIT (G578) ......................................................................10 1.3.2 HANDSET (D645) ...............................................................................11 2. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT......................................... 13 2.1 FCU .............................................................................................................13 2.1.1 SRAM DATA TRANSFER PROCEDURE ...........................................13 3. TROUBLESHOOTING ................................................................. 19 3.1 ERROR CODES ..........................................................................................19 3.2 IFAX TROUBLESHOOTING ........................................................................41 3.3 IP-FAX TROUBLESHOOTING ....................................................................44 3.3.1 IP-FAX TRANSMISSION ....................................................................44 Cannot send by IP Address/Host Name .................................................44 Cannot send via VoIP Gateway .............................................................46 Cannot send by Alias Fax number. ........................................................47 3.3.2 IP-FAX RECEPTION ..........................................................................49 Cannot receive via IP Address/Host Name. ...........................................49 Cannot receive by VoIP Gateway. .........................................................50 Cannot receive by Alias Fax number. ....................................................51 4. SERVICE TABLES ....................................................................... 53 4.1 CAUTIONS ..................................................................................................53 4.2 SERVICE PROGRAM TABLES ...................................................................54 4.2.1 SP1-XXX (BIT SWITCHES) ................................................................54 SM i D629 4.2.2 SP2-XXX (RAM DATA) .......................................................................55 4.2.3 SP3-XXX (TEL LINE SETTINGS) .......................................................57 4.2.4 SP4-XXX (ROM VERSIONS) .............................................................59 4.2.5 SP5-XXX (RAM CLEAR) ....................................................................60 4.2.6 SP6-XXX (REPORTS) ........................................................................61 4.2.7 SP7-XXX (TESTS) ..............................................................................64 4.3 BIT SWITCHES - 1 ......................................................................................66 4.3.1 SYSTEM SWITCHES .........................................................................66 4.4 BIT SWITCHES - 2 ......................................................................................83 4.4.1 I-FAX SWITCHES ...............................................................................83 4.4.2 PRINTER SWITCHES ........................................................................91 4.5 BIT SWITCHES - 3 ......................................................................................99 4.5.1 COMMUNICATION SWITCHES .........................................................99 4.6 BIT SWITCHES - 4 ....................................................................................110 4.6.1 G3 SWITCHES .................................................................................110 4.7 BIT SWITCHES - 5 ....................................................................................121 4.7.1 G3-2 AND G3-3 SWITCHES ............................................................121 4.7.2 G4 INTERNAL SWITCHES ..............................................................130 4.7.3 G4 PARAMETER SWITCHES ..........................................................130 4.8 BIT SWITCHES - 6 ....................................................................................131 4.8.1 IP FAX SWITCHES...........................................................................131 4.9 NCU PARAMETERS .................................................................................140 4.10 DEDICATED TRANSMISSION PARAMETERS ...................................155 4.10.1 PROGRAMMING PROCEDURE ...............................................155 4.10.2 PARAMETERS ..........................................................................156 Fax Parameters ....................................................................................156 E-mail Parameters ...............................................................................160 4.11 SERVICE RAM ADDRESSES .............................................................164 5. DETAILED SECTION DESCRIPTIONS ..................................... 175 5.1 OVERVIEW................................................................................................175 5.2 BOARDS ....................................................................................................176 5.2.1 FCU ..................................................................................................176 5.2.2 SG3 BOARD .....................................................................................178 5.3 VIDEO DATA PATH...................................................................................180 5.3.1 TRANSMISSION...............................................................................180 Memory Transmission and Parallel Memory Transmission ..................180 Immediate Transmission ......................................................................181 JBIG Transmission ...............................................................................181 D629 ii SM Adjustments .........................................................................................181 5.3.2 RECEPTION .....................................................................................182 5.4 FAX COMMUNICATION FEATURES ........................................................183 5.4.1 MULTI-PORT ....................................................................................183 5.4.2 DOCUMENT SERVER .....................................................................184 5.4.3 INTERNET MAIL COMMUNICATION...............................................185 Mail Transmission ................................................................................185 Mail Reception .....................................................................................187 Handling Mail Reception Errors............................................................189 Secure Internet Reception....................................................................190 Transfer Request: Request By Mail .....................................................190 E-Mail Options (Sub TX Mode) ............................................................191 5.5 IP-FAX .......................................................................................................195 5.5.1 WHAT IS IP-FAX? ............................................................................195 5.5.2 T.38 PACKET FORMAT ...................................................................195 UDP Related Switches .........................................................................195 5.5.3 SETTINGS ........................................................................................196 6. SPECIFICATIONS ...................................................................... 197 6.1 GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS ...................................................................197 6.1.1 FCU ..................................................................................................197 6.2 CAPABILITIES OF PROGRAMMABLE ITEMS .........................................199 6.3 IFAX SPECIFICATIONS ............................................................................201 6.4 IP-FAX SPECIFICATIONS.........................................................................203 6.5 FAX UNIT CONFIGURATION....................................................................204 SM iii D629 READ THIS FIRST Important Safety Notices Never install telephone wiring during a lightning storm. Never install telephone jacks in wet locations unless the jack is specifically designed for wet locations. Never touch uninsulated telephone wires or terminals unless the telephone line has been disconnected at the network interface. Use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines. Avoid using a telephone (other than a cordless type) during an electrical storm. There may be a remote risk of electric shock from lightning. Do not use a telephone or cellular phone to report a gas leak in the vicinity of the leak. Before installing the fax unit, switch off the main switch, and disconnect the power cord. The fax unit contains a lithium battery. The danger of explosion exists if a battery of this type is incorrectly replaced. Replace only with the same or an equivalent type recommended by the manufacturer. Discard batteries in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions and local regulations. Note for Australia: Unit must be connected to Telecommunication Network through a line cord which meets the requirements of ACA Technical Standard TS008. Symbols and Abbreviations Conventions Used in this Manual This manual uses several symbols. Symbol What it means Refer to section number Screw Connector E-ring Clip ring Clamp Cautions, Notes, etc. The following headings provide special information: Failure to obey warning information could result in serious injury or death. Obey these guidelines to ensure safe operation and prevent minor injuries. Obey these guidelines to avoid problems such as misfeeds, damage to originals, loss of valuable data and to prevent damage to the machine. Always obey these guidelines to avoid serious problems such as misfeeds, damage to originals, loss of valuable data and to prevent damage to the machine. bold is added for emphasis. This document provides tips and advice about how to best service the machine. Fax Option Installation Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 1. INSTALLATION 1.1 FAX OPTION INSTALLATION 1.1.1 COMPONENT CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list. No. SM Description Q'ty 1 FCU 1 2 Screw: M3x6 3 3 Telephone Cable (NA only) 1 4 Data Display Decal Sheet (21 languages) (EU only) 1 5 FCC Decal (NA only) 1 6 Serial Number Decal 1 7 G3 Decal 1 8 EMC Address (EU only) 1 9 Fax Decal for Operation Panel 1 1 D629 Fax Option Installation 1.1.2 FAX OPTION INSTALLATION PROCEDURE Before installation: If there is a printer option in the machine, print out all data in the printer buffer. Push the operation switch to put the machine in standby mode. Make sure the power LED is off, turn the main switch off, and then disconnect the power cord and the network cable. The copier must be connected to a properly grounded socket outlet. 1. Attach the serial number decal near the serial number plate of the mainframe. 2. For NA models, attach the FCC decal near the serial number plate of the mainframe. 3. Remove the controller cover [A] ( D629 x 2). 2 SM 4. Remove the FCU cover [A] ( x 3). 5. Remove the jumper [A] (set to OFF) and set it to Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Fax Option Installation Rev. 11/15/2012 ON. The machine may issue SC819, SC820 if the jumper is not set to "ON" correctly. (Sometimes these SC codes are not issued.) ⇒ 6. The following step is for units installed in Brazil only! For installation in Brazil, move the jumper switch (CN613) on the FAX board so that the edge is anchored at “1”. (So that the middle pin and the “1” pin are covered.) 7. In its default position, the switch covers the middle and “3” pin. Install the FCU [A] ( x 4; use the three screws which were removed in step 3). SM 3 D629 Fax Option Installation Rev. 11/15/2012 8. Reattach the controller cover [A] ( x2). 9. Connect the telephone cord to the "LINE 1" jack. 10. Attach the Super G3 decal [A]. 11. Attach the Fax decal under the function key on the operation panel. 12. Plug in the machine and turn on the main power switch. After you turn the machine on, if you see a message that tells you the SRAM has been formatted due to a problem with SRAM, turn the machine off and on again to clear the message. 13. Enter the "User Tools" mode and set date and time. 14. Do SP3102 in the fax SP mode and enter the serial number for the fax unit. 15. Enter the correct country code with SP1101-016 (NCU Country/Area Code Setting). D629 4 SM G3 Interface Board Installation Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 1.2 G3 INTERFACE BOARD INSTALLATION 1.2.1 COMPONENT CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list. No. SM Description Q'ty 1 SG3 Interface Unit 1 2 Flat Cable 1 3 Screw: M3x6 3 4 Telephone Cable (NA only) 1 5 FCC Decal (NA only) 1 5 D629 G3 Interface Board Installation 1.2.2 INSTALLATION: ONE G3 BOARD x 2). 1. Remove the controller cover [A] ( 2. If the fax unit is already installed in the machine, remove the FCU ( x 4). If not, remove the FCU cover ( x 3). 3. Attach one end (short length) of the flat cable to the connector [A] of the FCU board. 4. Attach the other end (long length) of the flat cable to the connector [B] of the CCUIF. 5. Attach the SG3 interface unit [A] ( D629 x 3). 6 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) G3 Interface Board Installation 6. Remove the knockout for LINE 2 from the controller cover. 7. Install the FCU in the machine (for details, refer to Fax Option Installation). 8. Reattach the controller cover ( 9. Connect the telephone cord to the LINE 2 jack. x2). 10. Enter the service mode. Set bit 1 of communication switch 16 to "1" (SP1-104-023) for PSTN-2. 11. Turn the main switch off and on. 12. Print out the system parameter list. Then check that "G3" shows as an option. 13. Set up and program the items required for PSTN-2 communications. 14. Attach the FCC decal near the serial number plate of the mainframe. SM 7 D629 G3 Interface Board Installation 1.2.3 INSTALLATION: TWO G3 BOARDS 1. Remove the SG3 board [A] from the second SG3 interface unit [B] for the two-SG3 board installation ( x 2). x 2). 2. Attach the SG3 board [A] to the interface board [C] of the first SG3 interface unit ( 3. Remove the controller cover [A] ( 4. If the fax unit is already installed in the machine, remove the FCU ( x 4). If not, remove the x 2). FCU cover ( x 3). 5. Attach one end (short length) of the flat cable to the connector [A] of the FCU board. 6. Attach the other end (long length) of the flat cable to the connector [B] of the CCUIF. D629 8 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) G3 Interface Board Installation x 3). 7. Attach the SG3 interface unit [A] ( 8. Remove the knockouts for LINE 2 and LINE 3 from the controller cover. 9. Install the FCU in the machine (for details, refer to Fax Option Installation). 10. Reattach the controller cover ( x2). 11. Connect the telephone cord to the LINE 3 jack. 12. Enter the service mode. Set bit 3 of communication switch 16 to "1" (SP1-104-023) for PSTN-3. 13. Turn the main switch off and on. 14. Print out the system parameter list. Then check that "G3" shows as an option. 15. Set up and program the items required for PSTN-3 communications. 16. Attach the FCC decal near the serial number plate of the mainframe. SM 9 D629 Fax Unit Options 1.3 FAX UNIT OPTIONS 1.3.1 MEMORY UNIT (G578) 1. FCU ( 2. Install the memory option in the memory slot [A]. 3. Reaasemble the machine. D629 p.1 "Fax Option Installation") 10 SM Fax Unit Options The optional handset is available for the U.S. version only. x 3). 1. Remove the scanner left cover [A] ( 2. Make two holes [B] in the scanner left cover. 3. SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 1.3.2 HANDSET (D645) Drill a hole from the outside of the cover with a screwdriver. Attach the handset support bracket [C] inside the scanner left cover. 11 D629 Fax Unit Options 4. Hold the handset bracket [D] and handset support bracket (set inside the scanner left cover). 5. Secure the handset bracket [D] ( 6. Install the scanner left cover on the machine. 7. Attach the clamp to the location [E]. 8. Set the handset on the handset bracket. 9. Clamp the hand set cord. x 2). 10. Connect the handset cable to the "TEL" jack at the rear of the machine. D629 12 SM FCU Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 2. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 2.1 FCU 2.1.1 SRAM DATA TRANSFER PROCEDURE When you replace the FCU board, transfer the SRAM data from the old FCU board to the new FCU board. Do the following procedure to back up the SRAM data. The following data can be transfered: TTI, RTI, CSI, Fax bit switch settings, RAM address settings, NCU parameter settings 1. Remove the controller cover [A] ( x 2). 2. Remove the fax unit [A] ( x 4). 3. Replace the FCU board. SM 13 D629 FCU 4. Move the jumper switch [A] of the new FCU board from "OFF" to "ON". 5. Remove the speaker [A] from the fax unit ( x 2, 6. Attach the speaker [A] to the fax unit as shown above. D629 14 x 2, x 1). SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) FCU 7. Connect the speaker harness to the new FCU board [A] through the hole [B]. 8. Connect a flat flexible cable [A] to the new FCU board. This cable is shipped with the new FCU board. SM The blue side [A] of the flat flexible cable must face outward as shown below. 15 D629 FCU 9. Install the fax unit [A] in the main machine ( x 3). 10. Move the Dip Switch [A] of the old FCU board from “OFF” to “ON”. 11. Connect the flat flexible cable to the old FCU board [A]. 12. Turn on the main power switch. 13. SRAM data transmission starts. When the transmission is completed, you will hear a beeper sound. D629 16 SM The beeper sound is the same volume as the speaker sound. The beeper sounds even if the sperker sound is turned off. If the beeper does not sound, turn the main power switch on and off repeatedly and do the transmission procedure 2 or 3 times. If the beeper does not sound after turning the main switch on and off 3 times, you need to input the settings stored in SRAM memory manually. 14. When “Ready” appears on the copy display, turn off the main power switch, and then disconnect the flat flexible cable from the old FCU board. 15. Remove the fax unit from the main machine ( x 3). 16. Disconnect the flat flexible cable from the new FCU board. 17. Remove the speaker [A] from the fax unit ( x 1). 18. Install the speaker [A] in the fax unit as shown above ( x 2, SM 17 x 2, x 1). D629 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) FCU FCU 19. Slide the fax unit [A] into the main machine ( x 4). 20. Reattach the controller cover ( x 2). 21. Turn on the main power switch, then do SP6-101 to print the system parameter list. 22. Check the system parameter list to make sure that the data was transferred correctly. 23. Set the correct date and time with the User Tools: User Tools > System Settings > Timer Setting > Set Date/Time. D629 If any of the SRAM data was not transferred, input those settings manually. 18 SM Error Codes Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 3. TROUBLESHOOTING 3.1 ERROR CODES If an error code occurs, retry the communication. If the same problem occurs, try to fix the problem as suggested below. Note that some error codes appear only in the error code display and on the service report. Code 0-00 Meaning Suggested Cause/Action DIS/NSF not detected within Check the line connection. 40 s of Start being pressed The machine at the other end may be incompatible. Replace the FCU. Check for DIS/NSF with an oscilloscope. If the rx signal is weak, there may be a bad line. 0-01 DCN received unexpectedly The other party is out of paper or has a jammed printer. The other party pressed Stop during communication. 0-03 Incompatible modem at the The other terminal is incompatible. other end SM 19 D629 Error Codes Code 0-04 Meaning Suggested Cause/Action CFR or FTT not received after modem training Check the line connection. Try changing the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings. Replace the FCU. The other terminal may be faulty; try sending to another machine. If the rx signal is weak or defective, there may be a bad line. Cross reference Tx level - NCU Parameter 01 (PSTN) Cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN) Dedicated Tx parameters in Service Program Mode 0-05 Modem training fails even G3 Check the line connection. shifts down to 2400 bps. Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer. Replace the FCU. Check for line problems. Cross reference See error code 0-04. 0-06 The other terminal did not Check the line connection. reply to DCS Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings. Replace the FCU. The other end may be defective or incompatible; try sending to another machine. Check for line problems. Cross reference See error code 0-04. D629 20 SM Error Codes 0-07 Meaning Suggested Cause/Action No post-message response Check the line connection. from the other end after a Replace the FCU. page was sent The other end may have jammed or run Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Code out of paper. The other end user may have disconnected the call. Check for a bad line. The other end may be defective; try sending to another machine. 0-08 The other end sent RTN or Check the line connection. PIN after receiving a page, Replace the FCU. because there were too many The other end may have jammed, or run errors out of paper or memory space. Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings. The other end may have a defective modem/FCU; try sending to another machine. Check for line problems and noise. Cross reference Tx level - NCU Parameter 01 (PSTN) Cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN) Dedicated Tx parameters in Service Program Mode 0-14 Non-standard post message response code received Incompatible or defective remote terminal; try sending to another machine. Noisy line: resend. Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings. Replace the FCU. Cross reference See error code 0-08. SM 21 D629 Error Codes Code 0-15 Meaning Suggested Cause/Action The other terminal is not The other terminal is not capable of accepting capable of specific functions. the following functions, or the other terminal’s memory is full. 0-16 Confidential rx Transfer function SEP/SUB/PWD/SID CFR or FTT not detected after Check the line connection. modem training in confidential Replace the FCU. or transfer mode Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings. The other end may have disconnected, or it may be defective; try calling another machine. If the rx signal level is too low, there may be a line problem. Cross reference See error code 0-08. 0-17 0-20 Communication was If the Stop key was not pressed and this error interrupted by pressing the keeps occurring, replace the operation panel or Stop key the operation panel drive board. Facsimile data not received Check the line connection. within 6 s of retraining Replace the FCU. Check for line problems. Try calling another fax machine. Try adjusting the reconstruction time for the first line and/or rx cable equalizer setting. Cross reference Reconstruction time - G3 Switch 0A, bit 6 Rx cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN) D629 22 SM Error Codes Meaning 0-21 EOL signal (end-of-line) from Suggested Cause/Action Check the connections between the FCU the other end not received and line. within 5 s of the previous EOL Check for line noise or other line problems. signal Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Code Replace the FCU. The remote machine may be defective or may have disconnected. Cross reference Maximum interval between EOLs and between ECM frames - G3 Bit Switch 0A, bit 4 0-22 The signal from the other end Check the line connection. was interrupted for more than Replace the FCU. the acceptable modem carrier drop time (default: 200 ms) Defective remote terminal. Check for line noise or other line problems. Try adjusting the acceptable modem carrier drop time. Cross reference Acceptable modem carrier drop time - G3 Switch 0A, bits 0 and 1 0-23 Too many errors during Check the line connection. reception Replace the FCU. Defective remote terminal Check for line noise or other line problems. Try asking the other end to adjust their tx level. Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer setting and/or rx error criteria. Cross reference Rx cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN) Rx error criteria - Communication Switch 02, bits 0 and 1 0-29 SM Data block format failure in Check for line noise or other line problems. ECM reception Check the FCU - NCU connectors. Replace the NCU or FCU. 23 D629 Error Codes Code 0-30 Meaning Suggested Cause/Action The other terminal did not Check the line connection. reply to NSS(A) in AI short Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable protocol mode equalizer settings. The other terminal may not be compatible. Cross reference Dedicated tx parameters - Section 4 0-32 The other terminal sent a Check the protocol dump list. DCS, which contained Ask the other party to contact the functions that the receiving manufacturer. machine cannot handle. 0-33 The data reception (not ECM) Check the line connection. is not completed within 10 The other terminal may have a defective minutes. 0-52 0-55 0-56 Polarity changed during modem/FCU. Check the line connection. communication Retry communication. FCU does not detect the SG3. FCU firmware or board defective. SG3 firmware or board defective. The stored message data SG3 firmware or board defective. exceeds the capacity of the mailbox in the SG3. 0-70 The communication mode The other terminal did not have a specified in CM/JM was not compatible communication mode (e.g., the available other terminal was a V.34 data modem and (V.8 calling and called not a fax modem.) terminal) A polling tx file was not ready at the other terminal when polling rx was initiated from the calling terminal. 0-74 The calling terminal fell back to T.30 mode, because it D629 The calling terminal could not detect ANSam due to noise, etc. could not detect ANSam after ANSam was too short to detect. sending CI. Check the line connection and condition. Try making a call to another V.8/V.34 fax. 24 SM Error Codes 0-75 Meaning Suggested Cause/Action The called terminal fell back to 0-76 The terminal could not detect ANSam. T.30 mode, because it could Check the line connection and condition. not detect a CM in response Try receiving a call from another V.8/V.34 to ANSam (ANSam timeout). The calling terminal fell back Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Code fax. to T.30 mode, because it The called terminal could not detect a CM due to noise, etc. could not detect a JM in Check the line connection and condition. response to CM Try making a call to another V.8/V.34 fax. (CM timeout). 0-77 The called terminal fell back to The calling terminal could not detect a JM T.30 mode, because it could due to noise, etc. not detect a CJ in response to A network that has narrow bandwidth JM cannot pass JM to the other end. (JM timeout). Check the line connection and condition. Try receiving a call from another V.8/V.34 fax. 0-79 The called terminal detected Check for line noise or other line problems. CI while waiting for a V.21 If this error occurs, the called terminal falls signal. 0-80 0-81 The line was disconnected these phases. Serious noise, narrow 2 – line probing. bandwidth, or low signal level can cause The line was disconnected 3 – equalizer training. The line was disconnected these errors. If these errors happen at the transmitting terminal: Try making a call at a later time. Try using V.17 or a slower modem using dedicated tx parameters. due to a timeout in the V.34 SM The guard timer expired while starting due to a timeout in V.34 phase due to a timeout in V.34 phase 0-82 back to T.30 mode. phase 4 – control channel Try increasing the tx level. start-up. Try adjusting the tx cable equalizer setting. 25 D629 Error Codes Code 0-83 Meaning Suggested Cause/Action The line was disconnected If these errors happen at the receiving terminal: due to a timeout in the V.34 Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer setting. control channel restart Try increasing the tx level. sequence. Try using V.17 or a slower modem if the same error is frequent when receiving from multiple senders. 0-84 The line was disconnected The signal did not stop within 10 s. due to abnormal signaling in Turn off the main power switch, then turn it back on. V.34 phase 4 – control channel start-up. If the same error is frequent, replace the FCU. 0-85 The line was disconnected The signal did not stop within 10 s. due to abnormal signaling in Turn off the main power switch, then turn it back on. V.34 control channel restart. If the same error is frequent, replace the FCU. 0-86 The line was disconnected The other terminal was incompatible. because the other terminal Ask the other party to contact the requested a data rate using manufacturer. MPh that was not available in the currently selected symbol rate. 0-87 The control channel started The receiving terminal restarted the control after an unsuccessful primary channel because data reception in the channel. primary channel was not successful. This does not result in an error communication. 0-88 The line was disconnected Try using a lower data rate at the start. because PPR was Try adjusting the cable equalizer setting. transmitted/received 9 (default) times within the same ECM frame. D629 26 SM Error Codes 2-11 Meaning Suggested Cause/Action Only one V.21 connection flag Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Code Replace the FCU. was received 2-12 Modem clock irregularity Replace the FCU. 2-13 Modem initialization error Turn off the machine, then turn it back on. Update the modem ROM. Replace the FCU. 2-22 2-23 Counter overflow error of If error occurs frequently, change the settings JBIG chip for resolution, paper size, compression type. JBIG compression or Turn off the machine, then turn it back on. reconstruction error 2-24 JBIG ASIC error 2-25 JBIG data reconstruction error (BIH error) 2-26 JBIG data reconstruction error Turn off the machine, then turn it back on. JBIG data error Check the sender’s JBIG function. Update the FCU ROM. (Float marker error) 2-27 JBIG data reconstruction error (End marker error) 2-28 JBIG data reconstruction error (Timeout) 2-29 JBIG trailing edge maker error 2-50 2-51 FCU defective Check the destination device. The machine resets itself for a If this is frequent, update the ROM, or fatal FCU system error replace the FCU. The machine resets itself because of a fatal If this is frequent, update the ROM, or replace the FCU. communication error SM 27 D629 Error Codes Code Meaning 2-53 Snd msg() in the manual task Suggested Cause/Action The user did the same operation many is an error because the times, and this gave too much load to the mailbox for the operation task machine. is full. 4-01 4-10 Line current was cut Communication failed Check the line connector. Check for line problems. Replace the FCU. Get the ID Codes the same and/or the because of an ID Code CSIs programmed correctly, then resend. mismatch (Closed Network) or The machine at the other end may be Tel. No./CSI mismatch defective. (Protection against Wrong Connections) 5-00 Data reconstruction not Replace the FCU. possible 5-10 DCR timer expired Replace the FCU. 5-20 Storage impossible because Temporary memory shortage. of a lack of memory Test the SAF memory. 5-21 Memory overflow 5-23 Print data error when printing Test the SAF memory. a substitute rx or confidential Ask the other end to resend the message. Replace an SD card or HDD. Replace the FCU. G3 ECM - T1 time out during Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer. reception of facsimile data Replace the FCU. rx message 5-25 6-00 6-01 SAF file access error G3 ECM - no V.21 signal was received 6-02 D629 G3 ECM - EOR was received 28 SM Error Codes 6-04 Meaning G3 ECM - RTC not detected Suggested Cause/Action Check the line connection. Check for a bad line or defective remote Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Code terminal. 6-05 G3 ECM - facsimile data Replace the FCU. Check the line connection. frame not received within 18 s Check for a bad line or defective remote of CFR, but there was no line terminal. fail Replace the FCU. Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer Cross reference 6-06 6-08 6-09 Rx cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN) G3 ECM - coding/decoding Defective FCU. error The other terminal may be defective. G3 ECM - PIP/PIN received in The other end pressed Stop during reply to PPS.NULL communication. G3 ECM - ERR received The other terminal may be defective. Check for a noisy line. Adjust the tx levels of the communicating machines. 6-10 6-21 6-22 G3 ECM - error frames still See code 6-05. Check for line noise. received at the other end after Adjust the tx level (use NCU parameter 01 all communication attempts at or the dedicated tx parameter for that 2400 bps address). Check the line connection. Defective remote terminal. V.21 flag detected during high The other terminal may be defective or speed modem communication incompatible. The machine resets the Check for line noise. sequence because of an If the same error occurs frequently, replace the FCU. abnormal handshake in the V.34 control channel SM Defective remote terminal. 29 D629 Error Codes Code 6-99 Meaning Suggested Cause/Action V.21 signal not stopped within Replace the FCU. 6s 13-17 SIP user name registration Double registration of the SIP user name. error Capacity for user-name registration in the SIP server is not sufficient. 13-18 13-24 SIP server access error SIP authentication error Incorrect initial setting for the SIP server. Defective SIP server. Registered password in the device does not match the password in the SIP server. 13-25 Network I/F setting error IPV4 is not active in the active protocol setting. 13-26 Network I/F setting error at IP address of the device is not registered. Active protocol setting does not match the power on I/F setting for SIP server. IP address of the device is not registered. 13-27 IP address setting error IP address of the device is not registered. 14-00 SMTP Send Error Error occurred during sending to the SMTP server. Occurs for any error other than 14-01 to 16. For example, the mail address of the system administrator is not registered. 14-01 SMTP Connection Failed Failed to connect to the SMTP server (timeout) because the server could not be found. D629 The PC is not ready to transfer files. SMTP server not functioning correctly. The DNS IP address is not registered. Network not operating correctly. Destination folder selection not correct. 30 SM Error Codes Meaning 14-02 No Service by SMTP Service Suggested Cause/Action (421) Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Code SMTP server operating incorrectly, or the destination for direct SMTP sending is not correct. Contact the system administrator and check that the SMTP server has the correct settings and operates correctly. Contact the system administrator for direct SMTP sending and check the sending destination. 14-03 Access to SMTP Server Failed to access the SMTP server because the access is denied. Denied (450) SMTP server operating incorrectly. Contact the system administrator to determine if there is a problem with the SMTP server and to check that the SMTP server settings are correct. Folder send destination is incorrect. Contact the system administrator to determine that the SMTP server settings and path to the server are correct. Device settings incorrect. Confirm that the user name and password settings are correct. Direct SMTP destination incorrect. Contact the system administrator to determine if there is a problem at the destination at that the settings at the destination are correct. 14-04 Access to SMTP Server SMTP server operating incorrectly Denied (550) Direct SMTP sending not operating correctly SM 31 D629 Error Codes Code Meaning 14-05 SMTP Server HDD Full (452) Suggested Cause/Action Failed to access the SMTP server because the HDD on the server is full. Insufficient free space on the HDD of the SMTP server. Contact the system administrator and check the amount of space remaining on the SMTP server HDD. Insufficient free space on the HDD where the destination folder is located. Contact the system administrator and check the amount of space remaining on the HDD where the target folder is located. Insufficient free space on the HDD at the target destination for SMTP direct sending. Contact the system administrator and check the amount of space remaining on the target HDD. 14-06 User Not Found on SMTP The designated user does not exist. Server (551) The designated user does not exist on the SMTP server. The designated address is not for use with direct SMTP sending. 14-07 Data Send to SMTP Server Failed to access the SMTP server because the transmission failed. Failed (4XX) PC not operating correctly. SMTP server operating incorrectly Network not operating correctly. Destination folder setting incorrect. Direct SMTP sending not operating correctly. D629 32 SM Error Codes 14-08 Meaning Data Send to SMTP Server Suggested Cause/Action Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Code Failed to access the SMTP server because the transmission failed. Failed (5XX) SMTP server operating incorrectly Destination folder setting incorrect. Direct SMTP sending not operating correctly. 14-09 Authorization Failed for Software application error. POP-Before-SMTP or SMTP authorization Sending to SMTP Server 14-10 Addresses Exceeded failed. Incorrect setting for file transfer Number of broadcast addresses exceeded the limit for the SMTP server. 14-11 Buffer Full The send buffer is full so the transmission could not be completed. Buffer is full due to using Scan-to-Email while the buffer is being used send mail at the same time. 14-12 Data Size Too Large Transmission was cancelled because the detected size of the file was too large. 14-13 Send Cancelled Processing is interrupted because the user pressed Stop. 14-14 Security Locked File Error Update the software because of the defective software. 14-15 Mail Data Error The transmitting a mail is interrupted via DCS due to the incorrect data. Update the software because of the defective software. 14-16 Maximum Division Number Error When a mail is divided for the mail transmission and the division number of a mail are more than the specified number, the mail transmission is interrupted. Update the software because of the defective software. SM 33 D629 Error Codes Code 14-17 Meaning Incorrect Ticket Suggested Cause/Action Update the software because of the defective software. 14-18 Access to MCS File Error The access to MCS file is denied due to the no permission of access. Update the software because of the defective software. 14-20 SMTP Authentication error Make sure the administrator's e-mail address is same as the SMTP authentication address or POP before SMTP address. 14-21 Transmission error of S/MIME Register the correct user certificate and device certificate. 14-30 MCS File Creation Failed Failed to create the MCS file because: The number of files created with other applications on the Document Server has exceeded the limit. 14-31 UFS File Creation Failed HDD is full or not operating correctly. Software error. UFS file could not be created: Not enough space in UFS area to handle both Scan-to-Email and IFAX transmission. 14-32 Cancelled the Mail Due to HDD full or not operating correctly. Software error. Error detected with NFAX and send was Error Detected by NFAX 14-33 No Mail Address For the Machine cancelled due to a software error. Neither the mail address of the machine nor the mail address of the network administrator is registered. D629 34 SM Error Codes 14-34 Meaning Address designated in the Suggested Cause/Action Operational error in normal mail sending or direct SMTP sending. domain for SMTP sending does not exist Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Code Check the address selected in the address book for SMTP sending. 14-50 Mail Job Task Error Check the domain selection. Due to an FCU mail job task error, the send was cancelled: Address book was being edited during creation of the notification mail. 14-51 Software error. UCS Destination Download Not even one return notification can be Error downloaded: The address book was being edited. The number for the specified destination does not exist (it was deleted or edited after the job was created). 14-60 Send Cancel Failed The cancel operation by the user failed to cancel the send operation. 14-61 Notification Mail Send Failed for All Destinations 14-62 Transmission Error due to the All addresses for return notification mail failed. existence of zero line page When the 0 line page exists in received pages with G3 communication, the transmission is interrupted. 15-01 POP3/IMAP4 Server Not Registered At startup, the system detected that the IP address of the POP3/IMAP4 server has not been registered in the machine. 15-02 POP3/IMAP4 Mail Account Information Not Registered The POP3/IMAP4 mail account has not been registered. 15-03 Mail Address Not Registered The mail address has not been registered. 15-10 DCS Mail Receive Error Error other than 15-11 to 15-18. SM 35 D629 Error Codes Code 15-11 Meaning Connection Error Suggested Cause/Action The DNS or POP3/IMAP4 server could not be found: The IP address for DNS or POP3/IMAP4 server is not stored in the machine. 15-12 Authorization Error The DNS IP address is not registered. Network not operating correctly. POP3/IMAP4 send authorization failed: Incorrect IFAX user name or password. Access was attempted by another device, such as the PC. 15-13 Receive Buffer Full POP3/IMAP4 settings incorrect. Occurs only during manual reception. Transmission cannot be received due to insufficient buffer space. The buffer is being used for mail send or Scan-to-Email. 15-14 Mail Header Format Error The mail header is not standard format. For example, the Date line description is incorrect. 15-15 Mail Divide Error The e-mail is not in standard format. There is no boundary between parts of the e-mail, including the header. 15-16 Mail Size Receive Error The mail cannot be received because it is too large. 15-17 Receive Timeout May occur during manual receiving only because the network is not operating correctly. 15-18 Incomplete Mail Received Only one portion of the mail was received. 15-31 Final Destination for Transfer The format of the final destination for the Request Reception Format transfer request was incorrect. Error D629 36 SM Error Codes 15-39 Meaning Suggested Cause/Action Send/Delivery Destination The transmission cannot be delivered to the Error final destination: Destination file format is incorrect. Could not create the destination for the file Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Code transmission. 15-41 SMTP Receive Error Reception rejected because the transaction exceeded the limit for the “Auth. E-mail RX” setting. 15-42 Off Ramp Gateway Error The delivery destination address was specified with Off Ramp Gateway OFF. 15-43 Address Format Error Format error in the address of the Off Ramp Gateway. 15-44 Addresses Over The number of addresses for the Off Ramp Gateway exceeded the limit of 30. 15-61 Attachment File Format Error 15-62 TIFF File Compatibility Error Could not receive transmission due to: The attached file is not TIFF format. Resolution error Image of resolution greater than 200 dpi without extended memory. Resolution is not supported. Page size error The page size was larger than A3. Compression error File was compressed with other than MH, MR, or MMR. 15-63 TIFF Parameter Error The TIFF file sent as the attachment could not be received because the TIFF header is incorrect: The TIFF file attachment is a type not supported. SM The TIFF file attachment is corrupted. Software error. 37 D629 Error Codes Code 15-64 Meaning TIFF Decompression Error Suggested Cause/Action The file received as an attachment caused the TIFF decompression error: The TIFF format of the attachment is corrupted. 15-71 Not Binary Image Data Software error. The file could not be received because the attachment was not binary image data. 15-73 MDN Status Error Could not find the Disposition line in the header of the Return Receipt, or there is a problem with the firmware. 15-74 MDN Message ID Error Could not find the Original Message ID line in the header of the Return Receipt, or there is a problem with the firmware. 15-80 Mail Job Task Read Error Could not receive the transmission because the destination buffer is full and the destination could not be created (this error may occur when receiving a transfer request or a request for notification of reception). 15-81 Repeated Destination Registration Error Could not repeat receive the transmission because the destination buffer is full and the destination could not be created (this error may occur when receiving a transfer request or a request for notification of reception). 15-91 Send Registration Error Could not receive the file for transfer to the final destination: The format of the final destination or the transfer destination is incorrect. Destinations are full so the final and transfer destinations could not be created. D629 38 SM Error Codes 15-92 Meaning Memory Overflow Suggested Cause/Action Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Code Transmission could not be received because memory overflowed during the transaction. 15-93 Memory Access Error Transaction could not complete due to a malfunction of SAF memory. 15-94 Incorrect ID Code The machine rejected an incoming e-mail for transfer request, because the ID code in the incoming e-mail did not match the ID code registered in the machine. 15-95 Transfer Station Function The machine rejected an incoming e-mail for transfer because the transfer function was unavailable. 22-00 Original length exceeded the maximum scan length Divide the original into more than one page. Check the resolution used for scanning. Lower the scan resolution if possible. 22-01 Add optional page memory. Memory overflow while Wait for the files in the queue to be sent. receiving Delete unnecessary files from memory. Transfer the substitute reception files to an another fax machine, if the machine’s printer is busy or out of order. Add an optional SAF memory card or hard disk. 22-02 Tx or rx job stalled due to line disconnection at the other end The job started normally but did not finish normally; data may or may not have been received fully. 22-04 22-05 Restart the machine. The machine cannot store Update the ROM received data in the SAF Replace the FCU. No G3 parameter confirmation Defective FCU board or firmware. answer SM 39 D629 Error Codes Code 23-00 25-00 Meaning Suggested Cause/Action Data read timeout during Restart the machine. construction Replace the FCU. The machine software resets Update the ROM itself after a fatal transmission Replace the FCU. error occurred F0-xx V.34 modem error Replace the FCU. F6-xx SG3 modem error Update the SG3 modem ROM. Replace the SG3 board. Check for line noise or other line problems. Try communicating another V.8/V.34 fax. D629 40 SM 3.2 IFAX TROUBLESHOOTING Use the following procedures to determine whether the machine or another part of the network is causing the problem. Communication Item Route General LAN 1. Connection with Action [Remarks] to the machine. the LAN 2. LAN activity Check that the LAN cable is connected Check that the LEDs on the hub are lit. Check that other devices connected to the LAN can communicate through the LAN. Between IFAX and 1. Network settings PC on the PC [Is the IP address registered in the TCP/IP Check the network settings on the PC. properties in the network setup correct? Check the IP address with the administrator of the network.] 2. Check that PC can connect with the machine Use the “ping” command on the PC to contact the machine. [At the MS-DOS prompt, type ping then the IP address of the machine, then press Enter.] 3. LAN settings in Check the LAN parameters the machine Check if there is an IP address conflict with other PCs. [Use the “Network” function in the User Tools. If there is an IP address conflict, inform the administrator.] SM 41 D629 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) IFAX Troubleshooting IFAX Troubleshooting Communication Route Item Action [Remarks] Between machine 1. LAN settings in Check the LAN parameters and e-mail server the machine Check if there is an IP address conflict with other PCs. [Use the “Network” function in the User Tools. If there is an IP address conflict, inform the administrator.] 2. E-mail account on Make sure that the machine can log the server into the e-mail server. Check that the account and password stored in the server are the same as in the machine. [Ask the administrator to check.] 3. E-mail server Make sure that the client devices which have an account in the server can send/receive e-mail. [Ask the administrator to check. Send a test e-mail with the machine’s own number as the destination. The machine receives the returned e-mail if the communication is performed successfully.] Between e-mail 1. E-mail account on Make sure that the PC can log into the server and internet the Server e-mail server. Check that the account and password stored in the server are the same as in the machine. [Ask the administrator to check.] D629 42 SM IFAX Troubleshooting Item Route 2. E-mail server Action [Remarks] Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Communication Make sure that the client devices which have an account in the server can send/receive e-mail. [Ask the administrator to check. Send a test e-mail with the machine’s own number as the destination. The machine receives the returned e-mail if the communication is performed successfully.] 3. Destination e-mail Make sure that the e-mail address is address actually used. Check that the e-mail address contains no incorrect characters such as spaces. 4. Router settings Use the “ping” command to contact the router. Check that other devices connected to the router can sent data over the router. [Ask the administrator of the server to check.] 5. Error message by Check whether e-mail can be sent to e-mail from the another address on the same network, network of the using the application e-mail software. destination. Check the error e-mail message. [Inform the administrator of the LAN.] SM 43 D629 IP-Fax Troubleshooting 3.3 IP-FAX TROUBLESHOOTING 3.3.1 IP-FAX TRANSMISSION Cannot send by IP Address/Host Name Check Point Action 1 LAN cable connected? Check the LAN cable connection. 2 Specified IP address/host name correct? Check the IP address/host name. Cannot breach the firewall. Send by 3 Firewall/NAT is installed? using another method (Fax, Internet Fax) 4 Transmission sent manually? Manual sending not supported. 5 IP address of local machine registered? Register the IP address. Remote terminal port number setting other 6 than 1720 (when using H.323) or 5060 Send by specifying the port number. (when using SIP)? 7 8 9 Confirm the port number of the remote Specified port number correct? fax. DNS server registered when host name Contact the network administrator. specified? Check whether the remote fax is a T38 Remote fax a T.38 terminal? terminal. Check that the remote fax is switched 10 Remote fax switched off or busy? on. Request the network administrator to increase the bandwidth. 11 Network bandwidth too narrow? Raise the delay level. IPFAX SW 01 Bit 0 to 3 D629 44 SM IP-Fax Troubleshooting Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) IP-Fax bandwidth is the same as the DCS speed. Set IP-Fax SW00 Bit 6 to 1. Check whether the remote fax 12 Remote fax cancelled transmission? SM cancelled the transmission. 45 D629 IP-Fax Troubleshooting Cannot send via VoIP Gateway Check Point Action 1 LAN cable connected? Check the LAN cable connection. 2 VoIP Gateway T.38 standard? Contact the network administrator. 3 VoIP Gateway installed correctly? Contact the network administrator. 4 VoIP Gateway power switched on? Contact the network administrator. 5 6 Is the IP address/host name of the Check the IP address/host name. specified Gateway correct? Number of the specified fax correct? Check the remote fax number. Cannot breach the firewall. Send by 7 Firewall/NAT is installed? using another method (Fax, Internet Fax) 8 Transmission sent manually? Manual sending not supported. 9 IP address of local fax registered? Register the IP address. 10 DNS registered when host name Contact the network administrator. specified? 11 Remote fax a G3 fax? Check that the remote fax is a G3 fax. 12 G3 fax is connected to VoIP gateway? Check that G3 fax is connected. 13 Remote G3 fax turned on? Check that G3 fax is switched on. Request the network administrator to increase the bandwidth. Raise the network delay level. 14 Network bandwidth too narrow? IPFAX SW 01 Bit 0 to 3 IP-Fax bandwidth is the same as the DCS speed. Set IP-Fax SW00 Bit 6 to 1. D629 46 SM IP-Fax Troubleshooting Check Point 1 LAN cable connected? 2 Number of specified Alias fax correct? Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Cannot send by Alias Fax number. Action Check the LAN cable connection. Confirm the Alias of the remote fax. Error Code: 13-14 Cannot breach the firewall. Send by 3 Firewall/NAT installed? using another method (Fax, Internet Fax) 4 Transmission sent manually? 5 Gatekeeper/SIP server installed correctly? Contact the network administrator. 6 7 Manual sending not supported. Gatekeeper/SIP server power switched Contact the network administrator. on? IP address/host name of Gatekeeper/SIP server correct? Check the IP address/host name. DNS server registered when 8 Gatekeeper/SIP server host name Contact the network administrator. specified? Check the settings. 9 Enable H.323/Enable SIP SW is set to on? See User Parameter SW 34 Bit 0/SW 34 Bit 1 10 IP address of local fax registered? Register the IP address of the local fax. Register the Alias number of the local 11 Alias number of local fax registered? fax. 12 Remote fax registered in Gatekeeper? Contact the network administrator. Check whether the remote fax is a T38 13 Remote fax a T.38 terminal? terminal. 14 Remote fax switched off or busy? SM Contact the network administrator. 47 D629 IP-Fax Troubleshooting Request the system administrator to increase the bandwidth. Raise the delay level. 15 Network bandwidth too narrow? IPFAX SW 01 Bit 0 to 3 Lower the modem transmission baud rate. IPFAX SW 05 Check whether the remote fax 16 Remote fax cancelled transmission? D629 cancelled the transmission. 48 SM IP-Fax Troubleshooting Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 3.3.2 IP-FAX RECEPTION Cannot receive via IP Address/Host Name. Check Point 1 LAN cable connected? 2 Firewall/NAT is installed? 3 IP address of local fax registered? 4 5 Action Check the LAN cable connection. Cannot breach the firewall. Send by using another method (Fax, Internet Fax) Register the IP address. Port number specified at remote sender Request the sender to specify the port fax (if required)? number. Specified port number correct (if Request the sender to check the port required)? number. Contact the network administrator. 6 DNS server registered when host name specified on sender side? The sender machine displays this error code if the sender fax is a Ricoh model. Request the system administrator to increase the bandwidth. 7 Network bandwidth too narrow? Lower the start modem reception baud rate on the receiving side. IPFAX SW06 8 SM Remote fax cancelled transmission? Check whether the remote fax cancelled the transmission. 49 D629 IP-Fax Troubleshooting Cannot receive by VoIP Gateway. Check Point 1 LAN cable connected? Action Check the LAN cable connection. Cannot breach the firewall. Request the 2 Firewall/NAT is installed? remote fax to send by using another method (Fax, Internet Fax) 3 VoIP Gateway installed correctly? Contact the network administrator. 4 VoIP Gateway power switched on? Contact the network administrator. 5 6 IP address/host name of specified VoIP Request the remote fax to check the IP Gateway correct on sender’s side? DNS server registered when host name specified on sender side? address/host name. Contact the network administrator. Request the network administrator to 7 Network bandwidth too narrow? 8 G3 fax connected? Check that G3 fax is connected. 9 G3 fax power switched on? Check that G3 fax is switched on. D629 increase the bandwidth. 50 SM IP-Fax Troubleshooting Check Point 1 LAN cable connected? Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Cannot receive by Alias Fax number. Action Check the LAN cable connection. Cannot the breach firewall. Request the 2 Firewall/NAT is installed? remote fax to send by using another method (Fax, Internet Fax) Contact the network administrator. 3 Gatekeeper/SIP server installed correctly? The sender machine displays this error code when the sender fax is a Ricoh model. Contact the network administrator. 4 Power to Gatekeeper/SIP server switched on? The sender machine displays this error code when the sender fax is a Ricoh model. Request the sender to check the IP IP address/host name of 5 address/host name. Gatekeeper/SIP server correct on the sender’s side? The sender machine displays this error code when the sender fax is a Ricoh model. Contact the network administrator. DNS server registered when 6 Gatekeeper/SIP server host name specified on sender’s side? The sender machine displays this error code when the sender fax is a Ricoh model. Request the sender to check the settings. 7 Enable H.323/Enable SIP SW is set to User Parameter SW 34 Bit 0/SW 34 Bit 1 on? Only if the remote sender fax is a Ricoh fax. SM 51 D629 IP-Fax Troubleshooting 8 Local fax IP address registered? Register the IP address. 9 Local fax Alias number registered? Register the Alias number. Request the system administrator to increase the bandwidth. 10 Network bandwidth too narrow? Lower the start modem reception baud rate on the receiving side. IPFAX SW06 11 Remote fax cancelled transmission? Check whether the remote fax cancelled the transmission. Contact the network administrator. 12 Local fax registered in Gatekeeper/SIP server? The sender machine displays this error code when the sender fax is a Ricoh model. D629 52 SM Cautions Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 4. SERVICE TABLES 4.1 CAUTIONS Never turn off the main power switch when the power LED is lit or flashing. To avoid damaging the hard disk or memory, press the operation power switch to switch the power off, wait for the power LED to go off, and then switch the main power switch off. The main power LED lights or flashes while the platen cover or ARDF is open, while the main machine is communicating with a facsimile or the network server, or while the machine is accessing the hard disk or memory for reading or writing data. SM 53 D629 Service Program Tables 4.2 SERVICE PROGRAM TABLES 4.2.1 SP1-XXX (BIT SWITCHES) Bit Switches 1 Mode No. Function System Switch Change the bit switches for system settings for the 101 001 – 032 00 – 1F fax option "System Switches" in "Bit Switches - 1" Ifax Switch Change the bit switches for internet fax settings for 102 001 – 016 00 – 0F the fax option "I-Fax Switches" in "Bit Switches - 2" Printer Switch Change the bit switches for printer settings for the fax 103 001 – 016 00 – 0F option "Printer Switches" in "Bit Switches - 2" Communication Switch Change the bit switches for communication settings 104 001 – 032 00 – 1F for the fax option "Communication Switches" in "Bit Switches - 3" G3-1 Switch Change the bit switches for the protocol settings of 105 001 – 016 00 – 0F the standard G3 board "G3 Switches" in "Bit Switches - 4" G3-2 Switch Change the bit switches for the protocol settings of 106 001 – 016 00 – 0F the optional G3 board "G3-2 and G3-3 Switches" in "Bit Switches - 5" D629 54 SM Service Program Tables Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) G3-3 Switch Change the bit switches for the protocol settings of 107 001 – 016 00 – 0F the optional G3 board "G3-2 and G3-3 Switches" in "Bit Switches - 5" G4 Internal Switch 108 001 – 032 00 – 1F Not used (Do not change the bit switches) G4 Parameter Switch 109 001 – 016 00 – 0F Not used (Do not change the bit switches) IP fax Switch Change the bit switches for optional IP fax 111 001 – 016 00 – 0F parameters "IP Fax Switches" in "Bit Switches - 6" 4.2.2 SP2-XXX (RAM DATA) 2 Mode No. Function RAM Read/Write 101 Change RAM data for the fax board directly. 001 p.164 "Service RAM Addresses" Memory Dump 001 102 002 003 004 103 SM G3-1 Memory Dump Print out RAM data for the fax board. p.164 "Service RAM Addresses" G3-2 Memory Print out RAM data for the optional SG3 Dump board. G3-3 Memory Print out RAM data for the optional SG3 Dump board. G4 Memory Dump Not used G3-1 NCU Parameters 55 D629 Service Program Tables 001 – 023 CC, 01 – 22 NCU parameter settings for the standard G3 board. p.140 "NCU Parameters" G3-2 NCU Parameters 104 001 – 023 CC, 01 – 22 NCU parameter settings for the optional G3 board. p.140 "NCU Parameters" G3-3 NCU Parameters 105 001 – 023 D629 CC, 01 – 22 NCU parameter settings for the optional G3 board. 56 p.140 "NCU Parameters" SM Service Program Tables 3 Mode No. Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 4.2.3 SP3-XXX (TEL LINE SETTINGS) Function Service Station 101 001 Fax Number Enter the fax number of the service station. 002 Select Line Select the line type. Serial Number 102 000 Enter the fax unit’s serial number. PSTN-1 Port Settings Select the line type setting for the G3-1 line. If 001 Select Line the machine is installed on a PABX line, select “PABX”, “PABX(GND)” or “PABX(FLASH)”. 103 002 003 PSTN Access Enter the PSTN access number for the Number G3-1 line. Memory Lock Disabled Not used PSTN-2 Port Settings Select the line setting for the G3-2 line. If the 001 Select Line machine is installed on a PABX line, select “PABX”, “PABX(GND)” or “PABX(FLASH)”. 104 002 003 004 SM PSTN Access Enter the PSTN access number for the G3-2 Number line. Memory Lock Disabled Not used Transmission If you turn this SP on, the machine does not Disabled send any fax messages on the G3-2 line. 57 D629 Service Program Tables PSTN-3 Port Settings Select the line setting for the G3-3 line. If the 001 Select Line machine is installed on a PABX line, select “PABX”, “PABX(GND)” or “PABX(FLASH)”. 105 002 003 004 PSTN Access Enter the PSTN access number for the G3-3 Number line. Memory Lock Disabled Not used Transmission If you turn this SP on, the machine does not Disabled send any fax messages on the G3-3 line. ISDN Port Settings 001 106 002 003 106 004 Select Line PSTN Access Number Memory Lock Not used (Do not change the settings.) Disabled Transmission Disabled IPFAX Port Settings 107 001 H323 Port Sets the H323 port number. 002 SIP Port Sets the SIP port number. 003 RAS Port Sets the RAS port number. 004 Gatekeeper port Sets the Gatekeeper port number. 005 T.38 Port Sets the T.38 port number. 006 SIP Server Port Sets the SIP port number. 007 D629 IPFAX Protocol Priority Select "H323" or "SIP". 58 SM Service Program Tables Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) FAX SW 201 001 – 032 00 – 1F 4.2.4 SP4-XXX (ROM VERSIONS) 4 Mode No. Function 101 001 FCU ROM Version Displays the FCU ROM version. 102 001 Error Codes Displays the latest 64 fax error codes. 103 001 G3-1 ROM Version Displays the G3-1 modem version. 104 001 G3-2 ROM Version Displays the G3-2 modem version. 105 001 G3-3 ROM Version Displays the G3-3 modem version. 106 001 G4 ROM Version Not used (Do not change the settings.) SM 59 D629 Service Program Tables 4.2.5 SP5-XXX (RAM CLEAR) 5 Mode No. Function Initialize SRAM (Except Secure) 101 000 Initializes the bit switches and user parameters, user data in the SRAM, files in the SAF memory, and clock. Erase All Files 102 000 Erases all files stored in the SAF memory. Reset Bit Switches (Except Secure) 103 000 Resets the bit switches and user parameters. Factory Setting 104 000 Resets the bit switches and user parameters, user data in the SRAM and files in the SAF memory. Reset All Bit Switches 105 000 Resets all the current bit switch settings. Reset Security Bit Switches Resets only the security bit switches. If you select automatic 106 000 output/display for the user parameter switches, the security settings are initialized. D629 60 SM Service Program Tables 6 Mode No. Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 4.2.6 SP6-XXX (REPORTS) Function System Parameter List 101 000 - Touch the “ON” button to print the system parameter list. Service Monitor Report 102 000 - Touch the “ON” button to print the service monitor report. G3 Protocol Dump List 001 002 003 103 004 005 006 007 SM G3 All Prints the protocol dump list of all Communications communications for all G3 lines. G3-1 (All Prints the protocol dump list of all Communications) communications for the G3-1 line. G3-1 Prints the protocol dump list of the last (1 Communication) communication for the G3-1 line. G3-2 Prints the protocol dump list of all (All Communications) communications for the G3-2 line. G3-2 Prints the protocol dump list of the last (1 Communication) communication for the G3-2 line. G3-3 Prints the protocol dump list of all (All Communications) communications for the G3-3 line. G3-3 Prints the protocol dump list of the last (1 Communication) communication for the G3-3 line. 61 D629 Service Program Tables G4 Protocol Dump List 104 001 Dch + Bch 1 002 Dch 003 Bch 1 Link Layer 004 Dch Link Layer 005 Dch +Bch 2 006 Bch 2 Link Layer Not used (Do not change the settings.) All Files print out Prints out all the user files in the SAF memory, including confidential messages. 105 000 - Do not use this function, unless the customer is having trouble printing confidential messages or recovering files stored using the memory lock feature. Journal Print out 106 D629 001 All Journals 002 Specified Date The machine prints all the communication records on the report. The machine prints all communication records after the specified date. 62 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Service Program Tables Log List Print out 001 All log files 002 Printer 003 SC/TRAP Stored 004 Decompression 005 Scanner 006 JOB/SAF 007 Reconstruction 008 JBIG 009 Fax Driver 010 G3CCU 011 Fax Job 012 CCU 013 Scanner Condition 107 These log print out functions are for designer use only. IP Protocol Dump List 108 SM 001 All Communications 002 1 Communication Prints the protocol dump list of all communications for the IP fax line. Prints the protocol dump list of the last communication for the IP fax line. 63 D629 Service Program Tables 4.2.7 SP7-XXX (TESTS) These are the test modes for PTT approval. 7 Function 101 G3-1 Modem Tests 102 G3-1 DTMF Tests 103 Ringer Test 104 G3-1 V34 (S2400baud) 105 G3-1 V34 (S2800baud) 106 G3-1 V34 (S3000baud) 107 G3-1 V34 (S3200baud) 108 G3-1 V34 (S3429baud) 109 Recorded Message Test 110 G3-2 Modem Tests 111 G3-2 DTMF Tests 112 G3-2 V34 (S2400baud) 113 G3-2 V34 (S2800baud) 114 G3-2 V34 (S3000baud) 115 G3-2 V34 (S3200baud) 116 G3-2 V34 (S3429baud) 117 G3-3 Modem Tests 118 G3-3 DTMF Tests 119 G3-3 V34 (S2400baud) 120 G3-3 V34 (S2800baud) 121 G3-3 V34 (S3000baud) D629 64 SM 122 G3-3 V34 (S3200baud) 123 G3-3 V34 (S3429baud) 124 IG3-1 Modem Tests - Not used 125 IG3-1 DTMF Tests - Not used 126 IG3-1 V34 (S2400baud) - Not used 127 IG3-1 V34 (S2800baud) - Not used 128 IG3-1 V34 (S3000baud) - Not used 129 IG3-1 V34 (S3200baud) - Not used 130 IG3-1 V34 (S3429baud) - Not used 131 IG3-2 Modem Tests - Not used 132 IG3-2 DTMF Tests - Not used 133 IG3-2 V34 (S2400baud) - Not used 134 IG3-2 V34 (S2800baud) - Not used 135 IG3-2 V34 (S3000baud) - Not used 136 IG3-2 V34 (S3200baud) - Not used 137 IG3-2 V34 (S3429baud) - Not used SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Service Program Tables 65 D629 Bit Switches - 1 4.3 BIT SWITCHES - 1 Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan. Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List printed by the machine. 4.3.1 SYSTEM SWITCHES System Switch 00 (SP No. 1-101-001) No 0 1 Function Dedicated transmission Set this bit to 1 before changing any dedicated parameter programming transmission parameters. 0: Disabled This setting is automatically reset to "0" after 1: Enabled turning off and on. Not used Do not change Technical data printout on the 2 Journal 0: Disabled 1: Enabled D629 Comments 1: Instead of the personal name, the following data are listed on the Journal for each G3 communication. 66 SM Bit Switches - 1 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Example: (1): EQM value (Line quality data). A larger number means more errors. (2): Symbol rate (V.34 only) (3): Final modem type used (4): Starting data rate (for example, 288 means 28.8 kbps) (5): Final data rate (6): Rx revel (see below for how to read the rx level) (7): Total number of error lines that occurred during non-ECM reception. (8): Total number of burst error lines that occurred during non-ECM reception. EQM and rx level are fixed at "FFFF" in tx mode. The seventh and eighth numbers are fixed at "00" for transmission records and ECM reception records. Rx level calculation Example: The four-digit hexadecimal value (N) after "L" indicates the rx level. The high byte is given first, followed by the low byte. Divide the decimal value of N by -16 to get the rx level. In the above example, the decimal value of N (= 0100 [H]) is 256. So, the actual rx level is 256/-16 = -16 dB 3 Not used Do not change this setting. When "1" is selected, a line error mark is 4 Line error mark print printed on the printout if a line error occurs 0: OFF, 1: ON (print) during reception. This shows error locations when ECM is turned off. This is a fault-finding aid. The LCD shows the 5 G3/G4 communication key parameters (see "G3 Communication parameter display Parameters" below this table). This is normally 0: Disabled disabled because it cancels the CSI display for 1: Enabled the user. Be sure to reset this bit to "0" after testing. SM 67 D629 Bit Switches - 1 This is only used for communication Protocol dump list output after 6 each communication 0: Off troubleshooting. It shows the content of the transmitted facsimile protocol signals. Always reset this bit to 0 after finishing testing. If system switch 09 bit 6 is at "1", the list is only 1: On printed if there was an error during the communication. 7 Not used Do not change the setting. G3 Communication Parameters Modem rate 336: 33600 bps 168: 16800 bps 312: 31200 bps 144: 14400 bps 288: 28800 bps 120: 12000 bps 264: 26400 bps 96: 9600 bps 240: 24000 bps 72: 7200 bps 216: 21600 bps 48: 4800 bps 192: 19200 bps 24: 2400 bps S: Standard (8 x 3.85 dots/mm) D: Detail (8 x 7.7 dots/mm) F: Fine (8 x 15.4 dots/mm) Resolution SF: Superfine (16 x 15.4 dots/mm) 21: Standard (200 x 100 dpi) 22: Detail (200 x 200 dpi) 44: Superfine (400 x 400 dpi) MMR: MMR compression MR: MR compression Compression mode MH: MH compression JBO: JBIG compression (Optional mode) JBB: JBIG compression (Basic mode) Communication ECM: With ECM mode NML: With no ECM D629 68 SM Bit Switches - 1 reduction A4: A4 (8.3"), no reduction Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Width and B4: B4 (10.1"), no reduction A3: A3 (11.7"), no reduction 0: 0 ms/line 5: 5 ms/line 10: 10 ms/line 20: 20 ms/line I/O rate 25: 2.5 ms/line 40: 40 ms/line "40" is displayed while receiving a fax message using AI short protocol. SM 69 D629 Bit Switches - 1 System Switch 01 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 02 (SP No. 1-101-003) No 0 Function Not used Do not change these settings. Forced reset after transmission 2 stalls complete the job. Not used Do not change these settings. File retention time 4 0: Depends on User Parameter 24 [18(H)] 1: A file that had a communication error will not be erased unless the communication is successful. 1: No limit 5 With this setting on, the machine resets itself automatically if a transmission stalls and fails to 0: Off 1: On 3 Comments Not used Do not change this setting. Memory read/write by RDS (0,0): All RDS systems are always locked out. Bit 7 Bit 6 Setting 0 0 Always disabled 0 1 User selectable 1 0 User selectable 1 1 Always enabled (0,1), (1,0): Normally, RDS systems are locked out, but the user can temporarily switch RDS on to allow RDS operations to take place. RDS will automatically be locked out again after a 6-7 certain time, which is stored in System Switch 03. Note that if an RDS operation takes place, RDS will not switch off until this time limit has expired. (1,1): At any time, an RDS system can access the machine. D629 70 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 1 System Switch 03 (SP No. 1-101-004) No 0 to 7 Function Comments Length of time that RDS is 00 - 99 hours (BCD). temporarily switched on when This setting is only valid if bits 6 and 7 of bits 6 and 7 of System Switch System Switch 02 are set to "User selectable". 02 are set to "User selectable" The default setting is 24 hours. System Switch 04 (SP No. 1-101-005) No 0-2 Function Not used Comments Do not change these settings. 1: Each Quick/Speed dial number on the list is 3 Printing dedicated tx printed with the dedicated tx parameters (10 parameters on Quick/Speed bytes each). Dial Lists The first 10 bytes of data are the programmed 0: Disabled dedicated tx parameters; 34 bytes of data are 1: Enabled printed (the other 24 bytes have no use for service technicians). 4-7 Not used Do not change these settings. System Switch 05 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 06 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 07 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 08 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) SM 71 D629 Bit Switches - 1 System Switch 09 (SP No. 1-101-010) No Function Addition of image data from 0 confidential transmissions on the transmission result report 0: Disabled 1: Enabled Comments If this feature is enabled, the top half of the first page of confidential messages will be printed on transmission result reports. Print timing of communication reports on the Journal when no 1 image data was exchanged. 0: After DCS/NSS communication (default), 0: The Journal is printed only when image data is sent. 1: The Journal is printed when any data is sent. 1: After polling 2 Automatic error report printout 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 0: Error reports will not be printed. 1: Error reports will be printed automatically after failed communications. Printing of the error code on the 1: Error codes are printed on the error reports. 3 4 error report This can be used for detecting an error which 0: No 1: Yes occurs rarely. Not used Do not change this setting. 1: A power failure report will be automatically printed after the power is switched on if a fax 5 Power failure report message disappeared from the memory when 0: Disabled the power was turned off last. 1: Enabled (default) NOTE: If "0" is selected, no reports are printed and no one may recognize that fax data is gone due to a power failure. D629 72 SM Bit Switches - 1 Conditions for printing the protocol dump list 6 0: Print for all communications 1: Print only when there is a communication error Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) This switch becomes effective only when system switch 00 bit 6 is set to 1. 1: Set this bit to 1 when you wish to print a protocol dump list only for communications with errors. NOTE: The memory size is limited. Use this bit switch only when some log reports are necessary. Priority given to various types of 7 remote terminal ID when This bit determines which set of priorities the printing reports machine uses when listing remote terminal 0: RTI > CSI > Dial label > Tel. names on reports. number Dial Label: The name stored, by the user, for 1: Dial label > Tel. number > RTI the Quick/Speed Dial number. > CSI System Switch 0A (SP No. 1-101-011) No Function Comments When "1" is selected, a suitable port is automatically selected if the selected port is not 0 Automatic port selection used. 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled NOTE: This bit is useful if all communication lines at a customer site are not the same quality 1-3 Not used Do not change these settings. 0: Prevents dialing from the ten-key pad while Dialing on the ten-key pad when 4 the external telephone is off-hook 0: Disabled 1: Enabled the external telephone is off-hook. Use this setting when the external telephone is not by the machine, or if a wireless telephone is connected as an external telephone. 1: The user can dial on the machine's ten-key pad when the handset is off-hook. 5 SM On hook dial 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 0: On hook dial is disabled. 73 D629 Bit Switches - 1 6-7 Not used Do not change the factory settings System Switch 0B - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 0C - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 0D - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 0E (SP No. 1-101-015) No 0-1 Function Not used Comments Do not change the settings. Direct sending cannot operate when the capture function is on during sending. Setting 2 Enable/disable for direct this switch to "1" enables direct sending without sending selection capture. 0: Direct sending off Setting this switch to "0" masks the direct 1: Direct sending on sending function on the operation panel so direct sending with ScanRouter cannot be selected. 0: Manual tx is possible while the external handset is off-hook. However, manual tx during 3 Action when the external handset off-hook may not be sent to a correct handset goes off-hook direction. Manual tx is not possible. 0: Manual tx and rx operation 1: The display stays in standby mode even 1: Memory tx and rx operation when the external handset is used, so that (the display remains the same) other people can use the machine for memory tx operation. Note that manual tx and rx are not possible with this setting. 4-7 D629 Not used Do not change these settings. 74 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 1 System Switch 0F (SP No. 1-101-016) No Function Comments Country/area code for functional settings (Hex) 00: France 12: Asia 01: Germany 13: Japan 02: UK 14: Hong Kong 03: Italy 15: South Africa This country/area code determines the 04: Austria 16: Australia 05: Belgium 17: New Zealand factory settings of bit switches and RAM addresses. However, it has no effect on the NCU parameter settings and 0 to 7 06: Denmark 18: Singapore 07: Finland 19: Malaysia 08: Ireland 1A: China 09: Norway 1B: Taiwan 0A: Sweden 1C: Korea 0B: Switz. 1D: Brazil 0C: Portugal 20: Turkey 0D: Holland 21: Greece 0E: Spain 22: Hungary 0F: Israel 23: Czech 10: --- 24: Poland communication parameter RAM addresses. Cross reference NCU country code: SP No. 2-103-001 for G3-1 SP No. 2-104-001 for G3-2 SP No. 2-105-001 for G3-3 11: USA SM 75 D629 Bit Switches - 1 System Switch 10 (SP No. 1-101-017) No 0-7 Function Threshold memory level for parallel memory transmission Comments Threshold = N x 128 KB + 256 KB N can be between 00 - FF(H) Default setting: 02(H) = 512 KB System Switch 11 (SP No. 1-101-018) No 0 1-2 Function Comments TTI printing position Change this bit to 1 if the TTI overprints 0: Superimposed on the page information that the customer considers to be data important (G3 transmissions). 1: Printed before the data NOTE: If "1" is selected, it is possible that sent leading edge data is printed on two sheets of paper. Not used Do not change the factory settings. TTI used for broadcasting 0: The TTIs selected for each 3 Quick/Speed dial are used 1: The same TTI is used for all 1: The TTI (TTI_1 or TTI_2) which is selected for all destinations during broadcasting. destinations 4-7 D629 Not used Do not change the factory settings. 76 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 1 System Switch 12 (SP No. 1-101-019) No Function Comments TTI: 08 to 92 (BCD) mm Input even numbers only. This setting determines the print start position 0-7 TTI printing position in the main scan direction for the TTI from the left edge of the paper. If the TTI is moved too far to the right, it may overwrite the file number which is on the top right of the page. On an A4 page, if the TTI is moved over by more than 50 mm, it may overwrite the page number. System Switch 13 - Not used (do not change these settings) System Switch 14 - Not used (do not change these settings) System Switch 15 (SP No. 1-101-022) No 0 Function Not used Comments Do not change the settings. 1: The machine will restart from the Energy Saver mode quickly, because the +5V power Going into the Energy Saver 1 mode automatically 0: Enabled 1: Disabled supply is active even in the Energy Saver mode. The LED of the operation switch is flashing instead of entering Energy Saver mode. Use this setting if an external telephone has to be used when the machine is in the Energy Saver mode. 2-3 SM Not used Do not change these settings. 77 D629 Bit Switches - 1 Interval for preventing the machine from entering Energy Saver mode if there is a pending If there is a file waiting for transmission, the transmission file. machine does not go to Energy Saver mode Bit 5 Bit 4 Setting 0 0 1 min 0 1 30 min 1 0 1 hour 1 1 24 hours 4-5 during the selected period. After transmitting the file, if there is no file waiting for transmission, the machine goes to 6-7 Not used the Energy Saver mode. Do not change System Switch 16 (SP No. 1-101-023) No Function Comments 1: The machine sends messages Parallel Broadcasting 0 0: Disabled 1: Enabled simultaneously using all available ports during broadcasting. NOTE: If a customer wants to keep a line available for fax reception or other reasons, select "0" (Disable). 1 2-7 Priority setting for the G3 line. This function allows the user to select the 0: PSTN-1 > PSTN-2 or 3 default G3 line type. The optional SG3 units are 1: PSTN-2 or 3 > PSTN-1 required to use the PSTN-2 or 3 setting. Not used Do not change these settings. System Switch 17 - Not used (do not change these settings) System Switch 18 - Not used (do not change these settings) D629 78 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 1 System Switch 19 (SP No. 1-101-026) No 0-5 Function Not used Comments Do not change the settings. 0: After installing the memory expansion option, 6 Extended scanner page the scanner page memory is extended to 4 MB memory after memory option is from 2 MB. installed 1: If this bit is set to 1 after installing the 0: Disabled memory expansion option, the scanner page 1: Enabled memory is extended to 12 MB. But the SAF memory decreases to 18 MB. 1: If the customer frequently wishes to transmit Special Original mode 7 0: Disabled a form or letterhead which has a colored or printed background, change this bit to "1". "Original 1" and "Original 2" can be selected in 1: Enabled addition to the "Text", "Text/Photo" and "Photo" modes. System Switch 1A (SP No. 1-101-027) No Function Comments Sets the value to x4KB. When the amount of 0 LS RX memory capacity to threshold setting 7 00-FF (0-1020 Kbyte: Hex) available memory drops below this setting, RX documents are printed to conserve memory. Initial setting 0x80 (512 KB) NOTE: If a customer wants available memory size to be larger, decrease this threshold System Switch 1B - Not used (do not change these settings) System Switch 1C - Not used (do not change these settings) SM 79 D629 Bit Switches - 1 System Switch 1D (SP No. 1-101-030) No Function RTI/CSI/CPS code display 0 0: Enable 0: RTI, CSI, CPS codes are displayed on the top line of the LCD panel during communication. 1: Disable 1-7 Comments 1: Codes are switched off (no display) Not used Do not change these settings. System Switch 1E (SP No. 1-101-031) No Function Comments 0: When this switch is on and the journal history becomes full, the next report prints. If the journal history is not deleted, the next transmission cannot be received. This prevents overwriting communication records before the Communication after the Journal data storage area has 0 become full 0: Impossible 1: Possible machine can print them. 1: If the buffer memory of the communication records for the Journal is full, fax communications are still possible. But the machine will overwrite the oldest communication records. This setting is effective only when Automatic Journal printout is enabled but the machine cannot print the report (e.g., no paper). D629 80 SM Bit Switches - 1 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 0: If the SAF memory becomes full during scanning for a memory transmission, the successfully scanned pages are transmitted. 1 Action when the SAF memory 1: If the SAF memory becomes full during has become full during scanning for a memory transmission, the file is scanning erased and no pages are transmitted. 0: The current page is erased. 1: The entire file is erased. This setting is effective only when Automatic Journal printout is enabled but the machine cannot print the report (e.g., no paper). 2 RTI/CSI display priority 0: RTI 1: CSI File No. printing 3 0: Enabled 1: Disabled This bit determines which identifier, RTI or CSI, is displayed on the LCD while the machine is communicating in G3 non-standard mode. 1: File numbers are not printed on any reports. NOTE: The file numbers may not be printed in the sequential order. If a customer does not like this numbering, select "0". 0: If the user has stored no acceptable sender RTIs or CSIs, the user can select “ON” in the 4 Action when authorized authorized reception setting but the setting reception is enabled but becomes invalid (“OFF”). The machine will not authorized RTIs/CSIs are not be able to receive any fax messages. yet programmed If the customer wishes to receive messages 0: Faxes can be received if the from any sender that includes an RTI or CSI, sender has an RTI or CSI and to block messages from senders that do 1: All fax reception is disabled not include an RTI or CSI, change this bit to "0", then enable Authorized Reception. Otherwise, keep this bit at "1 (default setting)". 5-7 SM Not used Do not change the settings 81 D629 Bit Switches - 1 System Switch 1F (SP No. 1-101-032) No 0 Function Not used Comments Do not change the settings. 0: When an original jams, or the SAF memory Report printout after an original overflows during scanning, a report will be jam during SAF storage or if the printed. 1 SAF memory fills up Change this bit to "1" if the customer does not 0: Enabled want to have a report in these cases. 1: Disabled Memory tx – Memory storage report Parallel memory tx – Transmission result report 2 Not used Received fax print start timing 3 (G3 reception) 0: After receiving each page 1: After receiving all pages 4-6 Not used Do not change the settings. 0: The machine prints each page immediately after the machine receives it. 1: The machine prints the complete message after the machine receives all the pages in the memory. Do not change the factory settings. 0: When the fax unit detects a fax SC code Action when a fax SC has 7 occurred 0: Automatic reset 1: Fax unit stops other than SC1201 and SC1207, the fax unit automatically resets itself. 1: When the fax unit detects any fax SC code, the fax unit stops. Cross Reference Fax SC codes - See "Troubleshooting" D629 82 SM 4.4 BIT SWITCHES - 2 Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan. Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List printed by the machine. 4.4.1 I-FAX SWITCHES I-fax Switch 00 (SP No. 1-102-001) No Function Comments This setting sets the maximum size of the Original Width of TX Attachment File original that the destination can receive. (Bits 3~7 are reserved for future use or not used.) 0 A4 1 B4 2 A3 3-6 Reserved 7 Not used - 0: Off (not selected), 1: On (selected) If more than one of these three bits is set to "1", the larger size has priority. For example, if both Bit 2 and Bit 1 are set to "1" then the maximum size is "A3" (Bit 2). When mail is sent, there is no negotiation with the receiving machine at the destination, so the sending machine cannot make a selection for the receiving capabilities (original width setting) of the receiving machine. The original width selected with this switch is used as the RX machine's original width setting, and the original is reduced to this size before sending. The default is A4. If the width selected with this switch is higher than the receiving machine can accept, the machine detects this and this causes an error. SM 83 D629 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 2 Bit Switches - 2 I-fax Switch 01 (SP No. 1-102-002) No Function Comments Original Line Resolution of TX These settings set the maximum resolution of Attachment File the original that the destination can receive. 0 200x100 Standard 1 200x200 Detail 0: Not selected 2 200x400 Fine 3 300 x 300 Reserve 4 400 x 400 Super Fine 5 600 x 600 Reserve 6 Reserve 7 mm/inch 1: Selected If more than one of these three bits is set to "1", the higher resolution has priority. For example, if both Bit 0 and Bit 2 are set to "1" Then The Resolution is set for "Bit 2 200 x 400. This setting selects mm/inch conversion for mail transmission. 0: Off (No conversion), 1: On (Conversion) When on (set to "1"), the machine converts millimeters to inches for sending mail. There is no switch for converting inches to millimeters. Unlike G3 fax transmissions which can negotiate between sender and receiver to determine the setting, mail cannot negotiate between terminals; the mm/inch selection is determined by the sender fax. When this switch is Off (0): Images scanned in inches are sent in inches. Images scanned in mm are sent in mm. Images received in inches are transmitted in inches. Images received in mm are transmitted in mm. When this switch is On (1): D629 Images scanned in inches are sent in inches. Images scanned in mm are converted to inches. Images received in inches are transmitted in inches. Images received in mm are converted to inches. 84 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 2 I-fax Switch 02 (SP No. 1-102-003) No Function Comments RX Text Mail Header Processing This setting determines whether the header information is printed with text e-mails when they are received. 0: Prints only text mail. 0 1: Prints mail header information attached to text mail. When a text mail is received with this switch On (1), the "From" address and "Subject" address are printed as header information. When a mail with only binary data is received (a TIFF-F file, for example), this setting is ignored and no header is printed. Output from Attached Document at E-mail TX Error This setting determines whether only the first page or all pages of an e-mail attachment are printed at the sending station when a transmission error occurs. 1 This allows the customer to see which documents have not reached their intended destinations if sent to the wrong e-mail addresses, for example. 0: Prints 1st page only. 1: Prints all pages. Text String for Return Receipt 2-3 This setting determines the text string output for the Return Receipt that confirms the transmission was received normally at the destination. SM 85 D629 Bit Switches - 2 00: "Dispatched" Sends from PC mail a request for a Return Receipt. Receives the Return Receipt with "dispatched" in the 2nd part: Disposition: Automatic-action/MDN-send automatically; dispatched The "dispatched" string is included in the Subject string. 01: "Displayed" Sends from PC mail a request for a Return Receipt. Receives the Return Receipt with "displayed" in the 2nd part: Disposition: Automatic-action/MDN-send automatically; displayed The "displayed" string is included in the Subject string. 10: Reserved 11: Reserved A mail requesting a Return Receipt sent from an IFAX with this switch set to "00" (for "dispatched") received by Microsoft Outlook 2000 may cause an error. If any setting other than "displayed" (01) causes a problem, change the setting to "01" to enable normal sending of the Return Receipt. Media accept feature This setting adds or does not add the media accept feature to the answer mail to confirm a reception. 4 0: Does not add the media accept feature to the answer mail 1: Adds the media accept feature to the answer mail. Use this bit switch if a problem occurs when the machine receives an answer mail, which contains the media accept feature field. 5-6 Not Used Image Resolution of RX Text Mail This setting determines the image resolution of the received mail. 7 0: 200 x 200 1: 400 x 400 The "1" setting requires installation of the Memory Unit in order to have enough SAF (Store and Forward) memory to receive images at 400 x 400 resolution. D629 86 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 2 I-fax Switch 03 - Not used (do not change these settings) I-fax Switch 04 (SP No. 1-102-005) No Function Comments Subject for Delivery TX/Memory Transfer This setting determines whether the RTI/CSI registered on this machine or the RTI/CSI of the originator is used in the subject lines of transferred documents. 0: Puts the RTI/CSI of the originator in the Subject line. If this is used, either the 0 RTI or CSI is used. Only one of these can be received for use in the subject line. 1: Puts the RTI/CSI registered on this machine in the Subject line. When this switch is used to transfer and deliver mail to a PC, the information in the Subject line that indicates where the transmission originated can be used to determine automatically the destination folder for each e-mail. Subject corresponding to mail post database 0: Standard subject 1: Mail post database subject The standard subject is replaced by the mail post database subject in the following three cases: 1) When the service technician sets the service (software) switch. 1 2) When memory sending or delivery specified by F code is applied by the SMTP server 3) With relay broadcasting (1st stage without the Schmidt 4 function). This switch does not apply for condition 3) when the RX system is set up for memory sending, delivery by F-code, sending with SMTP RX and when operators are using FOL (to prevent problems when receiving transmissions). 2-7 SM Not Used 87 D629 Bit Switches - 2 I-fax Switch 05 (SP No. 1-102-006) No Function Comments Mail Addresses of SMTP Broadcast Recipients Determines whether the e-mail addresses of the destinations that receive transmissions broadcasted using SMTP protocol are recorded in the Journal. For example: 0 "1st destination + Total number of destinations: 9" in the Journal indicates a broadcast to 9 destinations. 0: Not recorded 1: Recorded 1-7 Not Used I-fax Switch 06 - Not used (do not change the settings) I-fax Switch 07 - Not used (do not change the settings) I-fax Switch 08 (SP No. 1-102-009) No Function Comments Memory Threshold for POP Mail Reception This setting determines the amount of SAF (Store and Forward) memory. (SAF stores fax messages to send later for transmission to more than one location, and also holds incoming messages if they cannot be printed.) When the amount of 0-7 SAF memory available falls below this setting, mail can no longer be received; received mail is then stored on the mail server. 00-FF (0 to 1024 KB: HEX) The hexadecimal number you enter is multiplied by 4 KB to determine the amount of memory. D629 88 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 2 I-fax Switch 09 (SP No. 1-102-010) No 0-3 Function Comments Not used Do not change the settings This setting determines the number of retries 4-7 when connection and transmission fails due to Restrict TX Retries errors. 01-F (1-15 Hex) I-fax Switch 0A - Not used (do not change the settings) I-fax Switch 0B - Not used (do not change the settings) I-fax Switch 0C - Not used (do not change the settings) I-fax Switch 0D (SP No. 1-102-014) No 0-1 Function Comments Not used Do not change the settings Set to select the signature when sending mail notification of the send results 2-3 SM Bit 2 Bit 3 Setting 0 0 No sign 0 1 No setting 1 0 Individual setting 1 1 Always sign In response to IEEE2600.1. 89 D629 Bit Switches - 2 4-5 6-7 Set to select the signature when sending mail. Bit 5 Bit 4 Setting 0 0 No sign 0 1 No setting 1 0 Individual setting 1 1 Always sign In response to IEEE2600.1. Not used Do not change the settings. I-fax Switch 0E - Not used (do not change the settings) I-fax Switch 0F (SP No. 1-102-016) No Function Comments Delivery Method for SMTP RX Files This setting determines whether files received with SMTP protocol are delivered 0 or output immediately. 0: Off. Files received via SMTP are output immediately without delivery. 1: On. Files received via SMTP are delivered immediately to their destinations. 1-7 D629 Not used 90 SM Bit Switches - 2 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 4.4.2 PRINTER SWITCHES Printer Switch 00 (SP No. 1-103-001) No Function Comments 0: If a 2 page RX transmission is split, [*] is printed in the bottom right corner of the 1st page and only a [2] is printed in the upper right corner of the 2nd page. 1: If a 2 page RX transmission is split into two Select page separation marks 0 0: Off 1: On pages, for example, [*] [2] is printed in the bottom right corner of the 1st page and only a [2] is printed in the upper right corner of the 2nd page. This helps the user to identify pages that have been split because the size of the paper is smaller than the size of the document received. (When A5 is used to print an A4 size document, for example.) 1 Repetition of data when the 1: Default. 10 mm of the trailing edge of the received page is longer than previous page are repeated at the top of the next the printer paper page. 0: Off 0: The next page continues from where the 1: On previous page stopped without any repeated text. This switch is only effective when user parameter 2 Prints the date and time on 02 - bit 2 (printing the received date and time on received fax messages received fax messages) is enabled. 0: Disabled 1: The machine prints the received and printed 1: Enabled date and time at the bottom of each received page. 3-7 SM Not used Do not change the settings. 91 D629 Bit Switches - 2 Printer Switch 01 (SP No. 1-103-002) No 0-2 Function Comments Not used Do not change the settings. Maximum print width used in the setup protocol 3-4 5-6 Bit 4 Bit 3 Setting 0 0 Not used 0 1 A3 1 0 B4 1 1 A4 These bits are only effective when bit 7 of printer switch 01 is "1". Not used Do not change the settings. 0: The machine informs the transmitting machine of the print width depending on the paper size available from the paper feed Received message width restriction in the protocol signal 7 to the sender 0: Disabled 1: Enabled stations. Refer to the table on the next page for how the machine chooses the paper width used in the setup protocol (NSF/DIS). 1: The machine informs the transmitting machine of the fixed paper width which is specified by bits 3 and 4 above. Relationship between available paper sizes and printer width used in the setup protocol Available Paper Size Printer width used in the Protocol (NSF/DIS) A4 or 8.5" x 11" 297 mm width B5 256 mm width A5 or 8.5" x 5.5" 216 mm width No paper available (Paper end) 216 mm width D629 92 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 2 Printer Switch 02 (SP No. 1-103-003) No Function Comments 1st paper feed station usage for 0 fax printing 0: Enabled 1: Disabled 2nd paper feed station usage 1 for fax printing 0: The paper feed station can be used to print 0: Enabled fax messages and reports. 1: Disabled 1: The specified paper feed station will not be 3rd paper feed station usage for 2 fax printing 0: Enabled used for printing fax messages and reports. station which has been specified by 1: Disabled 3 Do not disable usage for a paper feed User Parameter Switch 0F (15), or 4th paper feed station usage for which is used for the Specified fax printing Cassette Selection feature. 0: Enabled 1: Disabled LCT usage for fax printing 4 0: Enabled 1: Disabled 5-7 SM Not used Do not change the settings. 93 D629 Bit Switches - 2 Printer Switch 03 (SP No. 1-103-004) No Function Comments 0: Incoming pages are printed without length reduction. 0 Length reduction of received (Page separation threshold: Printer Switch 03, data bits 4 to 7) 0: Disabled 1: Incoming page length is reduced when 1: Enabled printing. (Maximum reducible length: Printer Switches 04, bits 0 to 4) 1-3 Not used Do not change the settings Page separation threshold (with reduction disabled with switch 03-0 above). Page separation setting when For example, if this setting is set to "10", and 4 sub scan compression is A4 is the selected paper size: to forbidden If the received document is 10 mm or less 7 00-0F (0-15 mm: Hex) longer than A4, then the 10 mm are cut and Default: 6 mm only 1 page prints. If the received document is 10 mm longer than A4, then the document is split into 2 pages. D629 94 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 2 Printer Switch 04 (SP No. 1-103-005) No Function Comments Maximum reducible length when length reduction is enabled with switch 03-0 above. [Maximum reducible length] = [Paper length] + (N x 5mm) "N" is the decimal value of the binary setting of bits 0 to 4. 0 to 4 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Setting 0 0 0 0 0 0 mm 0 0 0 0 1 5 mm 0 0 1 0 0 20 mm 1 1 1 1 1 155 mm For A5 sideways and B5 sideways paper [Maximum reducible length] = [Paper length] + 0.75 x (N x 5mm) Length of the duplicated image on the next page, when page separation has taken place. 5 Bit 6 Bit 5 Setting 0 0 4 mm 0 1 10 mm 1 0 15 mm 1 1 Not used 6 7 SM Not used. Do not change the setting. 95 D629 Bit Switches - 2 Printer Switch 05 - Not used (do not change the settings) Printer Switch 06 (SP No. 1-103-007) No Function Comments Printing while a paper cassette is pulled out, when the Just Size Printing feature is enabled. 0 0: Printing will not start Cross reference 1: Printing will start if another Just size printing on/off – User switch 05, bit 5 cassette has a suitable size of paper, based on the paper size selection priority tables. 1-7 Not used. Do not change the settings. Printer Switch 07 (SP No. 1-103-008) No 0-3 Function Not used. Comments Do not change the settings. List of destinations in the Communication Failure Report 4 for broadcasting 0: All destinations 1: Only destinations where 1: Only destinations where communication failure occurred are printed on the Communication Failure Report. communication failure occurred 5-7 Not used. Do not change the settings. Printer Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings) Printer Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings) Printer Switch 0A - Not used (do not change the settings) Printer Switch 0B - Not used (do not change the settings) D629 96 SM Bit Switches - 2 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Printer Switch 0C - Not used (do not change the settings) Printer Switch 0E (SP No. 1-103-015) No Function Comments 0: A paper size that has the same width 0 Paper size selection priority as the received data is selected first. 0: Width 1: A paper size which has enough length 1: Length to print all the received lines without reduction is selected first. 1 Paper size selected for printing A4 This switch determines which paper size width fax data is selected for printing A4 width fax data, 0: 8.5" x 11" size when the machine has both A4 and 8.5" x 1: A4 size 11" size paper. 1: If all paper sizes in the machine require page separation to print a received fax 2 Page separation message, the machine does not print the 0: Enabled message (Substitute Reception is used). 1: Disabled After a larger size of paper is set in a cassette, the machine automatically prints the fax message. Printing the sample image on reports Bit 4 Bit 3 Setting 0 0 The upper half only 0 1 "Same size" means the sample image is printed at 100%, even if page separation 3-4 occurs. 50% reduction User Parameter Switch 19 (13H) bit 4 (sub-scan only) must be set to "0" to enable this switch. Refer to Detailed Section Descriptions for 5-6 SM 1 0 Same size 1 1 Not used Not used more on this feature. Do not change the settings. 97 D629 Bit Switches - 2 0: When page separation has taken 7 Equalizing the reduction ratio among place, all the pages are reduced with the separated pages same reduction ratio. (Page Separation) 1: Only the last page is reduced to fit the 0: Enabled selected paper size when page 1: Disabled separation has taken place. Other pages are printed without reduction. Printer Switch 0F (SP No. 1-103-016) No Function Comments Smoothing feature Bit 1 Bit 0 Setting 0 0 Disabled machine receives halftone images from 0 1 Disabled other manufacturers fax machines (0, 0) (0, 1): Disable smoothing if the 0-1 frequently. 1 0 Enabled 1 1 Not used Duplex printing 2 1: The machine always prints received 0: Disabled fax messages in duplex printing mode: 1: Enabled 0: Sets the binding for the left edge of Binding direction for Duplex printing 3 the stack. 0: Left binding 1: Sets the binding for the top of the 1: Top binding 4-7 D629 stack. Not used Do not change the settings. 98 SM 4.5 BIT SWITCHES - 3 Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan. Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List printed by the machine. 4.5.1 COMMUNICATION SWITCHES Communication Switch 00 (SP No. 1-104-001) No Function Comments Compression modes available in receive mode 0-1 Bit 1 Bit 0 0 0 Modes These bits determine the compression capabilities to be MH only declared in phase B (handshaking) 0 1 MH/MR 1 0 MH/MR/MMR 1 1 MH/MR/MMR/JBIG of the T.30 protocol. Compression modes available in transmit mode Bit 3 Bit 2 These bits determine the Modes compression capabilities to be used 2-3 0 0 MH only in the transmission and to be 0 1 MH/MR declared in phase B (handshaking) of the T.30 protocol. 4 SM 1 0 MH/MR/MMR 1 1 MH/MR/MMR/JBIG Not used Do not change the settings. 99 D629 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 3 Bit Switches - 3 5 6 JBIG compression method: Reception Change the setting when 0: Only basic supported communication problems occur 1: Basic and optional both supported using JBIG compression. JBIG compression method: Transmission Change the setting when 0: Basic mode priority communication problems occur 1: Optional mode priority using JBIG compression. 1: Reception will not go ahead if the polling ID code of the remote Closed network (reception) 7 terminal does not match the polling 0: Disabled ID code of the local terminal. This 1: Enabled function is only available in NSF/NSS mode. Communication Switch 01 (SP No. 1-104-002) No Function Comments If this bit is set to 0, ECM is switched off for all 0 ECM communications. 0: Off 1: On In addition, V.8 protocol and JBIG compression are switched off automatically. 1 Not used Do not change the setting. Wrong connection prevention method (0,1): The machine will disconnect the line without sending a fax message, if the last 8 digits of the received CSI do not match the last Bit 3 Bit 2 Setting 0 0 None does not work when manually dialed. 0 1 8 digit CSI (1,0): The same as above, except that only the 8 digits of the dialed telephone number. This 2-3 last 4 digits are compared. D629 1 0 4 digit CSI 1 1 CSI/RTI (1,1): The machine will disconnect the line without sending a fax message, if the other end 100 SM Bit Switches - 3 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) does not identify itself with an RTI or CSI. (0,0): Nothing is checked; transmission will always go ahead. This function does not work when dialing is done from the external telephone. 4-5 Not used Do not change the setting. Maximum printable page length available 6-7 Bit 7 Bit 6 0 0 Setting No limit The setting determined by these bits is informed to the transmitting terminal in the pre-message protocol exchange (in the 0 1 B4 (364 mm) 1 0 A4 (297 mm) 1 1 Not used DIS/NSF frames). Communication Switch 02 (SP No. 1-104-003) No Function Comments If there are more consecutive error lines in the received page than the threshold, the machine will send a negative response. The Low and High threshold values depend on the sub-scan resolution, and 0 SM G3 Burst error threshold 0: Low 1: High are as follows. 100 dpi 6(L) 200 dpi 12(L) 24(H) 300 dpi 18(L) 36(H) 400 dpi 24(L) 48(H) 101 12(H) D629 Bit Switches - 3 If the error line ratio for a page exceeds the Acceptable total error line ratio 1 acceptable ratio, RTN will be sent to the 0: 5% 1: 10% other end. Treatment of pages received with errors during G3 reception 2 0: Pages received with errors are not 0: Deleted from memory without printed. printing 1: Printed 0: The next page will be sent even if RTN 3 Hang-up decision when a negative or PIN is received. code (RTN or PIN) is received 1: The machine will send DCN and hang up during G3 immediate transmission if it receives RTN or PIN. 0: No hang-up, 1: Hang-up This bit is ignored for memory transmissions or if ECM is being used. 4-7 Not used Do not change the settings. Communication Switch 03 (SP No. 1-104-004) No 0-7 Function Comments Maximum number of page 00 - FF (Hex) times. retransmissions in a G3 This setting is not used if ECM is switched on. memory transmission Default setting - 03(H) Communication Switch 04 - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 05 - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 06 - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 07 - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings) D629 102 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 3 Communication Switch 0A (SP No. 1-104-011) No 0 1-7 Function Comments Point of resumption of memory 0: The transmission begins from the page transmission upon redialing where transmission failed the previous time. 0: From the error page 1: Transmission begins from the first page, 1: From page 1 using normal memory transmission. Not used Do not change the settings. Communication Switch 0B (SP No. 1-104-012) No 0-3 Function Not used Printout of the message when 4 acting as a Transfer Station 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled 5-7 Not used Comments Do not change the settings. When the machine is acting as a Transfer Station, this bit determines whether the machine prints the fax message coming in from the Requesting Terminal. Do not change the settings. Communication Switch 0C - Not used (do not change the settings) SM 103 D629 Bit Switches - 3 Communication Switch 0D (SP No. 1-104-014) No Function Comments 00 to FF (Hex), unit = 4 kbytes (e.g., 06(H) = 24 kbytes) One page is about 24 kbytes. 0-7 The available memory The machine refers to this setting before each fax threshold, below which ringing reception. If the amount of remaining memory is detection (and therefore below this threshold, the machine cannot receive reception into memory) is any fax messages. disabled If this setting is kept at 0, the machine will detect ringing signals and go into receive mode even if there is no memory available. This will result in communication failure. Communication Switch 0E (SP No. 1-104-015) No Function Comments 06 to FF (Hex), unit = 2 s 0-7 Minimum interval between (e.g., 06(H) = 12 s) automatic dialing attempts This value is the minimum time that the machine waits before it dials the next destination. Communication Switch 0F – Not used (do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 10 (SP No. 1-104-017) No Function Comments Memory transmission: 0-7 Maximum number of dialing attempts to the same 01 – FE (Hex) times destination D629 104 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 3 Communication Switch 11 – Not used (do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 12 (SP No. 1-104-019) No Function Comments Memory transmission: Interval 0-7 between dialing attempts to the 01 – FF (Hex) minutes same destination Communication Switch 13 – Not used (do not change the settings.) SM 105 D629 Bit Switches - 3 Communication Switch 14 (SP No. 1-104-021) No Function Comments 0: In immediate transmission, data scanned in inch format are transmitted without conversion. In memory transmission, data stored in the SAF memory in mm format are Inch-to-mm conversion during 0 transmission transmitted without conversion. Note: When storing the scanned data into SAF memory, the fax unit always 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled converts the data into mm format. 1: The machine converts the scanned data or stored data in the SAF memory to the format which was specified in the set-up protocol (DIS/NSF) before transmission. 1-5 Not used Do not change the factory settings. Available unit of resolution in which fax messages are received For the best performance, do not change 6-7 Bit 7 Bit 6 0 0 Unit mm the factory settings. The setting determined by these bits is informed to the transmitting terminal in 0 1 inch the pre-message protocol exchange (in 1 0 mm and inch the DIS/NSF frames). 1 1 Not used Communication Switch 15 – Not used (do not change the settings) D629 106 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 3 Communication Switch 16 (SP No. 1-104-023) No 0 Function Not used Do not change the settings. Optional G3 unit (G3-2) 1 0: Not installed 1: Installed 2 Comments Change this bit to 1 when installing the first optional G3 unit. Not used This switch enables the G3-2. 3 Select PSTN connection 0: Off, no connection 0: Off 1: Recognizes and enables G3-2. 1: On This switch can be used only after G3-2 has been installed. 4-7 Not used Do not change the settings. Communication Switch 17 (SP No. 1-104-024) No 0 1 Function SEP reception 0: Polling transmission to another maker's 0: Disabled machine using the SEP (Selective Polling) signal 1: Enabled is disabled. SUB reception 0: Confidential reception to another maker's 0: Disabled machine using the SUB (Sub-address) signal is 1: Enabled disabled. PWD reception 2 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 3-4 SM Comments Not used 0: Disables features that require PWD (Password) signal reception. Do not change the settings. 107 D629 Bit Switches - 3 PSTN dial-in routing setting 5 0: OFF numbers in the PSTN dial-in line and transfers received data from each PSTN dial-in number to 1: ON 6 1: The machine sets multiple PSTN dial-in each address. Not used Do not change the settings. Action when there is no box with an F-code that matches 7 the received SUB code 0: Disconnect the line Change this setting when the customer requires. 1: Receive the message (using normal reception mode) Communication Switch 18 (SP No. 1-104-025) No 0-4 5 Function Not used Do not change the settings. IP-Fax dial-in routing selection 1: Transfers received data to each IP-Fax dial-in 0: Off number. 1: On IP-Fax dial-in number is a 4-digit number. PSTN 2 dial-in routing 6 0: Off 1: On PSTN 3 dial-in routing 7 0: Off 1: On D629 Comments Enables or disables dial-in routing for the PSTN 2 connection. Enables or disables dial-in routing for the PSTN 3 connection. 108 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 3 Communication Switch 19 - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 1A - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 1B (SP No. 1-104-028) No Function Comments If the PABX does not support V.8/V.34 protocol Extension access code (0 to 7) 0-7 to turn V.8 protocol On/Off 0: On procedure, set this bit to "1" to disable V.8. Example: If "0" is the PSTN access code, set bit 0 to 1. When the machine detects "0" as the first dialed number, it automatically disables V.8 1: Off protocol. (Alternatively, if "3" is the PSTN access code, set bit 3 to 1.) Communication Switch 1C (SP No. 1-104-029) No Function Comments Refer to communication switch 1B. 0-1 Extension access code (8 and Example: If "8" is the PSTN access code, set bit 0 9) to turn V.8 protocol On/Off to 1. When the machine detects "8" as the first 0: On dialed number, it automatically disables V.8 1: Off protocol. (If "9" is the PSTN access code, use bit 1.) 2-7 Not used Do not change the settings. Communication Switch 1D - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 1E - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 1F - Not used (do not change the settings) SM 109 D629 Bit Switches - 4 4.6 BIT SWITCHES - 4 Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan. Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List printed by the machine. 4.6.1 G3 SWITCHES G3 Switch 00 (SP No. 1-105-001) No Function Comments Monitor speaker during communication (tx and rx) (0, 0): The monitor speaker is disabled all 0 1 Bit 1 Bit 0 Setting 0 0 Disabled 0 1 Up to Phase B 1 0 All the time 1 1 Not used Monitor speaker during memory 2 transmission 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 3-7 D629 Not used through the communication. (0, 1): The monitor speaker is on up to phase B in the T.30 protocol. (1, 0): Used for testing. The monitor speaker is on all through the communication. Make sure that you reset these bits after testing. 1: The monitor speaker is enabled during memory transmission. Do not change the settings. 110 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 4 G3 Switch 01 (SP No. 1-105-002) No 0-3 Function Comments Not used Do not change the settings. 1: The bytes in the DIS frame after the 4th byte 4 DIS frame length will not be transmitted (set to 1 if there are 0: 10 bytes 1: 4 bytes communication problems with PC-based faxes which cannot receive the extended DIS frames). 5 6 7 Not used Do not change the setting. Forbid CED/AMsam output Do not change this setting (Default: 0: Off), 0: Off unless communication problem is caused by a 1: On (Forbid output) CED or ANSam transmission. Not used Do not change the setting. G3 Switch 02 (SP No. 1-105-003) No Function Comments Change this bit to 1 only when the other end can 0 G3 protocol mode used only communicate with machines that send 0: Standard and non-standard T.30-standard frames only. 1: Standard only 1: Disables NSF/NSS signals (these are used in non-standard mode communication) 1-6 7 SM Not used Do not change the settings. Short preamble Refer to Appendix B in the Group 3 Facsimile 0: Disabled 1: Enabled Manual for details about Short Preamble. 111 D629 Bit Switches - 4 G3 Switch 03 (SP No. 1-105-004) No Function DIS detection number 0 (Echo countermeasure) 0: 1 1: 2 1 Not Used Comments 0: The machine will hang up if it receives the same DIS frame twice. 1: Before sending DCS, the machine will wait for the second DIS which is caused by echo on the line. Do not change the settings. 0: V.8/V.34 communications will not be possible. V.8 protocol 2 0: Disabled Do not set to 0 unless the line condition 1: Enabled is always bad enough to slow down the data rate to 14.4 kbps or lower. ECM frame size 3 0: 256 bytes Keep this bit at "0" in most cases. 1: 64 bytes 0: When using ECM in non-standard (NSF/NSS) mode, the machine sends a CTC to drop back the modem rate after receiving a PPR, if the following condition is met in communications at 14.4, 12.0, CTC transmission conditions 9.6, and 7.2 kbps. 0: After one PPR signal 4 received 1: After four PPR signals received (ITU-T standard) NTransmit- Number of transmitted frames NResend- Number of frames to be retransmitted 1: When using ECM, the machine sends a CTC to drop back the modem rate after receiving four PPRs. PPR, CTC: These are ECM protocol signals. This bit is not effective in V.34 communications. D629 112 SM Bit Switches - 4 5 page after receiving a negative code (RTN or PIN) Not used Do not change the settings This switch is used to prevent reverse polarity in Select detection of reverse 7 before sending the next page if a negative code is received. This bit is ignored if ECM is being used. 0: No change 1: Fallback 6 1: The machine's tx modem rate will fall back Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Modem rate used for the next ringing on the phone line (applied to PSTN-G3 polarity in ringing ringing). Do not change this setting 0: Off 0: No detection 1: On 1: Detection (Japan and Korea only) G3 Switch 04 (SP No. 1-105-005) No Function Comments 0 - F (Hex); 0 - 15 bits 0-3 Training error detection If the number of error bits in the received TCF is threshold below this threshold, the machine informs the sender that training has succeeded. 4-7 Not used Do not change the settings. G3 Switch 05 (SP No. 1-105-006) No Function Comments Initial Tx modem rate (kbps) Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 These bits set the initial starting modem kbps rate for transmission. Use the dedicated transmission 0-3 0 0 0 1 2.4 0 0 1 0 4.8 0 0 1 1 7.2 0 1 0 0 9.6 0 1 0 1 12.0 parameters if you need to change this for specific receivers. If a modem rate 14.4 kbps or slower is selected, V.8 protocol should be disabled manually. SM Cross reference V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit 2 113 D629 Bit Switches - 4 0 1 1 0 14.4 0 1 1 1 16.8 1 0 0 0 19.2 1 0 0 1 21.6 1 0 1 0 24.0 1 0 1 1 26.4 1 1 0 0 28.8 1 1 0 1 31.2 0 0 1 1 33.6 Other settings - Not used Initial modem type for 9.6 k or 7.2 kbps. Bit 5 Bit 4 Setting 0 0 V.29 0 1 V.17 1 0 V.34 1 1 Not used 4-5 6-7 D629 These bits set the initial modem type for 9.6 and 7.2 kbps, if the initial modem rate Not used is set at these speeds. Do not change the settings. 114 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 4 G3 Switch 06 (SP No. 1-105-007) No Function Comments Initial Rx modem rate(kbps) Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 kbps 0 0 0 1 2.4 0 0 1 0 4.8 0 0 1 1 7.2 0 1 0 0 9.6 0 1 0 1 12.0 0 1 1 0 14.4 0 1 1 1 16.8 selected, V.8 protocol should be 1 0 0 0 19.2 disabled manually. These bits set the initial starting modem rate for reception. 0-3 Use a lower setting if high speeds pose problems during reception. If a modem rate 14.4 kbps or slower is Cross reference 1 0 0 1 21.6 1 0 1 0 24.0 1 0 1 1 26.4 1 1 0 0 28.8 1 1 0 1 31.2 V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit2 Other settings - Not used SM 115 D629 Bit Switches - 4 Modem types available for reception The setting of these bits is used to inform the transmitting terminal of the available modem type for the machine in receive mode. If V.34 is not selected, V.8 protocol must be disabled manually. Cross reference V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit 2 4-7 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Types 0 0 0 1 V.27ter 0 0 1 0 V.27ter, V.29 0 0 1 1 V.27ter, V.29, V.33 0 1 0 0 V.27ter, V.29, V.17/V.33 0 1 0 1 V.27ter, V.29, V.17/V33, V.34 Other settings - Not used G3 Switch 07 (SP No. 1-105-008) No Function Comments PSTN cable equalizer Use a higher setting if there is signal loss (tx mode: Internal) at higher frequencies because of the Bit 1 Bit 0 Setting 0 0 None 0 1 Low 1 0 Medium 1 1 High length of wire between the modem and the telephone exchange. Use the dedicated transmission parameters for specific receivers. 0-1 Also, try using the cable equalizer if one or more of the following symptoms occurs. Communication error Modem rate fallback occurs frequently. This setting is not effective in V.34 communications. D629 116 SM PSTN cable equalizer Use a higher setting if there is signal loss (rx mode: Internal) at higher frequencies because of the Bit 3 Bit 2 Setting 0 0 None 0 1 Low 1 0 Medium 1 1 High Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 4 length of wire between the modem and the telephone exchange. Also, try using the cable equalizer if one or more of the following symptoms 2-3 occurs. Communication error with error codes such as 0-20, 0-23, etc. Modem rate fallback occurs frequently. This setting is not effective in V.34 communications. PSTN cable equalizer 4 (V.8/V.17 rx mode: External) 0: Disabled Keep this bit at "1". 1: Enabled 5 Not used Do not change the settings. 0: This uses the fixed table in the ROM Parameter selection for dial tone 6 detection 0: Normal parameter 1: Specific parameter for dial tone detection. 1: This uses the specific parameter adjusted with SRAM (69ECBEH 69ECDEH). Select this if the dial tone cannot be detected when the "Normal parameter: 0" is selected. 7 SM Not used Do not change the settings. 117 D629 Bit Switches - 4 G3 Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings) G3 Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings) G3 Switch 0A (SP No. 1-105-011) No Function Comments Maximum allowable carrier drop during image data reception 0-1 2 3 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value (ms) 0 0 200 These bits set the acceptable modem carrier drop time. Try a longer setting if error code 0-22 is 0 1 400 1 0 800 1 1 Not used frequent. Select cancellation of high-speed RX This switch setting determines if if carrier signal lost while receiving high-speed receiving ends if the carrier 0: Off signal is lost when receiving during 1: On non-ECM mode Not used Do not change the settings This bit set the maximum interval Maximum allowable frame interval 4 during image data reception. 0: 5 s 1: 13 s between EOL (end-of-line) signals and the maximum interval between ECM frames from the other end. Try using a longer setting if error code 0-21 is frequent. 5 D629 Not used Do not change the settings. 118 SM Bit Switches - 4 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) When the sending terminal is controlled by a computer, there may be a delay in receiving page data after the local machine accepts set-up data and sends Reconstruction time for the first line in CFR. This is outside the T.30 6 receive mode recommendation. But, if this delay 0: 6 s 1: 12 s occurs, set this bit to 1 to give the sending machine more time to send data. Refer to error code 0-20. ITU-T T.30 recommendation: The first line should come within 5 s of CFR. 7 Not used Do not change the settings. G3 Switch 0B Not used (do not change the settings). G3 Switch 0C Not used (do not change the settings). G3 Switch 0D Not used (do not change the settings). G3 Switch 0E (SP No. 1-105-015) No Function Comments Set CNG send time interval Some machines on the receiving side may not be able to automatically switch the 3-second CNG interval. 3000-2250ms: 3000-50xNms 0-7 High order bit 3000 – 50 x Nms 0F (3000 ms) <= N <= FF (2250 ms) 00-0E(3000-3700ms: 3000+50xNms Low order bit 3000 – 50 x Nms 0F (3000 ms) <= N <= 0F (3700 ms) SM 119 D629 Bit Switches - 4 G3 Switch 0F (SP No. 1-105-016) No Function Comments Alarm when an error occurred 0 in Phase C or later If the customer wants to hear an alarm after each 0: Disabled error communication, change this bit to "1". 1: Enabled Alarm when the handset is 1 off-hook at the end of If the customer wants to hear an alarm if the communication handset is off-hook at the end of fax 0: Disabled communication, change this bit to "1". 1: Enabled 2-3 Not used Sidaa manual calibration 4 setting 0: Off 1: On 5-7 D629 Not used Do not change the settings. 1: manually calibrates for communication with a line whose current change occurs such as an optical fiber line. Do not change the settings. 120 SM 4.7 BIT SWITCHES - 5 Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan. Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List printed by the machine. 4.7.1 G3-2 AND G3-3 SWITCHES These switches require an optional G3 interface unit. G3-3 switches are the same as for G3-2 switches. G3-2 Switch 00 (SP No. 1-106-001) No Function Comments Monitor speaker during communication (tx and rx) (0, 0): The monitor speaker is disabled all 0 1 Bit 1 Bit 0 Setting 0 0 Disable 0 1 Up to Phase B 1 0 All the time 1 1 Not used Monitor speaker during memory 2 transmission 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 3-7 SM Not used through the communication. (0, 1): The monitor speaker is on up to phase B in the T.30 protocol. (1, 0): Used for testing. The monitor speaker is on all through the communication. Make sure that you reset these bits after testing. 1: The monitor speaker is enabled during memory transmission. Do not change the settings. 121 D629 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 5 Bit Switches - 5 G3-2 Switch 01 (SP No. 1-106-002) No 0-3 Function Not used Comments Do not change the settings. 1: The bytes in the DIS frame after the 4th byte 4 DIS frame length will not be transmitted (set to 1 if there are 0: 10 bytes 1: 4 bytes communication problems with PC-based faxes which cannot receive the extended DIS frames). 5 6 7 Not used Do not change the setting. Forbid CED/AMsam output Do not change this setting (Default: 0: Off), 0: Off unless communication problem is caused by a 1: On (Forbid output) CED or ANSam transmission. Not used Do not change the setting. G3-2 Switch 02 (SP No. 1-106-003) No Function Comments Change this bit to 1 only when the other end can 0 G3 protocol mode used only communicate with machines that send 0: Standard and non-standard T.30-standard frames only. 1: Standard only 1: Disables NSF/NSS signals (these are used in non-standard mode communication) 1-6 7 D629 Not used Do not change the settings. Short preamble Refer to Appendix B in the Group 3 Facsimile 0: Disabled 1: Enabled Manual for details about Short Preamble. 122 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 5 G3-2 Switch 03 (SP No. 1-106-004) No Function DIS detection number 0 (Echo countermeasure) 0: 1 1: 2 1 Not Used Comments 0: The machine will hang up if it receives the same DIS frame twice. 1: Before sending DCS, the machine will wait for the second DIS which is caused by echo on the line. Do not change the settings. 0: V.8/V.34 communications will not be possible. V.8 protocol 2 0: Disabled Do not set to 0 unless the line condition 1: Enabled is always bad enough to slow down the data rate to 14.4 kbps or lower. ECM frame size 3 0: 256 bytes Keep this bit at "0" in most cases. 1: 64 bytes 0: When using ECM in non-standard (NSF/NSS) mode, the machine sends a CTC to drop back the modem rate after receiving a PPR, if the following condition is met in communications at 14.4, 12.0, CTC transmission conditions 9.6, and 7.2 kbps. 0: After one PPR signal 4 received 1: After four PPR signals received (ITU-T standard) Ntransmit = Number of transmitted frames Nresend = Number of frames to be retransmitted 1: When using ECM, the machine sends a CTC to drop back the modem rate after receiving four PPRs. PPR, CTC: These are ECM protocol signals. This bit is not effective in V.34 communications. SM 123 D629 Bit Switches - 5 Modem rate used for the next 5 page after receiving a negative code (RTN or PIN) Not used Do not change the settings This switch is used to prevent reverse polarity in Select detection of reverse 7 before sending the next page if a negative code is received. This bit is ignored if ECM is being used. 0: No change 1: Fallback 6 1: The machine's tx modem rate will fall back ringing on the phone line (applied to PSTN-G3 polarity in ringing ringing). Do not change this setting 0: Off 0: No detection 1: On 1: Detection (Japan and Korea only) G3-2 Switch 04 (SP No. 1-106-005) No Function Comments 0 - F (Hex); 0 - 15 bits 0-3 Training error detection If the number of error bits in the received TCF is threshold below this threshold, the machine informs the sender that training has succeeded. 4-7 Not used Do not change the settings. G3-2 Switch 05 (SP No. 1-106-006) No Function Comments Initial Tx modem rate (kbps) Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 These bits set the initial starting modem kbps rate for transmission. Use the dedicated transmission 0-3 0 0 0 1 2.4 0 0 1 0 4.8 0 0 1 1 7.2 0 1 0 0 9.6 0 1 0 1 12.0 parameters if you need to change this for specific receivers. If a modem rate 14.4 kbps or slower is selected, V.8 protocol should be disabled manually. D629 Cross reference V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit 2 124 SM 0 1 1 0 14.4 0 1 1 1 16.8 1 0 0 0 19.2 1 0 0 1 21.6 1 0 1 0 24.0 1 0 1 1 26.4 1 1 0 0 28.8 1 1 0 1 31.2 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 5 Other settings - Not used Initial modem type for 9.6 k or 7.2 kbps. Bit 5 Bit 4 Setting 0 0 V.29 0 1 V.17 1 0 V.34 1 1 Not used 4-5 6-7 SM These bits set the initial modem type for 9.6 and 7.2 kbps, if the initial modem rate Not used is set at these speeds. Do not change the settings. 125 D629 Bit Switches - 5 G3-2 Switch 06 (SP No. 1-106-007) No Function Comments Initial Rx modem rate(kbps) Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 kbps 0 0 0 1 2.4 0 0 1 0 4.8 0 0 1 1 7.2 0 1 0 0 9.6 0 1 0 1 12.0 0 1 1 0 14.4 0 1 1 1 16.8 selected, V.8 protocol should be 1 0 0 0 19.2 disabled manually. These bits set the initial starting modem rate for reception. 0-3 Use a lower setting if high speeds pose problems during reception. If a modem rate 14.4 kbps or slower is Cross reference 1 0 0 1 21.6 1 0 1 0 24.0 1 0 1 1 26.4 1 1 0 0 28.8 1 1 0 1 31.2 V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit2 Other settings - Not used Modem types available for reception The setting of these bits is used to inform the transmitting terminal of the available modem type for the machine in receive mode. If V.34 is not selected, V.8 protocol must be disabled manually. 4-7 Cross reference V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit 2 D629 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Types 0 0 0 1 V.27ter 126 SM 0 0 1 0 V.27ter 0 0 1 1 V.27ter 0 1 0 0 V.27ter 0 1 0 1 V.27ter Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 5 Other settings - Not used SM 127 D629 Bit Switches - 5 G3-2 Switch 07 (SP No. 1-106-008) No Function Comments PSTN cable equalizer Use a higher setting if there is signal loss (tx mode: Internal) at higher frequencies because of the Bit 1 Bit 0 Setting 0 0 None 0 1 Low 1 0 Medium 1 1 High length of wire between the modem and the telephone exchange. Use the dedicated transmission parameters for specific receivers. 0-1 Also, try using the cable equalizer if one or more of the following symptoms occurs. Communication error Modem rate fallback occurs frequently. This setting is not effective in V.34 communications. PSTN cable equalizer Use a higher setting if there is signal loss (rx mode: Internal) at higher frequencies because of the Bit 3 Bit 2 Setting 0 0 None 0 1 Low 1 0 Medium 1 1 High length of wire between the modem and the telephone exchange. Also, try using the cable equalizer if one or more of the following symptoms 2-3 occurs. Communication error with error codes such as 0-20, 0-23, etc. Modem rate fallback occurs frequently. This setting is not effective in V.34 communications. PSTN cable equalizer 4 (V.8/V.17 rx mode: External) 0: Disabled Keep this bit at "1". 1: Enabled D629 128 SM Bit Switches - 5 Not used Do not change the settings. Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 5-7 G3-2 Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings) G3-2 Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings) G3-2 Switch 0A (SP No. 1-106-011) No Function Comments Maximum allowable carrier drop during image data reception 0-1 2 3 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value (ms) 0 0 200 0 1 400 1 0 800 1 1 Not used These bits set the acceptable modem carrier drop time. Try a longer setting if error code 0-22 is frequent. Select cancellation of high-speed RX This switch setting determines if if carrier signal lost while receiving high-speed receiving ends if the carrier 0: Off signal is lost when receiving during 1: On non-ECM mode Not used Do not change the settings This bit set the maximum interval Maximum allowable frame interval 4 during image data reception. 0: 5 s 1: 13 s between EOL (end-of-line) signals and the maximum interval between ECM frames from the other end. Try using a longer setting if error code 0-21 is frequent. 5 SM Not used Do not change the settings. 129 D629 Bit Switches - 5 When the sending terminal is controlled by a computer, there may be a delay in receiving page data after the local machine accepts set-up data and sends Reconstruction time for the first line in CFR. This is outside the T.30 6 receive mode recommendation. But, if this delay 0: 6 s 1: 12 s occurs, set this bit to 1 to give the sending machine more time to send data. Refer to error code 0-20. ITU-T T.30 recommendation: The first line should come within 5 s of CFR. 7 Not used Do not change the settings. G3-2 Switch 0B- Not used (do not change the settings) G3-2 Switch 0C- Not used (do not change the settings) 4.7.2 G4 INTERNAL SWITCHES The G4 internal switches (SW00 to 1F) are displayed but do not change these settings. 4.7.3 G4 PARAMETER SWITCHES The G4 parameter switches (SW00 to 0F) are displayed but do not change these settings. D629 130 SM 4.8 BIT SWITCHES - 6 Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan. Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List printed by the machine. 4.8.1 IP FAX SWITCHES IP Fax Switch 00 (SP No. 1-111-001) No. 0 1 2 Function Not used IP Fax Transport 0: TCP, 1: UDP IP Fax single port selection 0: OFF, 1: ON (enable) Comments Do not change this setting. Selects TCP or UDP protocol for IP-Fax Selects single data port. IP Fax double ports (single data 3 port) selection Selects whether IP-Fax uses a double port. 0: OFF, 1: ON (enable) 4 5 IP Fax Gatekeeper 0: OFF, 1: ON (enable) IP Fax T30 bit signal reverse 0: LSB first, 1: MSB first Enables/disables the gatekeeper for IP-Fax. Reverses the T30 bit signal. When "0" is selected, the max bit rate does 6 IP Fax max bit rate setting not affect the value of the DIS/DCS. 0: Not affected, 1: Affected When "1" is selected, the max bit rate affects the value of the DIS/DCS. SM 131 D629 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 6 Bit Switches - 6 When "0" is selected, fax data is received without checking the telephone number. IP Fax received telephone number 7 confirmation 0: No confirmation, 1: Confirmation When "1" is selected, fax data is received only when confirming that the telephone number from the sender matches the registered telephone number in this machine. If this confirmation fails, the line is disconnected. IP Fax Switch 01 (SP No. 1-111-002) No. Function Comments IP Fax delay level setting Selects the acceptable delay level. Level 0 is the highest quality Default is "0000" (level 0). Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 Level 0 0 0 0 1 Level 1 0 0 1 0 Level 2 0 0 1 1 Level 3 0-3 Selects the preamble wait time. [00 to 0f] There are 16 values in this 4-bit binary 4-7 IP Fax preamble wait time setting switch combination. Waiting time: set value level x 100 ms Max: 0f (1500 ms) Min: 00 (No wait time) The default is "0000" (00H). D629 132 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 6 IP Fax Switch 02 (SP No. 1-111-003) No. Function Comments When "0" is selected, the bit signal reverse IP Fax bit signal reverse setting 0 0: Maker code setting 1: Internal bit switch setting method is decided by the maker code. When "1" is selected, the bit signal reverse method is decided by the internal bit switch. When communicating between IP Fax devices, LSB first is selected.) IP Fax transmission speed setting 1 0: Modem speed 1: No limitation SIP transport setting 2 0: TCP 1: UDP 3 Selects the transmit speed for IP Fax communication. This bit switch sets the transport that has priority for receiving IP Fax data. This function is activated only when the sender has both TCP and UDP. CCM connection When "1" is selected, only the connection 0: No CCM connection call message with H.323 or no tunneled 1: CCM connection H.245 is transmitted via CCM. 0: This answers the INVITE message from Message reception selection from 4 non-registered SIP server 0: Answer 1: Not answer the SIP server not registered for the machine. 1: This does not receive the INVITE message from the SIP server not registered for the machine and send a refusal message. 0: This does not limit the type of the image ECM communication setting 5 0: No limit for image compression 1: Limit for image compression compression with ECM communication. 1: When the other end machine is Ciscco, this permits the image compression other than JBIG or MMR with ECM communication. 6-7 SM Not used Do not change these settings. 133 D629 Bit Switches - 6 IP Fax Switch 03 (SP No. 1-111-004) No. Function Effective field limitation for G3 0 standard function information 0: OFF, 1: 4byte (DIS) Comments Limits the effective field for standard G3 function information. Switching between G3 standard 1 and G3 non standard Enables/disables switching between G3 0: Enable switching standard and G3 non-standard. 1: G3 standard only 2 Not used Do not change this setting. ECM frame size selection at 3 transmitting Selects the ECM frame size for sending. 0: 256byte, 1: 64byte DIS detection times for echo 4 prevention 0: 1 time, 1: 2 times Sets the number of times for DIS to detect echoes. When "0" is selected, the transmission 5 CTC transmission selection condition is decided by error frame 0: PPRx1 numbers. 1: PPRx4 When "1" is selected, the transmission condition is based on the ITU-T method. Shift down setting at receiving 6 negative code 0: OFF, 1: ON 7 D629 Not used Selects whether to shift down when negative codes are received. Do not change this setting. 134 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 6 IP Fax Switch 04 (SP No. 1-111-005) No. Function Comments 0-3 TCF error threshold 4-7 Not used Sets the TCF error threshold level. [00 to 0f] The default is "1111" (0fH). Do not change these settings. IP Fax Switch 05 (SP No. 1-111-006) No. Function Comments Modem bit rate setting for transmission (kbps) Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 kbps 0 0 0 1 2.4 0 0 1 1 4.8 transmission. The default is "0110" 0 0 1 1 7.2 (14.4K bps). 0 1 0 0 9.6 0 1 0 1 12.0 0 1 1 0 14.4 Sets the modem bit rate for 0-3 Modem setting for transmission Bit 5 Bit 4 Types 0 0 V29 0 1 V17 1 0 Not used 1 1 Not used Sets the modem type for 4-5 6-7 SM transmission. The default is "00" (V29). Not used Do not change these settings. 135 D629 Bit Switches - 6 IP Fax Switch 06 (SP No. 1-111-007) No. 0-3 Function Comments Modem bit rate setting for reception Sets the modem bit rate for reception. The default is "0110" (14.4K bps). Modem setting for reception Sets the modem type for reception. The default is "0100" (V27ter, V29, V17). 4-7 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Types 0 0 0 1 V.27ter 0 0 1 0 V.27ter, V.29 0 0 1 1 V.27ter, V.29, V.33 0 1 0 0 V.27ter, V.29, V.17/V.33 Other settings - Not used IP Fax Switch 07 (SP No. 1-111-008) No. 0 Function Comments TSI information Adds or does not add TSI information to 0: Not added, 1: Added NSS(S). DCN transmission setting at T1 1 timeout Transmits or does not transmit DCN at T1 0: Not transmitted timeout. 1: Transmitted 2 Not used Do not change this setting. Hang up setting at DIS reception 3 disabled Sets whether the machine disconnects after 0: No hang up DIS reception. 1: Hang up after transmitting DCN 4 D629 Number of times for training Selects the number of times training is done 0: 1 time, 1: 2 times at the same bit rate. 136 SM Bit Switches - 6 5 no CSI registration When "1" is selected, the transmitted data is 0: Not transmitted all spaces. 1: Transmitted 6-7 When "0" is selected, frame data is enabled. Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Space CSI transmission setting at Not used Do not change these settings. IP Fax Switch 08 (SP No. 1-111-009) No. Function Comments T1 timer adjustment Bit 1 Bit 0 0 0 35 s Adjusts the T1 timer. 0 1 40 s The default is "00" (35 seconds). 1 0 50 s 1 1 60 s 0-1 T4 timer adjustment Bit 3 Bit 2 0 0 3s 0 1 3.5 s 1 0 4s 1 1 5s 2-3 Adjust the T4 timer. The default is "00" (3 seconds). T0 timer adjustment Adjusts the fail safe timer. This timer sets Bit 5 Bit 4 0 0 the interval between "setup" data 75 s 4-5 transmission and T.38 phase decision. If your destination return is late on the 0 1 120 s network or G3 fax return is late, adjust the 1 0 180 s longer interval timer. The default is "00" (75 seconds). 1 SM 1 240 s 137 D629 Bit Switches - 6 6-7 Not used Do not change these settings. IP Fax Switch 09 (SP No. 1-111-010) No. Function Comments Network I/F setting for SIP 0 connection Selects the connection type (IPV4 or IPV6) 0: IPv4 to connect to the SIP server. 1: IPv6. 0: The I/F setting for fax communication 1 Network I/F setting for Fax follows the setting for SIP server communication connection. 0: Same setting as SIP server 1: The negotiation between the SIP server connection and the device decides whether IPv4 or 1: Automatic setting IPv6 is used for the I/F setting for fax communication. 0: Disables the record-route function of the Record-route setting 2 SIP server. 0: Disable 1: Enables the record-route function of the 1: Enable SIP server. re-INVITE transmission delay timer setting Bit 4 Bit 3 0 0 No delay 0 1 1 sec 1 0 2 sec 1 1 3 sec This changes the interval for transmit 3-4 5-7 D629 Not used. re-INVITE after receiving the ACK message transmitted by T.38 device. Do not change these settings. 138 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit Switches - 6 IP Fax Switch 0A - Not used (do not change the settings) IP Fax Switch 0B - Not used (do not change the settings) IP Fax Switch 0C - Not used (do not change the settings) IP Fax Switch 0D - Not used (do not change the settings) IP Fax Switch 0E - Not used (do not change the settings) SM 139 D629 NCU Parameters 4.9 NCU PARAMETERS The following tables give the RAM addresses and the parameter calculation units that the machine uses for ringing signal detection and automatic dialing. The factory settings for each country are also given. Most of these must be changed by RAM read/write (SP2-102), but some can be changed using NCU Parameter programming (SP2-103, 104 and 105); if SP2-103, 104 and 105 can be used, this will be indicated in the Remarks column. The RAM is programmed in hex code unless (BCD) is included in the Unit column. The following addresses describe settings for the standard NCU. Change the fourth digit from "5" to "6" (e.g. 680500 to 680600) for the settings for the first optional G3 interface unit and from "5" to "7" (e.g. 680700) for the settings for the second optional G3 interface unit. Address Function Country/Area code for NCU parameters Use the Hex value to program the country/area code directly into this address, or use the decimal value to program it using SP2-103-001 Country Decimal Hex France 00 00 Germany 01 UK Decimal Hex Asia 18 12 01 Japan 19 13 02 02 Hong Kong 20 14 Italy 03 03 South Africa 21 15 Austria 04 04 Australia 22 16 Belgium 05 05 New Zealand 26 17 Denmark 06 06 Singapore 24 18 Finland 07 07 Malaysia 25 19 Ireland 08 08 China 26 1A Norway 09 09 Taiwan 27 1B /Area 680500 D629 Country 140 /Area SM NCU Parameters Function Sweden 10 0A Korea 28 1C Switzerland 11 0B Brazil 29 1D Portugal 12 0C Turkey 32 20 Holland 13 0D Greece 33 21 Spain 14 0E Hungary 34 22 Israel 15 0F Czech 35 23 USA 17 11 Poland 36 24 Address Function 680501 Line current detection time 680502 Line current wait time 680503 Line current drop detect time 680504 Unit 680506 disabled. 20 ms Line current is not detected if 680501 contains FF. PSTN dial tone frequency upper If both addresses limit (high byte) PSTN dial tone frequency upper contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. limit (low byte) PSTN dial tone frequency lower If both addresses limit (high byte) Hz (BCD) 680507 Remarks Line current detection is Hz (BCD) 680505 PSTN dial tone frequency lower contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. limit (low byte) 680508 PSTN dial tone detection time If 680508 contains 680509 PSTN dial tone reset time (LOW) FF(H), the machine 68050A 68050B SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Address PSTN dial tone reset time (HIGH) 20 ms pauses for the pause time (address 68050D / PSTN dial tone continuous tone 68050E). time Italy: See Note 2. 141 D629 NCU Parameters Address 68050C Function Unit Remarks PSTN dial tone permissible drop time 68050D PSTN wait interval (LOW) 68050E PSTN wait interval (HIGH) - 68050F 680510 PSTN ring-back tone detection 20 ms time PSTN ring-back tone off detection time Detection is disabled if this contains FF. 20 ms - 20 ms - 20 ms - PSTN detection time for silent 680511 period after ring-back tone detected (LOW) PSTN detection time for silent 680512 period after ring-back tone detected (HIGH) 680513 PSTN busy tone frequency upper If both addresses limit (high byte) Hz (BCD) 680514 680515 PSTN busy tone frequency upper detection is disabled. limit (low byte) PSTN busy tone frequency lower If both addresses limit (high byte) Hz (BCD) 680516 680517 PSTN busy tone frequency lower 680519 D629 contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. limit (low byte) PABX dial tone frequency upper If both addresses limit (high byte) Hz (BCD) 680518 contain FF(H), tone PABX dial tone frequency upper contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. limit (low byte) PABX dial tone frequency lower Hz (BCD) limit (high byte) 142 If both addresses contain FF(H), tone SM NCU Parameters 68051A Function Unit PABX dial tone frequency lower detection is disabled. limit (low byte) 68051B PABX dial tone detection time 68051C PABX dial tone reset time (LOW) 68051D PABX dial tone reset time (HIGH) 68051E 68051F Remarks Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Address If 68051B contains FF, the machine pauses for the pause time (680520 / PABX dial tone continuous tone 20 ms time 680521). PABX dial tone permissible drop time 680520 PABX wait interval (LOW) 680521 PABX wait interval (HIGH) 680522 PABX ringback tone detection time 20 ms If both addresses PABX ringback tone off detection contain FF(H), tone - 680523 time 20 ms detection is disabled. PABX detection time for silent 680524 period after ringback tone 20 ms If both addresses detected (LOW) contain FF(H), tone PABX detection time for silent 680525 detection is disabled. period after ringback tone 20 ms detected (HIGH) 680526 PABX busy tone frequency upper If both addresses limit (high byte) Hz (BCD) 680527 680528 PABX busy tone frequency upper detection is disabled. limit (low byte) PABX busy tone frequency lower If both addresses limit (high byte) Hz (BCD) 680529 SM contain FF(H), tone PABX busy tone frequency lower contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. limit (low byte) 143 D629 NCU Parameters Address Function 68052A Busy tone ON time: range 1 68052B Busy tone OFF time: range 1 68052C Busy tone ON time: range 2 68052D Busy tone OFF time: range 2 68052E Busy tone ON time: range 3 68052F Busy tone OFF time: range 3 680530 Busy tone ON time: range 4 680531 Busy tone OFF time: range 4 680532 Unit Remarks 20 ms - 20 ms Busy tone continuous tone detection time Busy tone signal state time tolerance for all ranges, and number of cycles required for detection (a setting of 4 cycles means that ON-OFF-ON or OFF-ON-OFF must be detected twice). Tolerance (±) 680533 Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 75% Bits 2 and 3 must always be kept at 0. Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 50% Bits 2 and 3 must always be kept at 0. Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 25% Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 12.5% Bits 7, 6, 5, 4 - number of cycles required for cadence detection 680534 International dial tone frequency If both addresses upper limit (high byte) Hz (BCD) 680535 680536 International dial tone frequency detection is disabled. upper limit (low byte) International dial tone frequency If both addresses lower limit (high byte) Hz (BCD) 680537 680538 D629 contain FF(H), tone International dial tone frequency contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. lower limit (low byte) International dial tone detection 20 ms time 144 If 680538 contains FF, the machine pauses for SM NCU Parameters 680539 68053A 68053B 68053C 68053D Function Unit Remarks International dial tone reset time the pause time (68053D (LOW) / 68053E). Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Address Belgium: See Note 2. International dial tone reset time (HIGH) International dial tone continuous tone time International dial tone permissible drop time International dial wait interval (LOW) 68053E 68053F International dial wait interval (HIGH) Country dial tone upper frequency If both addresses limit (HIGH) contain FF(H), tone 680540 Country dial tone upper frequency detection is disabled. limit (LOW) Hz (BCD) 680541 Country dial tone lower frequency If both addresses limit (HIGH) contain FF(H), tone 680542 680543 680544 680545 680546 680547 SM Country dial tone lower frequency detection is disabled. limit (LOW) Country dial tone detection time If 680543 contains FF, Country dial tone reset time 20 ms (LOW) the machine pauses for the pause time (680548 / 680549). Country dial tone reset time (HIGH) Country dial tone continuous tone time Country dial tone permissible drop time 145 - - 20 ms - D629 NCU Parameters Address Function 680548 Country dial wait interval (LOW) 680549 Country dial wait interval (HIGH) Unit Time between opening or closing 68054A the DO relay and opening the Remarks See Notes 3, 6 and 8. 1 ms OHDI relay SP2-103-012 (parameter 11). See Note 3. 68054B Break time for pulse dialing 1 ms SP2-103-013 (parameter 12). See Note 3. 68054C Make time for pulse dialing 1 ms SP2-103-014 (parameter 13). See Notes 3, 6 and 8. Time between final OHDI relay 68054D SP2-103-015 closure and DO relay opening or 1 ms closing (parameter 14). This parameter is only valid in Europe. 68054E See Note 3 and 8. Minimum pause between dialed SP2-103-016 digits (pulse dial mode) (parameter 15). 20 ms 68054F 680550 SP2-103-017 Time waited when a pause is (parameter 16). See entered at the operation panel Note 3. SP2-103-018 DTMF tone on time (parameter 17). 1 ms 680551 680552 D629 SP2-103-019 DTMF tone off time (parameter 18). Tone attenuation level of DTMF -N x 0.5 signals while dialing –3.5 dBm 146 SP2-103-020 (parameter 19). See Note 5. SM NCU Parameters Function Unit Remarks Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Address SP2-103-021 (parameter 20). Tone attenuation value difference 680553 between high frequency tone and low frequency tone in DTMF The setting must be less -dBm x 0.5 than –5dBm, and should not exceed the setting at signals 680552h above. See Note 5. 680554 680555 680556 680557 680558 680559 68055A 68055B PSTN: DTMF tone attenuation -N x 0.5 level after dialling –3.5 dBm ISDN: DTMF tone attenuation -dBm x 0.5 level after dialling Not used - SM (parameter 21). See Note 5. See Note 5 Do not change the settings. Time between 68054Dh (NCU This parameter takes parameter 14) and 68054Eh (NCU 1 ms effect when the country parameter 15) code is set to France. Not used - Grounding time (ground start 20 ms mode) Break time (flash start mode) 1 ms Do not change the setting. The Gs relay is closed for this interval. The OHDI relay is open for this interval. International dial access code For a code of 100: (High) BCD 68055C SP2-103-022 International dial access code 68055B - F1 68055C - 00 (Low) 147 D629 NCU Parameters Address Function Unit Remarks This time is waited for each pause input after the PSTN access code. If this address contains 68055D PSTN access pause time 20 ms FF[H], the pause time stored in address 68054F is used. Do not set a number more than 7 in the UK. Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 0 = -25.0 dBm Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 1 = -35.0 dBm 68055E Progress tone detection level, and Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 0 = -30.0 dBm cadence detection enable flags Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 0 = -40.0 dBm Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 0 = -49.0 dBm Bits 2, 0 - See Note 2. 68055F To Not used - Long distance call prefix (HIGH) BCD 680564 680565 Do not change the settings. For a code of 0: 680565 – FF 680566 Long distance call prefix (LOW) BCD Not used - 680567 to 680571 680572 680573 680574 680575 D629 680566 - FF Do not change the settings. Acceptable ringing signal SP2-103-003 frequency: range 1, upper limit (parameter 02). Acceptable ringing signal SP2-103-004 frequency: range 1, lower limit 1000/ N (parameter 03). Acceptable ringing signal (Hz). SP2-103-005 frequency: range 2, upper limit (parameter 04). Acceptable ringing signal SP2-103-006 frequency: range 2, lower limit (parameter 05). 148 SM NCU Parameters Function Unit Remarks Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Address SP2-103-007 680576 Number of rings until a call is 1 detected (parameter 06). The setting must not be zero. 680577 680578 680579 See Note 4. Minimum required length of the 20 ms first ring SP2-103-008 (parameter 07). Minimum required length of the 20 ms second and subsequent rings Ringing signal detection reset time SP2-103-009 (parameter 08). SP2-103-010 (LOW) (parameter 09). 20 ms 68057A Ringing signal detection reset time SP2-103-011 (parameter (HIGH) 10). 68057B to - Not used 680580 Do not change the settings. Interval between dialing the last digit and switching the Oh relay 680581 over to the external telephone 20 ms Factory setting: 500 ms when dialing from the operation panel in handset mode. Bits 0 and 1 - Handset off-hook detection time Bit 1:0, Bit 0: 0 = 200 ms Bit 1:0, Bit 0: 1 = 800 ms Other Not used 680582 Bits 2 and 3 - Handset on-hook detection time - Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 0 = 200 ms Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 1 = 800 ms Other Not used Bits 4 to 7 - Not used SM 149 D629 NCU Parameters Address Function Unit 680583 To - Not used 6805A0 6805A1 6805A3 6805A5 6805A6 Acceptable CED detection 6805A8 frequency upper limit (low byte) Acceptable CED detection If both addresses frequency lower limit (high byte) Acceptable CED detection contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. frequency lower limit (low byte) 20 ms ± 20 CED detection time ms Factory setting: 200 ms Acceptable CNG detection If both addresses frequency upper limit (high byte) Acceptable CNG detection contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. frequency upper limit (low byte) Acceptable CNG detection If both addresses frequency lower limit (high byte) BCD (Hz) 6805A9 contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. BCD (Hz) 6805A7 settings. If both addresses frequency upper limit (high byte) BCD (Hz) 6805A4 Do not change the Acceptable CED detection BCD (Hz) 6805A2 Remarks Acceptable CNG detection contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. frequency lower limit (low byte) Do not change the 6805AA Not used - 6805AB CNG on time 20 ms Factory setting: 500 ms 6805AC CNG off time 20 ms Factory setting: 3000 ms 6805AD D629 setting. The data is coded in the Number of CNG cycles required - for detection same way as address 680533. 150 SM NCU Parameters 6805AE Function Unit Do not change the - Not used Remarks Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Address settings. Acceptable AI short protocol tone 6805AF (800Hz) detection frequency If both addresses upper limit (high byte) Hz (BCD) Acceptable AI short protocol tone 6805B0 contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. (800Hz) detection frequency upper limit (low byte) Acceptable AI short protocol tone 6805B1 (800Hz) detection frequency lower If both addresses limit (high byte) Hz(BCD) Acceptable AI short protocol tone 6805B2 contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. (800Hz) detection frequency lower limit (low byte) 6805B3 6805B4 6805B5 6805B6 6805B7 6805B8 6805B9 6805BD SM Detection time for 800 Hz AI short protocol tone 20 ms Factory setting: 360 ms SP2-103-002 PSTN: Tx level from the modem -N – 3 dBm PSTN: 1100 Hz tone transmission - N 6805B4 - 0.5N 6805B5 –3.5 (dB) level See Note 7. PSTN: 2100 Hz tone transmission - N6805B4 - 0.5N 6805B6 –3 (dB) level See Note 7. PABX: Tx level from the modem - dBm PABX: 1100 Hz tone transmission level PABX: 2100 Hz tone transmission level Modem turn-on level (incoming (parameter 01). - N 6805B7 - 0.5N 6805B8 (dB) - N 6805B7 - 0.5N 6805B9 (dB) -37-0.5N signal detection level) (dBm) 151 D629 NCU Parameters Address 6805BE to 6805C6 Function Unit - Not used Remarks Do not change the settings. Bits 0 to 3 – Not used 6805C7 Bit 4 = V.34 protocol dump 0: Simple, 1: Detailed (default) Bits 5 to 7 – Not used. 6805C8 to 6805D9 6805DA Not used - T.30 T1 timer 1s Do not change the settings. 1: Maximum wait time for post message (EOP/EOM/MPS) can 6805E0 bit Maximum wait time for post 0: 12 s be changed to 30 s. 3 1: 30 s Change this bit to “1” if message communication errors occur frequently during V.17 reception. Bits 0 and 1 – DCV (TIP/RING) Voltage Bit 1:0, Bit 0: 0 = 3.1 V Bit 1:0, Bit 0: 1 = 3.2 V Bit 1:1, Bit 0: 0 = 3.35 V Bit 1:1, Bit 0: 1 = 3.5 V Bits 2 and 3 – MINI (minimum loop electric current) 6805E3 Bit 2:0, Bit 3: 0 = 10 mA Bit 2:0, Bit 2: 1 = 12 mA Bit 2:1, Bit 3: 0 = 14 mA Bit 2:1, Bit 3: 1 = 16 mA Bits 6 and 7 – ACIM (AC impedance) Bit 7:0, Bit 6: 0 Bit 5:0, Bit 4: 0= 600 Bit 7:0, Bit 6: 0 Bit 5:1, Bit 4: 0= TBR21 D629 152 SM NCU Parameters Function Unit Remarks Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Address Bit 0 – OHS (on hook speed) 0: OHS=0 1: OHS=1 Bit 1 – SQ (spark quench) 0: SQ=00 1: SQ=11 Bit 2 – RZ (call signal Impedance) 0: RZ=0 (high) 1: RZ=1 (low) Bit 3 – RT (call signal detection level) 0: RT=0 (low) 6805E4 1: RT=1 (high) Bit 4 – ILIM (DC limitation) 0: ILIM=0 (CTR 21) 1: ILIM=1 (other than CTR 21) Bit 5 –FILTER 0: FILTER=0 (around 5Hz) 1: FILTER=1 (around 200Hz) Bits 6 to 7 – Calibration in off hook state Bit 6:0, Bit 7: 0 = off hook to ACAL:128 ms, off hook to MCAL: 1000 ms Bit 6:1, Bit 7: 0 = off hook to ACAL:128 ms, off hook to MCAL: 500 ms Bit 6:0, Bit 7: 1 = off hook to ACAL:128 ms (no MCAL) Bit 6:1, Bit 7: 1 = off hook to ACAL:8 ms (no MCAL) Bits 0 to 6 – Not used 6805E5 Bits 7 – Energy saving for DSP, COMBLK, SiDAA 0: Does not save energy 1: Saves energy SM 153 D629 NCU Parameters NOTES 1. If a setting is not required, store FF in the address. 2. Italy and Belgium only RAM address 68055E: the lower four bits have the following meaning. Bit 2 - 1: International dial tone cadence detection enabled (Belgium) Bit 1 - Not used Bit 0 - 1: PSTN dial tone cadence detection enabled (Italy) If bit 0 or bit 2 is set to 1, the functions of the following RAM addresses are changed. 680508 (if bit 0 = 1) or 680538 (if bit 2 = 1): tolerance for on or off state duration (%), and number of cycles required for detection, coded as in address 680533. 68050B (if bit 0 = 1) or 68053B (if bit 2 = 1): on time, hex code (unit = 20 ms) 68050C (if bit 0 = 1) or 68053C (if bit 2 = 1): off time, hex code (unit = 20 ms) 3. Pulse dial parameters (addresses 68054A to 68054F) are the values for 10 pps. If 20 pps is used, the machine automatically compensates. 4. The first ring may not be detected until 1 to 2.5 wavelengths after the time specified by this parameter. 5. The calculated level must be between 0 and 10. The attenuation levels calculated from RAM data are: High frequency tone: – 0.5 x N680552/680554–3.5 dBm – 0.5 x N680555 dBm Low frequency tone: – 0.5 x (N680552/680554 + N680553) –3.5 dBm – 0.5 x (N680555 + N680553) dBm 6. N680552, for example, means the value stored in address 680552(H) 68054A: Europe - Between Ds opening and Di opening, France - Between Ds closing and Di opening 68054D: Europe - Between Ds closing and Di closing, France - Between Ds opening and Di closing 7. Tone signals which frequency is lower than 1500Hz (e.g., 800Hz tone for AI short protocol) refer to the setting at 6805B5h. Tones which frequency is higher than 1500Hz refer to the setting at 6805B6h. 8. 68054A, 68054D, 68054E: The actual inter-digit pause (pulse dial mode) is the sum of the period specified by the RAM addresses 68054A, 68054D, and 68054E. D629 154 SM 4.10 DEDICATED TRANSMISSION PARAMETERS There are two sets of transmission parameters: Fax and E-mail Each Quick Dial Key and Speed Dial Code has eight bytes of programmable parameters allocated to it. If transmissions to a particular machine often experience problems, store that terminal’s fax number as a Quick Dial or Speed Dial, and adjust the parameters allocated to that number. The programming procedure will be explained first. Then, the eight bytes will be described. 4.10.1 PROGRAMMING PROCEDURE 1. Set the bit 0 of System Bit Switch 00 to 1. 2. Enter Address Book Management mode ([User Tools]> System Settings> Key Operator> Address Book Management). 3. Select the address book that you want to program. 4. For the fax parameter, select "Fax Dest.", for the E-mail parameter, select "E-mail", then press "Start". Make sure that the LED of the Start button lights green. 5. The settings for the switch 00 are now displayed. Press the bit number that you wish to change. 6. To scroll through the parameter switches, either: 7. Select the next switch: press "Next" or Select the previous switch: "Prev." until the correct switch is displayed. Then go back to step 6. 8. After the setting is changed, press "OK". 9. After finishing, reset bit 0 of System Bit Switch 00 to 0. SM 155 D629 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Dedicated Transmission Parameters Dedicated Transmission Parameters 4.10.2 PARAMETERS Fax Parameters The initial settings of the following fax parameters are all FF(H) - all the parameters are disabled. Switch 00 FUNCTION AND COMMENTS ITU-T T1 time (for PSTN G3 mode) If the connection time to a particular terminal is longer than the NCU parameter setting, adjust this byte. The T1 time is the value stored in this byte (in hex code), multiplied by 1 second. Range: 0 to 120 s (00h to 78h) FFh - The local NCU parameter factory setting is used. Do not program a value between 79h and FEh. Switch 01 No FUNCTION COMMENTS Tx level Bit4 Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 Bit0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 –1 0 0 0 1 0 –2 If communication with a particular remote terminal often contains errors, the signal level may be 0-4 inappropriate. Adjust the Tx level for communications with that terminal until the results are better. 0 0 0 1 1 –3 If the setting is "Disabled", the NCU 0 0 1 0 0 –4 parameter 01 setting is used. D629 0 1 1 1 1 –15 1 1 1 1 1 Disabled 156 Do not use settings other than listed on the left. SM Dedicated Transmission Parameters Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Use a higher setting if there is signal loss at higher frequencies because of the length of wire between the modem and the telephone exchange when calling the number stored in this Quick/Speed Dial. 5-7 Cable equalizer Also, try using the cable equalizer if Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 0 = None one or more of the following Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 1 = Low symptoms occurs. Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 0 = Medium Communication error with error Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 1 = High codes such as 0-20, 0-23, etc. Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 1 = Disabled Modem rate fallback occurs frequently. Do not use settings other than listed on the left. If the setting is "Disabled", the bit switch setting is used. Switch 02 No FUNCTION COMMENTS Initial Tx modem rate Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 Bit0 bps 0 0 0 0 Not used 0 0 0 1 2400 0 0 1 0 4800 0 0 1 1 7200 0 1 0 0 9600 If training with a particular remote terminal always takes too long, the initial modem rate may be too high. Reduce the initial Tx 0-3 modem rate using these bits. For the settings 14.4 or kbps slower, Switch 04 bit 4 must be changed to 0. Do not use settings other than listed on the left. If the setting is SM 0 1 0 1 12000 0 1 1 0 14400 0 1 1 1 16800 "Disabled", the bit switch setting is used. 157 D629 Dedicated Transmission Parameters 1 0 0 0 19200 1 0 0 1 21600 1 0 1 0 24000 1 0 1 1 26400 1 1 0 0 28800 1 1 0 1 31200 1 1 1 0 33600 1 1 1 1 Disabled Other settings: Not used 4-7 Not used Do not change the settings. Switch 03 No FUNCTION COMMENTS If "inch only" is selected on the machine uses Inch-mm conversion before tx inch-based resolutions for scanning, the printed Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 copy may be slightly distorted at the other end if = Inch-mm conversion that machine uses mm-based resolutions. 0-1 available If the setting is "Inch-mm conversion available ", Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 1 = Inch only Inch-mm conversion become effective to the Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 0 = Not used special senders. Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 1 = Disabled If the setting is "Disabled", the bit switch setting is used. DIS/NSF detection method Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 0 = First DIS or NSF 2-3 Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 1 = Second DIS or NSF Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 0 = Not used Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 1 = Disabled D629 (0, 1): Use this setting if echoes on the line are interfering with the set-up protocol at the start of transmission. The machine will then wait for the second DIS or NSF before sending DCS or NSS. If the setting is "Disabled", the bit switch setting is used. 158 SM Dedicated Transmission Parameters V.8 protocol 4 0: Off 1: Disabled Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) If transmissions to a specific destination always end at a lower modem rate (14,400 bps or lower), disable V.8 protocol so as not to use V.34 protocol. 0: V.34 communication will not be possible. If the setting is "Disabled", the bit switch setting is used. Compression modes available This bit determines the capabilities that are 5 in transmit mode informed to the other terminal during transmission. 0: MH only If the setting is "Disabled", the bit switch setting is 1: Disabled used. For example, if ECM is switched on but is not wanted when sending to a particular terminal, use ECM during transmission the (0, 0) setting. Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0 = Off 6-7 Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 1 = On V.8/V.34 protocol and JBIG compression Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 0 = Not used are automatically disabled if ECM is Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 1 = Disabled disabled. If the setting is "Disabled", the bit switch setting is used. Switch 04 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 05 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 06 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 07 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings) SM 159 D629 Dedicated Transmission Parameters E-mail Parameters The initial settings of the following e-mail parameters are all "0" (all parameters disabled). Switch 00 No FUNCTION COMMENTS MH Compression mode 0 for e-mail attachments Switches MH compression on and off for files 0: Off attached to e-mails for sending. 1: On MR Compression mode 1 for e-mail attachments Switches MR compression on and off for files 0: Off attached to e-mails for sending. 1: On MMR Compression mode 2 for e-mail attachments Switches MMR compression on and off for files 0: Off attached to e-mails for sending. 1: On 3-6 Not used Do not change these settings. Designates the bits to reference for 7 compression method of e-mail attachments 0: Registered (Bit 0 to 6) The "0" selection (default) references the settings for Bits 00, 01, 02 above. The "1" selection ignores the selections of Bits 00, 01, 02. 1: No registration. D629 160 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Dedicated Transmission Parameters Switch 01 No FUNCTION COMMENTS Original width of e-mail 0 attachment: A4 Sets the original width of the e-mail attachment as 0: Off A4. 1: On Original width of e-mail 1 attachment: B4 Sets the original width of the e-mail attachment as 0: Off B4. 1: On Original width of e-mail 2 attachment: A3 Sets the original width of the e-mail attachment as 0: Off A3. 1: On 3-6 Not used Do not change these settings. Designates the bits to reference for original size The "0" selection (default) references the settings for 7 of e-mail attachments Bits 00, 01, 02 above. The "1" selection ignores the 0: Registered (Bit 0 to 6) selections of Bits 00, 01, 02. 1: No registration. SM 161 D629 Dedicated Transmission Parameters Switch 02 No FUNCTION COMMENTS Line resolution of e-mail 0 attachment: 200 x 100 Sets the line resolution of the e-mail attachment as 0: Off 200 x100. 1: On Line resolution of e-mail 1 attachment: 200 x 200 Sets the line resolution of the e-mail attachment as 0: Off 200 x 200. 1: On Line resolution of e-mail 2 attachment: 200 x 400 Sets the line resolution of the e-mail attachment as 0: Off 200 x 400. 1: On 3 Not used Do not change these settings. Line resolution of e-mail 4 attachment: 400 x 400 Sets the line resolution of the e-mail attachment as 0: Off 400 x 400. 1: On 5-6 Not used Do not change these settings. Designates the bits to reference for original size The "0" selection (default) references the settings for 7 of e-mail attachments Bits 00, 01, 02, 04 above. The "1" selection ignores 0: Registered (Bit 0 to 6) the selections of Bits 00, 01, 02, 04. 1: No registration. D629 162 SM Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Dedicated Transmission Parameters Switch 03 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 04 No FUNCTION COMMENTS If the other ends have the addresses, which have 0 Full mode address the full mode function flag ("0"), this machine selection determines them as full mode standard machines. 0: Full mode address 1: No full mode (simple confirmation" to a message when transmitting. mode) This machine attaches the "demand of reception This machine updates the reception capability to the address book when receiving. 1-7 Not used Do not change these settings. Switch 05 No FUNCTION COMMENTS Directr transmission 0 selection to SMTP server Allows or does not allow the direct transmission to 0: ON SMTP server. 1: OFF 1-7 Not used Do not change these settings. Switch 06 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 07 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings) SM 163 D629 Service RAM Addresses 4.11 SERVICE RAM ADDRESSES Do not change the settings which are marked as “Not used” or “Read only.” 680001 to 680004(H) - ROM version (Read only) 680001(H) - Revision number (BCD) 680002(H) - Year (BCD) 680003(H) - Month (BCD) 680004(H) - Day (BCD) 680006 to 680015(H) - Machine’s serial number (16 digits - ASCII) 680018(H) - Total program checksum (low) 680019(H) - Total program checksum (high) 680020 to 68003F(H) - System bit switches 680050 to 68005F(H) - Printer bit switches 680060 to 68007F(H) - Communication bit switches 680080 to 68008F(H) - G3 bit switches 680090 to 68009F(H) - G3-2 bit switches: Not used 6800A0 to 6800AF(H) - G3-3 bit switches: Not used 6800D0(H) - User parameter switch 00 (SWUER_00) : Not used 6800D1(H) - User parameter switch 01 (SWUSR_01) : Not used 6800D2(H) - User parameter switch 02 (SWUSR_02) Bit 0: Forwarding mark printing on forwarded messages 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 1: Center mark printing on received copies (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 2: Reception time printing (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 3: TSI print on received messages 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 4: Checkered mark printing (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 5: Not used Bit 6: Not used Bit 7: Not used D629 164 SM Service RAM Addresses 6800D3(H) - User parameter switch 03 (SWUSR_03: Automatic report printout) Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Bit 0: Transmission result report (memory transmissions) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 1: Not used Bit 2: Memory storage report 0: Off, 1: On Bit 3: Polling reserve report (polling reception) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 4: Polling result report (polling reception) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 5: Transmission result report (immediate transmissions) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 6: Not used Bit 7: Journal 0: Off, 1: On 6800D4(H) - User parameter switch 04 (SWUSR_04: Automatic report printout) Bit 0: Not used Bit 1: Automatic communication failure report and transfer result report output 0: Off, 1: On Bits 2 to 3: Not used Bit 4: Indicates the parties 0: Not indicated, 1: Indicated Bit 5: Include sender’s name on reports 0: Off, 1: On Bit 6: Not used Bit 7: Inclusion of a sample image on reports 0: Off, 1: On 6800D5(H) - User parameter switch 05 (SWUSR_05) Bit 0: Substitute reception when the base copier is in an SC condition 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled Bits 1 and 2: Condition for substitute rx when the machine cannot print messages (Paper end, toner end, jam, and during night mode) Bit 2: 0, Bit 1: 0 = The machine receives all the fax messages. Bit 2: 0, Bit 1: 1 = The machine receives the fax messages with RTI or CSI. Bit 2: 1, Bit 1: 0 = The machine receives the fax messages with the same ID code. Bit 2: 1, Bit 1: 1 = The machine does not receive anything. Bit 3: Not used Bit 4: Not used Bit 5: Just size printing 0: Off, 1: On Bit 6: Not used Bit 7: Add paper display when a cassette is empty 0: Off, 1: On 6800D6(H) - User parameter switch 06 (SWUSR_06): Not used SM 165 D629 Service RAM Addresses 6800D7(H) - User parameter switch 07 (SWUSR_07) Bit 0 Ringing 0: Off, 1: On Bit1: Automatic answering message 0: Off, 1: On Bit 2: Parallel memory transmission 0: Off, 1: On Bits 3 and 4: Not used Bit 5: Remote control 0: Off, 1: On Bits 6 and 7: Not used 6800D8(H) - User parameter switch 08 (SWUSR_08) Bits 0 and 1: Not used. Bit 2: Authorized reception 0: Only faxes from senders whose RTIs/CSIs are specified for this feature are accepted. 1: Only faxes from senders whose RTIs/CSIs are not specified for this feature are accepted. Bits 3 to 7: Not used. 6800D9(H) - User parameter switch 09 (SWUSR_09): Not used 6800DA(H) - User parameter switch 10 (SWUSR_0A) Bits 0 to 2: Not used Bit 3: Page reduction 0: Off, 1: On Bits 4 and 5: Not used Bit 6: Use both e-mail notification and printed reports to confirm the transmission results 0: Off, 1: On Bit 7: Not used 6800DB(H) - User parameter switch 11 (SWUSR_0B) Bits 0 and 1: Not used Bit 2: White original detection 0: Off, 1: On (alarm and alert message on the LCD) Bit 3: Receive rejection for 1300 Hz transmission 0: Off (receive), 1: On (not receive) Bit 5: Not used Bit 6: Printout of messages received while acting as a forwarding station 0: Off, 1: On Bit 7: Not used 6800DC(H) - User parameter switch 12 (SWUSR_0C): Not used 6800DD(H) - User parameter switch 13 (SWUSR_0D): Not used D629 166 SM Service RAM Addresses Bit 0: Message printout while the machine is in Night Printing mode 0: On, 1: Off Bit 1: Maximum document length detection 0: Double letter, 1: Longer than double-letter (well log) – up to 1,200 mm Bit 2: Not used Bit 3: Fax mode settings, such as resolution, before a mode key (Copy/Fax/Printer/Scanner) is pressed 0: Not cleared, 1: Cleared Bits 4 to 6: Not used Bit 7: Not used 6800DF(H) - User parameter switch 15 (SWUSR_0F) (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) Bits 0, 1 and 2: Cassette for fax printout Bit 2: 0, Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 1 = 1st paper feed station Bit 2: 0, Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 0 = 2nd paper feed station Bit 2: 0, Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 1 = 3rd paper feed station Bit 2: 1, Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 4th paper feed station Bit 2: 1, Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 1 = LCT Other settings Not used Bits 3 and 4: Not used Bit 5: Using the cassette specified by bits 0, 1 and 2 above only 0: On, 1: Off Bits 6 and 7: Not used 6800E0(H) – User parameter switch 16 (SWUSR_10) (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) Bits 0 and 1: Not used Bit 2: Paper size selection priority for an A4 size fax message when A4/LT size paper is not available. 0: A3 has priority, 1: B4 has priority Bits 3 to 7: Not used 6800E1(H) – User parameter switch 17 (SWUSR_11) Bit 0: Not used Bit 1: Not used Bit 2: Inclusion of the “Add” button when a sequence of Quick/Speed dials is selected for broadcasting 0:Not needed, 1: Needed Bits 3 to 6: Not used Bit 7: Press “Start” key without an original when using the on hook dial or the external telephone, 0: displays “Cannot detect original size”. 1: Receives fax messages. SM 167 D629 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 6800DE(H) - User parameter switch 14 (SWUSR_0E) Service RAM Addresses 6800E2(H) - User parameter switch 18 (SWUSR_12) Bit 0: TTI date 0: Off, 1: On Bit 1: TTI sender 0: Off, 1: On Bit 2: TTI file number 0: Off, 1: On Bit 3: TTI page number 0: Off, 1: On Bits 4 to 6: Not used Bit 7: Japan only 6800E3(H) - User parameter switch 19 (SWUSR_13) Bit 0: Not used Bit 1: Journal format 0: The Journal is separated into transmissions and receptions 1: The Journal is separated into G3-1, G3-2, and G3-3 communications Bit 2: Not used Bit 3: 90° image rotation during B5 portrait Tx (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 4: Reduction of sample images on reports to 50% in the main scan and sub-scan directions. (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Technician adjustment (printer switch 0E bits 3 and 4), 1: 50% reduction Bit 5: Use of A5 size paper for reports (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Off, 1: On Bits 6 and 7: Not used 6800E4(H) - User parameter switch 20 (SWUSR_14) Bit 0: Automatic printing of the LAN fax result report 0: Off, 1: On Bit 1: Not used. Bits 2 to 5: Store documents in memory which could not be printed from PC fax (LAN fax) driver Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Setting 0 0 0 0 0 min. 0 0 0 1 1 min. 1 1 1 0 14 min. 1 1 1 1 15 min. Bits 6 and 7: Not used. D629 168 SM Service RAM Addresses Bit 0: Print results of sending reception notice request message 0: Disabled (print only when error occurs), 1: Enabled Bit 1: Respond to e-mail reception acknowledgment request 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 2: Not used Bit 3: File format for forwarded folders 0: TIFF, 1:PDF Bit 4: Transmit Journal by E-mail 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 5: Not used Bit 6: Network error display 0: Displayed, 1: Not displayed Bit 7: Transmit error mail notification 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled 6800E6(H) - User parameter switch 22 (SWUSR_16) (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) Bit 0: Dial tone detection (PSTN 1) 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bits 1 to 7: Not used 6800E7(H) – User parameter switch 23 (SWUSR_17): Not used 6800E8(H) - User parameter switch 24 (SWUSR_18): Not used 6800E9(H) - User parameter switch 25 (SWUSR_19) Bit 0: Not used Bit 1: Reception mode switch timer 0: Off, 1: On (switching Fax or Fax/Tel) Bit 2: Mode priority switch 0: Fax first, 1: Tel first Bit 3: Dial in function (Japan Only) Bit 4: RDS operation 0: Not acceptable, 1: Acceptable for the limit specified by system switch 03 This bit is only effective when RDS operation can be selected by the user (see system switch 02). Bits 5 to 7: Not used SM 169 D629 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 6800E5(H) - User parameter switch 21 (SWUSR_15) Service RAM Addresses 6800EA(H) and 6800EB(H) - User parameter switches 26 and 27 (SWUSR_1A and 1B): Not used 6800EC(H) - User parameter switch 28(SWUSR_1C): Not used 6800ED(H) - User parameter switch 29(SWUSR_1D): Not used 6800EE(H) and 6800EF(H) - User parameter switches 30 and 31 (SWUSR_1E and 1F): Not used 6800F0(H) - User parameter switch 32 (SWUSR_20) Bit 0: Quotation priority for a destination when there is no destination of the specified type 0: Paper output priority = Priority order: 1. IP-fax destination, 2. Fax Number, 3. E-mail address, 4. Folder 1: Electric putout order = Priority order: 1. E-mail address, 2. Folder, 3. IP-fax destination, 4. Fax number Bits 1 to 7: Not used 6800F1(H) - User parameter switch 33 (SWUSR_21): Not used 6800F2(H) - User parameter switch 34 (SWUSR_22) Bit 0: Gatekeeper server used with IP-Fax 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 1: SIP server used with IP-Fax 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bits 2 to 7: Not used 6800F3(H) - User parameter switch 35 (SWUSR_23) Redial interval when sending a backup file 6800F4(H) - User parameter switch 36 (SWUSR_24) Maximum number of redials when sending a backup file 6800F5-6800F8(H) - User parameter switch 37 (SWUSR_25) Bit 0: Stop sending a backup file if the destination folder becomes full while the machine is sending or waiting to send a fax or the backup file 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 1: Not used Bit 2 and 3: Backup file is printed along with the TX communication failure report when a backup file transmission failure occurs. 00: Do not print, 01: Print first page only, 10: Print whole file Bit 4: Display the sender's information in the file name of documents that are forwarded to folder destinations. 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 5: Limit the file names of documents that are forwarded to folder destinations to plain characters only. 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 6 to 7: Not used 6800F9(H) - User parameter switch 40 (SWUSR_28) Bit 0: When memory space is insufficient, the machine prints and then deletes the oldest faxes, creating memory space for storage of new faxes. 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 1 to 7: Not used D629 170 SM Service RAM Addresses Rev. 11/15/2012 Bit 0 and 1: File format for files transmitted to e-mail addresses and folders registered as forwarding, destinations of backup file transmission, receivers for Personal Box, or end receivers for Transfer Box. 0: PDF 1: PDF/A ⇒ Bit 3: 0- Follow settings of received document (default), 1- Do not print Bit 2, 4 to 7: Not used 680100 to 68010F(H) - G4 Parameter Switches – Not used 680110 to 68012F(H) - G4 Internal Switches – Not used 680130 to 68016F(H) - Service Switches 680170 to 68017F(H) - IFAX Switches 680180 to 68018F(H) - IP-FAX Switches 680190 to 6801AF(H) - Service station’s fax number (SP3-101) 6801B0 to 6801B9(H) - Own fax PABX extension number – Not used 6801BA to 6801C3(H) - Own fax number (PSTN) – Not used 6801C4 to 6801D7(H) - Own fax number (ISDN G4) – Not used 6801D8 to 6801E3(H) - The first subscriber number (ISDN G3) – Not used 6801E4 to 6801EF(H) - The second subscriber number (ISDN G3) – Not used 6801F0 to 6801FB(H) - The first subscriber number (ISDN G4) – Not used 6801FC to 680207(H) - The second subscriber number (ISDN G4) – Not used 680208 to 68021B(H) - PSTN-1 RTI (Max. 20 characters - ASCII) - See the following note. 68021C to 68022F(H) - PSTN-2 RTI (Max. 20 characters - ASCII) - Not used 680230 to 680246(H) - PSTN-3 RTI (Max. 20 characters - ASCII) - Not used 680247 to 680286(H) - TTI 1 (Max. 64 characters - ASCII) - See the following note. 680287 to 6802C6(H) - TTI 2 (Max. 64 characters - ASCII) - Not used 6802C7 to 680306(H) - TTI 3 (Max. 64 characters - ASCII) - Not used 680307 to 68031A(H) - PSTN-1 CSI (Max. 20 characters - ASCII) 68031B to 68032E(H) - PSTN-2 CSI (Max.20 characters - ASCII) - Not used 68032F to 680342(H) - PSTN-3 CSI (Max.20 characters - ASCII) - Not used 680343(H) - Number of PSTN-1 CSI characters (Hex) 680344(H) - Number of PSTN-2 CSI characters (Hex) - Not used 680345(H) Number of PSTN-3 CSI characters (Hex) - Not used SM 171 D629 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 6800FF(H) - User parameter switch 45 (SWUSR_2D) Service RAM Addresses If the number of characters is less than the maximum (20 for RTI, 32 for TTI), add a stop code (00[H]) after the last character. 680380 to 680387(H) - Last power off time (Read only) 680380(H) - 01(H) - 24-hour clock, 00(H) - 12-hour clock (AM), 02(H) - 12-hour clock (PM) 680381(H) - Year (BCD) 680382(H) - Month (BCD) 680383(H) - Day (BCD) 680384(H) – Hour 680385(H) – Minute 680386(H) – Second 680387(H) - 00: Monday, 01: Tuesday, 02: Wednesday, /// , 06: Sunday 680394(H) - Optional equipment (Read only – Do not change the settings) Bit 0: Page Memory 0: Not installed, 1: Installed Bit 1: SAF Memory 0: Not installed, 1: Installed Bits 2 to 7; Not used 680395(H) - Optional equipment (Read only – Do not change the settings) Bits 0 to 3: Not used Bit 4: G3-2 0: Not installed, 1: Installed Bit 5: G3-3 0: Not installed, 1: Installed Bit 6 and 7: Not used 680406 to 68040A – Option G3 board (G3-2) ROM information (Read only) 680406(H) - Suffix (BCD) 680407(H) - Version (BCD) 680408(H) - Year (BCD) 680409(H) - Month (BCD) 68040A(H) - Day (BCD) 68040B to 68040F – Option G3 board (G3-3) ROM information (Read only) 68040B(H) - Suffix (BCD) 68040C(H) - Version (BCD) 68040D(H) - Year (BCD) 68040E(H) - Month (BCD) 68040F(H) - Day (BCD) 680410(H) - G3-1 Modem ROM version (Read only) 680412(H) - G3-2 Modem ROM version (Read only) 680414(H) - G3-3 Modem ROM version (Read only) D629 172 SM Service RAM Addresses Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 680420(H) - Number of multiple sets print (Read only) 680476(H) - Time for economy transmission (hour in 24h clock format - BCD) 680477(H) - Time for economy transmission (minute - BCD) 680492(H) - Transmission monitor volume 00 - 07(H) 680493(H) - Reception monitor volume 00 - 07(H) 680494(H) - On-hook monitor volume 00 - 07(H) 680495(H) - Dialing monitor volume 00 - 07(H) 680496(H) - Buzzer volume 680497(H) - Beeper volume 00 - 07(H) 00 - 07(H) 6804A8(H) - Machine code (Check ram 4) 68AFDA(H) - IP-Fax backup data 00 - 600 (H) - Not used 69A614(H) - Own e-mail address for internet fax (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69A794(H) - User code for fax e-mail account (Max. 192 characters - ASCII) 69A854(H) – Password for fax e-mail account (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69A914(H) - Transmission mail size restriction for internet fax (Max. 4 bit) 69A918(H) - E-mail address for SMTP reception (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69A998(H) – Destination number for reception report e-mail (Max. 4 byte) 69FB40(H) to 69FDC0(H) - SIP server address (Read only) 69FB40(H) - Proxy server - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69FBC0(H) - Proxy server - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69FC40(H) - Redirect server - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69FCC0(H) - Redirect server - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69FD40(H) - Registrar server - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69FDC0(H) - Registrar server - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69FE40(H) - Gatekeeper server address - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69FEC0(H) - Gatekeeper server address - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69FF40(H) - Arias Number (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69FFC0(H) - SIP user name (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 6A0040H(H) - SIP digest authentication password (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 6A00C0H(H) - Gateway address information (Max. 7100 characters - ASCII) 6A1C7C(H) - Stand-by port number for H.323 connection 6A1C7E(H) - Stand-by port number for SIP connection 6A1C80(H) - RAS port number 6A1C82(H) - Gatekeeper port number 6A1C84(H) - Port number of data waiting for T.38 SM 173 D629 Service RAM Addresses 6A1C86(H) - Port number of SIP server 6A1C88(H) - Priority for SIP and H.323 0: H.323, 1: SIP 6A1C89(H) - SIP function 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled 6A1C8A(H) - H.323 function 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled 6A1C8B(H) - SIP digest authentication function 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled 6B9000 to 6B91FF(H) - Error code (Max. 512 byte) 6B9200 to 6BD61F - Reception results (Max. 17440 byte) 6BD620 to 6BDFA7 - Transmission error (Max. 2440 byte) 6BEBFE(H) - 6BEC1E (H) - Dial tone detection parameter (Max. 11 x 3 lines) This initializes following order. [0x04, 0x40, 0x03, 0x60, 0x64, 0xf4, 0x01,0x64, 0x04, 0xc8, 0x00] 6BEBFE(H) – Dial tone detection frequency – Upper limit (High) Defaults: NA: 06, EU: 06, ASIA: 06 6BEBFF(H) – Dial tone detection frequency – Upper Limit (Low) Defaults: NA: 50, EU: 50, ASIA: 50 6BEC00(H) – Dial tone detection frequency – Lower Limit (High) Defaults: NA: 03, EU: 02, ASIA: 02 6BEC01(H) – Dial tone detection frequency – Lower Limit (Low) Defaults: NA: 60, EU: 90, ASIA: 90 6BEC02(H) –Dial tone detection waiting time (20 ms) Defaults: NA: 64, EU 64, ASIA: 64 6BEC03 to 6BEC04 – Dial tone detection monitoring time (20 ms) Defaults Area 6BEC03 6BEC04 NA F4 01 EU F4 01 ASIA F4 01 6BEC05(H) – Dial tone detect judge time (20 ms) Defaults: NA: 64, EU: 1B, ASIA: 32 6BEC06(H) – Dial tone disconnect permission time (20 ms) Defaults: NA: 11, EU: 0F, ASIA: 11 D629 174 SM Overview Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 5. DETAILED SECTION DESCRIPTIONS 5.1 OVERVIEW The FCU controls all the fax communications and fax features, in cooperation with the controller board. Also, the FCU contains the ROM, SRAM and NCU circuit. Fax Options: Extra G3 Interface option: This provides one more analog line interface. This allows full dual access. Two extra G3 interface options can be installed. Memory Expansion: This expands the SAF memory and the page memory (used for image rotation); without this expansion, the page memory is not big enough for image rotation at 400 dpi, so transmission at 400 dpi is not possible. SM 175 D629 Boards 5.2 BOARDS 5.2.1 FCU The FCU (Facsimile Control Unit) controls fax communications, the video interface to the base copier’s engine, and all the fax options. FACE3.5 (Fax Application Control Engine) CPU Data compression and reconstruction (DCR) DMA control Clock generation DRAM backup control Modem (FAME2) V.34, V33, V17, V.29, V.27ter, V.21, and V.8 DRAM The 16 MB of DRAM is shared as follows. SAF memory: 4MB Working memory: 4MB Page memory: 8MB The SAF memory is backed up by a rechargeable battery. D629 176 SM Boards 4MB flash ROMs for system software storage SRAM The 512 KB SRAM for system and user parameter storage is backed up by a lithium battery. Memory Back-up A rechargeable battery backs up the SAF memory (DRAM) for 12 hours. A lithium battery backs up the system parameters and programmed items in the SRAM, in case the base copier's main switch is turned off. Switches Item SW1 SM Description Switches the SRAM backup battery on/off. 177 D629 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) ROM Boards 5.2.2 SG3 BOARD The SG3 board allows up to three simultaneous communications when used in combination with the FCU and optional G3 boards. The NCU is on the same board as the common SG-3 board. This makes the total board structure smaller. But, the specifications of the SG3 board do not change. NCCP (New Communication Control Processor) Controls the SG3 board. CPU (RU30) DPRAM (Dual Port RAM): Handshaking with the FCU is done through this block. DMA controller JBIG DSP V34 modem (RL5T892): Includes the DTMF Receiver function DCR for MH, MR, MMR, and JBIG compression and decompression D629 178 SM Boards FROM 1Mbyte flash ROM for SG3 software storage and modem software storage Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) SDRAM 4Mbyte DRAM shared between ECM buffer, line buffer, and working memory AFE (Analog Front End) Analog processing CODEC (COder-DECoder) A/D & D/A conversions for modem REG SM Generates +3.3 V from the +5V from the FCU 179 D629 Video Data Path 5.3 VIDEO DATA PATH 5.3.1 TRANSMISSION Memory Transmission and Parallel Memory Transmission The base copier's scanner scans the original at the selected resolution in inch format. The IPU processes the data and transfers it to the FCU. D629 180 SM When scanning a fax original, the IPU uses the MTF, independent dot erase and thresholding parameter settings programmed in the fax unit’s scanner bit switches, not the copier's SP modes. Then, the FCU converts the data to mm format, and compresses the data in MMR or raw format to store it in the SAF memory. If image rotation will be done, the image is rotated in page memory before compression. At the time of transmission, the FCU decompresses the stored data, then re-compresses and/or reduces the data if necessary for transmission. The NCU transmits the data to the line. Immediate Transmission The base copier's scanner scans the original at the resolution agreed with the receiving terminal. The IPU video processes the data and transfers it to the FCU. When scanning a fax original, the IPU uses the MTF, independent dot erase and thresholding parameter settings programmed in the fax unit’s scanner bit switches, not the copier's SP modes. Then the FCU stores the data in page memory, and compresses the data for transmission. The NCU transmits the data to the line. JBIG Transmission Memory transmission: If the receiver has JBIG compression, the data goes from the DCR to the QM-Coder. Then the NCU transmits the data to the line. When an optional G3 unit (SG3) is installed and PSTN2 is selected as the line type, JBIG compression is available, but only for the PSTN-2 line. Immediate transmission: If the receiver has JBIG compression, the data goes from the page memory to the QM-Coder. Then the NCU transmits the data to the line. When an optional G3 unit (SG3) is installed and PSTN2 is selected as the line type, JBIG compression is available, but only for the PSTN-2 line. Adjustments SM Priority for the line used for G3 transmissions (PSTN 1/PSTN 2 or 3): System switch 16 bit 1 181 D629 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Video Data Path Video Data Path 5.3.2 RECEPTION First, the FCU stores the incoming data from either an analog line to the SAF memory. (The data goes to the FACE3 at the same time, and is checked for error lines/frames.) The FCU then decompresses the data and transfers it to page memory. If image rotation will be done, the image is rotated in the page memory. The data is transferred to the IPU. If the optional G3 unit is installed, the line that the message comes in on depends on the telephone number dialled by the other party (the optional G3 unit has a different telephone number from the main fax board). JBIG Reception When data compressed with JBIG comes in on PSTN-1 (the standard analog line), the data is sent to the QM-CODER for decompression. Then the data is stored in the page memory, and transferred to the IPU. When data compressed with JBIG comes in on PSTN-2 (optional extra analog line), the data is sent to the QM-CODER on the SG3 board for decompression. D629 182 SM Fax Communication Features Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 5.4 FAX COMMUNICATION FEATURES 5.4.1 MULTI-PORT When the optional extra G3 Interface Unit is installed, communication can take place at the same time through the two or three lines at once. Option Standard only PSTN (double) SM Combinations G3 Extra G3 Interface Unit (single) PSTN + PSTN Extra G3 Interface Unit Available protocol Available Line Type PSTN + PSTN +PSTN 183 G3 + G3 G3 + G3 +G3 D629 Fax Communication Features 5.4.2 DOCUMENT SERVER The base copier's scanner scans the original at the selected resolution. The IPU video processes the data and transfers it to the controller board. Then the controller stores the data in the page memory for the copier function, and compresses the data in MMR (by software) to store it in the HDD. If image rotation will be done, the image is rotated in the page memory before compression. For transmission, the stored image data is transferred to the FCU. The FCU decompresses the image data, then recompresses and/or reduces the data if necessary for transmission. The NCU transmits the data to the line. The documents can be stored in the HDD (Document Server) from the fax application. The stored documents in the document sever can be used for the fax transmission in many times. More than one document and the scanned document can be combined into one file and then the file can be transmitted. When using the document server, the SAF memory is not used. The document is compressed with MMR and stored. Up to 9,000 pages can be stored (1 file: Up to 1,000 pages) from the fax application. Only stored documents from the fax application can be transmitted. Scanned documents are given a name automatically, such as "FAX001". But it is possible to change the file name, user name and password. Up to 30 files can be selected at once. D629 184 SM The compression method of the fax application is different from the copy application. The storing time is longer than the copier storing. When selecting "Print 1st page", the stored document will be reduced to A4 size. 5.4.3 INTERNET MAIL COMMUNICATION Mail Transmission T.37 simple and full modes This machine supports T.37 full mode. (ITU-T Recommendation, RFC2532). The difference between T.37 simple mode and full mode is as follows. Function T.37 Simple Mode T.37 Full Mode 200 x100 Resolution 200 x 100 200 x 200 200 x 200 200 x 400 400 x 400 (if available) RX Paper Width A4 A4, B4, A3 RX Data Compression Method MH MH (default), MR, MMR, Image data transmission, exchange of capability Signals Image data information between the two transmission only terminals, and acknowledgement of receipt of fax messages SM 185 D629 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Fax Communication Features Fax Communication Features Data Formats The scanned data is converted into a TIFF-F formatted file. The fields of the e-mail and their contents are as follows: Field Content From Mail address of the sender Reply To Destination requested for reply To Mail address of the destination Bcc Backup mail address Subject From CSI or RTI (Fax Message No. xxxx) Content Type Content Transfer Encoding Message Body Multipart/mixed Attached files: image/tiff Base 64, 7-bit, 8-bit, Quoted Printable MIME-converted TIFF-F (MIME standards specify how files are attached to e-mail messages) Direct SMTP Transmission Internet Fax documents can be sent directly to their destinations without going through the SMTP server. (Internet Faxes normally transmit via the SMTP server.) For example: e-mail address: gts@ricoh.co.jp SMTP server address: gts.abcd.com In this case, this feature destination e-mail address (gts@ricoh.co.jp) is read as the SMTP server address "gts.abcd.com", and the transmissions bypass the SMTP server. D629 186 SM Fax Communication Features These options are available for selection: With the default settings, the scan resolution can be either standard or detail. Inch-mm conversion before TX depends on IFAX SW01 Bit 7. Detail resolution will be used if Super Fine resolution is selected, unless Fine resolution is enabled with IFAX SW01. The requirements for originals (document size, scan width, and memory capacity) are the same as for G3 fax memory TX. The default compression is TIFF-F format. IFAX SW00: Acceptable paper widths for sending IFAX SW09: Maximum number of attempts to the same destination Secure Internet Transmission SMTP Authentication: User Tools> System Settings> File Transfer> SMTP Authentication POP Before SMTP: User Tools> System Settings> File Transfer> POP Before SMTP Mail Reception Three Types This machine supports three types of e-mail reception: POP3 (Post Office Protocol Ver. 3.) IMAP4 (Internet Messaging Access Protocol) SMTP (Simple Mail Transfer Protocol) For details: Core Technology Manual – Facsimile Processes – Faxing from a PC – Internet/LAN Fax Boards – Mail Reception POP3/IMAP4 Mail Reception Procedure The machine automatically picks up e-mail from the server at an interval which is adjustable in the range 2 to 1440 min. in 1-minute steps: User Tools> System Settings> File Transfer> E-mail Reception Interval SMTP Reception 1. The IFAX must be registered as an SMTP server in the MX record of the DNS server, and the address of the received mail must specify the IFAX. 2. To enable SMTP reception: User Tools> System Settings> File Transfer> Reception Protocol Even if the MX record on the DNS server includes the IFAX, mail cannot be received with SMTP until SMTP reception is enabled: However, if SMTP reception is selected and the machine is not registered in the MX record of the DNS server, then either IMAP4 or POP3 is used, depending on the setting: User Tools> System Settings> File Transfer> Reception Protocol SM 187 D629 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Selectable Options Fax Communication Features Mail Delivery Conditions: Transferring Mail Received With SMTP 1. The machine must be set up for SMTP mail delivery: 2. User Tools> Facsimile Features> Reception Settings> SMTP RX File Delivery Settings If the user wishes to limit this feature so that the machine will only deliver mail from designated senders, the machine's "Auth. E-mail RX" feature must be set (User Tools> Facsimile Features> Reception Settings> SMTP RX File Delivery Settings). 3. If the "SMTP RX File Delivery Setting" is set to “Off” to prohibit SMTP receiving, and if there is mail designated for delivery, then the machine responds with an error. (User Tools> Facsimile Features> Reception Settings> SMTP RX File Delivery Settings) 4. If the quick dial, speed dial, or group dial entry is incorrect, the mail transmission is lost, and the IFAX issues an error to the SMTP server and outputs an error report. Auth. E-mail RX In order to limit access to mail delivery with IFAX, the addresses of senders must be limited using the Access Limit Entry. Only one entry can be registered. 1. Access Limit Entry For example, to limit access to @IFAX.ricoh.co.jp: gts@IFAX.ricoh.co.jp Matches and is delivered. gts@IFAX.abcde.co.jp Does not match and is not delivered. IFAX@ricoh.co.jp Does not match and is not delivered. 1. Conditions The length of the Access Limit Entry is limited to 127 characters. If the Access Limit Entry address and the mail address of the incoming mail do not match, the incoming mail is discarded and not delivered, and the SMTP server responds with an error. However, in this case an error report is not output. If the Access Limit Entry address is not registered, and if the incoming mail specifies a delivery destination, then the mail is delivered unconditionally. D629 188 SM Handling Mail Reception Errors Abnormal files When an error of this type occurs, the machine stops receiving and commands the server to erase the message. Then the machine prints an error report and sends information about the error by e-mail to the sender address (specified in the "From" or "Reply-to" field of the message). If there is an incomplete received message in the machine memory, it will be erased. The machine prints an error message when it fails to send the receive error notification after a certain number of attempts. The following types of files are judged to be abnormal if one or more of the following are detected: 1. Unsupported MIME headers. Supported types of MIME header Header Content-Type Charset Content-TransferEncoding Supported Types Multipart/mixed, text/plain, message/rfc822 Image/tiff US-ASCII, ISO 8859 X. Other types cannot be handled, and some garbage may appear in the data. Base 64, 7-bit, 8-bit, Quoted Printable 2. MIME decoding errors 3. File format not recognized as TIFF-F format 4. Resolution, document size, or compression type cannot be accepted Remaining SAF capacity error The machine calls the server but does not receive e-mail if the remaining SAF capacity is less than a certain value (the value depends on IFAX Switch 08. The e-mail will be received when the SAF capacity increases (for example, after substitute reception files have been printed). The error handling method for this type of error is the same as for "Abnormal files". If the capacity of the SAF memory drops to zero during reception, the machine operates in the same way as when receiving an abnormal file (refer to "Abnormal files" above). SM 189 D629 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Fax Communication Features Fax Communication Features Secure Internet Reception To enable password encryption and higher level security: User Tools> System Settings> File Transfer> POP3/IMAP4 Settings> Encryption (set to "On") Transfer Request: Request By Mail For details: Core Technology Manual – Facsimile Processes – Faxing from a PC – Internet/LAN Fax Boards – Transfer Request The fields of the e-mail and their contents are as follows: Field Content From E-mail address of the requesting terminal To Destination address (Transfer Station address) Bcc Backup mail address Subject From TSI (Fax Message No. xxxx) Content-Type Multipart/mixed Text/Plain (for a text part), image/tiff (for attached files) Content-Transfer-Encoding Base 64, 7-Bit, 8-bit, Quoted Printable Mail body (text part) Message body D629 RELAY-ID-: xxxx (xxxx: 4 digits for an ID code) RELAY: #01#*X#**01…. MIME-converted TIFF-F. 190 SM E-Mail Options (Sub TX Mode) The following features are available as options for mail sending: entering a subject, designating the level of importance, confirming reception of the mail. Subject and Level of Importance You can enter a subject message with: TX Mode> Subject The Subject entry for the mail being sent is limited to 128 characters. The subject can also be prefixed with an "Confidential", "Urgent", "Please phone" or "Copy to corres. Section" notation. - How the Subject Differs According to Mail Type - Mail Type Subject Entry Item 1 --- Item 2 Entry Condition 1. "CSI" ("RTI") Fax Message No. 2. "RTI" CSI not registered 3. "CSI" RTI not registered No Subject Entry Item 3 4. None + File No. CSI, RTI not registered 1. "CSI" ("RTI") Normal: Return Receipt (dispatched). Confirmation of Reception 2. "RTI" CSI not registered You can select "displayed" with IFAX From SW02 Bits 2 and 3. 3. "CSI" RTI not registered Error: Return Receipt 4. None Mail delivery, RTI or CSI of memory the station transfer, designated SMTP From CSI, RTI not registered (processed/error) Mail delivery Fax Message No. + for delivery File Number receiving RTI or CSI of Mail sending from G3 and delivery sender memory SM 191 D629 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Fax Communication Features Fax Communication Features Mail Type Item 1 Item 2 Mail address of sender Mail address of sender Mail error notification --- Item 3 Memory sending SMTP receiving and delivery (Off Ramp Gateway) Error Message No. xxxx From CSI (RTI) Items 1, 2, and 3 in the table above are in the Subject. - Subjects Displayed on the PC - E-mail Messages After entering the subject, you can enter a message with: TX Mode> Text An e-mail message (up to 5 lines) can be pre-registered with: User Tools> System Settings> File Transfer> Program/Change/Delete E-mail Message - Limitations on Entries - Item Maximum Number of Lines 5 lines Line Length 80 characters Name Length 20 characters D629 192 SM Fax Communication Features For details: Core Technology Manual – Facsimile Processes – Faxing from a PC – Internet/LAN Fax Boards – E-mail Options The network system administrator can confirm whether a sent mail has been received correctly or not. This confirmation is done in four steps. 1. Send request for confirmation of mail reception. To enable or disable this request (known as MDN): TX Mode> Reception Notice 2. Mail reception (receive confirmation request) 3. Send confirmation of mail reception 4. Receive confirmation of mail reception The other party's machine will not respond to the request unless the two conditions below are met: The other party's machine must be set up to respond to the confirmation request. The other party's machine must support MDN (Message Disposition Notification). - Setting up the Receiving Party The receiving party will respond to the confirmation request if: 1. The "Disposition Notification To" field is in the received mail header (automatically inserted in the 4th line in the upper table on the previous page, if MDN is enabled), and 2. Sending the disposition notification must be enabled (User Parameter Setting SW21 (15 [H]) Bit 1 for this model). The content of the response is as follows: SM Normal reception: "Return Receipt (dispatched)" in the Subject line IFAX SW02 (Bit 2, 3) "Return Receipt (displayed)" in the Subject line Error: "Return Receipt (processed/error)" in the Subject line 193 D629 Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) Message Disposition Notification (MDN) Fax Communication Features Handling Reports - Sending a Request for a Return Receipt by Mail After the mail sender transmits a request for a return receipt, the mail sender's journal is annotated with two hyphens (--) in the Result column and a "Q" in the Mode column. - Mail Receipt (Request for Receipt Confirmation) and Sending Mail Receipt Response After the mail receiver sends a response to the request for a return receipt, the mail receiver's journal is annotated with two hyphens (--) in the Result column and an "A" in the Mode column. - Receiving the Return Receipt Mail After the mail sender receives a return receipt, the information in the mail sender's journal about the receipt request is replaced, i.e. the journal is annotated with "OK" in the Result column. When the return receipt reports an error, the journal is annotated with an "E" in the Result column. The arrival of the return receipt is not recorded in the journal as a separate communication. Its arrival is only reported by the presence of "OK" or "E" in the Result column. If the mail address used by the sender specifies a mailing list (i.e., a Group destination; the machine sends the mail to more than one location. See "How to set up Mail Delivery"), the Result column of the Journal is updated every time a return receipt is received. For example, if the mailing list was to 5 destinations, the Result column indicates the result of the communication with the 5th destination only. The results of the communications to the first 4 destinations are not shown. Exceptions: If one of the communications had an error, the Result column will indicate E, even if subsequent communications were OK. If two of the communications had an error, the Journal will indicate the destination for the first error only. - Report Sample - D629 194 SM IP-Fax Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 5.5 IP-FAX 5.5.1 WHAT IS IP-FAX? For details: Core Technology Manual – Facsimile Processes – Faxing from a PC – Internet/LAN Fax Boards – IP-FAX 5.5.2 T.38 PACKET FORMAT TCP is selected by default for this machine, but you can change this to UDP with IPFAX SW 00 Bit 1. UDP Related Switches IP-Fax Switch 01 No. Function Comments Select IP FAX Delay Level Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Raise the level by selecting a higher Bit 0 Level 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 0 2 setting if too many transmission errors are occurring on the network. If TCP/UDP is enabled on the network, raise this setting on the T.30 machine. 0-3 Increasing the delay time allows the recovery of more lost packets. If only UDP is enabled, increase the number of redundant packets. 0 0 1 1 3 Level 1~2: 3 Redundant packets Level 3: 4 Redundant packets SM 195 D629 IP-Fax 5.5.3 SETTINGS User parameter switch 34 (22[H]), bit 0 IP-Fax Gate Keeper usage, 0: No, 1: Yes IP Fax Switches: Various IP-FAX settings (see the bit switch table) D629 196 SM General Specifications Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 6. SPECIFICATIONS 6.1 GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS 6.1.1 FCU Type: Circuit: Connection: Desktop type transceiver PSTN (max. 3ch.) PABX Direct couple Book (Face down) Maximum Length: 432 mm [17 ins] Maximum Width: 297 mm [11.7 ins] ARDF (Face up) Original Size: (Single-sided document) Length: 128 - 1200 mm [5.0 - 47.2 ins] Width: 105 - 297 mm [4.1 - 11.7 inch] (Double-sided document) Length: 128 - 432 mm [5.0 - 17 inch] Width: 105 - 297 mm [4.1 - 11.7 inch] Scanning Method: Flat bed, with CCD G3 8 x 3.85 lines/mm (Standard) 8 x 7.7 lines/mm (Detail) 8 x 15.4 line/mm (Fine) See Note1 Resolution: 16 x15.4 line/mm (Super Fine) See Note 1 200 x 100 dpi (Standard) 200 x 200 dpi (Detail) 400 x 400 dpi (Super Fine) See Note 1 SM Optional Expansion Memory required 197 D629 General Specifications G3: 3 s at 28800 bps; Measured with G3 ECM using memory for Transmission Time: an ITU-T #1 test document (Slerexe letter) at standard resolution Data Compression: MH, MR, MMR, JBIG Protocol: Group 3 with ECM Modulation: V.34, V.33, V.17 (TCM), V.29 (QAM), V.27ter (PHM), V.8, V.21 (FSK) G3: 33600/31200/28800/26400/24000/21600/ Data Rate: 19200/16800/14400/12000/9600/7200/4800/2400 bps Automatic fallback I/O Rate: With ECM: 0 ms/line Without ECM: 2.5, 5, 10, 20, or 40 ms/line SAF Standard: 4 MB With optional Expansion Memory: 28 MB (4 MB+ 24 MB) Memory Capacity: Page Memory Standard: 8 MB (Print: 4 MB + Scanner: 4 MB) With optional Expansion Memory: 16 MB (8 MB + 8 MB) (Print 8 MB + Scanner: 8 MB) D629 198 SM Capabilities of Programmable Items Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 6.2 CAPABILITIES OF PROGRAMMABLE ITEMS The following table shows the capabilities of each programmable items. Item Standard Quick Dial 2000 Groups 100 Destination per Group 500 Destinations dialed from the ten-key pad overall 500 Programs 100 Auto Document 6 Communication records for Journal stored in the memory 200 Specific Senders 30 The following table shows how the capabilities of the document memory will change after the Expansion Memory are installed. SM 199 D629 Capabilities of Programmable Items Memory Transmission file Without the With the Expansion Expansion Memory Memory 400 400 1000 1000 320 2240 Maximum number of page for memory transmission Memory capacity for memory transmission (Note1) Measured using an ITU-T #1 test document (Slerexe letter) at the standard resolution, the auto image density mode and the Text mode. D629 200 SM IFAX Specifications Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 6.3 IFAX SPECIFICATIONS Local area network Connectivity: Ethernet 100base-Tx/10base-T Gigabit Ethernet 1000 Base-T IEEE802.11a/g, g (wireless LAN), 200 × 100 dpi (Standard resolution), 200 × 200 dpi (Detail resolution), 200 × 400 dpi (Fine resolution)*1, 400 × 400 dpi (Super Resolution: Fine resolution)*1 To use 200 × 400 dpi and 400 × 400 dpi, IFAX SW01 Bit 2 and/or Bit 4 must be set to “1”. 1 s (through a LAN to the server) Condition: ITU-T #1 test document (Selerexe Letter) MTF correction: OFF Transmission TTI: None Time: Resolution: 200 x 100 dpi Communication speed: 10 Mbps Correspondent device: E-mail server Line conditions: No terminal access Maximum Original Size: A3/DLT. Document Size: To use B4 and A3 width, IFAX SW00 Bit 1 (B4) and/or Bit 2 (A3) must be set to “1”. E-mail File Format: Single/multi-part MIME conversion Image: TIFF-F (MH, MR, MMR) Transmission: Protocol: SMTP, TCP/IP Reception: POP3, SMTP, IMAP4, TCP/IP SM 201 D629 IFAX Specifications 1000 Mbps (1000 Base-T) Data Rate: 100 Mbps (100base-Tx) 10 Mbps (10base-T) Authentication Method: Remark: SMTP-AUTH POP before SMTP A-POP The machine must be set up as an e-mail client before installation. Any client PCs connected to the machine through a LAN must also be e-mail clients, or some features will not work (e.g. Autorouting). D629 202 SM IP-FAX Specifications Fax Option Type 5002 (D629) 6.4 IP-FAX SPECIFICATIONS Local Area Network Network: Ethernet/10base-T, 100base-TX Gigabit Ethernet/1000 Base-T IEEE802.11a/g, g (wireless LAN) 8 x 3.85 lines/mm, 200x100dpi (standard character), 8 x 7.7lines/mm, 200x200dpi (detail character), Scan line density: 8 x 15.4lines/mm (fine character: optional expansion memory required), 16 x 15.4lines/mm, 400x400dpi (super fine character: optional expansion memory required) Maximum Original A3 or 11" x 17" (DLT) size: Custom: 297mm x 1200mm (11.7” x 47.3”) Maximum scanning size: 297mm x 1200mm (11.7” x 47.3”) Transmission Recommended: T.38 Annex protocol, TCP, UDP/IP protocol: communication, SIP (RFC 3261 compliant), H.323 v2 Compatible machines: IP-Fax compatible machines Specify IP address and send faxes to an IP-Fax compatible fax IP-Fax transmission through a network. function: Also capable of sending faxes from a G3 fax connected to a telephone line via a VoIP gateway. Receive faxes sent from an IP-Fax compatible fax through a IP-Fax reception network. function: Also capable of receiving faxes from a G3 fax connected to a telephone line via a VoIP gateway. SM 203 D629 Fax Unit Configuration 6.5 FAX UNIT CONFIGURATION Component Code No. FCU 3 D629 Included with fax unit Speaker Expansion Memory Remarks 1 G578 CCU I/F Board 2 Optional 6 Included with optional G3 unit 4 Included with optional G3 unit D629 SG3 Board SG3 Board D629 5 Optional Handset Type C5502 D645 - Optional (NA only) D629 204 SM D631 RT3020 - 1200-SHEET LCT R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY P ag e Dat e Ad d ed/ Upd at ed/ New None RT3020 - 1200-SHEET LCT (D631) TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT........................................... 1 1.1 COVERS ........................................................................................................1 1.1.1 REAR COVER ......................................................................................1 1.1.2 RIGHT DOOR .......................................................................................1 1.1.3 FRONT AND TOP COVERS ................................................................2 1.2 PAPER FEED ................................................................................................3 1.2.1 PICK-UP, PAPER FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLERS ....................3 1.3 DRIVE ............................................................................................................4 1.3.1 PAPER FEED CLUTCH........................................................................4 1.3.2 PAPER FEED MOTOR .........................................................................4 1.3.3 TRAY LIFT MOTOR..............................................................................5 1.4 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ......................................................................6 1.4.1 MAIN BOARD .......................................................................................6 1.4.2 LCT SET SWITCHES ...........................................................................6 Rear .........................................................................................................6 Front .........................................................................................................7 1.4.3 DOWN SWITCH ...................................................................................7 1.4.4 PAPER FEED, PAPER END, TRAY LIFT AND RELAY SENSORS .....8 1.4.5 STACK SENSOR ..................................................................................9 1.5 SIDE FENCE POSITION CHANGE .............................................................10 2. DETAILS ...................................................................................... 11 2.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT ..............................................................................11 2.1.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT .....................................................................11 2.1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT ..............................................12 2.1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTIONS ..................................13 2.1.4 DRIVE LAYOUT .................................................................................15 2.2 PAPER FEED ..............................................................................................16 2.2.1 PAPER FEED MECHANISM ..............................................................16 2.2.2 TRAY LIFT MECHANISM ...................................................................17 Tray lifting conditions..............................................................................17 Tray lowering conditions (Paper supply position) ...................................17 Tray lowering conditions (Full-down position) ........................................17 SM i D631 2.2.3 PAPER HEIGHT AND END DETECTION ..........................................18 Paper Height ..........................................................................................18 Paper End ..............................................................................................18 D631 ii SM Read This First Safety and Symbols Replacement Procedure Safety Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the replacement procedures in this manual. Symbols Used in this Manual This manual uses the following symbols. : See or Refer to : Screws : Connector : Clip ring : E-ring : Clamp Covers 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 COVERS RT3020 1200-SHEET LCT (D631) 1.1.1 REAR COVER 1. Cover [A] ( x 1) 2. Rear cover [B] ( x 3) 1.1.2 RIGHT DOOR 1. Right lower cover [A] ( x 2) 2. Right door [B] ( x 1) SM 1 D631 Covers 1.1.3 FRONT AND TOP COVERS 1. Right door ( p.1 "Rear Cover") 2. Switch cover [A] ( x 2) 3. Front cover [B] ( x 4) 4. Top cover [C] ( x 2) D631 2 SM Paper Feed 1.2 PAPER FEED 1.2.1 PICK-UP, PAPER FEED AND SEPARATION ROLLERS Open the right door. 2. Sensor bracket [A] ( x 2) 3. Rollers [B], [C], [D] ( x 1 each) RT3020 1200-SHEET LCT (D631) 1. [B]: Paper feed roller [C]: Pick-up roller [D]: Separation roller SM 3 D631 Drive 1.3 DRIVE 1.3.1 PAPER FEED CLUTCH 1. Rear cover ( p.1 "Rear Cover") 2. Bracket [A] ( x 1, x 2, bushing x 1) 3. Paper feed clutch [B] ( x 1, x 1) 1.3.2 PAPER FEED MOTOR 1. Rear cover ( p.1 "Rear Cover") 1. Paper feed motor [A] ( x 2) D631 4 SM Drive 1.3.3 TRAY LIFT MOTOR Rear cover ( p.1 "Rear Cover") 2. Tray lift motor unit [A] ( x 4, x 1) RT3020 1200-SHEET LCT (D631) 1. SM 5 D631 Electrical Components 1.4 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 1.4.1 MAIN BOARD 1. Rear cover ( p.1 "Rear Cover") 2. Main board ( x 2, all 's) 1.4.2 LCT SET SWITCHES Rear 1. Rear cover ( p.1 "Rear Cover") 2. Switch bracket [A] ( x 3) 3. Rear LCT set switch [B] D631 6 SM Electrical Components Front Front cover ( p.2 "Front and Top Covers") 2. Front LCT set switch [A] ( x 1) RT3020 1200-SHEET LCT (D631) 1. 1.4.3 DOWN SWITCH 1. Front cover ( p.2 "Front and Top Covers") 2. Switch base [A] ( x 2, x 1) 3. Down button [B] (spring x 1) 4. Down switch [C] (hook) SM 7 D631 Electrical Components 1.4.4 PAPER FEED, PAPER END, TRAY LIFT AND RELAY SENSORS 1. Front cover ( p.2 "Front and Top Covers") 2. Top Cover ( Front and Top Covers) 3. Rear ground plate [A] ( x 1) 4. Front ground plate [B] ( x 1) 5. Paper feed unit [C] ( x 2, x 1, x 1) 6. Paper feed unit cover [D] ( x 5, x 1) Before you re-install the paper feed unit cover, make sure that the pick-up solenoid holds the pick-up roller lever ([a]: correct, [b]: incorrect) and the pick-up roller works properly. D631 8 SM 7. RT3020 1200-SHEET LCT (D631) Electrical Components Sensors [E], [F], [G], [H] ( x 1, hooks each) [E]: Tray lift sensor [F]: Relay sensor [G]: Paper feed sensor [H]: Paper end sensor 1.4.5 STACK SENSOR 1. Open the right door 2. Paper feed unit ( p.8 "Paper Feed, Paper End, Tray Lift and Relay Sensors") 3. Sensor bracket [A] ( x 2) 4. Stack sensor [B] ( x 1) SM 9 D631 Side Fence Position Change 1.5 SIDE FENCE POSITION CHANGE 1. Open the right door of the LCT. 2. Push the down switch to lower the tray bottom plate until it reaches its lowest position. 3. Remove the front and rear side fences [A, B] ( x 1 each). 4. Install the side fences in the correct position (A4 LEF/ LT LEF/ B5 LEF). 5. Pull the end fence [C] for B5 size paper as shown ( x 1) if the the side fences are adjusted for B5 size paper. 6. Close the right door. 7. Turn on the main power switch, and then go into the SP mode. 8. Input the correct paper size for the1200-sheet LCT with SP5181-017. D631 10 SM Component Layout 2. DETAILS 2.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT RT3020 1200-SHEET LCT (D631) 2.1.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT 1. Rear LCT Set Switch 2. Pick-up Roller Solenoid 3. Tray Lift Sensor 4. Paper Feed Roller 5. Paper Feed Sensor 6. Paper End Sensor 7. Pick-up Roller 8. Tray Lift Motor 9. Paper Height Sensor 1 10. Interlock Switches 11. Paper Height Sensor 2 SM 12. Sub Paper Height Sensor 13. Tray Down Switch 14. Paper Height Sensor 3 15. Paper Tray 16. Lower Limit Sensor 17. Stack Sensor 18. Separation Roller 19. Front LCT Set Switch 20. Relay Sensor 5 21. Relay Roller 11 D631 Component Layout 2.1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT 1. Front LCT Set Switch 2. Rear LCT Set Switch 3. Paper Feed Clutch 4. Paper Feed Motor 5. Tray Lift Motor 6. Interlock Switches 7. Main Board 8. Tray Down Switch 9. Relay Sensor 10. Tray Lift Sensor D631 11. Pick-up Roller Solenoid 12. Paper Feed Sensor 13. Paper End Sensor 14. Paper Height Sensor 1 15. Paper Height Sensor 2 16. Sub Paper Height Sensor 17. Paper Height Sensor 3 18. Lower Limit Sensor 19. Stack Sensor 12 SM Component Layout 2.1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTIONS Symbol Name Function Index No. Motors M1 Paper Feed Drives all rollers. 4 M2 Tray Lift Drives the paper tray up or down. 5 S1 Paper Feed S2 Relay Detects whether the paper is jammed at the LCT. Detects the copy paper coming to the relay roller and checks for misfeeds. RT3020 1200-SHEET LCT (D631) Sensors 12 9 Informs the mainframe when the paper in S3 Paper End the tray has been used up and indicates 13 paper end. Detects when the paper is at the correct S4 Tray Lift S5 Paper Height 1 14 S6 Paper Height 2 15 paper feed height. 10 Detects the amount of paper remaining in S7 SM Sub Paper the tray. 16 Height S8 Paper Height 3 S9 Lower Limit 17 Detects when the tray is completely lowered, to stop the tray lift motor. 13 18 D631 Component Layout Symbol Name Function Index No. Detects a) when the tray has moved down to the paper supply position after paper end, to stop the tray lift motor or b) S10 Stack when the top of the paper stack has 19 moved down to the paper supply position, to stop the tray lift motor after the down switch has been pressed. Switches Detects whether the right door is open SW1 Right Door SW2 Front LCT Set Detects whether the LCT is correctly set. 1 SW3 Rear LCT Set Detects whether the LCT is correctly set. 2 SW4 Down and starts to drive the tray lift motor. Lowers the tray to the paper supply position if pressed. 6 8 Magnetic Clutches MC1 Paper Feed Drives the paper feed unit. 3 Pick-up Pushes the pick-up roller up or down. 11 Solenoids SOL1 PCBs PCB1 D631 Main Controls the LCT and communicates with the copier/printer. 14 7 SM Component Layout RT3020 1200-SHEET LCT (D631) 2.1.4 DRIVE LAYOUT 1. Tray Lift Motor 2. Paper Feed Motor 3. Pick-up Roller 4. Paper Feed Clutch SM 5. Relay Roller 6. Separation Roller 7. Tray Drive Belt 15 D631 Paper Feed 2.2 PAPER FEED 2.2.1 PAPER FEED MECHANISM This machine uses the FRR paper feed system (paper feed roller [E], separation roller [H], pick-up roller [G]). When the right door is closed, the tray lift motor raises the tray to the position where the top of the paper stack in the tray interrupts the tray lift sensor [D]. The paper feed motor switches on, then the pick-up solenoid [C] switches off and the pick-up roller drops onto the top of the stack of paper. The paper feed clutch transfers drive to the paper feed roller [E], pick-up roller [G] and separation roller [H]. The rotating pick-up roller lowers and feeds the first sheet when it contacts the top of the stack. The separation roller [H], in contact with the feed roller, only allows one sheet out of the tray. As soon as the paper feed sensor [F] detects the leading edge of the paper, it switches off the pick-up solenoid which raises the pick-up roller. The feed roller feeds the sheet to the registration roller in the main machine through the relay roller [B]. This process is repeated for each sheet. The paper feed sensor [F] detects "JAM7" and the relay sensor [A] detects "JAM58". D631 16 SM Paper Feed RT3020 1200-SHEET LCT (D631) 2.2.2 TRAY LIFT MECHANISM The lift motor [A] controls the vertical position of the tray through the timing belts [B]. Tray lifting conditions When the tray lift sensor [C] turns off in the following conditions, the tray lift motor raises the tray bottom plate until the tray lift sensor [C] turns on again. Just after the main switch is turned on During copying Just after the tray cover is closed Just after leaving the energy saving mode Tray lowering conditions (Paper supply position) In the following conditions, the tray lift motor lowers the tray until the stack sensor [D] turns on (this is the correct tray position for supplying paper). Just after the paper end sensor turns on Just after the down switch is pressed by the user Tray lowering conditions (Full-down position) In the following condition, the tray lift motor lowers the tray until the lower limit sensor [E] turns on (this is the correct tray position for adding 500 sheets of paper after installing the first stack of paper in the LCT tray). Just after the down switch [F] is pressed for 3 seconds or more when the tray is at the paper supply position. SM 17 D631 Paper Feed 2.2.3 PAPER HEIGHT AND END DETECTION Paper Height The amount of the paper in the tray is detected by combination of high (1)/low (0) outputs from three sensors (paper height sensor 1 [A], 2 [B], 3 [D] and sub paper height sensor [C]). Amount of paper 100% PH S-1 PH S-2 PH S-3 Sub PH S Indicator on the operation panel 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 - 0 0 0 1 30% 0 1 - - Two lines 10% 1 - - - One line End - - - - No line 70% Four lines Three lines 0: No interruption (low), 1: Interruption (high), -: No checking PH S: Paper Height Sensor Paper End The paper end sensor [E] monitors the light reflected by each sheet on top of the stack. When the last sheet feeds, the cutout [F] is exposed, and the paper end sensor receives no reflected light from below because there is no paper. As a result, this signals paper end. D631 18 SM RT3020 1200-SHEET LCT (D631) Paper Feed SM 19 D631 D632 1 BIN TRAY BN3100 R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY P ag e Dat e Ad d ed/ Upd at ed/ New None 1 BIN TRAY BN3100 (D632) TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT........................................... 1 1.1 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ......................................................................1 1.1.1 PAPER SENSOR..................................................................................1 1.1.2 1-BIN CONTROL BOARD ....................................................................3 SM i D632 Read This First Safety and Symbols Replacement Procedure Safety Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the replacement procedures in this manual. Symbols Used in this Manual This manual uses the following symbols. : See or Refer to : Screws : Connector : Clip ring : E-ring Electrical Components 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 1 Bin Tray BN3100 (D632) 1.1.1 PAPER SENSOR 1. Open the right door of the machine [A]. 2. Remove the front right cover [A] ( 3. Harness cover [A] ( SM x 1). x 1) 1 D632 Electrical Components 4. Disconnect the connector of the 1-bin tray [A] ( 5. 1-bin tray [A] ( 6. 1-bin sorter unit [A] ( D632 x 1). x 2) x 1) 2 SM 1 Bin Tray BN3100 (D632) Electrical Components 7. Paper sensor cover [A] ( 8. Paper sensor [A] ( x 2) x 1, hook) 1.1.2 1-BIN CONTROL BOARD 1. 1-bin tray ( 2. 1-bin sorter unit ( 3. 1-bin control board [A] ( SM p.1 "Paper Sensor") p.1 "Paper Sensor") x 1, x 3) 3 D632 D388/D633 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY SH3040/SH3060 R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY P ag e Dat e Ad d ed/ Upd at ed/ New None INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY SH3040/SH3060 (D388/D633) TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT........................................... 1 1.1 TRAY COVER................................................................................................1 1.2 TRAY MOTOR AND HALF TURN SENSOR BOARD....................................2 SM i D388/D633 Read This First Safety and Symbols Replacement Procedure Safety Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the replacement procedures in this manual. Symbols Used in this Manual This manual uses the following symbols. : See or Refer to : Screws : Connector : Clip ring : Clamp : E-ring Tray Cover 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 TRAY COVER 1. Remove the tray cover [A] by pressing on the two pawls [B] on the left side of the cover. – When Attaching the Tray Cover – The right side of the tray cover should be attached first. 1. Fit the pawls [C] on the shift tray. 2. Align the square [D] so that it fits into the groove in the underside of the tray cover and does not interfere with the attachment of the cover. Complete the attachment by inserting the left side pawls [B] into place. Internal Shift Tray SH3040/ SH3060 (D388/D633) 3. SM 1 D388/D633 Tray Motor and Half Turn Sensor Board 1.2 TRAY MOTOR AND HALF TURN SENSOR BOARD 1. Top cover ( p.1 "Tray Cover") 2. Slip disc [A] 3. Tray motor [B] ( x 1) 4. Half turn sensor board [C] ( x 1). D388/D633 2 SM BOOKLET FINISHER SR3020 (B803)/ SR3110 (D637)/SR4020 (D373) FINISHER SR3030 (B805)/ SR3120 (D636)/SR4010 (D374) R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY P ag e Dat e Ad d ed/ Upd at ed/ New None BOOKLET FINISHER SR3020 (B803)/ SR3110 (D637)/SR4020 (D373) FINISHER SR3030 (B805)/ SR3120 (D636)/SR4010 (D374) TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT........................................... 1 1.1 COVERS ........................................................................................................1 1.1.1 EXTERIOR COVERS ...........................................................................1 1.1.2 UPPER TRAY, END FENCE ................................................................2 1.2 MAIN UNIT.....................................................................................................3 1.2.1 UPPER TRAY LIMIT SENSOR, LIMIT SWITCH ..................................3 1.2.2 POSITIONING ROLLER .......................................................................4 1.2.3 PROOF TRAY EXIT SENSOR .............................................................5 1.2.4 UPPER TRAY HEIGHT SENSORS 1, 2 ...............................................5 1.2.5 EXIT GUIDE PLATE, UPPER TRAY EXIT SENSOR ...........................6 1.2.6 PROOF TRAY FULL SENSOR .............................................................7 1.2.7 FINISHER ENTRANCE SENSOR ........................................................7 1.2.8 PRE-STACK TRAY EXIT SENSOR ......................................................8 1.3 STAPLER UNIT .............................................................................................9 1.3.1 CORNER STAPLER .............................................................................9 1.3.2 POSITIONING ROLLER .....................................................................10 1.4 FOLD UNIT ..................................................................................................11 1.4.1 FOLD UNIT .........................................................................................11 1.4.2 FOLD UNIT ENTRANCE SENSOR ....................................................13 1.4.3 FOLD UNIT EXIT SENSOR ................................................................14 1.4.4 STACK PRESENT SENSOR ..............................................................15 1.4.5 FOLDING HORIZONTAL SKEW ADJUSTMENT (FOR B804 ONLY) 16 1.4.6 FOLD VERTICAL SKEW ADJUSTMENT (FOR B804 ONLY) ............19 1.5 BOOKLET STAPLER UNIT .........................................................................21 1.5.1 BOOKLET STAPLER..........................................................................21 1.5.2 BOOKLET STAPLER MOTOR ...........................................................22 To Reattach the Booklet Stapler Motor ..................................................23 SM i B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 2. DETAILED SECTION DESCRIPTIONS ....................................... 24 2.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT ..............................................................................24 2.1.1 GENERAL LAYOUT ...........................................................................24 Paper direction .......................................................................................24 Proof tray................................................................................................25 Upper tray ..............................................................................................25 Pre-stack tray .........................................................................................25 Lower tray ..............................................................................................25 2.1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ...........................................................26 Upper Area B804/B805 ..........................................................................26 Lower Area B804/B805 ..........................................................................27 Punch Unit B702 ....................................................................................28 Stacker/Stapler - B804/B805 ..................................................................29 B804 Fold unit ........................................................................................30 2.1.3 SUMMARY OF ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ..................................31 2.1.4 DRIVE LAYOUT .................................................................................41 2.2 JUNCTION GATES ......................................................................................42 2.2.1 PROOF MODE ...................................................................................42 2.2.2 SHIFT MODE ......................................................................................42 2.2.3 STAPLE MODE ..................................................................................43 2.3 PRE-STACKING ..........................................................................................44 2.4 TRAY MOVEMENT MECHANISM ...............................................................46 2.4.1 UPPER TRAY .....................................................................................46 2.4.2 LOWER TRAY (B804 ONLY) ..............................................................48 2.5 CORNER STAPLING ...................................................................................51 2.5.1 STACKING AND JOGGING ...............................................................51 2.5.2 STAPLER MOVEMENT ......................................................................52 2.5.3 CORNER STAPLING..........................................................................53 2.6 BOOKLET STAPLING (B804 ONLY) ...........................................................54 2.6.1 BOOKLET PRESSURE MECHANISM ...............................................54 2.6.2 BOOKLET STAPLING AND FOLDING ...............................................55 Overview ................................................................................................55 2.6.3 BOOKLET STAPLING AND FOLDING MECHANISMS......................61 2.7 UPPER TRAY OUTPUT ..............................................................................64 2.7.1 FEED OUT..........................................................................................64 2.7.2 FEED OUT STACKING ......................................................................65 2.8 PUNCH UNIT B702 (FOR B804/B805) ........................................................66 2.8.1 OVERVIEW OF OPERATION ............................................................66 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 ii SM Skew Correction before Punching ..........................................................66 Punch Unit Position Correction ..............................................................67 2.8.2 PUNCH MECHANISMS ......................................................................69 Paper Position Detection ........................................................................69 Punch Unit Movement ............................................................................70 Punch Selection and Firing ....................................................................71 2.8.3 PUNCH HOPPER MECHANISM ........................................................72 2.9 FINISHER JAM DETECTION ......................................................................73 SM iii B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Read This First Safety and Symbols Replacement Procedure Safety Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the replacement procedures in this manual. Symbols Used in this Manual This manual uses the following symbols. : See or Refer to : Screws : Connector : Clip ring : E-ring Covers 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 COVERS Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) 1.1.1 EXTERIOR COVERS 1. Open the front door [D]. 2. Small upper cover [A] ( x1) 3. Upper cover [B] ( x2) 4. Front door bracket [C] ( x1) 5. Front door [D] 6. Front left side cover [E] ( x2) 7. Cover [F] 8. Paper exit cover [G] ( x2) 9. Rear cover [H] ( x2) SM 1 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Covers 1.1.2 UPPER TRAY, END FENCE 1. Remove the rear cover. ( "Exterior Covers") 1. Support the tray [A] with your right hand. 2. Pull gear [B] toward you to release. 3. Slowly lower the tray until it stops. 4. Front side cover [C] ( x1) 5. Rear side cover [D] ( x1) 6. Upper tray [E] ( x1) 7. Tray bracket [F] ( x4, x1 shoulder screw ) 8. End Fence [G]( x3) B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 2 SM Main Unit 1.2 MAIN UNIT Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) 1.2.1 UPPER TRAY LIMIT SENSOR, LIMIT SWITCH 1. Front door, front left side cover, rear cover, upper cover ( "Exterior Cover") 2. End fence ( "Upper Tray, End Fence") 3. Upper tray exit mechanism [A] ( x4, x3) 4. Upper tray limit sensor [B] ( x1, x1) 5. Upper tray limit switch [C] ( x2) SM 3 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Main Unit 1.2.2 POSITIONING ROLLER 1. Open the front door [A]. 2. Pull out the stapling unit [B]. 3. Positioning roller [C] ( x1, timing belt x1) B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 4 SM Main Unit 1. Small upper cover ( "Exterior Cover") 2. Proof tray exit sensor bracket [A] ( x1) 3. Proof tray exit sensor [B] ( x1) Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) 1.2.3 PROOF TRAY EXIT SENSOR 1.2.4 UPPER TRAY HEIGHT SENSORS 1, 2 1. Small upper cover, upper cover ( "Exterior Cover") 2. Upper tray paper height sensor bracket [A] ( x1) 3. Upper tray paper height sensor [B] – staple mode (S08) ( x1) 4. Upper tray paper height sensor [C] – non-staple mode (S09) ( x1) SM 5 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Main Unit 1.2.5 EXIT GUIDE PLATE, UPPER TRAY EXIT SENSOR 1. Rear cover, Upper covers, Front door, Cover, Paper exit cover ( "Exterior Cover") 2. Inner cover [A] ( x2) 3. Exit guide plate [B] ( x1, Link and spring, x1, x1) 4. Upper tray exit sensor [C] (S6) ( x1) B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 6 SM Main Unit 1.2.6 PROOF TRAY FULL SENSOR Exit guide plate. ( "Exit Guide Plate, Upper Tray Exit Sensor") 2. Guide plate [A] (hook x 2) 3. Sensor bracket [B] ( x1) 4. Proof tray full sensor [C] (S11) ( x1) Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) 1. 1.2.7 FINISHER ENTRANCE SENSOR 1. Disconnect the finisher if it is connected to the copier. 2. Sensor bracket [A] ( x1) 3. Finisher entrance sensor [B] (S1) ( x1) SM 7 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Main Unit 1.2.8 PRE-STACK TRAY EXIT SENSOR 1. Disconnect the finisher if it is connected to the copier. 2. Sensor bracket [A] 3. Pre-stack tray exit sensor [B] (S2) B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 8 SM Stapler Unit 1.3 STAPLER UNIT 1. Open the front door. 2. Pull out the stapler unit. 3. Inner cover [A] ( x3) 4. Stapler unit holder [B] ( x1) 5. Corner stapler [C] (M20) ( x1) SM Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) 1.3.1 CORNER STAPLER 9 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Stapler Unit 1.3.2 POSITIONING ROLLER 1. Open the front door [A]. 2. Pull out the stapling unit [B]. 3. Positioning roller [C] ( x1, timing belt x1) B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 10 SM Fold Unit 1.4 FOLD UNIT 1. Remove the back cover ( "Exterior Covers"). 2. Open the front door. The stapler unit is heavy. 3. Ground cable [A] ( x1) 4. Harness [B] ( x6, x6) 5. Stapler unit [C] ( x4) SM Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) 1.4.1 FOLD UNIT 11 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Fold Unit 6. Support the fold unit with your hand to prevent it from falling. The fold unit is heavy. Folding unit [D] ( x4, x2, x6) If you have replaced the folding unit: 1. Read the DIP SW settings on the decal [A] attached to the back of the new folding unit. 2. Check the DIP SW settings on the main board [B] of the finisher. 3. If these settings are different, change these settings to match the settings printed on the decal attached to the folding unit. Set DIP switches 1 to 4 (the switch set on the right). Do not touch the other DIP switches. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 12 SM Fold Unit 1. Pull out the stapler unit ( "Positioning Roller"). 2. Fold unit entrance sensor bracket [A] ( x2) 3. Fold unit entrance sensor [B] (S26) ( x1, x1) SM 13 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) 1.4.2 FOLD UNIT ENTRANCE SENSOR B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Fold Unit 1.4.3 FOLD UNIT EXIT SENSOR 1. Open the front door. 2. Pull out the stapler unit ( "Positioning Roller"). 3. Fold unit vertical guide plate [A] 4. Fold unit inner cover [B] ( x2, Spring pin x1) 5. Fold unit upper cover [C] ( x1) 6. Paper clamp mechanism [D] ( x4) 7. Fold unit exit sensor bracket [E] ( x1) 8. Fold unit exit sensor [F] (S31) ( x1) B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 14 SM Fold Unit If you intend to correct the horizontal and vertical skew for the fold unit at the same time, do those adjustments first, then replace the sensor. ( "Folding Horizontal Skew Adjustment" or "Fold Vertical Skew Adjustment") 1. Remove the stapler unit ( "Fold Unit") 2. Guide plate [A]. 3. Stay [B] ( x4) 4. Left plate [C] ( x4) 5. Sensor bracket [D] ( x1) 6. Stack present sensor [E] (S32) ( x1) SM 15 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) 1.4.4 STACK PRESENT SENSOR Fold Unit 1.4.5 FOLDING HORIZONTAL SKEW ADJUSTMENT (FOR B804 ONLY) The fold unit is adjusted for optimum performance before the finisher is shipped from the factory. Do this adjustment only if the edges of folded booklets are not even. 1. Switch the copier on and enter the SP mode. 2. Europe, Asia: Use SP6-134-001 (this is for A3 paper). North America: Use SP6-134-005 (this is for DLT paper). If the original setting of SP6-134-001 or -005 is not "0", then you must do the vertical skew adjustment ( "Fold Vertical Skew Adjustment") after you finish this horizontal skew procedure. 3. Use the 10-key pad to input "-2" (mm) for the SP value. (Press to enter the minus sign.) 4. Press [#] then exit the SP mode. 5. Open the front door and pull the stapler unit [A] out of the finisher. 6. Open the guide plate [B]. 7. Loosen the adjustment screw [C] and then tighten until it stops. (Do not over tighten.) 8. Remove the lock screw [D]. 9. Raise the tip [E] of the adjustment screw very slightly and allow it to descend under its own weight. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 16 SM Fold Unit 10. Push the stapler unit into the finisher and close the front door. Switch the copier on. Put one page of A3 or DLT paper in the ARDF. On the copier operation panel, select booklet stapling. Press [Start]. One sheet is folded. 12. Remove the sheet from the lower tray. 13. Hold the folded sheet with the creased side pointing down and face-up (the same way that it came out of the finisher). 14. Referring to the diagram, determine if the skew is + [F] or - [G]. 15. Open the front door of the finisher and pull the stapler unit [H] out. 16. Open the guide plate [I]. 17. Turn the adjustment screw [J] to correct the amount of skew you measured from the test sheet. SM For + skew [F], turn the adjustment screw (clockwise). 17 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) 11. Do a folding test. Fold Unit For – skew [G], turn the adjustment screw to the left (counter-clockwise). Every click in the +/– direction adjusts the fold position by 0.1 mm by moving the bottom fence [K]. 18. Raise the tip of the adjustment screw [J] and allow it to lower under its own weight. 19. Attach and tighten the lock screw [L]. 20. Push the stapler unit into the machine, close the front door, then turn the copier on. 21. Europe, Asia: Do SP6-134-001 (this is for A3 paper). North America: Do SP6-134-005 (this is for DLT paper). 22. Reset it to "0". 23. Do the test again. 24. If the result is satisfactory, this completes the adjustment. -or- If some skew remains, repeat this adjustment. After doing this adjustment, adjust for vertical skew, if necessary. ( "Fold Vertical Skew Adjustment") B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 18 SM Fold Unit 1.4.6 FOLD VERTICAL SKEW ADJUSTMENT (FOR B804 ONLY) The fold unit is adjusted for optimum performance before the finisher is shipped from the factory. Do this adjustment only if the edges of folded booklets are not even. 1. Switch the copier on. 2. Do a folding test. 3. Switch the copier on. Put one page of A3 or DLT paper in the ARDF. On the copier operation panel, select booklet stapling. Press [Start]. One sheet is folded. Hold the folded sheet with the creased side pointing down, and face-up (the same way that it Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) came out of the finisher). 4. Referring to the diagram, determine if the skew is positive [A] or negative [B]. 5. Measure the amount of skew. 6. Enter the SP mode 7. Europe, Asia: Use SP6-134-001 (this is for A3 paper). North America: Use SP6-134-005 (this is for DLT paper). Enter one-half the measured amount of skew. Example: If the measure amount of skew is -1.2 mm, enter -0.6 mm SM 19 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Fold Unit The range for measurement is –3.0 mm to +3.0 mm in 0.2 mm steps for every notch adjustment. 8. Exit the SP mode and do the test again (steps 2 to 5). 9. Repeat this procedure until the skew is corrected. The illustration below shows the effects of +/- adjustment with SP6113. (The vertical arrows show the direction of paper feed.) B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 20 SM Booklet Stapler Unit 1.5 BOOKLET STAPLER UNIT 1. Open the front door. 2. Pull out the stapler unit ( "Positioning Roller"). 3. Harness cover [A] ( x2) 4. Booklet stapler support stay [B] ( x4, x2, x4) 5. Stapler [C] ( x4) SM 21 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) 1.5.1 BOOKLET STAPLER B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Stapler Unit 1.5.2 BOOKLET STAPLER MOTOR 1. Open the front door. 2. Remove the stapler unit. ( "Fold Unit") 3. Stay [A] ( x4). 4. Left plate [B] ( x4) 5. Harness cover [C] ( x2) 6. Booklet stapler support stay [D] ( x4, x2, x4) 7. Booklet stapler [E] ( x4) 8. Booklet stapler motor [F] ( x2, x1) B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 22 SM Booklet Stapler Unit To Reattach the Booklet Stapler Motor Reattach the booklet stapler motor. 2. Do not tighten the screws. Attach the special tool [A] and reattach the booklet stapler stay. This tool is included with the stapler spare part. 3. Turn the gear [B] with your finger until it stops. 4. Tighten the screws to attach to the booklet stapler motor. 5. Remove the stay again and remove the special tool. 6. Reattach the booklet stapler stay. 7. Push the stapler unit into the machine. SM 23 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) 1. Component Layout 2. DETAILED SECTION DESCRIPTIONS 2.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT 2.1.1 GENERAL LAYOUT 1. Proof Tray Junction Gate 7. Lower Tray (Booklet)*1 2. Punch Unit 8. Folder Rollers*1 3. Stapler Junction Gate 9. Folder Plate*1 4. Pre-Stack Junction Gate 10. Booklet Stapler*1 5. Pre-Stack Tray 11. Upper Tray (Shift) 6. Corner Stapler (M20) 12. Proof Tray *1: B804 Only Paper direction The operation of the proof tray and stapler junction gates direct the flow of the paper once it enters B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 24 SM Component Layout the finisher: Proof Junction Gate Stapler Junction Gate Paper Feeds Closed Closed Paper feeds straight through Open Closed Paper feeds to the proof tray Closed Open Paper feds to the staple tray Proof tray Copies are sent to the proof tray (12) when neither sorting nor stapling are selected for the job. The upper tray (11) receives copies that are sorted and shifted and also receives copies that have been corner stapled. Corner stapling is provided on both the B804 and the B805. Pre-stack tray The pre-stack tray has a switchback mechanism to increase the productivity of stapling. ( "Pre-Stacking) Pre-stacking is done for corner stapling in the B804/B805 and for booklet stapling in the B804. Lower tray The lower tray (7) receives copies that have been center folded and stapled (booklet stapling). Booklet stapling is not provided on the B805. SM 25 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) Upper tray Component Layout 2.1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS Upper Area B804/B805 1. Upper/Proof Exit Motor (M4) 2. Stapling Tray Junction Gate Solenoid (SOL2) 3. Upper Transport Motor (M2) 4. Exit Guide Plate HP Sensor (S7) 5. Proof Tray Exit Sensor (S10) 6. Proof Tray Full Sensor (S11) 7. Finisher Entrance Sensor (S1) 8. Upper Tray Paper Height Sensor (S9) (Non-Staple Mode) 9. Upper Tray Limit Sensor (S12) B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 10. Upper Tray Limit Switch (SW2) 11. Stacking Roller HP Sensor (S13) 12. Stacking Sponge Roller Motor (M10) 13. Upper Tray Exit Sensor (S6) 14. Upper Tray Paper Height Sensor (S8) (Staple Mode) 15. Shift Roller HP Sensor (S5) 16. Shift Roller Motor (M18) 17. Exit Guide Plate Motor (M19) 18. Proof Junction Gate Solenoid (SOL1) 26 SM Component Layout Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) Lower Area B804/B805 1. Upper Tray Lift Motor (M21) 2. Lower Transport Motor (M3) 3. Entrance Motor (M1) 4. Front Door Safety Switch (SW1) 5. Pre-Stack Tray Exit Sensor (S2) 6. Stapling Edge Pressure Plate Solenoid (SOL4) 7. Positioning Roller Solenoid (SOL3) 8. Positioning Roller Motor (M14) 9. Lower Tray Full Sensor – Front (S34)*1 10. Lower Tray Full Sensor – Rear (S33)*1 11. Main Board (PCB1) 12. Upper Tray Full Sensor – (S20) *2 13. Upper Tray Full Sensor – (S19) 14. Booklet Stapler Board (PCB2)*1 15. Booklet Pressure Roller Solenoid – (SOL5) *1 *1: B804 Only, *2: B805 Only SM 27 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Component Layout Punch Unit B702 1. Punch Encoder Sensor (S24) 6. Paper Position Slide HP Sensor (S22) 2. Punch Drive Motor (M24) 7. Paper Position Sensor (S3) 3. Punch HP Sensor (S24) 8. Punch Hopper Full Sensor (S4) 4. Punch Unit Board (PCB3) 9. Punch Movement Motor (M9) 5. Paper position sensor slide motor (M7) 10. Punch Movement HP Sensor (S21) B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 28 SM Component Layout Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) Stacker/Stapler - B804/B805 7. Jogger Fence Motor (M15) 1 1. Stack Present Sensor (S32)* 8. Jogger Fence HP Sensor (S15) 1 2. Stack Junction Gate HP Sensor (S27)* 9. Corner Stapler Movement Motor (M6) 3. Stack Feed Out Belt HP Sensor (S16) 10. Stapling Tray Paper Sensor (S14) 4. Feed Out Belt Motor (M5) 11. Corner Stapler EH530 (M20) 1 5. Booklet Stapler EH185R – Rear (M23)* 12. Corner Stapler Rotation Motor (M13) 6. Booklet Stapler EH185R – Front 13. Corner Stapler HP Sensor (S17) 1 (M22)* 14. Stapler Rotation HP Sensor (S18) 15. Stack Junction Gate Motor (M17) *1 *1: B804 Only SM 29 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Component Layout B804 Fold unit 1. Clamp Roller HP Sensor (S25) 6. Fold Cam HP Sensor (S30) 2. Fold Roller Motor (M12) 7. Fold Bottom Fence HP Sensor (S28) 3. Fold Plate Motor (M11) 8. Fold Unit Entrance Sensor (S26) 4. Fold Plate HP Sensor (S29) 9. Clamp Roller Retraction Motor (M8) 5. Fold Unit Bottom Fence Lift Motor (M16) 10. Fold Unit Exit Sensor (S31) B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 30 SM Component Layout 2.1.3 SUMMARY OF ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS Here is a general summary of all the electrical components of the B804/B805 finishers. In the table below a number that appears in bold text (M8, etc.) denotes a component that is on the 2000/3000 Sheet Finisher B804 only. No. Component Function PCB1 Main Board The main board that controls the finisher PCB2 Booklet Stapler Board A separate board that controls booklet finishing. PCB3 Punch Unit Board The board that controls the punch unit. Motors M1 Finisher Entrance Drives 1) the finisher entrance rollers, 2) and the punch Motor waste transport belt of the punch unit. Drives the paper feed rollers that feed paper 1) to the M2 Upper Transport Motor proof tray, 2) straight-through to the upper tray, 3) the pre-stack tray entrance roller. Drives paper feed rollers forward and reverse in the M3 Lower Transport Motor pre-stack tray for the switchback, and drives the other rollers in the lower transport area. M4 M5 Upper/Proof Tray Exit Motor Feed Out Belt Motor Drives 1) proof tray exit rollers, 2) extension and retraction of the stacking sponge roller, 3) upper tray exit rollers. Drives the feed out belt that moves the stapled stacks out of the stapling tray after stapling. Moves the corner stapler horizontally on a steel rod to M6 Corner Stapler position the stapler at the stapling position at 1) the Movement Motor front, 2) the rear (straight stapling), 3) the rear (diagonal stapling), or 4) the front and rear for double stapling. SM 31 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) Boards (PCB) Component Layout No. M7 Component Paper Position Sensor Slide Motor Function Drives the movement of the paper position slide that holds the paper position sensor (S3) that detects the position of the paper. Drives a large cam that alternately clamps and unclamps the clamp retraction roller, the idle roller of the clamp roller pair. When these rollers are clamped, they are part of the paper feed path and feed the stack M8 Clamp Roller toward the bottom fence of the fold unit. When the idle Retraction Motor roller is retracted, the stacks falls a very short distance (3 mm) onto the fold unit bottom fence below. These rollers remain unclamped while the bottom fence positions the stack for folding and while the stack is folded by the fold rollers. M9 M10 M11 Punch Movement Drives the front/back movement of the punch unit to Motor position it correctly for stapling the paper below. Stacking Sponge Roller Motor Fold Plate Motor Rotates the stacking roller that drags each sheet back against the end fence to jog the bottom of each sheet after feed out to the upper tray. Drives the fold plate that pushes the center of the stack into the nip of the fold rollers to start the fold. Rotates forward and drives the fold rollers that fold the M12 Fold Roller Motor stack and feed it out of the fold unit, reverses to feed the fold once more into the fold unit, and then rotates forward again to feed the fold out of the fold unit. M13 M14 M15 Corner Stapler Rotation Motor Positioning Roller Motor Jogger Fence Motor Swivels the corner stapler and positions it so the staple fires at an oblique angle at the rear corner of the paper stack. Drives the positioning roller in the stapling tray. Drives the jogger fences in the stapling tray to jog both sides of the stack before stapling. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 32 SM Component Layout No. Component Function Raises the bottom fence and stops when the center of the vertical stack is opposite the edge of the horizontal M16 Fold Unit Bottom Fence Lift Motor fold blade. The distance for raising the blade is prescribed as one-half the size of the paper selected for the job. For large paper, (A3, B4) the bottom fence first lowers the stack 10 mm below the fold position, and then raises it to the fold position. Drives the large cam that operates the stack junction gate at the top of the stapling tray. When this gate is M17 Stack Junction Gate open, it directs the ascending stack to the upper tray if it Motor has been corner stapled, or if it is closed the gate turns bottom fence of the folding unit. Drives the shift roller that operates in shift mode to M18 Shift Roller Motor stagger document sets as they feed out to the upper tray (making them easier to separate). M19 Exit Guide Plate Motor Drives the mechanism that raises and lowers the exit guide plate. This is the roving corner stapler, mounted on a steel rail M20 Corner Stapler EH530 that staples 1) at the front, 2) at the rear (straight staple), 3) at the rear (diagonal staple), and 4) font and rear (two staples). M21 M22 M23 M24 SM Upper Tray Lift Motor Raises and lowers the upper tray during feed out to keep the tray at the optimum height until it is full. Booklet Stapler Booklet stapler. Staples paper stacks in the center EH185R: Front before they are folded. Booklet Stapler Booklet stapler. Staples paper stacks in the center EH185R: Rear before they are folded. Punch Drive Motor Fires the punches that punch the holes in the paper. 33 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) the booklet stapled stack down so it falls onto the Component Layout No. Component Function Sensors Provides two functions: (1) Detects paper entering the S1 Finisher Entrance finisher from the copier, and (2) Signals a jam if it Sensor detects paper at the entrance when the copier is switched on. Detects 1) paper fed from the pre-stack tray to the stapling tray, and detects 2) paper in the pre-stack when S2 Pre-stack Tray Exit the copier is switched on. (This sensor performs no Sensor timing function. The entire flow of paper through the pre-stacking mechanism is controlled by motor pulse counts.) The photosensor that detects the edge of the paper and S3 Paper Position Sensor sends this information to the punch unit board where it is used to position the punch for punching the holes in the paper. 1) A photosensor that detects and signals that the punch S4 Punch Hopper Full Sensor hopper is filled with punch waste and needs emptying, and 2) confirms the presence of the punch hopper and signals an error if it is missing or not installed completely. Located near the shift roller motor, controls the S5 Shift Roller HP Sensor front-to-back movement of the shift roller as shifts paper during straight-through feed. A flat, photo sensor located inside the guide plate, detects the leading edge and trailing edge of the paper as it feeds out to the upper tray during straight-through S6 Upper Tray Exit Sensor jobs (with and without stapling). When paper is fed to the upper tray, at the paper output slot this sensor signals an error when it detects (1) paper has failed to leave the paper exit (lag error), (2) detects paper has failed to arrive at the paper exit (late error), (3) detects paper is in the exit slot when the machine is turned on. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 34 SM Component Layout No. Component Function Controls the vertical movement of the control exit S7 Exit Guide Plate HP guide . The guide plate is in the home position when the Sensor guide plate is down and the actuator interrupts the sensor gap. Upper Tray Paper S8 Height Sensor (Staple Mode) This is the upper sensor of the upper/lower paper height sensor pair that controls the lift of the upper tray. This sensor detects the paper height of the stack in the upper tray when the copier is operating in the staple mode. S9 Upper Tray Paper sensor pair that controls the lift of the upper tray. When Height Sensor the machine is switched on, the upper tray rises until the (Non-Staple Mode) actuator on the tray triggers this sensor to switch off the upper tray lift motor. This sensor detects and times the feeding of paper to S10 Proof Tray Exit Sensor the proof tray. It also detects whether paper is present at the proof tray exit when the copier is switched on. The top of the stack in the proof tray increases until it S11 Proof Tray Full Sensor nudges the feeler of this sensor. The sensor then signals that the proof tray is full and the job halts until some paper is removed from the proof tray. This sensor controls the position of the upper tray 1) during straight-through feed out, 2) during shift feed out, 3) when the machine is turned on. The machine obeys the signal of whichever sensor is actuated first. An actuator attached to an arm triggers this sensor. The S12 Upper Tray Limit tip of the same arm depresses the upper tray limit Sensor switch If the sensor fails, the tip of the arm will activate the upper tray limit microswitch (SW2) and stop the lift of the upper tray. Note: When the machine is turned on, the upper tray position is controlled by either this sensor or the upper tray paper height sensor (S9). SM 35 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) This is the lower sensor of the upper/lower paper height Component Layout No. Component Function Controls the forward and back motion of the stacking S13 Stacking Roller HP Sensor roller (a sponge roller) located at the output slot of the upper tray. The sponge roller drags each ejected sheet back against the end fence of the upper tray to keep the bottom of the stack aligned. A photo sensor that detects whether paper is in the S14 Stapling Tray Paper stapling tray. When this sensor detects paper, the Sensor bottom fence motor raises or lowers the bottom fence to position the selected paper size for booklet stapling. Detects the home position of the jogger fences. When S15 Jogger Fence HP the actuator on the jogger fence interrupts this sensor, Sensor the jogger fence is in its home position and the jogger fence motor (M15) stops. Controls the position of the stack feed-out pawl on the stack feed-out belt. Once the actuator on the feed belt S16 Stack Feed-Out Belt nudges the feeler of this sensor near the top of the HP Sensor stapling unit, the feed out belt motor (M5) remains on for the time prescribed to position the pawl at the home position to catch the next stack. Located at the front the stapling tray and mounted S17 Corner Stapler HP Sensor above the steel rod where the corner stapler travels, this sensor detects the home position of the corner stapler. The corner stapler is in its home position when the actuator on the corner stapler unit interrupts this sensor. S18 Stapler Rotation HP Controls the angle of the position of the corner stapler Sensor during oblique stapling. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 36 SM Component Layout No. Component Function B804: When the actuator on the side of the upper fence enters the gap of this sensor, the sensor signals that the S19 Upper Tray Full Sensor (B804/B805) upper tray is at its lowest position (full) and stops the job. B805: One of two upper tray full sensors. This is the higher tray full sensor for A3 and other heavy paper. The other upper tray full sensor (20) is for lighter paper. B804: This sensor is not used on the booklet finisher. Sensor (B805 only) There is only one upper tray full sensor (S18). B805: One of two upper tray full sensors. This is the lower tray full sensor for A4 and smaller paper. The other upper tray full sensor (19) is for larger paper. Switches off the punch movement motor when the S21 Punch Unit HP Sensor punch unit returns to its home position. Pulse counts determine where the punch unit pauses for punching and reversing. S22 Paper Position Side HP Sensor Controls the movement of the paper position detection unit. Switches on when the horizontal detection unit is at the home position (HP is the reference point). Detects the home position of the punch unit and S23 Punch HP Sensor controls the vertical movement of the punches when they fire. When the punch mode is selected for the job (2-hole, 3-hole, etc.), the machine controls the operation of the S24 Punch Encoder punch drive (M24) motor which drives a small encoder Sensor shaped like a notched wheel. This wheel is rotated forward and reverse precisely to select which punches are moved up and down during the punch stroke. SM 37 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) S20 Upper Tray Full Component Layout No. S25 Component Function Clamp Roller HP Controls the movement of the clamp retraction roller Sensor (the idle roller of the clamp roller pair). Detects 1) the leading edge of the stack during booklet S26 Fold Unit Entrance stapling, and 2) also used to signal an alarm if a paper is Sensor detected at the entrance of the fold unit when the copier is turned on. S27 Stack Junction Gate HP Sensor Controls the opening and closing of the stack junction gate. Switches on when the stack junction gate is open and at the home position. Controls the movement of the bottom fence in the S28 Fold Bottom Fence HP folding unit using pulse counts based on the size of the Sensor paper selected for the job to position the stack correctly for feeding. Along with the fold plate cam HP sensor (S30) this S29 Fold Plate HP Sensor sensor controls the movement of the fold plate . The fold plate has arrived at the home position when the edge of the plate enters the gap of this sensor. Along with the fold plate HP sensor (S29), this sensor controls the movement of the fold plate. The actuator S30 Fold Plate Cam HP Sensor mounted on the end of the roller that drives the folder plate forward and back makes three full rotations, i.e. the actuator passes the sensor gap twice and stops on the 3rd rotation and reverses. This accounts for the left and right movement of fold plate. 1) Detects the folded edge of the stack as it feeds out from the nip of the fold rollers, stops the rollers, and S31 Fold Unit Exit Sensor reverses them so the fold feeds back into the nip, 2) when the folded booklet finally emerges from the nip of the fold rollers, detects the leading and trailing edge of the booklet to make sure that it feeds out correctly. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 38 SM Component Layout No. Component Function This sensor determines whether a there is paper at the turn junction gate when the machine is turned on. If a S32 Stack Present Sensor stack is present, this triggers a jam alert. (This sensor performs no dynamic function such as pulse counting, etc. It only detects whether paper is at the top of the folding unit when power its turned on.) This rear sensor is the lower sensor of the lower tray full sensor pair. Two actuators are attached to the actuator Sensor - Rear arm that touches the top of stapled and folded booklets as they feed out. The on/off combinations of the two sensors are used to detect when the tray is full and stop the job. (The lower tray is stationary. At tray full, the job halts until booklets are removed from the lower tray.) This front sensor is the higher sensor of the lower tray full sensor pair. Two actuators are attached to the actuator arm that touches the top of stapled and folded S34 Lower Tray Full booklets as they feed out. The on/off combinations of Sensor - Front the two sensors are used to detect when the tray is full and stop the job. (The lower tray is stationary. At tray full, the job halts until booklets are removed from the lower tray.) Solenoids Opens and closes the proof tray junction gate. When SOL1 Proof Junction Gate the solenoid switches on, it opens the gate and paper is Solenoid diverted to the proof tray. When this gate is closed, the paper goes straight to the upper tray. I SOL2 SM Stapling Tray Junction Gate Solenoid Directs paper to the stapling tray. When this solenoid is on, paper feeds straight through. When this solenoid is off, paper feeds to the stapler tray below. 39 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) S33 Lower Tray Full Component Layout No. Component Function Engages the stapler transport motor and the positioning SOL3 Positioning Roller Solenoid roller of the stapling tray. The positioning roller pushes each sheet down against the bottom fence to align the bottom the stack for stapling. (The jogger fences align the sides.) Stapling Edge SOL4 Pressure Plate Solenoid SOL5 Booklet Pressure Roller Solenoid Operates the pressure plate of the stapling unit. The pressure plate presses down the edge of stack in the stapling tray so it is tight for stapling. When the paper stack in the stapling tray feeds to the folding unit, this solenoid turns on and operates the roller that pushes on the surface of the stack to flatten it. Switches SW1 Front Door Safety The safety switch that cuts the dc power when the front Switch door is opened. A micro-switch that cuts the power to the upper tray lift SW2 Upper Tray Limit SW motor when the upper tray reaches its upper limit. This switch duplicates the function of the upper tray limit sensor (S12) and stops the upper tray if S12 fails. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 40 SM Component Layout Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) 2.1.4 DRIVE LAYOUT 1. Upper Transport Motor (M2) 2. Upper/Proof Exit Motor (M4) 3. Upper Tray Lift Motor (M21) 4. Feed-Out Belt Motor (M5) 5. Fold Roller Motor*1 (M12) 6. Folder Plate Motor*1 (M11) 7. Positioning Roller Motor (M14) 8. Lower Transport Motor (M3) 9. Entrance Motor (M1) *1: B804 Only SM 41 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Junction Gates 2.2 JUNCTION GATES The positions of the proof tray and staple tray junction gates determine the direction of paper feed after paper enters the finisher. 2.2.1 PROOF MODE Proof tray junction gate [A] opens. Staple tray junction gate [B] remains closed. The proof tray junction gate directs paper to the proof tray above. 2.2.2 SHIFT MODE Proof tray junction gate [A] remains closed. Staple tray junction gate [B] remains closed. With both junction gates closed, the paper goes to the upper tray. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 42 SM Junction Gates 2.2.3 STAPLE MODE Proof tray junction gate [A] remains closed. Staple tray junction gate [B] opens Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) The staple tray junction gate directs the paper to the staple tray below for jogging and stapling. SM 43 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Pre-Stacking 2.3 PRE-STACKING This example describes what happens to Set 2 during the feed and stapling cycle of sets that contain three pages. [A]: While the Set 1 is being stapled in the staple tray [1], the 1st sheet of Set 2 [2] feeds to the pre-stack tray, and the 2nd sheet of Set 2 [3] enters the finisher. [B]: The pre-stack junction gate opens and the 1st sheet of Set 2 [4] switches back to the top of the pre-stack tray as the 2nd sheet of Set 2 [5] starts to descend. [C]: As the 2nd sheet of Set 2 continues to descend, the 1st sheet of Set 2 is fed from the pre-stack tray. At this time the leading edges [6] of both sheets are even. [D]: The trailing edges of the 1st and 2nd sheets of Set 2 pass the junction gate [7] as the 3rd sheet of Set 2 [8] enters the finisher. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 44 SM Pre-Stacking [E]: The 1st and 2nd sheets of Set 2 [9] switch back together into the top of the pre-stack and [F]: The stapling of Set 1 in the staple tray [10] is completed. [G]: Set 1 [11] exits the staple tray. [H]: The three sheets of Set 2 [12] feed together into the stapler tray for stapling. Pre-stacking is only done for A4, B5, and LT paper. In one-staple mode, one sheet goes to the pre-stacking tray. Then two sheets go to the stapler tray at the same time. In two-staple mode and booklet mode, three sheets go to the pre-stacking tray. Then four sheets go to the stapler tray at the same time. SM 45 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) wait for the 3rd of Set 2 sheet to arrive. Tray Movement Mechanism 2.4 TRAY MOVEMENT MECHANISM 2.4.1 UPPER TRAY [A]: Upper Tray Lift Motor [B]: Upper Feeler [E]: Lower Feeler [C]: Upper Tray Paper Height Sensor 1 [F]: Upper Tray Limit Sensor (Staple Mode) [G]: Upper Tray Limit Switch [D]: Upper Tray Paper Height Sensor 2 [H]: Upper Tray Full Sensors (Non-Staple Mode) The B804 (shown above) has only one upper tray full sensor (the higher sensor at [H]). The B805 has two upper tray full sensors (the upper and lower sensor at [H]). On the B805 the upper sensor detects tray full for heavier paper (A3, DLT, B4, LG, 12 x 18”), and the lower sensor detects tray full for lighter paper (A4, LT, etc.). The tray full capacity is 2,000 sheets (B804) for A4, LT and 3,000 sheets (B805) for A4, LT. Five sensors and one switch control the operation of the upper tray lift motor [A]. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 46 SM Tray Movement Mechanism Upper Tray Raising and Lowering Sensors, Switch Action Operation Mode [C] [D] [F] [G] Stops the lift motor is at the standby position when the actuator of the upper Standby (Non-Staple feeler deactivates sensor [C] (when it is OFF OFF between sensors [C] and [D]). Mode) Note: Sensor [F] and switch [G] are used as backup if sensor [C] fails or if the upper tray is not attached. Straight Through ON Non-staple mode operation: During operation, tray lift is controlled only by Shift ON sensor [F], the tray lowers until the actuator reactivates sensor [F]. Standby: The upper tray stops and waits for the paper output when the actuator activates sensor [C]. [D] is not used for staple mode Staple Mode Operation: Standby (Staple Mode) The upper tray lowers the prescribed distance immediately after the stack ON exits. The upper tray rises until the actuator activates sensor [C] and stops the tray lift motor (and the tray) to wait for the next set. Sensor [F] and switch [G] are used as backup if sensor [C] fails. SM 47 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) sensor [F]. When the actuator leaves Tray Movement Mechanism Tray Full When the actuator on the tray activates the upper tray full sensor [H] the tray lift B804 motor [A] switches off. Operation resumes after some copies are removed from the tray. Upper Tray Capacity: 2,000 sheets (A4, LT) The operation of the upper tray full sensor is the same as the B804. Capacity: B805 1,500 sheets for A3, B4 or other large paper. An additional upper tray full sensor (below sensor [H]) allows more sheets to stack on the upper tray. Capacity: 3,000 sheets (A4, LT) 2.4.2 LOWER TRAY (B804 ONLY) The lower tray sensor actuator arm [A] rests on the top of the stack of stapled booklets as they are output to the lower tray. A flap depressor [B] keeps the open ends of the booklets down. The front lower tray full sensor (S34) [C] and rear lower tray full sensor (S33) [D] detect when the lower tray is full of booklets. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 48 SM Tray Movement Mechanism The front lower tray full sensor is mounted higher than the rear lower tray full sensor. The lower tray is stationary. When it becomes full, the stapling and folding job stops until booklets are removed from the tray. If the lower tray is not installed (this is detected if the front and rear sensors remain OFF), the machine will not operate in the booklet staple and fold mode. When booklet mode is selected, the tray full message appears on the operation panel. The combinations of the two actuators and two sensors as the actuator arm rises determines the number of booklets that the lower tray can hold before the job stops. The tray full detection depends on the size of the paper and the number of sheets in one stapled and folded booklet. In the table below, the conditions ( Ready Full 1, Full 2 Full 3: See the illustration on the Condition Front Sensor Rear Sensor Ready ON OFF Full 1 ON ON Full 2 OFF ON Full 3 (or lower tray not installed) OFF OFF In the tables below: "Sht" denotes "sheets in a stack". "Cnt" denotes "Count" (see below for an explanation). After a booklet is feed out, the fold roller motor stops the exit roller. The machine then monitors the tray full sensors every 100 ms. The machine checks for a certain condition, based on the size of the paper and the number of sheets in the booklet. An example is shown below. Tell the operators that the number of sheets that the lower tray can hold will vary greatly. SM 49 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) previous page) refer to the states of the sensors described on the previous page. Tray Movement Mechanism Lower Tray Full Condition Table A3 (DLT) 1 Sht Full 1 3 Cnt 2 Sht 3 Sht 4 Sht 5 Sht 6 Sht 7 Sth 8 Sht 9 Sht … — — — — — — — — … — — — — — — … 4 Cnt 2 Cnt 2 Cnt 2 Cnt … 15 Full 2 — 5 Cnt Full 3 — — — 7 Cnt 1 Sht 2 Sht 3 Sht 4 Sht 5 Sht 6 Sht 7 Sth 8 Sht 9 Sht … — — — — — — — — … 8 Cnt 8 Cnt … Cnt 13 Cnt A4 (LT) Full1 16 Cnt Full 2 — Full 3 — 10 10 15 20 15 10 Cnt Cnt Cnt Cnt Cnt Cnt — — … Examples: After the copier makes a booklet with 1 sheet of A3/DLT paper, the machine checks every 100 ms for the ‘Full 1’ condition. If the Full 1 condition occurs 3 times (shaded block in the table above), the machine detects that the tray is full. After the copier makes a booklet with 5 sheets of A4/LT paper, the machine checks every 100 ms for the ‘Full 2’ condition. If the Full 2 condition occurs 20 times (shaded block in the table above), the machine detects that the tray is full. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 50 SM Corner Stapling 2.5 CORNER STAPLING Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) 2.5.1 STACKING AND JOGGING [A]: Jogger Fence Motor (M15) [B]: Jogger Fences [C]: Positioning Roller [D]: Jogger Fence HP Sensor (S15) [E]: Stapling Edge Pressure Plate Solenoid (SOL4) [F]: Pressure Plate At the beginning of the job, the jogger fence motor (M15) [A] switches on and moves the jogger fences [B] to the standby position (7.5 mm from the sides of the selected paper size). When each sheet passes the pre-stack tray exit sensor (S2) and enters the stapling tray: The jogger fence motor switches on and moves the jogger fences to within 5.5 mm of the sides of the selected paper size. The positioning roller solenoid (SOL3) switches on for the time prescribed for the paper size. This pushes the positioning roller [C] onto the sheet and pushes it down onto bottom fence. This aligns the edge of the stack. Next, the jogger fence motor: Switches on again and moves the jogger fences to within 2.6 mm of the sides of the stack to align the sides of the stack. Reverses and moves the fences to the standby position (7.5 mm away for the sides) and waits for the next sheet. SM 51 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Corner Stapling The jogger fence HP sensor [D] switches off the jogger motor at the end of the job. After the last sheet feeds: The stapling edge pressure plate solenoid [E] (SOL4) switches on and pushes the pressure plate [F] onto the stack to press down the edge for stapling. The corner stapler staples the stack. 2.5.2 STAPLER MOVEMENT [A]: Stapler Movement Motor [B]: Stapler [C]: Stapler Rotation Motor The stapler performs horizontal and rotational movement in each of the four staple modes: Front 1 staple Rear 1 staple Rear diagonal staple Rear/Front 2 staples The stapler movement motor [A] drives a timing belt that moves stapler [B] left and right on its stainless steel rail. The stapler rotation motor [C] rotates the stapler into position for diagonal stapling at the rear. The stapler movement motor switches on and moves the stapler the standby stapling position. (This is the stapling position for the paper size selected for the job.) The stapler movement motor switches off and the stapler waits for the signal to fire (or swivel and for diagonal stapling). B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 52 SM Corner Stapling If the stack is to be stapled at two positions: The stapler movement motor moves the stapler to the front position and staples the front. The stapler movement motor moves the stapler to the rear and the stapler staples the rear. If the stack is stapled at the rear with a diagonal staple, the staple moves to the rear. When it is time for stapling, the rotation motor rotates the stapler to the correct angle and holds the stapler in that position while the stapler fires. The stapling positions can be fine adjusted with SP6-133-001. Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) 2.5.3 CORNER STAPLING Staple firing is driven by the stapler motor [A] inside the stapler unit. The stapler hammer [B] fires the stapler [C]. The cartridge set sensor [D] detects the cartridge at the correct position. The staple end sensor [E] detects the staple end condition. SM 53 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Stapling (B804 Only) 2.6 BOOKLET STAPLING (B804 ONLY) 2.6.1 BOOKLET PRESSURE MECHANISM [A]: Booklet Pressure Roller Solenoid (SOL5) [B]: Booklet Pressure Roller Arm [C]: Booklet Pressure Roller As soon as the edges are aligned by the positioning roller and the jogger fences, the stack feed out belt moves. In booklet mode, immediately after the edges are aligned by the positioning roller and jogger fences, the booklet pressure solenoid switches on and the booklet pressure roller presses down on the stack until booklet stapling is finished. This prevents the stack from shifting during stapling. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 54 SM Booklet Stapling (B804 Only) 2.6.2 BOOKLET STAPLING AND FOLDING Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) Overview 1. Leading Edge Pressure Roller 13. Corner Stapler (M20) 2. Stack Present Sensor (S32) 14. Stapling Tray Paper Sensor (S14) 3. Feed Out Belt Pawl 1 15. Feed Out Belt 4. Booklet Staplers x2 (M22, M23) 16. Fold Unit Bottom Fence 5. Stack Feed Out Belt HP Sensor (S16) 17. Fold Bottom Fence HP Sensor (S28) 6. Feed Out Belt Pawl 2 18. Fold Unit Entrance Sensor (S26) 7. Positioning Roller 19. Fold Unit Exit Rollers x2 8. Booklet Pressure Roller (Rear) 20. Fold Unit Exit Sensor (S31) 9. Jogger Fences x2 21. Fold Rollers x2 10. Pre-Stack Exit Roller 22. Clamp Rollers x2 11. Pressure Plate 23. Stack Junction Gate 12. Stapling Tray Bottom Fence 24. Stack Transport Roller SM 55 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Stapling (B804 Only) 1: The last sheet of the stack [1] enters the stapling tray. The jogger fences [2] jog the last sheet into position (based on the width of the selected paper size) and then retract and stop 1 mm away from the sides of the stack. 2: The pressure plate [3] and booklet pressure roller [4] press down on the sheet. The stack feed out belt switches on and the pawl [5] on the feed out belt catches the bottom of the stack and raises it. The stapling tray sensor [6] detects the trailing edge of the paper stack. 3: The feed out belt [7] raises the stack to the prescribed stapling position and stops. The jogger fences move to the sides of the stack and the booklet staplers [8] staple the stack. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 56 SM 4: The jogger fences remain 1 mm away from the sides of the stack. The feed out belt [1] raises the stack until the top of the stack is 10 mm past the leading edge pressure roller [2] and stops. The leading edge pressure roller descends and applies pressure to the top of the stack. The stack junction gate [3] (normally open) closes. The pressure roller [4] and pressure plate [5] retract. 5: The feed out belt [6], transport rollers [7], [8], and clamp rollers [9] rotate and feed the stack past the closed stack junction, over the top and down toward the bottom fence [10]. At the same time, the fold unit bottom fence descends from its home position and stops 10 mm below the fold position. 6: The rollers feed the leading edge of the stack to within 3 mm of the stack stopper of the bottom fence [13]. The fold unit entrance sensor [11] detects the stack and opens the clamp rollers [12]. The stack drops 3 mm onto the fold unit bottom fence [13]. At this time, the first sheet [14] of the next stack feeds to the stapling tray. SM 57 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) Booklet Stapling (B804 Only) Booklet Stapling (B804 Only) 7: The bottom fence [1] raises the stack to the prescribed fold position [2]. 8: The fold plate [3] moves to the left and advances 1/3 its maximum horizontal stroke and exerts 20 kg (44 lb.) of pressure at the fold rollers [4]. 9: With the fold plate pushing the stack into nip of the fold rollers [5], the fold rollers begin to rotate and fold the stack as it feeds out. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 58 SM 10: When the fold rollers [1] feed the stack 10 mm past the nip, the fold plate retracts until it no longer touches the stack. The fold unit exit sensor [2] detects the folded edge of the stack and stops the fold rollers. 11: The rotation of the fold rollers [4] reverses and feeds the folded edge back until only 3 mm of the fold [5] remains at the nip. 12: The fold rollers [6] rotate forward once again feed out. The fold unit exit sensor [7] once again detects the edge of the fold. You can do SP6-136-001 to increase the sharpness of the fold. The number of forward and reverse feeds can be set in the range of 2 to 30. The machine repeats Steps 11 and 12. For more, please refer to Section "Service Tables". SM 59 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) Booklet Stapling (B804 Only) Booklet Stapling (B804 Only) 13: With the feed of the stack halted, the fold plate [1] retracts. The fold plate HP sensor (not shown) detects the fold plate and stops it at its home position. 14: The fold rollers [2] and fold unit exit rollers [3] begin to rotate together and feed out the folded booklet to the lower tray. 15: Once the trailing edge of the stack passes the fold unit exit sensor [4], the clamp rollers [5] close to be ready to feed the next stack. The fold unit bottom fence [6] descends. The bottom fence HP sensor [7] stops the bottom fence when it detects the actuator on the bottom fence. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 60 SM Booklet Stapling (B804 Only) Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) 2.6.3 BOOKLET STAPLING AND FOLDING MECHANISMS Booklet Stapler [A]: Feed Out Belt Pawl. Raises the stack to stapling position. [B]: Booklet Stapler EH185R – Rear [C]: Booklet Stapler EH185R – Front Stack Junction Gate [D]: Stack Junction Gate Motor. Drives a timing belt and stack junction gate cam. [E]: Stack Junction Gate Cam. Opens and closes the stack junction gate. [F]: Stack Junction Gate. The stack junction gate motor and stack junction gate cam close the stack junction gate. The feed out belt pawl raises the stapled stack and sends it over the top and down to the fold unit. [G]: Leading Edge Pressure Roller. Presses down on the leading edge of the stack after booklet stapling. SM 61 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Stapling (B804 Only) Clamp Roller [A]: Fold Roller Motor. Drives the stationary clamp drive roller as well as the fold rollers (see next page). [B]: Clamp Rollers. Clamp Roller – Drive. Rotated by the fold roller motor, this stationary roller feeds the stack down with the retracting roller closed. Clamp Roller – Retracting. Opened and closed by the retraction motor [C]. [C]: Clamp Roller Retraction Motor. Operates the clamp roller cam that retracts the retracting clamp roller. The clamp rollers feed the stack to within 3 mm of the bottom fence when closed and then open to drop the stack onto the bottom fence. [D]: Clamp Roller HP Sensor. Controls the rotation of the clamp roller retraction motor and cam that open and close the retracting clamp roller. [E]: Clamp Roller Cam. Forces open the spring loaded retracting clamp roller. Bottom Fence [F]: Bottom Fence. Raises the booklet stapled stack to the fold position. [G]: Bottom Fence HP Sensor. Detects the actuator on the bottom fence and stops it at the home position after folding. [H]: Bottom Fence Lift Motor. Raises the bottom fence and stapled stack to the fold position prescribed for the paper size. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 62 SM Booklet Stapling (B804 Only) Fold Plate [A]: Bottom Fence Stack Stoppers. Catches the stack after it is released by the clamp rollers. [C]: Fold Plate Cam. Controls the movement of the fold plate to the left (into the nip of the fold rollers) and right (toward the fold plate home position). [D]: Fold Plate HP Sensor. Controls operation of the fold plate motor. [E]: Fold Plate. Moves left and pushes the stack into the nip of the fold rollers and then moves right to retract. Fold Rollers [F]: Fold Roller Motor. Drives forward to feed out the stack at the fold and then reverses to feed the fold in to sharpen the crease, and then drives forward again to feed out the folded stack. This reverse/forward cycle is done once. This cycle can be repeated by changing the setting of SP6114. [G]: Fold Rollers. Driven by the fold roller motor, this roller pair feeds out the stack at its fold, reverses to feed in the stack to, and then feeds forward again (assisted by the fold unit exit rollers – not shown) to feed out the stack to the lower tray. SM 63 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) [B]: Fold Plate Motor. Drives the timing belt and gears that move the fold plate. Upper Tray Output 2.7 UPPER TRAY OUTPUT 2.7.1 FEED OUT [A]: Feed Out Belt Motor [B]: Stack Feed-Out Belt [C]: Pawl [D]: Exit Rollers [E]: Exit Guide Plate Motor [F]: Exit Guide Plate [G]: Exit Guide Plate HP Sensor [H]: Upper Tray After the stack is stapled, the feed out belt motor [A] switches on and drives the feed out belt [B]. The pawl [C] attached to the feed out belt catches on the stack and lifts the stack toward the feed out slot. The exit guide plate [F] remains open as the stack emerges at a prescribed distance away from the exit roller. Next, the exit guide plate closes and the exit roller feeds the stack out. The opening and closing of the exit guide plate is controlled by the rising and falling of a link driven by a rotating cam attached to the shaft of the exit guide plate motor [E]. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 64 SM Upper Tray Output The feed out belt motor stops 300 ms to prevent the stapled stack from rising too high. Next, the feed out belt motor switches on again, then the pawl actuates its home position sensor and switches off the motor. There are two output pawls on the feed out belt to improve the productivity of the feed out operation. Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) 2.7.2 FEED OUT STACKING Upper/proof exit motor [A] drives feed roller [B] and stacking sponge roller [C]. Stacking sponge roller motor [D] moves the sponge roller forward and back with link [E]. The position of the stacking sponge roller [C] is controlled by the stacking sponge roller motor which is switched on and off by the stacking roller HP sensor [F]. SM 65 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Punch Unit B702 (For B804/B805) 2.8 PUNCH UNIT B702 (FOR B804/B805) 2.8.1 OVERVIEW OF OPERATION Skew Correction before Punching This punch unit corrects for paper skew and then positions the punch unit to punch holes at the correct position. Each sheet is punched one at a time. Paper feeds out of the copier. The finisher entrance sensor [A] detects the leading edge of the sheet. The finisher entrance roller [B] stops rotating briefly while the copier exit rollers continue to rotate. This buckles the paper against the finisher entrance roller to correct skew. The finisher entrance roller [C] starts to rotate again and feeds the sheet into the finisher. These SP codes adjust the skew operation in the punch unit: SP6130. This SP corrects the punch hole alignment. To do this, it corrects the skew of each sheet by adjusting the amount of time the finisher entrance roller remains off while the exit roller of the machine remains on. For more, see Section "Service Tables". SP6131. This SP determines whether the finisher entrance roller stops to correct skew when paper enters the finisher. You can use this SP to disable the skew correction. For more, see Section "Service Tables". B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 66 SM Punch Unit B702 (For B804/B805) Punch Unit Position Correction These operations (skew correction before punching, and punch unit position correction) increase : The trailing edge of the sheet passes the finisher entrance sensor [A]. The paper position slide unit [B] moves the paper position sensor [C] forward to the edge of the paper. The paper position sensor detects the position of the paper edge and sends this information to the punch unit board. The machine uses the detected position of the paper edge to calculate the correct position for punching. The upper transport motor switches on and rotates the feed rollers [D] the prescribed distance to position the paper under the punch unit. : Using the result of the position calculation, the punch unit control board moves the punch unit [E] to the adjusted punch position. The paper position slide unit and its paper sensor, move back to the paper position slide home position sensor [F], and the punch unit fires the punches to make the holes. : The feed rollers [G] feed the punched paper out of the punch unit and into the paper path. SM 67 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) the accuracy of the punch alignment. Punch Unit B702 (For B804/B805) These SP codes adjust the punch hole alignment: SP6-128 Adjusts the punch positions in the direction of paper feed. SP6-129 Adjusts the punch position perpendicular to the direction of feed. For more, see Section "Service Tables". B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 68 SM Punch Unit B702 (For B804/B805) 2.8.2 PUNCH MECHANISMS Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) Paper Position Detection [A]: Finisher Entrance Motor (M1) [B]: Finisher Entrance Roller [C]: Finisher Entrance Sensor (S1) [D]: Paper Position Sensor Slide Motor (M7) [E]: Paper Position Sensor (S27) [F]: Paper Position Sensor Slide HP Sensor (S22) The finisher entrance motor (M1) [A] drives the finisher entrance rollers [B] that feed paper from the copier into the finisher. The finisher entrance sensor (S1) [C] detects paper when it enters the finisher, and detects paper jams. The paper position slide sensor motor (M7) [D] extends and retracts the paper position slide that holds the paper position sensor (S27) [E]. The paper position sensor detects the position of the paper edge. The detected position of the paper is used to calculate and position the punch unit for punching. The paper position slide HP sensor (S22) [F] detects the paper position slide when it retracts and stops the paper position slide motor so the slide stops at its home position. SM 69 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Punch Unit B702 (For B804/B805) Punch Unit Movement [A]: Punch Movement Motor (M9) [B]: Punch Movement HP Sensor (S21) [C]: Punch Drive Motor (M24) The punch movement motor (M9) [A] extends and retracts the punch unit to position it at the correct position for punching. The punch movement HP sensor (S21) [B] detects the position when it retracts, switches off the punch position movement motor, and stops the punch unit at its home position. The punch drive motor (M24) [C] fires the punches that punch holes in the paper below. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 70 SM Punch Unit B702 (For B804/B805) Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) Punch Selection and Firing [A]: Punch Drive Motor (M24) [B]: Punch Encoder Wheel [C]: Punch Encoder Sensor (S24) [D]: Punch HP Sensor (S23) The punch drive motor (M24) [A] turns the small, notched encoder wheel [B] through the gap in the punch encoder sensor [C] (S24). The sensor output is used to control the punch timing. The timing for 2-hole punching [E] is different from 3-hole punching [F]. When the punch unit is at the punching position, the punch motor turns until the encoder detects the starting position for 2-hole or 3-hole punching. SM 71 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Punch Unit B702 (For B804/B805) This is the ‘1’ position in the diagrams (the top diagram is for 2-hole punching, and the bottom diagram is for 3-hole punching). Then, the punch drive motor turns counter-clockwise to the ‘2’ position. This movement punches the holes in the paper. Then, the punch drive motor turns clockwise to the ‘1’ position, to be ready for the next sheet of paper. 2.8.3 PUNCH HOPPER MECHANISM [A]: Finisher Entrance Motor (M1) [B]: Punch Waste Belt [C]: Punch Waste Hopper [D]: Punch Hopper Full Sensor (S4) The finisher entrance motor (M1) [A] drives the timing belt and gears that rotate the punch waste belt [B]. The punchouts fall from the punch unit onto the belt. The belt moves the punchouts to the front and dumps them in the punch waste hopper [C]. The punch hopper full sensor [D]: Signals that the hopper is full when it detects the top of the stack of punchouts that have collected in the hopper. It also detects when the punch hopper is set properly. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 72 SM Finisher Jam Detection Booklet Finisher & Finishers (B803/B805/ D373/D374/ D636/D637) 2.9 FINISHER JAM DETECTION Display Mode Proof R1 to R3 Jam Finisher After main machine exit sensor goes OFF, entrance finisher entrance sensor does not go ON even sensor late after enough time to feed 450 mm. Finisher After finisher entrance sensor goes ON, it does entrance not go OFF after enough time to feed a sheet sensor lag 1.5 times its length has elapsed. Shift Staple Proof exit sensor late R3 After finisher entrance sensor goes ON, proof exit sensor does not go ON even after enough time to feed 450 mm. Proof Proof exit sensor lag SM What It Means After finisher entrance sensor goes OFF, proof exit sensor does not go OFF even after enough time to feed 450 mm. 73 B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 Finisher Jam Detection Display Mode Jam Upper tray exit sensor late R4 After finisher entrance sensor goes ON, upper tray exit sensor does not go ON even after enough time to feed 485 mm. Shift Upper tray exit sensor lag Pre-stack tray exit sensor lag R5 to R7 What It Means After finisher entrance sensor goes OFF, upper tray exit sensor does not go OFF even after enough time to feed 650 mm. After finisher entrance sensor goes ON, pre-stack tray exit sensor does not go ON even after enough time to feed 650 mm. Staple Pre-stack tray exit sensor late Fold unit entrance sensor late Booklet R8 to Staple R12 (B700 Only) (S26) After finisher entrance sensor goes ON, pre-stack tray exit sensor does not go OFF even after enough time to feed 1650 mm. The fold unit entrance sensor goes not go ON after enough time has elapsed to feed 1.5 times the length of the stack after the leading edge of the stack reaches the stack present sensor (S32). Fold unit exit The fold unit exit sensor does not go ON after sensor late enough time has elapsed for the stack to feed (S31) 1.5 times its length from the fold position. Fold unit exit After the fold unit exit sensor goes ON, it does sensor lag not go OFF after enough time has elapsed to (S31) feed 442.9 mm. B803/B805/D373/D374/D636/D637 74 SM D641 PRINTER/SCANNER UNIT TYPE 5002 R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY P ag e Dat e Ad d ed/ Upd at ed/ New None PRINTER/SCANNER UNIT TYPE 5002 (D641) TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. INSTALLATION ............................................................................. 1 1.1 OVERVIEW....................................................................................................1 1.1.1 PRINTER/SCANNER OPTIONS ..........................................................1 1.1.2 OTHER OPTIONS ................................................................................2 1.1.3 BOARD, SD CARD SLOTS ..................................................................3 Board Slot ................................................................................................5 SD Card Slot ............................................................................................6 USB Slots .................................................................................................6 1.2 PRINTER AND P/S OPTIONS (BASIC MODELS).........................................7 1.2.1 OVERVIEW ..........................................................................................7 Three Main Units ......................................................................................7 Separate Options .....................................................................................8 Enhance Options ......................................................................................8 1.2.2 KIT CONTENTS....................................................................................8 Common Accessory Table .......................................................................8 1.2.3 PRINTER/SCANNER INSTALLATION .................................................9 1.2.4 SCANNER ENHANCE OPTION .........................................................12 Accessory Check ...................................................................................12 Installation (Application Merge) ..............................................................12 To undo an option update ......................................................................13 Important Notes about SD Cards ...........................................................13 1.2.5 APPLICATION MERGE ......................................................................14 If more than one application is required… ..............................................14 1.3 INSTALLING CONTROLLER OPTIONS .....................................................15 1.3.1 OVERVIEW ........................................................................................15 Board Slot ..............................................................................................15 SD Card Slots ........................................................................................15 USB Slots ...............................................................................................15 1.3.2 POSTSCRIPT 3 UNIT (D641) .............................................................16 1.3.3 FILE FORMAT CONVERTER (D377) .................................................17 1.3.4 IEEE 1284 INTERFACE BOARD (B679) ............................................18 SM i D641 1.3.5 IEEE 802.11A/G OR G (D377) ...........................................................19 User Tool Settings for IEEE 802.11a/g ..................................................20 SP Mode Settings for IEEE 802.11 Wireless LAN..................................22 1.3.6 BLUETOOTH UNIT (D566).................................................................23 1.3.7 GIGABIT ETHERNET (G874) .............................................................24 1.3.8 IPDS UNIT (D641) ..............................................................................25 Accessories ............................................................................................25 Installation ..............................................................................................26 1.3.9 VM CARD TYPE U (D640) .................................................................28 Accessories ............................................................................................28 Installation ..............................................................................................29 1.4 CHECK ALL CONNECTIONS......................................................................30 2. SERVICE TABLES ....................................................................... 31 2.1 PRINTER SERVICE TABLES ......................................................................31 2.1.1 SP1-XXX (SERVICE MODE) ..............................................................31 2.2 SCANNER SERVICE TABLES ....................................................................41 2.2.1 SP1-XXX (SYSTEM AND OTHERS) ..................................................41 2.2.2 SP2-XXX (SCANNING-IMAGE QUALITY) .........................................43 3. SPECIFICATIONS ........................................................................ 44 3.1 PRINTER SPECIFICATIONS ......................................................................44 3.2 USB SPECIFICATIONS ...............................................................................46 3.3 IEEE 802.11A/B/G SPECIFICATIONS ........................................................46 3.4 BLUETOOTH SPECIFICATIONS ................................................................47 3.5 SCANNER SPECIFICATIONS.....................................................................47 3.6 SOFTWARE ACCESSORIES ......................................................................48 3.6.1 PRINTER DRIVERS ...........................................................................48 3.6.2 SCANNER AND LAN FAX DRIVERS .................................................48 3.6.3 UTILITY SOFTWARE .........................................................................49 D641 ii SM Read This First Important Safety Notices Never install telephone wiring during a lightning storm. Never install telephone jacks in wet locations unless the jack is specifically designed for wet locations. Never touch uninsulated telephone wires or terminals unless the telephone line has been disconnected at the network interface. Use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines. Avoid using a telephone (other than a cordless type) during an electrical storm. There may be a remote risk of electric shock from lightning. Do not use a telephone or cellular phone to report a gas leak in the vicinity of the leak. Before installing the fax unit, switch off the main switch, and disconnect the power cord. The fax unit contains a lithium battery. The danger of explosion exists if a battery of this type is incorrectly replaced. Replace only with the same or an equivalent type recommended by the manufacturer. Discard batteries in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions and local regulations. Note for Australia: Unit must be connected to Telecommunication Network through a line cord which meets the requirements of ACA Technical Standard TS008. Safety and Symbols Conventions Used in this Manual This manual uses several symbols. : See or Refer to : Screws : Connector : Clip ring : E-ring : Clamp Cautions, Notes, etc. The following headings provide special information: Failure to obey warning information could result in serious injury or death. Obey these guidelines to ensure safe operation and prevent minor injuries. Obey these guidelines to avoid problems such as misfeeds, damage to originals, loss of valuable data and to prevent damage to the machine. This information provides tips and advice about how to best service the machine. Overview 1. INSTALLATION 1.1 OVERVIEW This section describes the installation procedures for printer, scanner, and other options for D129/D130 series machines. 1.1.1 PRINTER/SCANNER OPTIONS Item Merge Options D641 Printer/Scanner Unit Type 5002 - D641 Printer Unit Type 5002 Scanner Enhance Option D641 Scanner Enhance Option Type 5002 - SM 1 Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) No. D641 Overview 1.1.2 OTHER OPTIONS No. Item D377 File Format Converter Type E G874 Gigabit Ethernet Board Type A D377 Slots IEEE 802.11a/g Interface Unit Type J Board Slot. Only one of these -or- boards can be installed at one time. IEEE 802.11g Interface Unit Type K B679 IEEE 1284 Interface Board Type A D566 Bluetooth Interface Unit Type D USB slot D641 PostScript3 Unit Type 5002 SD Card Slot 1 (Upper Slot) D641 IPDS Unit Type 5002 SD Card Slot 1 (Upper Slot) D640 Browser Unit Type I D640 VM Card Type U SD Card Slot 2 D629 SD card for NetWare printing Type K SD Card Slot 1 (Upper Slot) D594 Memory Unit Type L 512MB Controller Board SD Card Slot 1 (Upper Slot) (Install, then remove) If more than one SD card application is required, the applications must be moved to one SD card with SP5873-1. For more details about merging applications from SD card Slot 2 (Lower Slot) to Slot 1 (Upper Slot), see "Scanner Enhance Option" in this chapter. D641 2 SM Overview 1.1.3 BOARD, SD CARD SLOTS The machine controller box has one board slot and two SD card slots. Only one interface board option can be installed. Only two SD cards are available for applications and maintenance. Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) Board Slots No. 1 Name USB-A Description Both USB slots are used for the Bluetooth option and a card authentication device. 2 USB-B Built-in for connection of USB devices (USB 2.0) 3 SD Card Slot 1 For options provided on SD cards. The application SD (Upper Slot) card (with the exception of the VM card) can be installed in Slot 1 (Upper Slot). If two or more applications are to be used, move the applications to the same SD card with SP5873. 4 SM SD Card Slot 2 For options provided on SD cards and servicing. The VM (Lower Slot) card must be installed in Slot 2 (Lower Slot). 3 D641 Overview No. 5 Name Ethernet Description Standard LAN connection point. 100BASE-TX/10BASE-T LAN Orange LED: Lights when the network is connected and operating. Green LED: Lights when 10BASE-TX or 100BASE-TX is operating. 6 ISDN Jack for ISDN connection (Japan Only) 7 Line 3 Jack for a 3rd line connection to the Fax Interface Unit (D596) (G3) when this option is installed. 8 Line 1 Jack for the main telephone line from the outside for connection to Fax Option (D596). 9 TEL1 Jack for telephone connection 10 Line 2 Jack for a 2nd line connection to the Fax Interface Unit (D596) (G3) when this option is installed. 11 Board Slot Optional interface boards are installed here. Only two SD Card slots are available for applications. To install more applications, they must be moved onto one SD Card. D641 4 SM Overview Board Slot The following optional interface boards are available. There is only one board slot so only one can be installed. No. Interface Board D377 File Format Converter Type E G874 Gigabit Ethernet Board Type A IEEE 802.11a/g Interface Unit Type J D377 -orIEEE 802.11g Interface Unit Type K SM IEEE 1284 Interface Board Type A Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) B679 Only one of these boards can be installed at one time. 5 D641 Overview SD Card Slot The following options are provided on SD cards. Two SD card slots are available. The VM application SD card must be installed in Slot 2 (Lower Slot). Other applications should be installed in Slot 1 (Upper Slot). If more than one application is required, applications can be moved onto one SD card with SP5873-1. No. SD Card Applications D641 PostScript3 Unit Type 5002 D641 IPDS Unit Type 5002 D640 Browser Unit Type I D629 SD card for NetWare printing Type K D641 Printer/Scanner Unit Type 5002 D641 Printer Unit Type 5002 D641 Scanner Enhance Option Type 5002 USB Slots The following option is provided on a USB Device. No. D566 D641 USB Device Bluetooth Interface Unit Type D 6 SM Printer and P/S Options (Basic Models) 1.2 PRINTER AND P/S OPTIONS (BASIC MODELS) 1.2.1 OVERVIEW This section describes the installation of the following items: Printer Unit Printer/Scanner Unit 512 Memory. Optional memory is required for each unit. (Included in the Printer Unit or P/S Unit for NA models) Scanner Enhance Option Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) Three Main Units Printer Unit Type 5002: For customers who do not require the extended scanning features but need more printing capability (PCL printer languages are provided). The 512 MB memory is required. Printer/Scanner Unit Type 5002: For customers who require the full range of DS features (advanced scanning and printing features such as "scan-to" solutions, virtual mailboxes, PCL, etc.). The 512 MB memory unit is required. SM 7 D641 Printer and P/S Options (Basic Models) Separate Options There are two separate options: 512 MB memory and PS3. 512 MB memory: Every unit (Printer Unit, P/S unit) requires installation of the 512 MB memory. PostScript 3 Unit: The PS3 option can be used with the Printer Unit, or the Printer/Scanner Unit. Enhance Options Scanner Enhance Option Type 5002 updates the Printer Unit by adding the advanced scanning features. 1.2.2 KIT CONTENTS Check the accessories and their quantities against the list below and the illustration on the next page. This is a common list for all the kits. Common Accessory Table This common accessory table lists all the items of the following units. PU: Printer Unit P/S: Printer/Scanner Unit SEO: Scanner Enhance Unit Kit Contents No. Description Q'ty PU P/S SEO 512 MB Memory*1 - No No No 1 HDD Unit 1 Yes Yes No 2 Screw 3 Yes Yes No 3 SD Card 1 Yes Yes Yes *1: The 512 Memory is a separate option and it is not provided in the kits. However, one memory unit is required for the installation of every print unit. (Included in the Printer Unit or P/S Unit for NA models) D641 8 SM Printer and P/S Options (Basic Models) 1.2.3 PRINTER/SCANNER INSTALLATION Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power supply cord. x 2). Remove the controller board [A] ( 2. Connect the two harnesses to the HDD unit [A] ( 3. Install the connecting board unit [A] on the HDD unit [B] ( Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) 1. SM 9 x 2). x 2). D641 Printer and P/S Options (Basic Models) 4. Connect the two harnesses from the HDD unit to the connecting board [A] ( 5. Install the HDD unit [A] on the controller board unit ( 6. Install the 512 MB memory [A]. D641 10 x 2). x3). SM Printer and P/S Options (Basic Models) Reinstall the controller board. 8. Remove the controller cover [A]. 9. Insert the Printer/Scanner SD card in SD card Slot 1 (Upper Slot) [A]. Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) 7. 10. Reattach the cover. 11. Attach the supplied ferrite core [A] at the machine end of the Ethernet cable. SM 11 D641 Printer and P/S Options (Basic Models) 12. Connect the Ethernet interface cable to the 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX port [A]. 13. Connect the other end of the Ethernet interface cable to a network connection device such as a hub. 14. Connect the machine’s power cord and turn the main power switch on. 15. Enable the NIB and/or USB function. To enable the NIB function, enter the SP mode and set SP5985-001 (On Board NIC) to "1" (Enable). To enable the USB function, enter the SP mode and set SP5985-002 (On Board USB) to “1" (Enable). 1.2.4 SCANNER ENHANCE OPTION Accessory Check Refer to the "Common Accessory Table" in this chapter. Installation (Application Merge) The installation of the scanner enhance option are done with SP5873-001 (Application Move). If you are going to update the RPCS unit with both the printer and scanner enhance options, the order of execution is not important. 1. Turn off the copier. 2. Remove the cover ( 3. Confirm that the Printer Unit SD card is in SD card Slot 1 (Upper Slot). 4. Put the option SD Card (Scanner Enhance Option) in SD card Slot 2 (Lower Slot). 5. Open the front door. 6. Turn the copier on. 7. Go into the SP mode and select SP5873-001. 8. Touch "Execute". 9. Read the instructions on the display and touch "Execute" to start. x1). 10. When the display tells you copying is completed, touch "Exit", then turn the copier off. D641 12 SM Printer and P/S Options (Basic Models) 11. Remove the option SD card from Slot 2 (Lower Slot). 12. Turn the copier on. 13. Go into the User Tools mode and confirm that update was successful. 14. User Tools> System Settings> Administrator Tools> Firmware Version> Next 15. Turn the copier off again, then reattach the cover. 16. Return the copied SD card to the customer for safekeeping, or tape it to the faceplate of the controller. To undo an option update Turn the main switch off. 2. Confirm that the Printer Unit SD card is in SD card Slot 1 (Upper Slot). 3. Put the original option SD card (Scanner Enhance Option) in SD card Slot 2 (Lower Slot). 4. Turn the main switch on. 5. Go into the SP mode and do SP5873-002 (Undo Exec). 6. Follow the messages on the operation panel to complete the procedure. 7. Turn the main switch off. 8. Remove the option SD card from Slot 2 (Lower Slot). 9. Turn the main switch on. Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) 1. 10. Go into the User Tools mode and confirm that undo was successful. User Tools> System Settings> Administrator Tools> Firmware Version> Next 11. Turn the copier off again, then reattach the cover. Important Notes about SD Cards Here are some basic rules about merging applications on SD cards. The data necessary for authentication is transferred with the application program to the target SD card. The SD card is the only evidence that the customer is licensed to use the application program. The service technician may occasionally need to check the SD card and its data to solve problems. SD cards must be stored in a safe location at the work site. Once the merge is completed, the SD card from which the application was copied cannot be used again, but the customer must keep the card to serve as proof of purchase. An SD card from which an application has been moved to another SD card can be restored to full operation with SP5873-002 (Undo). Before storing the card from which an application has been copied, label it carefully so that you can identify it easily if you need to do the undo procedure later. SM 13 D641 Printer and P/S Options (Basic Models) 1.2.5 APPLICATION MERGE This machine has two SD card slots only. However, more than two optional applications are supplied for this machine. Always keep SD card Slot 2 (Lower Slot) vacant for servicing (except for the VM Card). Because of this, SD card merge is required if a customer wants to use many applications. Consider the following limitations when you try to merge SD cards. The destination SD card should have the largest memory size of all the application SD cards. Refer to the following table for the memory size of each SD card. SD Card Options SD Card Size Printer/Scanner Unit Type 5000 512 MB Printer Unit Type 5002 512 MB Scanner Enhance Option Type 5002 128 MB PostScript3 Unit Type 5000 512 MB IPDS Unit Type 5002 128 MB SD card for NetWare printing Type K 128 MB Browser Unit Type I 128 MB VM Card Type U 512 MB If more than one application is required… Merge all applications which the customer wants to use into one SD card (Destination card inserted in Slot 1 (Upper Slot)). D641 14 SM Installing Controller Options 1.3 INSTALLING CONTROLLER OPTIONS 1.3.1 OVERVIEW This machine has a board slot for optional I/F connection and two SD card slots for applications. After you install an option, check that the machine can recognize it. ( p.30 "Check All Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) Connections") Board Slot This slot [4] is used for one of the optional board connections (only one can be installed): IEEE1284, IEEE802.11a/g, g (Wireless LAN), Gigabit Ethernet, or File Format Converter. SD Card Slots PostScript3 Unit, IPDS Unit, Browser Unit, SD Card for Netware printing should be installed in Slot 1 (Upper Slot) [1]. VM Card must be installed in Slot 2 (Lower Slot) [2]. However, it can also be merged to the SD card in Slot 1 (Upper Slot). USB Slots SM Bluetooth Interface Unit is installed in the USB slot [3]. 15 D641 Installing Controller Options 1.3.2 POSTSCRIPT 3 UNIT (D641) Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure. x 2) 1. Remove the controller cover [A] ( 2. Turn the SD-card label face to the rear of the machine. Then push it slowly into Slot 1 (Upper Slot) [A] until you hear a click. x 2). 3. Attach the controller cover ( 4. Attach the "Adobe PostScript 3" decal [A] to the front door. 5. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option. ( D641 16 p.30 "Check All Connections") SM Installing Controller Options 1.3.3 FILE FORMAT CONVERTER (D377) Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure. x 2). 1. Remove the slot cover [A] from the board slot ( 2. Install the file format converter into the board slot, and then fasten it with screws. 3. Plug in and turn on the main power switch. 4. Check or set the following SP codes with the values shown below. SP No. Title Setting SP5-836-001 Capture Function (0:Off 1:On) "1" SP5-836-002 Panel Setting "0" 5. Check the operation. 6. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option. ( SM Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) 17 p.30 "Check All Connections") D641 Installing Controller Options 1.3.4 IEEE 1284 INTERFACE BOARD (B679) Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure. You can only install one of the following network interfaces at one time: (IEEE 802.11a/g, g (Wireless LAN), IEEE1284, Bluetooth). x 2). 1. Remove the slot cover [A] from the board slot ( 2. Install the interface board (Knob-screw x 2) into the board slot. 3. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option. ( D641 18 p.30 "Check All Connections") SM Installing Controller Options 1.3.5 IEEE 802.11A/G OR G (D377) Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure. You can only install one of the following network interfaces at one time: (IEEE 802.11a/g, g Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) (Wireless LAN), IEEE1284, Bluetooth). x 2). 1. Remove the slot cover [A] from the board slot ( 2. Install the wireless LAN board (Knob-screw x 2) into the board slot. 3. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option. ( 4. Peel off the double-sided tapes on the Velcro fasteners [A], and then attach them [B] at the p.30 "Check All Connections") front left and rear right of the machine. 5. Attach the "ANT1" (having a black ferrite core) to the front left of the machine. 6. Attach the "ANT2" (having a white ferrite core) to the rear right of the machine. SM 19 D641 Installing Controller Options "ANT1" is a transmission/reception antenna and "ANT2" is a reception antenna. Do not attach them at the wrong places. 7. Attach the clamps as shown above. 8. Wire the cables and clamp them ( x 8). Make sure that the cables are not slack. Keep them wired tightly along the covers. You may have to move the machine if the reception is not clear. Make sure that the machine is not located near an appliance or any type of equipment that generates strong magnetic fields. Put the machine as close as possible to the access point. User Tool Settings for IEEE 802.11a/g Go into the User Tools mode and do the procedure below. These settings take effect every time the machine is powered on. You cannot use IEEE 802.11a/g if you use Ethernet. 1. Press the “User Tools” key. 2. On the touch panel, touch “System Settings”. Select “Interface Settings”> “Network” > “LAN Type”. The “LAN Type” (default: Ethernet) must be set for either Ethernet or wireless LAN. 3. Select “Interface Settings”> “Wireless LAN”. Only the wireless LAN options show. 4. Set the “Communication Mode“. 5. Enter the “SSID setting”. (The setting is case sensitive.) 6. Set the “Ad-hoc Channel”. You need this setting when Ad Hoc Mode is selected. The allowed range for the channel settings may vary for different countries. Region A (mainly Europe and Asia) Range: 1-13, 36, 40, 44 and 48 channels (default: 11) D641 20 SM Installing Controller Options In some countries, only the following channels are available: Range: 1-11 channels (default: 11) Region B (mainly North America) Range: 1-11, 36, 40, 44 and 48 channels (default: 11) 7. Set the “Security Method” to specify the encryption of the Wireless LAN. The “WEP” (Wired Equivalent Privacy) setting is designed to protect wireless data transmission. The same WEP key is required on the receiving side in order to unlock encoded data. There are 64 bit and 128 bit WEP keys. Range of Allowed Settings: 64 bit: 10 characters 128 bit: 26 characters Specify “WPA” when “Communication Mode” is set to “Infrastructure Mode”. Set the “WPA Encryption Method” and “WPA Authent. Method”. WPA Encryption Method: Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) Select either "TKIP" or "CCMP (AES)". WPA Authent. Method: Select either “WPA-PSK”, “WPA”, “WPA2-PSK", or “WPA2”. If you select “WPA-PSK” or “WPA2-PSK”, enter the pre-shared key (PSK) of 8 - 63 characters in ASCII code. When “WPA” or “WPA2” are selected, authentication settings and certificate installation settings are required. 8. Press “Wireless LAN Signal” to check the machine's radio wave status using the operation panel. 9. Press “Restore Factory Defaults” to initialize the wireless LAN settings. Press “Yes” to initialize the following settings: SM Transmission mode Channel Transmission Speed WEP SSID WEP Key 21 D641 Installing Controller Options SP Mode Settings for IEEE 802.11 Wireless LAN The following SP commands and UP modes can be set for IEEE 802.11 SP No. Name 5840 006 Channel MAX 5840 007 Channel MIN Function Sets the maximum range of the channel settings for the country. Sets the minimum range of the channels settings allowed for your country. Sets the transmission speed. 5840 008 Transmission Auto, 54 Mbps, 48 Mbps, 36 Mbps, 24 Mbps, 18 Mbps, Speed 12 Mbps, 9 Mbps, 6 Mbps, 11 Mbps, 5.5 Mbps, 2 Mbps, 1 Mbps (default: Auto). 5840 011 UP mode WEP Key Select Used to select the WEP key (Default: 00). Name Function SSID Used to confirm the current SSID setting. WEP Key Used to confirm the current WEP key setting. WEP Mode WPA Encryption Method D641 Used to show the maximum length of the string that can be used for the WEP Key entry. Used to confirm the current WPA encryption setting. WPA Authent. Used to confirm the current WPA authentication setting Method and pre-shared key. 22 SM Installing Controller Options 1.3.6 BLUETOOTH UNIT (D566) Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power supply cord. 1. Insert the Bluetooth unit into the USB-A slot [A]. 2. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option. ( p.30 "Check All Connections") Bluetooth Unit and IEEE 802.11a/g or g Interface Unit cannot be set at the same time. SM 23 D641 Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) Installing Controller Options 1.3.7 GIGABIT ETHERNET (G874) Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure. You can only install one of the following network interfaces at one time: (IEEE 802.11a/g, g (Wireless LAN), IEEE1284, IEEE1394, Bluetooth). x 2). 1. Remove the slot cover [A] from the board slot ( 2. Insert the Gigabit Ethernet Board into the I/F slot and fasten it with the screws. 3. Print a configuration page to confirm that the machine recognizes the installed board for USB2.0: User Tools > Printer Features > List/Test Print > Configuration Page D641 24 SM Installing Controller Options 1.3.8 IPDS UNIT (D641) Accessories Check the accessories and their quantities against the table below. No. Description Q'ty 1 IPDS Emulation SD Card 1 2 Decal 1 Only two slots are available for SD cards that contain applications. If you want to use Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) more than two applications, merge all applications into two SD cards (SP5873-001). SM 25 D641 Installing Controller Options Installation 1. Check the software version. 2. If necessary, update the firmware to the required version. 3. Turn off the main switch. 4. Remove the controller cover [A] ( 5. Insert the IPDS SD Card into Slot 1 (Upper Slot) [A]. x 2) Pushing in the SD Card releases it for removal. Make sure the SD Card is inserted and locked in place. If it is partially out of the slot, push it in gently until it locks in place. 6. Reattach the controller cover and turn ON the main switch. D641 26 SM Installing Controller Options 7. Do one of the following ("A" or "B") to enable the IPDS function. A. [Enable the IPDS function via telnet] 1. Connect the machine via telnet. 2. Execute the following commands: msh> set ipds up ***If you want to stop the function. msh> set ipds down B. [Enable the IPDS option via WebImageMonitor] 1. Log in to WebImageMonitor. Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) 2. Change the setting to enable IPDS. 8. Attach the decal [A] as shown in the photo above. Line up the left side of the decal with the left edged of the main power switch. ([B]: 10 mm or more) SM 27 D641 Installing Controller Options 1.3.9 VM CARD TYPE U (D640) This option is only for basic models. Accessories Check the accessories and their quantities against the table below. Description Q'ty 1. VM SD Card 1 2. Decal 1 D641 28 SM Installing Controller Options Installation 1. Switch the machine off. 2. Remove the controller cover [A] ( 3. Insert the SD card into SD Slot 2 (Lower Slot) [A]. Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) x 2) SM This SD card must be inserted into Slot 2 (Lower Slot). 29 D641 Check All Connections 1.4 CHECK ALL CONNECTIONS Plug in the power cord. Then turn on the main switch. Enter the printer user mode. Then print the configuration page. User Tools > Printer Features > List Test Print > Configuration Page All installed options are shown in the “System Reference” column. D641 30 SM Printer Service Tables 2. SERVICE TABLES 2.1 PRINTER SERVICE TABLES 2.1.1 SP1-XXX (SERVICE MODE) Bit Switch 001 Bit Switch 1 0 1 bit 0 DFU - - bit 1 DFU - - bit 2 DFU - - bit 3 No I/O Timeout 0: Disable 1: Enable Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) 1001 Enable: The MFP I/O Timeout setting will have no effect. I/O Timeouts will never occur. bit 4 0: Disable SD Card Save Mode 1: Enable Enable: Print jobs will be saved to an SD Card in the GW SD slot. bit 5 DFU - - bit 6 DFU - - bit 7 [RPCS,PCL]: Printable area frame border 0: Disable 1: Enable Enable: The machine prints all RPCS and PCL jobs with a border on the edges of the printable area. SM 31 D641 Printer Service Tables 1001 Bit Switch 002 Bit Switch 2 0 1 bit 0 DFU - - bit 1 DFU - - bit 2 Applying a collation Type Shift Normal Collate Collate A collation type (shift or normal) will be applied to all jobs that do not already have a ‘Collate Type’ configured. bit 3 If #5-0 is enabled, this Bit Switch has no effect. [PCL5e/c,PS]: PDL Auto Switching 0: Enable 1: Disable Disable: The MFPs ability to change the PDL processor mid-job. Some host systems submit jobs that contain both PS and PCL5e/c. If Auto PDL switching is disabled, these jobs will not be printed properly. D641 bit 4 DFU - - bit 5 DFU - - bit 6 DFU - - bit 7 DFU - - 32 SM Printer Service Tables 1001 Bit Switch 003 Bit Switch 3 0 1 bit 0 DFU - - bit 1 DFU - - bit 2 [PCL5e/c]: Legacy HP compatibility 0: Disable 1: Enable Enable: Uses the same left margin as older HP models such as HP4000/HP8000. In other words, the left margin defined in the job (usually " *r0A") SM bit 3 DFU - - bit 4 DFU - - bit 5 DFU - - bit 6 DFU - - bit 7 DFU - - 33 Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) will be changed to " *r1A" D641 Printer Service Tables 1001 Bit Switch 004 Bit Switch 4 0 1 bit 0 DFU - - bit 1 DFU - - bit 2 DFU - - bit 3 IPDS print-side reversal 0: Disable 1: Enable Enable: Increases printing speed but simplex pages may be printed on the back side of the sheet. D641 bit 4 DFU - - bit 5 DFU - - bit 6 DFU - - bit 7 DFU - - 34 SM Printer Service Tables 1001 Bit Switch 005 Bit Switch 5 0 1 Disable Enable Show "Collate Type", "Staple Type" and "Punch Type" buttons on the operation panel. bit 0 If enabled, users will be able to configure a Collate Type, Staple Type, and Punch Type from the operation panel. The available types will depend on the device and configured options. After enabling the function, the settings will appear under: "User Tools > Printer Features > System" Multiple copies if a paper size or type 0: Disable (Single mismatch occurs copy) 1: Enable (Multiple copy) Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) bit 1 If a paper size or type mismatch occurs during the printing of multiple copies, only a single copy is output by default. Using this Bit Switch, the device can be configured to print all copies even if a paper mismatch occurs. bit 2 DFU bit 3 [PS] PS Criteria - - Pattern3 Pattern1 Change the number of PS criterion used by the PS interpreter to determine whether a job is PS data or not. Pattern3: includes most PS commands. Pattern1: A small number of PS tags and headers bit 4 Increase max number of the stored jobs Disable Enable (1000) (100) to 1000 jobs. Enable: Changes the maximum number of jobs that can be stored on the HDD via Job Type settings to 1000. The default is 100. bit 5 SM DFU - 35 - D641 Printer Service Tables bit 6 Method for determining the image rotation for the edge to bind on. 0: Disable 1: Enable If enabled, the image rotation will be performed as they were in the specifications of older models for the binding of pages of mixed orientation jobs. The old models are below: - PCL: Pre-04A models - PS/PDF/RPCS:Pre-05S models bit 7 0: Disable Letterhead mode printing 1: Enable (Duplex) Routes all pages through the duplex unit. If this is disabled, simplex pages or the last page of an odd-paged duplex job are not routed through the duplex unit. This could result in problems with letterhead/pre-printed pages. Only affects pages specified as Letterhead paper. 1001 Bit Switch 006 Bit Switch 6 DFU 1001 - - 0 1 0: Disable 1: Enable Bit Switch 007 Bit Switch 7 Print path If enabled, simplex pages (in mixed simplex/duplex PS/PCL5 jobs only) bit 0 and the last page of an odd paged duplex job (PS, PCL5, PCL6), are always routed through the duplex unit. Not having to switch paper paths increases the print speed slightly. bit 1 to 7 D641 DFU - 36 - SM Printer Service Tables 1001 Bit Switch 008 Bit Switch 8 DFU 1001 - - Bit Switch 009 Bit Switch 9 PDL Auto Detection timeout of jobs submitted via USB or Parallel Port (IEEE 1284). 0 1 "Disabled "Enabled (Immediately)" (10 seconds)" bit 0 To be used if PDL auto-detection fails. A failure of PDL autodetection doesn't necessarily mean that the job can't be printed. This bit switch tells the device bit 1 DFU bit 2 Job Cancel - - Disabled (Not cancelled) Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) whether to time-out immediately (default) upon failure or to wait 10 seconds. Enabled (Cancelled) If this bit switch, all jobs will be cancelled after a jam occurs. Note: If this bitsw is enabled, printing under the following conditions might result in problems: - Job submission via USB or Parallel Port - Spool printing (WIM >Configuration > Device Settings > System) bit 3 PCL/PS bypass tray paper rotation (SEF/LEF) 0: Disable 1: Enable This bitsw causes the device to revert to the behavior of previous generations. It only takes effect if "Bypass Tray Setting Priority" = "Driver/Command". Previous spec (bitsw=1): If a standard sized paper mismatch occurred in the bypass tray, the MFP always prompted for SEF paper. If this bitsw=0 (default) then in the event of a standard sized paper mismatch, the MFP will always prompt for paper of the rotation (SEF/LEF) determined by the MFP bypass tray paper setting or by the bypass tray sensor. SM 37 D641 Printer Service Tables bit 4 Response to PJL USTATUS when multiple collated copies are printed 0: Disable 1: Enable When enabled, if multiple collated copies are printed, the device no longer responds to PJL USTATUS with the number of pages in the current copy. Instead the device will return the total number of pages for all copies. Bit 5 DFU - to 7 1001 - Bit Switch 010 Bit Switch 10 bit 0 to 4 bit 5 DFU List / Test Print Lock 0 1 - - 0: Disable 1: Enable If enabled, you can lock or unlock the [List/Test Print] items under the Pinter Features menu when the Store and Skip Errored Job Function is on. Bit 6 Optional charge machines - - 0: Disable 1: Enable - - If enabled, you can use the optional charge machines when the Store and Skip Errored Job Function is on. Bit 7 D641 DFU 38 SM Printer Service Tables 1001 Bit Switch 011 Bit Switch 11 bit 0 List / Test Print menu 0 1 0: Disable 1: Enable When enabled, [Multiple Lists] menu is displayed in [List / Test Print] under the Printer Features menu. bit 1 0: Job Interrupt printing 1: Page Selects the interrupting units for the interrupt printing function. When you select "0," you can interrupt printing of a job while being processed. When you select "1," you can interrupt printing of a page while being Bit 2 DFU to 7 1001 - - 0 1 - - Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) processed. Bit Switch 012 Bit Switch 12 bit 0 to 7 1003 DFU [Clear Setting] Initialize Printer System 1003 001 Initializes settings in the "System" menu of the user mode. 1003 003 Delete Program SM 39 D641 Printer Service Tables 1004 [Print Summary] Print Printer Summary 1004 001 Prints the service summary sheet (a summary of all the controller settings). 1006 *CTL [Sample/Locked Print] 0: Link with Doc. Svr, 1: Enable Enables and disables the document server. When you select "0," the 1006 001 document server is enabled or disabled in accordance with Copy Service Mode SP5-967. When you select "1," the document server is enabled regardless of Copy Service Mode SP5-967. 1110 [Media Print Device Setting] 1110 002 0: Disable 1: Enable 1111 1111 001 D641 Selects the setting for the media print device. [All Job Delete Mode] Select whether to include an image 0: excluding New Job processing job in jobs subject to full 1: including New Job cancellation from the SCS job list. 40 SM Scanner Service Tables 2.2 SCANNER SERVICE TABLES 2.2.1 SP1-XXX (SYSTEM AND OTHERS) [Erase margin (Remote Scan)] 1005 Creates an erase margin for all edges of the scanned image. If the machine has scanned the edge of the original, create a margin. This SP is activated only when the machine uses TWAIN scanning. 1009 [Remote scan disable] *CTL *CTL [0 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step ] [0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: enable, 1: disable Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) 1005 1 Range from 0 to 5 mm 1009 1 Enable or disable remote scan. 1010 [Non Display Clear Light PDF] *CTL [0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: Display, 1: No display 1010 1 Enable or disable remote scan. 1011 [Org Count Disp] *CTL [0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: No display, 1: Display 1011 1 This SP codes switches the original count display on/off. SM 41 D641 Scanner Service Tables 1012 [User Info Release] *CTL [0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: Do not release, 1: Release This SP code sets the machine to release or not release the following items at job end. 1012 1 1013 Destination (E-mail/Folder/CS) Sender name Mail Text Subject line File name [Scan Media Device Setting] *CTL [0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: Disable, 1: Enable This SP code enables/disables the multi-media function option (USB 2.0/SD 1013 1 Slot) mounted on the left rear corner of the machine. Operators can scan documents to either an SD card or a USB memory device inserted into this unit. This SP must be enabled (set to "1") in order for the device to function. D641 42 SM Scanner Service Tables 2.2.2 SP2-XXX (SCANNING-IMAGE QUALITY) [Compression Level (Gray-scale)] 2021 Selects the compression ratio for grayscale processing mode (JPEG) for the three settings that can be selected at the operation panel. 2021 1 Comp1: 5-95 [5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ] 2021 2 Comp2: 5-95 [5 to 95 / 40 / 1 /step ] *CTL [5 to 95 / 65 / 1 /step ] 2021 4 Comp4: 5-95 [5 to 95 / 80 / 1 /step ] 2021 5 Comp5: 5-95 [5 to 95 / 95 / 1 /step ] Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) 2021 3 Comp3: 5-95 [Compression ratio of ClearLight PDF] 2024 Selects the compression ratio for clearlight PDF for the two settings that can be selected at the operation panel. 2024 1 Compression Ratio (Normal) [5 to 95 / 25 / 1 /step ] *CTL 2024 2 Compression Ratio (High) [5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ] [Compression ratio of ClearLight PDF JPEG2000] 2025 Selects the compression ratio for clearlight PDF for the two settings that can be selected at the operation panel. 2025 1 Compression Ratio (Normal) JPEG2000 [5 to 95 / 25 / 1 /step ] *CTL 2025 2 Compression Ratio (High) JEPG2000 SM 43 [5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ] D641 Printer Specifications 3. SPECIFICATIONS 3.1 PRINTER SPECIFICATIONS PCL 6/5e PDF Direct Printer Languages: Adobe PostScript 3 (optional) IPDS (optional) MediaPrint: JPEG/TIFF (optional) PCL 5e: 300 x 300 dpi 600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1-bit) PCL 6: 600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1-bit) Resolution and Gradation: PDF Direct: 300 x 300 dpi/600 x 600 dpi PS3: 300 x 300 dpi/600 x 600 dpi XPS: 600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1-bit) IPDS: 300 x 300 dpi/ 600 x 600 dpi Printing speed: D129: 40 ppm D130: 50 ppm PCL 6/5e (Standard): 45 Compatible fonts 13 International fonts Resident Fonts: 6 Bitmap fonts Adobe PostScript 3 (Optional): 136 fonts IPDS (Optional): 108 fonts D641 44 SM Printer Specifications USB2.0 Type A and Type B: Standard Ethernet (100 Base-TX/10 Base-T): Standard Host Interfaces: Gigabit Ethernet (1000 Base-T): Optional IEEE1284 parallel x 1: Optional IEEE802.11a/b/g (Wireless LAN): Optional Bluetooth (USB type): Optional TCP/IP (IPv4, IPv6), IPX/SPX Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) Network Protocols: SM 45 D641 USB Specifications 3.2 USB SPECIFICATIONS USB connectivity is built into the controller. Interface Data rates USB 2.0 480 Mbps (high speed), 12 Mbps (full speed), 1.5 Mbps (low speed) High speed mode is only supported by USB 2.0. 3.3 IEEE 802.11A/B/G SPECIFICATIONS Standard applied IEEE802.11a/b/g Network protocols TCP/IP, Apple Talk, NetBEUI, IPX/SPX, SMB Frequency range (Center 2412 - 2462 MHz (1-11 channels) Frequency) 5180 - 5320 MHz (36, 40, 44, 48, 52, 56, 60, and 64 channels) (Center 2412 - 2472 MHz (1-13 channels) Frequency) 5180 - 5320 MHz (36, 40, 44, 48, 52, 56, 60, and 64 channels) (US model) Frequency range (EU model) D641 46 SM Bluetooth Specifications 3.4 BLUETOOTH SPECIFICATIONS Transmission Specifications Based on Bluetooth Ver2.0+EDR Transmission Asynchronous Communication : Approximately 2.1 Mbps (Max) Speed Synchronous Communication : Approximately 1.3 Mbps (Max) Profile Hard Copy Cable Replacement Profile (HCRP), Serial Port Profile (SPP), Basic Imaging Profile (BIP) Standard Scanner Main scan/Sub scan Resolution: 200 to 600 dpi Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) 3.5 SCANNER SPECIFICATIONS Twain Mode: Available scanning 100 to 1200 dpi Resolution Range: Delivery Mode: 100/200/300/400/600 dpi Grayscales: Scanning Throughput (ARDF mode): Interface: 1 bit or 8 bits/pixel each for RGB BW: 61 ipm (A4LEF / BW Text/ Photo / 200dpi /Compression: On (MH)) FC: 31 ipm (A4LEF / FC Text / Photo / 200dpi / Compression: Standard) Ethernet 10Base-T / 100Base-TX, Gigabit Ethernet (1000Base-T), Wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11a/b/g) Compression B&W: TIFF (MH, MR, MMR, JBIG2), Gray Scale Method: Full Color: JPEG SM 47 D641 Software Accessories 3.6 SOFTWARE ACCESSORIES The printer drivers and utility software are provided on one CD-ROM. An auto-run installer allows you to select which components to install. 3.6.1 PRINTER DRIVERS Windows XP, Server 2003, Server MacOSX10.2 2008, Vista, 7 or later Yes No PS3 Yes Yes RPCS No No Printer Language PCL5c / PCL6 The PCL5c/6 and PS3 drivers are provided on the printer/scanner CD-ROM. The PS3 drivers are all genuine Adobe PS drivers, except for Windows XP/Server 2003/Server 2008/Vista/7. A PPD file for each operating system is provided with the driver. The PPD installer for Macintosh supports Mac OS X 10.2 or later versions. 3.6.2 SCANNER AND LAN FAX DRIVERS Printer Windows XP, Server 2003, MacOSX10.2 Language Server 2008, Vista, 7 or later Network TWAIN Yes No LAN-FAX Yes No The Network TWAIN and LAN Fax drivers are provided on the printer and scanner drivers CD-ROM. This software lets you fax documents directly from your PC. Address Book Editor and Cover Sheet Editor are to be installed as well. (These require the optional fax unit.) D641 48 SM Software Accessories 3.6.3 UTILITY SOFTWARE Software Font Manager (XP/Vista) Description A font management utility with screen fonts for the printer This is provided on the printer scanner CD-ROM Smart Device Monitor for Admin A printer management utility for network (XP/Server 2003/Server administrators. NIB setup utilities are also available. 2008/Vista/7) This is provided on the web. A printer management utility for client users. SmartDeviceMonitor for Client (XP/Server 2003/Server 2008/Vista/7) A utility for peer-to-peer printing over a NetBEUI or TCP/IP network. A peer-to-peer print utility over a TCP/IP network. Printer Scanner Unit Type 5002 (D641) DeskTopBinder – This provides the parallel printing and recovery printing features. This is provided on the web. A utility for peer-to-peer printing over a NetBEUI or Printer Utility for Mac TCP This software provides several convenient (Mac) functions for printing from Macintosh clients. This is provided on the web. DeskTopBinder Lite itself can be used as personal DeskTopBinder Lite document management software and can manage (XP/Server 2003/Server both image data converted from paper documents 2008/Vista/7) and application files saved in each client’s PC. This is provided on the web. SM 49 D641 www.s-manuals.com
Source Exif Data:
File Type : PDF File Type Extension : pdf MIME Type : application/pdf PDF Version : 1.7 Linearized : No Page Mode : UseOutlines XMP Toolkit : Adobe XMP Core 4.0-c316 44.253921, Sun Oct 01 2006 17:14:39 Modify Date : 2014:01:10 19:30:10+02:00 Create Date : 2012:01:10 14:52:33-05:00 Metadata Date : 2014:01:10 19:30:10+02:00 Creator Tool : Acrobat PDFMaker 10.1 for Word Document ID : uuid:da19c75e-bfeb-4287-a22b-38f519b6ea20 Instance ID : uuid:25177319-52c1-48fe-979f-e7c2d3c2e941 Format : application/pdf Title : Ricoh D129, D130 - Service Manual. www.s-manuals.com. Creator : Subject : Ricoh D129, D130 - Service Manual. www.s-manuals.com. Producer : Adobe PDF Library 10.0 Page Count : 1402 Page Layout : SinglePage Keywords : Ricoh D129, D130 - Service Manual. www.s-manuals.com. Warning : [Minor] Ignored duplicate Info dictionaryEXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools